S12 MagniV
Microcontrollers
freescale.com
MC9S12ZVH-Family
Reference Manual
MC9S12ZVHRMV1
Rev. 1.05
03/2015
To provide the most up-to-date information, the online revision of our documents is the most current. Your
printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information available, refer to:
freescale.com
The following revision history table summarizes changes. This document contains information for all
constituent modules, with the exception of the S12Z CPU. For S12ZCPU information please refer to the
CPU S12Z Reference Manual. A full list of family members and options is included in the appendices.
Revision History
Date Revision
Level Description
Sep, 2013 1.00
First external release version
- replace the ZVH64 100pin with ZVH128 100pin
- CANPHY update to pass conformance test for 2N65E
- Update OSC etc electrical spec
Sep, 2013 1.01
Corrected footers in TOC, S12ZBDC and Appendix N
Removed list of chapters
Corrected TOC format of appendix listing
Corrected SCIBDL reset value
SPI added MISO pin name to block diagram
Mar, 2014 1.02
Changed VLVRXA minimum to 2.95V
Changed VDDC load current in RPM to 2.5mA
Changed STOP IDD max. to 700uA at 150C
Changed STOP IDD max. to 65uA at -40C
Changed WAIT IDD max to 21mA at 105C
Changed RUN IDD max to 32mA at 105C
Removed incorrect reference to over-temperature protection
Corrected vector mapping of ADC CONIF_OIE interrupt
Changed STOP mode BDC enabled dependency description (section 1.10.3)
Added frequency spec. for WSTAT disable to Operating Conditions table
Updated ADC section (formatting and wording improvements).
Updated BDC section (improved description of NORESP bit)
Updated CPMU section (improved description of CSAD bit)
Updated FTMRZ section (description of protection in SSC Mode)
Removed electrical parameter classification
Removed references to production test (Tables B-3 and L-2)
Added NVM shipping information to appendix G.3
Jun, 2014 1.03 Corrected ordering information controller family encoding in Appendix N
Sep, 2014 1.04
Updated BKGD pin I/O specification
Specified ADC accuracy for a range of VDDA and VREF
Updated CANPHY over current detection specification.
Mar, 2015 1.05
CPMU chapter updated. See chapter revision history
Minor BDC chapter correction. See chapter revision history
Corrected 100LQFP diagram pins 76-79 and Table 1-7 Pin 103 mapping
Removed reference to PortP wake-up capability. It has no wake-up capability
Added Startup from reset parameters based on simulation to Table I-1
Corrected ADC result reference alignment.
Extended BKGD VIL condition from 3.15V to 3.13V
Updated BATS electrical parameters
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 3
Chapter 1
Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
1.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
1.2.1 MC9S12ZVH-Family Member Comparison . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
1.3 Maskset 0N65E and 1N65E device compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
1.4 Maskset 2N65E and 1N65E/0N65E device compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
1.5 Chip-Level Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
1.6 Module Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
1.6.1 S12Z Central Processor Unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
1.6.2 Embedded Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
1.6.3 Clocks, Reset & Power Management Unit (CPMU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
1.6.4 Main External Oscillator (XOSCLCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
1.6.5 32K External Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
1.6.6 System Integrity Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
1.6.7 Real Time Clock (RTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
1.6.8 Timer (TIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
1.6.9 Pulse Width Modulation Module (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.6.10 Simple Sound Generator (SSG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.6.11 Liquid Crystal Display driver (LCD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.6.12 Stepper Motor Controller (MC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.6.13 Stepper Stall Detect (SSD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.6.14 CAN Physical Layer (CANPHY) transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.6.15 Multi-Scalable Controller Area Network (MSCAN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.6.16 Inter-IC Bus Module (IIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.6.17 Serial Communication Interface Module (SCI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.6.18 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.6.19 Analog-to-Digital Converter Module (ADC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.6.20 Supply Voltage Sensor (BATS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.6.21 On-Chip Voltage Regulator system (VREG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.7 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
1.7.1 Device Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
1.7.2 Part ID registers Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
1.8 Signal Description and Device Pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
1.8.1 Pin Assignment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
1.8.2 Detailed Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.8.3 VSENSE - Voltage Sensor Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
1.8.4 BCTLC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
1.8.5 VDDC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
1.8.6 BCTL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
1.8.7 Power Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
1.9 Package and Pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
1.10 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
1.10.1 Chip Configuration Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
1.10.2 Debugging Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
4Freescale Semiconductor
1.10.3 Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
1.11 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
1.11.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
1.11.2 Securing the Microcontroller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
1.11.3 Operation of the Secured Microcontroller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
1.11.4 Unsecuring the Microcontroller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
1.11.5 Reprogramming the Security Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
1.11.6 Complete Memory Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
1.12 Resets and Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
1.12.1 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
1.12.2 Interrupt Vectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
1.12.3 Effects of Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
1.13 COP Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
1.14 ADC0 Internal Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
1.15 The ADC0 VRH/VRL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
1.16 The ADC0 Conversion Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
1.17 ADC Result Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
1.18 BDC Clock Source Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
1.19 FTMRZ Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
1.20 RTC Clock Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
1.21 LCD Clock Source Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
1.22 32K OSC enable control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Chapter 2
Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
2.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
2.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
2.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
2.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
2.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
2.3.1 Register Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
2.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
2.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
2.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
2.4.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
2.4.3 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
2.4.4 Pin interrupts and Wakeup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
2.5 Initialization and Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
2.5.1 Port Data and Data Direction Register writes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
2.5.2 SCI0,1 Baud Rate Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
2.5.3 RTC on chip calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
2.5.4 RTC off chip calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 5
Chapter 3
Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
3.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
3.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
3.1.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
3.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
3.1.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
3.1.5 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 3
3.3.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
3.4.1 Global Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
3.4.2 Illegal Accesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
3.4.3 Uncorrectable ECC Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Chapter 4
Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
4.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
4.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
4.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
4.1.4 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
4.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
4.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
4.4.1 S12Z Exception Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
4.4.2 Interrupt Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
4.4.3 Priority Decoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
4.4.4 Reset Exception Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
4.4.5 Exception Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
4.4.6 Interrupt Vector Table Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
4.5 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
4.5.1 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
4.5.2 Interrupt Nesting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
4.5.3 Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Chapter 5
Background Debug Controller (S12 ZBDCV2)
5.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
5.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
6Freescale Semiconductor
5.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
5.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
5.1.4 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
5.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
5.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
5.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
5.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
5.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
5.4.1 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
5.4.2 Enabling BDC And Entering Active BDM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
5.4.3 Clock Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
5.4.4 BDC Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
5.4.5 BDC Access Of Internal Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
5.4.6 BDC Serial Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
5.4.7 Serial Interface Hardware Handshake (ACK Pulse) Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
5.4.8 Hardware Handshake Abort Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
5.4.9 Hardware Handshake Disabled (ACK Pulse Disabled) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
5.4.10 Single Stepping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
5.4.11 Serial Communication Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
5.5 Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
5.5.1 Clock Frequency Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Chapter 6
S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
6.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
6.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
6.1.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
6.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
6.1.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
6.1.5 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
6.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
6.2.1 External Event Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
6.2.2 Profiling Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
6.3 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
6.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
6.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
6.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
6.4.1 DBG Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
6.4.2 Comparator Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
6.4.3 Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
6.4.4 State Sequence Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
6.4.5 Trace Buffer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
6.4.6 Code Profiling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
6.4.7 Breakpoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
6.5 Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 7
6.5.1 Avoiding Unintended Breakpoint Re-triggering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
6.5.2 Debugging Through Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
6.5.3 Breakpoints from other S12Z sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
6.5.4 Code Profiling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Chapter 7
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
7.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
7.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
7.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
7.1.3 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
7.2 Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
7.2.1 RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
7.2.2 EXTAL and XTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
7.2.3 VSUP — Regulator Power Input Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
7.2.4 VDDA, VSSA — Regulator Reference Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
7.2.5 VDDX, VSSX— Pad Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
7.2.6 BCTL— Base Control Pin for external PNP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
7.2.7 BCTLC — Base Control Pin for external PNP for VDDC power domain . . . . . . . . . . 234
7.2.8 VSS1,2 — Core Ground Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
7.2.9 VDD— Core Logic Supply Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
7.2.10 VDDF— NVM Logic Supply Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
7.2.11 API_EXTCLK — API external clock output pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
7.2.12 TEMPSENSE — Internal Temperature Sensor Output Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
7.3 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
7.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
7.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
7.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
7.4.1 Phase Locked Loop with Internal Filter (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
7.4.2 Startup from Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
7.4.3 Stop Mode using PLLCLK as source of the Bus Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
7.4.4 Full Stop Mode using Oscillator Clock as source of the Bus Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
7.4.5 External Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
7.4.6 System Clock Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
7.5 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
7.5.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
7.5.2 Description of Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
7.5.3 Oscillator Clock Monitor Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
7.5.4 PLL Clock Monitor Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
7.5.5 Computer Operating Properly Watchdog (COP) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
7.5.6 Power-On Reset (POR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
7.5.7 Low-Voltage Reset (LVR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
7.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
7.6.1 Description of Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
7.7 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
8Freescale Semiconductor
7.7.1 General Initialization Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
7.7.2 Application information for COP and API usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
7.7.3 Application Information for PLL and Oscillator Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Chapter 8
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
8.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
8.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
8.1.3 Block Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
8.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
8.2.1 IOC7 — Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
8.2.2 IOC6 - IOC0 — Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 6-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
8.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
8.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
8.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
8.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
8.4.1 Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
8.4.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
8.4.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
8.4.4 Pulse Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
8.4.5 Event Counter Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
8.4.6 Gated Time Accumulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
8.5 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
8.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
8.6.1 Channel [7:0] Interrupt (C[7:0]F) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
8.6.2 Pulse Accumulator Input Interrupt (PAOVI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
8.6.3 Pulse Accumulator Overflow Interrupt (PAOVF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
8.6.4 Timer Overflow Interrupt (TOF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Chapter 9
Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
9.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
9.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
9.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
9.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
9.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
9.2.1 PWM7 - PWM0 — PWM Channel 7 - 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
9.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
9.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
9.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
9.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
9.4.1 PWM Clock Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
9.4.2 PWM Channel Timers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 9
9.5 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
9.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
Chapter 10
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
10.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
10.2 Key Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
10.2.1 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
10.2.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
10.3 Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
10.3.1 Detailed Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
10.4 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
10.4.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
10.4.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
10.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
10.5.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
10.5.2 Analog Sub-Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
10.5.3 Digital Sub-Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
10.6 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
10.7 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
10.7.1 ADC Conversion Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
10.7.2 ADC Sequence Abort Done Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
10.7.3 ADC Error and Conversion Flow Control Issue Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407
10.8 Use Cases and Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
10.8.1 List Usage — CSL single buffer mode and RVL single buffer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
10.8.2 List Usage — CSL single buffer mode and RVL double buffer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
10.8.3 List Usage — CSL double buffer mode and RVL double buffer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
10.8.4 List Usage — CSL double buffer mode and RVL single buffer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
10.8.5 List Usage — CSL double buffer mode and RVL double buffer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
10.8.6 RVL swapping in RVL double buffer mode and related registers ADCIMDRI and
ADCEOLRI 410
10.8.7 Conversion flow control application information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
10.8.8 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
10.8.9 Triggered Conversion — Single CSL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
10.8.10Fully Timing Controlled Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
Chapter 11
Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
11.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
11.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
11.1.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
11.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
11.1.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
10 Freescale Semiconductor
11.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
11.2.1 RXCAN — CAN Receiver Input Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
11.2.2 TXCAN — CAN Transmitter Output Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
11.2.3 CAN System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
11.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
11.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
11.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
11.3.3 Programmers Model of Message Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
11.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
11.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
11.4.2 Message Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
11.4.3 Identifier Acceptance Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456
11.4.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
11.4.5 Low-Power Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464
11.4.6 Reset Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
11.4.7 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
11.5 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
11.5.1 MSCAN initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
11.5.2 Bus-Off Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
Chapter 12
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
12.1.1 Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
12.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
12.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
12.1.4 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
12.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
12.2.1 MOSI — Master Out/Slave In Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
12.2.2 MISO — Master In/Slave Out Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
12.2.3 SS — Slave Select Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
12.2.4 SCK — Serial Clock Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
12.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
12.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
12.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
12.4.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
12.4.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485
12.4.3 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486
12.4.4 SPI Baud Rate Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
12.4.5 Special Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
12.4.6 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
12.4.7 Low Power Mode Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 11
Chapter 13
Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
13.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
13.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
13.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
13.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
13.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500
13.2.1 IIC_SCL — Serial Clock Line Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500
13.2.2 IIC_SDA — Serial Data Line Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500
13.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500
13.3.1 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500
13.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
13.4.1 I-Bus Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
13.4.2 Operation in Run Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517
13.4.3 Operation in Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517
13.4.4 Operation in Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517
13.5 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517
13.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517
13.7 Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 518
13.7.1 IIC Programming Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 518
Chapter 14
Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
14.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525
14.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 526
14.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 526
14.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 526
14.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
14.2.1 BP[3:0] — Analog Backplane Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
14.2.2 FP[39:0] — Analog Frontplane Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
14.2.3 VLCD — LCD Supply Voltage Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
14.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
14.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
14.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
14.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537
14.4.1 LCD Driver Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537
14.4.2 Operation in Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539
14.4.3 Operation in Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539
14.4.4 LCD Waveform Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
14.4.5 LCD Clock Inputs & Reset Behavior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 546
14.5 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
14.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
12 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
15.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
15.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
15.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
15.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551
15.1.4 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551
15.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
15.2.1 TXD — Transmit Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
15.2.2 RXD — Receive Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
15.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
15.3.1 Module Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
15.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553
15.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566
15.4.1 Infrared Interface Submodule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
15.4.2 LIN Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
15.4.3 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
15.4.4 Baud Rate Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569
15.4.5 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
15.4.6 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575
15.4.7 Single-Wire Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583
15.4.8 Loop Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
15.5 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
15.5.1 Reset Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
15.5.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
15.5.3 Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
15.5.4 Recovery from Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588
15.5.5 Recovery from Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588
Chapter 16
Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
16.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
16.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
16.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
16.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 591
16.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 592
16.2.1 M0C0M/M0C0P/M0C1M/M0C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . 592
16.2.2 M1C0M/M1C0P/M1C1M/M1C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . 592
16.2.3 M2C0M/M2C0P/M2C1M/M2C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . 592
16.2.4 M3C0M/M3C0P/M3C1M/M3C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . 593
16.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593
16.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593
16.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 595
16.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 13
16.4.1 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
16.4.2 PWM Duty Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613
16.4.3 Motor Controller Counter Clock Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613
16.4.4 Output Switching Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614
16.4.5 Operation in Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
16.4.6 Operation in Stop and Pseudo-Stop Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
16.5 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
16.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
16.6.1 Timer Counter Overflow Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
16.7 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
16.7.1 Code Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
Chapter 17
Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
17.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 621
17.1.1 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 621
17.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 621
17.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 622
17.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 623
17.2.1 COSM/COSP — Cosine Coil Pins for Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 623
17.2.2 SINM/SINP — Sine Coil Pins for Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 623
17.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 624
17.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 624
17.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 624
17.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
17.4.1 Return to Zero Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
17.4.2 Full Step States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
17.4.3 Operation in Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
17.4.4 Stall Detection Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
Chapter 18
Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
18.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
18.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
18.2.1 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
18.2.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640
18.3 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641
18.3.1 OSCCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641
18.3.2 OSCCLK_32K . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 642
18.3.3 IRCCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 642
18.3.4 RTCCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 642
18.3.5 CALCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 642
18.4 Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 642
18.4.1 RTC Control Register 1(RTCCTL1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
14 Freescale Semiconductor
18.4.2 RTC Control Register 2 (RTCCTL2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 644
18.4.3 RTC Control Register 3 (RTCCTL3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 644
18.4.4 RTC Control Register 4 (RTCCTL4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 645
18.4.5 RTC Status Register 1 (RTCS1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 646
18.4.6 RTC Compensation Configure Register (RTCCCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647
18.4.7 RTC Counter Register (RTCCNT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 648
18.4.8 RTC Modulo Register (RTCMOD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 649
18.4.9 RTC Second Register (RTCSECR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 649
18.4.10RTC Minute Register (RTCMINR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
18.4.11RTC Hour Register (RTCHRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
18.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
18.5.1 RTC clock and reset behavior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
18.5.2 Calendar Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
18.5.3 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
18.5.4 RTC Clock Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 652
18.5.5 Calendar Register and Bit Write Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 653
18.5.6 Load buffer register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 654
18.6 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 654
18.6.1 RTC Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 654
18.6.2 RTC compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 655
Chapter 19
Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
19.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 657
19.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 657
19.1.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 657
19.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 658
19.2.1 SGT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 658
19.2.2 SGA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659
19.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659
19.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659
19.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659
19.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 670
19.4.1 SSG Amplitude Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 670
19.4.2 SSG Tone Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 671
19.4.3 SSG Attack and Decay function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 671
19.4.4 SSG Start and Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 674
19.4.5 Register Reload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675
19.4.6 SSG Output Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676
19.5 Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676
Chapter 20
ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
20.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 15
20.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677
20.2 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677
20.2.1 Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677
20.2.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 679
20.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 683
20.3.1 Aligned 2 and 4 Byte Memory write access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 684
20.3.2 Other Memory write access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 684
20.3.3 Memory read access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 685
20.3.4 Memory initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 685
20.3.5 Interrupt handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 685
20.3.6 ECC Algorithm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 686
20.3.7 ECC Debug Behavior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 686
Chapter 21
128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
21.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 690
21.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 690
21.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 691
21.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 691
21.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 692
21.3 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
21.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
21.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 697
21.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 717
21.4.1 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 717
21.4.2 IFR Version ID Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 717
21.4.3 Flash Block Read Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 717
21.4.4 Internal NVM resource . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 718
21.4.5 Flash Command Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 718
21.4.6 Allowed Simultaneous P-Flash and EEPROM Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723
21.4.7 Flash Command Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 724
21.4.8 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 740
21.4.9 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 740
21.4.10Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 741
21.5 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 741
21.5.1 Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 741
21.5.2 Unsecuring the MCU in Special Single Chip Mode using BDM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 742
21.5.3 .Mode and Security Effects on Flash Command Availability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 742
21.6 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 742
Chapter 22
CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
22.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 743
22.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 743
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
16 Freescale Semiconductor
22.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 744
22.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 744
22.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 745
22.2.1 CANH — CAN Bus High Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.2.2 CANL — CAN Bus Low Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.2.3 SPLIT — CAN Bus Termination Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.2.4 VDDC — Supply Pin for CAN Physical Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.2.5 VSSC — Ground Pin for CAN Physical Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.3 Internal Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.3.1 CPTXD — TXD Input to CAN Physical Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.3.2 CPRXD — RXD Output of CAN Physical Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
22.4 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 747
22.4.1 This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the CAN Physical
Layer.Module Memory Map 747
22.4.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 748
22.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
22.5.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
22.5.2 Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
22.5.3 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 757
22.6 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 758
22.6.1 Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 758
22.6.2 Wake-up Mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 759
22.6.3 Bus Error Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 759
22.6.4 CPTXD-Dominant Timeout Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 759
Chapter 23
Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
23.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 761
23.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 761
23.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 761
23.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 762
23.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 762
23.2.1 VSENSE — Supply (Battery) Voltage Sense Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 762
23.2.2 VSUP — Voltage Supply Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763
23.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763
23.3.1 Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763
23.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 764
23.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 769
23.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 769
23.4.2 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 770
Appendix A
MCU Electrical Specifications
A.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 773
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 17
A.1.1 Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 774
A.1.2 Current Injection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 775
A.1.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 776
A.1.4 ESD Protection and Latch-up Immunity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 777
A.1.5 Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 778
A.1.6 Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 779
A.1.7 I/O Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 782
A.1.8 Supply Currents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 784
A.1.9 ADC Conversion Result Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 786
Appendix B
ADC Electricals
B.1 ADC Operating Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 787
B.1.1 Factors Influencing Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 787
B.1.2 ADC Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 789
Appendix C
PLL Electrical Specifications
C.1 Reset, Oscillator and PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 793
C.1.1 Phase Locked Loop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 793
Appendix D
IRC Electrical Specifications
Appendix E
LCD Electrical Specifications
E.1 LCD Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 797
Appendix F
MSCAN Electrical Specifications
F.1 MSCAN Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 799
Appendix G
NVM Electrical Parameters
G.1 NVM Timing Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 801
G.2 NVM Reliability Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 802
G.3 NVM Factory Shipping Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 803
Appendix H
BATS Electrical Specifications
H.1 Maximum Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 805
H.2 Static Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 806
H.3 Dynamic Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 807
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
18 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix I
VREG Electrical Specifications
Appendix J
S12CANPHY Electrical Specifications
J.1 Maximum Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 811
J.2 Static Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 811
J.3 Dynamic Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 814
Appendix K
Electrical Characteristics for the Oscillator (OSCLCPcr)
K.1 OSCLCP Electrical characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 817
Appendix L
OSC32K Electrical Specifications
L.1 DC Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 819
L.2 Frequency Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 819
Appendix M
SPI Electrical Specifications
M.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 821
M.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 823
Appendix N
Ordering Information
Appendix O
Package Information
O.1 144 LQFP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 830
O.2 100 LQFP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 833
Appendix P
Detailed Register Address Map
P.1 Detailed Register Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 837
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 19
Chapter 1
Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
Table 1-1. Revision History
1.1 Introduction
The MC9S12ZVH-Family is an optimized automotive 16-bit microcontroller product line focused on low-
cost, high-performance and application component count reduction. This family integrates the components
of an S12HY or S12XHY-family microcontroller with a CAN Physical interface, a 5V regulator system to
supply the microcontroller and other components. The MC9S12ZVH-Family is targeted at a utomotive &
motorcycle instrument cluster applications requiring CAN connectivity, stepper motor gauges, and
segment LCD displays.
The MC9S12ZVH-Family features a 4x40 liquid crystal display (LCD) controller/driver and a pulse
width modulated motor controller (MC) consisting of up to 16 high current outputs. The device is capable
of stepper motor stall detection (SSD) via hardware or software, please contact Freescale sales office for
detailed information on software SSD.
The MC9S12ZVH-Family delivers an optimized solution with the integration of several key system
components into a single device, optimizing system architecture and achieving significant PCB space
savings. The MC9S12ZVH-Family delivers all the advantages and efficiencies of a 16-bit MCU while
retaining the low cost, power consumption, EMC, and code-size ef ficiency advantages currently enjoyed
by users of Freescale’s existing 8-bit and 16-bit MCU families. The MC9S12ZVH-Family also features
Version
Number Revision
Date Description of Changes
0.0 May 2011 initial Draft
0.1 Nov 2011 add the 100LQFP VSSC
0.2 Dec 2011 update base on review feedback
update the pin names for ADC/CAN/IIC/CANPHY/SPI/SSG with index number
0.3 Feb 2012 update VRH/VRL, update base on review feedback
0.4 Apri 2012 update Section 1.18, “BDC Clock Source Connectivity“
Add note on VDDC handle for 100pin
0.5 Sep 2012 Update the ADC conversion reference IFR location
Fix base on review feedback
Add FTMRZ related connection
0.6 Oct 2012 Add Section 1.3, “Maskset 0N65E and 1N65E device compare“ and update description
for 1N65E device
0.7 Nov 2012 Update BDC related change on 1N65E
0.8 Nov 2012 Update CANPHY related change on 1N65E
0.9 July 2013 Replace the 64K 100pin with 128K 100pin
Add 2N65E related update
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
20 Freescale Semiconductor
the revolutionary S12Z CPU with code size & execution efficiencies even higher than our class leading
S12X CPU. This also provides a linear memory map for flash memory for all members of the family,
eliminating the awkwardness and performance impact of page swapping. In addition to the I/O ports
available in each module, further I/O ports are available with interrupt capability allowing wake-up from
stop or wait modes.
1.2 Features
This section describes the key features of the MC9S12ZVH-Family.
1.2.1 MC9S12ZVH-Family Member Comparison
Table 1-2 provides a summary of feature set differences within the MC9S12ZVH-Family. All other
features are common to all MC9S12ZVH-Family members.
Table 1-2. MC9S12ZVH-Family features
Feature MC9S12ZVH128 MC9S12ZVH64
CPU HCS12Z HCS12Z
Flash memory (ECC) 128 KB 64 KB
EEPROM (ECC) 4 KB 4 KB
RAM (ECC) 8 KB 4 KB
Stepper Motor Drive (with HW SSD) 2 4 4
Segment LCD 4 x 32 4 x 40 4 x 40
Simple Sound Generator (SSG) Yes Yes Yes
SCI 2 2
SPI 1 1
IIC 1 1
CAN (digital communication
module) 11
High Speed CAN Physical layer - 1 1
Timer(1) one 4ch x 16-bit, one
7ch x16-b it two 8ch x 16-bit two 8ch x 16-bit
PWM 8 ch (8-bit) / 4ch (16-bit) 8 ch (8-bit) / 4ch (16-bit)
RTC Yes Yes
ADC Resolution 10-bit resolution 10-bit resolution
ADC Inputs 4 pins + internal signals 8 pins + internal signal s 8 pins + internal signals
Key Wakeup Pins 19 24 24
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 21
1.3 Maskset 0N65E and 1N65E device compare
0N65E and 1N65E devices have difference on some module versions. Table 1-3 shows the difference.
Frequency modu la te d P LL Yes Yes
Internal 1 MHz RC oscillator Yes Yes
Autonomous window watchdog 1 (with independent clock source) 1 (with independent
clock source)
Direct Battery Voltage sense pin Yes Yes
Vsup sense Yes Yes
Chip temperature sens or 1 General sensor 1 General sensor
VSUP Supply voltage 5.5 V – 18 V (normal operation)
up to 40V (protected operation)
5.5 V – 18 V (normal
operation)
up to 40V (protected
operation)
VDDX Output current Determined by power dissipation of external
ballast
Determined by pow er
dissipation of exte rna l
ballast
Maximum Bus Frequency 32 MHz 32 MHz
Package 100 pins (LQFP) 144 pins (LQFP) 144 pins (LQFP)
1. The channles show here just reflect the avaiable IOC pins, the timer are still 2 x 8 channles
Feature MC9S12ZVH128 MC9S12ZVH64
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
22 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE User should take care when switch from 0N65E to 1N65E device
1.4 Maskset 2N65E and 1N65E/0N65E device compare
on 2N65E, the CANPHY is update in order to pass conformance test. It changes the bus error behavior to
keep CANH bus driver operational if CANH and/or CANL sensed below ground. See CANPHY block
guide for the detailed information.
1.5 Chip-Level Features
On-chip modules available within the family include the following features:
S12Z CPU core
128 or 64 KB on-chip flash with ECC
4 KB EEPROM with ECC
8 or 4 KB on-chip SRAM with ECC
Phase locked loop (IPLL) frequency multiplier with internal filter
1 MHz internal RC oscillator with +/-1.3% accuracy over rated temperature range
4-20 MHz amplitude controlled pierce oscillator
32 KHz oscillator for RTC and LCD
Internal COP (watchdog) module
LCD driver for segment LCD with 40 frontplanes x 4 backplanes
Stepper Motor Controller with drivers for up to 4 motors
Up to 4 Stepper Stall Detector (SSD) modules (one for each motor)
Real Time Clock (RTC) support the Hour/Minute/Second function and frequency compensation
One Analog-to-Digital Converters (ADC) with 10-bit resolution and up to 8 channels available on
external pins
Two Timer module (TIM) supporting input/output channels that provide a range of 16-bit input
capture & output compare (8 channels)
Table 1-3. Device Difference for 0N65E and 1N65E
0N65E 1N65E
RTC V1 V2
CPMU V4 V6
DBG V1 V2
SCI V5 V6
FTMRZ V1 V2
BDC V1 V2
CANPHY V1 V2
MCU BDC fast clock source to CORE clock BDC fast clock source to Bus clock
ADC reference voltage to IFR
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 23
One Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modules with up to 8 x 8-bit channels
Simple Sound Generation (SSG) for monotonic tone generation
One Inter-Integrated Circuit (IIC) module
One Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) module
Two Serial Communication Interface (SCI) module supporting LIN 1.3, 2.0, 2.1 and SAE J2602
communications
Up to one on-chip high-speed CAN physical layer transceiver
One MSCAN (up to 1 Mbp/s, CAN 2.0 A, B compliant) module
On-chip Voltage Regulator (VREG) for regulation of input supply and all internal voltages
Optional VREG ballast control output to supply an external or internal CAN physical layer
Autonomous Periodic Interrupt (API) (combination with cyclic, watchdog)
Supply voltage sense with low battery warning.
Chip temperature sensor
1.6 Module Features
The following sections provide more details of the integrated modules.
1.6.1 S12Z Central Processor Unit (CPU)
The S12Z CPU is a revolutionary high-speed core, with code size and execution efficiencies over the S12X
CPU. The S12Z CPU also provides a linear memory map eliminating the inconvenience & performance
impact of page swapping.
Harvard Architecture - parallel data and code access
3 stage pipeline
32-Bit wide instruction and databus
32-Bit ALU
24-bit addressing, i.e. 16 MB linear address space
Instructions and Addressing modes optimized for C-Programming & Compiler
MAC unit 32bit += 32bit*32bit
Hardware divider
Single cycle multi-bit shifts (Barrel shifter )
Special instructions for fixed point match
Unimplemented opcode traps
Unprogrammed byte value (0xFF) defaults to SWI instruction
1.6.1.1 Background Debug Controller (BDC)
Background Debug Controller (BDC) with single-wire interface
Non-intrusive memory access commands
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
24 Freescale Semiconductor
Supports in-circuit programming of on-chip nonvolatile memory
1.6.1.2 Debugger (DBG)
Enhanced DBG module including:
Four comparators (A, B, C and D) each configurable to monitor PC addresses or addresses of
data accesses
A and C compare full address bus and full 32-bit data bus with data bus mask register
B and D compare full address bus only
Three modes: simple address/data match, inside address range, or outside address range
Tag-type or force-type hardware breakpoint requests
State sequencer control
64 x 64-bit circular trace buffer to capture change-of-flow addresses or address and data of every
access
Begin, End and Mid alignment of tracing to trigger
Profiling mode
1.6.2 Embedded Memory
1.6.2.1 Flash
On-chip flash memory :
Up to 128 KB of program flash memory
32 data bits plus 7 syndrome ECC (error correction code) bits allow single bit fault correction
and double fault detection
Erase sector size 512 bytes
Automated program and erase algorithm
User margin level setting for reads
Protection scheme to prevent accidental program or erase
1.6.2.2 EEPROM
Up to 4 KB EEPROM
16 data bits plus 6 syndrome ECC (error correction code) bits allow single bit error correction
and double fault detection
Erase sector size 4 bytes
Automated program and erase algorithm
User margin level setting for reads
1.6.2.3 SRAM
Up to 8 KB of general-purpose RAM with ECC
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 25
Single bit error correction and double bit error detection
1.6.3 Clocks, Reset & Power Management Unit (CPMU)
Real Time Interrupt (RTI)
Clock Monitor, supervising the correct function of the oscillator (CM)
System reset generation
Autonomous periodic interrupt (API) (combination with cyclic, watchdog)
Low Power Operation
RUN mode is the main full performance operating mode with the entire device clocked.
WAIT mode when the internal CPU clock is switched off, so the CPU does not execute
instructions.
Pseudo ST OP - system clocks are stopped but the RTI, COP, API, R TC and LCD modules can
be enabled with clock source from the osc.
STOP - the oscillator is stopped in this mode, all clocks are switched off and all counters and
dividers remain frozen. The 32 KHz oscillator can be enabled, RTC and LCD can be still
function if enabled. The API and COP can still function if their clock source are from API
clock(ACLK).
1.6.3.1 Internal Phase-Locked Loop (IPLL)
Phase-locked-loop clock frequency multiplier
No external components required
Reference divider and multiplier allow large variety of clock rates
Automatic bandwidth control mode for low-jitter operation
Automatic frequency lock detector
Configurable option to spread spectrum for reduced EMC radiation (frequency modulation)
Reference clock sources:
Internal 1 MHz RC oscillator (IRC)
External 4-20 MHz crystal oscillator/resonator
1.6.3.2 Internal RC Oscillator (IRC)
Trimmable internal reference clock.
Frequency: 1 MHz; Trimmed accuracy over -40C to 150C junction temperature range:
1.3%
1.6.4 Main External Oscillator (XOSCLCP)
Loop control Pierce oscillator using 4 MHz to 20 MHz crystal
Current gain control on amplitude output
Signal with low harmonic distortion
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
26 Freescale Semiconductor
Low power
Good noise immunity
Eliminates need for external current limiting resistor
Transconductance sized for optimum start-up margin for typical crystals
Oscillator pins shared with GPIO functionality
1.6.5 32K External Oscillator
Low speed oscillator using 32 KHz to 40 KHz crystal
Low power
Good noise immunity
Oscillator pins shared with GPIO functionality
1.6.6 System Integrity Support
Power-On Reset (POR)
Illegal address detection
Low-voltage detection and low voltage reset generation
Clock monitor
High temperature Interrupt
Computer Operating Properly (COP) watchdog
Configurable as window COP for enhanced failure detection
Can be initialized out of reset using option bits located in flash memory
Unimplemented opcode traps
Unprogrammed byte value (0xFF) defaults to SWI instruction
ECC support on embedded NVM
1.6.7 Real Time Clock (RTC)
Basic Clock functions with separate counters for Hour, Minutes and Seconds.Hardware
Compensation to reduce the effects of frequency variation on the 1 Hz clock (to the counters)
caused by temperature changes of crystal characteristics. Correction factor calculated by firmware.
(Programmable correction factor).
16-bit CPU register programming interface with protection against run-away code.
Option to output the buffered 32.768 kHz clock or the compensated 1 Hz clock for calibration.
1.6.8 Timer (TIM)
Up to two timer modules for input capture or output compare
8 x 16-bit channels per module
16-bit free-running counter with 8-bit precision prescaler
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 27
16-bit pulse accumulator
1.6.9 Pulse Width Modulation Module (PWM)
8 channels x 8-bit (4 channels x 16-bit)
Programmable period and duty cycle per channel
Center-aligned or edge-aligned outputs
Programmable clock select logic with a wide range of frequencies
1.6.10 Simple Sound Generator (SSG)
Programmable amplitude level with maximum 11 bit resolution from zero amplitude to max
amplitude
Sound STOP function to stop sound generation immediately
Registers double-buffered synchronously reload at edge of tone to avoid distortion of output tone.
Interrupt generated when SSG configure registers reload occurs
Input clock prescaler with 11 bit resolution
Module disable for power saving when SSG is not in use
Separate or mixed frequency and amplitude outputs for flexibility in external hardware variation.
Decay/attack function which can decrease/increase sound amplitude automatically without cpu
interaction. The function includs linear, gong and exponential decay/attack profiles
1.6.11 Liquid Crystal Display driver (LCD)
Up to 40 frontplanes and 4 backplanes or general-purpose input or output
5 modes of operation allow for different display sizes to meet application requirements
Unused frontplane and backplane pins can be used as general-purpose I/O
1.6.12 Stepper Motor Controller (MC)
PWM motor controller (MC) with up to 16 high current outputs
Each PWM channel switchable between two drivers in an H-bridge configuration
Left, right and center aligned outputs
Support for sine and cosine drive
Dithering
Output slew rate control
1.6.13 Stepper Stall Detect (SSD)
Up to four SSD
Programmable Full Step State
Programmable Integration polarity
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
28 Freescale Semiconductor
Blanking (recirculation) state
16-bit Integration Accumulator register
16-Bit Modulus Down Counter with interrupt
1.6.14 CAN Physical Layer (CANPHY) transceiver
High speed CAN interface for baud rates of up to 1 Mbit/s
ISO 11898-2 and ISO 11898-5 compliant for 12 V battery systems
SPLIT pin driver for bus recessive level stabilization
Low power mode with remote CAN wake-up handled by MSCAN module
Over-current shutdown for CANH and CANL
Voltage monitoring on CANH and CANL
CPTXD-dominant timeout feature monitoring the CPTXD signal on 1N65E/2N65E
1.6.15 Multi-Scalable Controller Area Network (MSCAN)
Implementation of the CAN protocol — Version 2.0A/B
Five receive buffers with FIFO storage scheme
Three transmit buffers with internal prioritization using a “local priority” concept
Flexible maskable identifier filter supports two full-size (32-bit) extended identifier filters, or four
16-bit filters, or either 8-bit filters
Programmable wake-up functionality with integrated low-pass filter
1.6.16 Inter-IC Bus Module (IIC)
Compatible with I2C bus standard
Multi-master operation
Software programmable for one of 256 different serial clock frequencies
Software selectable acknowledge bit
Interrupt driven byte-by-byte data transfer
Arbitration lost interrupt with automatic mode switching from master to slave
Calling address identification interrupt
Start and stop signal generation/detection
Repeated start signal generation
Acknowledge bit generation/detection
Bus busy detection
General Call Address detection
Compliant to ten-bit address
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 29
1.6.17 Serial Communication Interface Module (SCI)
Full-duplex or single-wire operation
Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format
13-bit baud rate selection for 0N65E device
16-bit baud rate selection for 1N65E device
Programmable character length
Programmable polarity for transmitter and receiver
Active edge receive wakeup
Break detection/generation supporting LIN communications
1.6.18 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Configurable 8- or 16-bit data size
Full-duplex or single-wire bidirectional
Double-buffered transmit and receive
Master or slave mode
MSB-first or LSB-first shifting
Serial clock phase and polarity options
1.6.19 Analog-to-Digital Converter Module (ADC)
One ADC
10-bit resolution
Up to 8 external channels & 8 internal channels
Left or right aligned result data
Continuous conversion mode
ADC directly writes results to RAM, preventing stall of further conversions
Internal signals monitored with the ADC module
Vrh, Vrl, Vrl+Vrh/2, Vsup or Vsense monitor, Vbg, TempSense.
External pins can also be used as digital I/O
1.6.20 Supply Voltage Sensor (BATS)
VSENSE & VSUP pin low or a high voltage interrupt
VSENSE & VSUP pin can be routed via an internal divider to the internal ADC channel
Generation of low or high voltage interrupts
1.6.21 On-Chip Volt age Regulator system (VREG)
Voltage regulator
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
30 Freescale Semiconductor
Linear voltage regulator directly supplied by VSUP (protected VBAT)
Low-voltage detect with low-voltage interrupt VSUP
Power-On Reset (POR)
Low-Voltage Reset (LVR)
External ballast device support to reduce internal power dissipation
Capable of supplying both the MCU internally plus external components
Over-temperature interrupt
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 31
1.7 Block Diagram
Figure 1-1. MC9S12ZVH-Family Block Diagram
ADC0
SCI1
AN0_[7:0]
10-bit 8-channel
Analog-Digital Converter
TIM1
Asynchronous Serial IF
ECLK
RXD1
VDDA/VRH
VSSA/VRL
VDDX3,2,1/VSSX3,2,1
VDDM2/VSSM2
5V IO Supply
VDDM1/VSSM1
PTU
Motor Driver0
IIC0
SDA0
SCL0
VLCD
VDDA/VSSA
CAN0
RXCAN0
TXCAN0
msCAN 2.0B
PA[7:0]
PTA
SSD 0
PB[3:0]
PTB
PH[7:0]
PTH
PD[7:0]
PTD
PF[7:0]
PTF
PG[7:0]
PTG
PC[7:0]
PTC
PP[7:0]
PTP
PT[7:0]
PTT(KWT)
PS[7:0]
PTS(KWS)
IOC1_[7:0]
XIRQ/IRQ function
PWM0 PWM[7:0]
SCI0
Asynchronous Serial IF
SS0
SCK0
MOSI0
MISO0
SPI0
Synchronous Serial IF
40 X 4 LCD display
PU[7:0]
PTAD(KWAD)
SSG0
SGA0
SGT0
4 KB, 8KB RAM with ECC
4 KB EEPROM with ECC
VSUP
64 KB, 128 KB Flash with ECC
S12ZCPU
VDDA
VSS1
Voltage Regulator
(Nominal 12 V)
BATS
Voltage Supply Monitor
BCTL
VDDX1
VDD
VDDF
VSS2
BCTLC
VDDC
RESET
EXTAL
XTAL
BKGD
Real Time Interrupt
Clock Monitor
Background
TEST
Debug Controller
Interrupt Module
COP Watchdog
PLL with Frequency
Modulation option
Debug Module
4 Comparators
64 Byte Trace Buffer
Reset Generation
and Test Entry
Auto. Periodic Int.
Low Power Pierce
Oscillator
PE0
PTE[1:0]
PE1
BDC
DBG
CANPHY
CANH0
CANL0
VDDC
SPLIT0
VSSC
32K_EXTAL
32K_XTAL
PE2
PTE[3:2]
PE3
32.768K OSC
Motor Driver1 SSD 1
PTV
Motor Driver2 SSD 2
PV[7:0]
Motor Driver3 SSD 3
VSENSE
TIM0 IOC0_[7:0]
PS7
PS6
RTC
Internal 1 MHz
Oscillator
TXD1
RXD0
TXD0
PAD[7:0]
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
32 Freescale Semiconductor
1.7.1 Device Memory Map
Table 1-4 shows the device register memory map.
Table 1-4. Module Register Address Ranges
Address Module Size
(Bytes)
0x0000-0x0003 ID Registers 4
0x0004-0x000F Reserved 12
0x0010-0x001F INT 16
0x0020-0x006F Reserved 80
0x0070-0x00FF MMC 14 4
0x0100-0x017F DBG 12 8
0x0180-0x01FF Reserved 128
0x0200-0x037F PIM 38 4
0x0380-0x039F FTMRZ 32
0x03A0-0x03BF Reserved 32
0x03C0-0x03CF RAM ECC 16
0x03D0-0x03FF Reserved 48
0x0400-0x042F TIM1 48
0x0430-0x047F Reserved 80
0x0480-0x04AF PWM 48
0x04B0-0x05BF Reserved 272
0x05C0-0x05EF TIM0 48
0x05F0-0x05FF Reserved 16
0x0600-0x063F ADC0 64
0x0640-0x06BF Reserved 128
0x06C0-0x06DF CPMU 32
0x06E0-0x06EF Reserved 16
0x06F0-0x06F7 BATS 8
0x06F8-0x06FF Reserved 8
0x0700-0x0707 SCI0 8
0x0708-0x070F Reserved 8
0x0710-0x0717 SCI1 8
0x0718-0x077F Reserved 104
0x0780-0x0787 SPI0 8
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 33
NOTE
Reserved register space shown in the table is not allocated to any module.
This register space is reserve d for future use. Writing to these locations has
no effect. Read access to these locations returns zero.
0x0788-0x07BF Reserved 56
0x07C0-0x07C7 IIC0 8
0x07C8-0x07FF Reserved 56
0x0800-0x083F CAN0 64
0x0840-0x098F Reserved 336
0x0990-0x0997 CANPHY0 8
0x0998-0x09FF Reserved 104
0x0A00-0x0A1F LCD 32
0x0A20-0x0A3F Reserved 32
0x0A40-0x0A7F MC 64
0x0A80-0x0A87 SSD0 8
0x0A88-0x0A8F Reserved 8
0x0A90-0x0A97 SSD1 8
0x0A98-0x0A9F Reserved 8
0x0AA0-0x0AA7 SSD2 8
0x0AA8-0x0AAF Reserved 8
0x0AB0-0x0AB7 SSD3 8
0x0AB8-0x0ADF Reserved 40
0x0AE0-0x0AEF RTC 16
0x0AF0-0x0AFF Reserved 16
0x0B00-0x0B17 SSG0 24
0x0B18-0x0FFF Reserved 1256
Table 1-4. Module Register Address Ranges
Address Module Size
(Bytes)
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
34 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 1-2. MC9S12ZVH-Family Global Memory Map.
0x00_1000
0x00_0000
0x10_0000
0x1F_4000
0x80_0000
0xFF_FFFF
RAM
EEPROM
Unimplemented
Program NVM
Register Space
4 KByte
max. 1 MB - 4 KB
max. 1 MB - 48 KB
max. 8 MB
6 MB
High address aligned
Low address aligned
0x1F_8000
Unimplemented
address range
0x1F_C000
Reserved (read only)
6 KB
NVM IFR
256 Byte
Reserved
512 Byte
0x20_0000
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 35
1.7.2 Part ID registers Assignments
The Part ID registers is located in four 8-bit registers at addresses 0x0000-0x0003. The read-only value is
a unique ID for each revision of the chip. Table 1-5 shows the assigned Part ID register value.
1.8 Signal Description and Device Pinouts
This section describes signals that connect off-chip. It includes a pinout diagram, a table of signal
properties, and detailed discussion of signals. It is built from the signal description sections of the
individual IP blocks on the device.
1.8.1 Pin Assignment Overview
Table 1-6 provides a summary of which ports are available for 100-pin and 144-pin package option.
Table 1-5. Assigned IDs Numbers
Device Mask Set number Part ID
MC9S12ZVH128 0N65E 32’h01170000
MC9S12ZVH64 0N65E 32’h01170000
MC9S12ZVH128 1N65E 32’h01171000
MC9S12ZVH64 1N65E 32’h01171000
MC9S12ZVH128 2N65E 32’h01171100
MC9S12ZVH64 2N65E 32’h01171100
Table 1-6. Port Availability by Package Option
Port 144 LQFP 100 LQFP
Port AD PAD[7:0] PAD[3:0]
Port A PA[7:0] PA[7:2]
Port B PB[3:0] PB[3:0]
Port C PC[7:0] PC[5:4]
Port D PD[7:0] PD[7:3]
Port E PE[3:0] PE[3:0]
Port F PF[7:0] PF[7:0]
Port G PG[7:0] PG[7:0]
Port H PH[7:0] PH[3:0]
Port P PP[7:0] PP[1,3,5,7]
Port S PS[7:0] PS[7:0]
Port T PT[7:0] PT[7:6], PT[4:0]
Port U PU[7:0] PU[7:0]
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
36 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
To avoid current drawn from floating inputs, all non-bonded pins should be
configured as output or configured as input with a pull up or pull down
device enabled
1.8.2 Detailed Signal Descriptions
1.8.2.1 RESET — External Reset Signal
The RESET signal is an active low bidirectional control signal. It acts as an input to initialize the MCU to
a known start-up state, and an output when an internal MCU function causes a reset. The RESET pin has
an internal pull-up device.
1.8.2.2 TEST — Test Pin
This input only pin is reserved for factory test. This pin has an internal pull-down device.
NOTE
The TEST pin must be tied to ground in all applications.
1.8.2.3 MODC — Mode C Signal
The MODC signal is used as a MCU operating mode select during reset. The state of this signal is latched
to the MODC bit at the rising edge of RESET. The signal has an internal pull-up device.
1.8.2.4 PAD[7:0] / KWAD[7:0] — Port AD, Input Pins of ADC
PAD[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. The signals can be configured on per signal basis as
interrupt inputs with wake-up capability (KWAD[7:0]). These signals can have a pull-up or pull-down
device selected and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull devices are disabled.
1.8.2.5 PA[7:0] — Port A I/O Signals
PA[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull-down devices are enabled.
Port V PV[7:0]
sum of ports 104 72
Table 1-6. Port Availability by Package Option
Port 144 LQFP 100 LQFP
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 37
1.8.2.6 PB[3:0] — Port B I/O Signals
PB[3:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull-down devices are enabled.
1.8.2.7 PC[7:0] — Port C I/O Signals
PC[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull devices are disabled.
1.8.2.8 PD[7:0] — Port D I/O Signals
PD[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull-down devices are enabled.
1.8.2.9 PE[3:0] — Port E I/O Signals
PE[3:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull-down devices are enabled.
1.8.2.10 PF[7:0] — Port F I/O Signals
PF[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull-down devices are enabled.
1.8.2.11 PG[7:0] — Port G I/O Signals
PG[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull-down devices are enabled.
1.8.2.12 PH[7:0] — Port H I/O Signals
PH[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull-down devices are enabled.
1.8.2.13 PP[7:0] — Port P I/O Signals
PP[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull devices are disabled.
1.8.2.14 PS[7:0] / KWS[7:0] — Port S I/O signals
PS[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. The signals can be configured on per signal basis as
interrupt inputs with wake-up capability (KWS[7:0]). These signals can have a pull-up or pull-down
device selected and enabled on per signal basis. The signals can be configured on per signals basis as open
drain output. Out of reset the pull-up devices are enabled.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
38 Freescale Semiconductor
1.8.2.15 PT[7:0] / KWT[7:0] — Port T I/O signals
PT[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. The signals can be configured on per signal basis as
interrupt inputs with wake-up capability (KWT[7:0]). These signals can have a pull-up or pull-down
device selected and enabled on per signal basis. Out of reset the pull devices are disabled.
1.8.2.16 PU[7:0] — Port U I/O Signals
PU[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. They can have a slew rate enabled per signal basis also. Out of reset the
pull devices are disabled.
1.8.2.17 PV[7:0] — Port V I/O Signals
PV[7:0] are general-purpose input or output signals. They can have a pull-up or pull-down device selected
and enabled on per signal basis. They can have a slew rate enabled per signal basis also. Out of reset the
pull devices are disabled.
1.8.2.18 AN0_[7:0] — ADC0 Input Signals
AN0_[7:0] are the analog inputs of the Analog-to-Digital Converters.
1.8.2.19 VRH, VRL — ADC0 Reference Signals
VRH and VRL are the reference voltage input pins for the analog-to-digital converter.
1.8.2.20 SPI0 Signals
1.8.2.20.1 SS0 Signal
This signal is associated with the slave select SS functionality of the serial peripheral interface SPI0.
1.8.2.20.2 SCK0 Signal
This signal is associated with the serial clock SCK functionality of the serial peripheral interface SPI0.
1.8.2.20.3 MISO0 Signal
This signal is associated with the MISO functionality of the serial peripheral interface SPI0. This signal
acts as master input during master mode or as slave output during slave mode.
1.8.2.20.4 MOSI0 Signal
This signal is associated with the MOSI functionality of the serial peripheral interface SPI0. This signal
acts as master output during master mode or as slave input during slave mode
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 39
1.8.2.21 SCI[1:0] Signals
1.8.2.21.1 RXD[1:0] Signals
These signals are associated with the receive functionality of the serial communication interfaces
(SCI[1:0]).
1.8.2.21.2 TXD[1:0] Signals
These signals are associated with the transmit functionality of the serial communication interfaces
(SCI[1:0]).
1.8.2.22 CAN0 Signals
1.8.2.22.1 RXCAN0 Signal
This signal is associated with the receive functionality of the scalable controller area network controller
(MSCAN0).
1.8.2.22.2 TXCAN0 Signal
This signal is associated with the transmit functionality of the scalable controller area network controller
(MSCAN0).
1.8.2.23 Timer IOC0_[7:0] & IOC1_[7:0] Signals
The signals IOC0_[7:0] are associated with the input capture or output compare functionality of the timer
(TIM0) module.
The signals IOC1_[7:0] are associated with the input capture or output compare functionality of the timer
(TIM1) module.
1.8.2.24 PWM[7:0] Signals
The signals PWM[7:0] are associated with the PWM module digital channel outputs.
1.8.2.25 LCD Signals
1.8.2.25.1 FP[39:0] Signals
These signals are associated with the segment LCD frontplane driver output.
1.8.2.25.2 BP[3:0] Signals
These signals are associate the segment LCD backplane driver output.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
40 Freescale Semiconductor
1.8.2.26 RTC Signals
1.8.2.26.1 RTC_CAL Signal
The signal can be the RTC output clock CALCLK for external clock calibration or external 1HZ standard
clock input for on chip clock calibration.
1.8.2.27 SSG0 Signals
1.8.2.27.1 SGT0 Signals
The signal is from SSG0 output, it contain tone or tone mixed with amplitude digital output.
1.8.2.27.2 SGA0 Signals
The signal is from SSG0 output, it contain the amplitude digital output.
1.8.2.28 IIC0 Signals
1.8.2.28.1 SDA0 Signal
This signal is associated with the serial data pin of IIC0.
1.8.2.28.2 SCL0 Signal
This signal is associated with the serial clock pin of IIC0.
1.8.2.29 MC Signals
1.8.2.29.1 M0C0M, M0C0P, M0C1M and M0C1P Signals
These signal are associated with the high current PWM out pin for the motor driver.
1.8.2.29.2 M1C0M, M1C0P, M1C1M and M1C1P Signals
These signal are associated with the high current PWM out pin for the motor driver.
1.8.2.29.3 M2C0M, M2C0P, M2C1M and M2C1P Signals
These signal are associated with the high current PWM out pin for the motor driver.
1.8.2.29.4 M3C0M, M3C0P, M3C1M and M3C1P Signals
These signal are associated with the high current PWM out pin for the motor driver.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 41
1.8.2.30 SSD[3:0] Signals
1.8.2.30.1 M0COSM, M0COSP, M0SINM and M0SINP Signals
These signal are used to measure the back EMF to calib rate the pointer reset position which are associated
with SSD[0].
1.8.2.30.2 M1COSM, M1COSP, M1SINM and M1SINP Signals
These signal are used to measure the back EMF to calib rate the pointer reset position which are associated
with SSD[1].
1.8.2.30.3 M2COSM, M2COSP, M2SINM and M2SINP Signals
These signal are used to measure the back EMF to calib rate the pointer reset position which are associated
with SSD[2].
1.8.2.30.4 M3COSM, M3COSP, M3SINM and M3SINP Signals
These signal are used to measure the back EMF to calib rate the pointer reset position which are associated
with SSD[3].
1.8.2.31 Interrupt Signals — IRQ and XIRQ
IRQ is a maskable level or falling edge sensitive input. XIRQ is a non-maskable level-sensitive interrupt.
1.8.2.32 Oscillator and Clock Signals
1.8.2.32.1 4-20MHZ main Oscillator Pins — EXTAL and XTAL
EXT AL and XTAL are the crystal driver . On reset, the OSC is not enabled, all the device clocks are derived
from the internal reference clock. EXTAL is the oscillator input. XTAL is the oscillator output.
1.8.2.32.2 32.768KHZ Oscillator Pins — 32K_EXTAL and 32K_XTAL
32K_EXTAL and 32K_XTAL are the 32.768KHZ crystal driver. On reset the OSC is not enabled.
32K_EXTAL is the oscillator input. 32K_XTAL is the oscillator output. Figure 1-3 is the 32K OSC
connection diagram. Refer to the Appendix T able L-1., “OSC32K DC Electrical Specifications for the Cx,
Cy and RF requirement. Both R TC and LCD clock source can from the 32K OSC. The OSC enable control
is from the RTC. If the RTCCTL2’s CLKSRC is set, then it will enable the 32K OSC. After enable the
OSC, it needs to wait enough time before enable the RTC and LCD. Refer to Appendix Table L-2.,
“OSC32K Frequency Specifications for the startup time requirement.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
42 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 1-3. 32K OSC Crystal/Resonator Connection
1.8.2.32.3 API_EXTCLK
This signal is associated with the output of the API.
1.8.2.32.4 ECLK
This signal is associated with the output of the divided bus clock (ECLK).
NOTE
This feature is only intended for debug purposes at room temperature.
It must not be used for clocking external devices in an application.
1.8.2.33 BDC and Debug Signals
1.8.2.33.1 BKGD — Background Debug signal
The BKGD signal is used as a pseudo-open-drain signal for the background debug communication. The
BKGD signal has an internal pull-up device.
1.8.2.33.2 PDO — Profiling Data Output
This is the profiling data output signal used when the DBG module profiling feature is enabled. This signal
is output only and provides a serial, encoded data stream that can be used by external development tools
to reconstruct the internal CPU code flow.
32K OSC
32K_XTAL 32K_EXTAL
CxCy
Crystal or Resonator
RF
Rs
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 43
1.8.2.33.3 PDOCLK — Profiling Data Output Clock
This is the PDO clock signal used when the DBG module profiling feature is enabled. This signal is output
only. During code profiling this is the clock signal that can be used by external development tools to
sample the PDO signal.
1.8.2.33.4 DBGEEV — External Event Input
This signal is the DBG external event input. It is input only. W ithin the DBG module, it allows an external
event to force a state sequencer transition, or trace buffer entry, or to gate trace buffer entries. A falling
edge at the external event signal constitutes an event. Rising edges have no effect. The maximum
frequency of events is half the internal core bus frequency.
1.8.2.34 CAN Physical Layer Signals(CANPHY0)
1.8.2.34.1 CANH0 — CAN Bus High Pin0
The CANH0 signal either connects directly to CAN bus high line or through an optional external common
mode choke.
1.8.2.34.2 CANL0 — CAN Bus Low Pin0
The CANL0 signal either connects directly to CAN bus low line or through an optional external common
mode choke.
1.8.2.34.3 SPLIT0 — CAN Bus Termination Pin0
The SPLIT0 pin can drive a 2.5 V bias for bus termination purpose (CAN bus middle point). Usage of this
pin is optional and depends on bus termination strategy for a given bus network.
1.8.2.34.4 CPTXD0
This is the CAN physical layer transmitter input signal.
1.8.2.34.5 CPRXD0
This is the CAN physical layer receiver output signal.
1.8.3 VSENSE - Voltage Sensor Input
This pin can be connected to the supply (Battery) line for voltage measurements. The voltage present at
this input is scaled down by an internal voltage divider , and can be routed to the internal ADC via an analog
multiplexer . The pin itself is protected against reverse battery connections. T o protect the pin from external
fast transients an external resistor is needed.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
44 Freescale Semiconductor
1.8.4 BCTLC
BCTLC provides the base current of an external bipolar that supplies an external or internal CAN physical
interface.
1.8.5 VDDC
This is connect to the output voltage of the external bipolar . It is the feed back pin to the MCU also. When
VDDC is not used, it must be shorted with VDDX and user must keep the EXTCON in CPMUVREGCTL
be enabled.
1.8.6 BCTL
BCTL provides the base current of an external bipolar of the VDDM, VDDA and VDDX supplies.
1.8.7 Power Supply Pins
The power and ground pins are described below. Because fast signal transitions place high, short-duration
current demands on the power supply , use bypass capacitors with high-frequency characteristics and place
them as close to the MCU as possible.
NOTE
All ground pins must be connected together in the application.
1.8.7.1 VDDX1, VDDX2, VDDX3, VSSX1, VSSX2, VSSX3 — Digit al I/O Power and
Ground Pins
VDDX1 is a dedicated voltage regulator output for the digital I/O drivers. It must be connected externally
to the VDDX2 and VDDX3 pin, which supplies the VDDX domain pads. The VSSX1, VSSX2 and
VSSX3 pins are the ground pin for the digital I/O drivers.
Bypass requirements on VDDX1/VSSX1, VDDX2/VSSX2 and VDDX3/VSSX3 depend on how heavily
the MCU pins are loaded.
1.8.7.2 VDDA, VSSA — External Power Supply Pins for ADC and VREG
These are the power supply and ground pins for the analog-to-digital converter and the voltage regulator.
1.8.7.3 VDDM1, VDDM2, VSSM1, VSSM2 — External Power Supply Pins for
Motor PAD
These are the power supply and ground pins for the motor driver pads. It should be supply by external
power transistor.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 45
1.8.7.4 VLCD- Power Supply Reference Pin for LCD driver
VLCD is the voltage reference pin for the LCD driver. Adjusting the voltage on this pin will change the
display contrast.
1.8.7.5 VDD, VSS2 — Core Power and Ground Pin
The VDD voltage supply of nominally 1.8V is generated by the internal voltage regulator. The return
current path is through the VSS2 pin.
1.8.7.6 VDDF, VSS1 — NVM Power and Ground Pin
The VDDF voltage supply of nominally 2.8V is generated by the internal voltage regulator. The return
current path is through the VSS1 pin.
1.8.7.7 VSSC — CANPHY0 Ground Pin
VSSC is the ground pin for the CAN physical layer CANPHY0.
1.8.7.8 VSUP — Voltage Supply Pin for Voltage Regulator
VSUP is the 12V/18V supply voltage pin for the on chip voltage regulator . This is the voltage supply input
from which the voltage regulator generates the on chip voltage supplies. It must be protected externally
against a reverse battery connection.
1.9 Package and Pinouts
The MC9S12ZVH-Family will be offered in 100 pin and 144 pin LQFP packages.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
46 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 1-4. MC9S12ZVH-Family 144-pin LQFP pin out 1 2
1. signal with () means that this is an alternative ro uting option location for this signal.
2. signal with bold means that it is avaialbe on 144 pin only
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
108
107
106
105
104
103
102
101
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
144
143
142
141
140
139
138
137
136
135
134
133
132
131
130
129
128
127
126
125
124
123
122
121
120
119
118
117
116
115
114
113
112
111
110
109
FP26 / PG2
FP25 / PG1
FP24 / PG0
VLCD
FP23 / PF7
KWT7 / IOC1_7 / PT7
NC
NC
M0COSM / M0C0M / IOC0_0 / PU0
M0COSP / M0C0P / PU1
M0SINM / M0C1M / IOC0_1 / PU2
M0SINP / M0C1P / PU3
VDDM1
VSSM1
M1COSM / M1C0M / IOC0_2 / PU4
M1COSP / M1C0P / PU5
M1SINM / M1C1M / IOC0_3 / PU6
M1SINP / M1C1P / PU7
M2COSM / M2C0M / IO C0_4 / PV0
M2COSP / M2C0P / PV1
M2SINM / M2C1M / ICO0_5 / PV2
M2SINP / M2C1P / PV3
VDDM2
VSSM2
M3COSM / M3C0M / IO C0_6 / PV4
M3COSP / M3C0P / PV5
M3SINM / M3C1M / IOC0_7 / PV6
M3SINP / M3C1P / PV7
NC
NC
KWT6 / IOC1_6 / ECLK / PT6
FP22 / PF6
FP21 / PF5
FP20 / PF4
FP19 / PF3
FP18 / PF2
BKGD / MODC
PC7 / TXD1
PC6 / RXD1
PC5 / SGA0
PC4 / SGT0
PT4 / PDO / IOC1_4 / KWT4
PT3 / PDOCLK / IOC1_3 / KWT3
PT2 / DBGEEV / IOC1_2 / KWT2
PT1 / RTC_CAL / IOC1_1 / KWT1
PT0 / API_EXTCLK / IOC1_0 / KWT0
VSSX2
VDDX2
PS7 / TXD0 / IRQ / KWS7
PS6 / RXD0 / XIRQ / KWS6
PS5 / (TXCAN0) / SDA0 / KWS5
PS4 / (RXCAN0) / SCL0 / KWS4
PS3 / SS0 / KWS3
PS2 / SCK0 / KWS2
PS1 / MOSI0 / KWS1
PS0 / MISO0 / KWS0
BCTLC
BCTL
VSENSE
NC
NC
SPLIT0
NC
CANL0
NC
VSSC
NC
CANH0
NC
VDDC
NC
VSUP
FP17 / PF1
FP16 / PF0
FP15 / PD7
FP14 / PD6
FP13 / PD5
FP12 / PD4
FP11 / PD3
FP10 / PD2
FP9 / PD1
FP8 / PD0
FP7 / (PWM6) / PA7
FP6 / (PWM4) / PA6
FP5 / (PWM2) / PA5
FP4 / (PWM0) / PA4
FP3 / (SDA0) / PA3
FP2 / (SCL0) / PA2
FP1 / PA1
FP0 / PA0
TEST
PWM1 / PP1
PWM3 / PP3
(RXD1) / PWM5 / PP5
(TXD1) / PWM7 / PP7
VSS1
VDDF
RXCAN0 / PC0
TXCAN0 / PC1
CPRXD0 / PC2
CPTXD0 / PC3
RESET
EXTAL / PE0
XTAL / PE1
VSSX1
VDDX1
PWM6 / PP6
KWT5 / IOC1_5 / PT5
PG3 / FP27
PG4 / FP28
PG5 / FP29
PG6 / FP30
PG7 / FP31
PH0 / FP32
PH1 / FP33
PH2 / FP34
PH3 / FP35
PH4 / FP36
PH5 / FP37
PH6 / FP38
PH7 / FP39
VSSX3
VDDX3
PB0 / BP0
PB1 / BP1
PB2 / BP2
PB3 / BP3
PP4 / PWM4
PP2 / PWM2
PP0 / PWM0
VDD
VSS2
PE3 / 32K_XTAL
PE2 / 32K_EXTAL
VSSA / VRL
VDDA / VRH
PAD7 / AN0_7 / KWAD7
PAD6 / AN0_6 / KWAD6
PAD5 / AN0_5 / KWAD5
PAD4 / AN0_4 / KWAD4
PAD3 / AN0_3 / KWAD3
PAD2 / AN0_2 / KWAD2
PAD1 / AN0_1 / KWAD1
PAD0 / AN0_0 / KWAD0
144 LQFP
Top view
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 47
Figure 1-5. MC9S12ZVH-Family 100-pin LQFP pin out 1
1. signal with () means that this is an alternative ro uting option location for this signal.
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
1 2 PG2 FP26 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
2 3 PG1 FP25 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
FP27 / PG3
FP26 / PG2
FP25 / PG1
FP24 / PG0
VLCD
FP23 / PF7
KWT7 / IOC1_7 / PT7
M0COSM / M0C0M / IOC0_0 / PU0
M0COSP / M0C0P / PU1
M0SINM / M0C1M / IOC0_1 / PU2
M0SINP / M0C1P / PU3
VDDM1
VSSM1
M1COSM / M1C0M / IOC0_2 / PU4
M1COSP / M1C0P / PU5
M1SINM / M1C1M / IOC0_3 / PU6
M1SINP / M1C1P / PU7
NC
NC
KWT6 / IOC1_6 / ECLK / PT6
FP22 / PF6
FP21 / PF5
FP20 / PF4
FP19 / PF3
FP18 / PF2
BKGD / MODC
PC5 / SGA0
PC4 / SGT0
PT4 / PDO / IOC1_4 / KWT4
PT3 / PDOCLK / IOC1_3 / KWT3
PT2 / DBGEEV / IOC1_2 / KWT2
PT1 / RTC_CAL / IOC1_1 / KWT1
PT0 / API_EXTCLK / IOC1_0 / KWT0
VSSX2
VDDX2
PS7 / TXD0 / IRQ / KWS7
PS6 / RXD0 / XIRQ / KWS6
PS5 / (TXCAN0) / SDA0 / KWS5
PS4 / (RXCAN0) / SCL0 / KWS4
PS3 / SS0 / KWS3
PS2 / SCK0 / KWS2
PS1 / MOSI0 / KWS1
PS0 / MISO0 / KWS0
BCTLC
BCTL
VSENSE
VSSC
VDDC
NC
VSUP
FP17 / PF1
FP16 / PF0
FP15 / PD7
FP14 / PD6
FP13 / PD5
FP12 / PD4
FP11 / PD3
FP7 / (PWM6) / PA7
FP6 / (PWM4) / PA6
FP5 / (PWM2) / PA5
FP4 / (PWM0) / PA4
FP3 / (SDA0) / PA3
FP2 / (SCL0) / PA2
TEST
PWM1 / PP1
PWM3 / PP3
(RXD1) / PWM5 / PP5
(TXD1) / PWM7 / PP7
VSS1
VDDF
RESET
EXTAL / PE0
XTAL / PE1
VSSX1
VDDX1
PG4 / FP28
PG5 / FP29
PG6 / FP30
PG7 / FP31
PH0 / FP32
PH1 / FP33
PH2 / FP34
PH3 / FP35
PH4 / FP36
VSSX3
VDDX3
PB0 / BP0
PB1 / BP1
PB2 / BP2
PB3 / BP3
VDD
VSS2
PE3 / 32K_XTAL
PE2 / 32K_EXTAL
VSSA / VRL
VDDA / VRH
PAD3 / AN0_3 / KWAD3
PAD2 / AN0_2 / KWAD2
PAD1 / AN0_1 / KWAD1
PAD0 / AN0_0 / KWAD0
100 LQFP
Top view
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
48 Freescale Semiconductor
3 4 PG0 FP24 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
4 5 VLCD VDDX
5 6 PF7 FP23 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
6 7 PT7 IOC1_7 KWT7 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
7—
8—
9 8 PU0 IOC0_0 M0C0M M0COSM VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
10 9 PU1 M0C0P M0COSP VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
11 10 PU2 IOC0_1 M0C1M M0SINM VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
12 11 PU3 M0C1P M0SINP VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
13 12 VDDM1
14 13 VSSM1 VDDM
15 14 PU4 IOC0_2 M1C0M M1COSM VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
16 15 PU5 M1C0P M1COSP VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
17 16 PU6 IOC0_3 M1C1M M1SINM VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
18 17 PU7 M1C1P M1SINP VDDM PERU/
PPSU
Disabled
19 PV0 IOC0_4 M2C0M M2COSM VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
20 PV1 M2C0P M2COSP VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
21 PV2 IOC0_5 M2C1M M2SINM VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
22 PV3 M2C1P M2SINP VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 49
23 VDDM2
24 VSSM2 VDDM
25 PV4 IOC0_6 M3C0M M3COSM VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
26 PV5 M3C0P M3COSP VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
27 PV6 IOC0_7 M3C1M M3SINM VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
28 PV7 M3C1P M3SINP VDDM PER V/
PPSV
Disabled
29 18
30 19
31 20 PT6 ECLK IOC1_6 KWT6 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
32 21 PF6 FP22 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
33 22 PF5 FP21 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
34 23 PF4 FP20 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
35 24 PF3 FP19 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
36 25 PF2 FP18 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
37 26 PF1 FP17 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
38 27 PF0 FP16 VDDX PERF/
PPSF
Pull
Down
39 28 PD7 FP15 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
40 29 PD6 FP14 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
41 30 PD5 FP13 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
50 Freescale Semiconductor
42 31 PD4 FP12 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
43 32 PD3 FP11 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
44 PD2 FP10 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
45 PD1 FP9 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
46 PD0 FP8 VDDX PERD/
PPSD
Pull
Down
47 33 PA7 (PWM6) FP7 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
48 34 PA6 (PWM4) FP6 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
49 35 PA5 (PWM2) FP5 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
50 36 PA4 (PWM0) FP4 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
51 37 PA3 (SDA0) FP3 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
52 38 PA2 (SCL0) FP2 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
53 PA1 FP1 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
54 PA0 FP0 VDDX PERA/
PPSA
Pull
Down
55 39 TEST VDDX
56 40 PP1 PWM1 VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
57 41 PP3 PWM3 VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
58 42 PP5 PWM5 (RXD1) VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
59 43 PP7 PWM7 (TXD1) VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
60 44 VSS1
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 51
61 45 VDDF VDDF ——
62 PC0 RXCAN0 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
63 PC1 TXCAN0 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
64 PC2 CPRXD0 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
65 PC3 CPTXD0 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
66 46 RESET VDDX TEST pin Pull Up
67 47 PE0 EXTAL VDDX PERE/
PPSE
Pull
Down
68 48 PE1 XTAL VDDX PERE/
PPSE
Pull
Down
69 49 VSSX1
70 50 VDDX1 VDDX ——
71 PP6 PWM6 VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
72 PT5 IOC1_5 KWT5 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
73 51 VSUP VSUP ——
74 52
75 53 VDDC
76
77 CANH0
78
79 54 VSSC
80
81 CANL0
82
83 SPLIT0
84
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
52 Freescale Semiconductor
85
86 55 VSENS
E
—— ——
87 56 BCTL
88 57 BCTLC
89 58 PS0 MISO0 KWS0 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
90 59 PS1 MOSI0 KWS1 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
91 60 PS2 SCK0 KWS2 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
92 61 PS3 SS0KWS3 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
93 62 PS4 (RXCAN
0)
SCL0 KWS4 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
94 63 PS5 (TXCAN
0)
SDA0 KWS5 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
95 64 PS6 RXD0 XIRQ KWS6 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
96 65 PS7 TXD0 IRQ KWS7 VDDX PERS/
PPSS
Pull Up
97 66 VDDX2 VDDX ——
98 67 VSSX2
99 68 PT0 API_EXT
CLK
IOC1_0 KWT0 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
100 69 PT1 RTC_CA
L
IOC1_1 KWT1 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
101 70 PT2 DBGEEV IOC1_2 KWT2 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
102 71 PT3 PDOCLK IOC1_3 KWT3 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
103 72 PT4 PDO IOC1_4 KWT2 VDDX PERT/
PPST
Disabled
104 73 PC4 SGT0 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 53
105 74 PC5 SGA0 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
106 PC6 RXD1 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
107 PC7 TXD1 VDDX PERC/
PPSC
Disabled
108 75 BKGD MODC VDDA Pull Up
109 76 PAD0 AN0_0 KWAD0 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
110 77 PAD1 AN0_1 KWAD1 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
111 78 PAD2 AN0_2 KWAD2 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
112 79 PAD3 AN0_3 KWAD3 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
113 PAD4 AN0_4 KWAD4 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
114 PAD5 AN0_5 KWAD5 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
115 PAD6 AN0_6 KWAD6 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
116 PAD7 AN0_7 KWAD7 VDDA PER1AD/
PPS1AD
Disabled
117 80 VDDA VDDA ——
118 81 VSSA
119 82 PE2 32K_EX
TAL
———V
DDX PERE/
PPSE
Pull
Down
120 83 PE3 32K_XT
AL
———V
DDX PERE/
PPSE
Pull
Down
121 84 VSS2
122 85 VDD VDD ——
123 PP0 PWM0 VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
124 PP2 PWM2 VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
54 Freescale Semiconductor
125 PP4 PWM4 VDDX PERP/
PPSP
Disabled
126 86 PB3 BP3 VDDX PERB/
PPSB
Pull
Down
127 87 PB2 BP2 VDDX PERB/
PPSB
Pull
Down
128 88 PB1 BP1 VDDX PERB/
PPSB
Pull
Down
129 89 PB0 BP0 VDDX PERB/
PPSB
Pull
Down
130 90 VDDX3 VDDX ——
131 91 VSSX3
132 PH7 FP39 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
133 PH6 FP38 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
134 PH5 FP37 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
135 92 PH4 FP36 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
136 93 PH3 FP35 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
137 94 PH2 FP34 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
138 95 PH1 FP33 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
139 96 PH0 FP32 VDDX PERH/
PPSH
Pull
Down
140 97 PG7 FP31 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
141 98 PG6 FP30 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
142 99 PG5 FP29 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
143 100 PG4 FP28 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 55
1.10 Modes of Operation
The MCU can operate in different modes. These are described in 1.10.1 Chip Configuration Modes.
The MCU can operate in different power modes to facilitate power saving when full system performance
is not required. These are described in 1.10.3 Low Power Modes.
Some modules feature a software programmable option to freeze the module status whilst the background
debug module is active to facilitate debugging. This is referred to as freeze mode at module level.
1.10.1 Chip Configuration Modes
The different modes and the security state of the MCU affect the debug features (enabled or disabled).
The operating mode out of reset is determined by the state of the MODC signal during reset (Table 1-8).
The MODC bit in the MODE register shows the current operating mode and provides limited mode
switching during operation. The state of the MODC signal is latched into this bit on the rising edge of
RESET
1.10.1.1 Normal Single-Chip Mode
This mode is intended for normal device operation. The opcode from the on-chip memory is being
executed after reset (requires the reset vector to be programmed correctly). The processor program is
executed from internal memory.
1.10.1.2 Special Single-Chip Mode
This mode is used for debugging operation, boot-strapping, or security related operations. The background
debug mode BDM is active on leaving reset in this mode.
144 1 PG3 FP27 VDDX PERG/
PPSG
Pull
Down
Table 1-8. Chip Modes
Chip Modes MODC
Normal single chip 1
Special single chip 0
Table 1-7. Pin Summary
LQFP
Option Function Power
Supply
Internal Pull
Resistor
144 100 Pin 1st
Func. 2nd
Func. 3rd
Func. 4th
Func. 5th
Func. CTRL Reset
State
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
56 Freescale Semiconductor
1.10.2 Debugging Modes
The background debug mode (BDM) can be activated by the BDC module or directly when resetting into
Special Single-Chip mode. Detailed information can be found in the BDC module section.
Writing to internal memory locations using the debugger, whilst code is running or at a breakpoint, can
change the flow of application code.
The MC9S12ZVH-Family supports BDC communication throughout the device Stop mode. During Stop
mode, writes to control registers can alter the operation and lead to unexpected results. It is thus
recommended not to reconfigure the peripherals during STOP using the debugger.
1.10.3 Low Power Modes
The device has two dynamic-power modes (run and wait) and two static low-power modes stop and pseudo
stop). For a detailed description refer to Chapter 7, “S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit
(S12CPMU_UHV_V6)“ .
Dynamic power mode: Run
Run mode is the main full performance operating mode with the entire device clocked. The user
can configure the device operating speed through selection of the clock source and the phase
locked loop (PLL) frequency. To save power, unused peripherals must not be enabled.
Dynamic power mode: Wait
This mode is entered when the CPU executes the WAI instruction. In this mode the CPU does
not execute instructions. The internal CPU clock is switched of f. All peripherals can be active
in system wait mode. For further power consumption reduction, the peripherals can
individually turn off their local clocks. Asserting RESET, XIR Q, IRQ, or any other interrupt
that is not masked ends system wait mode.
Static power mode Pseudo-stop:
In this mode the system clocks are stopped but the oscillator is still running and the real time
interrupt (RTI), watchdog (COP), RTC, LCD and Autonomous Periodic Interrupt (API) may
be enabled. Other peripherals are turned off. This mode consumes more current than system
STOP mode but, as the oscillator continues to run, the full speed wake up time from this mode
is significantly shorter.
Static power mode: Stop
The oscillator is stopped in this mode. By default, all clocks are switched off and all counters
and dividers remain frozen. The Autonomous Periodic Interrupt (API), Key Wake-Up, RTC,
CAN and the CAN physical layer transceiver modules may be enabled to wake the device.
If the BDC is enabled in Stop mode, the VREG remains in full performance mode and the
CPMU continues operation as in run mode. With BDC enabled and BDCCIS bit set, then all
clocks remain active to allow BDC access to internal peripherals. If the BDC is enabled and
BDCCIS is clear, then the BDCSI clock remains active, but bus and core clocks are disabled.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 57
With the BDC enabled during Stop, the VREG full performance mode and clock activity lead
to higher current consumption than with BDC disabled
If the BDC is enabled in Stop mode, then the voltage monitoring remains enabled.
1.11 Security
The MCU security mechanism prevents unauthorized access to the flash memory. It must be emphasized
that part of the security must lie with the application code. An extreme example would be application code
that dumps the contents of the internal memory. This would defeat the purpose of security. Also, if an
application has the capability of downloading code through a serial port and then executing that code (e.g.
an application containing bootloader code), then this capability could potentially be used to read the
EEPROM and Flash memory contents even when the microcontroller is in the secure state. In this
example, the security of the application could be enhanced by requiring a response authentication before
any code can be downloaded.
Device security details are also described in the 21.5 Security.
1.11.1 Features
The security features of the S12Z chip family are:
Prevent external access of the non-volatile memories (Flash, EEPROM) content
Restrict execution of NVM commands
Prevent BDC access of internal resources
1.11.2 Securing the Microcontroller
The chip can be secured by programming the security bits located in the options/security byte in the Flash
memory array. These non-volatile bits keep the device secured through reset and power-down.
This byte can be erased and programmed like any other Flash location. Two bits of this byte are used for
security (SEC[1:0]). The contents of this byte are copied into the Flash security register (FSEC) during a
reset sequence.
The meaning of the security bits SEC[1:0] is shown in Table 1-9. For security reasons, the state of device
security is controlled by tw o bits. To put the device in unsecured mode, these bits must be programmed to
SEC[1:0] = ‘10’. All other combinations put the device in a secured mode. The recommended value to put
the device in secured state is the inverse of the unsecured state, i.e. SEC[1:0] = ‘01’.
Table 1-9. Security Bits
SEC[1:0] Security State
00 1 (secured)
01 1 (secured)
10 0 (unsecure d)
11 1 (secured)
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
58 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
Please refer to the 21.5 Security for more security byte details.
1.11.3 Operation of the Secured Microcontroller
By securing the device, unauthorized access to the EEPROM and Flash memory contents is prevented.
Secured operation has the following effects on the microcontroller:
1.11.3.1 Normal Single Chip Mode (NS)
Background Debug Controller (BDC) operation is completely disabled.
Execution of Flash and EEPROM commands is restricted (described in flash block description).
1.11.3.2 Special Single Chip Mode (SS)
Background Debug Controller (BDC) commands are restricted
Execution of Flash and EEPROM commands is restricted (described in flash block description).
In special single chip mode the device is in active BDM after reset. In special single chip mode on a secure
device, only the BDC mass erase and BDC control and status register commands are possible. BDC access
to memory mapped resources is disabled. The BDC can only be used to erase the EEPROM and Flash
memory without giving access to their contents.
1.11 .4 Unsecuring the Microcontro ller
Unsecuring the microcontroller can be done using three different methods:
1. Backdoor key access
2. Reprogramming the security bits
3. Complete memory erase
1.11.4.1 Unsecuring the MCU Using the Backdoor Key Access
In normal single chip mode, security can be temporarily disabled using the backdoor key access method.
This method requires that:
The backdoor key has been programmed to a valid value.
The KEYEN[1:0] bits within the Flash options/security byte select ‘enabled’.
The application program programmed into the microcontroller has the capability to write to the
backdoor key locations.
The backdoor key values themselves would not normally be stored within the application data, which
means the application program would have to be designed to receive the backdoor key values from an
external source (e.g. through a serial port).
The backdoor key access method allows debugging of a secured microcontroller without having to erase
the Flash. This is particularly useful for failure analysis.
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 59
NOTE
No word backdoor key word is allowed to have the value 0x0000 or
0xFFFF.
1.11.5 Reprogramming the Security Bits
In normal single chip mode, security can also be disabled by erasing and reprogramming the security bits
within Flash options/security byte to the unsecured value. Because the erase operation will erase the entire
sector from (0xFF_FE00–0xFF_FFFF), the backdoor key and the interrupt vectors will also be erased; this
method is not recommended for normal single chip mode. The application software can only erase and
program the Flash options/security byte if the Flash sector containing the Flash options/security byte is not
protected (see Flash protection). Thus Flash protection is a useful means of preventing this method. The
microcontroller will enter the unsecured state after the next reset following the programming of the
security bits to the unsecured value.
This method requires that:
The application software previously programmed into the microcontroller has been designed to
have the capability to erase and program the Flash options/security byte.
The Flash sector containing the Flash options/security byte is not protected.
1.11.6 Complete Memory Erase
The microcontroller can be unsecured by erasing the entire EEPROM and Flash memory contents. If
ERASE_FLASH is successfully completed, then the Flash unsecures the device and programs the security
byte automatically.
1.12 Resets and Interrupts
1.12.1 Resets
Table 1-10. lists all reset sources and the vector locations. Resets are explained in detail in the Chapter 7,
“S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)“.
Table 1-10. Reset Sources and Vector Locations
Vector Address Reset Source CCR
Mask Local Enable
0xFFFFFC Power-On Reset (POR) None None
Low Voltage Reset (LVR) None None
External pin RESET None None
Clock monitor reset None CPMUOSC[OSCE]
COP watchdog reset None CR[2:0] in CPMUCOP register
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
60 Freescale Semiconductor
1.12.2 Interrupt Vectors
Table 1-11 lists all interrupt sources and vectors in the default order of priority. The interrupt module
description provides an Interrupt Vector Base register (IVBR) to relocate the vectors.
Table 1-11. Interrupt Vector Locations (Sheet 1 of 3)
Vector Address(1) Interrupt Source CCR
Mask Local Enable Wake up
from STOP Wake up
from WAIT
Vector base + 0x1F8 Unimplemented page1 op-code trap
(SPARE)
None None - -
Vector base + 0x1F4 Unimplemented page2 op-code trap
(TRAP)
None None - -
Vector base + 0x1F0 Software interrupt instruction (SWI) None None - -
Vector base + 0x1EC System call interrupt instruction
(SYS)
None None - -
Vector base + 0x1E8 Machine exception None None - -
Vector base + 0x1E4 Reserved
Vector base + 0x1E0 Reserved
Vector base + 0x1DC Spurious interrupt None - -
Vector base + 0x1D8 XIRQ interrupt request X bit None Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x1D4 IRQ interrupt request I bit IRQCR(IRQEN) Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x1D0 RTI time-out interrupt I bit CPMUINT (RTIE) See CPMU
section
Yes
Vector base + 0x1CC TIM0 timer channel 0 I bit TIM0TIE (C0I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1C8 TIM0 timer channel 1 I bit TIM0TIE (C1I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1C4 TIM0 timer channel 2 I bit TIM0TIE (C2I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1C0 TIM0 timer channel 3 I bit TIM0TIE (C3I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1BC TIM0 timer channel 4 I bit TIM0TIE (C4I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1B8 TIM0 timer channel 5 I bit TIM0TIE (C5I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1B4 TIM0 timer channel 6 I bit TIM0TIE (C6I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1B0 TIM0 timer channel 7 I bit TIM0TIE (C7I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1AC TIM0 timer overflow I bit TIM0TSCR2(TOI) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1A8 TIM0 Pulse accumulator A overflow I bit TIM0PACTL(PAOVI) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1A4 TIM0 Pulse accumulator input edge I bit TIM0PACTL(PAI) No Yes
Vector base + 0x1A0 SPI0 I bit SPI0CR1 (SPIE, SPTIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x19C SCI0 I bit SCI0CR2 Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x198 SCI1 I bit SCI1CR2 Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x194 Reserved
Vector base + 0x190 Reserved
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 61
Vector base + 0x18C ADC0 Error I bit ADC0EIE(IA_EIE,CMD_EIE,
EOL_EIE,TRIG_EIE,RSTAR_
EIE,LDOK_EIE)
ADC0IE(CONIF_OIE)
No Yes
Vector base + 0x188 ADC0 conversion sequence abort I bit ADC0IE(SEQAR_IE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x184 ADC0 conversion complete I bit ADC0CONIE[15:0] No Yes
Vector base + 0x180 Oscillator status interrupt I bit CPMUINT (OSCIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x17C PLL lock interrupt I bit CPMUINT (LOCKIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x178
to
Vector base + 0x174
Reserved
Vector base + 0x170 RAM error I bit ECCIE (SBEEIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x16C
to
Vector base + 0x168
Reserved
Vector base + 0x164 FLASH error I bit FERCNFG (SFDIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x160 FLASH command I bit FCNFG (CCIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x15C CAN0 wake-up I bit CAN0RIER (WUPIE) Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x158 CAN0 errors I bit CAN0RIER (CSCIE, OVRIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x154 CAN0 receive I bit CAN0RIER (RXFIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x150 CAN0 transmit I bit CAN0RIER (TXEIE[2:0]) No Yes
Vector base + 0x14C
to
Vector base + 0x144
Reserved
Vector base + 0x140 BATS supply voltage monitor interrupt I bit BATIE (BVHIE,BVLIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x13C
to
Vector base + 0x130
Reserved
Vector base + 0x12C Port T interrupt I bit PIET(PIET[7:0]) Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x128 CANPHY0 Interrupt (CP0I) I bit CP0IE(CPVFIE, CPOCIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x124 Port S interrupt I bit PIES(PIES[7:0]) Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x120
to
Vector base + 0x108
Reserved
Vector base + 0x104 Low-voltage interrupt (LVI) I bit CPMUCTRL (LVIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x100 Autonomous periodical interrupt
(API) I bit CPMUAPICTRL (APIE) Yes Yes
Vector base + 0xFC High temperature interrupt I bit CPMUHTCTL(HTIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0xF8 Reserved
Table 1-11. Interrupt Vector Locations (Sheet 2 of 3)
Vector Address(1) Interrupt Source CCR
Mask Local Enable Wake up
from STOP Wake up
from WAIT
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
62 Freescale Semiconductor
1.12.3 Effects of Reset
When a reset occurs, MCU registers and control bits are initialized. For RTC block, some registers are
power on reset only. Refer to the respective block sections for register reset states.
Vector base + 0xF4 Port AD interrupt I bit PIEADL(PIEADL[7:0]) Yes Yes
Vector base + 0xF0
to
Vector base + 0xB8
Reserved
Vector base + 0xB4 IIC I bit IIC0IBCR(IBIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0xB0 Reserved
Vector base + 0xAC TIM1 timer channel 0 I bit TIM1TIE (C0I) No Yes
Vector base + 0xA8 TIM1 timer channel 1 I bit TIM1TIE (C1I) No Yes
Vector base + 0xA4 TIM1 timer channel 2 I bit TIM1TIE (C2I) No Yes
Vector base + 0xA0 TIM1 timer channel 3 I bit TIM1TIE (C3I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x9C TIM1 timer channel 4 I bit TIM1TIE (C4I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x98 TIM1 timer channel 5 I bit TIM1TIE (C5I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x94 TIM1 timer channel 6 I bit TIM1TIE (C6I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x90 TIM1 timer channel 7 I bit TIM1TIE (C7I) No Yes
Vector base + 0x8C TIM1 timer overflow I bit TIM1TSCR2(TOI) No Yes
Vector base + 0x88 TIM1 Pulse accumulator A overflow I bit TIM1PACTL(PAOVI) No Yes
Vector base + 0x84 TIM1 Pulse accumulator input edge I bit TIM1PACTL(PAI) No Yes
Vector base + 0x80
to
Vector base + 0x7C
Reserved
Vector base + 0x78 Motor Control Timer Overflow I bit MCCTL1(MCOCIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x74 SSD0 I bit MDC0CTL(MCZIE,AOVIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x70 SSD1 I bit MDC1CTL(MCZIE,AOVIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x6C SSD2 I bit MDC2CTL(MCZIE,AOVIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x68 SSD3 I bit MDC3CTL(MCZIE,AOVIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x64 RTC I bit RTCCTL4(HRIE,MINIE,SECI
E,COMPIE,TB0IE)
Yes Yes
Vector base + 0x60 SSG0 Ready For Next Data(RNDI) I bit SSG0IE(RNDIE) No Yes
Vector base + 0x5C
to
Vector base + 0x10
Reserved
1. 15 bits vector address based
Table 1-11. Interrupt Vector Locations (Sheet 3 of 3)
Vector Address(1) Interrupt Source CCR
Mask Local Enable Wake up
from STOP Wake up
from WAIT
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 63
On each reset, the Flash module executes a reset sequence to load Flash configuration registers
1.12.3.1 Flash Configuration Reset Sequence Phase
On each reset, the Flash module will hold CPU activity while loading Flash module registers from the
Flash memory. If double faults are detected in the reset phase, Flash module protection and security may
be active on leaving reset. This is explained in more detail in 21.6 Initialization.
1.12.3.2 Reset While Flash Command Active
If a reset occurs while any Flash command is in progress, that command will be immediately aborted. The
state of the word being programmed or the sector/block being erased is not guaranteed.
1.12.3.3 I/O Pins
Refer to Chapter 2, “Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)“ for reset configurati ons of all peripheral
module ports.
1.12.3.4 RAM
The system RAM arrays, including their ECC syndromes, are initialized following a power on reset, but
not out of warm reset. All other RAM arrays are not initialized out of any type of reset.
W ith the exception of resets resulting from low voltage conditions, the RAM content is unaltered by a reset
occurrence.
1.13 COP Configuration
The COP time-out rate bits CR[2:0] and the WCOP bit in the CPMUCOP register are loaded from the
Flash configuration field byte at global address 0xFF_FE0E during the reset sequence. See Table 1-12 and
Table 1-13 for coding
Table 1-12. Initial COP Rate Configuration
NV[2:0] in
FOPT Register CR[2:0] in
COPCTL Register
000 111
001 110
010 101
011 100
100 011
101 010
110 001
111 000
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
64 Freescale Semiconductor
1.14 ADC0 Internal Channels
Table 1-14 lists the internal sources which are connected to these special conversion channels.
1.15 The ADC0 VRH/VRL
The ADC0 offers two possible sources for both reference voltages VRH[1:0] and VRL[1:0]. On the
MC9S12ZVH-Family only VRH[1], VRL[1] sources are connected at device level(to VDDA, VSSA
respectively), the VRH[0], VRL[0] sources are not connected. Thus the application must set both
VRH_SEL and VRL_SEL in the 10.4.2.16 ADC Command Register 1 (ADCCMD_1) to 1.
1.16 The ADC0 Conversion Resolution
The MC9S12ZVH-Family only support 10 and 8 bit conversion resolution, although ADC block guide still
has 12 bit related descrition.
Table 1-13. Initial WCOP Configuration
NV[3] in
FOPT Register WCOP in
COPCTL Register
10
01
Table 1-14. ADC0 Channel Assignment
ADC0CMD_1 CH_SEL[5:0]
[5][4][3][2][1][0] Analog Input
Channel Usage
0 0 1 0 0 0 Internal_0 ADC temperature sensor
0 0 1 0 0 1 Internal_1 Bandgap Voltage VBG or
Vreg temperature sensor
VHT(see Chapter 7, “S12
Clock, Reset and Power
Management Unit
(S12CPMU_UHV_V6) on how
to config)
0 0 1 0 1 0 Internal_2 RESERVED
0 0 1 0 1 1 Internal_3 RESERVED
0 0 1 1 0 0 Internal_4 VSENSE or VSUP
selectable in BATS
module
0 0 1 1 0 1 Internal_5 RESERVED
0 0 1 1 1 0 Internal_6 RESERVED
0 0 1 1 1 1 Internal_7 RESERVED
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 65
1.17 ADC Result Reference
MCUs of the MC9S12ZVH-Family are able to measure the internal reference voltage VBG(see Table 1-
14). VBG is a constant voltage with a narrow distribution over temperature and external voltage supply (see
Table I-1).
A 10-bit right justified ADC conversion result of VBG is provided at address 0x1F_C040/0x1F_C041 in
the NVM’s IFR for reference.The measurement conditions of the reference conversion are listed in
Section A.1.9, “ADC Conversion Result Reference“. By measuring the voltage VBG (see Table 1-14) and
comparing the result to the reference value in the IFR, it is possible to determine the ADC’s reference
voltage VRH in the application environment:
The exact absolute value of an analog conversion can be determined as follows:
With:
ConvertedADInput: Result of the analog to digital conversion of the desired pin
ConvertedReference: Result of channel “Internal_1” conversion
StoredReference: Value in IFR location 0x1F_C040/0x1F_C041
n: ADC resolution (10 bit)
1.18 BDC Clock Source Connectivity
The BDC clock, BDCCLK, is mapped to the IRCCLK generated in CPMU module. On 0N65E device, the
BDCFCLK is mapped to the Core clock. On 1N65E device, the BDCFCLK is mapped to the bus clock.
1.19 FTMRZ Connectivity
The soc_erase_all_req input to the flash module is driven directly by a BDC erase flash request resulting
from the BDC ERASE_FLASH command.
The FTMRZ FCLKDIV register is forced to 0x05 by the BDC ERASE_FLASH command. This
configures the clock frequency correctly for the initial bus frequency on leaving reset. The bus frequency
must not be changed before launching the ERASE_FLASH command.
1.20 RTC Clock Source
The RTC has three clock source, the 32K OSC, main OSC, refer to 18.4.2 RTC Control Register 2
(RTCCTL2) for more information. On 1N65E device, it also has IRC clock source. When select main
VRH StoredReference
ConvertedReference
-------------------------------------------------------5V=
Result ConvertedADInput StoredReference 5V
ConvertedReference 2n
------------------------------------------------------------------=
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12ZVH-Family
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
66 Freescale Semiconductor
OSC, user need to config the registers in CPMU block, refer to Chapter 7, “S12 Clock, Reset and Power
Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)“ for more detailed information. And main OSC will be stop if
silicon enter full stop mode. On 1N65E device, if the clock source is from IRC, it will be stop if silicon
enter stop mode.
1.21 LCD Clock Source Connectivity
The LCD’s clock is connected to the RTC’s RTCCLK output.User need to set the RTCCTL2[RTCPS] to
get the expect RTCCLK frequency if it uses the main OSC as clock source. Refer to 18.4.2 RTC Control
Register 2 (RTCCTL2) for more information.
1.22 32K OSC enable control
The 32K OSC enable is controlled by the RTCCTL2[CLKSRC] in 18.4.2 RTC Control Register 2
(RTCCTL2). Setting it to 1 enable the 32K OSC. Setting it to 1 also selects the 32K OSC as the LCD and
RTC clock source. RTCCTL2 is write one time only in NSC mode, once enable the 32K OSC, it will be
not able to switch off.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 67
Chapter 2
Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
Revision History
2.1 Introduction
2.1.1 Overview
The S12ZVH-family port integration module establishes the interface between the peripheral modules and
the I/O pins for all ports. It controls the electrical pin properties as well as the signal prioritization and
multiplexing on shared pins.
This document covers:
8-pin port A associated with the LCD FP[7:0] and rerouting of PWM0, PWM2, PWM4, PWM6
channels and rerouting of IIC
4-pin port B associated with the LCD BP[3:0]
8-pin port C associated with MSCAN0, SCI1, SSG0 and CANPHY0’s CPTXD0&CPRXD0
8-pin port D associated with LCD FP[15:8]
4-pin port E associated with the external 4-20MHZ oscillator and 32.768KHZ oscillator
8-pin port F associated with LCD FP[23:16]
8-pin port G associated with LCD FP[31:24]
8-pin port H associated with LCD FP[39:32]
8-pin port P associated with 8 PWM channels; associated with the rerouting SCI1 function also.
8-pin port S associated with SCI0, IIC0, SPI0 modules and rerouting of MSCAN0. PS7 and PS6
also associated with IRQ, XIRQ interrupt inputs; associated with the key wakeup functions also
8-pin port T with the key wakeup function and 8 TIM1 channels, also associated with
API_EXTCLK
Rev. No.
(Item No.) Date (Submitted
By) Sections
Affected Substantial Change(s)
V00.01 18 Mar 2011 Initial Version
V00.09 18 Mar 2012 update the MODRR0 related description
V00.10 12 Oct 2012 fix typos, add XIRQ function explain
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
68 Freescale Semiconductor
DBG external signals PDO, PDOCLK and DBGEEV
ECLK output
8-pin port AD associated with 8 ADC0 channels; associated with the key wakeup function also
8-pin port U associated with SSD0, SSD1, 2 Motor controls and 4 TIM0 channels
8-pin port V associated with SSD2, SSD3 , 2 Motor controls and 4 TIM0 channels
Most I/O pins can be configured by register bits to select data direction and to enable and select pullup or
pulldown devices.
NOTE
This document assumes the availability of all features (144-pin package
option). Some functions are not available on lower pin count package
options. Refer to the pin-out summary in the SOC Guide.
2.1.2 Features
The PIM includes these distinctive registers:
Data registers and data direction registers for ports A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, T, S, P, AD, U and V
when used as general-purpose I/O
Control registers to enable pull devices and select pullups/pulldowns on ports A, B, C, D, E, F, G,
H, T, S, P, AD, U and V
Single control register bit to enable pullups on BKGD pin
Control register to enable open-drain (wired-or) mode on port S and port A (only PA3, PA2)
Control register to enable digital input buffers on port AD
Control register to enable the slew rate control on Port U and V
Interrupt flag register for pin interrupts on port S, T and AD
Control register to configure IRQ pin operation
Control register to enable ECLK output
Control register to enable the RTC_CAL input or output
Routing registers to support signal relocation on external pins and control internal routings:
IIC0 to alternative pins
SCI1 to alternative pins
Various CAN0-CANPHY0 routing options supporting standalone use and conformance testing
MSCAN0 to alternative pins
PWM0, PWM2, PWM4, PWM6 to alternative pins
rerouting the RTC_CAL to TIM1 channel
rerouting the RXD0 and RXD1 to TIM1 channel for the baud rate detection
A standard port pin has the following minimum features:
Input/output selection
5V output drive
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 69
5V digital and analog input
Input with selectable pullup or pulldown device
Optional features supported on dedicated pins:
Open drain for wired-or connections
Interrupt input with glitch filtering
Slew rate control on motor pads
2.2 External Signal Description
This section lists and describes the signals that do connect off-chip.
Table 2-1 shows all pins with the pins and functions that are controlled by the PIM. Routing options are
denoted in parenthesis.
NOTE
If there is more than one function associated with a pin, the output priority
is indicated by the position in the table from top (highest priority) to bottom
(lowest priority).
Table 2-1. Pin Functions and Priorities
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
- BKGD MODC(2) I MODC input during RESET BKGD
BKGD I/O S12ZBDC communication
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
70 Freescale Semiconductor
A PA7 FP7 O LCD FP7 signal GPIO
(PWM6) O PWM channel 6 PWM6RR
PTA[7] I/O General-purpose
PA6 FP6 O LCD FP6 signal
(PWM4) O PWM channel 4 PWM4RR
PTA[6] I/O General-purpose
PA5 FP5 O LCD FP5 signal
(PWM2) O PWM channel 2 PWM2RR
PTA[5] I/O General-purpose
PA4 FP4 O LCD FP4 signal
(PWM0) O PWM channel 0 PWM6RR
PTA[4] I/O General-purpose
PA3 FP3 O LCD FP3 signal
(SDA0) I/O SDA of IIC0 signal IIC0RR
PTA[3] I/O General-purpose
PA2 FP2 O LCD FP2 signal
(SCL0) I/O SCL of IIC0 signal IIC0RR
PTA[2] I/O General-purpose
PA1 FP1 O LCD FP1 signal
PTA[1] I/O General-purpose
PA0 FP0 O LCD FP0 signal
PTA[0] I/O General-purpose
B PB3 BP3 O LCD BP3 signals GPIO
PTB[3] I/O General-purpose
PB2 BP2 O LCD BP2 signal
PTB[2] I/O General-purpose
PB1 BP1 O LCD BP1 signal
PTB[1] I/O General-purpose
PB0 BP0 O LCD BP0 signal
PTB[0] I/O General-purpose
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 71
C PC7 TXD1 O TXD of SCI1 GPIO
PTC[7] I/O General-purpose
PC6 RXD1 I RXD of SCI1
PTC[6] I/O General-purpose
PC5 SGA0 O SGA of SSG0
PTC[5] I/O General-purpose
PC4 SGT0 O SGT of SSG0
PTC[4] I/O General-purpose
PC3 CPTXD0 I TXD of CANPHY0 C0CP0RR3-0
PTC[3] I/O General-purpose
PC2 CPRXD0 O RXD of CANPHY0 C0CP0RR3-0
PTC[2] I/O General-purpose
PC1 TXCAN0 O TX of MSCAN0 C0CP0RR3-0
PTC[1] I/O General-purpose
PC0 RXCAN0 I RX of MSCAN0 C0CP0RR3-0
PTC[0] I/O General-purpose
D PD7 FP15 O LCD FP15 signal GPIO
PTD[7] I/O General-purpose
PD6 FP14 O LCD FP14 signal
PTD[6] I/O General-purpose
PD5 FP13 O LCD FP13 signal
PTD[5] I/O General-purpose
PD4 FP12 O LCD FP12 signal
PTD[4] I/O General-purpose
PD3 FP11 O LCD FP11 signal
PTD[3] I/O General-purpose
PD2 FP10 O LCD FP10 signal
PTD[2] I/O General-purpose
PD1 FP9 O LCD FP9 signal
PTD[1] I/O General-purpose
PD0 FP8 O LCD FP8 signal
PTD[0] I/O General-purpose
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
72 Freescale Semiconductor
E
PE3 32K_XTAL - 32K OSC signal
GPIO
PTE[3] I/O General-purpose
PE2 32K_EXTAL - 32K OSC signal
PTE[2] I/O General-purpose
PE1 XTAL - CPMU OSC signal
PTE[1] I/O General-purpose
PE0 EXTAL - CPMU OSC signal
PTE[0] I/O General-purpose
F PF7 FP23 O LCD FP23 signal GPIO
PTF[7] I/O General-purpose
PF6 FP22 O LCD FP22 signal
PTF[6] I/O General-purpose
PF5 FP21 O LCD FP21 signal
PTF[5] I/O General-purpose
PF4 FP20 O LCD FP20 signal
PTF[4] I/O General-purpose
PF3 FP19 O LCD FP19 signal
PTF[3] I/O General-purpose
PF2 FP18 O LCD FP18 signal
PTF[2] I/O General-purpose
PF1 FP17 O LCD FP17 signal
PTF[1] I/O General-purpose
PF0 FP16 O LCD FP16 signal
PTF[0] I/O General-purpose
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 73
G PG7 FP31 O LCD FP31 signal GPIO
PTG[7] I/O General-purpose
PG6 FP30 O LCD FP30 signal
PTG[6] I/O General-purpose
PG5 FP29 O LCD FP29 signal
PTG[5] I/O General-purpose
PG4 FP28 O LCD FP28 signal
PTG[4] I/O General-purpose
PG3 FP27 O LCD FP27 signal
PTG[3] I/O General-purpose
PG2 FP26 O LCD FP26 signal
PTG[2] I/O General-purpose
PG1 FP25 O LCD FP25 signal
PTG[1] I/O General-purpose
PG0 FP24 O LCD FP24 signal
PTG[0] I/O General-purpose
H PH7 FP39 O LCD FP39 signal GPIO
PTH[7] I/O General-purpose
PH6 FP38 O LCD FP38 signal
PTH[6] I/O General-purpose
PH5 FP37 O LCD FP37 signal
PTH[5] I/O General-purpose
PH4 FP36 O LCD FP36 signal
PTH[4] I/O General-purpose
PH3 FP35 O LCD FP35 signal
PTH[3] I/O General-purpose
PH2 FP34 O LCD FP34 signal
PTH[2] I/O General-purpose
PH1 FP33 O LCD FP33 signal
PTH[1] I/O General-purpose
PH0 FP32 O LCD FP32 signal
PTH[0] I/O General-purpose
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
74 Freescale Semiconductor
P PP7 (TXD1) O TXD of SCI1 SCI1RR GPIO
PWM7 O PWM channel 7
PP[7] I/O General-purpose
PP6 PWM6 O PWM channel 6
PP[6] I/O General-purpose
PP5 (RXD1) O RXD of SCI1 SCI1RR
PWM5 O PWM channel 5
PP[5] I/O General-purpose
PP4 PWM4 O PWM channel 4
PP[4] I/O General-purpose
PP3 PWM3 O PWM channel 3
PP[3] I/O General-purpose
PP2 PWM2 O PWM channel 2
PP[2] I/O General-purpose
PP1 PWM1 O PWM channel 1
PP[1] I/O General-purpose
PP0 PWM0 O PWM channel 0
PP[0] I/O General-purpose
S PS7 IRQ O IRQ interrupt input GPIO
TXD0 I/O TXD of SCI0
PTS[7]/KWS[7] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PS6 XIRQ O XIRQ interrupt input(3)
RXD0 I/O RXD of SCI0
PTS[6]/KWS[6] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PS5 SDA0 O SDA of IIC0
(TXCAN0) I/O TX of MSCAN0 C0CP0RR3-0
PTS[5]/KWS[5] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PS4 SCL0 O SCL of IIC0
(RXCAN) I/O RX of MSCAN0 C0CP0RR3-0
PTS[4]/KWS[4] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PS3 SS0 I/O SPI0 slave select
PTS[3]/KWS[3] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PS2 SCK0 I/O SPI0 serial clock
PTS[2]/KWS[2] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PS1 MOSI0 I/O SPI0 master out/slave in
PTS[1]/KWS[1] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PS0 MISO0 I/O SPI0 master in/slave out
PTS[0]/KWS[0] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 75
T PT7 IOC1_7 O TIM1 channel 7 GPIO
PTT[7]/KWT[7] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PT6 IOC1_6 I/O TIM1 channel 6
ECLK O Free running clock output
PTT[6]/KWT[6] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PT5 IOC1_5 I/O TIM1 channel 5
PTT[5]/KWT[5] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PT4 IOC1_4 I/O TIM1 channel 4
PDO O DBG profiling data output
PTT[4]/KWT[4] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PT3 IOC1_3 I/O TIM1 channel 3
PDOCLK O DBG profiling clock
PTT[3]/KWT[3] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PT2 IOC1_2 I/O TIM1 channel 2
DBGEEV I DBG external event input
PTT[2]/KWT[2] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PT1 IOC1_1 I/O TIM1 channel 1
RTC_CAL I/O RTC CALCLK output or external 1HZ input
PTT[1]/KWT[1] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PT0 (IOC1_0) I/O TIM1 channel 0 T1IC0RR1-0
API_EXTCLK O API clock output
PTT[0]/KWT[0] I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
76 Freescale Semiconductor
AD
PAD7 AN0_7 I ADC0 analog input 7
GPIO
PTADL[7]/
KWADL[7]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PAD6 AN0_6 I ADC0 analog input 6
PTADL[6]/
KWADL[6]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PAD5 AN0_5 I ADC0 analog input 5
PTADL[5]/
KWADL[5]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PAD4 AN0_4 I ADC0 analog input 4
PTADL[4]/
KWADL[4]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PAD3 AN0_3 I ADC0 analog input 3
PTADL[3]/
KWADL[3]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PAD2 AN0_2 I ADC0 analog input 2
PTADL[2]/
KWADL[2]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PAD1 AN0_1 I ADC0 analog input 1
PTADL[1]/
KWADL[1]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
PAD0 AN0_0 I ADC0 analog input 0
PTADL[0]/
KWADL[0]
I/O General-purpose; with interrupt and wakeup
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 77
U PU[7] M1SINP I/O SSD1 Sine+ Node GPIO
M1C1P O Motor control output for motor 1
PTU[7] I/O General purpose
PU[6] M1SINM I/O SSD1 Sine- Node
M1C1M O Motor control output for motor 1
IOC0_3 I/O TIM0 channel 3
PTU[6] I/O General purpose
PU[5] M1COSP I/O SSD1 Cosine+ Node
M1C0P O Motor control output for motor 1
PTU[5] I/O General purpose
PU[4] M1COSM I/O SSD1 Cosine- Node
M1C0M O Motor control output for motor 1
IOC0_2 I/O TIM0 channel2
PTU[4] I/O General purpose
PU[3] M0SINP I/O SSD0 Sine+ Node
M0C1P O Motor control output for motor 0
PTU[3] I/O General purpose
PU[2] M0SINM I/O SSD0 Sine- Node
M0C1M O Motor control output for motor 0
IOC0_1 I/O TIM0 channel 1
PTU[2] I/O General purpose
PU[1] M0COSP I/O SSD0 Cosine+ Node
M0C0P O Motor control output for motor 0
PTU[1] I/O General purpose
PU[0] M0COSM I/O SSD0 Cosine- Node
M0C0M O Motor control output for motor 0
IOC0_0 I/O TIM0 channel 0
PTU[0] I/O General purpose
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
78 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all port integration module registers.
V
PV[7] M3SINP I/O SSD3 Sine+ Node GPIO
M3C1P O Motor control output for motor 3
PTV[7] I/O General purpose
PV[6] M3SINM I/O SSD3 Sine- Node
M3C1M O Motor control output for motor 3
IOC0_7 I/O TIM0 channel 7
PTV[6] I/O General purpose
PV[5] M3COSP I/O SSD3 Cosine+ Node
M3C0P O Motor control output for motor 3
PTV[5] I/O General purpose
PV[4] M3COSM I/O SSD3 cosine- node
M3C0M O Motor control output for motor 3
IOC0_6 I/O TIM0 channel 6
PTV[4] I/O General purpose
PV3 M2SINP I/O SSD2 sine+ node
M2C1P O Motor control output for Motor 2
PTV[3] I/O General purpose
PV2 M2SINM I/O SSD2 sine- node
M2C1M O Motor control output for Motor 2
IOC0_5 I/O TIM0 channel 5
PTV[2] I/O General purpose
PV1 M2COSP I/O SSD2 cosine+ node
M2C0P O Motor control output for Motor 2
PTV[1] I/O General purpose
PV0 M2COSM I/O SSD2 cosine- node
M2C0M O Motor control output for Motor 2
IOC0_4 I/O TIM0 channel 4
PTV[0] I/O General purpose
1. Signals in parenthesis denote alternative module routing pins
2. Function active when RESET asserted.
3. The interrupt is enabled by clearing the X mask bit in the CPU CCR. The pin is forced to input upon first clearing of the X bit
and is held in this state until reset. A stop or wait recovery with the X bit set (refer to S12ZCPU reference manual) is not
available.
Port Pin Name Pin Function
& Priority(1) I/O Description Routing Register Pin
Function
after Reset
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 79
2.3.1 Register Map
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
0x0200 MODRR0 R0 0 0 0 C0CP0RR
3
C0CP0RR
2
C0CP0RR
1
C0CP0RR
0
W
0x0201 MODRR1 R0 0 0 0 PWM6RR PWM4RR PWM2RR PWM0RR
W
0x0202 MODRR2 R0 0 SCI1RR IIC0RR 00
T1IC0RR1 T1IC0RR0
W
0x0203–
0x0207 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0208 ECLKCTL RNECLK 0000000
W
0x0209 IRQCR RIRQE IRQEN 000000
W
0x020A PIMMISC R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CALCLKE
N
W
0x020B–
0x020D Reserved R00000000
W
0x020E Reserved RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x020F Reserved RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0210–
0x021F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0220 PTA RPTA7 PTA6 PTA5 PTA4 PTA3 PTA2 PTA1 PTA0
W
0x0221 PTB R0 0 0 0 PTB3 PTB2 PTB1 PTB0
W
0x0222 PTIA R PTIA7 PTIA6 PTIA5 PTIA4 PTIA3 PTIA2 PTIA1 PTIA0
W
0x0223 PTIB R 0 0 0 0 PTIB3 PTIB2 PTIB1 PTIB0
W
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
80 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0224 DDRA RDDRA7 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0
W
0x0225 DDRB R0 0 0 0 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0
W
0x0226 PERA RPERA7 PERA6 PERA5 PERA4 PERA3 PERA2 PERA1 PERA0
W
0x0227 PERB R0 0 0 0 PERB3 PERB2 PERB1 PERB0
W
0x0228 PPSA RPPSA7 PPSA6 PPSA5 PPSA4 PPSA3 PPSA2 PPSA1 PPSA0
W
0x0229 PPSB R0 0 0 0 PPSB3 PPSB2 PPSB1 PPSB0
W
0x022A–
0x023D Reserved R00000000
W
0x023E WOMA R0 0 0 0 WOMA3 WOMA2 00
W
0x023F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0240 PTC RPTC7 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1 PTC0
W
0x0241 PTD RPTD7 PTD6 PTD5 PTD4 PTD3 PTD2 PTD1 PTD0
W
0x0242 PTIC R PTIC7 PTIC6 PTIC5 PTIC4 PTIC3 PTIC2 PTIC1 PTIC0
W
0x0243 PTID R PTID7 PTID6 PTID5 PTID4 PTID3 PTID2 PTID1 PTID0
W
0x0244 DDRC RDDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0
W
0x0245 DDRD RDDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0
W
0x0246 PERC RPERC7 PERC6 PERC5 PERC4 PERC3 PERC2 PERC1 PERC0
W
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 81
0x0247 PERD RPERD7 PERD6 PERD5 PERD4 PERD3 PERD2 PERD1 PERD0
W
0x0248 PPSC RPPSC7 PPSC6 PPSC5 PPSC4 PPSC3 PPSC2 PPSC1 PPSC0
W
0x0249 PPSD RPPSD7 PPSD6 PPSD5 PPSD4 PPSD3 PPSD2 PPSD1 PPSD0
W
0x024A–
0x025F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0260 PTE R0 0 0 0 PTE3 PTE2 PTE1 PTE0
W
0x0261 PTF RPTF7 PTF6 PTF5 PTF4 PTF3 PTF2 PTF1 PTF0
W
0x0262 PTIE R 0 0 0 0 PTIE3 PTIE2 PTIE1 PTIE0
W
0x0263 PTIF R PTIF7 PTIF6 PTIF5 PTIF4 PTIF3 PTIF2 PTIF1 PTIF0
W
0x0264 DDRE R0 0 0 0 DDRE3 DDRE2 DDRE1 DDRE0
W
0x0265 DDRF RDDRF7 DDRF6 DDRF5 DDRF4 DDRF3 DDRF2 DDRF1 DDRF0
W
0x0266 PERE R0 0 0 0 PERE3 PERE2 PERE1 PERE0
W
0x0267 PERF RPERF7 PERF6 PERF5 PERF4 PERF3 PERF2 PERF1 PERF0
W
0x0268 PPSE R0 0 0 0 PPSE3 PPSE2 PPSE1 PPSE0
W
0x0269 PPSF RPPSF7 PPSF6 PPSF5 PPSF4 PPSF3 PPSF2 PPSF1 PPSF0
W
0x026A–
0x027F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0280 Reserved R00000000
W
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
82 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0281 PTADL RPTADL7 PTADL6 PTADL5 PTADL4 PTADL3 PTADL2 PTADL1 PTADL0
W
0x0282 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0283 PTIADL R PTIADL7 PTIADL6 PTIADL5 PTIADL4 PTIADL3 PTIADL2 PTIADL1 PTIADL0
W
0x0284 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0285 DDRADL RDDRADL7 DDRADL6 DDRADL5 DDRADL4 DDRADL3 DDRADL2 DDRADL1 DDRADL0
W
0x0286 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0287 PERADL RPERADL7 PERADL6 PERADL5 PERADL4 PERADL3 PERADL2 PERADL1 PERADL0
W
0x0288 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0289 PPSADL RPPSADL7 PPSADL6 PPSADL5 PPSADL4 PPSADL3 PPSADL2 PPSADL1 PPSADL0
W
0x028A–
0x028B Reserved R00000000
W
0x028C Reserved R00000000
W
0x028D PIEADL RPIEADL7 PIEADL6 PIEADL5 PIEADL4 PIEADL3 PIEADL2 PIEADL1 PIEADL0
W
0x028E Reserved R00000000
W
0x028F PIFADL RPIFADL7 PIFADL6 PIFADL5 PIFADL4 PIFADL3 PIFADL2 PIFADL1 PIFADL0
W
0x0290–
0x0298 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0299 DIENADL RDIENADL7 DIENADL6 DIENADL5 DIENADL4 DIENADL3 DIENADL2 DIENADL1 DIENADL0
W
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 83
0x029A–
0x02BF Reserved R00000000
W
0x02C0 PTT R PTT7 PTT6 PTT5 PTT4 PTT3 PTT2 PTT1 PTT0
W
0x02C1 PTIT R PTIT7 PTIT6 PTIT5 PTIT4 PTIT3 PTIT2 PTIT1 PTIT0
W
0x02C2 DDRT R DDRT7 DDRT6 DDRT5 DDRT4 DDRT3 DDRT2 DDRT1 DDRT0
W
0x02C3 PERT R PERT7 PERT6 PERT5 PERT4 PERT3 PERT2 PERT1 PERT0
W
0x02C4 PPST R PPST7 PPST6 PPST5 PPST4 PPST3 PPST2 PPST1 PPST0
W
0x02C5 Reserved R00000000
W
0x02C6 PIET RPIET7 PIET6 PIET5 PIET4 PIET3 PIET2 PIET1 PIET0
W
0x02C7 PIFT RPIFT7 PIFT6 PIFT5 PIFT4 PIFT3 PIFT2 PIFT1 PIFT0
W
0x02C8–
0x02CF Reserved R00000000
W
0x02D0 PTS RPTS7 PTS6 PTS5 PTS4 PTS3 PTS2 PTS1 PTS0
W
0x02D1 PTIS R PTIS7 PTIS6 PTIS5 PTIS4 PTIS3 PTIS2 PTIS1 PTIS0
W
0x02D2 DDRS RDDRS7 DDRS6 DDRS5 DDRS4 DDRS3 DDRS2 DDRS1 DDRS0
W
0x02D3 PERS RPERS7 PERS6 PERS5 PERS4 PERS3 PERS2 PERS1 PERS0
W
0x02D4 PPSS RPPSS7 PPSS6 PPSS5 PPSS4 PPSS3 PPSS2 PPSS1 PPSS0
W
0x02D5 Reserved R00000000
W
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
84 Freescale Semiconductor
0x02D6 PIES RPIES7 PIES6 PIES5 PIES4 PIES3 PIES2 PIES1 PIES0
W
0x02D7 PIFS RPIFS7 PIFS6 PIFS5 PIFS4 PIFS3 PIFS2 PIFS1 PIFS0
W
0x02D8–
0x02DE Reserved R00000000
W
0x02DF WOMS RWOMS7WOMS6WOMS5WOMS4WOMS3WOMS2WOMS1WOMS0
W
0x02E0–
0x02EF Reserved R00000000
W
0x02F0 PTP RPTP7 PTP6 PTP5 PTP4 PTP3 PTP2 PTP1 PTP0
W
0x02F1 PTIP R PTIP7 PTIP6 PTIP5 PTIP4 PTIP3 PTIP2 PTIP1 PTIP0
W
0x02F2 DDRP RDDRP7 DDRP6 DDRP5 DDRP4 DDRP3 DDRP2 DDRP1 DDRP0
W
0x02F3 PERP RPERP7 PERP6 PERP5 PERP4 PERP3 PERP2 PERP1 PERP0
W
0x02F4 PPSP RPPSP7 PPSP6 PPSP5 PPSP4 PPSP3 PPSP2 PPSP1 PPSP0
W
0x02F5–
0x02FF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0300 PTH RPTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3 PTH2 PTH1 PTH0
W
0x0301 PTIH R PTIH7 PTIH6 PTIH5 PTIH4 PTIH3 PTIH2 PTIH1 PTIH0
W
0x0302 DDRH RDDRH7 DDRH6 DDRH5 DDRH4 DDRH3 DDRH2 DDRH1 DDRH0
W
0x0303 PERH RPERH7 PERH6 PERH5 PERH4 PERH3 PERH2 PERH1 PERH0
W
0x0304 PPSH RPPSH7 PPSH6 PPSH5 PPSH4 PPSH3 PPSH2 PPSH1 PPSH0
W
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 85
0x0305–
0x030F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0310–
0x031F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0320 PTG RPTG7 PTG6 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1 PTG0
W
0x0321 PTIG RPTIG7 PTIG6 PTIG5 PTIG4 PTIG3 PTIG2 PTIG1 PTIG0
W
0x0322 DDRG RDDRG7 DDRG6 DDRG5 DDRG4 DDRG3 DDRG2 DDRG1 DDRG0
W
0x0323 PERG RPERG7 PERG6 PERG5 PERG4 PERG3 PERG2 PERG1 PERG0
W
0x0324 PPSG RPPSG7 PPSG6 PPSG5 PPSG4 PPSG3 PPSG2 PPSG1 PPSG0
W
0x0325–
0x032F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0350 PTU RPTU7 PTU6 PTU5 PTU4 PTU3 PTU2 PTU1 PTU0
W
0x0351 PTIU R PTIU7 PTIU6 PTIU5 PTIU4 PTIU3 PTIU2 PTIU1 PTIU0
W
0x0352 DDRU RDDRU7 DDRU6 DDRU5 DDRU4 DDRU3 DDRU2 DDRU1 DDRU0
W
0x0353 PERU RPERU7 PERU6 PERU5 PERU4 PERU3 PERU2 PERU1 PERU0
W
0x0354 PPSU RPPSU7 PPSU6 PPSU5 PPSU4 PPSU3 PPSU2 PPSU1 PPSU0
W
0x0355–
0x035D Reserved R00000000
W
0x035E SRRU RSRRU7 SRRU6 SRRU5 SRRU4 SRRU3 SRRU2 SRRU1 SRRU0
W
0x035F Reserved R00000000
W
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
86 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes the details of all configuration registers.
If not stated differently, writing to reserved bits has no effect and read returns zero.
All register read accesses are synchronous to internal clocks.
All registers can be written at any time, however a specific configuration might not become active.
E.g. a pullup device does not become active while the port is used as a push-pull output.
General-purpose data output availability depends on prioritization; input data registers always
reflect the pin status independent of the use.
Pull-device availability, pull-device polarity, wired-or mode, key-wake up functionality are
independent of the prioritization unless noted differently.
The description of registers PTx, PTIx, DDRx, DIENx, PERx, PPSx, SRRx, WOMx, PIEx and
PIFx generically assumes a fully implemented 8-bit register . For availability of individual bits refer
to Section 2.3.1, “Register Map”.
0x0360 PTV RPTV7 PTV6 PTV5 PTV4 PTV3 PTV2 PTV1 PTV0
W
0x0361 PTIV R PTIV7 PTIV6 PTIV5 PTIV4 PTIV3 PTIV2 PTIV1 PTIV0
W
0x0362 DDRV RDDRV7 DDRV6 DDRV5 DDRV4 DDRV3 DDRV2 DDRV1 DDRV0
W
0x0363 PERV RPERV7 PERV6 PERV5 PERV4 PERV3 PERV2 PERV1 PERV0
W
0x0364 PPSV RPPSV7 PPSV6 PPSV5 PPSV4 PPSV3 PPSV2 PPSV1 PPSV0
W
0x0365–
0x036D Reserved R00000000
W
0x036E SRRV RSRRV7 SRRV6 SRRV5 SRRV4 SRRV3 SRRV2 SRRV1 SRRV0
W
0x036F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0370–
0x037F Reserved R00000000
W
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 87
2.3.2.1 Module Routing Register 0 (MODRR0)
For routing options refer to Figure 2-2.
.
Table 2-3. Preferred Interface Configurations
Address 0x0200 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Once in normal, anytime in special mode
76543210
R0000
C0CP0RR3 C0CP0RR2 C0CP0RR1 C0CP0RR0
W
CAN0-CANPHY0 (see Figure 2-2)
Reset00000000
Figure 2-1. Module Routing Register 0 (MODRR0)
Table 2-2. Module Routing Register 0 Field Descriptions
Field Description
3
C0CP0RR3
Module Routing Register
When set to 1, the internal interface is visible on the alternate external pins.
2
C0CP0RR2
Module Routing Register
When set to 1, the internal interface is visible on external pins.
1
C0CP0RR1
Module Routing Register
When set to 1, the internal interface is opened and CPTXD0 and RXCAN0 are routed to external pins.
0
C0CP0RR0
Module Routing Register
When set to 1, CPTXD0 is driven by CANPHY0 internal register bit CPDR1.
C0CP0RR[3:0] Signal Routing Description
0 0 0 0 TXCAN0->CPTXD0
CPRXD0->RXCAN0
MSCAN0 connects to CANPHY0, interface internal
only
0 0 0 1 CPDR1->CPTXD0
CPRXD0->RXCAN0
CPDR1 connects to CPTXD0, interface internal only
0100 TXCAN0-
>CPTXD0,PC1
CPRXD0-
>RXCAN0,PC2
Probe mode, MCSAN0 connects to CANPHY0,
interface visible on 2 external pins
0110 TXCAN0->PC1
PC3->CPTXD0
CPRXD0->PC2
PC0->RXCAN0
Conformance test mode, interface opened and all 4
signals routed externally(1)
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
88 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 2-2. MSCAN0-CANPHY0 Routing Options Illustration
1110 TXCAN0->PS5
PC3->CPTXD0
CPRXD0->PC2
PS4->RXCAN0
Conformance test mode, interface opened and all 4
signals routed externally1
1. if CANPHY is not enabled, then PC3/PC2 will be controlled by other functio ns. The
configure can be use for standalone MSCAN connection.
C0CP0RR[3:0] Signal Routing Description
MSCAN0 CANPHY0
TXCAN0
RXCAN0
CPTXD0
CPRXD0
PC2/CPRXD0
PC3/CPTXD0
PC1/TXCAN0
PC0/RXCAN0
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
CPDR1
C0CP0RR0
SPLIT0
CANH0
CANL0
0
1
0
1PS5/(TXCAN0)
PS4/(RXCAN0)
C0CP0RR1
C0CP0RR2 C0CP0RR3
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 89
2.3.2.2 Module Routing Register 1 (MODRR1)
Address 0x0201 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Once in normal, anytime in special mode
76543210
R0000
PWM6RR PWM4RR PWM2RR PWM0RR
W
PWM6 PWM4 PWM2 PWM0
Reset00000000
Figure 2-3. Module Routing Register 1 (MODRR1)
Table 2-4. MODRR1 Routing Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
3
PWM6RR
Module Routing Register — PWM6 routing
PWM channel 6 can be configured for PP6 or PA7.
1 PWM6 to PA7
0 PWM6 to PP6
2
PWM4RR
Module Routing Register — PWM4 routing
PWM channel 4 can be configured for PP4 or PA6.
1 PWM4 to PA6
0 PWM4 to PP4
1
PWM2RR
Module Routing Register — PWM2 routing
PWM channel 2 can be configured for PP2 or PA5.
1 PWM2 to PA5
0 PWM2 to PP2
0
PWM0RR
Module Routing Register — PWM0 routing
PWM channel can be configured for PP0 or PA4.
1 PWM0 to PA4
0 PWM0 to PP0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
90 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2.3 Module Routing Register 2 (MODRR2)
Address 0x0202 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Once in normal, anytime in special mode
76543210
R0 0
SCI1RR IIC0RR
00
T1IC0RR1 T1IC0RR0
W
SCI1 IIC0 TI M1 IC0
Reset00000000
Figure 2-4. Module Routing Register 2 (MODRR2)
Table 2-5. MODRR2 Routing Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
5
SCI1RR
Module Routing Register — SCI1 routing
1 TXD1 on PP7; RXD1 on PP5
0 TXD1 on PC7; RXD1 on PC6
4
IIC0RR
Module Routing Register — IIC0 routing
1 SCL0 on PA2; SDA0 on PA3
0 SCL0 on PS4; SDA0 on PS5
1-0
T1IC0RR1-0
Module Routing Register — TIM1 IC0 routing
11 TIM1 input capture channel 0 is connected to RXD1
10 TIM1 input capture channel 0 is connected to RXD0
01 TIM1 input capture channel 0 is connected to RTC’s CALCLK
00 TIM1 input capture channel 0 is connected to PT0
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 91
2.3.2.4 ECLK Control Register (ECLKCTL)
2.3.2.5 IRQ Control Register (IRQCR)
Address 0x0208 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
NECLK
0000000
W
Reset:10000000
Figure 2-5. ECLK Control Register (ECLKCTL)
Table 2-6. ECLKCTL Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
NECLK
No ECLKDisable ECLK output
This bit controls the availability of a free-running clock on the ECLK pin. This clock has a fixed rate equivalent to the
internal bus clock.
1 ECLK disabled
0 ECLK enabled
Address 0x0209 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write:
IRQE: Once in normal mode, anytime in special mode
IR QEN: Anytime
76543210
R
IRQE IRQEN
000000
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-6. IRQ Control Register (IRQCR)
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
92 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2.6 PIM Miscellaneous Register (PIMMISC)
Table 2-7. IRQCR Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
IRQE
IRQ select edge sensitive only
1 IRQ pin configured to respond only to falling edges. Falling edges on the IRQ pin are detected anytime when
IRQE=1 and will be cleared only upon a reset or the servicing of the IRQ interrupt.
0 IRQ configured for low level recognition
6
IRQEN
IRQ enable
1 IRQ pin is connected to interrupt logic
0 IRQ pin is disconnected from interrupt logic
Address 0x020A Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write:Anytime
76543210
R0000000
CALCLKEN
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-7. PIM Miscellaneous Register (PIMMISC)
Table 2-8. PIM Miscellaneous Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
0
CALCLKE
N
RTC_CAL output Enable — Activate the RTC CALCLK output on PT1
1 CALCLK output on PT1 enabled
0 CALCLK output on PT1 disabled
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 93
2.3.2.7 Reserved Register PIM Test Register
2.3.2.8 Port C Polarity Select Register
Address 0x020E Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Only in special mode
These reserved registers are designed for factory test purposes only and are
not intended for general user access. Writing to these registers when in
special modes can alter the modules functionality
76543210
R
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Resetxxxxxxxx
Figure 2-8. Reserved Register
Address 0x020F Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Only in special mode
NOTE
These reserved registers are designed for factory test purposes only and are
not intended for general user access. Writing to these registers when in
special modes can alter the modules functionality
76543210
R
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Resetxxxxxxxx
Figure 2-9. Reserved Register
Address 0x0248 PPSC Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
PPSx7 PPSx6 PPSx5 PPSx4 PPSx3 PPSx2 PPSx1 PPSx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-10. Port C Polarity Select Register
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
94 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2.9 Port S Polarity Select Register
Table 2-9. Port C Polarity Select Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-1
PPSC
Pull Polarity Select Configure pull device on input pin
This bits select a pullup or a pulldown device if enabled on the associated port input pin.
1 pulldown device selected
0 pullup device selected
0
PPSC
Port P Pull Polarity Select — Configure pull device on input pin
This bit selects a pullup or a pulldown device if enabled on the associated port input pin.
If MSCAN0 is active and routing to this pin, a pullup device can be activated on the RXCAN0 input; attempting to
select a pulldown disables the pull-device.
1 pulldown device selected
0 pullup device selected
Address 0x02D4 PPSS Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
PPSx7 PPSx6 PPSx5 PPSx4 PPSx3 PPSx2 PPSx1 PPSx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-11. Port S Polarity Select Register
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 95
2.3.2.10 Port Data Register
Table 2-10. Port S Polarity Select Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-5
PPSS
Pull Polarity Select — Configure pull device and pin interrupt edge polarity on input pin
This bits select a pullup or a pulldown device if enabled on the associated port input pin.
1 pulldown device selected; rising edge selected
0 pullup device selected; falling edge selected
4
PPSS
Port P Pull Polarity Select — Configure pull device and pin interrupt edge polarity on input pin
This bit selects a pullup or a pulldown device if enabled on the associated port input pin.
If MSCAN0 is active and routing to this pin, a pullup device can be activated on the RXCAN0 input; attempting to
select a pulldown disables the pull-device.
1 pulldown device selected; rising edge selected
0 pullup device selected; falling edge selected
3-0
PPSS
Pull Polarity Select — Configure pull device and pin interrupt edge polarity on input pin
This bit selects a pullup or a pulldown device if enabled on the associated port input pin.
This bit also selects the polarity of the active interrupt edge.
1 pulldown device selected; rising edge selected
0 pullup device selected; falling edge selected
Address 0x0220 PTA
0x0221 PTB
0x0240 PTC
0x0241 PTD
0x0260 PTE
0x0261 PTF
0x0281 PTADL
0x02C0 PTT
0x02D0 PTS
0x02F0 PTP
0x0300 PTH
0x0320 PTG
0x0350 PTU
0x0360 PTV
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value.
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
PTx7 PTx6 PTx5 PTx4 PTx3 PTx2 PTx1 PTx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-12. Port Data Register
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
96 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2.11 Port Input Register
Table 2-11. Port Data Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
PTx
PortGeneral purp os e in pu t/output data
This register holds the value driven out to the pin if the pin is used as a general purpose output.
When not used with the alternative function (refer to Tab l e 2-1), these pins can be used as general purpose I/O.
If the associated data direction bits of these pins are set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register, otherwise
the buffered pin input state is read.
Address 0x0222 PTIA
0x0223 PTIB
0x0242 PTIC
0x0243 PTID
0x0262 PTIE
0x0263 PTIF
0x0283 PTIADL
0x02C1 PTIT
0x02D1 PTIS
0x02F1 PTIP
0x0301 PTIH
0x0321 PTIG
0x0351 PTIU
0x0361 PTIV
Access: User read only(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write:Never
76543210
R PTIx7 PTIx6 PTIx5 PTIx4 PTIx3 PTIx2 PTIx1 PTIx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-13. Port Input Register
Table 2-12. Port Input Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
PTIx
Port Input — Data input
A read always returns the buffered input state of the associated pin. It can be used to detect overload or short circuit
conditions on output pins.
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 97
2.3.2.12 Data Direction Register
NOTE
Due to internal synchronization circuits, it can take up to two bus clock
cycles until the correct value is read on port data and port input registers,
when changing the data direction register.
The general-purpose data direction configuration can be overruled by an enabled peripheral function
shared on the same pin (Table 2-22). If more then one peripheral function is available and enabled at the
same time, the highest ranked module according the predefined priority scheme in Table 2-1 will take
precedence on the pin.
Address 0x0224 DDRA
0x0225 DDRB
0x0244 DDRC
0x0245 DDRD
0x0264 DDRE
0x0265 DDRF
0x0285 DDRADL
0x02C2 DDRT
0x02D2 DDRS
0x02F2 DDRP
0x0302 DDRH
0x0322 DDRG
0x0352 DDRU
0x0362 DDRV
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
DDRx7 DDRx6 DDRx5 DDRx4 DDRx3 DDRx2 DDRx1 DDRx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-14. Data Direction Register
Table 2-13. Data Direction Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
DDRx
Data DirectionSelect general-purpose data direction
This bit determines whether the pin is a general-purpose input or output.
1 Associated pin is configured as output
0 Associated pin is configured as input
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
98 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2.13 Digital Input Enable Register
Address 0x0299 DIENADL Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
DIENx7 DIENx6 DIENx5 DIENx4 DIENx3 DIENx2 DIENx1 DIENx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-15. Digital Input Enable Register
Table 2-14. Digital Input Enable Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
DIENx
Digital Input Enable — Input buffer control
This bit controls the digital input function. If set to 1 the input buffers are enabled and the pin can be used with the
digital function. If the pin is used with an analog function this bit shall be cleared to avoid shoot-through current.
1 Associated pin is configured as digital input
0 Associated pin digital input is disabled
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 99
2.3.2.14 Pull Device Enable Register
Address 0x0226 PERA
0x0227 PERB
0x0246 PERC
0x0247 PERD
0x0266 PERE
0x0267 PERF
0x0287 PERADL
0x02C3 PERT
0x02D3 PERS
0x02F3 PERP
0x0303 PERH
0x0323 PERG
0x0353 PERU
0x0363 PERV
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
PERx7 PERx6 PERx5 PERx4 PERx3 PERx2 PERx1 PERx0
W
Reset
Ports B, E: 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1
Ports C, P T,
ADL, U, V: 00000000
Others:11111111
Figure 2-16. Pull Device Enable Register
Table 2-15. Pull Device Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
PERx
Pull Enable — Activate pull device on input pin
This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input or open-drain output pin is active. If a pin is used
as push-pull output this bit has no effect. The polarity is selected by the related polarity select register bit. On open-
drain output pins only a pullup device can be enabled.
1 Pull device enabled
0 Pull device disabled
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
100 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2.15 Polarity Select Register
Address 0x0228 PPSA
0x0229 PPSB
0x0248 PPSC
0x0249 PPSD
0x0268 PPSE
0x0269 PPSF
0x0289 PPSADL
0x02C4 PPST
0x02D4 PPSS
0x02F4 PPSP
0x0304 PPSH
0x0324 PPSG
0x0354 PPSU
0x0364 PPSV
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
PPSx7 PPSx6 PPSx5 PPSx4 PPSx3 PPSx2 PPSx1 PPSx0
W
Reset
Ports B, E:00001111
Ports A, D,
F, G, H : 11111111
Others:00000000
Figure 2-17. Polarity Select Register
Table 2-16. Polarity Select Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
PPSx
Pull Polarity Select — Configure pull device and pin interrupt edge polarity on input pin
This bit selects a pullup or a pulldown device if enabled on the associated port input pin.
If a port has interrupt functionality this bit also selects the polarity of the active edge.
If MSCAN0 is active a pullup device can be activated on the RXCAN0 input; attempting to select a pulldown disables
the pull-device.
1 Pulldown device selected; rising edge selected
0 Pullup device selected; falling edge selected
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 101
2.3.2.16 Wired-Or Mode Register
2.3.2.17 Port Interrupt Enable Register
Read: Anytime
Address 0x023E WOMA
0x02DF WOMS
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
WOMx7 WOMx6 WOMx5 WOMx4 WOMx3 WOMx2 WOMx1 WOMx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-18. Wired-Or Mode Register
Table 2-17. Wired- Or Mode Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
WOMx
Wired-Or Mode — Enable open-drain output
This bit configures the output pin as wired-or. If enabled the output is driven active low only (open-drain) while the
active high drive is turned off. This allows a multipoint connection of several serial modules. These bits have no
influence on pins used as inputs. Enable the IIC0, it will force the corresponding pins to be open drain output.
1 Output buffers operate as open-drain outputs
0 Output buffers operate as push-pull outputs
Address 0x02C6 PIET
0x02D6 PIES
0x028D PIEADL
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
PIEx7 PIEx6 PIEx5 PIEx4 PIEx3 PIEx2 PIEx1 PIEx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-19. Port Interrupt Enable Register
Table 2-18. Port Interrupt Enable Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
PIEx
Port Interrupt Enable — Activate pin interrupt
This bit enables or disables the edge sensitive pin interrupt on the associated pin. An interrupt can be generated if
the pin is operating in input or output mode when in use with the general-purpose or related peripheral function.
1 Interrupt is enabled
0 Interrupt is disabled (interrupt flag masked)
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
102 Freescale Semiconductor
2.3.2.18 Port Interrupt Flag Register
2.3.2.19 Port Slew Rate Register
Address 0x02C7 PIFT
0x02D7 PIFS
0x028F PIFADL
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
PIFx7 PIFx6 PIFx5 PIFx4 PIFx3 PIFx2 PIFx1 PIFx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-20. Port Interrupt Flag Register
Table 2-19. Port Interrupt Flag Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
PIFx
Port Interrupt Flag — Signal pin event
The flag asserts after a valid active edge was detected on the related pin (see Section 2.4.4, “Pin interrupts and
Wakeup”). This can be a rising or a falling edge based on the state of the polarity select register.
Writing a logic “1” to the corresponding bit field clears the flag.
1 Active edge on the associated bit has occurred (an interrupt will occur if the associated enable bit is set)
0 No active edge occurred
Address 0x035E SRRU
0x036E SRRV
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
SRRx7 SRRx6 SRRx5 SRRx4 SRRx3 SRRx2 SRRx1 SRRx0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-21. Port Slew Rate Register
Table 2-20. Port Interrupt Flag Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
SRRx
Port Slew Rate— Slew Rate control(1)
1 Enable the slew rate control and disable the digital input buffer
0 Disable the slew rate control and enable the digital input buffer
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 103
2.3.2.20 PIM Reserved Register
2.4 Functional Description
2.4.1 General
Each pin except BKGD can act as general-purpose I/O. In addition each pin can act as an output or input
of a peripheral module.
2.4.2 Registers
Table 2-21 lists the configuration registers which are available on each port. These registers except the pin
input registers can be written at any time, however a specific configuration might not become active.
For example selecting a pullup device: This device does not become active while the port is used as a push-
pull output.
1. When change SRRx from non-zero value to zero value or vice versa, It will need to wait about 300 nanoseconds delay
before the slew rate control to be real function as setting. When enter STOP, to save the power, the slew rate control will
be force to off state. After wakeup from STOP, it will also need to wait about 300 nanoseconds before slew rate control
to be function as setting. To enable the TIM0 ICx functions which shared with motor pads, the corresponding SRRx bit
should be set to zero.
Address (any reserved) Access: User read(1)
1. Read: Always reads 0x00
Write: Unimplemented
76543210
R00000000
W
Reset00000000
Figure 2-22. PIM Reserved Register
Table 2-21. Register availability per port(1)
Port Data Input Data
Direction Pull
Enable Polarity
Select Wired-
Or Mode
Slew
Rate
Enable
Interrupt
Enable Interrupt
Flag
A yes yes yes yes yes yes(2) ---
Byesyesyesyesyes----
Cyesyesyesyesyes----
Dyesyesyesyesyes----
Eyesyesyesyesyes----
Fyesyesyesyesyes----
Gyesyesyesyesyes----
Hyesyesyesyesyes----
Pyesyesyesyesyes----
S yes yes yes yes yes yes - yes yes
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
104 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 2-22 shows the effect of enabled peripheral features on I/O state and enabled pull devices.
T yes yes yes yes yes - - yes yes
AD yes yes yes yes yes - - yes yes
U yes yes yes yes yes - yes - -
V yes yes yes yes yes - yes - -
1. Each cell represents one register with individual configuration bits
2. Only PA3/PA2
Table 2-22. Effect of Enabled Features
Enabled
Feature Related Pin(s) Effect on
I/O state Effect on enabled
pull devic e
CPMU OSC EXTAL, XTAL CPMU takes control Forced off
32K OSC 32K_EXTAL,
32K_XTAL
OSC takes control Forced off
LCD FP[39:0], BP[3:0] LCD takes control Forced off
TIMx output compare IOCx Forced output Forced off
TIMx input capture IOCx None (DDR maintains control) None (PER/PPS maintain control)
SPIx MISO, MOSI, SCK, SS Controlled input/output Forced off if output
SCIx TXD Forced output Forced off
RXD Forced input None (PER/PPS maintain control)
CANx TXCAN Forced output Forced off
RXCAN Forced input Pulldown forced off
IICx SCL, SDA Controlled input/output Forced off if output
S12ZDBG PDO, PDOCLK Forced output Forced off
SSGx SGA, SGT Forced output Forced off
PWM channel PWMx Forced output Forced off
MC MxCxM, MxCxP Forced output Forced off
SSDx MxCOSM, MxCOSP,
MxSINM, MxSINP
Controlled input/output Forced off if output
API API_EXTCLK Forced output Forced off
ADCx ANx None (DDR maintains
control(1))
None (PER/PPS maintain control)
CANPHYx CPTXD Force input None (PER/PPS maintain control)
CPRXD Force output Forced off
Table 2-21. Register availability per port(1)
Port Data Input Data
Direction Pull
Enable Polarity
Select Wired-
Or Mode
Slew
Rate
Enable
Interrupt
Enable Interrupt
Flag
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 105
2.4.2.1 Data register (PTx)
This register holds the value driven out to the pin if the pin is used as a general-purpose I/O.
Writing to this register has only an effect on the pin if the pin is used as general-purpose output. When
reading this address, the synchronized state of the pin is returned if the associated data direction register
bits are configured as input.
If the data direction register bits are configured as output, the contents of the data register is returned. This
is independent of any other configuration (Figure 2-23).
2.4.2.2 Input register (PTIx)
This register is read-only and always returns the synchronized state of the pin (Figure 2-23).
2.4.2.3 Data direction register (DDRx)
This register defines whether the pin is used as an general-purpose input or an output.
If a peripheral module controls the pin the contents of the data direction register is ignored (Figure 2-23).
Independent of the pin usage with a peripheral module this register determines the source of data when
reading the associated data register address (Section 2.4.2.1, “Data register (PTx)”).
NOTE
Due to internal synchronization circuits, it can take up to 2 bus clock cycles
until the correct value is read on port data or port input registers, when
changing the data direction register.
1. To use the digital input function the related bit in Digital Input Enable Register (DIENADx) must be set to logic level
“1”. To use the digital input function the related bit in Slew Rate Register (SRRx) must be set to logic level “0”.
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
106 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 2-23. Illustration of I/O pin functionality
2.4.2.4 Pull device enable register (PERx)
This register turns on a pullup or pulldown device on the related pins determined by the associated polarity
select register (Section 2.4.2.5, “Polarity select register (PPSx)”).
The pull device becomes active only if the pin is used as an input or as a wired-or output. Some peripheral
module only allow certain configurations of pull devices to become active. Refer to the respective bit
descriptions.
2.4.2.5 Polarity select register (PPSx)
This register selects either a pullup or pulldown device if enabled.
It becomes only active if the pin is used as an input. A pullup device can be activated if the pin is used as
a wired-or output.
On pins with interrupt functionality this register selects the active edge polarity of the input signal.
2.4.2.6 Wired-or mode register (WOMx)
If the pin is used as an output this register turns off the active-high drive. This allows wired-or type
connections of outputs.
2.4.2.7 Interrupt enable register (PIEx)
If the pin is used as an interrupt input this register serves as a mask to the interrupt flag to enable/disable
the interrupt.
PT
DDR
output enable
module enable
1
0
1
1
0
0
PIN
PTI
data out
Module
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 107
2.4.2.8 Interrupt flag register (PIFx)
If the pin is used as an interrupt input this register holds the interrupt flag after a valid pin event.
2.4.2.9 Digital input enable register (DIENADx)
This register controls the digital input buf fer. If DIENADx is set to logic level “1”, then it will enable the
digital input buffer.
2.4.2.10 Slew rate register (SRRx)
This register selects the slew rate function on the motor pad. It also controls the digital input buffer. If
SRRx is set to logic level “1”, then it will disable the digital input buffer.
2.4.2.11 Module routing register (MODRRx)
Routing registers allow software re-configuration of specific peripheral inputs and outputs:
MODRR0 supports CAN0 rerouting as well as options to test the internal CAN0-CANPHY0
interface signals
MODRR1 supports PWM channel rerouting
MODRR2 supports TIM1IC0, IIC0 and SCI1 rerouting
2.4.3 Interrupts
This section describes the interrupts generated by the PIM and their individual sources. Vector addresses
and interrupt priorities are defined at MCU level.
2.4.3.1 XIRQ, IRQ Interrupts
The XIRQ pin allows requesting non-maskable interrupts after reset initialization. During reset, the X bit
in the condition code register is set and any interrupts are masked until software enables them.
The IRQ pin allows requesting asynchronous interrupts. The interrupt input is disabled out of reset. To
enable the interrupt the IRQCR[IRQEN] bit must be set and the I bit cleared in the condition code register.
The interrupt can be configured for level-sensitive or falling-edge-sensitive triggering. If IRQCR[IRQEN]
is cleared while an interrupt is pending, the request will deassert.
Table 2-23. PIM Interrupt Sources
Module Interrupt Sources Local Enable
XIRQ None
IRQ IRQCR[IRQEN]
Port S pin interrupt PIES[PIES7-PIES0]
Port T pin interrupt PIET[PIET7-PIET0]
Port AD pin interrupt PIEADL[PIEADL7-PIEADL0]
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
108 Freescale Semiconductor
Both interrupts are capable to wake-up the device from stop mode. Means for glitch filtering are not
provided on these pins.
2.4.4 Pin interrupts and Wakeup
Ports S, T and AD offer pin interrupt and key-wakeup capability . The related interrupt enable (PIE) as well
as the sensitivity to rising or falling edges (PPS) can be individually configured on per-pin basis. All
bits/pins in a port share the same interrupt vector . Interrupts can be used with the pins configured as inputs
or outputs.
An interrupt is generated when a bit in the port interrupt flag (PIF) and its corresponding port interrupt
enable (PIE) are both set. The pin interrupt feature is also capable to wake up the CPU when it is in stop
or wait mode(key-wakeup).
A digital filter on each pin prevents short pulses from generating an interrupt. A valid edge on an input is
detected if 4 consecutive samples of a passive level are followed by 4 consecutive samples of an active
level. Else the sampling logic is restarted.
In run and wait mode the filters are continuously clocked by the bus clock. Pulses with a duration of
tPULSE <n
P_MASK/fbus are assuredly filtered out while pulses with a duration of tPULSE >n
P_PASS/fbus
guarantee a pin interrupt.
In stop mode the filter clock is generated by an RC-oscillator. The minimum pulse length varies over
process conditions, temperature and voltage(Figure 2-24). Pulses with a duration of tPULSE < tP_MASK are
assuredly filtered out while pulses with a duration of tPULSE > tP_PASS guarantee a wakeup event.
Please refer to the appendix table “Pin Interrupt Characteristics” for pulse length limits.
To maximize current saving the RC oscillator is active only if the following condition is true on any
individual pin:
Sample count <= 4 (at active or passive level) and interrupt flag not set (PIF[x]=0).
Figure 2-24. Interrupt Glitch Filter (here: active low level selected)
Glitch, filtered out, no interrupt flag set
Valid pulse, interrupt flag set uncertain
tP_MASK tP_PASS
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 109
2.5 Initialization and Application Information
2.5.1 Port Data and Data Direction Register writes
It is not recommended to write PORTx/PTx and DDRx in a word access. When changing the register pins
from inputs to outputs, the data may have extra transitions during the write access. Initialize the port data
register before enabling the outputs.
2.5.2 SCI0,1 Baud Rate Detection
The baud rate for SCI0 and SCI1 is achieved by using a timer channel to measure the data rate on the RXD
pin.
1. Establish the link:
For SCI0: Set [T1IC0RR1:T1IC0RR0]=0b10 to disconnect IOC0 from TIM1 input capture
channel 0 and reroute the timer input from the RXD0 of SCI0.
For SCI1: Set [T1IC0RR1:T1IC0RR0]=0b11 to disconnect IOC0 from TIM1 input capture
channel 0 and reroute the timer input from the RXD1 of SCI1.
2. Determine pulse width of incoming data: Configure TIM1 IC0 to measure time between incoming
signal edges.
2.5.3 RTC on chip calibration
The on chip RTC calibration used the TIM1 IC0 and IC1 channel.
1. Establish the link:
Set the RTC configuration to generate the expect CALCLK frequency
Set [T1IC0RR1:T1IC0RR0]=0b10 to disconnect IOC0 from TIM1 input capture channel 0 and
reroute the RTC CALCLK to IC0.
Input a standard clock on RTC_CAL pin
2. Determine pulse width of incoming data: Configure TIM1 IC0 and IC1 to measure time between
incoming signal edges. Need to pay attention to timer overflow also.
3. Compare the data between IC0 and IC1 to get the RTC clock frequency value. Suppose the
RTC_CAL measure value is B, and CALCLK measure value is A. Then the CALCLK frequency
will be between fRTC_CAL * (B-2) / (A+2) and fRTC_CAL * (B+2) / (A-2). Depend on the
calibration, user need to select the RTC_CAL, CALCLK and TIM1 frequency.
2.5.4 RTC off chip calibration
The off chip RTC calibration, user need to set the CALCLKEN bit in the PIMMIC register to enable the
CALCLK out on RTC_CAL pin. Base on the external requirement, user can set the RTCMOD and CALS
bit in RTCCTL3 registers to get the expected CALCLK output on RTC_CAL pin.
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12ZVHPIMV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
110 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 111
Chapter 3
Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
Table 3-1. Revision History
3.1 Introduction
The S12ZMMC module controls the access to all internal memories and peripherals for the S12ZCPU, and
the S12ZBDC module. It also provides direct memory access for the ADC module. The S12ZMMC
determines the address mapping of the on-chip resources, regulates access priorities and enforces memory
protection. Figure 3-1 shows a block diagram of the S12ZMMC module.
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Changes
V01.07 3 May 2013 Fixed typos
Removed PTU references
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
112 Freescale Semiconductor
3.1.1 Glossary
3.1.2 Overview
The S12ZMMC provides access to on-chip memories and peripherals for the S12ZCPU, the S12ZBDC,
and the ADC. It arbitrates memory accesses and determines all of the MCU memory maps. Furthermore,
the S12ZMMC is responsible for selecting the MCUs functional mode.
3.1.3 Features
S12ZMMC mode operation control
Memory mapping for S12ZCPU, S12ZBDC, and ADC
Maps peripherals and memories into a 16 MByte address space for the S12ZCPU, the
S12ZBDC, and the ADC
Handles simultaneous accesses to different on-chip resources (NVM, RAM, and peripherals)
Access violation detection and logging
Triggers S12ZCPU machine exceptions upon detection of illegal memory accesses and
uncorrectable ECC errors
Logs the state of the S12ZCPU and the cause of the access error
3.1.4 Modes of Operation
3.1.4.1 Chip configuration modes
The S12ZMMC determines the chip configuration mode of the device. It captures the s tate of the MODC
pin at reset and provides the ability to switch from special-single chip mode to normal single chip-mode.
Table 3-2. Glossary Of Terms
Term Definition
MCU Microcontroller Unit
CPU S12Z Central Processing Unit
BDC S12Z Background Debug Controller
ADC Analog-to-Digital Converter
unmapped
address range Address space that is not assigned to a memory
reserved address
range Address space that is reserved for future use cases
illegal access Memory access, that is not supported or prohibited by the S12ZMMC, e.g. a data store to NVM
access violation Either an illegal access or an uncorrectable ECC error
byte 8-bit data
word 16-bit data
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 113
3.1.4.2 Power modes
The S12ZMMC module is only active in run and wait mode.There is no bus activity in stop mode.
3.1.5 Block Diagram
e
Figure 3-1. S12ZMMC Block Diagram
3.2 External Signal Description
The S12ZMMC uses two external pins to determine the devices operating mode: RESET and MODC
(Table 3-3)
See device overview for the mapping of these signals to device pins.
3.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
3.3.1 Memory Map
A summary of the registers associated with the MMC block is shown in Figure 3-2. Detailed descriptions
of the registers and bits are given in the subsections that follow.
Table 3-3. External System Pins Associated With S12ZMMC
Pin Name Description
RESET External reset signal. The RESET signal is active low.
MODC This input is captured in bit MODC of the MODE register when the external RESET pin deasserts.
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
114 Freescale Semiconductor
3.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of the S12ZMMC control and status register descriptions in address order.
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
0x0070 MODE R MODC 0000000
W
0x0071-
0x007F
Reserved R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0080 MMCECH R ITR[3:0] TGT[3:0]
W
0x0081 MMCECL R ACC[3:0] ERR[3:0]
W
0x0082 MMCCCRH R CPUU 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0083 MMCCCRL R 0 CPUX 0 CPUI 0 0 0 0
W
0x0084 Reserved R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0085 MMCPCH R CPUPC[23:16]
W
0x0086 MMCPCM R CPUPC[15:8]
W
0x0087 MMCPCL R CPUPC[7:0]
W
0x0088-
0x00FF
Reserved R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 3-2. S12ZMMC Register Summary
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 115
3.3.2.1 Mode Register (MODE)
Read: Anytime.
Write: Only if a transition is allowed (see Figure 3-4).
The MODE register determines the operating mode of the MCU.
CAUTION
Figure 3-4. Mode Transition Diagram
Address: 0x0070
76543210
RMODC 0000000
W
Reset MODC10000000
1. External signal (see Table 3-3).
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 3-3. Mode Register (MODE)
Table 3-4. MODE Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
MODC
Mode Select Bit — This bit determines the current operating mode of the MCU. Its reset value is captured from
the MODC pin at the rising edge of the RESET pin. Figure 3-4 illustrates the only valid mode transition from
special single-chip mode to normal single chip mode.
Reset with
MODC pin = 1 Reset with
MODC pin = 0
Special
Single-Chip
Mode (SS)
Normal
Single-Chip
Mode (NS) write access to
MODE:
1 MODC bit
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
116 Freescale Semiconductor
3.3.2.2 Error Code Register (MMCECH, MMCECL)
Figure 3-5. Error Code Register (MMCEC)
Read: Anytime
Write: Write of 0xFFFF to MMCECH:MMCECL resets both registers to 0x0000
Table 3-5. MMCECH and MMCECL Field Descriptions
Address: 0x0080 (MMCECH)
76543210
RITR[3:0] TGT[3:0]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0081 (MMCECL)
76543210
RACC[3:0] ERR[3:0]
W
Reset00000000
Field Description
7-4 (MMCECH)
ITR[3:0]
Initiator Field — The ITR[3:0] bits capture the initiator which caused the access violation. The initiator is
captured in form of a 4 bit value which is assigned as follows:
0: none (no error condition detected)
1: S12ZCPU
2: reserved
3: ADC
4-15: reserved
3-0 (MMCECH)
TGT[3:0]
Target Field — The TGT[3:0] bits capture the target of the faulty access. The target is captured in form of a
4 bit value which is assigned as follows:
0: none
1: register space
2: RAM
3: EEPROM
4: program flash
5: IFR
6-15: reserved
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 117
The MMCEC register captures debug information about access violations. It is set to a non-zero value if
a S12ZCPU access violation or an uncorrectable ECC error has occurred. At the same time this register is
set to a non-zero value, access information is captured in the MMCPCn and MMCCCRn registers. The
MMCECn, the MMCPCn and the MMCCCRn registers are not updated if the MMCECn registers contain
a non-zero value. The MMCECn registers are cleared by writing the value 0xFFFF.
3.3.2.3 Captured S12ZCPU Condition Code Register (MMCCCRH, MMCCCRL)
Figure 3-6. Captured S12ZCPU Condition Code Register (MMCCCRH, MMCCCRL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Never
7-4 (MMCECL)
ACC[3:0]
Access Type Field — The ACC[3:0] bits capture the type of memory access, which caused the access
violation. The access type is captured in form of a 4 bit value which is assigned as follows:
0: none (no error condition detected)
1: opcode fetch
2: vector fetch
3: data load
4: data store
5-15: reserved
3-0 (MMCECL)
ERR[3:0]
Error Type Field The EC[3:0] bits capture the type of the access violation. The type is captured in form of
a 4 bit value which is assigned as follows:
0: none (no error condition detected)
1: access to an illegal address
2: uncorrectable ECC error
3-15: reserved
Address: 0x0082 (MMCCCRH)
76543210
RCPUU 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0083 (MMCCCRL)
76543210
R 0 CPUX 0 CPUI 0 0 0 0
W
Reset00000000
Field Description
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
118 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 3-6. MMCCCRH and MMCCCRL Field Descriptions
3.3.2.4 Captured S12ZCPU Program Counter (MMCPCH, MMCPCM, MMCPCL)
Figure 3-7. Captured S12ZCPU Program Counter (MMCPCH, MMCPCM, MMCPCL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Never
Field Description
7 (MMCCCRH)
CPUU
S12ZCPU User St ate Flag — This bit shows the state of the user/supervisor mode bit in the S12ZCPU’s CCR
at the time the access violation has occurred. The S12ZCPU user state flag is read-only; it will be automatically
updated when the next error condition is flagged through the MMCEC register. This bit is undefined if the error
code registers (MMCECn) are cleared.
6 (MMCCCRL)
CPUX
S12ZCPU X-Interrupt Mask— This bit shows the state of the X-interrupt mask in the S12ZCPU’s CCR at the
time the access violation has occurred. The S12ZCPU X-interrupt mask is read-only; it will be automatically
updated when the next error condition is flagged through the MMCEC register. This bit is undefined if the error
code registers (MMCECn) are cleared.
4 (MMCCCRL)
CPUI
S12ZCPU I-Interrupt MaskThis bit shows the state of the I-interrupt mask in the CPU’s CCR at the time the
access violation has occurred. The S12ZCPU I-interrupt mask is read-only; it will be automatically updated
when the next error condition is flagged through the MMCEC register. This bit is undefined if the error code
registers (MMCECn) are cleared.
Address: 0x0085 (MMCPCH)
76543210
R CPUPC[23:16]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0086 (MMCPCM)
76543210
RCPUPC[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0087 (MMCPCL)
76543210
R CPUPC[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 119
Table 3-7. MMCPCH, MMCPCM, and MMCPCL Field Descriptions
3.4 Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the S12ZMMC module.
3.4.1 Global Memory Map
The S12ZMMC maps all on-chip resources into an 16MB address space, the global memory map. The
exact resource mapping is shown in Figure 3-8. The global address space is used by the S12ZCPU, ADC,
and the S12ZBDC module.
Field Description
7–0 (MMCPCH)
7–0 (MMCPCM)
7–0 (MMCPCL)
CPUPC[23:0]
S12ZCPU Program Counter Value— The CPUPC[23:0] stores the CPU’s program counter value at the time
the access violation occurred. CPUPC[23:0] always points to the instruction which triggered the violation. These
bits are undefined if the error code registers (MMCECn) are cleared.
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
120 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 3-8. Global Memory Map
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 121
3.4.2 Illegal Accesses
The S12ZMMC module monitors all memory traf fic for illegal accesses. See Table 3-8 for a complete list
of all illegal accesses.
Illegal accesses are reported in several ways:
All illegal accesses performed by the S12ZCPU trigger machine exceptions.
All illegal accesses perfor med through the S12ZBDC interface, are captured in the ILLACC bit of
the BDCCSRL register.
Table 3-8. Illegal memory accesses
S12ZCPU S12ZBDC ADC
Register
space
Read access ok ok illegal access
Write access ok ok illegal access
Code execution illegal access
RAM
Read access ok ok ok
Write access ok ok ok
Code execution ok
EEPROM
Read access ok(1)
1. Unsupported NVM accesses during NVM command execution (“collisions”), are treated as illegal accesses.
ok1ok1
Write access illegal access illegal access illegal access
Code execution ok1
Reserved
Space
Read access ok ok illegal access
Write access only permitted in SS mode ok illegal access
Code execution illegal access
Reserved
Read-only
Space
Read access ok ok illegal access
Write access illegal access illegal access illegal access
Code execution illegal access
NVM IFR
Read access ok1ok1illegal access
Write access illegal access illegal access illegal access
Code execution illegal access
Program NVM
Read access ok1ok1ok1
Write access illegal access illegal access illegal access
Code execution ok1
Unmapped
Space
Read access illegal access illegal access illegal access
Write access illegal access illegal access illegal access
Code execution illegal access
Chapter 3 Memory Mapping Control (S12ZMMCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
122 Freescale Semiconductor
All illegal accesses performed by the ADC module trigger error interrupts. See ADC section for
details.
NOTE
Illegal accesses caused by S12ZCPU opcode prefetches will also trigger
machine exceptions, even if those opcodes might not be executed in the
program flow. To avoid these machine exceptions, S12ZCPU instructions
must not be executed from the last (high addresses) 8 bytes of RAM,
EEPROM, and Flash.
3.4.3 Uncorr ectable ECC Faults
RAM and flash use error correction codes (ECC) to detect and correct memory corruption. Each
uncorrectable memory corruption, which is detected during a S12ZCPU or ADC access triggers a machine
exception. Uncorrectable memory corruptions which are detected during a S12ZBDC access, are captured
in the RAMWF or the RDINV bit of the BDCCSRL register.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 123
Chapter 4
Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
4.1 Introduction
The INT module decodes the priority of all system exception requests and provides the applicable vector
for processing the exception to the CPU. The INT module supports:
I-bit and X-bit maskable interrupt requests
One non-maskable unimplemented page1 op-code trap
One non-maskable unimplemented page2 op-code trap
One non-maskable software interrupt (SWI)
Table 4-1. Revision History
Version
Number Revision
Date Effective
Date Description of Changes
V00.01 17 Apr 2009 all Initial version based on S12XINT V2.06
V00.02 14 Jul 2009 all Reduce RESET vectors from three to one.
V00.03 05 Oct 2009 all Removed dedicated ECC machine exception vector and marked vector-table
entry “reserved for future use”.
Added a second illegal op-code vector (to distinguish between SPARE and
TRAP).
V00.04 04 Jun 2010 all Fixed remaining descriptions of RESET vectors.
Split non-maskable hardware interrupts into XGATE software error and
machine exception requests.
Replaced mentions of CCR (old name from S12X) with CCW (new name).
V00.05 12 Jan 2011 all Corrected wrong IRQ vector address in some descriptions.
V00.06 22 Mar 2011 all Added vectors for RAM ECC and NVM ECC machine exceptions. And moved
position to 1E0..1E8.
Moved XGATE error interrupt to vector 1DC.
Remaining vectors accordingly.
Removed illegal address reset as a potential reset source.
V00.07 15 Apr 2011 all Removed illegal address reset as a potential reset source from Exception
vector table as well. Added the other possible reset sources to the table.
Changed register addresses according to S12Z platform definition.
V00.08 02 May 2011 all Reduced machine exception vectors to one.
Removed XGATE error interrupt.
Moved Spurious interrupt vector to 1DC.
Moved vector base address to 010 to make room for NVM non-volatile
registers.
V00.09 12 Aug 2011 all Added: Machine exceptions can cause wake-up from STOP or WAIT
V00.10 21 Feb 2012 all Corrected reset value for INT_CFADDR register
V00.11 02 Jul 2012 all Removed references and functions related to XGATE
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
124 Freescale Semiconductor
One non-maskable system call interrupt (SYS)
One non-maskable machine exception vector request
One spurious interrupt vector request
One system reset vector request
Each of the I-bit maskable interrupt requests can be assigned to one of seven priority levels supporting a
flexible priority scheme . The priority scheme can be used to imple ment nested interrupt capability where
interrupts from a lower level are automatically blocked if a higher level interrupt is being processed.
4.1.1 Glossary
The following terms and abbreviations are used in the document.
4.1.2 Features
Interrupt vector base register (IVBR)
One system reset vector (at address 0xFFFFFC).
One non-maskable unimplemented page1 op-code trap (SPARE) vector (at address vector base1 +
0x0001F8).
One non-maskable unimplemented page2 op-code trap (TRAP) vector (at address vector base1 +
0x0001F4).
One non-maskable software interrupt request (SWI) vector (at address vector base1 + 0x0001F0).
One non-maskable system call interrupt request (SYS) vector (at address vector base1 +
0x00001EC).
One non-maskable machine exception vector request (at address vector base1 + 0x0001E8.
One spurious interrupt vector (at address vector base1 + 0x0001DC).
One X-bit maskable interrupt vector request associated with XIRQ (at address vector base1 +
0x0001D8).
One I-bit maskable interrupt vector request associated with IRQ (at address vector base1 +
0x0001D4).
Table 4-2 . Te rmi n ol og y
Term Meaning
CCW Condition Code Register (in the S12Z CPU)
DMA Direct Memory Access
INT Interrupt
IPL Interrupt Processing Level
ISR Interrupt Service Routine
MCU Micro-Controller Unit
IRQ refers to the interrupt request associated with the IRQ pin
XIRQ refers to the interrupt request associated with the XIRQ pin
1. The vector base is a 24-bit address which is accumulated from the contents of the interrupt vector base register (IVBR, used
as the upper 15 bits of the address) and 0x000 (used as the lower 9 bits of the address).
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 125
up to 1 13 additional I-bit maskable interrupt vector requests (at addresses vector base1 + 0x000010
.. vector base + 0x0001D0).
Each I-bit maskable interrupt request has a configurable priority level.
I-bit maskable interrupts can be nested, depending on their priority levels.
Wakes up the system from stop or wait mode when an appropriate interrupt request occurs or
whenever XIRQ is asserted, even if X interrupt is masked.
4.1.3 Modes of Operation
Run mode
This is the basic mode of operation.
Wait mode
In wait mode, the INT module is capable of waking up the CPU if an eligible CPU exception
occurs. Please refer to Section 4.5.3, “Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode” for details.
Stop Mode
In stop mode, the INT module is capable of waking up the CPU if an eligible CPU exception
occurs. Please refer to Section 4.5.3, “Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode” for details.
4.1.4 Block Diagram
Figure 4-1 shows a block diagram of the INT module.
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
126 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 4-1. INT Block Diagram
4.2 External Signal Description
The INT module has no external signals.
4.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the INT module.
4.3.1 Module Memory Map
Table 4-3 gives an overview over all INT module registers.
Table 4-3. INT Memory Map
Address Use Access
0x000010–0x000011 Interrupt Vector Base Register (IVBR) R/W
0x000012–0x000016 RESERVED
0x000017 Interrupt Request Configuration Address Register
(INT_CFADDR)
R/W
0x000018 Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 0
(INT_CFDATA0)
R/W
Wake Up
Current
IVBR
One Set Per Channel
Interrupt
Requests
Interrupt Requests CPU
Vector
Address
New
IPL
IPL
(Up to 117 Channels)
PRIOLVLn Priority Level
= configuration bits from the associated
channel configuration register
IVBR = Interrupt Vector Base
IPL = Interrupt Processing Level
PRIOLVL0
PRIOLVL1
PRIOLVL2
Peripheral
To C P U
Priority
Decoder
Non I Bit Maskable
Channels
Priority
Level
Filter
Highest Pending
IPL
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 127
4.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes in address order all the INT module registers and their individual bits.
0x000019 Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 1
(INT_CFDATA1)
R/W
0x00001A Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 2
(INT_CFDATA2
R/W
0x00001B Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 3
(INT_CFDATA3)
R/W
0x00001C Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 4
(INT_CFDATA4)
R/W
0x00001D Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 5
(INT_CFDATA5)
R/W
0x00001E Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 6
(INT_CFDATA6)
R/W
0x00001F Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 7
(INT_CFDATA7)
R/W
Address Register
Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
0x000010 IVBR R IVB_ADDR[15:8]
W
0x000011 R IVB_ADDR[7:1] 0
W
0x000017 INT_CFADDR R 0 INT_CFADDR[6:3] 000
W
0x000018 INT_CFDATA0 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x000019 INT_CFDATA1 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x00001A INT_CFDATA2 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x00001B INT_CFDATA3 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x00001C INT_CFDATA4 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-2. INT Register Summary
Table 4-3. INT Memory Map
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
128 Freescale Semiconductor
4.3.2.1 Interrupt Vector Base Register (IVBR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
4.3.2.2 Interrupt Request Configuration Address Register (INT_CFADDR)
Read: Anytime
0x00001D INT_CFDATA5 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x00001E INT_CFDATA6 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x00001F INT_CFDATA7 R 0 0 0 0 0 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Address: 0x000010
1514131211109876543210
RIVB_ADDR[15:1] 0
W
Reset1111111111111110
Figure 4-3. Interrupt Vector Base Register (IVBR)
Table 4-4. IVBR Field Descriptions
Field Description
15–1
IVB_ADDR
[15:1]
Interrupt Vector Base Address Bits — These bits represent the upper 15 bits of all vector addresses. Out
of reset these bits are set to 0xFFFE (i.e., vectors are located at 0xFFFE00–0xFFFFFF).
Note: A system reset will initialize the interrupt vector base register with “0xFFFE” before it is used to
determine the reset vector address. Therefore, changing the IVBR has no effect on the location of the
reset vector (0xFFFFFC–0xFFFFFF).
Address: 0x000017
76543210
R0 INT_CFADDR[6:3] 000
W
Reset00001000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-4. Interrupt Configuration Address Register (INT_CFADDR)
Address Register
Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-2. INT Register Summary
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 129
Write: Anytime
4.3.2.3 Interrupt Request Configuration Data Registers (INT_CFDATA0–7)
The eight register window visible at addresses INT_CFDATA0–7 contains the configuration data for the
block of eight interrupt requests (out of 128) selected by the interrupt configuration address register
(INT_CFADDR) in ascending order. INT_CFDATA0 represents the interrupt configuration data register
of the vector with the lowest address in this block, while INT_CFDATA7 represents the interrupt
configuration data register of the vector with the highest address, respectively.
Table 4-5. INT_CFADDR Field Descriptions
Field Description
6–3
INT_CFADDR[6:3]
Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register Select Bits These bits determine which of the 128
configuration data registers are accessible in the 8 register window at INT_CFDATA0–7.
The hexadecimal value written to this register corresponds to the upper 4 bits of the vector number
(multiply with 4 to get the vector address offset).
If, for example, the value 0x70 is written to this register, the configuration data register block for the 8
interrupt vector requests starting with vector at address (vector base + (0x70*4 = 0x0001C0)) is selected
and can be accessed as INT_CFDATA0–7.
Address: 0x000018
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-5. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 0 (INT_CFDATA0)
Address: 0x000019
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-6. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 1 (INT_CFDATA1)
Address: 0x00001A
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-7. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 2 (INT_CFDATA2)
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
130 Freescale Semiconductor
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
Address: 0x00001B
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-8. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 3 (INT_CFDATA3)
Address: 0x00001C
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-9. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 4 (INT_CFDATA4)
Address: 0x00001D
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-10. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 5 (INT_CFDATA5)
Address: 0x00001E
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-11. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 6 (INT_CFDATA6)
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 131
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
4.4 Functional Description
The INT module processes all exception requests to be serviced by the CPU module. These exceptions
include interrupt vector requests and reset vector requests. Each of these exception types and their overall
priority level is discussed in the subsections below.
Address: 0x00001F
76543210
R00000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
Reset00000001
(1)
1. Please refer to the notes following the PRIOLVL[2:0] description below.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 4-12. Interrupt Request Configuration Data Register 7 (INT_CFDATA7)
Table 4-6. INT_CFDATA0–7 Field Descriptions
Field Description
2–0
PRIOLVL[2:0]
Interrupt Request Priority Level Bi ts — The PRIOLVL[2:0] bits configure the interrupt request priority level of
the associated interrupt request. Out of reset all interrupt requests are enabled at the lowest active level (“1”).
Please also refer to Tab le 4- 7 for available interrupt request priority levels.
Note: Write accesses to configuration data registers of unused interrupt channels are ignored and read
accesses return all 0s. For information about what interrupt channels are used in a specific MCU, please
refer to the Device Reference Manual for that MCU.
Note: When non I-bit maskable request vectors are selected, writes to the corresponding INT_CFDATA
registers are ignored and read accesses return all 0s. The corresponding vectors do not have
configuration data registers associated with them.
Note: Write accesses to the configuration register for the spurious interrupt vector request
(vector base + 0x0001DC) are ignored and read accesses return 0x07 (request is handled by the CPU,
PRIOLVL = 7).
Table 4-7. Interrupt Priority Levels
Priority PRIOLVL2 PRIOLVL1 PRIOLVL0 Meaning
0 0 0 Interrupt request is disabled
low 0 0 1 Priority level 1
0 1 0 Priority level 2
0 1 1 Priority level 3
1 0 0 Priority level 4
1 0 1 Priority level 5
1 1 0 Priority level 6
high 1 1 1 Priority level 7
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
132 Freescale Semiconductor
4.4.1 S12Z Exception Requests
The CPU handles both reset requests and interrupt requests. The INT module contains registers to
configure the priority level of each I-bit maskable interrupt request which can be used to implement an
interrupt priority scheme. This also includes the possibility to nest interrupt requests. A priority decoder is
used to evaluate the relative priority of pending interrupt requests.
4.4.2 Interrupt Prioritization
After system reset all I-bit maskable interrupt requests are configured to be enabled, are set up to be
handled by the CPU and have a pre-configured priority level of 1. Exceptions to this rule are the non-
maskable interrupt requests and the spurious interrupt vector request at (vector base + 0x0001DC) which
cannot be disabled, are always handled by the CPU and have a fixed priority levels. A priority level of 0
effectively disables the associated I-bit maskable interrupt request.
If more than one interrupt request is configured to the same interrupt priority level the interrupt request
with the higher vector address wins the prioritization.
The following conditions must be met for an I-bit maskable interrupt request to be processed.
1. The local interrupt enabled bit in the peripheral module must be set.
2. The setup in the configuration register associated with the interrupt request channel must me et the
following conditions:
a) The priority level must be set to non zero.
b) The priority level must be greater than the current interrupt processing level in the condition
code register (CCW) of the CPU (PRIOLVL[2:0] > IPL[2:0]).
3. The I-bit in the condition code register (CCW) of the CPU must be cleared.
4. There is no access violation interrupt request pending.
5. There is no SYS, SWI, SPARE, TRAP, Machine Exception or XIRQ request pending.
NOTE
All non I-bit maskable interrupt requests always have higher priority than I-
bit maskable interrupt requests. If an I-bit maskable interrupt request is
interrupted by a non I-bit maskable interrupt request, the currently active
interrupt processing level (IPL) remains unaffected. It is possible to nest
non I-bit maskable interrupt requests, e.g., by nesting SWI, SYS or TRAP
calls.
4.4.2.1 Interrupt Priority Stack
The current interrupt processing level (IPL) is stored in the condition code register (CCW) of the CPU.
This way the current IPL is automatically pushed to the stack by the standard interrupt stacking procedure.
The new IPL is copied to the CCW from the priority level of the highest priority active interrupt request
channel which is configured to be handled by the CPU. The copying takes place when the interrupt vector
is fetched. The previous IPL is automatically restored from the stack by executing the RTI instruction.
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 133
4.4.3 Priority Decoder
The INT module contains a priority decoder to determine the relative priority for all interrupt requests
pending for the CPU.
A CPU interrupt vector is not supplied until the CPU requests it. Therefore, it is possible that a higher
priority interrupt request could override the original exception which caused the CPU to request the vector .
In this case, the CPU will receive the highest priority vector and the system will process this exception first
instead of the original request.
If the interrupt source is unknown (for example, in the case where an interrupt request becomes inactive
after the interrupt has been recognized, but prior to the vector request), the vector address supplied to the
CPU defaults to that of the spurious interrupt vector.
NOTE
Care must be taken to ensure that all exception requests remain active until
the system begins execution of the applicable service routine; otherwise, the
exception request may not get processed at all or the result may be a
spurious interrupt request (vector at address (vector base + 0x0001DC)).
4.4.4 Reset Exception Requests
The INT module supports one system reset exception request. The diff erent reset types are mapped to this
vector (for details please refer to the Clock and Power Management Unit module (CPMU)):
1. Pin reset
2. Power-on reset
3. Low-voltage reset
4. Clock monitor reset request
5. COP watchdog reset request
4.4.5 Exception Priority
The priority (from highest to lowest) and address of all exception vectors issued by the INT module upon
request by the CPU are shown in Table 4-8. Generally, all non-maskable interrupts have higher priorities
than maskable interrupts. Please note that between the four software interrupts (Unimplemented op-code
trap page1/page2 requests, SWI request, SYS request) there is no real priority defined since they cannot
occur simultaneously (the S12Z CPU executes one instruction at a time).
Table 4-8. Exception Vector Map and Priority
Vector Address(1) Source
0xFFFFFC Pin reset, power-on reset, low-voltage reset, clock monitor reset, COP watchdog reset
(Vector base + 0x0001F8) Unimplemented page1 op-code trap (SPARE) vector request
(Vector base + 0x0001F4) Unimplemented page2 op-code trap (TRAP) vector request
(Vector base + 0x0001F0) Software interrupt instruction (SWI) vector request
(Vector base + 0x0001EC) System call interrupt instruction (SYS) vector request
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
134 Freescale Semiconductor
4.4.6 Interrupt Vector Table Layout
The interrupt vector table contains 128 entries, each 32 bits (4 bytes) wide. Each entry contains a 24-bit
address (3 bytes) which is stored in the 3 low-significant bytes of the entry. The content of the most
significant byte of a vector-table entry is ignored. Figure 4-13 illustrates the vector table entry format.
Figure 4-13. Interrupt Vector Table Entry
4.5 Initialization/Application Information
4.5.1 Initialization
After system reset, software should:
Initialize the interrupt vector base register if the interrupt vector table is not located at the default
location (0xFFFE00–0xFFFFFB).
Initialize the interrupt processing level configuration data registers (INT_CFADDR,
INT_CFDATA0–7) for all interrupt vector requests with the desired priority levels. It might be a
good idea to disable unused interrupt requests.
Enable I-bit maskable interrupts by clearing the I-bit in the CCW.
Enable the X-bit maskable interrupt by clearing the X-bit in the CCW (if required).
4.5.2 Interrupt Nesting
The interrupt request pr iority level scheme makes it possible to implement priority based interrupt request
nesting for the I-bit maskable interrupt requests.
I-bit maskable interrupt requests can be interrupted by an interrupt request with a higher priority,
so that there can be up to seven nested I-bit maskable interrupt requ ests at a time (refer to Figure 4-
14 for an example using up to three nested interrupt requests).
(Vector base + 0x0001E8) Machine exception vector request
(Vector base + 0x0001E4) Reserved
(Vector base + 0x0001E0) Reserved
(Vector base + 0x0001DC) Spurious interrupt
(Vector base + 0x0001D8) XIRQ interrupt request
(Vector base + 0x0001D4) IRQ interrupt request
(Vector base + 0x000010
..
Vector base + 0x0001D0)
Device specific I-bit maskable interrupt sources (priority determined by the associated
configuration registers, in descending order)
1. 24 bits vector address based
Bits [31:24 ] [23:0]
(unused) ISR Address
Table 4-8. Exception Vector Map and Priority
Vector Address(1) Source
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 135
I-bit maskable interrupt requests cannot be interrupted by other I-bit maskable interrupt requests per
default. In order to make an interrupt service routine (ISR) interruptible, the ISR must explicitly clear the
I-bit in the CCW (CLI). Afte r cleari ng the I-bit, I-bit maska ble inter rupt requests with higher priority can
interrupt the current ISR.
An ISR of an interruptible I-bit maskable interrupt request could basically look like this:
Service interrupt, e.g., clear interrupt flags, copy data, etc.
Clear I-bit in the CCW by executing the CPU instruction CLI (thus allowing interrupt requests with
higher priority)
Process data
Return from interrupt by executing the instruction RTI
Figure 4-14. Interrupt Processing Example
4.5.3 Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode
4.5.3.1 CPU Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode
Every I-bit maskable interrupt request which is configured to be handled by the CPU is capable of waking
the MCU from stop or wait mode. Additionally machine exceptions can wake-up the MCU from stop or
wait mode.
T o determine whether an I-bit maskable interrupts is qualified to wake up the CPU or not, the same settings
as in normal run mode are applied during stop or wait mode:
If the I-bit in the CCW is set, all I-bit maskable interrupts are masked from waking up the MCU.
An I-bit maskable interrupt is ignored if it is configured to a priority level below or equal to the
current IPL in CCW.
The X-bit maskable interrupt request can wake up the MCU from stop or wait mode at anytime, even if
the X-bit in CCW is set If the X-bit maskable interrupt request is used to wake-up the MCU with the X-
0
Reset
4
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L4
7
0
4
L1 (Pending)
L7
L3 (Pending)
RTI
4
0
3
0
RTI
RTI
1
0
0
RTI
Stacked IPL
Processing Levels
IPL in CCW
Chapter 4 Interrupt (S12ZINTV0)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
136 Freescale Semiconductor
bit in the CCW set, the associated ISR is not called. The CPU then resumes program execution with the
instruction following the WAI or STOP instruction. This feature works following the same rules like any
interrupt request, i.e. care must be taken that the X-bit maskable interrupt request used for wake-up
remains active at least until the system begins execution of the instruction following the WAI or STOP
instruction; otherwise, wake-up may not occur.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 137
Chapter 5
Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
5.1 Introduction
The background debug controller (BDC) is a single-wire, background debug system implemented in on-
chip hardware for minimal CPU intervention. The device BKGD pin interfaces directly to the BDC.
The S12ZBDC maintains the standard S12 serial interface protocol but introduces an enhanced handshake
protocol and enhanced BDC command set to support the linear instruction set family of S12Z devices and
offer easier, more flexible internal resource access over the BDC serial interface.
5.1.1 Glossary
Table 5-1. Revision History
Revision
Number Revision
Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Changes
V2.04 03.Dec.2012 Section 5.1.3.3 Included BACKGROUND/ Stop mode dependency
V2.05 22.Jan.2013 Section 5.3.2.2 Improved NORESP description and added STEP1/ Wait mode dependency
V2.06 22.Mar.2013 Section 5.3.2.2 Improved NORESP description of STEP1/ Wait mode dependency
V2.07 11.Apr.2013 Section 5.1.3.3.1 Improved STOP and BACKGROUND interdepency description
V2.08 31.May.2013 Section 5.4.4.4
Section 5.4.7.1
Removed misleading WAIT and BACKGROUND interdepency description
Added subsection dedicated to Long-ACK
V2.09 29.Aug.2013 Section 5.4.4.12 Noted that READ_DBGTB is only available for devices featuring a trace
buffer.
V2.10 21.Oct.2013 Section 5.1.3.3.2 Improved description of NORESP dependence on WAIT and BACKROUND
V2.11 02.Feb.2015 Section 5.1.3.3.1
Section 5.3.2
Corrected name of clock that can stay active in Stop mode
Table 5-2. Glossary Of Terms
Term Definition
DBG On chip Debug Module
BDM Active Background Debug Mode
CPU S12Z CPU
SSC Special Single Chip Mode (device operating mode)
NSC Normal Single Chip Mode (device operating mode)
BDCSI Background Debug Controller Serial Interface. This refers to the single pin BKGD serial interface.
EWAIT Optional S12 feature which allows external devices to delay external accesses until deassertion of EWAIT
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
138 Freescale Semiconductor
5.1.2 Features
The BDC includes these distinctive features:
Single-wire communication with host development system
SYNC command to determine communication rate
Genuine non-intrusive handshake protocol
Enhanced handshake protocol for error detection and stop mode recognition
Active out of reset in special single chip mode
Most commands not requiring active BDM, for minimal CPU intervention
Full global memory map access without paging
Simple flash mass erase capability
5.1.3 Modes of Operation
S12 devices feature power modes (run, wait, and stop) and operating modes (normal single chip, special
single chip). Furthermore, the operation of the BDC is dependent on the device security status.
5.1.3.1 BDC Modes
The BDC features module specific modes, namely disabled, enabled and active. These modes are
dependent on the device security and operating mode. In active BDM the CPU ceases execution, to allow
BDC system access to all internal resources including CPU internal registers.
5.1.3.2 Security and Operating mode Dependency
In device run mode the BDC dependency is as follows
Normal modes, unsecure device
General BDC operation available. The BDC is disabled out of reset.
Normal modes, secure device
BDC disabled. No BDC access possible.
Special single chip mode, unsecure
BDM active out of reset. All BDC commands are available.
Special single chip mode, secure
BDM active out of reset. Restricted command set available.
When operating in secure mode, BDC operation is restricted to allow checking and clearing security by
mass erasing the on-chip flash memory. Secure operation prevents BDC access to on-chip memory other
than mass erase. The BDC command set is restricted to those commands classified as Always-available.
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 139
5.1.3.3 Low-Power Modes
5.1.3.3.1 Stop Mode
The execution of the CPU STOP instruction leads to stop mode only when all bus masters (CPU, or others,
depending on the device) have finished processing. The operation during stop mode depends on the
ENBDC and BDCCIS bit settings as summarized in Table 5-3
A disabled BDC has no influence on stop mode operation. In this case the BDCSI clock is disabled in stop
mode thus it is not possible to enable the BDC from within stop mode.
STOP Mode With BDC Enabled An d BDCCIS Clear
If the BDC is enabled and BDCCIS is clear , then the BDC prevents the BDCCLK clock (Figure 5-5) from
being disabled in stop mode. This allows BDC communication to continue throughout stop mode in order
to access the BDCCSR register. All other device level clock signals are disabled on entering stop mode.
NOTE
This is intended for application debugging, not for fast flash programming.
Thus the CLKSW bit must be clear to map the BDCSI to BDCCLK.
With the BDC enabled, an internal acknowledge delays stop mode entry and exit by 2 BDCSI clock + 2
bus clock cycles. If no other module delays stop mode entry and exit, then these additional clock cycles
represent a diff erence between the debug and not debug cases. Furthermore if a BDC internal access is
being executed when the device is entering stop mode, then the stop mode entry is delayed until the internal
access is complete (typically for 1 bus clock cycle).
Accesses to the internal memory map are not possible when the internal device cloc ks are disabled. Thus
attempted accesses to memory mapped resources are suppressed and the NORESP flag is set. Resources
can be accessed again by the next command received following exit from Stop mode.
A BACKGROUND command issued whilst in stop mode remains pending internally until the device
leaves stop mode. This means that subsequent active BDM commands, issued whilst BACKGROUND is
pending, set the ILLCMD flag because the device is not yet in active BDM.
If ACK handshaking is enabled, then the first ACK, following a stop mode entry is long to indicate a stop
exception. The BDC indicates a stop mode occurrence by setting the BDCCSR bit STOP. If the host
attempts further communication before the ACK pulse generation then the OVRUN bit is set.
Table 5-3. BDC STOP Operation Dependencies
ENBDC BDCCIS Descr iption Of Operation
0 0 BDC has no effect on STOP mode.
0 1 BDC has no effect on STOP mode.
1 0 Only BDCCLK clock continues
1 1 All clocks continue
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
140 Freescale Semiconductor
STOP Mode With BDC Enabled And BDCCIS Set
If the BDC is enabled and BDCCIS is set, then the BDC prevents core clocks being disabled in stop mode.
This allows BDC communication, for access of internal memory mapped resources, but not CPU registers,
to continue throughout stop mode.
A BACKGROUND command issued whilst in stop mode remains pending internally until the device
leaves stop mode. This means that subsequent active BDM commands, issued whilst BACKGROUND is
pending, set the ILLCMD flag because the device is not yet in active BDM.
If ACK handshaking is enabled, then the first ACK, following a stop mode entry is long to indicate a stop
exception. The BDC indicates a stop mode occurrence by setting the BDCCSR bit STOP. If the host
attempts further communication before the ACK pulse generation then the OVRUN bit is set.
5.1.3.3.2 Wait Mode
The device enters wait mode when the CPU starts to execute the WAI instruction. The second part of the
WAI instruction (return from wait mode) can only be performed when an interrupt occurs. Thus on
entering wait mode the CPU is in the middle of the WAI instruction and cannot permit access to CPU
internal resources, nor allow entry to active BDM. Thus only commands classified as Non-Intrusive or
Always-Available are possible in wait mode.
On entering wait mode, the WAIT flag in BDCCSR is set. If the ACK handshake protocol is enabled then
the first ACK generated after WAIT has been set is a long-ACK pulse. Thus the host can recognize a wait
mode occurrence. The WAIT flag remains set and cannot be cleared whilst the device remains in wait
mode. After the device leaves wait mode the WAIT flag can be cleared by writing a “1” to it.
A BACKGROUND command issued whilst in wait mode sets the NORESP bit and the BDM active
request remains pending internally until the CPU leaves wait mode due to an interrupt. The device then
enters BDM with the PC po inting to the address of the first instruction of the ISR.
With ACK disabled, further Non-Intrusive or Always-Available commands are possible, in this pending
state, but attempted Active-Background commands set NORESP and ILLCMD because the BDC is not in
active BDM state.
W ith ACK enabled, if the host attempts further co mmunication before the ACK pulse generation then the
OVRUN bit is set.
Similarly the STEP1 command issued from a WAI instruction cannot be completed by the CPU until the
CPU leaves wait mode due to an interrupt. The first STEP1 into wait mode sets the BDCCSR WAIT bit.
If the part is still in Wait mode and a further STEP1 is carried out then the NORESP and ILLCMD bits are
set because the device is no longer in active BDM for the duration of WAI execution.
5.1.4 Block Diagram
A block diagram of the BDC is shown in Figure 5-1.
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 141
Figure 5-1. BDC Block Diagram
5.2 External Signal Description
A single-wire interface pin (BKGD) is used to communicate with the BDC system. During res et, this pin
is a device mode select input. After reset, this pin becomes the dedicated serial interface pin for the BDC.
BKGD is a pseudo-open-drain pin with an on-chip pull-up. Unlike typical open-drain pins, the external
RC time constant on this pin due to external capacitance, plays almost no role in signal rise time. The
custom protocol provides for brief, actively driven speed-up pulses to force rapid rise times on this pin
without risking harmful drive level conflicts. Refer to Section 5.4.6 for more details.
5.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
5.3.1 Module Memory Map
Table 5-4 shows the BDC memory map.
Table 5-4. BDC Memory Map
Global Address Module Size
(Bytes)
Not Applicable BDC registers 2
BKGD
HOST
SYSTEM SERIAL INTERFACE CONTROL
INSTRUCTION
DECODE AND
BUS INTERFACE
AND
CONTROL LOGIC
ADDRESS
DATA
BUS CONTROL
BDCSI
CORE CLOCK
ERASE FLASH
FLASH ERASED
CPU CONTROL
AND SHIFT REGISTER
FLASH SECURE
BDCCSR REGISTER
AND DATAPATH
CONTROL
CLOCK DOMAIN
CONTROL
FSM
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
142 Freescale Semiconductor
5.3.2 Register Descriptions
The BDC registers are shown in Figure 5-2. Registers are accessed only by host-driven communications
to the BDC hardware using READ_BDCCSR and WRITE_BDCCSR commands. They are not accessible
in the device memory map.
5.3.2.1 BDC Control Status Register High (BDCCSRH)
Figure 5-3. BDC Control Status Register High (BDCCSRH)
Read: All modes through BDC operation only.
Write: All modes through BDC operation only, when not secured, but subject to the following:
Bits 7,3 and 2 can only be written by WRITE_BDCCSR commands.
Bit 5 can only be written by WRITE_BDCCSR commands when the device is not in stop mode.
Bits 6, 1 and 0 cannot be written. They can only be updated by internal hardware.
Global
Address Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Not
Applicable
BDCCSRH R ENBDC BDMACT BDCCIS 0STEAL CLKSW UNSEC ERASE
W
Not
Applicable
BDCCSRL R WAIT STOP RAMWF OVRUN NORESP RDINV ILLACC ILLCMD
W
= Unimplemented, Reserved 0 = Always read zero
Figure 5-2. BDC Register Summary
Register Address: This register is not in the device memory map. It is accessible using BDC inherent addressing commands
76543 2 1 0
RENBDC BDMACT BDCCIS 0STEAL CLKSW UNSEC ERASE
W
Reset
Secure AND SSC-Mode 11000000
Unsecure AND SSC-Mode 11000010
Secure AND NSC-Mode 00000000
Unsecure AND NSC-Mode 00000010
= Unimplemented, Reserved
0 = Always read zero
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 143
Table 5-5. BDCCSRH Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
ENBDC
Enable BDC — This bit controls whether the BDC is enabled or disabled. When enabled, active BDM can be
entered and non-intrusive commands can be carried out. When disabled, active BDM is not possible and the
valid command set is restricted. Further information is provided in Tab l e 5-7 .
0 BDC disabled
1 BDC enabled
Note: ENBDC is set out of reset in special single chip mode.
6
BDMACT
BDM Active Status This bit becomes set upon entering active BDM. BDMACT is cleared as part of the active
BDM exit sequence.
0 BDM not active
1BDM active
Note: BDMACT is set out of reset in special single chip mode.
5
BDCCIS
BDC Continue In Stop — If ENBDC is set then BDCCIS selects the type of BDC operation in stop mode (as
shown in Tab l e 5-3 ). If ENBDC is clear, then the BDC has no effect on stop mode and no BDC communication
is possible.If ACK pulse handshaking is enabled, then the first ACK pulse following stop mode entry is a long
ACK. This bit cannot be written when the device is in stop mode.
0 Only the BDCCLK clock continues in stop mode
1 All clocks continue in stop mode
3
STEAL
Steal enabled with ACK— This bit forces immediate internal accesses with the ACK handshaking protocol
enabled. If ACK handshaking is disabled then BDC accesses steal the next bus cycle.
0 If ACK is enabled then BDC accesses await a free cycle, with a timeout of 512 cycles
1 If ACK is enabled then BDC accesses are carried out in the next bus cycle
2
CLKSW
Clock Switch The CLKSW bit controls the BDCSI clock source. This bit is initialized to “0” by each reset and
can be written to “1”. Once it has been set, it can only be cleared by a reset. When setting CLKSW a minimum
delay of 150 cycles at the initial clock speed must elapse before the next command can be sent. This guarantees
that the start of the next BDC command uses the new clock for timing subsequent BDC communications.
0 BDCCLK used as BDCSI clock source
1 Device fast clock used as BDCSI clock source
Note: Refer to the device specification to determine which clock connects to the BDCCLK and fast clock inputs.
1
UNSEC
Unsecure — If the device is unsecure, the UNSEC bit is set automatically.
0 Device is secure.
1 Device is unsecure.
Note: When UNSEC is set, the device is unsecure and the state of the secure bits in the on-chip Flash EEPROM
can be changed.
0
ERASE
Erase Flash — This bit can only be set by the dedicated ERASE_FLASH command. ERASE is unaffected by
write accesses to BDCCSR. ERASE is cleared either when the mass erase sequence is completed, independent
of the actual status of the flash array or by a soft reset.
Reading this bit indicates the status of the requested mass erase sequence.
0 No flash mass erase sequence pending completion
1 Flash mass erase sequence pending completion.
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
144 Freescale Semiconductor
5.3.2.2 BDC Control Status Register Low (BDCCSRL)
Figure 5-4. BDC Control Status Register Low (BDCCSRL)
Read: BDC access only.
Write: Bits [7:5], [3:0] BDC access only, restricted to flag clearing by writing a “1” to the bit position.
Write: Bit 4 never. It can only be cleared by a SYNC pulse.
If ACK handshaking is enabled then BDC commands with ACK causing a BDCCSRL[3:1] flag setting
condition also generate a long ACK pulse. Subsequent commands that are executed correctly generate a
normal ACK pulse. Subsequent commands that are not correctly executed generate a long ACK pulse. The
first ACK pulse after WAIT or STOP have been set also generates a long ACK. Subsequent ACK pulses
are normal, whilst STOP and WAIT remain set.
Long ACK pulses are not immediately generated if an overrun condition is caused by the host driving the
BKGD pin low whilst a target ACK is pending, because this would conflict with an attempted host
transmission following the BKGD edge. When a whole byte has been received following the offending
BKGD edge, the OVRUN bit is still set, forcing subsequent ACK pulses to be long.
Unimplemented BDC opcodes causing the ILLCMD bit to be set do not generate a long ACK because this
could conflict with further transmission from the host. If the ILLCMD is set for another reason, then a long
ACK is generated for the current command if it is a BDC command with ACK.
Register Address: This register is not in the device memory map. It is accessible using BDC inherent addressing commands
76543 2 1 0
RWAIT STOP RAMWF OVRUN NORESP RDINV ILLACC ILLCMD
W
Reset 00000000
Table 5-6. BDCCSRL Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
WAIT
WAIT Indicator Flag — Indicates that the device entered wait mode. Writing a “1” to this bit whilst in wait mode
has no effect. Writing a “1” after exiting wait mode, clears the bit.
0 Device did not enter wait mode
1 Device entered wait mode.
6
STOP
STOP Ind icator Flag — Indicates that the CPU requested stop mode following a STOP instruction. Writing a
“1” to this bit whilst not in stop mode clears the bit. Writing a “1” to this bit whilst in stop mode has no effect.
This bit can only be set when the BDC is enabled.
0 Device did not enter stop mode
1 Device entered stop mode.
5
RAMWF
RAM Write Fault — Indicates an ECC double fault during a BDC write access to RAM.
Writing a “1” to this bit, clears the bit.
0 No RAM write double fault detected.
1 RAM write double fault detected.
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 145
4
OVRUN
Overrun Flag — Indicates unexpected host activity before command completion.
This occurs if a new command is received before the current command completion.
With ACK enabled this also occurs if the host drives the BKGD pin low whilst a target ACK pulse is pending
To protect internal resources from misinterpreted BDC accesses following an overrun, internal accesses are
suppressed until a SYNC clears this bit.
A SYNC clears the bit.
0 No overrun detected.
1 Overrun detected when issuing a BDC command.
3
NORESP
No Response Flag Indicates that the BDC internal action or data access did not complete. This occurs in the
following scenarios:
a) If no free cycle for an access is found within 512 core clock cycles. This could typically happen if a code loop
without free cycles is executing with ACK enabled and STEAL clear.
b) With ACK disabled or STEAL set, when an internal access is not complete before the host starts
data/BDCCSRL retrieval or an internal write access is not complete before the host starts the next BDC
command.
c) Attempted internal memory or SYNC_PC accesses during STOP mode set NORESP if BDCCIS is clear.
In the above cases, on setting NORESP, the BDC aborts the access if permitted. (For devices supporting
EWAIT, BDC external accesses with EWAIT assertions, prevent a command from being aborted until EWAIT
is deasserted).
d) If a BACKGROUND command is issued whilst the device is in wait mode the NORESP bit is set but the
command is not aborted. The active BDM request is completed when the device leaves wait mode.
Furthermore subsequent CPU register access commands during wait mode set the NORESP bit, should it
have been cleared.
e) If a command is issued whilst awaiting return from Wait mode. This can happen when using STEP1 to step
over a CPU WAI instruction, if the CPU has not returned from Wait mode before the next BDC command is
received.
f) If STEP1 is issued with the BDC enabled as the device enters Wait mode regardless of the BDMACT state.
When NORESP is set a value of 0xEE is returned for each data byte associated with the current access.
Writing a “1” to this bit, clears the bit.
0 Internal action or data access completed.
1 Internal action or data access did not complete.
2
RDINV
Read Data Invalid Flag — Indicates invalid read data due to an ECC error during a BDC initiated read access.
The access returns the actual data read from the location.
Writing a “1” to this bit, clears the bit.
0 No invalid read data detected.
1 Invalid data returned during a BDC read access.
1
ILLACC
Illegal Access Flag — Indicates an attempted illegal access. This is set in the following cases:
When the attempted access addresses unimplemented memory
When the access attempts to write to the flash array
When a CPU register access is attempted with an invalid CRN (Section 5.4.5.1).
Illegal accesses return a value of 0xEE for each data byte
Writing a “1” to this bit, clears the bit.
0 No illegal access detected.
1 Illegal BDC access detected.
Table 5-6. BDCCSRL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
146 Freescale Semiconductor
5.4 Functional Description
5.4.1 Security
If the device resets with the system secured, the device clears the BDCCSR UNSEC bit. In the secure state
BDC access is restricted to the BDCCSR register. A mass erase can be requested using the
ERASE_FLASH command. If the mass erase is completed successfully, the device programs the security
bits to the unsecure state and sets the BDC UNSEC bit. If the mass erase is unsuccessful, the device
remains secure and the UNSEC bit is not set.
For more information regarding security, please refer to device specific security information.
5.4.2 Enabling BDC And Entering Active BDM
BDM can be activated only after being enabled. BDC is enabled by setting the ENBDC bit in the BDCCSR
register, via the single-wire interface, using the command WRITE_BDCCSR.
After being enabled, BDM is activated by one of the following1:
The BDC BACKGROUND command
A CPU BGND instruction
The DBG Breakpoint mechanism
Alternatively BDM can be activated directly from reset when resetting into Special Single Chip Mode.
The BDC is ready for receiving the first command 10 core clock cycles after the deassertion of the internal
reset signal. This is delayed relative to the external pin reset as specified in the device reset documentation.
On S12Z devices an NVM initialization phase follows reset. During this phase the BDC commands
classified as always available are carried out immediately, whereas other BDC commands are subject to
delayed response due to the NVM initialization phase.
NOTE
After resetting into SSC mode, the initial PC address must be supplied by
the host using the WRITE_Rn command before issuing the GO command.
0
ILLCMD
Illegal Command Flag — Indicates an illegal BDC command. This bit is set in the following cases:
When an unimplemented BDC command opcode is received.
When a DUMP_MEM{_WS}, FILL_MEM{_WS} or READ_SAME{_WS} is attempted in an illegal sequence.
When an active BDM command is received whilst BDM is not active
When a non Always-available command is received whilst the BDC is disabled or a flash mass erase is ongoing.
When a non Always-available command is received whilst the device is secure
Read commands return a value of 0xEE for each data byte
Writing a “1” to this bit, clears the bit.
0 No illegal command detected.
1 Illegal BDC command detected.
1. BDM active immediately out of special single-chip reset.
Table 5-6. BDCCSRL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 147
When BDM is activated, the CPU finishes executing the current instruction. Thereafter only BDC
commands can affect CPU register contents until the BDC GO command returns from active BDM to user
code or a device reset occurs. When BDM is activated by a breakpoint, the type of breakpoint used
determines if BDM becomes active before or after execution of the next instruction.
NOTE
Attempting to activate BDM using a BGND instruction whilst the BDC is
disabled, the CPU requires clock cycles for the attempted BGND execution.
However BACKGROUND commands issued whilst the BDC is disabled
are ignored by the BDC and the CPU execution is not delayed.
5.4.3 Clock Source
The BDC clock source can be mapped to a constant frequency clock source or a PLL based fast clock. The
clock source for the BDC is selected by the CLKSW bit as shown in Figure 5-5. The BDC internal clock
is named BDCSI clock. If BDCSI clock is mapped to the BDCCLK by CLKSW then the serial interface
communication is not af fected by bus/core clock frequency changes. If the BDC is mapped to BDCFCLK
then the clock is connected to a PLL derived source at device level (typically bus clock), thus can be
subject to frequency changes in application. Debugging through frequency changes requires SYNC pulses
to re-synchronize. The sources of BDCCLK and BDCFCLK are specified at device level.
BDC accesses of internal device resources always use the device co re clock. Thus if the ACK handshake
protocol is not enabled, the clock frequency relationship must be taken into account by the host.
When changing the clock source via the CLKSW bit a minimum delay of 150 cycles at the initial clock
speed must elapse before a SYNC can be sent. This guarantees that the start of the next BDC command
uses the new clock for timing subsequent BDC communications.
Figure 5-5. Clock Switch
5.4.4 BDC Commands
BDC commands can be classified into three types as shown in Table 5-7.
BDCSI Clock
Core clock
1
0
CLKSW
BDCCLK BDC serial interface
and FSM
BDC device resource
interface
BDCFCLK
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
148 Freescale Semiconductor
Non-intrusive commands are used to read and write target system memo ry locations and to enter active
BDM. Target system memory includes all memory and registers within the global memory map, including
external memory.
Active background commands are used to read and write all memory locations and CPU resources.
Furthermore they allow single stepping through application code and to exit from active BDM.
Non-intrusive commands can only be executed when the BDC is en abled and the device unsecure. Active
background commands can only be executed when the system is not secure and is in active BDM.
Non-intrusive commands do not require the system to be in active BDM for execution, although, they can
still be executed in this mode. When executing a non-intrusive command with the ACK pulse handshake
protocol disabled, the BDC steals the next bus cycle for the access. If an operation requires multiple cycles,
then multiple cycles can be stolen. Thus if stolen cycles are not free cycles, the application code execution
is delayed. The delay is negligible because the BDC serial transfer rate dictates that such accesses occur
infrequently.
For data read commands, the external host must wait at least 16 BDCSI clock cycles after sending the
address before attempting to obtain the read data. This is to be certain that valid data is available in the
BDC shift register, ready to be shifted out. For write commands, the external host must wait 16 bdcsi
cycles after sending the data to be written before attempting to send a new command. This is to avoid
disturbing the BDC shift register before the write has been completed. The external host must wa it at least
for 16 bdcsi cycles after a control command before starting any new serial command.
Table 5-7. BDC Command Types
Command Type Secure
Status BDC
Status CPU Status Command Set
Always-available Secure or
Unsecure
Enabled or
Disabled
Read/write access to BDCCSR
Mass erase flash memory using ERASE_FLASH
•SYNC
ACK enable/disable
Non-intrusive Unsecure Enabled
Code
execution
allowed
Read/write access to BDCCSR
Memory access
Memory access with status
Mass erase flash memory using ERASE_FLASH
Debug register access
BACKGROUND
•SYNC
ACK enable/disable
Active background Unsecure Active
Code
execution
halted
Read/write access to BDCCSR
Memory access
Memory access with status
Mass erase flash memory using ERASE_FLASH
Debug register access
Read or write CPU registers
Single-step the application
Exit active BDM to return to the application program (GO)
•SYNC
ACK enable/disable
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 149
If the ACK pulse handshake protocol is enabled and STEAL is cleared, then the BDC waits for the first
free bus cycle to make a non-intrusive access. If no free bus cycle occurs within 512 core clock cycles then
the BDC aborts the access, sets the NORESP bit and uses a long ACK pulse to indicate an error condition
to the host.
Table 5-8 summarizes the BDC command set. The subsequent sections describe each command in detail
and illustrate the command structure in a series of packets, each c onsisting of eight bit times starting with
a falling edge. The bar across the top of the blocks indicates that the BKGD line idles in the high state. The
time for an 8-bit command is 8 16 target BDCSI clock cycles.
The nomenclature below is used to describe the structure of the BDC commands. Commands begin with
an 8-bit hexadecimal command code in the host-to-target direction (most significant bit first)
/ = separates parts of the command
d = delay 16 target BDCSI clock cycles (DLY)
dack = delay (16 cycles) no ACK; or delay (=> 32 cycles) then ACK.(DACK)
ad24 = 24-bit memory address in the host-to-target direction
rd8 = 8 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction
rd16 = 16 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction
rd24 = 24 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction
rd32 = 32 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction
rd64 = 64 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction
rd.sz = read data, size defined by sz, in the target-to-host direction
wd8 = 8 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction
wd16 = 16 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction
wd32 = 32 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction
wd.sz = write data, size defined by sz, in the host-to-target direction
ss = the contents of BDCCSRL in the target-to-host direction
sz = memory operand size (00 = byte, 01 = word, 10 = long)
(sz = 11 is reserved and currently defaults to long)
crn = core register number, 32-bit data width
WS = command suffix signaling the operation is with status
Table 5 -8. BDC Command Summary
Command
Mnemonic Command
Classification ACK Command
Structure Description
SYNC Always
Available
N/A N/A(1) Request a timed reference pulse to
determine the target BDC communication
speed
ACK_DISABLE Always
Available
No 0x03/d Disable the communication handshake.
This command does not issue an ACK
pulse.
ACK_ENABLE Always
Available
Yes 0x02/dack Enable the communication handshake.
Issues an ACK pulse after the command is
executed.
BACKGROUND Non-Intrusive Yes 0x04/dack Halt the CPU if ENBDC is set. Otherwise,
ignore as illegal command.
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
150 Freescale Semiconductor
DUMP_MEM.sz Non-Intrusive Yes (0x32+4 x sz)/dack/rd.sz Dump (read) memory based on operand
size (sz). Used with READ_MEM to dump
large blocks of memory. An initial
READ_MEM is executed to set up the
starting address of the block and to retrieve
the first result. Subsequent DUMP_MEM
commands retrieve sequential operands.
DUMP_MEM.sz_WS Non-Intrusive No (0x33+4 x sz)/d/ss/rd.sz Dump (read) memory based on operand
size (sz) and report status. Used with
READ_MEM{_WS} to dump large blocks of
memory. An initial READ_MEM{_WS} is
executed to set up the starting address of
the block and to retrieve the first result.
Subsequent DUMP_MEM{_WS}
commands retrieve sequential operands.
FILL_MEM.sz Non-Intrusive Yes (0x12+4 x sz)/wd.sz/dack Fill (write) memory based on operand size
(sz). Used with WRITE_MEM to fill large
blocks of memory. An initial WRITE_MEM
is executed to set up the starting address of
the block and to write the first operand.
Subsequent FILL_MEM commands write
sequential operands.
FILL_MEM.sz_WS Non-Intrusive No (0x13+4 x sz)/wd.sz/d/ss Fill (write) memory based on operand size
(sz) and report status. Used with
WRITE_MEM{_WS} to fill large blocks of
memory. An initial WRITE_MEM{_WS} is
executed to set up the starting address of
the block and to write the first operand.
Subsequent FILL_MEM{_WS} commands
write sequential operands.
GO Active
Background
Yes 0x08/dack Resume CPU user code execution
GO_UNTIL(2) Active
Background
Yes 0x0C/dack Go to user program. ACK is driven upon
returning to active background mode.
NOP Non-Intrusive Yes 0x00/dack No operation
READ_Rn Active
Background
Yes (0x60+CRN)/dack/rd32 Read the requested CPU register
READ_MEM.sz Non-Intrusive Yes (0x30+4 x sz)/ad24/dack/rd.sz Read the appropriately-sized (sz) memory
value from the location specified by the 24-
bit address
READ_MEM.sz_WS Non-Intrusive No (0x31+4 x sz)/ad24/d/ss/rd.sz Read the appropriately-sized (sz) memory
value from the location specified by the 24-
bit address and report status
READ_DBGTB Non-Intrusive Yes (0x07)/dack/rd32/dack/rd32 Read 64-bits of DBG trace buffer
Table 5-8. BDC Command Summary (continued)
Command
Mnemonic Command
Classification ACK Command
Structure Description
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 151
5.4.4.1 SYNC
The SYNC command is unlike other BDC commands because the host does not necessarily know the
correct speed to use for serial communications until after it has analyzed the response to the SYNC
command.
To issue a SYNC command, the host:
1. Ensures that the BKGD pin is high for at least 4 cycles of the slowest possible BDCSI clock
without reset asserted.
2. Drives the BKGD pin low for at least 128 cycles of the slowest possible BDCSI clock.
3. Drives BKGD high for a brief speed-up pulse to get a fast rise time. (This speedup pulse is typically
one cycle of the host clock which is as fast as the maximum target BDCSI clock).
4. Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance.
5. Listens to the BKGD pin for the sync response pulse.
READ_SAME.sz Non-Intrusive Yes (0x50+4 x sz)/dack/rd.sz Read from location. An initial READ_MEM
defines the address, subsequent
READ_SAME reads return content of
same address
READ_SAME.sz_WS Non-Intrusive No (0x51+4 x sz)/d/ss/rd.sz Read from location. An initial READ_MEM
defines the address, subsequent
READ_SAME reads return content of
same address
READ_BDCCSR Always
Available
No 0x2D/rd16 Read the BDCCSR register
SYNC_PC Non-Intrusive Yes 0x01/dack/rd24 Read current PC
WRITE_MEM.sz Non-Intrusive Yes (0x10+4 x
sz)/ad24/wd.sz/dack
Write the appropriately-sized (sz) memory
value to the location specified by the 24-bit
address
WRITE_MEM.sz_WS Non-Intrusive No (0x11+4 x sz)/ad24/wd.sz/d/ss Write the appropriately-sized (sz) memory
value to the location specified by the 24-bit
address and report status
WRITE_Rn Active
Background
Yes (0x40+CRN)/wd32/dack Write the requested CPU register
WRITE_BDCCSR Always
Available
No 0x0D/wd16 Write the BDCCSR register
ERASE_FLASH Always
Available
No 0x95/d Mass erase internal flash
STEP1 (TRACE1) Active
Background
Yes 0x09/dack Execute one CPU command.
1. The SYNC command is a special operation which does not have a command code.
2. The GO_UNTIL command is identical to the GO command if ACK is not enabled.
Table 5-8. BDC Command Summary (continued)
Command
Mnemonic Command
Classification ACK Command
Structure Description
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
152 Freescale Semiconductor
Upon detecting the sync request from the host (which is a much longer low time than would ever occur
during normal BDC communications), the target:
1. Discards any incomplete command
2. Waits for BKGD to return to a logic high.
3. Delays 16 cycles to allow the host to stop driving the high speed-up pulse.
4. Drives BKGD low for 128 BDCSI clock cycles.
5. Drives a 1-cycle high speed-up pulse to force a fast rise time on BKGD.
6. Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance.
7. Clears the OVRRUN flag (if set).
The host measures the low time of this 128-cycle SYNC response pulse and determines the correct speed
for subsequent BDC communications. Typically, the host can determine the correct communication speed
within a few percent of the actual target speed and the serial protocol can easily tolerate this speed error.
If the SYNC request is detected by the target, any partially executed command is discarded. This is referred
to as a soft-reset, equivalent to a timeout in the serial communication. After the SYNC response, the target
interprets the next negative edge (issued by the host) as the start of a new BDC command or the start of
new SYNC request.
A SYNC command can also be used to abort a pending ACK pulse. This is explained in Section 5.4.8.
5.4.4.2 ACK_DISABLE
Disables the serial communication handshake protocol. The subsequent commands, issued after the
ACK_DISABLE command, do not execute the hardware handshake protocol. This command is not
followed by an ACK pulse.
5.4.4.3 ACK_ENABLE
Enables the hardware handshake protocol in the serial communication. The hardware handshake is
implemented by an acknowledge (ACK) pulse issued by the tar get MCU in response to a host command.
The ACK_ENABLE command is interpreted and executed in the BDC logic without the need to interface
Disable host/target handshake protocol Always Available
0x03
host
target
D
L
Y
Enable host/target handshake protocol Always Available
0x02
host
target
D
A
C
K
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 153
with the CPU. An ACK pulse is issued by the target device after this command is executed. This command
can be used by the host to evaluate if the target supports the hardware handshake protocol. If the target
supports the hardware handshake protocol, subsequent commands are enabled to execute the hardware
handshake protocol, otherwise this command is ignored by the target. Table 5-8 indicates which
commands support the ACK hardware handshake protocol.
For additional information about the hardware handshake protocol, refer to Section 5.4.7,” and
Section 5.4.8.”
5.4.4.4 BACKGROUND
Provided ENBDC is set, the BACKGROUND command causes the target MCU to enter active BDM as
soon as the current CPU instruction finishes. If ENBDC is cleared, the BACKGROUND command is
ignored.
A delay of 16 BDCSI clock cycles is required after the BACKGROUND command to allow the target
MCU to finish its current CPU instruction and enter active background mode before a new BDC command
can be accepted.
The host debugger must set ENBDC before attempting to send the BACKGROUND command the first
time. Normally the host sets ENBDC once at the beginning of a debug session or after a target system reset.
During debugging, the host uses GO commands to move from active BDM to application program
execution and uses the BACKGROUND command or DBG breakpoints to return to active BDM.
A BACKGROUND command issued during stop or wait modes cannot immediately force active BDM
because the WAI instruction does not end until an interrupt occurs. For the detailed mode dependency
description refer to Section 5.1.3.3.
The host can recognize this pending BDM request condition because both NORESP and WAIT are set, but
BDMACT is clear. Whilst in wait mode, with the pending BDM request, non-intrusive BDC commands
are allowed.
5.4.4.5 DUMP_MEM.sz, DUMP_MEM.sz_WS
Enter active background mode (if enabled) Non-intrusive
0x04
host
target
D
A
C
K
DUMP_MEM.sz
Read memory specified by debug address register, then
increment address Non-intrusive
0x32 Data[7-0]
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
154 Freescale Semiconductor
DUMP_MEM{_WS} is used with the READ_MEM{_WS} command to access lar g e blocks of memory.
An initial READ_MEM{_WS} is executed to set-up the starting address of the block and to retrieve the
first result. The DUMP_MEM{_WS} command retrieves subsequent operands. The initial address is
incremented by the operand size (1, 2, or 4) and saved in a temporary register. Subsequent
DUMP_MEM{_WS} commands use this address, perform the memory read, increment it by the current
operand size, and store the updated address in the temporary register . If the with-status option is specified,
the BDCCSRL status byte is returned before the read data. This status byte reflects the state after the
memory read was performed. If enabled, an ACK pulse is driven before the data bytes are transmitted. The
effect of the access size and alignment on the next address to be accessed is explained in more detail in
Section 5.4.5.2”.
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
0x36 Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
0x3A Data[31-24] Data[23-16] Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
DUMP_MEM.sz_WS
Read memory specified by debug address register with status,
then increment address Non-intrusive
0x33 BDCCSRL Data[7-0]
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
0x37 BDCCSRL Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
target
host
0x3B BDCCSRL Data[31-24] Data23-16] Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
DUMP_MEM.sz
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 155
NOTE
DUMP_MEM{_WS} is a valid command only when preceded by SYNC,
NOP, READ_MEM{_WS}, or another DUMP_MEM{_WS} command.
Otherwise, an illegal command response is returned, setting the ILLCMD
bit. NOP can be used for inter-command padding without corrupting the
address pointer.
The size field (sz) is examined each time a DUMP_MEM{_WS} command is processed, allowing the
operand size to be dynamically altered. The examples show the DUMP_MEM.B{_WS},
DUMP_MEM.W{_WS} and DUMP_MEM.L{_WS} commands.
5.4.4.6 FILL_MEM.sz, FILL_MEM.sz_WS
FILL_MEM.sz
Write memory specified by debug address register, then
increment address Non-intrusive
0x12 Data[7-0]
host
target
host
target
D
A
C
K
0x16 Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
A
C
K
0x1A Data[31-24] Data[23-16] Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
A
C
K
FILL_MEM.sz_WS
Write memory specified by debug address register with
status, then increment address Non-intrusive
0x13 Data[7-0] BDCCSRL
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
0x17 Data[15-8] Data[7-0] BDCCSRL
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
156 Freescale Semiconductor
FILL_MEM{_WS} is used with the WRITE_MEM{_WS} command to access large blocks of memory.
An initial WRITE_MEM{_WS} is executed to set up the starting address of the block and write the first
datum. If an initial WRITE_MEM{_WS} is not executed before the first FILL_MEM{_WS}, an illegal
command response is returned. The FILL_MEM{_WS} command stores subsequent operands. The initial
address is incremented by the operand size (1, 2, or 4) and saved in a temporary register. Subsequent
FILL_MEM{_WS} commands use this address, perform the memory write, increment it by the current
operand size, and store the updated address in the temporary register . If the with-status option is specified,
the BDCCSRL status byte is returned after the write data. This status byte reflects the state after the
memory write was performed. If enabled an ACK pulse is generated after the internal write access has been
completed or aborted. The effect of the access size and alignment on the next address to be accessed is
explained in more detail in Section 5.4.5.2
NOTE
FILL_MEM{_WS} is a valid command only when preceded by SYNC,
NOP, WRITE_MEM{_WS}, or another FILL_MEM{_WS} command.
Otherwise, an illegal command response is returned, setting the ILLCMD
bit. NOP can be used for inter command padding without corrupting the
address pointer.
The size field (sz) is examined each time a FILL_MEM{_WS} command is processed, allowing the
operand size to be dynamically altered. The examples show the FILL_MEM.B{_WS},
FILL_MEM.W{_WS} and FILL_MEM.L{_WS} commands.
5.4.4.7 GO
This command is used to exit active BDM and begin (or resume) execution of CPU application code. The
CPU pipeline is flushed and refilled before normal instruction execution resumes. Prefetching begins at
the current address in the PC. If any register (such as the PC) is altered by a BDC command whilst in BDM,
the updated value is used when prefetching resumes. If enabled, an ACK is driven on exiting active BDM.
If a GO command is issued whilst the BDM is inactive, an illegal command response is returned and the
ILLCMD bit is set.
0x1B Data[31-24] Data[23-16] Data[15-8] Data[7-0] BDCCSRL
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
Go Non-intrusive
0x08
host
target
D
A
C
K
FILL_MEM.sz_WS
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 157
5.4.4.8 GO_UNTIL
This command is used to exit active BDM and begin (or resume) execution of application code. The CPU
pipeline is flushed and refilled before normal instruction execution resumes. Prefetching begins at the
current address in the PC. If any register (such as the PC) is altered by a BDC command whilst in BDM,
the updated value is used when prefetching resumes.
After resuming application code execution, if ACK is enabled, the BDC awaits a return to active BDM
before driving an ACK pulse. timeouts do not apply when awaiting a GO_UNTIL command ACK.
If a GO_UNTIL is not acknowledged then a SYNC command must be issued to end the pending
GO_UNTIL.
If a GO_UNTIL command is issued whilst BDM is inactive, an illegal command response is returned and
the ILLCMD bit is set.
If ACK handshaking is disabled, the GO_UNTIL command is identical to the GO command.
5.4.4.9 NOP
NOP performs no operation and may be used as a null command where required.
5.4.4.10 READ_Rn
This command reads the selected CPU registers and returns the 32-bit result. Accesses to CPU registers
are always 32-bits wide, regardless of implemented register width. Bytes that are not implemented return
Go Until Active Background
0x0C
host
target
D
A
C
K
No operation Active Background
0x00
host
target
D
A
C
K
Read CPU register Active Background
0x60+CRN Data [31-24] Data [23-16] Data [15-8] Data [7-0]
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
158 Freescale Semiconductor
zero. The register is addressed through the CPU register number (CRN). See Section 5.4.5.1 for the CRN
address decoding. If enabled, an ACK pulse is driven before the data bytes are transmitted.
If the device is not in active BDM, this command is illegal, the ILLCMD bit is set and no access is
performed.
5.4.4.11 READ_MEM.sz, READ_MEM.sz_WS
Read data at the specified memory address. The address is transmitted as three 8-bit packets ( msb to lsb)
immediately after the command.
The hardware forces low-order address bits to zero longword accesses to ensure these accesses are on 0-
modulo-size alignments. Byte alignment details are described in Section 5.4.5.2”. If the with-status option
is specified, the BDCCSR status byte is returned before the read data. This status byte reflects the state
READ_MEM.sz
Read memory at the specified address Non-intrusive
0x30 Address[23-0] Data[7-0]
host
target
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
0x34 Address[23-0] Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
host 
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
0x38 Address[23-0] Data[31-24] Data[23-16] Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
host 
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
READ_MEM.sz_WS
Read memory at the specified addre ss with status Non-intrusive
0x31 Address[23-0] BDCCSRL Data[7-0]
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
0x35 Address[23-0] BDCCSRL Data [15-8] Data [7-0]
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
target
host
0x39 Address[23-0] BDCCSRL Data[31-24] Data[23-16] Data [15-8] Data [7-0]
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 159
after the memory read was performed. If enabled, an ACK pulse is driven before the data bytes are
transmitted.
The examples show the READ_MEM.B{_WS}, READ_MEM.W{_WS} and READ_MEM.L{_WS}
commands.
5.4.4.12 READ_DBGTB
This command is only available on devices, where the DBG module includes a trace buffer . Attempted use
of this command on devices without a traace buffer return 0x00.
Read 64 bits from the DBG trace buffer. Refer to the DBG module description for more detailed
information. If enabled an ACK pulse is generated before each 32-bit longword is ready to be read by the
host. After issuing the first ACK a timeout is still possible whilst accessing the second 32-bit longword,
since this requires separate internal accesses. The first 32-bit longword corresponds to trace buffer line
bits[31:0]; the second to trace buffer line b its[63:32]. If ACK handshaking is disabled, the host must wait
16 clock cycles (DLY) after completing the first 32-bit read before starting the second 32-bit read.
5.4.4.13 READ_SAME.sz, READ_SAME.sz_W S
Read DBG trace buffer Non-intrusive
0x07 TB Line [31-
24]
TB Line [23-
16]
TB Line [15-
8]
TB Line [7-
0]
TB Line [63-
56]
TB Line [55-
48]
TB Line [47-
40]
TB Line [39-
32]
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
READ_SAME
Read same location specified by previous READ_MEM{_WS} Non-intrusive
0x54 Data[15-8] Data[7-0]
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
READ_SAME_WS
Read same location specified by previous READ_MEM{_WS} Non-intrusive
0x55 BDCCSRL Data [15-8] Data [7-0]
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
target
host
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
160 Freescale Semiconductor
Read from location defined by the previous READ_MEM. The previous READ_MEM command defines
the address, subsequent READ_SAME commands return contents of same address. The example shows
the sequence for reading a 16-bit word size. Byte alignment details are described in Section 5.4.5.2”. If
enabled, an ACK pulse is driven before the data bytes are transmitted.
NOTE
READ_SAME{_WS} is a valid command only when preceded by SYNC,
NOP, READ_MEM{_WS}, or another READ_SAME{_WS} command.
Otherwise, an illegal command response is returned, setting the ILLCMD
bit. NOP can be used for inter-command padding without corrupting the
address pointer.
5.4.4.14 READ_BDCCSR
Read the BDCCSR status register. This command can be executed in any mode.
5.4.4.15 SYNC_PC
This command returns the 24-bit CPU PC value to the host. Unsuccessful SYNC_PC accesses return 0xEE
for each byte. If enabled, an ACK pulse is driven before the data bytes are transmitted. The value of 0x EE
is returned if a timeout occurs, whereby NORESP is set. This can occur if the CPU is executing the WAI
instruction, or the STOP instruction with BDCCIS clear, or if a CPU access is delayed by EWAIT. If the
CPU is executing the ST OP instruction and BDCCIS is set, then SYNC_PC returns the PC addre ss of the
instruction following STOP in the code listing.
This command can be used to dynamically access the PC for performance monitoring as the execution of
this command is considerably less intrusive to the real-time operation of an application than a
BACKGROUND/read-PC/GO command sequence. Whilst the BDC is not in active BDM, SYNC_PC
returns the PC address of the instruction currently being executed by the CPU. In active BDM, SYNC_PC
returns the address of the next instruction to be executed on returning from active BDM. Thus following
a write to the PC in active BDM, a SYNC_PC returns that written value.
Read BDCCSR Status Register Always Available
0x2D BDCCSR
[15:8]
BDCCSR
[7-0]
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
target
host
Sample current PC Non-intrusive
0x01 PC
data[23–16]
PC
data[15–8]
PC
data[7–0]
host
target
D
A
C
K
target
host
target
host
target
host
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 161
5.4.4.16 WRITE_MEM.sz, WRITE_MEM.sz_WS
Write data to the specified memory address. The address is transmitted a s three 8-bit packets (msb to lsb)
immediately after the command.
If the with-status option is specified, the status byte contained in BDCCSRL is returned after the write data.
This status byte reflects the state after the memory write was performed. The examples show the
WRITE_MEM.B{_WS}, WRITE_MEM.W{_WS}, and WRITE_MEM.L{_WS} commands. If enabled
an ACK pulse is generated after the internal write access has been completed or aborted.
The hardware forces low-order address bits to zero longword accesses to ensure these accesses are on 0-
modulo-size alignments. Byte alignment details are described in Section 5.4.5.2”.
WRITE_MEM.sz
Write memory at the specified address Non-intrusive
0x10 Address[23-0] Data[7–0]
host
target host target host
target
D
A
C
K
0x14 Address[23-0] Data[15–8] Data[7–0]
host
target host target host
target
host
target
D
A
C
K
0x18 Address[23-0] Data[31–24] Data[23–16] Data[15–8] Data[7–0]
host
target host target host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
A
C
K
WRITE_MEM.sz_WS
Write memory at the specified address with status Non-intrusive
0x11 Address[23-0] Data[7–0] BDCCSRL
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
0x15 Address[23-0] Data[15–8] Data[7–0] BDCCSRL
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
0x19 Address[23-0] Data[31–24] Data[23–16] Data[15–8] Data[7–0] BDCCSRL
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
L
Y
target
host
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
162 Freescale Semiconductor
5.4.4.17 WRITE_Rn
If the device is in active BDM, this command writes the 32-bit operand to the selected CPU general-
purpose register. See Section 5.4.5.1 for the CRN details. Accesses to CPU registers are always 32-bits
wide, regardless of implemented register width. If enabled an ACK pulse is generated after the internal
write access has been completed or aborted.
If the device is not in active BDM, this command is rejected as an illegal operation, the ILLCMD bit is set
and no operation is performed.
5.4.4.18 WRITE_BDCCSR
16-bit write to the BDCCSR register. No ACK pulse is generated. Writing to this register can be used to
configure control bits or clear flag bits. Refer to the register bit descriptions.
5.4.4.19 ERASE_FLASH
Mass erase the internal flash. This command can always be issued. On receiving this command twice in
succession, the BDC sets the ERASE bit in BDCCSR and requests a flash mass erase. Any other BDC
command following a single ERASE_FLASH initializes the sequence, such that thereafter the
ERASE_FLASH must be applied twice in succession to request a mass erase. If 512 BDCSI clock cycles
elapse between the consecutive ERASE_FLASH commands then a timeout occurs, which forces a soft
reset and initializes the sequence. The ERASE bit is cleared when the mass erase sequence has been
completed. No ACK is driven.
Wri te ge ne ral-purpose CPU register Active Background
0x40+CRN Data [31–24] Data [23–16] Data [15–8] Data [7–0]
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
host
target
D
A
C
K
Write BDCCSR Always Available
0x0D BDCCSR
Data [15-8]
BDCCSR
Data [7-0]
host
target
D
L
Y
host
target
host
target
Erase FLASH Always Available
0x95
host
target
D
L
Y
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 163
During the mass erase operation, which takes many clock cycles, the command status is indicated by the
ERASE bit in BDCCSR. Whilst a mass erase operation is ongoing, Always-available commands can be
issued. This allows the status of the erase operation to be polled by reading BDCCSR to determine when
the operation is finished.
The status of the flash array can be verified by subsequently reading the flash error flags to determine if
the erase completed successfully.
ERASE_FLASH can be aborted by a SYNC pulse forcing a soft reset.
NOTE: Device Bus Frequency Considerations
The ERASE_FLASH command requires the default device bus clock
frequency after reset. Thus the bus clock frequency must not be changed
following reset before issuing an ERASE_FLASH command.
5.4.4.20 STEP1
This command is used to step through application code. In active BDM this command executes the next
CPU instruction in application code. If enabled an ACK is driven.
If a STEP1 command is issued and the CPU is not halted, the command is ignored.
Using STEP1 to step through a CPU WAI instruction is explained in Section 5.1.3.3.2.
5.4.5 BDC Access Of Internal Resources
Unsuccessful read accesses of internal resources return a value of 0xEE for each data byte. This enables a
debugger to recognize a potential error, even if neither the ACK handshaking protocol nor a status
command is currently being executed. The value of 0xEE is returned in the following cases.
Illegal address access, whereby ILLACC is set
Invalid READ_SAME or DUMP_MEM sequence
Invalid READ_Rn command (BDM inactive or CRN incorrect)
Internal resource read with timeout, whereby NORESP is set
5.4.5.1 BDC Access Of CPU Registers
The CRN field of the READ_Rn and WRITE_Rn commands contains a pointer to the CPU registers. The
mapping of CRN to CPU registers is shown in Table 5-9. Accesses to CPU registers are always 32-bits
wide, regardless of implemented register width. This means that the BDC data transmission for these
Step1 Active Background
0x09
host
target
D
A
C
K
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
164 Freescale Semiconductor
commands is 32-bits long. The valid bits of the transf er are listed in the Valid Data Bits column. The other
bits of the transmission are redundant.
Attempted accesses of CPU registers using a CRN of 0xD,0xE or 0xF is invalid, returning the value 0xEE
for each byte and setting the ILLACC bit.
5.4.5.2 BDC Access Of Device Memory Mapped Resources
The device memory map is accessed using READ_MEM, DUMP_MEM, WRITE_MEM, FILL_MEM
and READ_SAME, which support different access sizes, as explained in the command descriptions.
When an unimplemented command occurs during a DUMP_MEM, FILL_MEM or READ_SAME
sequence, then that sequence is ended.
Illegal read accesses return a value of 0xEE for each byte. After an illegal access FILL_MEM and
READ_SAME commands are not valid, and it is necessary to restart the internal access sequence with
READ_MEM or WRITE_MEM. An illegal access does not break a DUMP_MEM sequence. After read
accesses that cause the RDINV bit to be set, DUMP_MEM and READ_SAME commands are valid, it is
not necessary to restart the access sequence with a READ_MEM.
The hardware forces low-order address bits to zero for longword accesses to ensure these accesses are
realigned to 0-modulo-size alignments.
Word accesses map to 2-bytes from within a 4-byte field as shown in Table 5-10. Thus if address bits [1:0]
are both logic “1” the access is realigned so that it does not straddle the 4-byte boundary but accesses data
from within the addressed 4-byte field.
Table 5-9. CPU Register Number (CRN) Mapping
CPU Register Valid Dat a Bits Command Opcode Command Opcode
D0 [7:0] WRITE_D0 0x40 READ_D0 0x60
D1 [7:0] WRITE_D1 0x41 READ_D1 0x61
D2 [15:0] WRITE_D2 0x42 READ_D2 0x62
D3 [15:0] WRITE_D3 0x43 READ_D3 0x63
D4 [15:0] WRITE_D4 0x44 READ_D4 0x64
D5 [15:0] WRITE_D5 0x45 READ_D5 0x65
D6 [31:0] WRITE_D6 0x46 READ_D6 0x66
D7 [31:0] WRITE_D7 0x47 READ_D7 0x67
X [23:0] WRITE_X 0x48 READ_X 0x68
Y [23:0] WRITE_Y 0x49 READ_Y 0x69
SP [23:0] WRITE_SP 0x4A READ_SP 0x6A
PC [23:0] WRITE_PC 0x4B READ_PC 0x6B
CCR [15:0] WRITE_CCR 0x4C READ_CCR 0x6C
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 165
Table 5-10. Field Location to Byte Access Mapping
5.4.5.2.1 FILL_MEM and DUMP_MEM Increments and Alignment
FILL_MEM and DUMP_MEM increment the previou sly accessed address by the previous access size to
calculate the address of the current access. On misaligned longword accesses, the address bits [1:0] are
forced to zero, therefore the following FILL_MEM or DUMP_MEM increment to the first address in the
next 4-byte field. This is shown in Table 5-11, the address of the first DUMP_MEM.32 following
READ_MEM.32 being calculated from 0x004000+4.
When misaligned word accesses are realigned, then the original address (not the realigned address) is
incremented for the following FILL_MEM, DUMP_MEM command.
Misaligned word accesses can cause the same locations to be read twice as shown in rows 6 and 7. The
hardware ensures alignment at an attempted misaligned word access across a 4-byte boundary, as shown
in row 7. The following word access in row 8 continues from the realigned address of row 7.
d
Address[1:0] Access Size 00 01 10 11 Note
00 32-bit Dat a[31:24] Data[23:16] Data [15:8] Data [7:0]
01 32-bit Dat a[31:24] Data[23:16] Data [15:8] Data [7:0] Realigned
10 32-bit Dat a[31:24] Data[23:16] Data [15:8] Data [7:0] Realigned
11 32-bit Dat a[31:24] Data[23:16] Data [15:8] Data [7:0] Realigned
00 16-bit Data [15:8] Data [7:0]
01 16-bit Data [15:8] Data [7:0]
10 16-bit Data [15:8] Data [7:0]
11 16-bit Data [15:8] Data [7:0] Realigned
00 8-bit Dat a [7:0]
01 8-bit Data [7:0]
10 8-bit Data [7:0]
11 8-bit Data [7:0]
Denotes byte that is not transmitted
Table 5-11. Consecutive Accesses With Variable Size
Row Command Ad dress Address[1:0] 00 01 10 11
1 READ_MEM.32 0x004003 11 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
2 DUMP_MEM.32 0x004004 00 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
3 DUMP_MEM.16 0x004008 00 Accessed Accessed
4 DUMP_MEM.16 0x00400A 10 Accessed Accessed
5 DUMP_MEM.08 0x00400C 00 Accessed
6 DUMP_MEM.16 0x00400D 01 Accessed Accessed
7 DUMP_MEM.16 0x00400E 10 Accessed Accessed
8 DUMP_MEM.16 0x004010 01 Accessed Accessed
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
166 Freescale Semiconductor
5.4.5.2.2 READ_SAME Effects Of Variable Access Size
READ_SAME uses the unadjusted address given in the previous READ_MEM command as a base
address for subsequent READ_SAME commands. When the READ_MEM and READ_SAME size
parameters differ then READ_SAME uses the original base address buts aligns 32-bit and 16-bit accesses,
where those accesses would otherwise cross the aligned 4-byte boundary. Table 5-12 shows some
examples of this.
d
5.4.6 BDC Serial Interface
The BDC communicates with external devices serially via the BKGD pin. During reset, this pin is a mode
select input which selects between normal and special modes of operation. After reset, this pin becomes
the dedicated serial interface pin for the BDC.
The BDC serial interface uses an internal clock source, selected by the CLKSW bit in the BDCCSR
register. This clock is referred to as the target clock in the following explanation.
Table 5-12. Consecutive READ_SAME Accesses With Variable Size
Row Command Base Address 00 01 10 11
1 READ_MEM.32 0x004003 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
2 READ_SAME.32 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
3 READ_SAME.16 Accessed Accessed
4 READ_SAME.08 Accessed
5 READ_MEM.08 0x004000 Accessed
6 READ_SAME.08 Accessed
7 READ_SAME.16 Accessed Accessed
8 READ_SAME.32 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
9 READ_MEM.08 0x004002 Accessed
10 READ_SAME.08 Accessed
11 READ_SAME.16 Accessed Accessed
12 READ_SAME.32 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
13 READ_MEM.08 0x004003 Accessed
14 READ_SAME.08 Accessed
15 READ_SAME.16 Accessed Accessed
16 READ_SAME.32 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
17 READ_MEM.16 0x004001 Accessed Accessed
18 READ_SAME.08 Accessed
19 READ_SAME.16 Accessed Accessed
20 READ_SAME.32 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
21 READ_MEM.16 0x004003 Accessed Accessed
22 READ_SAME.08 Accessed
23 READ_SAME.16 Accessed Accessed
24 READ_SAME.32 Accessed Accessed Accessed Accessed
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 167
The BDC serial interface uses a clocking scheme in which the external host generates a falling edge on the
BKGD pin to indicate the start of each bit time. This falling edge is sent for every bit whether data is
transmitted or received. Data is transferred most significant bit (MSB) first at 16 target clock cycles per
bit. The interface times out if during a command 512 clock cycles occur between falling edges from the
host. The timeout forces the current command to be discarded.
The BKGD pin is a pseudo open-drain pin and has a weak on-chip active pull-up that is enabled at all
times. It is assumed that there is an external pull-up and that drivers connected to BKGD do not typically
drive the high level. Since R-C rise time could be unacceptably long, the target system and host provide
brief drive-high (speedup) pulses to drive BKGD to a logic 1. The source of this speedup pulse is the host
for transmit cases and the target for receive cases.
The timing for host-to-target is shown in Figure 5-6 and that of target-to-host in Figure 5-7 and
Figure 5-8. All cases begin when the host drives the BKGD pin low to generate a falling edge. Since the
host and target operate from separate clocks, it can take the target up to one full clock cycle to recognize
this edge; this synchronization uncertainty is illustrated in Figure 5-6. The target measures delays from this
perceived start of the bit time while the host me asures delays fr om the point it actually drove BKGD low
to start the bit up to one target clock cycle earlier. Synchronization between the host and target is
established in this manner at the start of every bit time.
Figure 5-6 shows an external host transmitting a logic 1 and transmitting a logic 0 to the BKGD pin of a
target system. The host is asynchronous to the target, so there is up to a one clock-cycle delay from the
host-generated falling edge to where the target recognizes this edge as the beginning of the bit time. Ten
target clock cycles later, the target senses the bit level on the BKGD pin. Internal glitch detect logic
requires the pin be driven high no later than eight target clock cycles after the falling edge for a logic 1
transmission.
Since the host drives the high speedup pulses in these two cases, the rising edges look like digitally driven
signals.
Figure 5-6. BDC Host-to-Target Serial Bit Timing
Figure 5-7 shows the host receiving a logic 1 from the target system. The host holds the BKGD pin low
long enough for the target to recognize it (at least two target clock cycles). The host must release the low
EARLIEST START
TARGET SENSES BIT LEVEL
10 CYCLES
SYNCHRONIZATION
UNCERTAINTY
BDCSI clock
(TARGET MCU)
HOST
TRANSMIT 1
HOST
TRANSMIT 0
PERCEIVED START
OF BIT TIME
OF NEXT BIT
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
168 Freescale Semiconductor
drive at the latest after 6 clock cycles, before the target drives a brief high speedup pulse seven target clock
cycles after the perceived start of the bit time. The host should sample the bit level about 10 target clock
cycles after it started the bit time.
Figure 5-7. BDC Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 1)
Figure 5-8 shows the host receiving a logic 0 from the target. The host initia tes the bit time but the target
finishes it. Since the target wants the host to receive a logic 0, it drives the BKGD pin low for 13 target
clock cycles then briefly drives it high to speed up the rising edge. The host samples the bit level about 10
target clock cycles after starting the bit time.
HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN
10 CYCLES
BDCSI clock
(TARGET MCU)
HOST DRIVE
TO BKGD PIN
TARGET M CU
SPEEDUP PULSE
PERCEIVED START
OF BIT TIME
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
HIGH-IMPEDANCE HIGH-IMPEDANCE
BKGD PIN
R-C RISE
10 CYCLES
EARLIEST START
OF NEXT BIT
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 169
Figure 5-8. BDC Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 0)
5.4.7 Serial Interface Hardware Handshake (ACK Pulse) Protocol
BDC commands are processed internally at the device core clock rate. Since the BDCSI clock can be
asynchronous relative to the bus frequency, a handshake protocol is provided so the host can determine
when an issued command has been executed. This section describes the hardware handshake protocol.
The hardware handshake protocol signals to the host controller when a BDC command has been exec uted
by the target. This protocol is implemented by a low pulse (16 BDCSI clock cycles) followed by a brief
speedup pulse on the BKGD pin, generated by the tar get MCU when a command, issued by the host, has
been successfully executed (see Figure 5-9). This pulse is referred to as the ACK pulse. After the ACK
pulse has finished, the host can start the bit retrieval if the last issued command was a read command, or
start a new command if the last command was a write command or a control command.
Figure 5-9. Target Acknowledge Pulse (ACK)
10 CYCLES
BDCSI clock
(TARGET MCU)
HOST DRIVE
TO BKGD PIN
TARGET M CU
DRIVE AND
PERCEIVED START
OF BIT TIME
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
BKGD PIN
10 CYCLES
SPEED-UP PULSE
SPEEDUP
PULSE
EARLIEST START
OF NEXT BIT
HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN
16 CYCLES
BDCSI clock
(TARGET MCU)
TARGET
TRANSMITS
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
BKGD PIN
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
MINIMUM DELAY
FROM THE BDC COMMAND
32 CYCLES
EARLIEST
START OF
NEXT BIT
SPEED UP PULSE
16th CYCLE OF THE
LAST COMMAND BIT
ACK PULSE
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
170 Freescale Semiconductor
The handshake protocol is enabled by the ACK_ENABLE command. The BDC sends an ACK pulse when
the ACK_ENABLE command has been completed. This feature can be used by the host to evaluate if the
target supports the hardware handshake protocol. If an ACK pulse is issued in response to this command,
the host knows that the target supports the hardware handshake protocol.
Unlike the normal bit transfer, where the host initiates the transmission by issuing a negative edge on the
BKGD pin, the serial interface ACK handshake pulse is initiated by the target MCU by issuing a negative
edge on the BKGD pin. Figure 5-9 specifies the timing when the BKGD pin is being driven. The host must
follow this timing constraint in order to avoid the risk of an electrical conflict at the BKGD pin.
When the handshake protocol is enabled, the STEAL bit in BDCCSR selects if bus cycle stealing is used
to gain immediate access. If STEAL is cleared, the BDC is configured for low priority bus access using
free cycles, without stealing cycles. This guarantees that BDC accesses remain truly non-intrusive to not
affect the system timing during debugging. If STEAL is set, the BDC gains immediate access, if necessary
stealing an internal bus cycle.
NOTE
If bus steals are disabled then a loop with no free cycles cannot allow access.
In this case the host must recognize repeated NORESP messages and then
issue a BACKGROUND command to stop the target and access the data.
Figure 5-10 shows the ACK handshake protocol without steal in a command level timing diagram. The
READ_MEM.B command is used as an example. First, the 8-bit command code is sent by the host,
followed by the address of the memory location to be read. The target BDC decodes the command. Then
an internal access is requested by the BDC. When a free bus cycle occurs the READ_MEM.B operation
is carried out. If no free cycle occurs within 512 core clock cycles then the access is aborted, the NORESP
flag is set and the target generates a Long-ACK pulse.
Having retrieved the data, the BDC issues an ACK pulse to the host controller, indicating that the
addressed byte is ready to be retrieved. After detecting the ACK pulse, the host initiates the data read part
of the command.
Figure 5-10. Handshake Protocol at Command Level
Alternatively, setting the STEAL bit configures the handshake protocol to make an immediate internal
access, independent of free bus cycles.
READ_MEM.B
BDC ISSUES THE
BYTE IS NEW BDC COMMAND
BKGD PIN ADDRESS[23–0]
MCU EXECUTES THE
READ_MEM.B
COMMAND
RETRIEVED
HOST T ARGET
HOST TARGET
HOST T ARGET
BDC DECODES
THE COMMAND
ACK PULSE (NOT TO SCALE)
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 171
The ACK handshake protocol does not support nested ACK pulses. If a BDC command is not
acknowledged by an ACK pulse, the host needs to abort the pending command first in order to be able to
issue a new BDC command. The host can decide to abort any possible pending ACK pulse in order to be
sure a new command can be issued. Therefore, the protocol provides a mechanism in which a command,
and its corresponding ACK, can be aborted.
Commands With-Status do not generate an ACK, thus if ACK is enabled and a With-Status command is
issued, the host must use the 512 cycle timeout to calculate when the data is ready for retrieval.
5.4.7.1 Long-ACK Hardware Handshake Protocol
If a command results in an error condition, whereby a BDCCSRL flag is set, then the target generates a
“Long-ACK” low pulse of 64 BDCSI clock cycles, followed by a brief speed pulse. This indicates to the
host that an error has occurred. The host can subsequently read BDCCSR to determine the type of error.
Whether normal ACK or Long-ACK, the ACK pulse is not issued earlier than 32 BDCSI clock cycles after
the BDC command was issued. The end of the BDC command is assumed to be the 16th BDCSI clock
cycle of the last bit. The 32 cycle minimum delay dif fers from the 16 cycle delay time with ACK disabled.
If a BDC access request does not gain access within 512 core clock cycles, the request is aborted, the
NORESP flag is set and a Long-ACK pulse is transmitted to indicate an error case.
Following a STOP or WAI instruction, if the BDC is enabled, the first ACK, following stop or wait mode
entry is a long ACK to indicate an exception.
5.4.8 Hardware Handshake Abort Procedure
The abort procedure is based on the SYNC command. To abort a command that has not responded with an
ACK pulse, the host controller generates a sync request (by driving BKGD low for at least 128 BDCSI
clock cycles and then driving it high for one BDCSI clock cycle as a speedup pulse). By detecting this long
low pulse in the BKGD pin, the target executes the SYNC protocol, see Section 5.4.4.1”, and assumes that
the pending command and therefore the related ACK pulse are being aborted. After the SYNC protocol
has been completed the host is free to issue new BDC commands.
The host can issue a SYNC close to the 128 clock cycles length, providing a small overhead on the pulse
length to assure the sync pulse is not misinterpreted by the target. See Section 5.4.4.1”.
Figure 5-11 shows a SYNC command being issued after a READ_MEM, which aborts the READ_MEM
command. Note that, after the command is aborted a new command is issued by the host.
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
172 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 5-11. ACK Abort Procedure at the Command Level (Not To Scale)
Figure 5-12 shows a conflict between the ACK pulse and the SYNC request pulse. The tar get is executing
a pending BDC command at the exact moment the host is being connected to the BKGD pin. In this case,
an ACK pulse is issued simultaneously to the SYNC command. Thus there is an electrical conflict between
the ACK speedup pulse and the SYNC pulse. As this is not a probable situation, the protocol does not
prevent this conflict from happening.
Figure 5-12. ACK Pulse and SYNC Request Conflict
5.4.9 Hardware Handshake Disabled (ACK Pulse Disabled)
The default state of the BDC after reset is hardware handshake protocol disabled. It can also be disabled
by the ACK_DISABLE BDC command. This provides backwards compatibility with the existing host
devices which are not able to execute the hardware handshake protocol. For host devices that support the
hardware handshake protocol, true non-intrusive debugging and error flagging is offered.
If the ACK pulse protocol is disabled, the host needs to use the worst case delay time at the appropriate
places in the protocol.
READ_MEM.B READ_BDCCSR
BKGD PIN ADDRESS[23-0]
HOST T ARGET
BDC DECODES
READ_MEM.B CMD
IS ABORTED BY THE SYNC REQUEST
NEW BDC COMMAND
AND TRYS TO EXECUTE
HOST T ARGET HOST T ARGET
SYNC RESPONSE
FROM THE TARGET
NEW BDC COMMAND
(NOT TO SCALE) (NOT TO SCALE)
BDCSI clock
(TARGET MCU)
TARGET M CU
DRIVES TO
BKGD PIN
BKGD PIN
16 CYCLES
SPEEDUP PULSE
HIGH-IMPEDANCE
HOST
DRIVES SYNC
TO BKGD PIN
HOST AND TARGET
ACK PULSE
HOST SYNC REQUEST PULSE
AT LEAST 128 CYCLES
ELECTRICAL CONFLICT
DRIVE TO BKGD PIN
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 173
If the handshake protocol is disabled, the access is always independent of free cycles, whereby BDC has
higher priority than CPU. Since at least 2 bytes (command byte + data byte) are transferred over BKGD
the maximum intrusiveness is only once every few hundred cycles.
After decoding an internal access command, the BDC then awaits the next internal core clock cycle. The
relationship between BDCSI clock and core clock must be considered. If the host retrieves the data
immediately, then the BDCSI clock frequency must not be more than 4 times the core clock frequency, in
order to guarantee that the BDC gains bus access within 16 the BDCSI cycle DLY period following an
access command. If the BDCSI clock frequency is more than 4 times the core clock frequency, then the
host must use a suitable delay time before retrieving data (see 5.5.1/5-174). Furthermore, for stretched read
accesses to external resources via a device expanded bus (if implemented) the potential extra stretch cycles
must be taken into consideration before attempting to obtain read data.
If the access does not succeed before the host starts data retrieval then the NORESP flag is set but the
access is not aborted. The NORESP state can be used by the host to recognize an unexpected access
conflict due to stretched expanded bus accesses. Although the NORESP bit is set when an access does not
succeed before the start of data retrieval, the access may succeed in following bus cycles if the internal
access has already been initiated.
5.4.10 Single Stepping
When a STEP1 command is issued to the BDC in active BDM, the CPU executes a single instruction in
the user code and returns to active BDM. The STEP1 command can be issued repeatedly to step through
the user code one instruction at a time.
If an interrupt is pending when a STEP1 command is issued, the interrupt stacking operation occurs but
no user instruction is executed. In this case the stacking counts as one instruction. The device re-enters
active BDM with the program counter pointing to the first instruction in the interrupt service routine.
When stepping through the user code, the execution of the user code is done step by step but peripherals
are free running. Some peripheral modules include a freeze feature, whereby their cloc ks are halted when
the device enters active BDM. Timer modules typically include the freeze feature. Serial interface modules
typically do not include the freeze feature. Hence possible timing rela tions between CPU code execution
and occurrence of events of peripherals no longer exist.
If the handshake protocol is enabled and BDCCIS is set then stepping over the STOP instruction causes
the Long-ACK pulse to be generated and the BDCCSR STOP flag to be set. When stop mode is exited due
to an interrupt the device enters active BDM and the PC points to the start of the corresponding interrupt
service routine. Stepping can be continued.
S tepping over a WAI instruction, the STEP1 command cannot be finished because active BDM cannot be
entered after CPU starts to execute the WAI instruction.
Stepping over the WAI instruction causes the BDCCSR WAIT and NORESP flags to be set and, if the
handshake protocol is enabled, then the Long-ACK pulse is generated. Then the device enters wait mode,
clears the BDMACT bit and awaits an interrupt to leave wait mode. In this time non-intrusive BDC
commands are possible, although the STEP1 has actually not finished. When an interrupt occurs the device
leaves wait mode, enters active BDM and the PC points to the start of the corresponding interrupt service
routine. A further ACK related to stepping over the WAI is not generated.
Chapter 5 Background Debug Controller (S12ZBDCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
174 Freescale Semiconductor
5.4.11 Serial Communication Timeout
The host initiates a host-to-target serial transmission by generating a falling edge on the BKGD pin. If
BKGD is kept low for more than 128 target clock cycles, the target understands that a SYNC command
was issued. In this case, the target waits f or a risi ng edge on BKGD in order to answer the SYNC requ est
pulse. When the BDC detects the rising edge a soft reset is generated, whereby the current BDC command
is discarded. If the rising edge is not detected, the target keeps waiting forever without any timeout limit.
If a falling edge is not detected by the target within 512 clock cycles since the last falling edge, a timeout
occurs and the current command is discarded without affecting memory or the operating mode of the
MCU. This is referred to as a soft-reset. This timeout also applies if 512 cycles elapse between 2
consecutive ERASE_FLASH commands. The soft reset is disabled whilst the internal flash mass erase
operation is pending completion.
timeouts are also possible if a BDC command is partially issued, or data partially retrieved. Thus if a time
greater than 512 BDCSI clock cycles is observed between two consecutive negative edges, a soft-reset
occurs causing the partially received command or data retrieved to be discarded. The next negative edge
at the BKGD pin, after a soft-reset has occurred, is considered by the target as the start of a new BDC
command, or the start of a SYNC request pulse.
5.5 Application Information
5.5.1 Clock Frequency Considerations
Read commands without status and without ACK must consider the frequency relationship between
BDCSI and the internal core clock. If the core clock is slow, then the internal access may not have been
carried out within the standard 16 BDCSI cycle delay period (DLY). The host must then extend the DLY
period or clock frequencies accordingly. Taking internal clock domain synchronizers into account, the
minimum number of BDCSI periods required for the DLY is expressed by:
#DLY > 3(f(BDCSI clock) / f(core clock)) + 4
and the minimum core clock frequency with respect to BDCSI clock frequency is expressed by
Minimum f(core clock) = (3/(#DLY cycles -4))f(BDCSI clock)
For the standard 16 period DLY this yields f(core clock)>= (1/4)f(BDCSI clock)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 175
Chapter 6
S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
6.1 Introduction
The DBG module provides on-chip breakpoints and trace buffer with flexible triggering capability to allow
non-intrusive debug of application software. The DBG module is optimized for the S12Z architecture and
allows debugging of CPU module operations.
Typically the DBG module is used in conjunction with the BDC module, whereby the user configures the
DBG module for a debugging session over the BDC interface. Once configured the DBG module is armed
and the device leaves active BDM returning control to the user program, which is then monitored by the
DBG module. Alternatively the DBG module can be configured over a serial interface using SWI routines.
6.1.1 Glossary
Table 6-1. Revision History Table
Revision
Number Revision
Date Sections
Affected Description Of Changes
2.04 19.APR.2012 Section 6.4.5.2.1 Documented DBGTB read dependency on PROFILE bit
2.05 23.MAY.2012 General Formatting changes to support DBGV3 from single source
2.06 10.SEP.2012 Section 6.4.5.3 Added NOTE about PC trace buffer entries for Comp D timestamps
2.07 18.OCT.2012 General Formatting corrections
2.08 16.NOV.2012 Section 6.5.1 Modified step over breakpoint information
2.09 19.DEC.2012 General Formatting corrections
2.10 28.JUN.2013 General
Section 6.3.2.21
Section 6.3.2.1
Section 6.3.2.5
Emphasized need to set TSOURCE for tracing or profiling
Corrected DBGCDM write access dependency
Corrrected ARM versus PTACT dependency
Modified DBGTBH read access dependencies
2.11 15.JUL.2013 Section 6.3.2 Added explicit names to state control register bit fields
Table 6-2. Glossary Of Terms
Term Definition
COF Change Of Flow.
Change in the program flow due to a conditional branch, indexed jump or interrupt
PC Program Counter
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
176 Freescale Semiconductor
6.1.2 Overview
The comparators monitor the bus activity of the CPU. A single comparator match or a series of matches
can trigger bus tracing and/or generate breakpoints. A state sequencer determines if the correct series of
matches occurs. Similarly an external event can trigger bus tracing and/or generate breakpoints.
The trace buffer is visible through a 2- byte window in the register address map and can be read out using
standard 16-bit word reads.
6.1.3 Features
Four comparators (A, B, C, and D)
Comparators A and C compare the full address bus and full 32-bit data bus
Comparators A and C feature a data bus mask register
Comparators B and D compare the full address bus only
Each comparator can be configured to monitor PC addresses or addresses of data accesses
Each comparator can select either read or write access cycles
Comparator matches can force state sequencer state transitions
Three comparator modes
Simple address/data comparator match mode
Inside address range mode, Addmin Address Addmax
Outside address range match mode, Address Addminor Address Addmax
State sequencer control
State transitions forced by comparator matches
State transitions forced by software write to TRIG
State transitions forced by an external event
The following types of breakpoints
CPU breakpoint entering active BDM on breakpoint (BDM)
CPU breakpoint executing SWI on breakpoint (SWI)
Trace control
BDM Background Debug Mode.
In this mode CPU application code execution is halted.
Execution of BDC “active BDM” commands is possible.
BDC Background Debug Controller
WORD 16-bit data entity
Data Line 64-bit data entity
CPU S12Z CPU module
Trigger A trace buffer input that triggers tracing start, end or mid point
Table 6-2. Glossary Of Terms
Term Definition
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 177
Tracing session triggered by state sequencer
Begin, End, and Mid alignment of tracing to trigger
Four trace modes
Normal: change of flow (COF) PC information is stored (see Section 6.4.5.2.1) for change of
flow definition.
Loop1: same as Normal but inhibits consecutive duplicate source address entries
Detail: address and data for all read/write access cycles are stored
Pure PC: All program counter addresses are stored.
2 Pin (data and clock) profiling interface
Output of code flow information
6.1.4 Modes of Operation
The DBG module can be used in all MCU functional modes.
The DBG module can issue breakpoint requests to force the device to enter active BDM or an SWI ISR.
The BDC BACKGROUND command is also handled by the DBG to force the device to enter active BDM.
When the device enters active BDM through a BACKGROUND command with the DBG module armed,
the DBG remains armed.
6.1.5 Block Diagram
B
Figure 6-1. Debug Module Block Diagram
CPU BUS
TRACE BUFFER
BUS INTERFACE
MATCH0
COMPARATOR B
COMPARATOR C
COMPARATOR D
COMPARATOR A STATE SEQUENCER
MATCH1
MATCH2
MATCH3
TRACE
READ TRACE DATA (DBG READ DATA BUS)
CONTROL
BREAKPOINT
COMPARATOR
MATCH CONTROL
TRIGGER
AND
EVENT CONTROL
REQUESTS
REGISTERS TRIG
PROFILE
OUTPUT
EXTERNAL EVENT
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
178 Freescale Semiconductor
6.2 External Signal Description
6.2.1 External Event Input
The DBG module features an external event input signal, DBGEEV. The mapping of this signal to a device
pin is specified in the device specific documentation. This function can be enabled and configured by the
EEVE field in the DBGC1 control register. This signal is input only and allows an external event to force
a state sequencer transition, or trace buffer entry, or to gate trace buffer entries. With the external event
function enabled, a falling edge at the external event pin constitutes an event. Rising edges have no effect.
If configured for gating trace buffer entries, then a low level at the pin allows entries, but a high level
suppresses entries. The maximum frequency of events is half the internal core bus frequency . The function
is explained in the EEVE field description.
NOTE
Due to input pin synchronization circuitry, the DBG module sees external
events 2 bus cycles after they occur at the pin. Thus an external event
occurring less than 2 bus cycles before arming the DBG module is perceived
to occur whilst the DBG is armed.
When the device is in stop mode the synchronizer clocks are disabled and
the external events are ignored.
6.2.2 Profiling Output
The DBG module features a profiling data output signal PDO. The mapping of this signal to a device pin
is specified in the device specific documentation. The device pin is enabled for profiling by setting the
PDOE bit. The profiling function can be enabled by the PROFILE bit in the DBGTCRL control register.
This signal is output only and provides a serial, encoded data stream that can be used by external
development tools to reconstruct the internal CPU code flow, as specified in Section 6.4.6. During code
profiling the device PDOCLK output is used as a clock signal.
6.3 Memory Map and Registers
6.3.1 Module Memory Map
A summary of the registers associated with the DBG module is shown in Figure 6-2. Detailed descriptions
of the registers and bits are given in the subsections that follow.
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
0x0100 DBGC1 RARM 0reserved BDMBP BRKCPU reserved EEVE
WTRIG
0x0101 DBGC2 R0 0 0 0 CDCM ABCM
W
Figure 6-2. Quick Reference to DBG Registers
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 179
0x0102 DBGTCRH Rreserved TSOURCE TRANGE TRCMOD TALIGN
W
0x0103 DBGTCRL R0 0 0 0 DSTAMP PDOE PROFILE STAMP
W
0x0104 DBGTB R Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
W
0x0105 DBGTB RBit 7Bit 6Bit 5Bit 4Bit 3Bit 2Bit 1Bit 0
W
0x0106 DBGCNT R0 CNT
W
0x0107 DBGSCR1 RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
0x0108 DBGSCR2 RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
0x0109 DBGSCR3 RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
0x010A DBGEFR R PTBOVF TRIGF 0 EEVF ME3 ME2 ME1 ME0
W
0x010B DBGSR R TBF 0 0 PTACT 0 SSF2 SSF1 SSF0
W
0x010C-
0x010F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0110 DBGACTL R0 NDB INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0111-
0x0114 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0115 DBGAAH RDBGAA[23:16]
W
0x0116 DBGAAM RDBGAA[15:8]
W
0x0117 DBGAAL RDBGAA[7:0]
W
0x0118 DBGAD0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x0119 DBGAD1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x011A DBGAD2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 6-2. Quick Reference to DBG Registers
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
180 Freescale Semiconductor
0x011B DBGAD3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x011C DBGADM0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x011D DBGADM1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x011E DBGADM2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
0x011F DBGADM3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x0120 DBGBCTL R0 0 INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0121-
0x0124 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0125 DBGBAH RDBGBA[23:16]
W
0x0126 DBGBAM RDBGBA[15:8]
W
0x0127 DBGBAL RDBGBA[7:0]
W
0x0128-
0x012F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0130 DBGCCTL R0 NDB INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0131-
0x0134 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0135 DBGCAH RDBGCA[23:16]
W
0x0136 DBGCAM RDBGCA[15:8]
W
0x0137 DBGCAL RDBGCA[7:0]
W
0x0138 DBGCD0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x0139 DBGCD1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x013A DBGCD2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 6-2. Quick Reference to DBG Registers
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 181
6.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of the DBG register descriptions in address order. When ARM is set in DBGC1, the
only bits in the DBG module registers that can be written are ARM, and TRIG
6.3.2.1 Debug Control Register 1 (DBGC1)
Read: Anytime
0x013B DBGCD3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x013C DBGCDM0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x013D DBGCDM1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x013E DBGCDM2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
0x013F DBGCDM3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x0140 DBGDCTL R0 0 INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0141-
0x0144 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0145 DBGDAH RDBGDA[23:16]
W
0x0146 DBGDAM RDBGDA[15:8]
W
0x0147 DBGDAL RDBGDA[7:0]
W
0x0148-
0x017F Reserved R00000000
W
Address: 0x0100
76543210
0x0100 ARM 0reserved BDMBP BRKCPU reserved EEVE
TRIG
Reset00000000
Figure 6-3. Debug Control Register (DBGC1)
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 6-2. Quick Reference to DBG Registers
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
182 Freescale Semiconductor
W rite: Bit 7 Anytime with the exception that it cannot be set if PTACT is set. An ongoing profiling session
must be finished before DBG can be armed again.
Bit 6 can be written anytime but always reads back as 0.
Bits 5:0 anytime DBG is not armed and PTACT is clear.
NOTE
On a write access to DBGC1 and simultaneous hardware disarm from an
internal event, the hardware disarm has highest priority, clearing the ARM
bit and generating a breakpoint, if enabled.
NOTE
When disarming the DBG by clearing ARM with software, the contents of
bits[5:0] are not affected by the write, since up until the write operation,
ARM = 1 preventing these bits from being written. These bits must be
cleared using a second write if required.
Table 6-3. DBGC1 Field Desc rip ti ons
Field Description
7
ARM
Arm Bit — The ARM bit controls whether the DBG module is armed. This bit can be set and cleared by register
writes and is automatically cleared when the state sequencer returns to State0 on completing a debugging
session. On setting this bit the state sequencer enters State1.
0 Debugger disarmed. No breakpoint is generated when clearing this bit by software register writes.
1 Debugger armed
6
TRIG
Immediate Trigger Request Bit — This bit when written to 1 requests an immediate transition to final state
independent of comparator status. This bit always reads back a 0. Writing a 0 to this bit has no effect.
0 No effect.
1 Force state sequencer immediately to final state.
4
BDMBP
Background De bug Mode Enable — This bit determines if a CPU breakpoint causes the system to enter
Background Debug Mode (BDM) or initiate a Software Interrupt (SWI). If this bit is set but the BDC is not enabled,
then no breakpoints are generated.
0 Breakpoint to Software Interrupt if BDM inactive. Otherwise no breakpoint.
1 Breakpoint to BDM, if BDC enabled. Otherwise no breakpoint.
3
BRKCPU
CPU Breakpoint Enable — The BRKCPU bit controls whether the debugger requests a breakpoint to CPU upon
transitions to State0. If tracing is enabled, the breakpoint is generated on completion of the tracing session. If
tracing is not enabled, the breakpoint is generated immediately. Please refer to Section 6.4.7 for further details.
0 Breakpoints disabled
1 Breakpoints enabled
1–0
EEVE
External Event Enable — The EEVE bits configure the external event function. Tab le 6- 4 explains the bit
encoding.
Table 6-4. EEVE Bit Encoding
EEVE Description
00 External event function disabled
01 External event forces a trace buffer entry if tracing is enabled
10 External event is mapped to the state sequencer, replacing comparator channel 3
11 External event pin gates trace buffer entries
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 183
6.3.2.2 Debug Control Register2 (DBGC2)
Read: Anytime.
Write: Anytime the module is disarmed and PTACT is clear.
This register configures the comparators for range matching.
Address: 0x0101
76543210
R0 0 0 0 CDCM ABCM
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-4. Debug Control Register2 (DBGC2)
Table 6-5. DBGC2 Field Desc rip ti ons
Field Description
3–2
CDCM[1:0]
C and D Comparator Match Control — These bits determine the C and D comparator match mapping as
described in Table 6-6.
1–0
ABCM[1:0]
A and B Comparator Match Control These bits determine the A and B comparator match mapping as
described in Table 6-7.
Table 6-6. CDCM Encoding
CDCM Description
00 Match2 mapped to comparator C match....... Match3 mapped to comparator D match.
01 Match2 mapped to comparator C/D inside range....... Match3 disabled.
10 Match2 mapped to comparator C/D outside range....... Match3 disabled.
11 Reserved(1)
1. Currently defaults to Match2 mapped to inside range: Match3 disabled.
Table 6-7. ABCM Encoding
ABCM Description
00 Match0 mapped to comparator A match....... Match1 mapped to comparator B match.
01 Match0 mapped to comparator A/B inside range....... Match1 disabled.
10 Match0 mapped to comparator A/B outside range....... Match1 disabled.
11 Reserved(1)
1. Currently defaults to Match0 mapped to inside range: Match1 disabled
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
184 Freescale Semiconductor
6.3.2.3 Debug Trace Control Register High (DBGTCRH)
Read: Anytime.
Write: Anytime the module is disarmed and PTACT is clear.
WARNING
DBGTCR[7] is reserved. Setting this bit maps the tracing to an unimplemented bus, thus
preventing proper operation.
This register configures the trace buffer for tracing and profiling.
Address: 0x0102
76543210
Rreserved TSOURCE TRANGE TRCMOD TALIGN
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-5. Debug Trace Control Register (DBGTCRH)
Table 6-8. DBGTCRH Field Descriptions
Field Description
6
TSOURCE
Tra ce Control Bits — The TSOURCE enables the tracing session.
0 No CPU tracing/profiling selected
1 CPU tracing/profiling selected
5–4
TRANGE
Trace Range Bit s — The TRANGE bits allow filtering of trace information from a selected address range when
tracing from the CPU in Detail mode. These bits have no effect in other tracing modes. To use a comparator for
range filtering, the corresponding COMPE bit must remain cleared. If the COMPE bit is set then the comparator
is used to generate events and the TRANGE bits have no effect. See Table 6-9 for range boundary definition.
3–2
TRCMOD
Trace Mode Bits — See Section 6.4.5.2 for detailed Trace Mode descriptions. In Normal Mode, change of flow
information is stored. In Loop1 Mode, change of flow information is stored but redundant entries into trace
memory are inhibited. In Detail Mode, address and data for all memory and register accesses is stored. See
Table 6-10.
1–0
TALIGN
Trigger Align Bits — These bits control whether the trigger is aligned to the beginning, end or the middle of a
tracing or profiling session. See Ta ble 6 - 11.
Table 6-9. TRANGE Trace Range Encoding
TRANGE Tracing Range
00 Trace from all addresses (No filter)
01 Trace only in address range from $00000 to Comparator D
10 Trace only in address range from Comparator C to $FFFFFF
11 Trace only in range from Comparator C to Comparator D
Table 6-10. TRCMOD Trace Mode Bit Encoding
TRCMOD Description
00 Normal
01 Loop1
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 185
6.3.2.4 Debug Trace Control Register Low (DBGTCRL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: Anytime the module is disarmed and PTACT is clear.
This register configures the profiling and timestamp features
10 Detail
11 Pure PC
Table 6-11. TALIGN Trace Alignment Encoding
TALIGN Description
00 Trigger ends data trace
01 Trigger starts data trace
10 32 lines of data trace follow trigger
11(1)
1. Tracing/Profiling disabled.
Reserved
Address: 0x0103
76543210
R0 0 0 0 DSTAMP PDOE PROFILE STAMP
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-6. Debug Trace Control Register Low (DBGTCRL)
Table 6-12. DBGTCRL Field Descriptions
Field Description
3
DSTAMP
Comparator D Timestamp Enable — This bit, when set, enables Comparator D matches to generate
timestamps in Detail, Normal and Loop1 trace modes.
0 Comparator D match does not generate timestamp
1 Comparator D match generates timestamp if timestamp function is enabled
2
PDOE
Profile Data Out Enable This bit, when set, configures the device profiling pins for profiling.
0 Device pins not configured for profiling
1 Device pins configured for profiling
1
PROFILE
Profile Enable — This bit, when set, enables the profile function, whereby a subsequent arming of the DBG
activates profiling.
When PROFILE is set, the TRCMOD bits are ignored.
0 Profile function disabled
1 Profile function enabled
Table 6-10. TRCMOD Trace Mode Bit Encoding
TRCMOD Description
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
186 Freescale Semiconductor
6.3.2.5 Debug Trace Buffer Register (DBGTB)
Read: Only when unlocked AND not armed and the TSOURCE bit is set, otherwise an error code (0xEE)
is returned. Only aligned word read operations are supported. Misaligned word reads or byte reads return
the error code 0xEE for each byte. The PROFILE bit must be clear to read profiling data,
Write: Aligned word writes when the DBG is disarmed and both PTACT and PROFILE are clear unlock
the trace buffer for reading but do not affect trace buffer contents.
6.3.2.6 Debug Count Register (DBGCNT)
0
STAMP
Timestamp Enable — This bit, when set, enables the timestamp function. The timestamp function adds a
timestamp to each trace buffer entry in Detail, Normal and Loop1 trace modes.
0 Timestamp function disabled
1 Timestamp function enabled
Address: 0x0104, 0x0105
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
PORXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
Other
Resets ————————————————
Figure 6-7. Debug Trace Buffer Register (DBGTB)
Table 6 -13. DBGTB Field Descriptions
Field Description
15–0
Bit[15:0]
T race Buffer Dat a Bits — The Trace Buffer Register is a window through which the lines of the trace buffer may
be read 16 bits at a time. Each valid read of DBGTB increments an internal trace buffer pointer which points to
the next address to be read. When the ARM bit is written to 1 the trace buffer is locked to prevent reading. The
trace buffer can only be unlocked for reading by writing to DBGTB with an aligned word write when the module
is disarmed. The DBGTB register can be read only as an aligned word. Byte reads or misaligned access of these
registers returns 0xEE and does not increment the trace buffer pointer. Similarly word reads while the debugger
is armed or trace buffer is locked return 0xEEEE. The POR state is undefined Other resets do not affect the trace
buffer contents.
Address: 0x0106
76543210
R 0 CNT
W
Reset
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-8. Debug Count Register (DBGCNT)
Ta ble 6-12. DBGTCRL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 187
Read: Anytime.
Write: Never.
6.3.2.7 Debug State Control Register 1 (DBGSCR1)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG is not armed and PTACT is clear.
The state control register 1 selects the tar geted next state whilst in State1. The matches refer to the outputs
of the comparator match control logic as depicted in Figure 6-1 and described in Section 6.3.2.12”.
Comparators must be enabled by setting the comparator enable bit in the associated DBGXCTL control
register.
Table 6-14. DBGCNT Fi el d De sc rip ti ons
Field Description
6–0
CNT[6:0]
Count Value — The CNT bits [6:0] indicate the number of valid data lines stored in the trace buffer. Tab l e 6-1 5
shows the correlation between the CNT bits and the number of valid data lines in the trace buffer. When the CNT
rolls over to zero, the TBF bit in DBGSR is set. Thereafter incrementing of CNT continues if configured for end-
alignment or mid-alignment.
The DBGCNT register is cleared when ARM in DBGC1 is written to a one. The DBGCNT register is cleared by
power-on-reset initialization but is not cleared by other system resets. If a reset occurs during a debug session,
the DBGCNT register still indicates after the reset, the number of valid trace buffer entries stored before the reset
occurred. The DBGCNT register is not decremented when reading from the trace buffer.
Table 6-15. CNT Decoding Table
TBF (DBGSR) CNT[6:0] Description
0 0000000 No data valid
0 0000001 32 bits of one line valid
0 0000010
0000100
0000110
..
1111100
1 line valid
2 lines valid
3 lines valid
..
62 lines valid
0 1111110 63 l ines v alid
1 0000000 64 lines valid; if using Begin trigger alignment,
ARM bit is cleared and the tracing session ends.
1 0000010
..
1111110
64 lines valid,
oldest data has been overwritten by most recent data
Address: 0x0107
76543210
RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-9. Debug State Control Regist er 1 (DBGSCR1)
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
188 Freescale Semiconductor
In the case of simultaneous matches, the match on the higher channel number (3...0) has priority.
6.3.2.8 Debug State Control Register 2 (DBGSCR2)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG is not armed and PTACT is clear.
The state control register 2 selects the tar geted next state whilst in State2. The matches refer to the outputs
of the comparator match control logic as depicted in Figure 6-1 and described in Section 6.3.2.12”.
Comparators must be enabled by setting the comparator enable bit in the associated DBGXCTL control
register.
Table 6-16. DBGSCR 1 Fi el d De sc rip ti ons
Field Description
1–0
C0SC[1:0]
Channel 0 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State1 following a match0.
3–2
C1SC[1:0]
Channel 1 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State1 following a match1.
5–4
C2SC[1:0]
Channel 2 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State1 following a match2.
7–6
C3SC[1:0]
Channel 3 State Control.
If EEVE !=10, these bits select the targeted next state whilst in State1 following a match3.
If EEVE = 10, these bits select the targeted next state whilst in State1 following an external event.
Table 6-17. State1 Match State Sequencer Transitions
CxSC[1:0] Function
00 Match has no effect
01 Match forces sequencer to State2
10 Match forces sequencer to State3
11 Match forces sequencer to Final State
Address: 0x0108
76543210
RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-10. Debug State Control Register 2 (DBGSCR2)
Table 6-18. DBGSCR 2 Fi el d De sc rip ti ons
Field Description
1–0
C0SC[1:0]
Channel 0 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State2 following a match0.
3–2
C1SC[1:0]
Channel 1 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State2 following a match1.
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 189
In the case of simultaneous matches, the match on the higher channel number (3...0) has priority.
6.3.2.9 Debug State Control Register 3 (DBGSCR3)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG is not armed and PTACT is clear.
The state control register three selects the targeted next state whilst in State3. The matches refer to the
outputs of the comparator match control logic as depicted in Figure 6-1 and described in Section 6.3.2.12”.
Comparators must be enabled by setting the comparator enable bit in the associated DBGxCTL control
register.
5–4
C2SC[1:0]
Channel 2 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State2 following a match2.
7–6
C3SC[1:0]
Channel 3 State Control.
If EEVE !=10, these bits select the targeted next state whilst in State2 following a match3.
If EEVE =10, these bits select the targeted next state whilst in State2 following an external event.
Table 6-19. State2 Match State Sequencer Transitions
CxSC[1:0] Function
00 Match has no effect
01 Match forces sequencer to State1
10 Match forces sequencer to State3
11 Match forces sequencer to Final State
Address: 0x0109
76543210
RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-11. Debug State Control Register 3 (DBGSCR3)
Table 6-20. DBGSCR 3 Fi el d De sc rip ti ons
Field Description
1–0
C0SC[1:0]
Channel 0 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State3 following a match0.
3–2
C1SC[1:0]
Channel 1 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State3 following a match1.
5–4
C2SC[1:0]
Channel 2 State Control.
These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State3 following a match2.
Table 6-18. DBGSCR2 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
190 Freescale Semiconductor
In the case of simultaneous matches, the match on the higher channel number (3....0) has priority.
6.3.2.10 Debug Event Flag Register (DBGEFR)
Read: Anytime.
Write: Never
DBGEFR contains flag bits each mapped to events whilst armed. Should an event occur, then the
corresponding flag is set. With the exception of TRIGF, the bits can only be set when the ARM bit is set.
The TRIGF bit is set if a TRIG event occurs when ARM is already set, or if the TRIG event occurs
simultaneous to setting the ARM bit.All other flags can only be cleared by arming the DBG module. Thus
the contents are retained after a debug session for evaluation purposes.
A set flag does not inhibit the setting of other flags.
7–6
C3SC[1:0]
Channel 3 State Control.
If EEVE !=10, these bits select the targeted next state whilst in State3 following a match3.
If EEVE =10, these bits select the targeted next state whilst in State3 following an external event.
Table 6-21. State3 Match State Sequencer Transitions
CxSC[1:0] Function
00 Match has no effect
01 Match forces sequencer to State1
10 Match forces sequencer to State2
11 Match forces sequencer to Final State
Address: 0x010A
76543210
R PTBOVF TRIGF 0 EEVF ME3 ME2 ME1 ME0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-12. Debug Event Flag Register (DBGEFR)
Table 6-22. DBGEFR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
PTBOVF
Profiling Tr ace Buffer Overflow Flag — Indicates the occurrence of a trace buffer overflow event during a
profiling session.
0 No trace buffer overflow event
1 Trace buffer overflow event
6
TRIGF
TRIG Flag — Indicates the occurrence of a TRIG event during the debug session.
0 No TRIG event
1 TRIG event
Table 6-20. DBGSCR3 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 191
6.3.2.11 Debug Status Register (DBGSR)
Read: Anytime.
Write: Never.
4
EEVF
External Event Flag — Indicates the occurrence of an external event during the debug session.
0 No external event
1 External event
3–0
ME[3:0]
Match Event[3:0]— Indicates a comparator match event on the corresponding comparator channel.
Address: 0x010B
76543210
R TBF 0 0 PTACT 0 SSF2 SSF1 SSF0
W
Reset
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-13. Debug Status Register (DBGSR)
Table 6-23. DBGSR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
TBF
T race Buffer Full — The TBF bit indicates that the trace buffer has been filled with data since it was last armed.
If this bit is set, then all trace buffer lines contain valid data, regardless of the value of DBGCNT bits CNT[6:0].
The TBF bit is cleared when ARM in DBGC1 is written to a one. The TBF is cleared by the power on reset
initialization. Other system generated resets have no affect on this bit
4
PTACT
Profiling Transmission Active — The PTACT bit, when set, indicates that the profiling transmission is still
active. When clear, PTACT then profiling transmission is not active. The PTACT bit is set when profiling begins
with the first PTS format entry to the trace buffer. The PTACT bit is cleared when the profiling transmission ends.
2–0
SSF[2:0]
St ate Sequencer Flag Bits The SSF bits indicate the current State Sequencer state. During a debug session
on each transition to a new state these bits are updated. If the debug session is ended by software clearing the
ARM bit, then these bits retain their value to reflect the last state of the state sequencer before disarming. If a
debug session is ended by an internal event, then the state sequencer returns to State0 and these bits are
cleared to indicate that State0 was entered during the session. On arming the module the state sequencer enters
State1 and these bits are forced to SSF[2:0] = 001. See Table 6-24.
Table 6-24. SSF[2:0] — State Seque nce Flag Bit Encoding
SSF[2:0] Current State
000 State0 (disarmed)
001 State1
010 State2
011 State3
100 Final State
Table 6-22. DBGEFR Field Descriptions
Field Description
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
192 Freescale Semiconductor
6.3.2.12 Debug Comparator A Control Register (DBGACTL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
Table 6-26 shows the effect for RWE and RW on the comparison conditions. These bits are ignored if
INST is set, because matches based on opcodes reaching the execution stage are data independent.
101,110,111 Reserved
Address: 0x0110
76543210
R0 NDB INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-14. Debug Comparator A Control Register
Table 6-25. DBGACTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
6
NDB
Not Data Bus The NDB bit controls whether the match occurs when the data bus matches the comparator
register value or when the data bus differs from the register value. This bit is ignored if the INST bit in the
same register is set.
0 Match on data bus equivalence to comparator register contents
1 Match on data bus difference to comparator register contents
5
INST
Instruction Select — This bit configures the comparator to compare PC or data access addresses.
0 Comparator compares addresses of data accesses
1 Comparator compares PC address
3
RW
Read/Write Comparator Value Bit — The RW bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for the
associated comparator. The RW bit is ignored if RWE is clear or INST is set.
0 Write cycle is matched
1 Read cycle is matched
2
RWE
Read/W ri te Enab le Bit The RWE bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for the
associated comparator. This bit is ignored when INST is set.
0 Read/Write is not used in comparison
1 Read/Write is used in comparison
0
COMPE
Enable Bit — Determines if comparator is enabled
0 The comparator is not enabled
1 The comparator is enabled
Table 6-24. SSF[2:0] — State Seque nce Flag Bit Encoding
SSF[2:0] Current State
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 193
6.3.2.13 Debug Comparator A Address Register (DBGAAH, DBGAAM, DBGAAL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
Table 6-26. Read or Write Comparison Logic Table
RWE Bit RW Bit RW Signal Comment
0 x 0 RW not used in comparison
0 x 1 RW not used in comparison
1 0 0 Write match
10 1 No match
11 0 No match
1 1 1 Read match
Address: 0x0115, DBGAAH
2 3 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RDBGAA[23:16]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0116, DBGAAM
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RDBGAA[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0117, DBGAAL
76543210
RDBGAA[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-15. Debug Comparator A Address Register
Table 6-27. DBGAAH, DBGAAM, DBGAAL Field Descriptions
Field Description
23–16
DBGAA
[23:16]
Comparator Address Bits [23:16]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [23:16] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
15–0
DBGAA
[15:0]
Comparator Address Bits [15:0]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [15:0] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
194 Freescale Semiconductor
6.3.2.14 Debug Comparator A Data Register (DBGAD)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
This register can be accessed with a byte resolution, whereby DBGAD0, DBGAD1, DBGAD2, DBGAD3
map to DBGAD[31:0] respectively.
6.3.2.15 Debug Comparator A Data Mask Register (DBGADM)
Read: Anytime.
Address: 0x0118, 0x0119, 0x011A, 0x011B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RBit 31 Bit 30 Bit 29 Bit 28 Bit 27 Bit 26 Bit 25 Bit 24 Bit 23 Bit 22 Bit 21 Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16
W
Reset0000000000000000
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
Reset0000000000000000
Figure 6-16. Debug Comparator A Data Register (DBGAD)
Table 6-28. DBGAD Field Descriptions
Field Description
31–16
Bits[31:16]
(DBGAD0,
DBGAD1)
Comp arator Dat a Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to a logic one
or logic zero. The comparator data bits are only used in comparison if the corresponding data mask bit is logic 1.
0 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic one
15–0
Bits[15:0]
(DBGAD2,
DBGAD3)
Comp arator Dat a Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to a logic one
or logic zero. The comparator data bits are only used in comparison if the corresponding data mask bit is logic 1.
0 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic one
Address: 0x011C, 0x011D, 0x011E, 0x011F
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RBit 31 Bit 30 Bit 29 Bit 28 Bit 27 Bit 26 Bit 25 Bit 24 Bit 23 Bit 22 Bit 21 Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16
W
Reset0000000000000000
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
Reset0000000000000000
Figure 6-17. Debug Comparator A Data Mask Register (DBGADM)
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 195
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
This register can be accessed with a byte resolution, whereby DBGADM0, DBGADM1, DBGADM2,
DBGADM3 map to DBGADM[31:0] respectively.
6.3.2.16 Debug Comparator B Control Register (DBGBCTL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
Table 6-29. DBGADM Field Descriptions
Field Description
31–16
Bits[31:16]
(DBGADM0,
DBGADM1)
Comp arator Data Mask Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to the
corresponding comparator data compare bits.
0 Do not compare corresponding data bit
1 Compare corresponding data bit
15-0
Bits[15:0]
(DBGADM2,
DBGADM3)
Comp arator Data Mask Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to the
corresponding comparator data compare bits.
0 Do not compare corresponding data bit
1 Compare corresponding data bit
Address: 0x0120
76543210
R0 0 INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-18. Debug Comparator B Control Register
Table 6-30. DBGBCTL Field Descriptions
Field(1)
1. If the ABCM field selects range mode comparisons, then DBGACTL bits configure the comparison, DBGBCTL is ignored.
Description
5
INST
Instruction Select — This bit configures the comparator to compare PC or data access addresses.
0 Comparator compares addresses of data accesses
1 Comparator compares PC address
3
RW
Read/Write Comparator Value Bit — The RW bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for the
associated comparator. The RW bit is ignored if RWE is clear or INST is set.
0 Write cycle is matched
1 Read cycle is matched
2
RWE
Read/W ri te Enab le Bit The RWE bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for the
associated comparator. This bit is ignored when INST is set.
0 Read/Write is not used in comparison
1 Read/Write is used in comparison
0
COMPE
Enable Bit — Determines if comparator is enabled
0 The comparator is not enabled
1 The comparator is enabled
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
196 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 6-31 shows the effect for RWE and RW on the comparison conditions. These bits are ignored if
INST is set, as matches based on instructions reaching the execution stage are data independent.
6.3.2.17 Debug Comparator B Address Register (DBGBAH, DBGBAM, DBGBAL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
Table 6-31. Read or Write Comparison Logic Table
RWE Bit RW Bit RW Signal Comment
0 x 0 RW not used in comparison
0 x 1 RW not used in comparison
1 0 0 Write match
10 1 No match
11 0 No match
1 1 1 Read match
Address: 0x0125, DBGBAH
2 3 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RDBGBA[23:16]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0126, DBGBAM
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RDBGBA[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0127, DBGBAL
76543210
RDBGBA[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-19. Debug Comparator B Address Register
Table 6-32. DBGBAH, DBGBAM, DBGBAL Field Descriptions
Field Description
23–16
DBGBA
[23:16]
Comparator Address Bits [23:16]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [23:16] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
15–0
DBGBA
[15:0]
Comparator Address Bits[15:0]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [15:0] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 197
6.3.2.18 Debug Comparator C Control Register (DBGCCTL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
Table 6-34 shows the effect for RWE and RW on the comparison conditions. These bits are ignored if
INST is set, because matches based on opcodes reaching the execution stage are data independent.
Address: 0x0130
76543210
R0 NDB INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-20. Debug Comparator C Control Register
Table 6-33. DBGCCTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
6
NDB
Not Data Bus The NDB bit controls whether the match occurs when the data bus matches the comparator
register value or when the data bus differs from the register value. This bit is ignored if the INST bit in the
same register is set.
0 Match on data bus equivalence to comparator register contents
1 Match on data bus difference to comparator register contents
5
INST
Instruction Select — This bit configures the comparator to compare PC or data access addresses.
0 Comparator compares addresses of data accesses
1 Comparator compares PC address
3
RW
Read/Write Comparator Value Bit — The RW bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for the
associated comparator. The RW bit is ignored if RWE is clear or INST is set.
0 Write cycle is matched
1 Read cycle is matched
2
RWE
Read/W ri te Enab le Bit The RWE bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for the
associated comparator. This bit is not used if INST is set.
0 Read/Write is not used in comparison
1 Read/Write is used in comparison
0
COMPE
Enable Bit — Determines if comparator is enabled
0 The comparator is not enabled
1 The comparator is enabled
Table 6-34. Read or Write Comparison Logic Table
RWE Bit RW Bit RW Signal Comment
0 x 0 RW not used in comparison
0 x 1 RW not used in comparison
1 0 0 Write match
10 1 No match
11 0 No match
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
198 Freescale Semiconductor
6.3.2.19 Debug Comparator C Address Register (DBGCAH, DBGCAM, DBGCAL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
1 1 1 Read match
Address: 0x0135, DBGCAH
2 3 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RDBGCA[23:16]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0136, DBGCAM
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RDBGCA[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0137, DBGCAL
76543210
RDBGCA[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-21. Debug Comparator C Address Register
Table 6-35. DBGCAH, DBGCAM, DBGCAL Field Descriptions
Field Description
23–16
DBGCA
[23:16]
Comparator Address Bits [23:16]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [23:16] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
15–0
DBGCA
[15:0]
Comparator Address Bits[15:0]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [15:0] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
Table 6-34. Read or Write Comparison Logic Table
RWE Bit RW Bit RW Signal Comment
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 199
6.3.2.20 Debug Comparator C Data Register (DBGCD)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
This register can be accessed with a byte resolution, whereby DBGCD0, DBGCD1, DBGCD2, DBGCD3
map to DBGCD[31:0] respectively.
XGATE data accesses have a maximum width of 16-bits and are mapped to DBGCD[15:0].
6.3.2.21 Debug Comparator C Data Mask Register (DBGCDM)
Read: Anytime.
Address: 0x0138, 0x0139, 0x013A, 0x013B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RBit 31 Bit 30 Bit 29 Bit 28 Bit 27 Bit 26 Bit 25 Bit 24 Bit 23 Bit 22 Bit 21 Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16
W
Reset0000000000000000
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
Reset0000000000000000
Figure 6-22. Debug Comparator C Data Register (DBGCD)
Table 6-36. DBGCD Field Descriptions
Field Description
31–16
Bits[31:16]
(DBGCD0,
DBGCD1)
Comp arator Dat a Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to a logic one
or logic zero. The comparator data bits are only used in comparison if the corresponding data mask bit is logic 1.
0 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic one
15–0
Bits[15:0]
(DBGCD2,
DBGCD3)
Comp arator Dat a Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to a logic one
or logic zero. The comparator data bits are only used in comparison if the corresponding data mask bit is logic 1.
0 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic one
Address: 0x013C, 0x013D, 0x013E, 0x013F
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RBit 31 Bit 30 Bit 29 Bit 28 Bit 27 Bit 26 Bit 25 Bit 24 Bit 23 Bit 22 Bit 21 Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16
W
Reset0000000000000000
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
Reset0000000000000000
Figure 6-23. Debug Comparator C Data Mask Register (DBGCDM)
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
200 Freescale Semiconductor
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
This register can be accessed with a byte resolution, whereby DBGCDM0, DBGCDM1, DBGCDM2,
DBGCDM3 map to DBGCDM[31:0] respectively.
XGATE data accesses have a maximum width of 16-bits and are mapped to DBGCDM[15:0].
6.3.2.22 Debug Comparator D Control Register (DBGDCTL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
Table 6-37. DBGCDM Field Descriptions
Field Description
31–16
Bits[31:16]
(DBGCDM0,
DBGCDM1)
Comp arator Data Mask Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to the
corresponding comparator data compare bits.
0 Do not compare corresponding data bit
1 Compare corresponding data bit
15–0
Bits[15:0]
(DBGCDM2,
DBGCDM3)
Comp arator Data Mask Bits — These bits control whether the comparator compares the data bus bits to the
corresponding comparator data compare bits.
0 Do not compare corresponding data bit
1 Compare corresponding data bit
Address: 0x0140
76543210
R0 0 INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-24. Debug Comparator D Control Register
Table 6-38. DBGDCTL Field Descriptions
Field(1) Description
5
INST
Instruction Select — This bit configures the comparator to compare PC or data access addresses.
0 Comparator compares addresses of data accesses
1 Comparator compares PC address
3
RW
Read/Write Comparator Value Bit — The RW bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for the
associated comparator. The RW bit is ignored if RWE is clear or INST is set.
0 Write cycle is matched
1 Read cycle is matched
2
RWE
Read/W ri te Enab le Bit The RWE bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for the
associated comparator. This bit is ignored if INST is set.
0 Read/Write is not used in comparison
1 Read/Write is used in comparison
0
COMPE
Enable Bit — Determines if comparator is enabled
0 The comparator is not enabled
1 The comparator is enabled
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 201
Table 6-39 shows the effect for RWE and RW on the comparison conditions. These bits are ignored if
INST is set, because matches based on opcodes reaching the execution stage are data independent.
6.3.2.23 Debug Comparator D Address Register (DBGDAH, DBGDAM, DBGDAL)
Read: Anytime.
Write: If DBG not armed and PTACT is clear.
1. If the CDCM field selects range mode comparisons, then DBGCCTL bits configure the comparison, DBGDCTL is ignored.
Table 6-39. Read or Write Comparison Logic Table
RWE Bit RW Bit RW Signal Comment
0 x 0 RW not used in comparison
0 x 1 RW not used in comparison
1 0 0 Write match
10 1 No match
11 0 No match
1 1 1 Read match
Address: 0x0145, DBGDAH
2 3 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RDBGDA[23:16]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0146, DBGDAM
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RDBGDA[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Address: 0x0147, DBGDAL
76543210
RDBGDA[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 6-25. Debug Comparator D Address Register
Table 6-40. DBGDAH, DBGDAM, DBGDAL Field Descriptions
Field Description
23–16
DBGDA
[23:16]
Comparator Address Bits [23:16]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [23:16] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
202 Freescale Semiconductor
6.4 Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the DBG module.
6.4.1 DBG Operation
The DBG module operation is enabled by setting ARM in DBGC1. When armed it supports storing of data
in the trace buffer and can be used to generate breakpoints to the CPU. The DBG module is made up of
comparators, control logic, the trace buffer, and the state sequencer, Figure 6-1.
The comparators monitor the bus activity of the CPU. Comparators can be configured to monitor opcode
addresses (effectively the PC address) or data accesses. Comparators can be configured during data
accesses to mask out individual data bus bits and to use R/W access qualification in the comparison.
Comparators can be configured to monitor a range of addresses.
When configured for data access comparisons, the match is generated if the a ddress (and optionally data)
of a data access matches the comparator value.
Configured for monitoring opcode addresses, the match is generated when the associated opcode reaches
the execution stage of the instruction queue, but before execution of that opcode.
When a match with a comparator register value occurs, the associated control logic can force the state
sequencer to another state (see Figure 6-26).
The state sequencer can transition freely between the states 1, 2 and 3. On transition to Final State bus
tracing can be triggered. On completion of tracing the state sequencer enters State0. If tracing is disabled
or End aligned tracing is enabled then the state sequencer transitions immediately from Final State to
State0. The transition to State0 generates breakpoints if breakpoints are enabled.
Independent of the comparators, state sequencer transitions can be forced by the external event input or by
writing to the TRIG bit in the DBGC1 control register.
The trace buffer is visible through a 2- byte window in the register address map and can be read out using
standard 16-bit word reads.
6.4.2 Comparator Modes
The DBG contains four comparators, A, B, C, and D. Each comparator compares the address stored in
DBGXAH, DBGXAM, and DBGXAL with the PC (opcode addresses) or selected address bus (data
15–0
DBGDA
[15:0]
Comparator Address Bits[15:0]— These comparator address bits control whether the comparator compares
the address bus bits [15:0] to a logic one or logic zero.
0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero
1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
Table 6-40. DBGDAH, DBGDAM, DBGDAL Field Descriptions
Field Description
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 203
accesses). Furthermore, comparators A and C can compare the data buses to values stored in DBGXD3-0
and allow data bit masking.
The comparators can monitor the buses for an exact address or an address range. The comparator
configuration is controlled by the control register contents and the range control by the DBGC2 contents.
The comparator control register also allows the type of data access to be included in the comparison
through the use of the RWE and RW bits. The RWE bit controls whether the access type is compared for
the associated comparator and the RW bit selects either a read or write access for a valid match.
The INST bit in each comparator control register is used to determine the matching condition. By setting
INST, the comparator matches opcode addresses, whereby the databus, data mask, RW and RWE bits are
ignored. The comparator register must be loaded with the exact opcode address.
The comparator can be configured to match memory access addresses by clearing the INST bit.
Each comparator match can force a transition to another state sequencer state (see Section 6.4.3”).
Once a successful comparator match has occurred, the condition that caused the original match is not
verified again on subsequent matches. Thus if a particular data value is matched at a given address, this
address may not contain that data value when a subsequent match occurs.
Comparators C and D can also be used to select an address range to trace from, when tracing CPU accesses
in Detail mode. This is determined by the TRANGE bits in the DBGTCRH register. The TRANGE
encoding is shown in Table 6-9. If the TRANGE bits select a range definition using comparator D and the
COMPE bit is clear , then comparator D is configured for trace range definition. By setting the COMPE bit
the comparator is configured for address bus comparisons, the TRANGE bits are ignored and the tracing
range function is disabled. Similarly if the TRANGE bits select a range definition using comparator C and
the COMPE bit is clear, then comparator C is configured for trace range definition.
Match[0, 1, 2, 3] map directly to Comparators [A, B, C, D] respectively, except in range modes (see
Section 6.3.2.2”). Comparator priority rules are describe d in the event prior ity sec tion (Section 6.4.3.5”).
6.4.2.1 Exact Address Comparator Match
With range comparisons disabled, the match condition is an exact equivalence of address bus with the
value stored in the comparator address registers. Qualification of the type of access (R/W) is also possible.
Code may contain various access forms of the same address, for example a 16-bit access of ADDR[n] or
byte access of ADDR[n+1] both access n+1. The comparators ensure that any access of the address defined
by the comparator address register generates a match, as shown in the example of Table 6-41. Thus if the
comparator address register contains ADDR[n+1] any access of ADDR[n+1] ma tches. This means that a
16-bit access of ADDR[n] or 32-bit access of ADDR[n-1] also match because they also access
ADDR[n+1]. The right hand columns show the contents of DBGxA that would match for each access.
Table 6-41. Comparator Address Bus Matches
Access Address ADDR[n] ADDR[n+1] ADDR[n+2] ADDR[n+3]
32-bit ADDR[n] Match Match Match Match
16-bit ADDR[n] Match Match No Match No Match
16-bit ADDR[n+1] No Match Match Match No Match
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
204 Freescale Semiconductor
If the comparator INST bit is set, the comparator address register contents are compared with the PC, the
data register contents and access type bits are ignored. The comparator address register must be loaded
with the address of the first opcode byte.
6.4.2.2 Address and Data Comparator Match
Comparators A and C feature data comparators, for data access comparisons. The comparators do not
evaluate if accessed data is valid. Accesses across aligned 32-bit boundaries are split internally into
consecutive accesses. The data comparator mapping to accessed addresses for the CPU is shown in
Table 6-42, whereby the Address column refers to the lowest 2 bits of the lowest accessed address. This
corresponds to the most significant data byte.
The fixed mapping of data comparator bytes to addresses within a 32-bit data field ensures data matches
independent of access size. To compare a single data byte within the 32-bit field, the other bytes within
that field must be masked using the corresponding data mask registers. This ensures that any access of that
byte (32-bit,16-bit or 8-bit) with matching data causes a match. If no bytes are masked then the data
comparator always compares all 32-bits and can only generate a matc h on a 32-bit access with correct 32-
bit data value. In this case, 8-bit or 16-bit accesses within the 32-bit fi eld cannot generate a match even if
the contents of the addressed bytes match because all 32-bits must match. In Table 6-43 the Access
Address column refers to the address bits[1:0] of the lowest accessed address (m ost significant data byte).
Table 6-43. Data Register Use Dependency On CPU Access Type
8-bit ADDR[n] Match No Match No Match No Match
Table 6-42. Comparator Data Byte Alignment
Address[1:0] Data Comparator
00 DBGxD0
01 DBGxD1
10 DBGxD2
11 DBGxD3
Memory Address[2:0]
Case Access
Address Access
Size 000 001 010 011 100 101 110
1 00 32-bit D BGxD0 DBGxD1 DBGxD2 DBGxD3
2 01 32-bit DBGxD1 DBGxD2 DBGxD3 DBGxD0
3 10 32-bit DBGxD2 DBGxD3 DBGxD0 DBGxD1
4 11 32-bit DBGxD3 DBGxD0 DBGxD1 DBGxD2
5 00 16-bit D BGxD0 DBGxD1
6 01 16-bit DBGxD1 DBGxD2
7 10 16-bit DBGxD2 DBGxD3
8 11 16-bit DBGxD3 DBGxD0
Table 6-41. Comparator Address Bus Matches
Access Address ADDR[n] ADDR[n+1] ADDR[n+2] ADDR[n+3]
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 205
For a match of a 32-bit access with data compare, th e address comparator must be loaded with the address
of the lowest accessed byte. For Case1 Table 6-43 this corresponds to 000, for Case2 it corresponds to 001.
To compare all 32-bits, it is required that no bits are masked.
6.4.2.3 Data Bus Comparison NDB Dependency
The NDB control bit allows data bus comparators to be configured to either match on equivalence or on
difference. This allows monitoring of a difference in the contents of an address location from an ex pected
value.
When matching on an equivalence (NDB=0), each individual data bus bit position can be masked out by
clearing the corresponding mask bit, so that it is ignored in the comparison. A match occurs when all data
bus bits with corresponding mask bits set are equivalent. If all mask register bits are clear , then a match is
based on the address bus only, the data bus is ignored.
When matching on a difference, mask bits can be cleared to ignore bit positions. A match occurs when any
data bus bit with corresponding mask bit set is different. Clearing all mask bits, causes all bits to be ignored
and prevents a match because no difference can be detected. In this case address bus equivalence does not
cause a match. Bytes that are not accessed are ignored. Thus when monitoring a multi byte field for a
difference, partial accesses of the field only return a match if a dif ference is detected in the accessed bytes.
6.4.2.4 Range Comparisons
Range comparisons are accurate to byte boundaries. Thus for data access comparisons a match occurs if
at least one byte of the access is in the range (inside range) or outside the range (outside range). For opcode
comparisons only the address of the first opcode byte is compared with the range.
9 00 8-bit D BGxD0
10 01 8-bit DBGxD1
11 10 8-bit DBGxD2
12 11 8-bit DBGxD3
13 00 8-bit DBGxD0
Denotes byte that is not accessed.
Table 6-44. NDB and MASK bit dependency
NDB DBGADM Comment
0 0 Do not compare data bus bit.
0 1 Compare data bus bit. Match on equivalence.
1 0 Do not compare data bus bit.
1 1 Compare data bus bit. Match on difference.
Memory Address[2:0]
Case Access
Address Access
Size 000 001 010 011 100 101 110
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
206 Freescale Semiconductor
When using the AB comparator pair for a range comparison, the data bus can be used for qualification by
using the comparator A data and data mask registers. Simila rly when using the CD comparator pair for a
range comparison, the data bus can be used for qualification by using the comparator C data and data mask
registers. The DBGACTL/DBGCCTL RW and RWE bits can be used to qualify the range comparison on
either a read or a write access. The corresponding DBGBCTL/DBGDCTL bits are ignored. The
DBGACTL/DBGCCTL COMPE/INST bits are used for range comparisons. The DBGBCTL/DBGDCTL
COMPE/INST bits are ignored in range modes.
6.4.2.4.1 Inside Range (CompAC_Addr address CompBD_Addr)
In the Inside Range comparator mode, either comparator pair A and B or comparator pair C and D can be
configured for range comparisons by the control register (DBGC2). The match condition requires a
simultaneous valid match for both comparators. A match condition on only one comparator is not valid.
6.4.2.4.2 Outside Range (address < CompAC_Addr or address > CompBD_Addr)
In the Outside Range comparator mode, either comparator pair A and B or comparator pair C and D can
be configured for range comparisons. A single match condition on either of the comparators is recognized
as valid. Outside range mode in combination with opcode address matches can be used to detect if opcodes
are from an unexpected range.
NOTE
When configured for data access matches, an outside range match would
typically occur at any interrupt vector fetch or register access. This can be
avoided by setting the upper or lower range limit to $FFFFFF or $000000
respectively. Interrupt vector fetches do not cause opcode address matches.
6.4.3 Events
Events are used as qualifiers for a state sequencer change of state. Th e state control register for the current
state determines the next state for each event. An event can immediately initiate a transition to the next
state sequencer state whereby the corresponding flag in DBGSR is set.
6.4.3.1 Comparator Match Events
6.4.3.1.1 Opcode Address Comparator Match
The comparator is loaded with the address of the selected instruction and the comparator control register
INST bit is set. When the opcode reaches the execution stage of the instruction queue a match occurs just
before the instruction executes, allowing a breakpoint immediately before the instruction boundary. The
comparator address register must contain the address of the first opc ode byte for the match to occur.
Opcode address matches are data independent thus the RWE and RW bits are ignored. CPU compares are
disabled when BDM becomes active.
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 207
6.4.3.1.2 Data Access Comparator Match
Data access matches are generated when an access occurs at the address contained in the comparator
address register. The match can be qualified by the access data and by the access type (read/write). The
breakpoint occurs a maximum of 2 instructions after the access in the CPU flow. Note, if a COF occurs
between access and breakpoint, the opcode address of the breakpoint can be elsewhere in the memory map.
Opcode fetches are not classed as data accesses. Thus data access matches are not possible on opcode
fetches.
6.4.3.2 External Event
The DBGEEV input signal can force a state sequencer transition, independent of internal comparator
matches. The DBGEEV is an input signal mapped directly to a device pin and configured by the EEVE
field in DBGC1. The external events can change the state sequencer state, or force a trace buf fer entry, or
gate trace buffer entries.
If configured to change the state sequencer state, then the external match is mapped to DBGSCRx bits
C3SC[1:0]. In this configuration, internal comparator channel3 is de-coupled from the state sequencer but
can still be used for timestamps. The DBGEFR bit EEVF is set when an external event occurs.
6.4.3.3 Setting The TRIG Bit
Independent of comparator matches it is possible to initiate a tracing session and/or breakpoint by writing
the TRIG bit in DBGC1 to a logic “1”. This forces the state sequencer into the Final S tate. If configured
for End aligned tracing or for no tracing, the transition to Final State is followed immediately by a
transition to S tate0. If configured for Begin- or Mid Aligned tracing, the state sequencer remains in Final
State until tracing is complete, then it transitions to State0.
Breakpoints, if enabled, are issued on the transition to State0.
6.4.3.4 Profiling Trace Buffer Overflow Event
During code profiling a trace buffer overflow forces the state sequencer into the disarmed State0 and, if
breakpoints are enabled, issues a breakpoint request to the CPU.
6.4.3.5 Event Priorities
If simultaneous events occur, the priority is resolved according to Table 6-45. Lower priority events are
suppressed. It is thus possible to miss a lower priority event if it occurs simultaneously with an event of a
higher priority. The event priorities dictate that in the case of simultaneous matches, the match on the
higher comparator channel number (3,2,1,0) has priority.
If a write access to DBGC1 with the ARM bit position set occurs simultaneously to a hardware disarm
from an internal event, then the ARM bit is cleared due to the hardware disarm.
Table 6-45. Event Priorities
Priority Source Action
Highest TB Overflow Immediate force to state 0, generate breakpoint and terminate tracing
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
208 Freescale Semiconductor
6.4.4 State Sequence Control
Figure 6-26. State Sequence r Diagram
The state sequencer allows a defined sequence of events to provide a breakpoint and/or a trigger point for
tracing of data in the trace buffer. When the DBG module is armed by setting the ARM bit in the DBGC1
register , the state sequencer enters S tate1. Further transitions between the states are controlled by the state
control registers and depend upon event occurrences (see Section 6.4.3). From Final State the only
permitted transition is back to the disarmed State0. Transition between the states 1 to 3 is not restricted.
Each transition updates the SSF[2:0] flags in DBGSR accordingly to indicate the current state. If
breakpoints are enabled, then an event based transition to State0 generates the breakpoint request. A
transition to State0 resulting from writing “0” to the ARM bit does not generate a breakpoint request.
6.4.4.1 Final State
On entering Final State a trigger may be issued to th e trace buffer according to the trigger position control
as defined by the TALIGN field (see Section 6.3.2.3”).
If tracing is enabled and either Begin or Mid aligned triggering is selected, the state sequencer remains in
Final State until completion of the trace. On completion of the trace the state sequencer returns to State0
and the debug module is disarmed; if breakpoints are enabled, a breakpoint request is generated.
If tracing is disabled or End aligned triggering is selected, then when the Final State is reached the state
sequencer returns to State0 immediately and the debug module is disarmed. If breakpoints are enabled, a
breakpoint request is generated on transitions to State0.
TRIG Force immediately to final state
DBGEEV Force to next state as defined by state control registers (EEVE=2’b10)
Match3 Force to next state as defined by state control registers
Match2 Force to next state as defined by state control registers
Match1 Force to next state as defined by state control registers
Lowest Match0 Force to next state as defined by state control registers
Table 6-45. Event Priorities
State1
Final State State3
ARM = 1
State2
State 0
(Disarmed)
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 209
6.4.5 Trace Buffer Operation
The trace buffer is a 64 lines deep by 64-bits wide RAM array . If the TSOURCE bit is set the DBG module
can store trace information in the RAM array in a circ ular buffer format. Data is stored in mode dependent
formats, as described in the following sections. After each trace buffer entry, the counter register
DBGCNT is incremented. Trace buffer rollover is possible when configured for End- or Mid-Aligned
tracing, such that older entries are replaced by newer entries. T racing of CPU activity is disabled when the
BDC is active.
The RAM array can be accessed through the register DBGTB using 16-bit wide word accesses. After each
read, the internal RAM pointer is incremented so that the next read will receive fresh information. Reading
the trace buffer whilst the DBG is armed returns invalid data and the trace buffer pointer is not
incremented.
In Detail mode the address range for CPU access tracing can be limited to a range specified by the
TRANGE bits in DBGTCRH. This function uses comparators C and D to define an address range inside
which accesses should be traced. Thus traced accesses can be restricted, for example, to particular register
or RAM range accesses.
The external event pin can be configured to force trace buffer entries in Normal or Loop1 trace modes. All
tracing modes support trace buffer gating. In Pure PC and Detail modes external events do not force trace
buffer entries.
If the external event pin is configured to gate trace buffer entries then any trace mode is valid.
6.4.5.1 Trace Trigger Alignment
Using the TALIGN bits (see Section 6.3.2.3”) it is possible to align the trigger with the end, the middle, or
the beginning of a tracing session.
If End or Mid-Alignment is selected, tracing begins when the ARM bit in DBGC1 is set and State1 is
entered. The transition to Final State if End-Alignment is selected, ends the tracing session. The transition
to Final State if Mid-Alignment is selected signals that another 32 lines are traced before ending the tracing
session. Tracing with Begin-Alignment starts at the trigger and ends when the trace buffer is full.
6.4.5.1.1 Storing with Begin-Alignment
S toring with Begin-Alignment, data is not stored in the trace buffer until the Final State is entered. Once
the trigger condition is met the DBG module remains armed until 64 lines are stored in the trace buffer.
Table 6-46. Tracing Alignment
TALIGN Tracing Begin Tracing End
00 On arming At trigger
01 At trigger When trace buffer is full
10 On arming When 32 trace buffer lines have
been filled after trigger
11 Reserved
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
210 Freescale Semiconductor
Using Begin-Alignment together with opcode address comparisons, if the instruction is about to be
executed then the trace is started. If the trigger is at the address of a COF instruction, whilst tracing COF
addresses, then that COF address is stored to the trace buffer. If breakpoints are enabled, the breakpoint is
generated upon entry into S tate0 on completion of the tracing session; thus the breakpoint does not occur
at the instruction boundary.
6.4.5.1.2 Storing with Mid-Alignment
Storing with Mid-Alignment, data is stored in the trace buffer as soon as the DBG module is armed. When
the trigger condition is met, another 32 lines are traced before ending the tracing session, irrespective of
the number of lines stored before the trigger occurred, then the DBG module is disarmed and no more data
is stored. Using Mid-Alignment with opcode address triggers, if the instruction is about to be executed then
the trace is continued for another 32 lines. If breakpoints are enabled, the breakpoint is generated upon
entry into State0 on completion of th e tracing session; thus the breakpoint does not occur at the instruction
boundary. When configured for Compressed Pure-PC tracing, the MAT info bit is set to indicate the last
PC entry before a trigger event.
6.4.5.1.3 Storing with End-Alignment
Storing with End-Alignment, data is stored in the trace buffer until the Final State is entered. Following
this trigger, the DBG module immediately transitions to State0. If the trigger is at the address of a COF
instruction the trigger event is not stored in the trace buffer.
6.4.5.2 Trace Modes
The DBG module can operate in four trace modes. The mode is selected using the TRCMOD bits in the
DBGTCRH register. Normal, Loop1 and Detail modes can be configured to store a timestamp with each
entry, by setting the STAMP bit. The modes are described in the following subsections.
In addition to the listed trace modes it is also possible to use code profiling to fill the trace buffer with a
highly compressed COF format. This can be subsequently read out in the same fashion as the listed trace
modes (see Section 6.4.6).
6.4.5.2.1 Normal Mode
In Normal Mode, change of flow (COF) program counter (PC) addresses are stored.
CPU COF addresses are defined as follows:
Source address of taken conditional branches (bit-conditional, and loop primitives)
Destination address of indexed JMP and JSR instruction.s
Destination address of RTI and RTS instructions.
Vector address of interrupts
BRA, BSR, BGND as well as non-indexed JMP and JSR instructions are not classified as change of flow
and are not stored in the trace buffer.
COF addresses stored include the full address bus of CPU and an information byte, which contains bits to
indicate whether the stored address was a source, destination or vector address.
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 211
NOTE
When a CPU indexed jump instruction is executed, the destination address
is stored to the trace buffer on instruction completion, indicating the COF
has taken place. If an interrupt occurs simultaneously then the next
instruction carried out is actually from the interrupt service routine. The
instruction at the destination address of the original program flow gets
executed after the interrupt service routine.
In the following example an IRQ interrupt occurs during execution of the
indexed JMP at address MARK1. The NOP at the destination (SUB_1) is
not executed until after the IRQ service routine but the destination address
is entered into the trace buffer to indicate that the indexed JMP COF has
taken place.
LD X,#SUB_1
MARK1: JMP (0,X) ; IRQ interrupt occurs during execution of this
MARK2: NOP ;
SUB_1: NOP ; JMP Destination address TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 1
; RTI Destination address TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 3
NOP ;
ADDR1: DBNE D0,PART5 ; Source address TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 4
IRQ_ISR: LD D1,#$F0 ; IRQ Vector $FFF2 = TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 2
ST D1,VAR_C1
RTI ;
The execution flow taking into account the IRQ is as follows
LD X,#SUB_1
MARK1: JMP (0,X) ;
IRQ_ISR: LD D1,#$F0 ;
ST D1,VAR_C1
RTI ;
SUB_1: NOP
NOP ;
ADDR1: DBNE D0,PART5 ;
The Normal Mode trace buffer format is shown in the following tables. Whilst tracing in Normal or Loop1
modes each array line contains 2 data entries, thus in this case the DBGCNT[0] is incremented after each
separate entry. Information byte bits indicate if an entry is a source, destination or vector address.
The external event input can force trace buf fer entries independent of COF occurrences, in which case the
EEVI bit is set and the PC value of the last instruction is stored to the trace buffer. If the external event
coincides with a COF buffer entry a single entry is made with the EEVI bit set.
Normal mode profiling with timestamp is possible when tracing from a single source by setting the
STAMP bit in DBGTCRL. This results in a different format (see Table 6-48).
Table 6-47. Normal and Loop1 Mode Trace Buffer Format without T imestamp
Mode 8-Byte Wide Trace Buffer Line
76543210
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
212 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 6-48. Normal and Loop1 Mode Trace Buffer Format with Timestamp
CINF contains information relating to the CPU.
CPU Information Byte CINF For Normal And Loop1 Modes
CPU CINF1 CPCH1 CPCM1 CPCL1 CINF0 CPCH0 CPCM0 CPCL0
CINF3 CPCH3 CPCM3 CPCL3 CINF2 CPCH2 CPCM2 CPCL2
Mode 8-Byte Wide Trace Buffer Line
76543210
CPU Timestamp Timestamp Reserved Reserved CINF0 CPCH0 CPCM0 CPCL0
Timestamp Timestamp Reserved Reserved CINF1 CPCH1 CPCM1 CPCL1
Bit 7Bit 6Bit 5Bit 4Bit 3Bit 2Bit 1Bit 0
CET 0 0 CTI EEVI 0 TOVF
Figure 6-27. CPU Information Byte CINF
Table 6-49. CINF Bit Descriptions
Field Description
7–6
CET
CPU Entry T ype Field Indicates the type of stored address of the trace buffer entry as described in Table 6-50
3
CTI
Comparator Timestamp Indicator — This bit indicates if the trace buffer entry corresponds to a comparator
timestamp.
0 Trace buffer entry initiated by trace mode specification conditions or timestamp counter overflow
1 Trace buffer entry initiated by comparator D match
2
EEVI
External Event Indicator — This bit indicates if the trace buffer entry corresponds to an external event.
0 Trace buffer entry not initiated by an external event
1 Trace buffer entry initiated by an external event
0
TOVF
Timestamp Overflow Indicator — Indicates if the trace buffer entry corresponds to a timestamp overflow
0 Trace buffer entry not initiated by a timestamp overflow
1 Trace buffer entry initiated by a timestamp overflow
Table 6-50. CET Encoding
CET Entry Type Description
00 Non COF opcode address (entry forced by an external event)
01 Vector destination address
10 Source address of COF opcode
11 Destination address of COF opcode
Table 6-47. Normal and Loop1 Mode Trace Buffer Format without T imestamp
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 213
6.4.5.2.2 Loop1 Mode
Loop1 Mode, similarly to Normal Mode also stores only COF address information to the trace buffer, it
however allows the filtering out of redundant information.
The intent of Loop1 Mode is to prevent the trace buffer from being filled entirely with duplicate
information from a looping construct such as delays using the DBNE instruction. The DBG monitors trace
buffer entries and prevents consecutive duplicate address entries resulting from repeated branches.
Loop1 Mode only inhibits consecutive duplicate source address entries that would typically be stored in
most tight looping constructs. It does not inhibit repeated entries of destination addresses or vector
addresses, since repeated entries of these could indicate a bug in application code that the DBG module is
designed to help find.
The trace buffer format for Loop1 Mode is the same as that of Normal Mode.
6.4.5.2.3 Detail Mode
When tracing CPU activity in Detail Mode, address and data of data and vector accesses are traced. The
information byte indicates the size of access and the type of access (read or write).
ADRH, ADRM, ADRL denote address high, middle and low byte respectively. The numerical suffix
indicates which tracing step. DBGCNT increments by 2 for each line completed.
If timestamps are enabled then each CPU entry can span 2 trace buffer lines, whereby the second line
includes the timestamp. If a valid PC occurs in the same cycle as the timestamp, it is also stored to the trace
buffer and the PC bit is set. The second line featuring the timestamp is on ly stored if no further data access
occurs in the following cycle. This is shown in Table 6-52, where data accesses 2 and 3 occur in
consecutive cycles, suppressing the entry2 timestamp. If 2 lines are used for an entry, then DBGCNT
increments by 4. A timestamp line is indicated by bit1 in the TSINF byte. The timestamp counter is only
reset each time a timestamp line entr y is made. It is not reset when the data and address trace buffer line
entry is made.
Table 6-51. Detail Mode Trace Buffer Format without Timestamp
Mode 8-Byte Wide Trace Buffer Line
76543210
CPU
Detail
CDATA31 CDATA21 CDATA11 CDATA01 CINF1 CADRH1 CADRM1 CADRL1
CDATA32 CDATA22 CDATA12 CDATA02 CINF2 CADRH2 CADRM2 CADRL2
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
214 Freescale Semiconductor
Detail Mode data entries store the bytes aligned to the address of the MSB accessed (Byte1 Table 6-53).
Thus accesses split across 32-bit boundaries are wrapped around.
Table 6-53. Detail Mode Data Byte Alignment
Information Bytes
When tracing in Detail Mode, CINF provides information about the type of CPU access being made.
Table 6-52. Detail Mode Trace Buffer Format with Timestamp
Mode 8-Byte Wide Trace Buffer Line
76543210
CPU
Detail
CDATA31 CDATA21 CDATA11 CDATA01 CINF1 CADRH1 CADRM1 CADRL1
Timestamp Timestamp Reserved Reserved TSINF1 CPCH1 CPCM1 CPCL1
CDATA32 CDATA22 CDATA12 CDATA02 CINF2 CADRH2 CADRM2 CADRL2
CDATA33 CDATA23 CDATA13 CDATA03 CINF3 CADRH3 CADRM3 CADRL3
Timestamp Timestamp Reserved Reserved TSINF3 CPCH3 CPCM3 CPCL3
Access
Address Access
Size CDATA31 CDATA21 CDATA11 CDATA01
00 32-bit Byte1 Byte2 Byte3 Byte4
01 32-bit Byte4 Byte1 Byte2 Byte3
10 32-bit Byte3 Byte4 Byte1 Byte2
11 32-bit Byte2 Byte3 Byte4 Byte1
00 24-bit Byte1 Byte2 Byte3
01 24-bit Byte1 Byte2 Byte3
10 24-bit Byte3 Byte1 Byte2
11 24-bit Byte2 Byte3 Byte1
00 16-bit Byte1 Byte2
01 16-bit Byte1 Byte2
10 16-bit Byte1 Byte2
11 16-bit Byte2 Byte1
00 8-bit Byte 1
01 8-bit Byte1
10 8-bit Byte1
11 8-bit Byte1
Denotes byte that is not accessed.
BYTE Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
CINF CSZ CRW 0 0 0 0 0
TSINF 0 0 0 0 CTI PC 1 TOVF
Figure 6-28. Information Bytes CINF and XINF
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 215
TSINF provides information about a timestamp. Bit1 indicates if the byte is a TSINF byte.
6.4.5.2.4 Pure PC Mode
In Pure PC Mode, the PC addresses of all opcodes loaded into the execution stage, including illegal
opcodes, are stored.
Tracing from a single source, compression is implemented to increase the effective trace depth. A
compressed entry consists of the lowest PC byte only. A full entry consists of all PC bytes. If the PC
remains in the same 256 byte range, then a compressed entry is made, otherwise a full entry is made. The
full entry is always the last entry of a record.
Each trace buffer line consists of 7 payload bytes, PLB0-6, containing full or compressed CPU PC
addresses and 1 information byte to indicate the type of entry (compressed or base address) for each
payload byte.
Each trace buffer line is filled from right to left. The final entry on each line is always a base address, used
as a reference for the previous entries on the same line. Whilst tracing, a base address is typically stored
Table 6-54. CINF Field Descriptions
Field Description
7–6
CSZ
Access Type Indicator — This field indicates the CPU access size.
00 8-bit Access
0116-bit Access
10 24-bit Access
11 32-bit Access
5
CRW
Read/W rite Indicator — Indicates if the corresponding stored address corresponds to a read or write access.
0 Write Access
1 Read Access
Table 6-55. TSINF Field Descriptions
Field Description
3
CTI
Comparator Timestamp Indicator — This bit indicates if the trace buffer entry corresponds to a comparator
timestamp.
0 Trace buffer entry initiated by trace mode specification conditions or timestamp counter overflow
1 Trace buffer entry initiated by comparator D match
2
PC
Program Counter Valid Indicator — Indicates if the PC entry is valid on the timestamp line.
0 Trace buffer entry does not include PC value
1 Trace buffer entry includes PC value
0
TOVF
Timestamp Overflow Indicator — Indicates if the trace buffer entry corresponds to a timestamp overflow
0 Trace buffer entry not initiated by a timestamp overflow
1 Trace buffer entry initiated by a timestamp overflow
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
216 Freescale Semiconductor
in bytes[6:4], the other payload bytes may be compressed or complete addresses as indicated by the info
byte bits.
If the info bit for byte3 indicates a full CPU PC address, whereby bytes[5:3] are used, then the info bit
mapped to byte[4] is redundant and the byte[6] is unused because a line overflow has occurred. Similarly
a base address stored in bytes[4:2] causes line overflow, so bytes[6:5] are unused.
CXINF[6:4] indicate how many bytes in a line contain valid data, since tracing may terminate before a
complete line has been filled.
CXINF Information Byte Source Tracing
Pure PC mode tracing does not support timestamps or external event entries.
6.4.5.3 Timestamp
When set, the STAMP bit in DBGTCRL configures the DBG to add a timestamp to trace buffer en tries in
Normal, Loop1 and Detail trace buffer modes. The timestamp is generated from a 16-bit counter and is
stored to the trace buffer line each time a trace buffer entry is made.
Table 6-56. Pure PC Mode Trace Bu ff er Fo rmat Sin gl e Sour ce
Mode 8-Byte Wide Trace Buffer Line
76543210
CPU CXINF BASE BASE BASE PLB3 PLB2 PLB1 PLB0
76543 210
CXINF MAT PLEC NB3 NB2 NB1 NB0
Figure 6-29. Pure PC Mode CXINF
Table 6-57. CXINF Field Descriptions
Field Description
MAT Mid Aligned Trigger— This bit indicates a mid aligned trigger position. When a mid aligned trigger occurs, the
next trace buffer entry is a base address and the counter is incremented to a new line, independent of the number
of bytes used on the current line. The MAT bit is set on the current line, to indicate the position of the trigger.
When configured for begin or end aligned trigger, this bit has no meaning.
NOTE: In the case when ARM and TRIG are simultaneously set together in the same cycle that a new PC value
is registered, then this PC is stored to the same trace buffer line and MAT set.
0 Line filled without mid aligned trigger occurrence
1 Line last entry is the last PC entry before a mid aligned trigger
PLEC[2:0] Payload Entry Count— This field indicates the number of valid bytes in the trace buffer line
Binary encoding is used to indicate up to 7 valid bytes.
NBx Payload Compression IndicatorThis field indicates if the corresponding payload byte is the lowest byte of a
base PC entry
0 Corresponding payload byte is a not the lowest byte of a base PC entry
1 Corresponding payload byte is the lowest byte of a base PC entry
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 217
The number of core clock cycles since the last entry equals the timestamp + 1. The core clock runs at twice
the frequency of the bus clock. The timestamp of the first trace buffer entry is 0x0000. With timestamps
enabled trace buffer entries are initiated in the following ways:
according to the trace mode specification, for example COF PC addresses in Normal mode
on a timestamp counter overflow
If the timestamp counter reaches 0xFFFF then a trace buffer entry is made, with timestamp=
0xFFFF and the timestamp overflow bit TOVF is set.
on a match of comparator D
If STAMP and DSTAMP are set then comparator D is used for forcing trace buffer entries with
timestamps. The state control register settings determine if comparator D is also used to trigger the
state sequencer. Thus if the state control register configuration does not use comparator D, then it
is used solely for the timestamp function. If comparator D initiates a timestamp then the CTI bit is
set in the INFO byte. This can be used in Normal/Loop1 mode to indicate when a particular data
access occurs relative to the PC flow. For example when the timing of an access may be unclear
due to the use of indexes.
NOTE
If comparator D is configured to match a PC address then associated
timestamps trigger a trace buffer entry during execution of the previous
instruction. Thus the PC stored to the trace buffer is that of the previous
instruction.The comparator must contain the PC address of the instruction’ s
first opcode byte
Timestamps are disabled in Pure PC mode.
6.4.5.4 Reading Data from Trace Buffer
The data stored in the trace buffer can be read using either the background debug controller (BDC) module
or the CPU provided the DBG module is not armed and is configured for tracing by TSOURCE. When the
ARM bit is set the trace buffer is locked to prevent reading. The trace buffer can only be unlocked for
reading by an aligned word write to DBGTB when the module is disarmed. The trace buffer can only be
read through the DBGTB register using aligned word reads. Reading the trace buffer while the DBG
module is armed, or trace buffer locked returns 0xEE and no shifting of the RAM pointer occurs. Any byte
or misaligned reads return 0xEE and do not cause the trace buffer pointer to increment to the next trace
buffer address.
Reading the trace buffer is prevented by internal hardware whilst profiling is active because the RAM
pointer is used to indicate the next row to be transmitted. Thus attempted reads of DBGTB do not return
valid data when the PROFILE bit is set. To initialize the pointer and read profiling data, the PROFILE bit
must be cleared and remain cleared.
The trace buf fer data is read out first-in first-out. By reading CNT in DBGCNT the number of valid 64-bit
lines can be determined. DBGCNT does not decrement as data is read.
Whilst reading, an internal pointer is used to determine the next line to be read. After a tracing session, the
pointer points to the oldest data entry, thus if no overflow has occurred, the pointer points to line0. The
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
218 Freescale Semiconductor
pointer is initialized by each aligned write to DBGTB to point to the oldest data again. This enables an
interrupted trace buffer read sequence to be easily restarted from the oldest data entry. After reading all
trace buffer lines, the next read wraps around and returns the contents of line0.
The least significant word of each 64-bit wide array line is read out first. All bytes, including those
containing invalid information are read out.
6.4.5.5 Trace Buffer Reset State
The trace buffer contents are not initialized by a system res et. Thus shou ld a system reset occur, the trace
session information from immediately before the reset occurred can be read out. The DBGCNT bits are
not cleared by a system reset. Thus should a reset occur, the number of valid lines in the trace buffer is
indicated by DBGCNT. The internal pointer is cleared by a system reset. It can be initialized by an aligned
word write to DBGTB following a reset during debugging, so that it points to the oldest valid data again.
Debugging occurrences of system resets is best handled using mid or end trigger alignment since the reset
may occur before the trace trigger , which in the begin trigger alignment case means no information would
be stored in the trace buffer.
6.4.6 Code Profiling
6.4.6.1 Code Profiling Overview
Code profiling supplies encoded COF information on the PDO pin and the reference clock on the
PDOCLK pin. If the TSOURCE bit is set then code profiling is enabled by setting the PROFILE bit. The
associated device pin is configured for code profiling by setting the PDOE bit. Once enabled, code
profiling is activated by arming the DBG. During profiling, if PDOE is set, the PDO operates as an output
pin at a half the internal bus frequency, driving both high and low.
Independent of PDOE status, profiling data is stored to the trace buffer and can be read out in the usual
manner when the debug session ends and the PROFILE bit has been cleared.
The external debugger uses both edges of the clock output to strobe the data on PDO. The first PDOCLK
edge is used to sample the first data bit on PDO.
Figure 6-30. Profiling Output Interface
DEV TOOL
PDO
PDOCLK DATA
CLOCK
DBG
TBUF
MCU
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 219
Figure 6-31 shows the profiling clock, PDOCLK, whose edges are offset from the bus clock, to ease setup
and hold time requirements relative to PDO, which is synchronous to the bus clock.
Figure 6-31. PDO Profiling Clock Control
The trace buffer is us ed as a temporary storage medium to store COF in formation before it is transmitted.
COF information can be transmitted whilst new informat ion is written to the trace buffer. The trace buffer
data is transmitted at PDO least significant bit firs t. After the first trace buf fer entry is made, transmission
begins in the first clock period in which no further data is written to the trace buffer.
If a trace buffer line transmission completes before the next trace buffer line is ready , then the clock output
is held at a constant level until the line is ready for transfer.
6.4.6.2 Profiling Configuration, Alignment and Mode Dependencies
The PROFILE bit must be set and the DBG armed to enable profiling. Furthermore the PDOE bit must be
set to configure the PDO and PDOCLK pins for profiling.
If TALIGN is configured for End-Aligned tracing then profiling begins as soon as the module is armed.
If TALIGN is configured for Begin-aligned tracing, then profiling begins when the state sequencer enters
Final State and continues until a software disarm or trace buffer overflow occurs; thus profiling does not
terminate after 64 line entries have been made.
Mid-Align tracing is not supported whilst profiling; if the TALIGN bits are configured for Mid-Align
tracing when PROFILE is set, then the alignment defaults to end alignment.
Profiling entries continue until either a trace buf fer overflow occurs or the DBG is disarmed by a state
machine transition to State0. The profiling output transmission continues, even after disarming, until all
trace buffer entries have been transmitted. The PTACT bit indicates if a profiling transmission is still
active. The PTBOVF indicates if a trace buffer overflow has occurred.
The profiling timestamp feature is used only for the PTVB and PTW formats, thus differing from
timestamps offered in other modes.
Profiling does not support trace buffer gating. The external pin gating feature is ignored during profiling.
When the DBG module is disarmed but profiling transmission is ongoing, register write accesses are
suppressed.
When the DBG module is disarmed but profiling transmission is still ongoing, reading from the DBGTB
returns the code 0xEE.
BUS CLOCK
PDO
STROBE
CLOCK ENABLE
PDOCLK
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
220 Freescale Semiconductor
6.4.6.3 Code Profiling Internal Data Storage Format
When profiling starts, the first trace buffer entry is made to provide the start address. This uses a 4 byte
format (PTS), including the INFO byte and a 3-byte PC start address. In order to avoid trace buffer
overflow a fully compressed format is used for direct (conditional branch) COF information.
Ta ble 6-58. Profiling Trace buffer line format
The INFO byte indicates the line format used. Up to 4 bytes of each line are dedicated to branch COFs.
Further bytes are used for storing indirect COF information (indexed jumps and interrupt vectors). Indexed
jumps force a full line entry with the PTIB format and require 3-bytes for the full 24-bit destination
address. Interrupts force a full line entry with the PTVB format, whereby vectors are stored as a single byte
and a 16-bit timestamp value is stored simultaneously to indicate the number of bus cycles relative to the
previous COF. At each trace buffer entry the 16-bit timestamp counter is cleared. The device vectors use
address[8:0] whereby address[1:0] are constant zero for vectors. Thus the value stored to the PTVB vector
byte is equivalent to (Vector Address[8:1]).
After the PTS entry, the pointer increments and the DBG begins to fill the next line with direct COF
information. This continues until the direct COF field is full or an indirect COF occurs, then the INFO byte
and, if needed, indirect COF information are entered on that line and the pointer increments to the next line.
If a timestamp overflow occurs, indicating a 65536 bus clock cycles without COF, then an entry is made
with the TSOVF bit set, INFO[6] (Table 6-59) and profiling continues.
If a trace buffer overflow occu rs, a final entry is made with the TBOVF bit set, profiling is terminated and
the DBG is disarmed. Trace buffer overflow occurs when the trace buffer contains 64 lines pending
transmission.
Whenever the DBG is disarmed during profiling, a final entry is made with the TERM bit set to indicate
the final entry.
When a final entry is made then by default the PTW line format is used, except if a COF occurs in the same
cycle in which case the corresponding PTIB/PTVB/PTHF format is used. Since the development tool
receives the INFO byte first, it can determine in advance the format of data it is about to receive. The
Format 8-Byte Wide Trace Buffer Line
76543210
PTS PC Start Address INFO
PTIB Indirect Indirect Indirect Direct Direct Direct Direct INFO
PTHF 0 Direct Direct Direct Direct INFO
PTVB Timestamp Timestamp Vector Direct Direct Direct Direct INFO
PTW Timestamp Timestamp 0 Direct Direct Direct Direct INFO
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 221
transmission of the INFO byte starts when a line is complete. Whole bytes are always transmitted. The
grey shaded bytes of Table 6-58 are not transmitted.
Figure 6-32. INFO byte encoding
Table 6-59. Profiling Format Enco di ng
6.4.6.4 Direct COF Compression
Each branch COF is stored to the trace buf fer as a single bit (0=branch not taken, 1=branch taken) until an
indirect COF (indexed jump, return, or interrupt) occurs. The branch COF entries are stored in the byte
fields labelled “Direc t” in Table 6-58. These entries start at byte1[0] and continue through to byte4[7], or
until an indirect COF occurs, whichever occurs sooner. The entries use a format whereby the left most
asserted bit is always the stop bit, which indicates that the bit to its right is the first direct COF and byte1[0]
is the last COF that occurred before the indirect COF. This is shown in Table 6-60, whereby the Bytes 4 to
1 of the trace buffer are shown for 3 different cases. The stop bit field for each line is shaded.
In line0, the left most asserted bit is Byte4[7]. This indicates that all remaining 31 bits in the 4-byte field
contain valid direct COF information, whereby each 1 represents branch taken and each 0 represents
branch not taken. The stop bit of line1 indicates that all 30 bits to it’s right are valid, after the 30th direct
COF entry, an indirect COF occurred, that is stored in bytes 7 to 5. In this case the bit to the left of the stop
bit is redundant. Line2 indicates that an indirect COF occurred after 8 direct COF entries. The indirect COF
address is stored in bytes 7 to 5. All bits to the left of the stop bit are redundant.
76543210
0 TSOVF TBOVF TERM Line Format
INFO[3:0] Line Format Source Description
0000 PTS CPU Initial CPU entry
0001 PTIB CPU Indexed jump with up to 31 direct COFs
0010 PTHF CPU 31 direct COFs without indirect COF
0011 PTVB CPU Vector with up to 31 direct COFs
0111 PTW CPU Error (Error codes in INFO[7:4])
Others Reserved CPU Reserved
INFO[7:4] Bit Name Description
INFO[7] Reserved CPU Reserved
INFO[6] TSOVF CPU Timestamp Overflow
INFO[5] TBOVF CPU Trace Buffer Overflow
INFO[4] TERM CPU Profiling terminated by disarming
Vector[7:0] Vector[7:0] CPU Device Interrupt Vector Address [8:1]
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
222 Freescale Semiconductor
6.4.7 Breakpoints
Breakpoints can be generated by state sequencer transitions to State0. Transitions to S tate0 are forced by
the following events
Through comparator matches via Final State.
Through software writing to the TRIG bit in the DBGC1 register via Final State.
Through the external event input (DBGEEV) via Final State.
Through a profiling trace buffer overflow event.
Breakpoints are not generated by software writes to DBGC1 that clear the ARM bit.
6.4.7.1 Breakpoints From Comparator Matches or External Events
Breakpoints can be generated when the state sequencer transitions to State0 following a comparator match
or an external event.
If a tracing session is selected by TSOURCE, the transition to State0 occurs when the tracing session has
completed, thus if Begin or Mid aligned triggering is selected, the breakpoint is requested only on
completion of the subsequent trace. If End aligned tracing or no tracing session is selected, the transition
to State0 and associated breakpoints are immediate.
6.4.7.2 Breakpoints Generated Via The TRIG Bit
When TRIG is written to “1”, the Final State is entered. If a tracing session is selected by TSOURCE,
State0 is entered and breakpoints are requested only when the tracing session has completed, thus if Begin
or Mid aligned triggering is selected, the breakpoint is requested only on completion of the subsequent
trace. If no tracing session is selected, the state sequencer enters State0 immediately and breakpoints are
requested. TRIG breakpoints are possible even if the DBG module is disarmed.
6.4.7.3 DBG Breakpoint Priorities
If a TRIG occurs after Begin or Mid aligned tracing has already been triggered by a comparator instigated
transition to Final State, then TRIG no longer has an effect. When the associated tracing session is
complete, the breakpoint occurs. Similarly if a TRIG is followed by a subsequent comparator match, it has
no effect, since tracing has already started.
Line Byte4 Byte3 Byte2 Byte1
Line0 10010010010110010010000110000110
Line1 0 1100101100100101100100101100100
Line2 00000000000000000000000100010001
Table 6-60. Profiling Direct COF Format
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 223
6.4.7.3.1 DBG Breakpoint Priorities And BDC Interfacing
Breakpoint operation is dependent on the state of the S12ZBDC module. BDM cannot be entered from a
breakpoint unless the BDC is enabled (ENBDC bit is set in the BDC). If BDM is already active,
breakpoints are disabled. In addition, while executing a BDC STEP1 command, breakpoints are disabled.
When the DBG breakpoints are mapped to BDM (BDMBP set), then if a breakpoint request, either from
a BDC BACKGROUND command or a DBG event, coincides with an SWI instruction in application
code, (i.e. the DBG requests a breakpoint at the next instruction boundary and the next instruction is an
SWI) then the CPU gives priority to the BDM request over the SWI request.
On returning from BDM, the SWI from user code gets executed. Breakpoint generation control is
summarized in Table 6-61.
6.5 Application Information
6.5.1 Avoiding Unintended Breakpoint Re-triggering
Returning from an instruction address breakpoint using an RTI or BDC GO command without PC
modification, returns to the instruction that generated the breakpoint. If an active breakpoint or trigger still
exists at that address, this can re-trigger , disarming the DBG. If configured for BDM breakpoints, the user
must apply the BDC STEP1 command to increment the PC past the current instruction.
If configured for SWI breakpoints, the DBG can be re configured in the SWI routine. If a comparator
match occurs at an SWI vector address then a code SWI and DBG breakpoint SWI could occur
simultaneously. In this case the SWI routine is executed twice before returning.
6.5.2 Debugging Through Reset
To debug through reset, the debugger can recognize a reset occurrence and pull the device BKGD pin low .
This forces the device to leave reset in special single chip (SSC) mode, because the BKGD pin is used as
the MODC signal in the reset phase. When the device leaves reset in SSC mode, CPU execution is halted
and the device is in active BDM. Thus the debugger can configure the DBG for tracing and breakpoints
before returning to application code execution. In this way it is possible to analyze the sequence of events
emerging from reset. The recommended handling of the internal reset scenario is as follows:
Table 6-61. Breakpoint Mapping Summary
BRKCPU BDMBP Bit
(DBGC1[4]) BDC
Enabled BDM
Active Breakpoint
Mapping
0 X X X No Breakpoint
1 0 X 0 Breakpoint to SWI
1011 No Breakpoint
1 1 0 X No Breakpoint
1110 Breakpoint to BDM
1111 No Breakpoint
Chapter 6 S12Z Debug (S12ZDBGV2) Module
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
224 Freescale Semiconductor
When a reset occurs the debugger pulls BKGD low until the reset ends, forcing SSC mode entry.
Then the debugger reads the reset flags to determine the cause of reset.
If required, the debugger can read the trace buf fer to see what happened just before reset. Since the
trace buffer and DBGCNT register are not affected by resets other than POR.
The debugger configures and arms the DBG to start tracing on returning to application code.
The debugger then sets the PC according to the reset flags.
Then the debugger returns to user code with GO or STEP1.
6.5.3 Breakpoints from other S12Z sources
The DBG is neither affected by CPU BGND instructions, nor by BDC BACKGROUND commands.
6.5.4 Code Profiling
The code profiling data output pin PDO is mapped to a device pin that can also be used as GPIO in an
application. If profiling is required and all pins are required in the application, it is recommended to use
the device pin for a simple output function in the application, without feedback to the chip. In this way the
application can still be profiled, since the pin has no effect on code flow.
The PDO provides a simple bit stream that must be strobed at both edges of the profiling clock when
profiling. The external development tool activates profiling by setting the DBG ARM bit, with PROFI LE
and PDOE already set. Thereafter the first bit of the profiling bit stream is valid at the first rising edge of
the profiling clock. No start bit is provided. The external development tool must detect this first rising edge
after arming the DBG. To detect the end of profiling, the DBG ARM bit can be monitored using the BDC.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 225
Chapter 7
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit
(S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
Table 7-1. Revision History
7.1 Introduction
This specification describes the function of the Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit
(S12CPMU_UHV_V6).
The Pierce oscillator (XOSCLCP) provides a robust, low-noise and low-power external clock
source. It is designed for optimal start-up margin with typical crystal oscillators.
The Voltage regulator (VREGAUTO) operates from the range 6V to 18V. It provides all the
required chip internal voltages and voltage monitors.
The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) provides a highly accurate frequency multiplier with internal filter.
The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) provides a 1MHz internal clock.
Rev. No.
(Item No) Date
(Submitted By) Sections Affected Substantial Change(s)
V06.04 21 Aug. 2013
corrected bit numbering for CSAD Bit
•f
PLLRST changed to fVCORST
corrected typo in heading of CPMUOSC2 Field Description
changed frequency upper limit of external Pierce Oscillator
(XOSCLCP) from 16MHz to 20MHz
V06.05 3 Jan. 2014 corrected description of CSAD Bit
V06.06 18 June 2014 added functional safety tags
V06.07 21 Oct. 2014
Improved Figure: Start up of clock system after Reset
Improved Figure: Full stop mode using Oscillator
Improved Figure: Enabling the external oscillator
Improved Table: Trimming effect of ACLKTR
Improved Table: Trimming effect of HTTR
Register Description for CPMUHTCTL: Added note on how to
compute VHT
Functional Description PBE Mode: Added Note that the clock
system might stall if osc monitor reset disabled (OMRE=0)
Signal Descriptions: added BCTLC pin
Signal Descriptions: changed recommended resistor for BCTL
pin to 1K
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
226 Freescale Semiconductor
7.1.1 Features
The Pierce Oscillator (XOSCLCP) contains circuitry to dynamically control current gain in the output
amplitude. This ensures a signal with low harmonic distortion, low power and good noise immunity.
Supports crystals or resonators from 4MHz to 20MHz.
High noise immunity due to input hysteresis and spike filtering.
Low RF emissions with peak-to-peak swing limited dynamically
Transconductance (gm) sized for optimum start-up margin for typical crystals
Dynamic gain control eliminates the need for external current limiting resistor
Integrated resistor eliminates the need for external bias resistor
Low power consumption: Operates from internal 1.8V (nominal) supply , Amplitude control limits
power
Optional oscillator clock monitor reset
Optional full swing mode for higher immunity against noise injection on the cost of higher power
consumption and increased emission
The Voltage Regulator (VREGAUTO) has the following features:
Input voltage range from 6 to 18V (nominal operating range)
Low-voltage detect (LVD) with low-voltage interrupt (LVI)
Power-on reset (POR)
Low-voltage reset (LVR)
On Chip Temperature Sensor and Bandgap Voltage measurement via internal ADC channel.
Voltage Regulator providing Full Performance Mode (FPM) and Reduced Performance Mode
(RPM)
External ballast device support to reduce internal power dissipation
Capable of supplying both the MCU internally plus external components
Over-temperature interrupt
The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) has the following features:
Highly accurate and phase locked frequency multiplier
Configurable internal filter for best stability and lock time
Frequency modulation for defined jitter and reduced emission
Automatic frequency lock detector
Interrupt request on entry or exit from locked condition
PLL clock monitor reset
Reference clock either external (crystal) or internal square wave (1MHz IRC1M) based.
PLL stability is sufficient for LIN communication in slave mode, even if using IRC1M as reference
clock
The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) has the following features:
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 227
Frequency trimming
(A factory trim value for 1MHz is loaded from Flash Memory into the IRCTRIM register after
reset, which can be overwritten by application if required)
Temperature Coefficient (TC) trimming.
(A factory trim value is loaded from Flash Memory into the IRCTRIM register to turn off TC
trimming after reset. Application can trim the TC if required by overwriting the IRCTRIM
register).
Other features of the S12CPMU_UHV_V6 include
Oscillator clock monitor to detect loss of crystal
Autonomous periodical interrupt (API)
Bus Clock Generator
Clock switch to select either PLLCLK or external crystal/resonator based Bus Clock
PLLCLK divider to adjust system speed
System Reset genera tion from the following possible sources:
Power-on reset (POR)
Low-voltage reset (LVR)
COP system watchdog, COP reset on time-out, windowed COP
Loss of oscillation (Oscillator clock monitor fail)
Loss of PLL clock (PLL clock monitor fail)
External pin RESET
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
228 Freescale Semiconductor
7.1.2 Modes of Operation
This subsection lists and briefly describes all operating modes supported by the S12CPMU_UHV_V6.
7.1.2.1 Run Mode
The voltage regulator is in Full Performance Mode (FPM).
NOTE
The voltage regulator is active, providing the nominal supply voltages with
full current sourcing capability (see also Appendix for VREG electrical
parameters). The features ACLK clock source, Low Voltage Interrupt (LVI),
Low Voltage Reset (LVR) and Power-On Reset (POR) are available.
The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) is on.
The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) is on.
The API is available.
PLL Engaged Internal (PEI)
This is the default mode after System Reset and Power-On Reset.
The Bus Clock is based on the PLLCLK.
After reset the PLL is configured for 50MHz VCOCLK operation.
Post divider is 0x03, so PLLCLK is VCOCLK divided by 4, that is 12.5MHz and Bus Clock is
6.25MHz.
The PLL can be re-configured for other bus frequencies.
The reference clock for the PLL (REFCLK) is based on internal reference clock IRC1M.
PLL Engaged External (PEE)
The Bus Clock is based on the PLLCLK.
This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps:
Configure the PLL for desired bus frequency.
Program the reference divider (REFDIV[3:0] bits) to divide down oscillator frequency if
necessary.
Enable the external oscillator (OSCE bit).
Wait for oscillator to start up (UPOSC=1) and PLL to lock (LOCK=1).
PLL Bypassed External (PBE)
The Bus Clock is based on the Oscillator Clock (OSCCLK).
The PLLCLK is always on to qualify the external oscillator clock. Therefore it is necessary to
make sure a valid PLL configuration is used for the selected oscillator frequency.
This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps:
Make sure the PLL configuration is valid for the selected oscillator frequency.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 229
Enable the external oscillator (OSCE bit).
Wait for oscillator to start up (UPOSC=1).
Select the Oscillator Clock (OSCCLK) as source of the Bus Clock (PLLSEL=0).
The PLLCLK is on and used to qualify the external oscillator clock.
7.1.2.2 Wait Mode
For S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Wait Mode is the same as Run Mode.
7.1.2.3 Stop Mode
This mode is entered by executing the CPU STOP instruction.
The voltage regulator is in Reduced Performance Mode (RPM).
NOTE
The voltage regulator output voltage may degrade to a lower value than in
Full Performance Mode (FPM), additionally the current sourcing capability
is substantially reduced (see also Appendix for VREG electrical
parameters). Only clock source ACLK is available and th e Power On Reset
(POR) circuitry is functional. The Low Voltage Interrupt (LVI) and Low
Voltage Reset (LVR) are disabled.
The API is available.
The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) is off.
The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) is off.
Core Clock and Bus Clock are stopped.
Depending on the setting of the PSTP and the OSCE bit, Stop Mode can be differentiated between Full
Stop Mode (PSTP = 0 or OSCE=0) and Pseudo Stop Mode (PSTP = 1 and OSCE=1). In addition, the
behavior of the COP in each mode will change based on the clocking method selected by
COPOSCSEL[1:0].
Full Stop Mode (PSTP = 0 or OSCE=0)
External oscillator (XOSCLCP) is disabled.
If COPOSCSEL1=0:
The COP and RTI counters halt during Full Stop Mode.
After wake-up from Full Stop Mode the Core Clock and Bus Clock are running on PLLCLK
(PLLSEL=1). COP and RTI are running on IRCCLK (COPOSCSEL0=0, RTIOSCSEL=0).
If COPOSCSEL1=1:
The clock for the COP is derived from ACLK (trimmable internal RC-Oscillator clock). During
Full Stop Mode the ACLK for the COP can be stopped (COP static) or running (COP active)
depending on the setting of bit CSAD. When bit CSAD is set the ACLK clock source for the
COP is stopped during Full Stop M ode and COP continues to operate after exit from Full S top
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
230 Freescale Semiconductor
Mode. For this COP configuration (ACLK clock source, CSAD set) a latency time (please refer
to CSAD bit description for details) occurs when entering or exiting (Full, Pseudo) Stop Mode.
When bit CSAD is clear the ACLK clock source is on for the COP during Full S top Mode and
COP is operating.
During Full Stop Mode the RTI counter halts.
After wake-up from Full Stop Mode the Core Clock and Bus Clock are running on PLLCLK
(PLLSEL=1). The COP runs on ACLK and RTI is running on IRCCLK (COPOSCSEL0=0,
RTIOSCSEL=0).
Pseudo Stop Mode (PSTP = 1 and OSCE=1)
External oscillator (XOSCLCP) continues to run.
If COPOSCSEL1=0:
If the respective enable bits are set (PCE=1 and PRE= 1) the COP and RTI will continue to run
with a clock derived from the oscillator clock.
The clock configuration bits PLLSEL, COPOSCSEL0, RTIOSCSEL are unchanged.
If COPOSCSEL1=1:
If the respective enable bit for the RTI is set (PRE=1) the RTI will continue to run with a clock
derived from the oscillator clock.
The clock for the COP is derived from ACLK (trimmable internal RC-Oscillator clock). During
Pseudo Stop Mode the ACLK for the COP can be stopped (COP static) or running (COP active)
depending on the setting of bit CSAD. When bit CSAD is set the ACLK for the COP is stopped
during Pseudo Stop Mode and COP continues to operate after exit from Pseudo Stop Mode.
For this COP configuration (ACLK clock source, CSAD set) a latency time (please refer to
CSAD bit description for details) occurs when entering or exiting (Pseudo, Full) Stop Mode.
When bit CSAD is clear the ACLK clock source is on for the COP during Pseudo Stop Mode
and COP is operating.
The clock configuration bits PLLSEL, COPOSCSEL0, RTIOSCSEL are unchanged.
NOTE
When starting up the external oscillator (either by programming OSCE bit
to 1 or on exit from Full S top Mode with OSCE bit already 1) the software
must wait for a minimum time equivalent to the startup-time of the external
oscillator tUPOSC before entering Pseudo Stop Mode.
7.1.2.4 Freeze Mode (BDM active)
For S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Freeze Mode is the same as Run Mode except for RTI and COP which can be
frozen in Active BDM Mode with the RSBCK bit in the CPMUCOP register. After exiting BDM Mode
RTI and COP will resume its operations starting from this frozen status.
Additionally the COP can be forced to the maximum time-out period in Active BDM Mode. For details
please see also the RSBCK and CR[2:0] bit description field of Table 7-14 in Section 7.3.2.10,
“S12CPMU_UHV_V6 COP Control Register (CPMUCOP)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 231
7.1.3 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Block Diagram
Figure 7-1. Block diagram of S12CPMU_UHV_V6
S12CPMU_UHV
EXTAL
XTAL
System Reset
Power-On Detect
Loop
Reference
Divider
Voltage
VSUP
Internal
Reset
Generator
Divide by
Phase
Post
Divider
1,2,.32
VCOCLK
LOCKIE
IRCTRIM[9:0]
SYNDIV[5:0]
LOCK
REFDIV[3:0]
2*(SYNDIV+1)
Pierce
Oscillator
4MHz-20MHz
OSCE
PORF
divide
by 2
ECLK
POSTDIV[4:0]
Power-On Reset
Controlled
locked
Loop with
internal
Filter (PLL)
REFCLK
FBCLK
REFFRQ[1:0]
VCOFRQ[1:0]
Lock
detect
Regulator
6V to 18V
Autonomous
Periodic
Interrupt (API)
API Interrupt
VSS1,2
PLLSEL
VSSX
VDDA
VDDX
Low Voltage Detect
LVRF
PLLCLK
Reference
Clock
(IRC1M)
OSCCLK
Monitor
osc monitor fail
Real Time
Interrupt (RTI)
RTI Interrupt
PSTP
CPMURTI
Oscillator status Interrupt
(XOSCLCP)
High
Temperature
Sense
HT Interrupt
Low Voltage Interrupt
APICLK
RTICLK
IRCCLK
OSCCLK
RTIOSCSEL
COP time-out
PRE
UPOSC=0 sets PLLSEL bit
API_EXTCLK
RC
Osc.
UPOSC
RESET
OSCIE
APIE
RTIE
HTDS HTIE
LVDS LVIE
Low Voltage Detect VDDA
OSCCLK
divide
by 4
Bus Clock
VSSA
ADC
vsup
monitor
(VREGAUTO)
ECLK2X
(Core Clock)
(Bus Clock)
COP time-out
COP
Watchdog
CPMUCOP
COPCLK
IRCCLK
OSCCLK
COPOSCSEL0
to Reset
Generator
PCE
UPOSC
UPOSC=0 clears
ACLK
COPOSCSEL1
CSAD
divide
by 2
ACLK
divide
by 2
IRCCLK
OSCCLK
IRCCLK
PLL lock interrupt
OMRF
COPRF
PMRF
PLL monitor fail
VDDX, VDD, VDDF
OSCMOD
VDD
VDDF
VDDC
BCTL
BCTLC
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
232 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 7-2 shows a block diagram of the XOSCLCP.
Figure 7-2. XOSCLCP Block Diagram
EXTAL XTAL
Gain Control
VDD=1.8V
Rf
OSCCLK
Peak
Detector
VSS
VSS VSS
C1 C2
Quartz Crystals
Ceramic Resonators
or
Clock
Monitor
monitor fail
OSCMOD
+
_
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 233
7.2 Signal Description
This section lists and describes the signals that connect off chip as well as internal supply nodes and special
signals.
7.2.1 RESET
Pin RESET is an active-low bidirectional pin. As an input it initializes the MCU asynchronously to a
known start-up state. As an open-drain output it indicates that an MCU-internal reset has been triggered.
7.2.2 EXTAL and XTAL
These pins provide the interface for a crystal to control the internal clock generator circuitry. EXTAL is
the input to the crystal oscillator amplifier. XTAL is the output of the crystal oscillator amplifier. If
XOSCLCP is enabled, the MCU internal OSCCLK_LCP is derived from the EXTAL input frequency. If
OSCE=0, the EXTAL pin is pulled down by an internal resistor of approximately 200 k and the XTAL
pin is pulled down by an internal resistor of approximately 700 k.
NOTE
Freescale recommends an evaluation of the application board and chosen
resonator or crystal by the resonator or crystal supplier.
The loop controlled circuit (XOSCLCP) is not suited for overtone
resonators and crystals.
7.2.3 VSUP — Regulator Power Input Pin
Pin VSUP is the power input of VREGAUTO. All currents sourced into the regulator loads flow through
this pin.
A suitable reverse battery protection network can be used to connect VSUP to the car battery supply
network.
7.2.4 VDDA, VSSA — Regulator Reference Supply Pins
Pins VDDA and VSSA,are used to supply the analog parts of the regulator. Internal precision reference
circuits are supplied from these signals.
An off-chip decoupling capacitor (220 nF(X7R ceramic)) between VDDA and VSSA is required and can
improve the quality of this supply.
VDDA has to be connected externally to VDDX.
7.2.5 VDDX, VSSX— Pad Supply Pins
VDDX is the supply domain for the digital Pads.
An off-chip decoupling capacitor (10F plus 220 nF(X7R ceramic)) between VDDX and VSSX is
required.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
234 Freescale Semiconductor
This supply domain is monitored by the Low Voltage Reset circuit.
VDDX has to be connected externally to VDDA.
7.2.6 BCTL— Base Control Pin for external PNP
BCTL is the ballast connection for the on chip voltage regulator . It provides the base current of an external
BJT (PNP) of the VDDX and VDDA supplies. An additional 1K resistor between emitter and base of
the BJT is required.
7.2.7 BCTLC — Base Control Pin for external PNP for VDDC power
domain
BCTLC is the ballast connection for the on chip voltage regulator for the VDDC power domain. It provides
the base current of an external BJT (PNP) of the VDDC supply. An additional 1K resistor between
emitter and base of the BJT is required.
7.2.8 VSS1,2 — Core Ground Pins
VSS1,2 are the core logic supply return pins. They must be grounded.
7.2.9 VDD— Core Logic Supply Pin
VDD is the supply domain for the core logic.
An off-chip decoupling capacitor (220 nF(X7R ceramic)) between VDD and VSS is required and can
improve the quality of this supply.
This supply domain is monitored by the Low Voltage Reset circuit and The Power On Reset circuit.
7.2.10 VDDF— NVM Logic Supply Pin
VDDF is the supply domain for the NVM logic.
An off-chip decoupling capacitor (220 nF(X7R ceramic)) between VDDF and VSS is required and can
improve the quality of this supply.
This supply domain is monitored by the Low Voltage Reset circuit.
7.2.11 API_EXTCLK API external clock output pin
This pin provides the signal selected via APIES and is enabled with APIEA bit. See the device
specification if this clock output is available on this device and to which pin it might be connected.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 235
7.2.12 TEMPSENSE — Internal Temperature Sensor Output Voltage
Depending on the VSEL setting either the voltage level generated by the temperature sensor or the VREG
bandgap voltage is driven to a special channel input of the ADC Converter. See device level specification
for connectivity of ADC special channels.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
236 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3 Memory Map and Registers
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the S12CPMU_UHV_V6.
7.3.1 Module Memory Map
The S12CPMU_UHV_V6 registers are shown in Figure 7-3.
Address
Offset Register
Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
0x0000 CPMU
RESERVED00
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0001 CPMU
RESERVED01
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0002 CPMU
RESERVED02
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0003 CPMURFLG R0 PORF LVRF 0COPRF 0OMRF PMRF
W
0x0004 CPMU
SYNR
RVCOFRQ[1:0] SYNDIV[5:0]
W
0x0005 CPMU
REFDIV
RREFFRQ[1:0] 00 REFDIV[3:0]
W
0x0006 CPMU
POSTDIV
R0 0 0 POSTDIV[4:0]
W
0x0007 CPMUIFLG RRTIF 00
LOCKIF LOCK 0 OSCIF UPOSC
W
0x0008 CPMUINT RRTIE 00
LOCKIE 00
OSCIE 0
W
0x0009 CPMUCLKS RPLLSEL PSTP CSAD COP
OSCSEL1 PRE PCE RTI
OSCSEL
COP
OSCSEL0
W
0x000A CPMUPLL R0 0 FM1 FM0 00 0 0
W
0x000B CPMURTI RRTDEC RTR6 RTR5 RTR4 RTR3 RTR2 RTR1 RTR0
W
0x000C CPMUCOP RWCOP RSBCK 000
CR2 CR1 CR0
W WRTMASK
0x000D RESERVED
CPMUTEST0
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x000E RESERVED
CPMUTEST1
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-3. CPMU Register Summary
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 237
0x000F CPMU
ARMCOP
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0010 CPMU
HTCTL
R0 0 VSEL 0HTE HTDS HTIE HTIF
W
0x0011 CPMU
LVCTL
R0 0 0 0 0 LVDS LVIE LVIF
W
0x0012 CPMU
APICTL
RAPICLK 00
APIES APIEA APIFE APIE APIF
W
0x0013 CPMUACLKTR RACLKTR5 ACLKTR4 ACLKTR3 ACLKTR2 ACLKTR1 ACLKTR0 00
W
0x0014 CPMUAPIRH RAPIR15 APIR14 APIR13 APIR12 APIR11 APIR10 APIR9 APIR8
W
0x0015 CPMUAPIRL RAPIR7 APIR6 APIR5 APIR4 APIR3 APIR2 APIR1 APIR0
W
0x0016 RESERVED
CPMUTEST3
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0017 CPMUHTTR RHTOE 000
HTTR3 HTTR2 HTTR1 HTTR0
W
0x0018 CPMU
IRCTRIMH
RTCTRIM[4:0] 0IRCTRIM[9:8]
W
0x0019 CPMU
IRCTRIML
RIRCTRIM[7:0]
W
0x001A CPMUOSC ROSCE 0Reserved 000 0 0
W
0x001B CPMUPROT R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PROT
W
0x001C RESERVED
CPMUTEST2
R000 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x001D CPMU
VREGCTL
R0 0 0 0 0EXTCON EXTXON INTXON
W
0x001E CPMUOSC2 R0 0 0 0 0 0 OMRE OSCMOD
W
0x001F CPMU
RESERVED1F
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
Address
Offset Register
Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-3. CPMU Register Summary
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
238 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes all the S12CPMU_UHV_V6 registers and their individual bits.
Address order is as listed in Figure 7-3
7.3.2.1 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Reset Flags Register (CPMURFLG)
This register provides S12CPMU_UHV_V6 reset flags.
Read: Anytime
Write: Refer to each bit for individual write conditions
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R0
PORF LVRF
0
COPRF
0
OMRF PMRF
W
Reset 0 Note 1 Note 2 0 Note 3 0 Note 4 Note 5
1. PORF is set to 1 when a power on reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset.
2. LVRF is set to 1 when a low voltage reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset. Set by power on reset.
3. COPRF is set to 1 when COP reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset. Cleared by power on reset.
4. OMRF is set to 1 when an oscillator clock monitor reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset. Cleared by power on reset.
5. PMRF is set to 1 when a PLL clock monitor reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset. Cleared by power on reset.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-4. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Flags Register (CPMURFLG)
Table 7-2. CPMURFLG Field Descriptions
Field Description
6
PORF
Power on Reset Flag PORF is set to 1 when a power on reset occurs. This flag can only be cleared by writing
a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect.
0 Power on reset has not occurred.
1 Power on reset has occurred.
5
LVRF
Low Voltage Reset Flag LVRF is set to 1 when a low voltage reset occurs on the VDD, VDDF or VDDX
domain. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect.
0 Low voltage reset has not occurred.
1 Low voltage reset has occurred.
3
COPRF
COP Reset Flag COPRF is set to 1 when a COP (Computer Operating Properly) reset occurs. Refer to 7.5.5,
“Computer Operating Properly Watchdog (COP) Reset and 7.3.2.10, “S12CPMU_UHV_V6 COP Control
Register (CPMUCOP) for details.This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect.
0 COP reset has not occurred.
1 COP reset has occurred.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 239
7.3.2.2 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Synthesizer Register (CPMUSYNR)
The CPMUSYNR register controls the multiplication factor of the PLL and selects the VCO frequency
range.
Read: Anytime
Write: If PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register), then write anytime.
Else write has no effect.
NOTE
Writing to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits.
NOTE
fVCO must be within the specified VCO frequency lock range. Bus
frequency fbus must not exceed the specified maximum.
The VCOFRQ[1:0] bits are used to configure the VCO gain for optimal stability and lock time. For correct
PLL operation the VCOFRQ[1:0] bits have to be selected according to the actual target VCOCLK
1
OMRF
Oscillator Clock Monitor Reset Flag OMRF is set to 1 when a loss of oscillator (crystal) clock occurs. Refer
to7.5.3, “Oscillator Clock Monitor Reset for details.This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has
no effect.
0 Loss of oscillator clock reset has not occurred.
1 Loss of oscillator clock reset has occurred.
0
PMRF
PLL Clock Monitor Reset Flag PMRF is set to 1 when a loss of PLL clock occurs. This flag can only be
cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect.
0 Loss of PLL clock reset has not occurred.
1 Loss of PLL clock reset has occurred.
Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
R
VCOFRQ[1:0] SYNDIV[5:0]
W
Reset01011000
Figure 7-5. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Synthesizer Register (CPMUSYNR)
Table 7-2. CPMURFLG Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
fVCO 2f
REF
SYNDIV 1+=
If PLL has locked (LOCK=1)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
240 Freescale Semiconductor
frequency as shown in Table 7-3. Setting the VCOFRQ[1:0] bits incorrectly can result in a non functional
PLL (no locking and/or insufficient stability).
7.3.2.3 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Reference Divider Register (CPMUREFDIV)
The CPMUREFDIV register provides a finer granularity for the PLL multiplier steps when using the
external oscillator as reference.
Read: Anytime
Write: If PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register), then write anytime.
Else write has no effect.
NOTE
Write to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits.
The REFFRQ[1:0] bits are used to configure the internal PLL filter for optimal stability and lock time. For
correct PLL operation the REFFRQ[1:0] bits have to be selected according to the actual REFCLK
frequency as shown in Table 7-4.
If IRC1M is selected as REFCLK (OSCE=0) the PLL filter is fixed configured for the 1MHz <= fREF <=
2MHz range. The bits can still be written but will have no effect on the PLL filter configuration.
For OSCE=1, setting the REFFRQ[1:0] bits incorrectly can result in a non functional PLL (no locking
and/or insufficient stability).
Table 7-3. VCO Clock Frequency Selection
VCOCLK Frequency Ranges VCOFRQ[1:0]
32MHz <= fVCO <= 48MHz 00
48MHz < fVCO <= 64MHz 01
Reserved 10
Reserved 11
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
R
REFFRQ[1:0]
00
REFDIV[3:0]
W
Reset00001111
Figure 7-6. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Reference Divider Register (CPMUREFDIV)
fREF
fOSC
REFDIV 1+
-------------------------------------
=
If XOSCLCP is enabled (OSCE=1)
If XOSCLCP is disabled (OSCE=0) fREF fIRC1M
=
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 241
Table 7-4. Reference Clock Frequency Selection if OSC_LCP is enabled
REFCLK Frequency Ranges
(OSCE=1) REFFRQ[1:0]
1MHz <= fREF <= 2MHz 00
2MHz < fREF <= 6MHz 01
6MHz < fREF <= 12MHz 10
fREF >12MHz 11
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
242 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.4 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Post Divider Register (CPM UPOSTDIV)
The POSTDIV register controls the frequency ratio between the VCOCLK and the PLLCLK.
Read: Anytime
Write: If PLLSEL=1 write anytime, else write has no effect
When changing the POSTDIV[4:0] value or PLL transitions to locked stated (lock=1), it takes up to 32
Bus Clock cycles until fPLL is at the desired target frequency. This is because the post divider gradually
changes (increases or decreases) fPLL in order to avoid sudden load changes for the on-chip voltage
regulator.
7.3.2.5 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Interrupt Flags Register (CPMUIFLG)
This register provides S12CPMU_UHV_V6 status bits and interrupt flags.
Module Base + 0x0006
76543210
R0 0 0
POSTDIV[4:0]
W
Reset00000011
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-7. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Post Divider Register (CPMUPOSTDIV)
fPLL
fVCO
POSTDIV 1+
-----------------------------------------
=
If PLL is locked (LOCK=1)
If PLL is not locked (LOCK=0) fPLL
fVCO
4
---------------
=
fbus
fPLL
2
-------------
=
If PLL is selected (PLLSEL=1)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 243
Read: Anytime
Write: Refer to each bit for individual write conditions
Module Base + 0x0007
76543210
R
RTIF
00
LOCKIF
LOCK 0
OSCIF
UPOSC
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-8. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Flags Register (CPMUIFLG)
Table 7-5. CPMUIFLG Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RTIF
Real Time Interrupt Flag RTIF is set to 1 at the end of the RTI period. This flag can only be cleared by writing
a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (RTIE=1), RTIF causes an interrupt request.
0 RTI time-out has not yet occurred.
1 RTI time-out has occurred.
4
LOCKIF
PLL Lock Interrupt Flag LOCKIF is set to 1 when LOCK status bit changes. This flag can only be cleared by
writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (LOCKIE=1), LOCKIF causes an interrupt request.
0 No change in LOCK bit.
1 LOCK bit has changed.
3
LOCK
Lock Status Bit LOCK reflects the current state of PLL lock condition. Writes have no effect. While PLL is
unlocked (LOCK=0) fPLL is fVCO / 4 to protect the system from high core clock frequencies during the PLL
stabilization time tlock.
0 VCOCLK is not within the desired tolerance of the target frequency.
fPLL = fVCO/4.
1 VCOCLK is within the desired tolerance of the target frequency.
fPLL = fVCO/(POSTDIV+1).
1
OSCIF
Oscillator Interrupt Flag OSCIF is set to 1 when UPOSC status bit changes. This flag can only be cleared
by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (OSCIE=1), OSCIF causes an interrupt request.
0 No change in UPOSC bit.
1 UPOSC bit has changed.
0
UPOSC
Oscillator Status Bit — UPOSC reflects the status of the oscillator. Writes have no effect. Entering Full Stop
Mode UPOSC is cleared.
0 The oscillator is off or oscillation is not qualified by the PLL.
1 The oscillator is qualified by the PLL.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
244 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.6 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Interrupt Enable Register (CPMUINT)
This register enables S12CPMU_UHV_V6 interrupt requests.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0008
76543210
R
RTIE
00
LOCKIE
00
OSCIE
0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-9. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Interrupt Enable Register (CPMUINT)
Table 7 -6. CPMUINT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RTIE
Real Time Interrupt Enable Bit
0 Interrupt requests from RTI are disabled.
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever RTIF is set.
4
LOCKIE
PLL Lock Interrupt Enable Bit
0 PLL LOCK interrupt requests are disabled.
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever LOCKIF is set.
1
OSCIE
Oscillator Corrupt Interrupt Enable Bit
0 Oscillator Corrupt interrupt requests are disabled.
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever OSCIF is set.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 245
7.3.2.7 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Clock Select Register (CPMUCLKS)
This register controls S12CPMU_UHV_V6 clock selection.
Read: Anytime
Write:
Only possible if PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) in all MCU Modes (Normal and Special Mode).
All bits in Special Mode (if PROT=0).
PLLSEL, PSTP, PRE, PCE, RTIOSCSEL: In Normal Mode (if PROT=0).
CSAD: In Normal Mode (if PROT=0) until CPMUCOP write once has taken place.
COPOSCSEL0: In Normal Mode (if PROT=0) until CPMUCOP write once has taken place.
If COPOSCSEL0 was cleared by UPOSC=0 (entering Full Stop Mode with COPOSCSEL0=1 or
insufficient OSCCLK quality), then COPOSCSEL0 can be set once again.
COPOSCSEL1: In Normal Mode (if PROT=0) until CPMUCOP write once has taken place.
COPOSCSEL1 will not be cleared by UPOSC=0 (entering Full Stop Mode with COPOSCSEL1=1
or insufficient OSCCLK quality if OSCCLK is used as clock source for other clock domains: for
instance core clock etc.).
NOTE
After writing CPMUCLKS register, it is strongly recommended to read
back CPMUCLKS register to make sure that write of PLLSEL,
RTIOSCSEL and COPOSCSEL was successful. This is because under
certain circumstances writes have no effect or bits are automatically
changed (see CPMUCLKS register and bit descriptions).
NOTE
When using the oscillator clock as system clock (write PLLSEL = 0) it is
highly recommended to enable the oscillator clock monitor reset feature
(write OMRE = 1 in CPMUOSC2 register). If the oscillator monitor reset
feature is disabled (OMRE = 0) and the oscillator clock is used as system
clock, the system will stall in case of loss of oscillation.
Module Base + 0x0009
76543210
R
PLLSEL PSTP CSAD COP
OSCSEL1 PRE PCE RTI
OSCSEL
COP
OSCSEL0
W
Reset10000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-10. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Clock Select Register (CPMUCLKS)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
246 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 7-7. CPMUCLKS Descriptions
Field Description
7
PLLSEL
PLL Select Bit
This bit selects the PLLCLK as source of the System Clocks (Core Clock and Bus Clock).
PLLSEL can only be set to 0, if UPOSC=1.
UPOSC= 0 sets the PLLSEL bit.
Entering Full Stop Mode sets the PLLSEL bit.
0 System clocks are derived from OSCCLK if oscillator is up (UPOSC=1, fbus = fosc / 2).
1 System clocks are derived from PLLCLK, fbus = fPLL / 2.
6
PSTP
Pseudo Stop Bit
This bit controls the functionality of the oscillator during Stop Mode.
0 Oscillator is disabled in Stop Mode (Full Stop Mode).
1 Oscillator continues to run in Stop Mode (Pseudo Stop Mode), option to run RTI and COP.
Note: Pseudo Stop Mode allows for faster STOP recovery and reduces the mechanical stress and aging of the
resonator in case of frequent STOP conditions at the expense of a slightly increased power consumption.
Note: When starting up the external oscillator (either by programming OSCE bit to 1 or on exit from Full Stop
Mode with OSCE bit already 1) the software must wait for a minimum time equivalent to the startup-time
of the external oscillator tUPOSC before entering Pseudo Stop Mode.
5
CSAD
COP in Stop Mode ACLK Disable — If this bit is set the ACLK for the COP in Stop Mode is disabled. Hence
the COP is static while in Stop Mode and continues to operate after exit from Stop Mode.
For CSAD = 1 and COP is running on ACLK (COPOSCSEL1 = 1) the following applies:
Due to clock domain crossing synchronization there is a latency time of 2 ACLK cycles to enter Stop Mode.
After exit from STOP mode (when interrupt service routine is entered) the software has to wait for 2 ACLK
cycles before it is allowed to enter Stop mode again (STOP instruction). It is absolutely forbidden to enter
Stop Mode before this time of 2 ACLK cycles has elapsed.
0 COP running in Stop Mode (ACLK for COP enabled in Stop Mode).
1 COP stopped in Stop Mode (ACLK for COP disabled in Stop Mode)
4
COP
OSCSEL1
COP Clock Select 1 — COPOSCSEL0 and COPOSCSEL1 combined determine the clock source to the COP
(see also Tabl e 7 -8).
If COPOSCSEL1 = 1, COPOSCSEL0 has no effect regarding clock select and changing the COPOSCSEL0 bit
does not re-start the COP time-out period.
COPOSCSEL1 selects the clock source to the COP to be either ACLK (derived from trimmable internal RC-
Oscillator) or clock selected via COPOSCSEL0 (IRCCLK or OSCCLK).
Changing the COPOSCSEL1 bit re-starts the COP time-out period.
COPOSCSEL1 can be set independent from value of UPOSC.
UPOSC= 0 does not clear the COPOSCSEL1 bit.
0 COP clock source defined by COPOSCSEL0
1 COP clock source is ACLK derived from a trimmable internal RC-Oscillator
3
PRE
RTI Enable During Pseudo Stop Bit — PRE enables the RTI during Pseudo Stop Mode.
0 RTI stops running during Pseudo Stop Mode.
1 RTI continues running during Pseudo Stop Mode if RTIOSCSEL=1.
Note: If PRE=0 or RTIOSCSEL=0 then the RTI will go static while Stop Mode is active. The RTI counter will not
be reset.
2
PCE
COP Enable During Pseudo Stop BitPCE enables the COP during Pseudo Stop Mode.
0 COP stops running during Pseudo Stop Mode
1 COP continues running during Pseudo Stop Mode if COPOSCSEL=1
Note: If PCE=0 or COPOSCSEL=0 then the COP will go static while Stop Mode is active. The COP counter will
not be reset.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 247
Table 7-8. COPOSCSEL1, COPOSCSEL0 clock source select description
1
RTIOSCSEL
RTI Clock SelectRTIOSCSEL selects the clock source to the RTI. Either IRCCLK or OSCCLK. Changing the
RTIOSCSEL bit re-starts the RTI time-out period.
RTIOSCSEL can only be set to 1, if UPOSC=1.
UPOSC= 0 clears the RTIOSCSEL bit.
0 RTI clock source is IRCCLK.
1 RTI clock source is OSCCLK.
0
COP
OSCSEL0
COP Clock Select 0 — COPOSCSEL0 and COPOSCSEL1 combined determine the clock source to the COP
(see also Tabl e 7 -8)
If COPOSCSEL1 = 1, COPOSCSEL0 has no effect regarding clock select and changing the COPOSCSEL0 bit
does not re-start the COP time-out period.
When COPOSCSEL1=0,COPOSCSEL0 selects the clock source to the COP to be either IRCCLK or OSCCLK.
Changing the COPOSCSEL0 bit re-starts the COP time-out period.
COPOSCSEL0 can only be set to 1, if UPOSC=1.
UPOSC= 0 clears the COPOSCSEL0 bit.
0 COP clock source is IRCCLK.
1 COP clock source is OSCCLK
COPOSCSEL1 COPOSCSEL0 COP clock source
0 0 IRCCLK
0 1 OSCCLK
1xACLK
Table 7-7. CPMUCLKS Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
248 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.8 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 PLL Control Register (CPMUPLL)
This register controls the PLL functionality.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime if PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register). Else write
has no effect.
NOTE
Write to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits.
NOTE
Care should be taken to ensure that the bus frequency does not exceed the
specified maximum when frequency modulation is enabled.
Module Base + 0x000A
76543210
R0 0
FM1 FM0
0000
W
Reset00000000
Figure 7-11. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 PLL Control Register (CPMUPLL)
Table 7-9. CP MU PL L Fi el d De sc rip ti on s
Field Description
5, 4
FM1, FM0
PLL Frequency Modu lation Enable Bit s — FM1 and FM0 enable frequency modulation on the VCOCLK. This
is to reduce noise emission. The modulation frequency is fref divided by 16. See Table 7-10 for coding.
Table 7-10. FM Amplitude selection
FM1 FM0 FM Amplitude /
fVCO Variation
00FM off
011%
102%
114%
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 249
7.3.2.9 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 RTI Control Register (CPMURTI)
This register selects the time-out period for the Real Time Interrupt.
The clock source for the RTI is either IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the RTIOSCSEL
bit. In Stop Mode with PSTP=1 (Pseudo Stop Mode) and RTIOSCSEL=1 the RTI continues to run, else
the RTI counter halts in Stop Mode.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
A write to this register starts the RTI time-out period. A change of the
RTIOSCSEL bit (writing a different value or loosing UPOSC status) re-
starts the RTI time-out period.
Module Base + 0x000B
76543210
R
RTDEC RTR6 RTR5 RTR4 RTR3 RTR2 RTR1 RTR0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 7-12. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 RTI Control Register (CPMUR T I)
Table 7-11. CPMURTI Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RTDEC
Decimal or Binary Divider Select Bit — RTDEC selects decimal or binary based prescaler values.
0 Binary based divider value. See Table 7-12
1 Decimal based divider value. See Tab l e 7-13
6–4
RTR[6:4]
Real Time Interrupt Prescale Rate Select Bits — These bits select the prescale rate for the RTI.See Table 7 -
12 and Ta b le 7 -1 3.
3–0
RTR[3:0]
Real Time Interrupt Modulus Counter Select Bits — These bits select the modulus counter target value to
provide additional granularity.Tab le 7- 1 2 and Table 7-13 show all possible divide values selectable by the
CPMURTI register.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
250 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 7-12. RTI Frequency Divide Rates for RTDEC = 0
RTR[3:0]
RTR[6:4] =
000
(OFF) 001
(210)010
(211)011
(212)100
(213)101
(214)110
(215)111
(216)
0000 (1) OFF(1)
1. Denotes the default value out of reset.This value should be used to disable the RTI to ensure future backwards compatibility.
210 211 212 213 214 215 216
0001 (2) OFF 2x210 2x211 2x212 2x213 2x214 2x215 2x216
0010 (3) OFF 3x210 3x211 3x212 3x213 3x214 3x215 3x216
0011 (4) OFF 4x210 4x211 4x212 4x213 4x214 4x215 4x216
0100 (5) OFF 5x210 5x211 5x212 5x213 5x214 5x215 5x216
0101 (6) OFF 6x210 6x211 6x212 6x213 6x214 6x215 6x216
0110 (7) OFF 7x210 7x211 7x212 7x213 7x214 7x215 7x216
0111 (8) OFF 8x210 8x211 8x212 8x213 8x214 8x215 8x216
1000 (9) OFF 9x210 9x211 9x212 9x213 9x214 9x215 9x216
1001 (10) OFF 10x210 10x211 10x212 10x213 10x214 10x215 10x216
1010 (11) OFF 11x210 11x211 11x212 11x213 11x214 11x215 11x216
1011 (12) OFF 12x210 12x211 12x212 12x213 12x214 12x215 12x216
1100 (13) OFF 13x210 13x211 13x212 13x213 13x214 13x215 13x216
1101 (14) OFF 14x210 14x211 14x212 14x213 14x214 14x215 14x216
1110 (15) OFF 15x210 15x211 15x212 15x213 15x214 15x215 15x216
1111 (16) OFF 16x210 16x211 16x212 16x213 16x214 16x215 16x216
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 251
Table 7-13. RTI Frequency Divide Rates for RTDEC=1
RTR[3:0]
RTR[6:4] =
000
(1x103)001
(2x103)010
(5x103)011
(10x103)100
(20x103)101
(50x103)110
(100x103)111
(200x103)
0000 (1) 1x1032x1035x10310x10320x10350x103100x103200x103
0001 (2) 2x1034x10310x10320x10340x103100x103200x103400x103
0010 (3) 3x1036x10315x10330x10360x103150x103300x103600x103
0011 (4) 4x1038x10320x10340x10380x103200x103400x103800x103
0100 (5) 5x10310x10325x10350x103100x103250x103500x1031x106
0101 (6) 6x10312x10330x10360x103120x103300x103600x1031.2x106
0110 (7) 7x10314x10335x10370x103140x103350x103700x1031.4x106
0111 (8) 8x10316x10340x10380x103160x103400x103800x1031.6x106
1000 (9) 9x10318x10345x10390x103180x103450x103900x1031.8x106
1001 (10) 10 x10320x10350x103100x103200x103500x1031x1062x106
1010 (11) 11 x10322x10355x103110x103220x103550x1031.1x1062.2x106
1011 ( 12) 12x10324x10360x103120x103240x103600x1031.2x1062.4x106
1100 ( 13) 13x10326x10365x103130x103260x103650x1031.3x1062.6x106
1101 ( 14) 14x10328x10370x103140x103280x103700x1031.4x1062.8x106
1110 (15) 15x10330x10375x103150x103300x103750x1031.5x1063x106
1111 (16) 16x10332x10380x103160x103320x103800x1031.6x1063.2x106
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
252 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.10 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 COP Control Register (CPMUCOP)
This register controls the COP (Computer Operating Properly) watchdog.
The clock source for the COP is either ACLK, IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the
COPOSCSEL0 and COPOSCSEL1 bit (see also Table 7-8).
In S top Mode with PSTP=1 (Pseudo Stop Mode), COPOSCSEL0=1 and COPOSCEL1=0 and PCE=1 the
COP continues to run, else the COP counter halts in Stop Mode with COPOSCSEL1 =0.
In Full Stop Mode and Pseudo Stop Mode with COPOSCSEL1=1 the COP continues to run.
Read: Anytime
Write:
1. RSBCK: Anytime in Special Mode; write to “1” but not to “0” in Normal Mode
2. WCOP, CR2, CR1, CR0:
Anytime in Special Mode, when WRTMASK is 0, otherwise it has no effect
Write once in Normal Mode, when WRTMASK is 0, otherwise it has no effect.
Writing CR[2:0] to “000” has no effect, but counts for the “write once” condition.
Writing WCOP to “0” has no effect, but counts for the “write once” condition.
When a non-zero value is loaded from Flash to CR[2:0] the COP time-out period is started.
A change of the COPOSCSEL0 or COPOSCSEL1 bit (writing a different value) or loosing UPOSC status
while COPOSCSEL1 is clear and COPOSCSEL0 is set, re-starts the COP time-out period.
In Normal Mode the COP time-out period is restarted if either of these conditions is true:
1. Writing a non-zero value to CR[2:0] (anytime in special mode, once in normal mode) with
WRTMASK = 0.
2. Writing WCOP bit (anytime in Special Mode, once in Normal Mode) with WRTMASK = 0.
3. Changing RSBCK bit from “0” to “1”.
In Special Mode, any write access to CPMUCOP register restarts the COP time-out period.
Module Base + 0x000C
76543210
R
WCOP RSBCK
000
CR2 CR1 CR0
W WRTMASK
ResetF0000FFF
After de-assert of System Reset the values are automatically loaded from the Flash memory. See Device specification for
details.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-13. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 COP C ont ro l Re gi st er (CPM UC OP)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 253
Table 7-14. CPMUCOP Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
WCOP
Window COP Mode Bit — When set, a write to the CPMUARMCOP register must occur in the last 25% of the
selected period. A write during the first 75% of the selected period generates a COP reset. As long as all writes
occur during this window, $55 can be written as often as desired. Once $AA is written after the $55, the time-out
logic restarts and the user must wait until the next window before writing to CPMUARMCOP. Table 7-15 shows
the duration of this window for the seven available COP rates.
0 Normal COP operation
1 Window COP operation
6
RSBCK
COP and RTI Stop in Active BDM Mode Bit
0 Allows the COP and RTI to keep running in Active BDM mode.
1 Stops the COP and RTI counters whenever the part is in Active BDM mode.
5
WRTMASK
Write Mask for WCOP and CR[2:0] Bit — This write-only bit serves as a mask for the WCOP and CR[2:0] bits
while writing the CPMUCOP register. It is intended for BDM writing the RSBCK without changing the content of
WCOP and CR[2:0].
0 Write of WCOP and CR[2:0] has an effect with this write of CPMUCOP
1 Write of WCOP and CR[2:0] has no effect with this write of CPMUCOP.
(Does not count for “write once”.)
2–0
CR[2:0]
COP Watchdog Timer Rate SelectThese bits select the COP time-out rate (see Tab le 7 -1 5 and Ta ble 7- 1 6).
Writing a nonzero value to CR[2:0] enables the COP counter and starts the time-out period. A COP counter time-
out causes a System Reset. This can be avoided by periodically (before time-out) initializing the COP counter
via the CPMUARMCOP register.
While all of the following four conditions are true the CR[2:0], WCOP bits are ignored and the COP operates at
highest time-out period (2 24 cycles) in normal COP mode (Window COP mode disabled):
1) COP is enabled (CR[2:0] is not 000)
2) BDM mode active
3) RSBCK = 0
4) Operation in Special Mode
Table 7-15. COP Wat chdog Rates if COPOSCSEL1=0.
(default out of reset)
CR2 CR1 CR0
COPCLK
Cycles to time-out
(COPCLK is either IRCCLK or
OSCCLK depending on the
COPOSCSEL0 bit)
0 0 0 COP disabled
001 2
14
010 2
16
011 2
18
100 2
20
101 2
22
110 2
23
111 2
24
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
254 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 7-16. COP Wat chdog Rates if COPOSCSEL1=1.
CR2 CR1 CR0 COPCLK
Cycles to time-out
(COPCLK is ACLK divided by 2)
0 0 0 COP disabled
001 2
7
010 2
9
011 2
11
100 2
13
101 2
15
110 2
16
111 2
17
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 255
7.3.2.11 Reserved Register CPMUTEST0
NOTE
This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not
intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in Special
Mode can alter the S12CPMU_UHV_V6’s functionality.
Read: Anytime
Write: Only in Special Mode
7.3.2.12 Reserved Register CPMUTEST1
NOTE
This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not
intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in Special
Mode can alter the S12CPMU_UHV_V6’s functionality.
Read: Anytime
Write: Only in Special Mode
Module Base + 0x000D
76543210
R00000000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-14. Reserved Register (CPMUTEST0)
Module Base + 0x000E
76543210
R00000000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-15. Reserved Register (CPMUTEST1)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
256 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.13 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 COP Timer Arm/Reset Register (CPMUARMCOP)
This register is used to restart the COP time-out period.
Read: Always reads $00
Write: Anytime
When the COP is disabled (CR[2:0] = “000”) writing to this register has no effect.
When the COP is enabled by setting CR[2:0] nonzero, the following applies:
Writing any value other than $55 or $AA causes a COP reset. To restart the COP time-out period
write $55 followed by a write of $AA. These writes do not need to occur back-to-back, but the
sequence ($55, $AA) must be completed prior to COP end of time-out period to avoid a COP reset.
Sequences of $55 writes are allowed. When the WCOP bit is set, $55 and $AA writes must be done
in the last 25% of the selected time-out period; writing any value in the first 75% of the selected
period will cause a COP reset.
7.3.2.14 High Temperature Control Register (CPMUHTCTL)
The CPMUHTCTL register configures the temperature sense features.
Read: Anytime
Write: VSEL, HTE, HTIE and HTIF are write anytime, HTDS is read only
Module Base + 0x000F
76543210
R00000000
W ARMCOP-Bit
7
ARMCOP-Bit
6
ARMCOP-Bit
5
ARMCOP-Bit
4
ARMCOP-Bit
3
ARMCOP-Bit
2
ARMCOP-Bit
1
ARMCOP-Bit
0
Reset00000000
Figure 7-16. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 CPMUARMCOP Register
Module Base + 0x0010
76543210
R0 0 VSEL 0HTE HTDS HTIE HTIF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-17. High Temperature Control Register (CPMUHTCTL)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 257
NOTE
The voltage at the temperature sensor can be computed as follows:
VHT(temp) = VHT(150) - (150 - temp) * dVHT
Figure 7-18. Voltage Access Select
Table 7-17. CPMUHTCTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
5
VSEL
Voltage Access Select Bit — If set, the bandgap reference voltage VBG can be accessed internally (i.e.
multiplexed to an internal Analog to Digital Converter channel). If not set, the die temperature proportional
voltage VHT of the temperature sensor can be accessed internally. See device level specification for connectivity.
For any of these access the HTE bit must be set.
0 An internal temperature proportional voltage VHT can be accessed internally.
1 Bandgap reference voltage VBG can be accessed internally.
3
HTE
High Temperature Sensor/Bandgap V o ltage Enable BitThis bit enables the high temperature sensor and
bandgap voltage amplifier.
0 The temperature sensor and bandgap voltage amplifier is disabled.
1 The temperature sensor and bandgap voltage amplifier is enabled.
2
HTDS
High Temperature Detect Status Bit — This read-only status bit reflects the temperature status. Writes have
no effect.
0 Junction Temperature is below level THTID or RPM.
1 Junction Temperature is above level THTIA and FPM.
1
HTIE
High Temperature Interrupt Enable Bit
0 Interrupt request is disabled.
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever HTIF is set.
0
HTIF
High Temperature Interrupt Flag — HTIF is set to 1 when HTDS status bit changes. This flag can only be
cleared by writing a 1.
Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (HTIE=1), HTIF causes an interrupt request.
0 No change in HTDS bit.
1 HTDS bit has changed.
C
HTD
VBG
ADC
Ref
Channel
VSEL TEMPSENSE
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
258 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.15 Low Voltage Control Register (CPMULVCTL)
The CPMULVCTL register allows the configuration of the low-voltage detect features.
Read: Anytime
Write: LVIE and LVIF are write anytime, LVDS is read only
Module Base + 0x0011
76543210
R00000LVDS
LVIE LVIF
W
Reset00000U0U
The Reset state of LVDS and LVIF depends on the external supplied VDDA level
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-19. Low Voltage Control Register (CPMULVCTL)
Table 7-18. CPMULVCTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
2
LVDS
Low-Voltage Detect Status Bit — This read-only status bit reflects the voltage level on VDDA. Writes have no
effect.
0 Input voltage VDDA is above level VLVID or RPM.
1 Input voltage VDDA is below level VLVIA and FPM.
1
LVIE
Low-Voltage Interrupt Enable Bit
0 Interrupt request is disabled.
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever LVIF is set.
0
LVIF
Low-Voltage Interrupt Flag LVIF is set to 1 when LVDS status bit changes. This flag can only be cleared by
writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (LVIE = 1), LVIF causes an interrupt request.
0 No change in LVDS bit.
1 LVDS bit has changed.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 259
7.3.2.16 Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Control Register (CPMUAPICTL)
The CPMUAPICTL register allows the configuration of the autonomous periodical interrupt features.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0012
76543210
RAPICLK 00
APIES APIEA APIFE APIE APIF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-20. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Control Register (CPMUAPICTL)
Table 7-19. CPMUAPICTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
APICLK
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Clock Select Bit — Selects the clock source for the API. Writable only if
APIFE = 0. APICLK cannot be changed if APIFE is set by the same write operation.
0 Autonomous Clock (ACLK) used as source.
1 Bus Clock used as source.
4
APIES
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt External Select Bit — Selects the waveform at the external pin
API_EXTCLK as shown in Figure 7-21. See device level specification for connectivity of API_EXTCLK pin.
0 If APIEA and APIFE are set, at the external pin API_EXTCLK periodic high pulses are visible at the end of
every selected period with the size of half of the minimum period (APIR=0x0000 in Tabl e 7 -23 ).
1 If APIEA and APIFE are set, at the external pin API_EXTCLK a clock is visible with 2 times the selected API
Period.
3
APIEA
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt External Access Enable Bit If set, the waveform selected by bit APIES
can be accessed externally. See device level specification for connectivity.
0 Waveform selected by APIES can not be accessed externally.
1 Waveform selected by APIES can be accessed externally, if APIFE is set.
2
APIFE
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Feature Enable Bit — Enables the API feature and starts the API timer
when set.
0 Autonomous periodical interrupt is disabled.
1 Autonomous periodical interrupt is enabled and timer starts running.
1
APIE
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Enable Bit
0 API interrupt request is disabled.
1 API interrupt will be requested whenever APIF is set.
0
APIF
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Flag — APIF is set to 1 when the in the API configured time has elapsed.
This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1.Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (APIE = 1), APIF causes an
interrupt request.
0 API time-out has not yet occurred.
1 API time-out has occurred.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
260 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 7-21. Waveform selected on API_EXTCLK pin (APIEA=1, APIFE=1)
APIES=0
APIES=1
API period
API min. period / 2
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 261
7.3.2.17 Autonomous Clock Trimming Register (CPMUACLKTR)
The CPMUACLKTR register configures the trimming of the Autonomous Clock (ACLK - trimmable
internal RC-Oscillator) which can be selected as clock source for some CPMU features.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0013
76543210
RACLKTR5 ACLKTR4 ACLKTR3 ACLKTR2 ACLKTR1 ACLKTR0 00
W
ResetFFFFFF00
After de-assert of System Reset a value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory.
Figure 7-22. Autonomous Clock Trimming Register (CPMUACLKTR)
Table 7-20. CPMUACLKTR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7–2
ACLKTR[5:0]
Autonomous Clock Period T rimming Bits — See Tab le 7- 21 for trimming effects. The ACLKTR[5:0] value
represents a signed number influencing the ACLK period time.
Table 7-21. Trimming Effect of ACLKTR[5:0]
ACLKTR[5:0] Decimal ACLK frequency
100000 -32 lowest
100001 -31
increasing
....
111111 -1
000000 0 mid
000001 +1
increasing
....
011110 +30
011111 +31 highest
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
262 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.18 Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate High and Low Register
(CPMUAPIRH / CPMUAPIRL)
The CPMUAPIRH and CPMUAPIRL registers allow the configuration of the autonomous periodical
interrupt rate.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime if APIFE=0, Else writes have no effect.
The period can be calculated as follows depending on logical value of the APICLK bit:
APICLK=0: Period = 2*(APIR[15:0] + 1) * (ACLK Clock Period * 2)
APICLK=1: Period = 2*(APIR[15:0] + 1) * Bus Clock Period
NOTE
For APICLK bit clear the first time-out period of the API will show a
latency time between two to three fACLK cycles due to synchronous clock
gate release when the API feature gets enabled (APIFE bit set).
Module Base + 0x0014
76543210
RAPIR15 APIR14 APIR13 APIR12 APIR11 APIR10 APIR9 APIR8
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-23. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate High Register (CPMUAPIRH)
Module Base + 0x0015
76543210
RAPIR7 APIR6 APIR5 APIR4 APIR3 APIR2 APIR1 APIR0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 7-24. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate Low Register (CPMUAPIRL)
Table 7-22. CPMUAPIRH / CPMUAPIRL Field Descriptions
Field Description
15-0
APIR[15:0]
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate Bits — These bits define the time-out period of the API. See Tabl e 7-
23 for details of the effect of the autonomous periodical interrupt rate bits.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 263
Table 7-23. Selectable Autonomous Periodical Inte rrupt Periods
APICLK APIR[15:0] Selected Period
0 0000 0.2 ms(1)
1. When fACLK is trimmed to 20KHz.
0 0001 0.4 ms1
0 0002 0.6 ms1
0 0003 0.8 ms1
0 0004 1.0 ms1
0 0005 1.2 ms1
0 ..... .....
0 FFFD 13106.8 ms1
0 FFFE 13107.0 ms1
0 FFFF 13107.2 ms1
1 0000 2 * Bus Clock period
1 0001 4 * Bus Clock period
1 0002 6 * Bus Clock period
1 0003 8 * Bus Clock period
1 0004 10 * Bus Clock period
1 0005 12 * Bus Clock period
1 ..... .....
1 FFFD 131068 * Bus Clock period
1 FFFE 131070 * Bus Clock period
1 FFFF 131072 * Bus Clock period
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
264 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.19 Reserved Register CPMUTEST3
NOTE
This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not
intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in Special
Mode can alter the S12CPMU_UHV_V6’s functionality.
Read: Anytime
Write: Only in Special Mode
Module Base + 0x0016
76543210
R00000000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-25. Reserved Register (CPMUTEST3)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 265
7.3.2.20 High Temperature Trimming Register (CPMUHTTR)
The CPMUHTTR register configures the trimming of the S12CPMU_UHV_V6 temperature sense.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0017
76543210
RHTOE 000
HTTR3 HTTR2 HTTR1 HTTR0
W
Reset0000FFFF
After de-assert of System Reset a trim value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory. See Device specification for
details.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-26. High Temperature Trimming Register (CPMUHTTR)
Table 7-25. CPMUHTTR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
HTOE
High Temperature Offset Enable Bit — If set the temperature sense offset is enabled.
0 The temperature sense offset is disabled. HTTR[3:0] bits don’t care.
1 The temperature sense offset is enabled. HTTR[3:0] select the temperature offset.
3–0
HTTR[3:0]
High Temperature Trimming Bits — See Tab le 7 - 2 6 for trimming effects.
Table 7-26. Trimming Effect of HTTR
HTTR[3:0] Temperature
sensor voltage VHT
Interrupt threshold
temperatures THTIA and THTID
0000 lowest highest
0001
increasing decreasing
....
1110
1111 highest lowest
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
266 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.21 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 IRC1M Trim Registers (CPMUIRCTRIMH /
CPMUIRCTRIML)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime if PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register). Else write has no effect
NOTE
Writes to these registers while PLLSEL=1 clears the LOCK and UPOSC
status bits.
Module Base + 0x0018
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
R
TCTRIM[4:0]
0
IRCTRIM[9:8]
W
ResetFFFFF0FF
After de-assert of System Reset a factory programmed trim value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory to
provide trimmed Internal Reference Frequency fIRC1M_TRIM.
Figure 7-27. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 IRC1M Trim High Register (CPMUIRCTRIMH)
Module Base + 0x0019
76543210
R
IRCTRIM[7:0]
W
ResetFFFFFFFF
After de-assert of System Reset a factory programmed trim value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory to
provide trimmed Internal Reference Frequency fIRC1M_TRIM.
Figure 7-28. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 IRC1M Trim Low Register (CPMUIRCTRIML)
Table 7-27. CPMUIRCTRIMH/L Field Descriptions
Field Description
15-11
TCTRIM[4:0]
IRC1M temperature coefficient Trim Bits
Trim bits for the Temperature Coefficient (TC) of the IRC1M frequency.
Table 7-28 shows the influence of the bits TCTRIM[4:0] on the relationship between frequency and temperature.
Figure 7-30 shows an approximate TC variation, relative to the nominal TC of the IRC1M (i.e. for
TCTRIM[4:0]=0x00000 or 0x10000).
9-0
IRCTRIM[9:0]
IRC1M Frequency Trim Bits — Trim bits for Internal Reference Clock
After System Reset the factory programmed trim value is automatically loaded into these registers, resulting in a
Internal Reference Frequency fIRC1M_TRIM.See device electrical characteristics for value of fIRC1M_TRIM.
The frequency trimming consists of two different trimming methods:
A rough trimming controlled by bits IRCTRIM[9:6] can be done with frequency leaps of about 6% in average.
A fine trimming controlled by bits IRCTRIM[5:0] can be done with frequency leaps of about 0.3% (this trimming
determines the precision of the frequency setting of 0.15%, i.e. 0.3% is the distance between two trimming
values).
Figure 7-29 shows the relationship between the trim bits and the resulting IRC1M frequency.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 267
Figure 7-29. IRC1M Frequency Trimming Diagram
IRCTRIM[9:0]
$000
IRCTRIM[9:6]
IRCTRIM[5:0]
IRC1M frequency (IRCCLK)
600KHz
1.5MHz
1MHz
$3FF
......
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
268 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 7-30. Influence of TCTRIM[4:0] on the Temperature Coefficient
NOTE
The frequency is not necessarily linear with the temperature (in most cases
it will not be). The above diagram is meant only to give the direction
(positive or negative) of the variation of the TC, relative to the nominal TC.
Setting TCTRIM[4:0] at 0x00000 or 0x10000 does not mean that the
temperature coefficient will be zero. These two combinations basically
switch off the TC compensation module, which results in the nominal TC of
the IRC1M.
frequency
temperature
TCTRIM[4:0] = 0x11111
TCTRIM[4:0] = 0x01111
- 40C 150C
TCTRIM[4:0] = 0x10000 or 0x00000 (nominal TC)
0x00001
0x00010
0x00011
0x00100
0x00101
...
0x01111
0x11111
...
0x10101
0x10100
0x10011
0x10010
0x10001
TC increases
TC decreases
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 269
Table 7-28. TC trimming of the frequency of the IRC1M at ambient temperature
NOTE
Since the IRC1M frequency is not a linear function of the temperature, but
more like a parabola, the above relative variation is only an indication and
should be considered with care.
TCTRIM[4:0] IRC1M Indicative
relative TC variation IRC1M indicative frequency drift for relative
TC variation
00000 0 (nominal TC of the IRC) 0%
00001 -0.27% -0.5%
00010 -0.54% -0.9%
00011 -0.81% -1.3%
00100 -1.08% -1.7%
00101 -1.35% -2.0%
00110 -1.63% -2.2%
00111 -1.9% -2.5%
01000 -2.20% -3.0%
01001 -2.47% -3.4%
01010 -2.77% -3.9%
01011 -3.04 -4.3%
01100 -3.33% -4.7%
01101 -3.6% -5.1%
01110 -3.91% -5.6%
01111 -4.18% -5.9%
10000 0 (nominal TC of the IRC) 0%
10001 +0.27% +0.5%
10010 +0.54% +0.9%
10011 +0.81% +1.3%
10100 +1.07% +1.7%
10101 +1.34% +2.0%
10110 +1.59% +2.2%
10111 +1.86% +2.5%
11000 +2.11% +3.0%
11001 +2.38% +3.4%
11010 +2.62% +3.9%
11011 +2.89% +4.3%
11100 +3.12% +4.7%
11101 +3.39% +5.1%
11110 +3.62% +5.6%
11111 +3.89% +5.9%
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
270 Freescale Semiconductor
Be aware that the output frequency varies with the TC trimming. A
frequency trimming correction is therefore necessary. The values provided
in Table 7-28 are typical values at ambient temperature which can vary from
device to device.
7.3.2.22 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Oscillator Register (CPMUOSC)
This registers configures the external oscillator (XOSCLCP).
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime if PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register). Else write
has no effect.
NOTE.
Write to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits.
Module Base + 0x001A
76543210
R
OSCE
0
Reserved
00000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-31. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Oscillator Register (CPMUOSC)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 271
Table 7-29. CPMUOSC Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
OSCE
Oscillator Enable Bit — This bit enables the external oscillator (XOSCLCP). The UPOSC status bit in the
CPMIUFLG register indicates when the oscillation is stable and when OSCCLK can be selected as source of the
Bus Clock or source of the COP or RTI.If the oscillator clock monitor reset is enabled (OMRE = 1 in
CPMUOSC2 register), then a loss of oscillation will lead to an oscillator clock monitor reset.
0 External oscillator is disabled.
REFCLK for PLL is IRCCLK.
1 External oscillator is enabled.
Oscillator clock monitor is enabled.
External oscillator is qualified by PLLCLK.
REFCLK for PLL is the external oscillator clock divided by REFDIV.
If OSCE bit has been set (write “1”) the EXTAL and XTAL pins are exclusively reserved for the oscillator
and they can not be used anymore as general purpose I/O until the next system reset.
Note: When starting up the external oscillator (either by programming OSCE bit to 1 or on exit from Full Stop
Mode with OSCE bit already 1) the software must wait for a minimum time equivalent to the startup-time
of the external oscillator tUPOSC before entering Pseudo Stop Mode.
5
Reserved
Do not alter this bit from its reset value. It is for Manufacturer use only and can change the Oscillator behavior.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
272 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.23 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Protection Register (CPMUPROT)
This register protects the clock configuration registers from accidental overwrite:
CPMUSYNR, CPMUREFDIV, CPMUCLKS, CPMUPLL, CPMUIRCTRIMH/L, CPMUOSC and
CPMUOSC2
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x001B
76543210
R0000000
PROT
W
Reset00000000
Figure 7-32. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Protection Register (CPMUPROT)
Field Description
PROT Clock Configu r ati on Regis te r s Protec t io n Bit This bit protects the clock configuration registers from
accidental overwrite (see list of protected registers above): Writing 0x26 to the CPMUPROT register clears the
PROT bit, other write accesses set the PROT bit.
0 Protection of clock configuration registers is disabled.
1 Protection of clock configuration registers is enabled. (see list of protected registers above).
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 273
7.3.2.24 Reserved Register CPMUTEST2
NOTE
This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not
intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in Special
Mode can alter the S12CPMU_UHV_V6’s functionality.
Read: Anytime
Write: Only in Special Mode
Module Base + 0x001C
76543210
R000 0 0 0 0 0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-33. Reserved Register CPMUTEST2
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
274 Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.25 Voltage Regulator Control Register (CPM UVREGCTL)
The CPMUVREGCTL allows to enable or disable certain parts of the voltage regulator.This register must
be configured after system startup.
Read: Anytime
Write: Once in normal modes, anytime in special modes
Module Base + 0x001D
76543210
R00000
EXTCON EXTXON INTXON
W
Reset00000111
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-34. Voltage Regulator Control Register (CPMUVREGCTL)
Table 7-30. Effects of writing the EXTXON and INTXON bit s
value of
EXTXON
to be written
value of
INTXON
to be written Write Access
0 0 blocked, no effect
0 1 legal access
1 0 legal access
1 1 blocked, no effect
Table 7-31. CPMUVR EGC T L Fi el d De sc rip ti ons
Field Description
2
EXTCON
External voltage regulator Enable Bit for VDDC domain Should be disabled after system startup if VDDC
domain is not used.
0 VDDC domain disabled
1 VDDC domain enabled
1
EXTXON
External volt ag e reg ulator Enable Bit for VDDX domain — Should be set to 1 if external BJT is present on
the PCB, cleared otherwise.
0 VDDX control loop does not use external BJT
1 VDDX control loop uses external BJT
0
INTXON
Internal volt age regulator Enable Bit for VDDX domainShould be set to 1 if no external BJT is present on
the PCB, cleared otherwise.
0 VDDX control loop does not use internal power transistor
1 VDDX control loop uses internal power transistor
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 275
7.3.2.26 S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Oscillator Register 2 (CPMUOSC2)
This registers configures the external oscillator (XOSCLCP).
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime if PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register). Else write
has no effect.
Module Base + 0x001E
76543210
R000000
OMRE OSCMOD
W
Reset00000000
Figure 7-35. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Oscillator Register 2 (CPMUOSC2)
Table 7-32. CPMUOSC2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
1
OMRE
This bit enables the oscillator clock monitor reset. If OSCE bit in CPMUOSC register is 1, then the OMRE bit can
not be changed (writes will have no effect).
0 Oscillator clock monitor reset is disabled
1 Oscillator clock monitor reset is enabled
0
OSCMOD
This bit selects the mode of the external oscillator (XOSCLCP)
If OSCE bit in CPMUOSC register is 1, then the OSCMOD bit can not be changed (writes will have no effect).
0 External oscillator configured for loop controlled mode (reduced amplitude on EXTAL and XTAL))
1 External oscillator configured for full swing mode (full swing amplitude on EXTAL and XTAL)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
276 Freescale Semiconductor
7.4 Functional Description
7.4.1 Phase Locked Loop with Internal Filter (PLL)
The PLL is used to generate a high speed PLLCLK based on a low frequency REFCLK.
The REFCLK is by default the IRCCLK which is trimmed to fIRC1M_TRIM=1MHz.
If using the oscillator (OSCE=1) REFCLK will be based on OSCCLK. For increased flexibility , OSCCLK
can be divided in a range of 1 to 16 to generate the reference frequency REFCLK using the REFDIV[3:0]
bits. Based on the SYNDIV[5:0] bits the PLL generates the VCOCLK by multiplying the ref erence clock
by a 2, 4, 6,... 126, 128. Based on the POSTDIV[4:0] bits the VCOCLK can be divided in a range of 1,2,
3, 4, 5, 6,... to 32 to generate the PLLCLK.
.NOTE
Although it is possible to set the dividers to command a very high clock
frequency, do not exceed the specified bus frequency limit for the MCU.
fVCO 2f
REF
SYNDIV 1+=
fREF
fOSC
REFDIV 1+
-------------------------------------
=
If oscillator is enabled (OSCE=1)
If oscillator is disabled (OSCE=0) fREF fIRC1M
=
fPLL
fVCO
POSTDIV 1+
-----------------------------------------
=
If PLL is locked (LOCK=1)
If PLL is not locked (LOCK=0) fPLL
fVCO
4
---------------
=
fbus
fPLL
2
-------------
=
If PLL is selected (PLLSEL=1)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 277
Several examples of PLL divider settings are shown in Table 7-33. The following rules help to achieve
optimum stability and shortest lock time:
Use lowest possible fVCO / fREF ratio (SYNDIV value).
Use highest possible REFCLK frequency fREF.
The phase detector inside the PLL compares the feedback clock (FBCLK = VCOCLK/(SYNDIV+1)) with
the reference clock (REFCLK = (IRC1M or OSCCLK)/(REFDIV+1)). Correction pulses are generated
based on the phase difference between the two signals. The loop filter alters the DC voltage on the internal
filter capacitor, based on the width and direction of the correction pulse which leads to a higher or lower
VCO frequency.
The user must select the range of the REFCLK frequency (REFFRQ[1:0] bits) and the range of the
VCOCLK frequency (VCOFRQ[1:0] bits) to ensure that the correct PLL loop bandwidth is set.
The lock detector compares the frequencies of the FBCLK and the REFCLK. Therefore the speed of the
lock detector is directly proportional to the reference clock frequency. The circuit determines the lock
condition based on this comparison. So e.g. a failure in the reference clock will cause the PLL not to lock.
If PLL LOCK interrupt requests are enabled, the software can wait for an interrupt request and for instance
check the LOCK bit. If interrupt requests are disabled, software can poll the LOCK bit continuously
(during PLL start-up) or at periodic intervals. In either case, only when the LOCK bit is set, the VCOCLK
will have stabilized to the programmed frequency.
The LOCK bit is a read-only indicator of the locked state of the PLL.
The LOCK bit is set when the VCO frequency is within the tolerance, Lock, and is cleared when
the VCO frequency is out of the tolerance, unl.
Interrupt requests can occur if enabled (LOCKIE = 1) when the lock condition changes, toggling the
LOCK bit.In case of loss of reference clock (e.g. IRCCLK) the PLL will not lock or if already locked, then
it will unlock. The frequency of the VCOCLK will be very low and will depend on the value of the
VCOFRQ[1:0] bits.
Table 7-33. Examples of PLL Divider Settings
fosc REFDIV[3:0] fREF REFFRQ[1:0] SYNDIV[5:0] fVCO VCOFRQ[1:0] POSTDIV[4:0] fPLL fbus
off $00 1MHz 00 $18 50MHz 01 $03 12.5MHz 6.25MHz
off $00 1MHz 00 $18 50MHz 01 $00 50MHz 25MHz
4MHz $00 4MHz 01 $05 48MHz 00 $00 48MHz 24MHz
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
278 Freescale Semiconductor
7.4.2 S tartup from Reset
An example for startup of the clock system from Reset is given in Figure 7-36.
Figure 7-36. Startup of clock system after Reset
System
PLLCLK =
Reset
fVCORST
CPU reset state vector fetch, program execution
LOCK
POSTDIV $03 (default target fPLL=fVCO/4 = 12.5MHz)
fPLL increasing fPLL=12.5MHz
tlock
SYNDIV $18 (default target fVCO=50MHz)
$00
fPLL=50MHz
example change
of POSTDIV
) (
RESET
Pin
) (
768 cycles
startup
fVCORST
n
STARTUP
cycles
fBUS
512 cycles
fVCORST
256 cycles
fVCORST
Core Clock
Bus Clock = fBUS increasing fBUS=6.25MHz fBUS=25MHz
) ( ) (
Core Clock/2
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 279
7.4.3 Stop Mode using PLLCLK as source of the Bus Clock
An example of what happens going into Stop Mode and exiting Stop Mode after an interrupt is shown in
Figure 7-37. Disable PLL Lock interrupt (LOCKIE=0) before going into Stop Mode.
Figure 7-37. Stop Mode using PLLCLK as source of the Bus Clock
Depending on the COP configuration there might be an additional significant latency time until COP is
active again after exit from Stop Mode due to clock domain crossing synchronization. This latency time
occurs if COP clock source is ACLK and the CSAD bit is set (please refer to CSAD bit description for
details).
7.4.4 Full Stop Mode using Oscillator Clock as source of the Bus Clock
An example of what happens going into Full Stop Mode and exiting Full Stop Mode after an interrupt is
shown in Figure 7-38.
Disable PLL Lock interrupt (LOCKIE=0) and oscillator status change interrupt (OSCIE=0) before going
into Full Stop Mode.
PLLCLK
CPU
LOCK tlock
STOP instructionexecution interrupt continue execution
wake up
tSTP_REC
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
280 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 7-38. Full Stop Mode using Oscillator Clock as source of the Bus Clock
Depending on the COP configuration there might be a significant latency time until COP is active again
after exit from Stop Mode due to clock domain crossing synchronization. This la tency time occurs if COP
clock source is ACLK and the CSAD bit is set (please refer to CSAD bit description for details).
CPU
UPOSC
tlock
STOP instruction
execution interrupt continue execution
wake up
tSTP_REC
Core
Clock
select OSCCLK as Core/Bus Clock by writing PLLSEL to “0”
PLLSEL autom at ic ally set when going into Full Stop Mode
OSCCLK
PLLCLK
crystal/resonator starts oscillating
tUPOSC
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 281
7.4.5 External Oscillator
7.4.5.1 Enabling the External Oscillator
An example of how to use the oscillator as source of the Bus Clock is shown in Figure 7-39.
Figure 7-3 9. En ab li ng th e ex te rn al oscillator
PLLSEL
OSCE
OSCCLK
Core
enable external oscillator by writing OSCE bit to one.
crystal/resonator starts oscillating
UPOSC
UPOSC flag is set upon successful start of oscillation
select OSCCLK as Core/Bus Clock by writing PLLSEL to zero
Clock based on PLL Clock based on OSCCLK
tUPOSC
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
282 Freescale Semiconductor
7.4.6 System Clock Configurations
7.4.6.1 PLL Engaged Internal Mode (PEI)
This mode is the default mode after System Reset or Power-On Reset.
The Bus Clock is based on the PLLCLK, the reference clock for the PLL is internally generated (IRC1M).
The PLL is configured to 50 MHz VCOCLK with POSTDIV set to 0x03. If locked (LOCK=1) this results
in a PLLCLK of 12.5 MHz and a Bus Clock of 6.25 MHz. The PLL can be re-configured to other bus
frequencies.
The clock sources for COP and R TI can be based on the internal reference clock generator (IRC1M) or the
RC-Oscillator (ACLK).
7.4.6.2 PLL Engaged External Mode (PEE)
In this mode, the Bus Clock is based on the PLLCLK as well (like PEI). The reference clock for the PLL
is based on the external oscillator.
The clock sources for COP and RTI can be based on the internal reference clock generator or on the
external oscillator clock or the RC-Oscillator (ACLK).
This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps:
1. Configure the PLL for desired bus frequency.
2. Enable the external Oscillator (OSCE bit).
3. Wait for oscillator to start-up and the PLL being locked (LOCK = 1) and (UPOSC =1).
4. Clear all flags in the CPMUIFLG register to be able to detect any future status bit change.
5. Optionally status interrupts can be enabled (CPMUINT register).
Loosing PLL lock status (LOCK=0) means loosing the oscillator status information as well (UPOSC=0).
The impact of loosing the oscillator status (UPOSC=0) in PEE mode is as follows:
The PLLCLK is derived from the VCO clock (with its actual frequency) divided by four until the
PLL locks again.
Application software needs to be prepared to deal with the impact of loosing the oscillator status at any
time.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 283
7.4.6.3 PLL Bypassed External Mode (PBE)
In this mode, the Bus Clock is based on the external oscillator clock. The reference clock for the PLL is
based on the external oscillator.
The clock sources for COP and RTI can be based on the internal reference clock generator or on the
external oscillator clock or the RC-Oscillator (ACLK).
This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps:
1. Make sure the PLL configuration is valid.
2. Enable the external Oscillator (OSCE bit)
3. Wait for the oscillator to start-up and the PLL being locked (LOCK = 1) and (UPOSC =1)
4. Clear all flags in the CPMUIFLG register to be able to detect any status bit change.
5. Optionally status interrupts can be enabled (CPMUINT register).
6. Select the Oscillator clock as source of the Bus clock (PLLSEL=0)
Loosing PLL lock status (LOCK=0) means loosing the oscillator status information as well (UPOSC=0).
The impact of loosing the oscillator status (UPOSC=0) in PBE mode is as follows:
PLLSEL is set automatically and the Bus clock source is switched back to the PLL clock.
The PLLCLK is derived from the VCO clock (with its actual frequency) divided by four until the
PLL locks again.
NOTEApplication software needs to be prepared to deal with the impact of loosing the oscillator status at
any time.
When using the oscillator clock as system clock (write PLLSEL = 0) it is
highly recommended to enable the oscillator clock monitor reset feature
(write OMRE = 1 in CPMUOSC2 register). If the oscillator monitor reset
feature is disabled (OMRE = 0) and the oscillator clock is used as system
clock, the system might stall in case of loss of oscillation.
7.5 Resets
7.5.1 General
All reset sources are listed in Table 7-34. There is only one reset vector for all these reset sources. Refer
to MCU specification for reset vector address.
Table 7-34. Reset Summary
Reset Source Local Enable
Power-On Reset (POR) None
Low Voltage Reset (LVR) None
External pin RESET None
PLL Clock Monitor Reset None
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
284 Freescale Semiconductor
7.5.2 Description of Reset Operation
Upon detection of any reset of Table 7-34, an internal circuit drives the RESET pin low for 512 PLLCLK
cycles. After 512 PLLCLK cycles the RESET pin is released. The internal reset of the MCU remains
asserted while the reset generator completes the 768 PLLCLK cycles long reset sequence.In case the
RESET pin is externally driven low for more than these 768 PLLCLK cycles (External Reset), the internal
reset remains asserted longer.
NOTE
While System Reset is asserted the PLLCLK runs with the frequency
fVCORST.
Figure 7-40. RESET Timing
7.5.3 Oscillator Clock Monitor Reset
If the external oscillator is enabled (OSCE=1)and the oscillator clock monitor reset is enabled (OMRE=1),
then in case of loss of oscillation or the oscillator frequency drops below the failure assert frequency fCMFA
(see device electrical characteristics for values), the S12CPMU_UHV_V6 generates an Oscillator Clock
Monitor Reset. In Full Stop Mode the external oscillator and the oscillator clock monitor are disabled.
Oscillator Clock Monitor Reset OSCE Bit in CPMUOSC register and
OMRE Bit in CPMUOSC2 register
COP Reset CR[2:0] in CPMUCOP register
Table 7-34. Reset Summary
Reset Source Local Enable
)
(
)
PLLCLK
512 cycles 25 6 cy c le s
S12_CPMU drives
possibly
RESET
driven low
externally
)
(
(
RESET
S12_CPMU releases
fVCORST
RESET pin low RESET pin
fVCORST
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 285
7.5.4 PLL Clock Monitor Reset
In case of loss of PLL clock oscillation or the PLL clock frequency is below the failure assert frequency
fPMFA (see device electrical characteristics for values), the S12CPMU_UHV_V6 generates a PLL Clock
Monitor Reset. In Full Stop Mode the PLL and the PLL clock monitor are disabled.
7.5.5 Computer Operating Properly Watchdog (COP) Reset
The COP (free running watchdog timer) enables the user to check that a program is running and
sequencing properly. When the COP is being used, software is responsible for keeping the COP from
timing out. If the COP times out it is an indication that the software is no longer being executed in the
intended sequence; thus COP reset is generated.
The clock source for the COP is either ACLK, IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the
COPOSCSEL0 and COPOSCSEL1 bit.
Depending on the COP configuration there might be a significant latency time until COP is active again
after exit from Stop Mode due to clock domain crossing synchronization. This la tency time occurs if COP
clock source is ACLK and the CSAD bit is set (please refer to CSAD bit description for details).
Table 7-35 gives an overview of the COP condition (run, static) in Stop Mode depending on legal
configuration and status bit settings:
Table 7-35. COP condition (run, static) in St op Mode
COPOSCSEL1 CSAD PSTP PCE COPOSCSEL0 OSCE UPOSC COP counter behavior in Stop Mode
(clock source)
1 0 x x x x x Run (ACLK)
11xx x x x Static (ACLK)
0 x 1 1 1 1 1 Run (OSCCLK)
0 x 1 1 0 0 x Static (IRCCLK)
0 x 1 1 0 1 x Static (IRCCLK)
0 x 1 0 0 x x Static (IRCCLK)
0x101 1 1 Static (OSCCLK)
0x011 1 1 Static (OSCCLK)
0 x 0 1 0 1 x Static (IRCCLK)
0 x 0 1 0 0 0 Static (IRCCLK)
0 x 0 0 1 1 1 Satic (OSCCLK)
0 x 0 0 0 1 1 Static (IRCCLK)
0 x 0 0 0 1 0 Static (IRCCLK)
0 x 0 0 0 0 0 Static (IRCCLK)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
286 Freescale Semiconductor
Three control bits in the CPMUCOP register allow selection of seven COP time-out periods.
When COP is enabled, the program must write $55 and $AA (in this order) to the CPMUARMCOP
register during the selected time-out period. Once this is done, the COP time-out period is restarted. If the
program fails to do this and the COP times out, a COP reset is generated. Also, if any value other than $55
or $AA is written, a COP reset is generated.
W indowed COP operation is enabled by setting WCOP in the CPMUCOP register. In this mode, writes to
the CPMUARMCOP register to clear the COP timer must occur in the last 25% of the selected time-out
period. A premature write will immediately reset the part.
In MCU Normal Mode the COP time-out period (CR[2:0]) and COP window (WCOP) setting can be
automatically pre-loaded at reset release from NVM memory (if values are defined in the NVM by the
application). By default the COP is off and no window COP feature is enabled after reset release via NVM
memory. The COP control register CPMUCOP can be written once in an application in MCU Normal
Mode to update the COP time-out period (CR[2:0]) and COP window (WCOP) setting loaded from NVM
memory at reset release. Any value for the new COP time-out period and COP window setting is allowed
except COP off value if the COP was enabled during pre-load via NVM memory.
The COP clock source select bits can not be pre-loaded via NVM memory at reset release. The IRC clock
is the default COP clock source out of reset.
The COP clock source select bits (COPOSCSEL0/1) and ACLK clock control bit in Stop Mode (CSAD)
can be modified until the CPMUCOP register write once has taken place. Therefore these control bits
should be modified before the final COP time-out period and window COP setting is written.
The CPMUCOP register access to modify the COP time-out period and window COP setting in MCU
Normal Mode after reset release must be done with the WRTMASK bit cleared otherwise the update is
ignored and this access does not count as the write once.
7.5.6 Power-On Reset (POR)
The on-chip POR circuitry detects when the internal supply VDD drops below an appropriate voltage
level. The POR is deasserted, if the internal supply VDD exceeds an appropriate voltage level (voltage
levels not specified, because the internal supply can not be monitored externally).The POR circuitry is
always active. It acts as LVR in Stop Mode.
7.5.7 Low-Voltage Reset (LVR)
The on-chip LVR circuitry detects when one of the supply voltages VDD, VDDX and VDDF drops below
an appropriate voltage level. If LVR is deasserted the MCU is fully operatio nal at the specified maximum
speed. The LVR assert and deassert levels for the supply voltage VDDX are VLVRXA and VLVRXD and are
specified in the device Reference Manual.The LVR circuitry is active in Run- and Wait Mode.
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 287
7.6 Interrupts
The interrupt vectors requested by the S12CPMU_UHV_V6 are listed in Table 7-36. Refer to MCU
specification for related vector addresses and priorities.
7.6.1 Description of Interrupt Operation
7.6.1.1 Real Time Interrupt (RTI)
The clock source for the RTI is either IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the RTIOSCSEL
bit. In Stop Mode with PSTP=1 (Pseudo Stop Mode), RTIOSCSEL=1 and PRE=1 the RTI continues to
run, else the RTI counter halts in Stop Mode.
The RTI can be used to generate hardware interrupts at a fixed periodic rate. If enabled (by setting
R TIE=1), this interrupt will occur at the rate selected by the CPMUR TI register. At the end of the RTI time-
out period the RTIF flag is set to one and a new RTI time-out period starts immediately.
A write to the CPMURTI register restarts the RTI time-out period.
7.6.1.2 PLL Lock Interrupt
The S12CPMU_UHV_V6 generates a PLL Lock interrupt when the lock condition (LOCK status bit) of
the PLL changes, either from a locked state to an unlocked state or vice versa. Lock interrupts are locally
disabled by setting the LOCKIE bit to zero. The PLL Lock interrupt flag (LOCKIF) is set to1 when the
lock condition has changed, and is cleared to 0 by writing a 1 to the LOCKIF bit.
7.6.1.3 Oscillator Status Interrupt
When the OSCE bit is 0, then UPOSC stays 0. When OSCE=1 the UPOSC bit is set after the LOCK bit is
set.
Table 7-36. S12CPMU_UHV_V6 Interrupt Vectors
Interrupt Source CCR
Mask Local Enable
RTI time-out interrupt I bit CPMUINT (RTIE)
PLL lock interrupt I bit CPMUINT (LOCKIE)
Oscillator status
interrupt
I bit CPMUINT (OSCIE)
Low voltage interrupt I bit CPMULVCTL (LVIE)
High temperature
interrupt
I bit CPMUHTCTL (HTIE)
Autonomous
Periodical Interrupt
I bit CPMUAPICTL (APIE)
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
288 Freescale Semiconductor
Upon detection of a status change (UPOSC) the OSCIF flag is set. Going into Full Stop Mode or disabling
the oscillator can also cause a status change of UPOSC.
Any change in PLL configuration or any other event which causes the PLL lock status to be cleared leads
to a loss of the oscillator status information as well (UPOSC=0).
Oscillator status change interrupts are locally enabled with the OSCIE bit.
NOTE
Loosing the oscillator status (UPOSC=0) affects the clock configuration of
the system1. This needs to be dealt with in application software.
7.6.1.4 Low-Voltage Interrupt (LVI)
In FPM the input voltage VDDA is monitored. Whenever VDDA drops below level VLVIA, the status bit
LVDS is set to 1. When VDDA rises above level VLVID the status bit LVDS is cleared to 0. An interrupt,
indicated by flag LVIF = 1, is triggered by any change of the status bit LVDS if interrupt enable bit LVIE
= 1.
7.6.1.5 HTI - High Temperature Interrupt
In FPM the junction temperature TJ is monitored. Whenever TJ exceeds level THTIA the status bit HTDS
is set to 1. Vice versa, HTDS is reset to 0 when TJ get below level THTID. An interrupt, indicated by flag
HTIF = 1, is triggered by any change of the status bit HTDS, if interrupt enable bit HTIE = 1.
7.6.1.6 Autonomous Periodical Interrupt (API)
The API sub-block can generate periodical interrupts independent of the clock source of the MCU. To
enable the timer, the bit APIFE needs to be set.
The API timer is either clocked by the Autonomous Clock (ACLK - trimmable internal RC oscillator) or
the Bus Clock. Timer operation will freeze when MCU clock source is selected and Bus Clock is turned
off. The clock source can be selected with bit APICLK. APICLK can only be written when APIFE is not
set.
The APIR[15:0] bits determine the interrupt period. APIR[15:0] can only be written when APIFE is
cleared. As soon as APIFE is set, the timer starts running for the period selected by APIR[15:0] bits. When
the configured time has elapsed, the flag APIF is set. An interrupt, indicated by flag APIF = 1, is triggered
if interrupt enable bit APIE = 1. The timer is re-started automatically again after it has set APIF.
The procedure to change APICLK or APIR[15:0] is first to clear APIFE, then write to APICLK or
APIR[15:0], and afterwards set APIFE.
The API Trimming bits ACLKTR[5:0] must be set so the minimum period equals 0.2 ms if stable
frequency is desired.
See Table 7-21 for the trimming effect of ACLKTR[5:0].
1. For details please refer to “7.4.6 System Clock Configurations”
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 289
NOTE
The first period after enabling the counter by APIFE might be reduced by
API start up delay tsdel.
It is possible to generate with the API a waveform at the external pin API_EXTCLK by setting APIFE and
enabling the external access with setting APIEA.
7.7 Initialization/Application Information
7.7.1 General Initialization Information
Usually applications run in MCU Normal Mode.
It is recommended to write the CPMUCOP register in any case from the application program initialization
routine after reset no matter if the COP is used in the application or not, even if a configuration is loaded
via the flash memory after reset. By doing a “controlled” write access in MCU Normal Mode (with the
right value for the application) the write once for the COP configuration bits (WCOP,CR[2:0]) takes place
which protects these bits from further accidental change. In case of a program sequencing issue (code
runaway) the COP configuration can not be accidentally modified anymore.
7.7.2 Application information for COP and API usage
In many applications the COP is used to check that the program is running and sequencing properly. Often
the COP is kept running during S top Mode and periodic wake-up events are needed to service the COP on
time and maybe to check the system status.
For such an application it is reco mmended to use the ACLK as clock source for both COP and API. This
guarantees lowest possible IDD current during S top Mode. Additionally it eases software implementation
using the same clock source for both, COP and API.
The Interrupt Service Routine (ISR) of the Autonomous Periodic Interrupt API should contain the write
instruction to the CPMUARMCOP register. The value (byte) written is derived from the “main routine”
(alternating sequence of $55 and $AA) of the application software.
Using this method, then in the case of a runtime or program sequencing issue the application “main
routine” is not executed properly anymore and the alternating va lues are not provided properly. Hence the
COP is written at the correct time (due to independent API interrupt request) but the wrong value is written
(alternating sequence of $55 and $AA is no longer maintained) which causes a COP reset.
If the COP is stopped during any Stop Mode it is recommended to service the COP shortly before Stop
Mode is entered.
7.7.3 Application Information for PLL and Oscillator Startup
The following C-code example shows a recommended way of setting up the system clock system using
the PLL and Oscillator:
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU_UHV_V6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
290 Freescale Semiconductor
/* Procedure proposed by to setup PLL and Oscillator */
/* example for OSC = 4 MHz and Bus Clock = 25MHz, That is VCOCLK = 50MHz */
/* Initialize */
/* PLL Clock = 50 MHz, divide by one */
CPMUPOSTDIV = 0x00;
/* Generally: Whenever changing PLL reference clock (REFCLK) frequency to a higher value */
/* it is recommended to write CPMUSYNR = 0x00 in order to stay within specified */
/* maximum frequency of the MCU */
CPMUSYNR = 0x00;
/* configure PLL reference clock (REFCLK) for usage with Oscillator */
/* OSC=4MHz divide by 4 (3+1) = 1MHz, REFCLK range 1MHz to 2 MHz (REFFRQ[1:0] = 00) */
CPMUREFDV = 0x03;
/* enable external Oscillator, switch PLL reference clock (REFCLK) to OSC */
CPMUOSC = 0x80;
/* multiply REFCLK = 1MHz by 2*(24+1)*1MHz = 50MHz */
/* VCO range 48 to 80 MHz (VCOFRQ[1:0] = 01) */
CPMUSYNR = 0x58;
/* clear all flags, especially LOCKIF and OSCIF */
CPMUIFLG = 0xFF;
/* put your code to loop and wait for the LOCKIF and OSCIF or */
/* poll CPMUIFLG register until both UPOSC and LOCK status are “1” */
/* that is CPMIFLG == 0x1B */
/*...............continue to your main code execution here...............*/
/* in case later in your code you want to disable the Oscillator and use the */
/* 1MHz IRCCLK as PLL reference clock */
/* Generally: Whenever changing PLL reference clock (REFCLK) frequency to a higher value */
/* it is recommended to write CPMUSYNR = 0x00 in order to stay within specified */
/* maximum frequency of the MCU */
CPMUSYNR = 0x00;
/* disable OSC and switch PLL reference clock to IRC */
CPMUOSC = 0x00;
/* multiply REFCLK = 1MHz by 2*(24+1)*1MHz = 50MHz */
/* VCO range 48 to 80 MHz (VCOFRQ[1:0] = 01) */
CPMUSYNR = 0x58;
/* clear all flags, especially LOCKIF and OSCIF */
CPMUIFLG = 0xFF;
/* put your code to loop and wait for the LOCKIF or */
/* poll CPMUIFLG register until both LOCK status is “1” */
/* that is CPMIFLG == 0x18 */
/*...............continue to your main code execution here...............*/
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 291
Chapter 8
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
8.1 Introduction
The basic scalable timer consists of a 16-bit, software-programmable counter driven by a flexible
programmable prescaler.
This timer can be used for many purposes, including input waveform measurements while simultaneously
generating an output waveform. Pulse widths can vary from microseconds to many seconds.
This timer could contain up to 8 input capture/output compare channels with one pulse accumulator
available only on channel 7. The input capture function is used to detect a selected transition edge and
record the time. The output compare function is used for generating output signals or for timer software
delays. The 16-bit pulse accumulator is used to operate as a simple event counter or a gated time
accumulator. The pulse accumulator shares timer channel 7 when the channel is available and when in
event mode.
A full access for the counter registers or the input capture/output compare registers should take place in
one clock cycle. Accessing high byte and low byte separately for all of these registers may not yield the
same result as accessing them in one word.
8.1.1 Features
The TIM16B8CV3 includes these distinctive features:
Up to 8 channels available. (refer to device specification for exact number)
All channels have same input capture/output compare functionality.
Clock prescaling.
16-bit counter.
16-bit pulse accumulator on channel 7 .
Table 8-1.
V03.02 Apri,12,2010 8.3.2.8/8-302
8.3.2.11/8-305
8.4.3/8-314
-Add Table 8-10
-update TCRE bit description
-add Figure 8-31
V03.03 Jan,14,2013
-single source generate different channel guide
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
292 Freescale Semiconductor
8.1.2 Modes of Operation
Stop: Timer is off because clocks are stopped.
Freeze: Timer counter keeps on running, unless TSFRZ in TSCR1 is set to 1.
Wait: Counters keeps on running, unless TSWAI in TSCR1 is set to 1.
Normal: Timer counter keep on running, unless TEN in TSCR1 is cleared to 0.
8.1.3 Block Diagrams
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 293
Figure 8-1. TIM16B8CV3 Block Diagram
Prescaler
16-bit Counter
Input capture
Output compare
16-bit
Pulse accumulator
IOC0
IOC2
IOC1
IOC5
IOC3
IOC4
IOC6
IOC7
PA input
interrupt
PA overflow
interrupt
Timer overflow
interrupt
Timer channel 0
interrupt
Timer channel 7
interrupt
Registers
Bus clock
Input capture
Output compare
Input capture
Output compare
Input capture
Output compare
Input capture
Output compare
Input capture
Output compare
Input capture
Output compare
Input capture
Output compare
Channel 0
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 3
Channel 4
Channel 5
Channel 6
Channel 7
Maximum possible channels, scalable from 0 to 7.
Pulse Accumulator is available only if channel 7 exists.
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
294 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 8-2. 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator Block Diagram
Figure 8-3. Interrupt Flag Setting
Edge detector
Intermodule Bus
IOC7
M clock
Divide by 64
Clock select
CLK0
CLK1 4:1 MUX
TIMCLK
PACLK
PACLK / 256
PACLK / 65536
Prescaled clock
(PCLK)
(Timer clock)
Interrupt
MUX
(PAMOD)
PACNT
IOCn
Edge detector
16-bit Main Timer
TCn Input Capture Reg.
Set CnF Interrupt
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 295
Figure 8-4. Channel 7 Output Compare/Pulse Accumulator Logic
8.2 External Signal Description
The TIM16B8CV3 module has a selected number of external pins. Refer to device specification for exact
number.
8.2.1 IOC7 — Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 7
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 7 . This can also be configured as pulse
accumulator input.
8.2.2 IOC6 - IOC0 — Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 6-0
Those pins serve as input capture or output compare for TIM16B8CV3 channel .
NOTE
For the description of interrupts see Section 8.6, “Interrupts”.
8.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all memory and registers.
8.3.1 Module Memory Map
The memory map for the TIM16B8CV3 module is given below in Figure 8-5. The address listed for each
register is the address offset. The total address for each register is the sum of the base address for the
TIM16B8CV3 module and the address offset for each register.
PULSE
ACCUMULATOR PAD
TEN
CHANNEL 7 OUTPUT COMPARE
OCPD
TIOS7
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
296 Freescale Semiconductor
8.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order . Each description includes a standard register
diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register
diagrams, in bit order.
Only bits related to implemented channels are valid.
Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
0x0000
TIOS
RIOS7 IOS6 IOS5 IOS4 IOS3 IOS2 IOS1 IOS0
W
0x0001
CFORC
R00000000
W FOC7 FOC6 FOC5 FOC4 FOC3 FOC2 FOC1 FOC0
0x0002
OC7M
ROC7M7OC7M6OC7M5OC7M4OC7M3OC7M2OC7M1OC7M0
W
0x0003
OC7D
ROC7D7 OC7D6 OC7D5 OC7D4 OC7D3 OC7D2 OC7D1 OC7D0
W
0x0004
TCNTH
RTCNT15 TCNT14 TCNT13 TCNT12 TCNT11 TCNT10 TCNT9 TCNT8
W
0x0005
TCNTL
RTCNT7 TCNT6 TCNT5 TCNT4 TCNT3 TCNT2 TCNT1 TCNT0
W
0x0006
TSCR1
RTEN TSWAI TSFRZ TFFCA PRNT 000
W
0x0007
TTOV
RTOV7 TOV6 TOV5 TOV4 TOV3 TOV2 TOV1 TOV0
W
0x0008
TCTL1
ROM7OL7OM6OL6OM5OL5OM4OL4
W
0x0009
TCTL2
ROM3OL3OM2OL2OM1OL1OM0OL0
W
0x000A
TCTL3
REDG7B EDG7A EDG6B EDG6A EDG5B EDG5A EDG4B EDG4A
W
0x000B
TCTL4
REDG3B EDG3A EDG2B EDG2A EDG1B EDG1A EDG0B EDG0A
W
0x000C
TIE
RC7I C6I C5I C4I C3I C2I C1I C0I
W
0x000D
TSCR2
RTOI 000
TCRE PR2 PR1 PR0
W
0x000E
TFLG1
RC7F C6F C5F C4F C3F C2F C1F C0F
W
0x000F
TFLG2
RTOF 0000000
W
0x0010–0x001F
TCxH–TCxL(1)
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
W
RBit 7Bit 6Bit 5Bit 4Bit 3Bit 2Bit 1Bit 0
W
0x0020
PACTL
R0 PAEN PAMOD PEDGE CLK1 CLK0 PAOVI PAI
W
Figure 8-5. TIM16B8CV3 Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 2)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 297
8.3.2.1 Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Select (TIOS)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
0x0021
PAFLG
R000000
PAOVF PAIF
W
0x0022
PACNTH
RPACNT15 PACNT14 PACNT13 PACNT12 PACNT11 PACNT10 PACNT9 PACNT8
W
0x0023
PACNTL
RPACNT7 PACNT6 PACNT5 PACNT4 PACNT3 PACNT2 PACNT1 PACNT0
W
0x0024–0x002B
Reserved
R
W
0x002C
OCPD
ROCPD7 OCPD6 OCPD5 OCPD4 OCPD3 OCPD2 OCPD1 OCPD0
W
0x002D
Reserved
R
0x002E
PTPSR
RPTPS7 PTPS6 PTPS5 PTPS4 PTPS3 PTPS2 PTPS1 PTPS0
W
0x002F
Reserved
R
W
1. The register is available only if corresponding channel exists.
76543210
R
IOS7 IOS6 IOS5 IOS4 IOS3 IOS2 IOS1 IOS0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-6. Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Select (TIOS)
Table 8 -2. TIOS Field Descriptions
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero.
Field Description
7:0
IOS[7:0]
Input Capture or Output Compare Channel Configuration
0 The corresponding implemented channel acts as an input capture.
1 The corresponding implemented channel acts as an output compare.
Register
Name Bit 76 5 4 3 2 1Bit 0
Figure 8-5. TIM16B8CV3 Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 2)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
298 Freescale Semiconductor
8.3.2.2 Timer Compare Force Register (CFORC)
Read: Anytime but will always return 0x0000 (1 state is transient)
Write: Anytime
8.3.2.3 Output Compare 7 Mask Register (OC7M)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R00000000
W FOC7 FOC6 FOC5 FOC4 FOC3 FOC2 FOC1 FOC0
Reset00000000
Figure 8-7. Timer Compare Force Regi st er (CFORC)
Table 8-3. CFORC Field Descriptions
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero.
Field Description
7:0
FOC[7:0]
Note: Force Output Compare Action for Channel 7:0 — A write to this register with the corresponding data
bit(s) set causes the action which is programmed for output compare “x” to occur immediately. The action
taken is the same as if a successful comparison had just taken place with the TCx register except the
interrupt flag does not get set. A channel 7 event, which can be a counter overflow when TTOV[7] is set
or a successful output compare on channel 7, overrides any channel 6:0 compares. If forced output
compare on any channel occurs at the same time as the successful output compare then forced output
compare action will take precedence and interrupt flag won’t get set.
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
R
OC7M7 OC7M6 OC7M5 OC7M4 OC7M3 OC7M2 OC7M1 OC7M0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-8. Outp ut Compare 7 Mask Regist er (O C7M )
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 299
8.3.2.4 Output Compare 7 Data Register (OC7D)
1.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
8.3.2.5 Timer Count Register (TCNT)
Table 8-4. OC7M Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:0
OC7M[7:0]
Output Compare 7 Mask — A channel 7 event, which can be a counter overflow when TTOV[7] is set or a
successful output compare on channel 7, overrides any channel 6:0 compares. For each OC7M bit that is set,
the output compare action reflects the corresponding OC7D bit.
0 The corresponding OC7Dx bit in the output compare 7 data register will not be transferred to the timer port on
a channel 7 event, even if the corresponding pin is setup for output compare.
1 The corresponding OC7Dx bit in the output compare 7 data register will be transferred to the timer port on a
channel 7 event.
Note: The corresponding channel must also be setup for output compare (IOSx = 1 and OCPDx = 0) for data to
be transferred from the output compare 7 data register to the timer port.
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R
OC7D7 OC7D6 OC7D5 OC7D4 OC7D3 OC7D2 OC7D1 OC7D0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-9. Output Compare 7 Data Register (OC7D)
Table 8 -5. OC7D Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:0
OC7D[7:0]
Output Compare 7 Data — A channel 7 event, which can be a counter overflow when TTOV[7] is set or a
successful output compare on channel 7, can cause bits in the output compare 7 data register to transfer to the
timer port data register depending on the output compare 7 mask register.
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 9
R
TCNT15 TCNT14 TCNT13 TCNT12 TCNT11 TCNT10 TCNT9 TCNT8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-10. Timer Count Register High (TCNTH)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
300 Freescale Semiconductor
The 16-bit main timer is an up counter.
A full access for the counter register should take place in one clock cycle. A separate read/write for high
byte and low byte will give a different result than accessing them as a word.
Read: Anytime
Write: Has no meaning or effect in the normal mode; only writable in special modes .
The period of the first count after a write to the TCNT registers may be a different size because the write
is not synchronized with the prescaler clock.
8.3.2.6 Timer System Control Register 1 (TSCR1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
TCNT7 TCNT6 TCNT5 TCNT4 TCNT3 TCNT2 TCNT1 TCNT0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-11. Timer Count Registe r Low (TCNTL)
76543210
R
TEN TSWAI TSFRZ TFFCA PRNT
000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 8-12. Timer System Control Register 1 (TSCR1)
Table 8-6. TSCR1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
TEN
Timer Enable
0 Disables the main timer, including the counter. Can be used for reducing power consumption.
1 Allows the timer to function normally.
If for any reason the timer is not active, there is no 64 clock for the pulse accumulator because the 64 is
generated by the timer prescaler.
6
TSWAI
Timer Module Stops While in Wait
0 Allows the timer module to continue running during wait.
1 Disables the timer module when the MCU is in the wait mode. Timer interrupts cannot be used to get the MCU
out of wait.
TSWAI also affects pulse accumulator.
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 301
8.3.2.7 Timer Toggle On Overflow Register 1 (TTOV)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
5
TSFRZ
Timer Stops While in Freeze Mode
0 Allows the timer counter to continue running while in freeze mode.
1 Disables the timer counter whenever the MCU is in freeze mode. This is useful for emulation.
TSFRZ does not stop the pulse accumulator.
4
TFFCA
Timer Fast Flag Clear All
0 Allows the timer flag clearing to function normally.
1 For TFLG1(0x000E), a read from an input capture or a write to the output compare channel (0x0010–0x001F)
causes the corresponding channel flag, CnF, to be cleared. For TFLG2 (0x000F), any access to the TCNT
register (0x0004, 0x0005) clears the TOF flag. Any access to the PACNT registers (0x0022, 0x0023) clears
the PAOVF and PAIF flags in the PAFLG register (0x0021) if channel 7 exists. This has the advantage of
eliminating software overhead in a separate clear sequence. Extra care is required to avoid accidental flag
clearing due to unintended accesses.
3
PRNT
Precision Timer
0 Enables legacy timer. PR0, PR1, and PR2 bits of the TSCR2 register are used for timer counter prescaler
selection.
1 Enables precision timer. All bits of the PTPSR register are used for Precision Timer Prescaler Selection, and
all bits.
This bit is writable only once out of reset.
76543210
R
TOV7 TOV6 TOV5 TOV4 TOV3 TOV2 TOV1 TOV0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-13. Timer Toggle On Overflow Register 1 (TTOV)
Table 8-7. TTOV Field Descriptions
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero.
Field Description
7:0
TOV[7:0]
Toggle On Overflow Bits TOVx toggles output compare pin on overflow. This feature only takes effect when
in output compare mode. When set, it takes precedence over forced output compare but not channel 7 override
events.
0 Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature disabled.
1 Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature enabled.
Table 8-6. TSCR1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
302 Freescale Semiconductor
8.3.2.8 Timer Control Register 1/Timer Control Register 2 (TCTL1/TCTL2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Note: T o enable output action using the OM7 and OL7 bits on the timer port,the corresponding bit OC7M7
in the OC7M register must also be cleared. The settings for these bits can be seen inTable 8-10.
76543210
R
OM7 OL7 OM6 OL6 OM5 OL5 OM4 OL4
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-14. Timer Control Register 1 (TCTL1)
76543210
R
OM3 OL3 OM2 OL2 OM1 OL1 OM0 OL0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-15. Timer Control Register 2 (TCTL2)
Table 8 -8. TCTL1/TCTL2 Field Descriptions
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7:0
OMx
Output ModeThese eight pairs of control bits are encoded to specify the output action to be taken as a result
of a successful OCx compare. When either OMx or OLx is 1, the pin associated with OCx becomes an output
tied to OCx.
Note: To enable output action by OMx bits on timer port, the corresponding bit in OC7M should be cleared. For
an output line to be driven by an OCx the OCPDx must be cleared.
7:0
OLx
Output LevelThese eightpairs of control bits are encoded to specify the output action to be taken as a result
of a successful OCx compare. When either OMx or OLx is 1, the pin associated with OCx becomes an output
tied to OCx.
Note: To enable output action by OLx bits on timer port, the corresponding bit in OC7M should be cleared. For
an output line to be driven by an OCx the OCPDx must be cleared.
Table 8-9. Compare Result Output Action
OMx OLx Action
0 0 No output compare
action on the timer output signal
0 1 Toggle OCx output line
1 0 Clear OCx output line to zero
1 1 Set OCx output line to one
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 303
Note: in Table 8-10, the IOS7 and IOSx should be set to 1
IOSx is the register TIOS bit x,
OC7Mx is the register OC7M bit x,
TCx is timer Input Capture/Output Compare register,
IOCx is channel x,
OMx/OLx is the register TCTL1/TCTL2,
OC7Dx is the register OC7D bit x.
IOCx = OC7Dx+ OMx/OLx, means that both OC7 event and OCx event will change channel x value.
8.3.2.9 Timer Control Register 3/Timer Control Register 4 (TCTL3 and TCTL4)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime.
Table 8-10. The OC7 and OCx event priority
OC7M7=0 OC7M7=1
OC7Mx=1 OC7Mx=0 OC7Mx=1 OC7Mx=0
TC7=TCx TC7>TCx TC7=TCx TC7>TCx TC7=TCx TC7>TCx TC7=TCx TC7>TCx
IOCx=OC7Dx
IOC7=OM7/O
L7
IOCx=OC7Dx
+OMx/OLx
IOC7=OM7/O
L7
IOCx=OMx/OLx
IOC7=OM7/OL7
IOCx=OC7Dx
IOC7=OC7D7
IOCx=OC7Dx
+OMx/OLx
IOC7=OC7D7
IOCx=OMx/OLx
IOC7=OC7D7
76543210
R
EDG7B EDG7A EDG6B EDG6A EDG5B EDG5A EDG4B EDG4A
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-16. Timer Control Register 3 (TCTL3)
76543210
R
EDG3B EDG3A EDG2B EDG2A EDG1B EDG1A EDG0B EDG0A
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-17. Timer Control Register 4 (TCTL4)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
304 Freescale Semiconductor
8.3.2.10 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIE)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime.
Table 8-11. TCTL3/TCTL4 Field De scriptions
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero.
Field Description
7:0
EDGnB
EDGnA
Input Capture Edge Control These eight pairs of control bits configure the input capture edge detector
circuits.
Table 8-12. Edge Detector Circuit Configur ation
EDGnB EDGnA Configuration
0 0 Capture disabled
0 1 Capture on rising edges only
1 0 Capture on falling edges only
1 1 Capture on any edge (rising or falling)
76543210
R
C7I C6I C5I C4I C3I C2I C1I C0I
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-18. Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIE)
Table 8-13. TIE Field Descriptions
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7:0
C7I:C0I
Input Capture/Output Compare “x” Interrupt Enable — The bits in TIE correspond bit-for-bit with the bits in
the TFLG1 status register. If cleared, the corresponding flag is disabled from causing a hardware interrupt. If set,
the corresponding flag is enabled to cause a interrupt.
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 305
8.3.2.11 Timer System Control Register 2 (TSCR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime.
76543210
R
TOI
000
TCRE PR2 PR1 PR0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 8-19. Timer System Control Register 2 (TSCR2)
Table 8-14. TSCR2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
TOI
Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable
0 Interrupt inhibited.
1 Hardware interrupt requested when TOF flag set.
3
TCRE
Timer Counter Reset Enable — This bit allows the timer counter to be reset by a successful output compare 7
event. This mode of operation is similar to an up-counting modulus counter.
0 Counter reset inhibited and counter free runs.
1 Counter reset by a successful output compare 7.
Note: If TC7 = 0x0000 and TCRE = 1, TCNT will stay at 0x0000 continuously. If TC7 = 0xFFFF and TCRE = 1,
TOF will never be set when TCNT is reset from 0xFFFF to 0x0000.
Note: TCRE=1 and TC7!=0, the TCNT cycle period will be TC7 x "prescaler counter width" + "1 Bus Clock", for
a more detail explanation please refer to Section 8.4.3, “Output Compare
Note: This bit and feature is available only when channel 7 exists. If channel 7 doesn’t exist, this bit is reserved.
Writing to reserved bit has no effect. Read from reserved bit return a zero.
2:0
PR[2:0]
Timer Prescaler Select — These three bits select the frequency of the timer prescaler clock derived from the
Bus Clock as shown in Tab l e 8-15 .
Table 8-15. Timer Clock Selection
PR2 PR1 PR0 Timer Clock
0 0 0 Bus Clock / 1
0 0 1 Bus Clock / 2
0 1 0 Bus Clock / 4
0 1 1 Bus Clock / 8
1 0 0 Bus Clock / 16
1 0 1 Bus Clock / 32
1 1 0 Bus Clock / 64
1 1 1 Bus Clock / 128
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
306 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
The newly selected prescale factor will not take effect until the next
synchronized edge where all prescale counter stages equal zero.
8.3.2.12 Main Timer Interrupt Flag 1 (TFLG1)
Read: Anytime
W rite: Used in the clearing mechanism (set bits cause corresponding bits to be cleared). Writing a zero will
not affect current status of the bit.
8.3.2.13 Main Timer Interrupt Flag 2 (TFLG2)
TFLG2 indicates when interrupt conditions have occurred. To clear a bit in the flag register, write the bit
to one while TEN bit of TSCR1 or PAEN bit of PACTL is set to one.
Read: Anytime
Write: Used in clearing mechanism (set bits cause corresponding bits to be cleared).
Any access to TCNT will clear TFLG2 register if the TFFCA bit in TSCR register is set.
76543210
R
C7F C6F C5F C4F C3F C2F C1F C0F
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-20. Main Timer Interrupt Flag 1 (TFLG1)
Table 8-16. TRLG1 Field Descriptions
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero.
Field Description
7:0
C[7:0]F
Input Capture/Output Compare Channel “x” Flag — These flags are set when an input capture or output
compare event occurs. Clearing requires writing a one to the corresponding flag bit while TEN or PAEN is set to
one.
Note: When TFFCA bit in TSCR register is set, a read from an input capture or a write into an output compare
channel (0x0010–0x001F) will cause the corresponding channel flag CxF to be cleared.
76543210
R
TOF
0000000
W
Reset00000000
Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 8-21. Main Timer Interrupt Flag 2 (TFLG2)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 307
8.3.2.14 Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Registers High and Low 0–
7(TCxH and TCxL)
1This register is available only when the corresponding channel exists and is reserved if that channel does not exist. Writes to
a reserved register have no functional effect. Reads from a reserved register return zeroes.
Depending on the TIOS bit for the corresponding channel, these registers are used to latch the value of the
free-running counter when a defined transition is sensed by the corresponding input capture edge detector
or to trigger an output action for output compare.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime for output compare function.Writes to these registers have no meaning or effect during
input capture. All timer input capture/output compare registers are reset to 0x0000.
NOTE
Read/W rite access in byte mode for high byte should take place before low
byte otherwise it will give a different result.
Table 8-17. TRLG2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
TOF
Timer Overflow Flag — Set when 16-bit free-running timer overflows from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. Clearing this bit
requires writing a one to bit 7 of TFLG2 register while the TEN bit of TSCR1 or PAEN bit of PACTL is set to one
(See also TCRE control bit explanation) .
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 0
R
Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-22. Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Re gister x High (TCxH)
76 543210
R
Bit 7Bit 6Bit 5Bit 4Bit 3Bit 2Bit 1Bit 0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-23. Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Register x Low (TCxL)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
308 Freescale Semiconductor
8.3.2.15 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator Control Register (PACTL)
Read: Any time
Write: Any time
When PAEN is set, the Pulse Accumulator counter is enabled. The Pulse Accumulator counter shares the
input pin with IOC7.
Module Base + 0x0020
76543210
R0
PAEN PAMOD PEDGE CLK1 CLK0 PAOVI PAI
W
Reset00000000
Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 8-24. 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator Control Register (PACTL)
Table 8-18. PACTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
6
PAEN
Pulse Accumulator System Enable — PAEN is independent from TEN. With timer disabled, the pulse
accumulator can function unless pulse accumulator is disabled.
0 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator system disabled.
1 Pulse Accumulator system enabled.
5
PAMOD
Pulse Accumulator Mode — This bit is active only when the Pulse Accumulator is enabled (PAEN = 1). See
Table 8-19.
0 Event counter mode.
1 Gated time accumulation mode.
4
PEDGE
Pulse Accumulator Edge Control This bit is active only when the Pulse Accumulator is enabled (PAEN = 1).
For PAMOD bit = 0 (event counter mode). See Table 8-19.
0 Falling edges on IOC7 pin cause the count to be increased.
1 Rising edges on IOC7 pin cause the count to be increased.
For PAMOD bit = 1 (gated time accumulation mode).
0 IOC7 input pin high enables M (Bus clock) divided by 64 clock to Pulse Accumulator and the trailing falling
edge on IOC7 sets the PAIF flag.
1 IOC7 input pin low enables M (Bus clock) divided by 64 clock to Pulse Accumulator and the trailing rising edge
on IOC7 sets the PAIF flag.
3:2
CLK[1:0]
Clock Select B its Refer to Table 8-20.
1
PAOVI
Pulse Accumulator Overflow Interrupt Enable
0 Interrupt inhibited.
1 Interrupt requested if PAOVF is set.
0
PAI
Pulse Accumulator Input Interrupt Enable
0 Interrupt inhibited.
1 Interrupt requested if PAIF is set.
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 309
NOTE
If the timer is not active (TEN = 0 in TSCR), there is no divide-by-64
because the 64 clock is generated by the timer prescaler.
For the description of PACLK please refer Figure 8-30.
If the pulse accumulator is disabled (PAEN = 0), the prescaler clock from the timer is always used as an
input clock to the timer counter. The change from one selected clock to the other happens immediately
after these bits are written.
8.3.2.16 Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (PAFLG)
1.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
When the TFFCA bit in the TSCR register is set, any access to the PACNT register will clear all the flags
in the PAFLG register . Timer module or Pulse Accumulator must stay enabled (TEN=1 or PAEN=1) while
clearing these bits.
Table 8-19. Pin Action
PAMOD PEDGE Pin Action
0 0 Falling edge
0 1 Rising edge
1 0 Div. by 64 clock enabled with pin high level
1 1 Div. by 64 clock enabled with pin low level
Table 8-20. Timer Clock Selection
CLK1 CLK0 Timer Clock
0 0 Use timer prescaler clock as timer counter clock
0 1 Use PACLK as input to timer counter clock
1 0 Use PACLK/256 as timer counter clock frequency
1 1 Use PACLK/65536 as timer counter clock frequency
Module Base + 0x0021
76543210
R000000
PAOVF PAIF
W
Reset00000000
Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 8-25. Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (PAFLG)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
310 Freescale Semiconductor
8.3.2.17 Pulse Accumulators Count Registers (PACNT)
1.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
These registers contain the number of active input edges on its input pin since the last reset.
When PACNT overflows from 0xFFFF to 0x0000, the Interrupt flag PAOVF in PAFLG (0x0021) is set.
Full count register access should take place in one clock cycle. A separate read/write for high byte and low
byte will give a different result than accessing them as a word.
NOTE
Reading the pulse accumulator counter registers immediately after an active
edge on the pulse accumulator input pin may miss the last count because the
input has to be synchronized with the Bus clock first.
Table 8 -21. PAFLG Field Descriptions
Field Description
1
PAOVF
Pulse Accumulator Overflow Flag Set when the 16-bit pulse accumulator overflows from 0xFFFF to 0x0000.
Clearing this bit requires writing a one to this bit in the PAFLG register while TEN bit of TSCR1 or PAEN bit of
PACTL register is set to one.
0
PAIF
Pulse Accumulator Input edge FlagSet when the selected edge is detected at the IOC7 input pin.In event
mode the event edge triggers PAIF and in gated time accumulation mode the trailing edge of the gate signal at
the IOC7 input pin triggers PAIF.
Clearing this bit requires writing a one to this bit in the PAFLG register while TEN bit of TSCR1 or PAEN bit of
PACTL register is set to one. Any access to the PACNT register will clear all the flags in this register when TFFCA
bit in register TSCR(0x0006) is set.
Module Base + 0x0022
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 0
R
PACNT15 PACNT14 PACNT13 PACNT12 PACNT11 PACNT10 PACNT9 PACNT8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-26. Pulse Accumulator Count Register High (PACNTH)
Module Base + 0x0023
76543210
R
PACNT7 PACNT6 PACNT5 PACNT4 PACNT3 PACNT2 PACNT1 PACNT0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-27. Pulse Accumulator Count Register Low (PACNTL)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 311
8.3.2.18 Output Compare Pin Disconnect Register(OCPD)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
All bits reset to zero.
8.3.2.19 Precision Timer Prescaler Select Register (PTPSR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
All bits reset to zero.
76543210
R
OCPD7 OCPD6 OCPD5 OCPD4 OCPD3 OCPD2 OCPD1 OCPD0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-28. Output Compare Pin Disconnect Register (OCPD)
Table 8-22. OCPD Fi el d De sc rip tio n
Note: Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Reading from unavailable bits return a zero.
Field Description
7:0
OCPD[7:0]
Output Compare Pin Disconnect Bits
0 Enables the timer channel port. Output Compare action will occur on the channel pin. These bits do not affect
the input capture or pulse accumulator functions.
1 Disables the timer channel port. Output Compare action will not occur on the channel pin, but the output
compare flag still become set.
76543210
R
PTPS7 PTPS6 PTPS5 PTPS4 PTPS3 PTPS2 PTPS1 PTPS0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 8-29. Precision T imer Prescaler Select Register (PTPSR)
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
312 Freescale Semiconductor
...
The Prescaler can be calculated as follows depending on logical value of the PTPS[7:0] and PRNT bit:
PRNT = 1 : Prescaler = PTPS[7:0] + 1
Table 8-24. Precision Timer Prescaler Selection Examples when PRNT = 1
8.4 Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the timer TIM16B8CV3 block. Please refer to
the detailed timer block diagram in Figure 8-30 as necessary.
Table 8-23. PTPSR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:0
PTPS[7:0]
Precision Timer Prescaler Select Bits These eight bits specify the division rate of the main Timer prescaler.
These are effective only when the PRNT bit of TSCR1 is set to 1. Tab le 8- 2 4 shows some selection examples in
this case.
The newly selected prescale factor will not take effect until the next synchronized edge where all prescale counter
stages equal zero.
PTPS7 PTPS6 PTPS5 PTPS4 PTPS3 PTPS2 PTPS1 PTPS0 Prescale
Factor
00000000 1
00000001 2
00000010 3
00000011 4
-------- -
-------- -
-------- -
00010011 20
00010100 21
00010101 22
-------- -
-------- -
-------- -
11111100 253
11111101 254
11111110 255
11111111 256
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 313
Figure 8-30. Detailed Timer Block Diagram
PRESCALER
CHANNEL 0
IOC0 PIN
16-BIT COUNTER
LOGIC
PR[2:1:0]
DIVIDE-BY-64
TC0
EDGE
DETECT
PACNT(hi):PACNT(lo)
PAOVF PEDGE
PAOVI
TEN
PAEN
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCNT(hi):TCNT(lo)
CHANNEL 1
TC1
16-BIT COMPARATOR
16-BIT COUNTER
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
TOF
TOI
C0F
C1F
EDGE
DETECT
IOC1 PIN
LOGIC
EDGE
DETECT
CxF
CHANNEL7
TC7
16-BIT COMPARATOR C7F
IOC7 PIN
LOGIC
EDGE
DETECT
OM:OL0
TOV0
OM:OL1
TOV1
OM:OL7
TOV7
EDG1A EDG1B
EDG7A
EDG7B
EDG0B
TCRE
PAIF
CLEAR COUNTER
PAIF
PAI
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
CxI
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
PAOVF
CH. 7 COMPARE
CH.7 CAPTURE
CH. 1 CAPTURE
MUX
CLK[1:0]
PACLK
PACLK/256
PACLK/65536
IOC1 PIN
IOC0 PIN
IOC7 PIN
PACLK
PACLK/256
PACLK/65536
TE
CH. 1 COMPARE
CH. 0COMPARE
CH. 0 CAPTURE
PA INPUT
CHANNEL2
EDG0A
channel 7 output
compare
IOC0
IOC1
IOC7
tim source
PAOVF
PAOVI
TOF
C0F
C1F
C7F
MUX
PRE-PRESCALER
PTPSR[7:0]
tim source Clock
1
0
PRNT
Maximum possible channels, scalable from 0 to 7.
Pulse Accumulator is available only if channel 7 exists.
MUX
PAMOD
PEDGE
clock
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
314 Freescale Semiconductor
8.4.1 Prescaler
The prescaler divides the Bus clock by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64 or 128. The prescaler select bits, PR[2:0], select
the prescaler divisor. PR[2:0] are in timer system control register 2 (TSCR2).
The prescaler divides the Bus clock by a prescalar value. Prescaler select bits PR[2:0] of in timer system
control register 2 (TSCR2) are set to define a prescalar value that generates a divide by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32,
64 and 128 when the PRNT bit in TSCR1 is disabled.
By enabling the PRNT bit of the TSCR1 register, the performance of the timer can be enhanced. In this
case, it is possible to set additional prescaler settings for the main timer counter in the present timer by
using PTPSR[7:0] bits of PTPSR register generating divide by 1, 2, 3, 4,....20, 21, 22, 23,......255, or 256.
8.4.2 Input Capture
Clearing the I/O (input/output) select bit, IOSx, configures channel x as an input capture channel. The
input capture function captures the time at which an external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on
the pin of an input capture channel, the timer transfers the value in the timer counter into the timer channel
registers, TCx.
The minimum pulse width for the input capture input is greater than two Bus clocks.
An input capture on channel x sets the CxF flag. The CxI bit enables the CxF flag to generate interrupt
requests. Timer module or Pulse Accumulator must stay enabled (TEN bit of TSCR1 or PAEN bit of
PACTL register must be set to one) while clearing CxF (writing one to CxF).
8.4.3 Output Compare
Setting the I/O select bit, IOSx, configures channel x when available as an output compare channel. The
output compare function can generate a periodic pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and
frequency . When the timer counter reaches the value in the channel registers of an output compare channel,
the timer can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin if the corresponding OCPDx bit is set to zero. An output
compare on channel x sets the CxF flag. The CxI bit enables the CxF flag to generate interrupt requests.
Timer module or Pulse Accumulator must stay enabled (TEN bit of TSCR1 or PAEN bit of P ACTL register
must be set to one) while clearing CxF (writing one to CxF).
The output mode and level bits, OMx and OLx, select set, clear, toggle on output compare. Clearing both
OMx and OLx results in no output compare action on the output compare channel pin.
Setting a force output compare bit, FOCx, causes an output compare on channel x. A forced output
compare does not set the channel flag.
A channel 7 event, which can be a counter overflow when TT OV[7] is set or a successful output compare
on channel 7, overrides output compares on all other output compare channels. The output compare 7 mask
register masks the bits in the output compare 7 data register. The timer counter reset enable bit, TCRE,
enables channel 7 output compares to reset the timer counter. A channel 7 output compare can reset the
timer counter even if the IOC7 pin is being used as the pulse accumulator input.
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 315
Writing to the timer port bit of an output compare pin does not affect the pin state. The value written is
stored in an internal latch. W h en the pin becomes available for general-purpose output, the last value
written to the bit appears at the pin.
When TCRE is set and TC7 is not equal to 0, then TCNT will cycle from 0 to TC7. When TCNT reaches
TC7 value, it will last only one Bus cycle then reset to 0.
Note: in Figure 8-31,if PR[2:0] is equal to 0, one prescaler counter equal to one Bus clock
Figure 8-31. The TCNT cycle diagram under TCRE=1 condition
8.4.3.1 OC Channel Initialization
The internal register whose output drives OCx can be programmed before the timer drives OCx. The
desired state can be programmed to this internal register by writing a one to CFORCx bit with TIOSx,
OCPDx and TEN bits set to one.
Set OCx: Write a 1 to FOCx while TEN=1, IOSx=1, OMx=1, OLx=1 and OCPDx=1
Clear OCx: Write a 1 to FOCx while TEN=1, IOSx=1, OMx=1, OLx=0 and OCPDx=1
Setting OCPDx to zero allows the internal register to drive the programmed state to OCx. This allows a
glitch free switch over of port from general purpose I/O to timer output once the OCPDx bit is set to zero.
8.4.4 Pulse Accumulator
The pulse accumulator (PACNT) is a 16-bit counter that can operate in two modes:
Event counter mode — Counting edges of selected polarity on the pulse accumulator input pin, PAI.
Gated time accumulation mode — Counting pulses from a divide-by-64 clock. The PAMOD bit selects the
mode of operation.
The minimum pulse width for the PAI input is greater than two Bus clocks.
TC7 01----- TC7-1 TC7 0
TC7 event TC7 event
prescaler
counter 1 Bus
clock
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
316 Freescale Semiconductor
8.4.5 Event Counter Mode
Clearing the PAMOD bit configures the PACNT for event counter operation. An active edge on the IOC7
pin increments the pulse accumulator counter. The PEDGE bit selects falling edges or rising edges to
increment the count.
NOTE
The PACNT input and timer channel 7 use the same pin IOC7. To use the
IOC7, disconnect it from the output logic by clearing the channel 7 output
mode and output level bits, OM7 and OL7. Also clear the channel 7 output
compare 7 mask bit, OC7M7.
The Pulse Accumulator counter register reflect the number of active input edges on the PACNT input pin
since the last reset.
The PAOVF bit is set when the accumulator rolls over from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. The pulse accumulator
overflow interrupt enable bit, PAOVI, enables the PAOVF flag to generate interrupt requests.
NOTE
The pulse accumulator counter can operate in event counter mode even
when the timer enable bit, TEN, is clear.
8.4.6 Gated Time Accumulation Mode
Setting the PAMOD bit configures the pulse accumulator for gated time accumulation operation. An active
level on the PACNT input pin enables a divided-by-64 clock to drive the pulse accumulator. The PEDGE
bit selects low levels or high levels to enable the divided-by-64 clock.
The trailing edge of the active level at the IOC7 pin sets the PAIF. The PAI bit enables the PAIF flag to
generate interrupt requests.
The pulse accumulator counter register reflect the number of pulses from the divided-by-64 clock since
the last reset.
NOTE
The timer prescaler generates the divided-by-64 clock. If the timer is not
active, there is no divided-by-64 clock.
8.5 Resets
The reset state of each individual bit is listed within Section 8.3, “Memory Map and Register Definition”
which details the registers and their bit fields
8.6 Interrupts
This section describes interrupts originated by the TIM16B8CV3 block. Table 8-25 lists the interrupts
generated by the TIM16B8CV3 to communicate with the MCU.
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 317
The TIM16B8CV3 could use up to 1 1 interrupt vectors. The interrupt vector offsets and interrupt numbers
are chip dependent.
8.6.1 Channel [7:0] Interrupt (C[7:0]F)
This active high outputs will be asserted by the module to request a timer channel 7 – 0 interrupt. The TIM
block only generates the interrupt and does not service it. Only bits related to implemented channels are
valid.
8.6.2 Pulse Accumulator Input Interrupt (PAOVI)
This active high output will be asserted by the module to request a timer pulse accumulator input interrupt.
The TIM block only generates the interrupt and does not service it.
8.6.3 Pulse Accumulator Overflow Interrupt (PAOVF)
This active high output will be asserted by the module to request a timer pulse accumulator overflow
interrupt. The TIM block only generates the interrupt and does not service it.
8.6.4 Timer Overflow Interrupt (TOF)
This active high output will be asserted by the module to request a timer overflow interrupt. The TIM block
only generates the interrupt and does not service it.
Table 8-25. TIM16B8CV3 Interrupts
Interrupt Offset Vector Priority Source Description
C[7:0]F Timer Channel 7–0 Active high timer channel interrupts 7–0
PAOVI Pulse Accumulator
Input
Active high pulse accumulator input interrupt
PAOVF Pulse Accumulator
Overflow
Pulse accumulator overflow interrupt
TOF Timer Overflow Timer Overflow interrupt
Chapter 8 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
318 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 319
Chapter 9
Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
9.1 Introduction
The Version 2 of S12 PWM module is a channel scalable and optimized implementation of S12
PWM8B8C Version 1. The channel is scalable in pairs from PWM0 to PWM7 and the available channel
number is 2, 4, 6 and 8. The shutdown feature has been removed and the flexibility to select one of four
clock sources per channel has improved. If the corresponding channels exist and shutdown feature is not
used, the Version 2 is fully software compatible to Version 1.
9.1.1 Features
The scalable PWM block includes these distinctive features:
Up to eight independent PWM channels, scalable in pairs (PWM0 to PWM7)
Available channel number could be 2, 4, 6, 8 (refer to device specification for exact number)
Programmable period and duty cycle for each channel
Dedicated counter for each PWM channel
Programmable PWM enable/disable for each channel
Software selection of PWM duty pulse polarity for each channel
Period and duty cycle are double buffered. Change takes effect when the end of the effective period
is reached (PWM counter reaches zero) or when the channel is disabled.
Programmable center or left aligned outputs on individual channels
Up to eight 8-bit channel or four 16-bit channel PWM resolution
Four clock sources (A, B, SA, and SB) provide for a wide range of frequencies
Programmable clock select logic
9.1.2 Modes of Operation
There is a software programmable option for low power consumption in wait mode that disables the input
clock to the prescaler.
Table 9-1. Revision Histor y
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Ch anges
v02.00 Feb. 20, 2009 All Initial revision of scalable PWM. Started from pwm_8b8c (v01.08).
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
320 Freescale Semiconductor
In freeze mode there is a software programmable option to disable the input clock to the prescaler. This is
useful for emulation.
Wait: The prescaler keeps on running, unless PSWAI in PWMCTL is set to 1.
Freeze: The prescaler keeps on running, unless PFRZ in PWMCTL is set to 1.
9.1.3 Block Diagram
Figure 9-1 shows the block diagram for the 8-bit up to 8-channel scalable PWM block.
Figure 9-1. Scalable PWM Block Diagram
9.2 External Signal Description
The scalable PWM module has a selected number of external pins. Refer to device specification for exact
number.
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 6
Clock Select PWM Clock
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 5
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 4
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 3
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 2
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 1
Alignment
Polarity
Control
PWM8B8C
PWM6
PWM5
PWM4
PWM3
PWM2
PWM1
Enable
PWM Channels
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 7
Period and Duty Counter
Channel 0
PWM0
PWM7
Bus Clock
Maximum possible c hanne ls, scalable in pairs from PWM0 to PWM7.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 321
9.2.1 PWM7 - PWM0 — PWM Channel 7 - 0
Those pins serve as waveform output of PWM channel 7 - 0.
9.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
9.3.1 Module Memory Map
This section describes the content of the registers in the scalable PWM module. The base address of the
scalable PWM module is determined at the MCU level when the MCU is defined. The register decode map
is fixed and begins at the first address of the module address offset. The figure below shows the registers
associated with the scalable PWM and their relative offset from the base address. The register detail
description follows the order they appear in the register map.
Reserved bits within a register will always read as 0 and the write will be unimplemented. Unimplemented
functions are indicated by shading the bit.
NOTE
Register Address = Base Address + Address Offset, where the Base Address
is defined at the MCU level and the Address Of fset is defined at the module
level.
9.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes in detail all the registers and register bits in the scalable PWM module.
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
PWME(1) RPWME7 PWME6 PWME5 PWME4 PWME3 PWME2 PWME1 PWME0
W
0x0001
PWMPOL1RPPOL7 PPOL6 PPOL5 PPOL4 PPOL3 PPOL2 PPOL1 PPOL0
W
0x0002
PWMCLK1RPCLK7 PCLKL6 PCLK5 PCLK4 PCLK3 PCLK2 PCLK1 PCLK0
W
0x0003
PWMPRCLK
R0 PCKB2 PCKB1 PCKB0 0PCKA2 PCKA1 PCKA0
W
0x0004
PWMCAE1RCAE7 CAE6 CAE5 CAE4 CAE3 CAE2 CAE1 CAE0
W
0x0005
PWMCTL1RCON67 CON45 CON23 CON01 PSWAI PFRZ 00
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-2. The scalable PWM Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 4)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
322 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0006
PWMCLKAB
1
R
PCLKAB7 PCLKAB6 PCLKAB5 PCLKAB4 PCLKAB3 PCLKAB2 PCLKAB1 PCLKAB0
W
0x0007
RESERVED
R00 0 00000
W
0x0008
PWMSCLA
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0009
PWMSCLB
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x000A
RESERVED
R00 0 00000
W
0x000B
RESERVED
R00 0 00000
W
0x000C
PWMCNT0
(2)
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
0x000D
PWMCNT12RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
0x000E
PWMCNT22RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
0x000F
PWMCNT32RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
0x0010
PWMCNT42RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
0x0011
PWMCNT52RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
0x0012
PWMCNT62RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
0x0013
PWMCNT72RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00 0 00000
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-2. The scalable PWM Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 4)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 323
0x0014
PWMPER02RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0015
PWMPER12RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0016
PWMPER22RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0017
PWMPER32RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0018
PWMPER42RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0019
PWMPER52RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x001A
PWMPER62RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x001B
PWMPER72RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x001C
PWMDTY02RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x001D
PWMDTY12RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x001E
PWMDTY22RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x001F
PWMDTY32RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0010
PWMDTY42RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0021
PWMDTY52RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0022
PWMDTY62RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-2. The scalable PWM Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 4)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
324 Freescale Semiconductor
9.3.2.1 PWM Enable Register (PWME)
Each PWM channel has an enable bit (PWMEx) to start its waveform output. When any of the PWMEx
bits are set (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM output is enabled imme diately. However , the actual PWM
waveform is not available on the associated PWM output until its clock source begins its next cycle due
to the synchronization of PWMEx and the clock source.
NOTE
The first PWM cycle after enabling the channel can be irregular.
An exception to this is when channels are concatenated. Once concatenated mode is enabled (CONxx bits
set in PWMCTL register), enabling/disabling the corresponding 16-bit PWM channel is controlled by the
low order PWMEx bit. In this case, the high order bytes PWMEx bits have no effect and their
corresponding PWM output lines are disabled.
While in run mode, if all existing PWM channels are disabled (PWMEx–0 = 0), the prescaler counter shuts
off for power savings.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
0x0023
PWMDTY72RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0024
RESERVED
R00 0 00000
W
0x0025
RESERVED
R00 0 00000
W
0x0026
RESERVED
R00 0 00000
W
0x0027
RESERVED
R00 0 00000
W
1. The related bit is available only if corresponding channel exists.
2. The register is available only if corresponding channel exists.
Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
RPWME7 PWME6 PWME5 PWME4 PWME3 PWME2 PWME1 PWME0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 9-3. PWM Enable Register (PWME)
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-2. The scalable PWM Register Summary (Sheet 4 of 4)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 325
9.3.2.2 PWM Polarity Register (PWMPOL)
The starting polarity of each PWM channel waveform is determined by the associated PPOLx bit in the
PWMPOL register. If the polarity bit is one, the PWM channel output is high at the beginning of the cycle
and then goes low when the duty count is reached. Conversely, if the polarity bit is zero, the output starts
low and then goes high when the duty count is reached.
Table 9-2. PWME Field Descriptions
Note: Bits related to available channels have functional significance. Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Read from
unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7
PWME7
Pulse Width Channel 7 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 7 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 7 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM output bit 7 when
its clock source begins its next cycle.
6
PWME6
Pulse Width Channel 6 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 6 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 6 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM output bit 6 when
its clock source begins its next cycle. If CON67=1, then bit has no effect and PWM output line 6 is disabled.
5
PWME5
Pulse Width Channel 5 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 5 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 5 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM output bit 5 when
its clock source begins its next cycle.
4
PWME4
Pulse Width Channel 4 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 4 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 4 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 4 when
its clock source begins its next cycle. If CON45 = 1, then bit has no effect and PWM output line 4 is disabled.
3
PWME3
Pulse Width Channel 3 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 3 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 3 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 3 when
its clock source begins its next cycle.
2
PWME2
Pulse Width Channel 2 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 2 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 2 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 2 when
its clock source begins its next cycle. If CON23 = 1, then bit has no effect and PWM output line 2 is disabled.
1
PWME1
Pulse Width Channel 1 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 1 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 1 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 1 when
its clock source begins its next cycle.
0
PWME0
Pulse Width Channel 0 Enable
0 Pulse width channel 0 is disabled.
1 Pulse width channel 0 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 0 when
its clock source begins its next cycle. If CON01 = 1, then bit has no effect and PWM output line 0 is disabled.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
326 Freescale Semiconductor
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
PPOLx register bits can be written anytime. If the polarity is changed while
a PWM signal is being generated, a truncated or stretched pulse can occur
during the transition
9.3.2.3 PWM Clock Select Register (PWMCLK)
Each PWM channel has a choice of four clocks to use as the clock source for that channel as described
below.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
Register bits PCLK0 to PCLK7 can be written anytime. If a clock select is
changed while a PWM signal is being generated, a truncated or stretched
pulse can occur during the transition.
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
RPPOL7 PPOL6 PPOL5 PPOL4 PPOL3 PPOL2 PPOL1 PPOL0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 9-4. PWM Polarity Register (PWMPOL)
Table 9-3. PWMPOL Field Descriptions
Note: Bits related to available channels have functional significance. Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Read from
unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7–0
PPOL[7:0]
Pulse Width Channel 7–0 Polarity Bits
0 PWM channel 7–0 outputs are low at the beginning of the period, then go high when the duty count is reached.
1 PWM channel 7–0 outputs are high at the beginning of the period, then go low when the duty count is reached.
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
RPCLK7 PCLKL6 PCLK5 PCLK4 PCLK3 PCLK2 PCLK1 PCLK0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 9-5. PWM Clock Select Register (PWMCLK)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 327
The clock source of each PWM channel is determined by PCLKx bits in PWMCLK and PCLKABx bits
in PWMCLKAB (see Section 9.3.2.7, “PWM Clock A/B Select Register (PWMCLKAB)). For Channel
0, 1, 4, 5, the selection is shown in Table 9-5; For Channel 2, 3, 6, 7, the selection is shown in Table 9-6.
Table 9-5. PWM Channel 0, 1, 4, 5 Clock Source Selection
Table 9-6. PWM Channel 2, 3, 6, 7 Clock Source Selection
9.3.2.4 PWM Prescale Clock Select Register (PWMPRCLK)
This register selects the prescale clock source for clocks A and B independently.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
PCKB2–0 and PCKA2–0 register bits can be written anytime. If the clock
pre-scale is changed while a PWM signal is being generated, a truncated or
stretched pulse can occur during the transition.
Table 9-4. PWMCLK Field Descriptions
Note: Bits related to available channels have functional significance. Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Read from
unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7-0
PCLK[7:0]
Pulse Width Channel 7-0 Clock Select
0 Clock A or B is the clock source for PWM channel 7-0, as shown in Tab le 9-5 and Table 9- 6.
1 Clock SA or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 7-0, as shown in Table 9-5 and Tab le 9- 6.
PCLKAB[0,1,4,5] PCLK[0,1,4,5] Clock Source Selection
0 0 Clock A
0 1 Clock SA
1 0 Clock B
1 1 Clock SB
PCLKAB[2,3,6,7] PCLK[2,3,6,7] Clock Source Selection
0 0 Clock B
0 1 Clock SB
1 0 Clock A
1 1 Clock SA
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R0 PCKB2 PCKB1 PCKB0 0PCKA2 PCKA1 PCKA0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-6. PWM Prescale Clock Select Register (PWMPRCLK)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
328 Freescale Semiconductor
s
9.3.2.5 PWM Center Align Enable Register (PWMCAE)
The PWMCAE register contains eight control bits for the selection of center aligned outputs or left aligned
outputs for each PWM channel. If the CAEx bit is set to a one, the corresponding PWM output will be
center aligned. If the CAEx bit is cleared, the corresponding PWM output will be left aligned. See
Section 9.4.2.5, “Left Aligned Outputs” and Section 9.4.2.6, “Center Aligned Outputs” for a more detailed
description of the PWM output modes.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
Write these bits only when the corresponding channel is disabled.
Ta ble 9-7. PW MPRCLK Field Descriptions
Field Description
6–4
PCKB[2:0]
Prescaler Select for Clock B Clock B is one of two clock sources which can be used for all channels. These
three bits determine the rate of clock B, as shown in Table 9-8.
2–0
PCKA[2:0]
Prescaler Select for Clock A Clock A is one of two clock sources which can be used for all channels. These
three bits determine the rate of clock A, as shown in Table 9-8.
Table 9-8. Clock A or Clock B Prescaler Selects
PCKA/B2 PCKA/B1 PCKA/B0 Value of Clock A/B
0 0 0 Bus clock
0 0 1 Bus clock / 2
0 1 0 Bus clock / 4
0 1 1 Bus clock / 8
1 0 0 Bus clock / 16
1 0 1 Bus clock / 32
1 1 0 Bus clock / 64
1 1 1 Bus clock / 128
Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
RCAE7 CAE6 CAE5 CAE4 CAE3 CAE2 CAE1 CAE0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 9-7. PWM Center Align Enable Register (PWMCAE)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 329
9.3.2.6 PWM Control Register (PWMCTL)
The PWMCTL register provides for various control of the PWM module.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
There are up to four control bits for concatenation, each of which is used to concatenate a pair of PWM
channels into one 16-bit channel. If the corresponding channels do not exist on a particular derivative, then
writes to these bits have no effect and reads will return zeroes. When channels 6 and 7are concatenated,
channel 6 registers become the high order bytes of the double byte channel. When channels 4 and 5 are
concatenated, channel 4 registers become the high order bytes of the double byte channel. When channels
2 and 3 are concatenated, channel 2 registers become the high order bytes of the double byte channel.
When channels 0 and 1 are concatenated, channel 0 registers become the high order bytes of the double
byte channel.
See Section 9.4.2.7, “PWM 16-Bit Functions” for a more detailed description of the concatenation PWM
Function.
NOTE
Change these bits only when both corresponding channels are disabled.
Table 9 -9. PWMCAE Field Descriptions
Note: Bits related to available channels have functional significance. Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Read from
unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7–0
CAE[7:0]
Center Aligned Output Modes on Channels 7–0
0 Channels 7–0 operate in left aligned output mode.
1 Channels 7–0 operate in center aligned output mode.
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
RCON67 CON45 CON23 CON01 PSWAI PFRZ 00
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-8. PWM Control Register (PWMCTL)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
330 Freescale Semiconductor
9.3.2.7 PWM Clock A/B Select Register (PWMCLKAB)
Each PWM channel has a choice of four clocks to use as the clock source for that channel as described
below.
Table 9-10. PWMCTL Field Descriptions
Note: Bits related to available channels have functional significance. Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Read from
unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7
CON67
Concatenate Channels 6 an d 7
0 Channels 6 and 7 are separate 8-bit PWMs.
1 Channels 6 and 7 are concatenated to create one 16-bit PWM channel. Channel 6 becomes the high order
byte and channel 7 becomes the low order byte. Channel 7 output pin is used as the output for this 16-bit
PWM (bit 7 of port PWMP). Channel 7 clock select control-bit determines the clock source, channel 7 polarity
bit determines the polarity, channel 7 enable bit enables the output and channel 7 center aligned enable bit
determines the output mode.
6
CON45
Concatenate Channels 4 an d 5
0 Channels 4 and 5 are separate 8-bit PWMs.
1 Channels 4 and 5 are concatenated to create one 16-bit PWM channel. Channel 4 becomes the high order
byte and channel 5 becomes the low order byte. Channel 5 output pin is used as the output for this 16-bit
PWM (bit 5 of port PWMP). Channel 5 clock select control-bit determines the clock source, channel 5 polarity
bit determines the polarity, channel 5 enable bit enables the output and channel 5 center aligned enable bit
determines the output mode.
5
CON23
Concatenate Channels 2 an d 3
0 Channels 2 and 3 are separate 8-bit PWMs.
1 Channels 2 and 3 are concatenated to create one 16-bit PWM channel. Channel 2 becomes the high order
byte and channel 3 becomes the low order byte. Channel 3 output pin is used as the output for this 16-bit
PWM (bit 3 of port PWMP). Channel 3 clock select control-bit determines the clock source, channel 3 polarity
bit determines the polarity, channel 3 enable bit enables the output and channel 3 center aligned enable bit
determines the output mode.
4
CON01
Concatenate Channels 0 an d 1
0 Channels 0 and 1 are separate 8-bit PWMs.
1 Channels 0 and 1 are concatenated to create one 16-bit PWM channel. Channel 0 becomes the high order
byte and channel 1 becomes the low order byte. Channel 1 output pin is used as the output for this 16-bit
PWM (bit 1 of port PWMP). Channel 1 clock select control-bit determines the clock source, channel 1 polarity
bit determines the polarity, channel 1 enable bit enables the output and channel 1 center aligned enable bit
determines the output mode.
3
PSWAI
PWM Stops in Wait Mode — Enabling this bit allows for lower power consumption in wait mode by disabling
the input clock to the prescaler.
0 Allow the clock to the prescaler to continue while in wait mode.
1 Stop the input clock to the prescaler whenever the MCU is in wait mode.
2
PFRZ
PWM Counters Stop in Freeze Mode — In freeze mode, there is an option to disable the input clock to the
prescaler by setting the PFRZ bit in the PWMCTL register. If this bit is set, whenever the MCU is in freeze mode,
the input clock to the prescaler is disabled. This feature is useful during emulation as it allows the PWM function
to be suspended. In this way, the counters of the PWM can be stopped while in freeze mode so that once normal
program flow is continued, the counters are re-enabled to simulate real-time operations. Since the registers can
still be accessed in this mode, to re-enable the prescaler clock, either disable the PFRZ bit or exit freeze mode.
0 Allow PWM to continue while in freeze mode.
1 Disable PWM input clock to the prescaler whenever the part is in freeze mode. This is useful for emulation.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 331
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
Register bits PCLKAB0 to PCLKAB7 can be written anytime. If a clock
select is changed while a PWM signal is being generated, a truncated or
stretched pulse can occur during the transition.
Module Base + 0x00006
76543210
RPCLKAB7 PCLKAB6 PCLKAB5 PCLKAB4 PCLKAB3 PCLKAB2 PCLKAB1 PCLKAB0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 9-9. PWM Clock Select Register (PWMCLK)
Table 9 -11. PWMCLK Field Descriptions
Note: Bits related to available channels have functional significance. Writing to unavailable bits has no effect. Read from
unavailable bits return a zero
Field Description
7
PCLKAB7
Pulse Width Channel 7 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 7, as shown in Table 9-6.
1 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 7, as shown in Table 9-6.
6
PCLKAB6
Pulse Width Channel 6 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 6, as shown in Table 9-6.
1 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 6, as shown in Table 9-6.
5
PCLKAB5
Pulse Width Channel 5 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 5, as shown in Table 9-5.
1 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 5, as shown in Table 9-5.
4
PCLKAB4
Pulse Width Channel 4 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 4, as shown in Table 9-5.
1 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 4, as shown in Table 9-5.
3
PCLKAB3
Pulse Width Channel 3 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 3, as shown in Table 9-6.
1 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 3, as shown in Table 9-6.
2
PCLKAB2
Pulse Width Channel 2 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 2, as shown in Table 9-6.
1 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 2, as shown in Table 9-6.
1
PCLKAB1
Pulse Width Channel 1 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 1, as shown in Table 9-5.
1 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 1, as shown in Table 9-5.
0
PCLKAB0
Pulse Width Channel 0 Clock A/B Select
0 Clock A or SA is the clock source for PWM channel 0, as shown in Table 9-5.
1 Clock B or SB is the clock source for PWM channel 0, as shown in Table 9-5.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
332 Freescale Semiconductor
The clock source of each PWM channel is determined by PCLKx bits in PWMCLK (see Section 9.3.2.3,
“PWM Clock Select Register (PWMCLK)) and PCLKABx bits in PWMCLKAB as shown in Table 9-5
and Table 9-6.
9.3.2.8 PWM Scale A Register (PWMSCLA)
PWMSCLA is the programmable scale value used in scaling clock A to generate clock SA. Clock SA is
generated by taking clock A, dividing it by the value in the PWMSCLA register and dividing that by two.
Clock SA = Clock A / (2 * PWMSCLA)
NOTE
When PWMSCLA = $00, PWMSCLA value is considered a full scale value
of 256. Clock A is thus divided by 512.
Any value written to this register will cause the scale counter to load the new scale value (PWMSCLA).
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime (causes the scale counter to load the PWMSCLA value)
9.3.2.9 PWM Scale B Register (PWMSCLB)
PWMSCLB is the programmable scale value used in scaling clock B to generate clock SB. Clock SB is
generated by taking clock B, dividing it by the value in the PWMSCLB register and dividing that by two.
Clock SB = Clock B / (2 * PWMSCLB)
NOTE
When PWMSCLB = $00, PWMSCLB value is considered a full scale value
of 256. Clock B is thus divided by 512.
Any value written to this register will cause the scale counter to load the new scale value (PWMSCLB).
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime (causes the scale counter to load the PWMSCLB value).
Module Base + 0x0008
76543210
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 9-10. PWM Scale A Register (PWMSCLA)
Module Base + 0x0009
76543210
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 9-11. PWM Scale B Register (PWMSCLB)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 333
9.3.2.10 PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNTx)
Each channel has a dedicated 8-bit up/down counter which runs at the rate of the selected clock source.
The counter can be read at any time without affecting the count or the operation of the PWM channel. In
left aligned output mode, the counter counts from 0 to the value in the period register - 1. In center aligned
output mode, the counter counts from 0 up to the value in the period register and then back down to 0.
Any value written to the counter causes the counter to reset to $00, the counter direction to be set to up,
the immediate load of both duty and period registers with values from the buffers, and the output to change
according to the polarity bit. The counter is also cleared at the end of the effective period (see
Section 9.4.2.5, “Left Aligned Outputs” and Section 9.4.2.6, “Center Aligned Outputs” for more details ).
When the channel is disabled (PWMEx = 0), the PWMCNTx register does not count. When a channel
becomes enabled (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM counter starts at the count in the PWMCNTx
register. For more detailed information on the operation of the counters, see Section 9.4.2.4, “PWM T imer
Counters”.
In concatenated mode, writes to the 16-bit counter by using a 16-bit access or writes to either the low or
high order byte of the counter will reset the 16-bit counter. Reads of the 16-bit counter must be made by
16-bit access to maintain data coherency.
NOTE
Writing to the counter while the channel is enabled can cause an irregular
PWM cycle to occur.
1This register is available only when the corresponding channel exists and is reserved if that channel does not exist. Writes to
a reserved register have no functional effect. Reads from a reserved register return zeroes.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime (any value written causes PWM counter to be reset to $00).
9.3.2.11 PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPERx)
There is a dedicated period register for each channel. The value in this register determines the period of
the associated PWM channel.
The period registers for each channel are double buffered so that if they change while the channel is
enabled, the change will NOT take effect until one of the following occurs:
The effective period ends
Module Base + 0x000C = PWMCNT0, 0x000D = PWMCNT1, 0x000E = PWMCNT2, 0x000F = PWMCNT3
Module Base + 0x0010 = PWMCNT4, 0x0011 = PWMCNT5, 0x0012 = PWMCNT6, 0x0013 = PWMCNT7
76543210
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
Reset00000000
Figure 9-12. PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNTx)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
334 Freescale Semiconductor
The counter is written (counter resets to $00)
The channel is disabled
In this way , the output of the PWM will always be either the old waveform or the new waveform, not some
variation in betwee n. If the channel is not enable d, then writes to the period register will go directly to the
latches as well as the buffer.
NOTE
Reads of this register return the most recent value written. Reads do not
necessarily return the value of the currently active period due to the double
buffering scheme.
See Section 9.4.2.3, “PWM Period and Duty” for more information.
To calculate the output period, take the selected clock source period for the channel of interest (A, B, SA,
or SB) and multiply it by the value in the period register for that channel:
Left aligned output (CAEx = 0)
PWMx Period = Channel Clock Period * PWMPERx
Center Aligned Output (CAEx = 1)
PWMx Period = Channel Clock Period * (2 * PWMPERx)
For boundary case programming values, please refer to Section 9.4.2.8, “PWM Boundary Cases”.
1This register is available only when the corresponding channel exists and is reserved if that channel does not exist. Writes to
a reserved register have no functional effect. Reads from a reserved register return zeroes.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
9.3.2.12 PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTYx)
There is a dedicated duty register for each channel. The value in this register determines the duty of the
associated PWM channel. The duty value is compared to the counter and if it is equal to the counter value
a match occurs and the output changes state.
The duty registers for each channel are double buffered so that if they change while the channel is enabled,
the change will NOT take effect until one of the following occurs:
The effective period ends
The counter is written (counter resets to $00)
Module Base + 0x0014 = PWMPER0, 0x0015 = PWMPER1, 0x0016 = PWMPER2, 0x0017 = PWMPER3
Module Base + 0x0018 = PWMPER4, 0x0019 = PWMPER5, 0x001A = PWMPER6, 0x001B = PWMPER7
76543210
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
Reset11111111
Figure 9-13. PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPERx)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 335
The channel is disabled
In this way , the output of the PWM will always be either the old duty waveform or the new duty waveform,
not some variation in between. If the channel is not enabled, then writes to the duty register will go directly
to the latches as well as the buffer.
NOTE
Reads of this register return the most recent value written. Reads do not
necessarily return the value of the currently active duty due to the double
buffering scheme.
See Section 9.4.2.3, “PWM Period and Duty” for more information.
NOTE
Depending on the polarity bit, the duty registers will contain the count of
either the high time or the low time. If the polarity bit is one, the output starts
high and then goes low when the duty count is reached, so the duty registers
contain a count of the high time. If the polarity bit is zero, the output starts
low and then goes high when the duty count is reached, so the duty registers
contain a count of the low time.
To calculate the output duty cycle (high time as a% of period) for a particular channel:
Polarity = 0 (PPOL x =0)
Duty Cycle = [(PWMPERx-PWMDTYx)/PWMPERx] * 100%
Polarity = 1 (PPOLx = 1)
Duty Cycle = [PWMDTYx / PWMPERx] * 100%
For boundary case programming values, please refer to Section 9.4.2.8, “PWM Boundary Cases”.
1This register is available only when the corresponding channel exists and is reserved if that channel does not exist. Writes to
a reserved register have no functional effect. Reads from a reserved register return zeroes.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x001C = PWMDTY0, 0x001D = PWMDTY1, 0x001E = PWMDTY2, 0x001F = PWMDTY3
Module Base + 0x0020 = PWMDTY4, 0x0021 = PWMDTY5, 0x0022 = PWMDTY6, 0x0023 = PWMDTY7
76543210
RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
Reset11111111
Figure 9-14. PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTYx)
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
336 Freescale Semiconductor
9.4 Functional Description
9.4.1 PWM Clock Select
There are four available clocks: clock A, clock B, clock SA (scaled A), and clock SB (scaled B). These
four clocks are based on the bus clock.
Clock A and B can be software selected to be 1, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8,..., 1/64, 1/128 times the bus clock. Clock SA
uses clock A as an input and divides it further with a reloadable counter. Similarly, clock SB uses clock B
as an input and divides it further with a reloadable counter. The rates available for clock SA are software
selectable to be clock A divided by 2, 4, 6, 8,..., or 512 in increments of divide by 2. Similar rates are
available for clock SB. Each PWM channel has the capability of selecting one of four clocks, clock A,
Clock B, clock SA or clock SB.
The block diagram in Figure 9-15 shows the four different clocks and how the scaled clocks are created.
9.4.1.1 Prescale
The input clock to the PWM prescaler is the bus clock. It can be disabled whenever the part is in freeze
mode by setting the PFRZ bit in the PWMCTL register. If this bit is set, whenever the MCU is in freeze
mode (freeze mode signal active) the input clock to the prescaler is disabled. This is useful for emulation
in order to freeze the PWM. The input clock can also be disabled when all available PWM channels are
disabled (PWMEx-0 = 0). This is useful for reducing power by disabling the prescale counter.
Clock A and clock B are scaled values of the input clock. The value is software selectable for both clock
A and clock B and has options of 1, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, or 1/128 times the bus clock. The value
selected for clock A is dete rmined by the PCKA2, PCKA1, PCKA0 bits in the PWMPRCLK register . The
value selected for clock B is determined by the PCKB2, PCKB1, PCKB0 bits also in the PWMPRCLK
register.
9.4.1.2 Clock Scale
The scaled A clock uses clock A as an input and divides it further with a user programmable value and
then divides this by 2. The scaled B clock uses clock B as an input and divides it further with a user
programmable value and then divides this by 2. The rates available for clock SA are software selectable
to be clock A divided by 2, 4, 6, 8,..., or 512 in increments of divide by 2. Similar rates are available for
clock SB.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 337
Figure 9-15. PWM Clock Select Block Diagram
128248163264
PCKB2
PCKB1
PCKB0
M
U
X
Clock A
Clock B
Clock SA
Clock A/2, A/4, A/6,....A/512
Prescale Scale
Divide by
PFRZ
Freeze Mode Signal
Bus Clock
Clock Select
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 0
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 2
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 1
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 4
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 5
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 6
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 7
M
U
X
Clock to
PWM Ch 3
Load
DIV 2PWMSCLB Clock SB
Clock B/2, B/4, B/6,....B/512
M
U
X
PCKA2
PCKA1
PCKA0
PWME7-0
Count = 1
Load
DIV 2PWMSCLA
Count = 1
8-Bit Down
Counter
8-Bit Down
Counter
Prescaler Taps:
Maximum possible channels, scalable in pairs from PWM0 to PWM7.
PCLK0 PCLKAB0
PCLK1 PCLKAB1
PCLK7 PCLKAB7
PCLK6 PCLKAB6
PCLK5 PCLKAB5
PCLK4 PCLKAB4
PCLK3 PCLKAB3
PCLK2 PCLKAB2
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
338 Freescale Semiconductor
Clock A is used as an input to an 8-bit down counter. This down counter loads a user programmable scale
value from the scale register (PWMSCLA). When the down counter reaches one, a pulse is output and the
8-bit counter is re-loaded. The output signal from this circuit is further divided by two. This gives a greater
range with only a slight reduction in granularity. Clock SA equals clock A divided by two times the value
in the PWMSCLA register.
NOTE
Clock SA = Clock A / (2 * PWMSCLA)
When PWMSCLA = $00, PWMSCLA value is considered a full scale value
of 256. Clock A is thus divided by 512.
Similarly , clock B is used as an input to an 8-bit down counter followed by a divide by two producing clock
SB. Thus, clock SB equals clock B divided by two times the value in the PWMSCLB register.
NOTE
Clock SB = Clock B / (2 * PWMSCLB)
When PWMSCLB = $00, PWMSCLB value is considered a full scale value
of 256. Clock B is thus divided by 512.
As an example, consider the case in which the user writes $FF into the PWMSCLA register. Clock A for
this case will be E (bus clock) divided by 4. A pulse will occur at a rate of once every 255x4 E cycles.
Passing this through the divide by two circuit produces a clock signal at an E divided by 2040 rate.
Similarly, a value of $01 in the PWMSCLA register when clock A is E divided by 4 will produce a clock
at an E divided by 8 rate.
Writing to PWMSCLA or PWMSCLB causes the associated 8-bit down counter to be re-loaded.
Otherwise, when changing rates the counter would have to count down to $01 before counting at the proper
rate. Forcing the associated counter to re-load the scale register value every time PWMSCLA or
PWMSCLB is written prevents this.
NOTE
Writing to the scale registers while channels are operating can cause
irregularities in the PWM outputs.
9.4.1.3 Clock Select
Each PWM channel has the capability of selecting one of four clocks, clock A, clock SA, clock B or clock
SB. The clock selection is done with the PCLKx control bits in the PWMCLK register and PCLKABx
control bits in PWMCLKAB register. For backward compatibility consideration, the reset value of
PWMCLK and PWMCLKAB configures following default clock selection.
For channels 0, 1, 4, and 5 the clock choices are clock A.
For channels 2, 3, 6, and 7 the clock choices are clock B.
NOTE
Changing clock control bits while channels are operating can cause
irregularities in the PWM outputs.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 339
9.4.2 PWM Channel Timers
The main part of the PWM module are the actual timers. Each of the timer channels has a counter , a period
register and a duty register (each are 8-bit). The wavefo rm output period is controlled by a match between
the period register and the value in the counter. The duty is controlled by a match between the duty register
and the counter value and causes the state of the output to change during the period. The starting polarity
of the output is also selectable on a per channel basis. Shown below in Figure 9-16 is the block diagram
for the PWM timer.
Figure 9-16. PWM Timer Channel Block Diagram
9.4.2.1 PWM Enable
Each PWM channel has an enable bit (PWMEx) to start its waveform output. When any of the PWMEx
bits are set (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM output signal is enabled immediately. However , the actual
PWM waveform is not available on the associated PWM output until its clock source begins its next cycle
due to the synchronization of PWMEx and the clock source. An exception to this is when channels are
concatenated. Refer to Section 9.4.2.7, “PWM 16-Bit Functions” for more detail.
NOTE
The first PWM cycle after enabling the channel can be irregular.
Clock Source
T
R
Q
Q
PPOLx
From Port PWMP
Data Register
PWMEx
To P i n
Driver
Gate
8-bit Compare =
PWMDTYx
8-bit Compare =
PWMPERx
CAEx
T
R
Q
Q
8-Bit Counter
PWMCNTx
M
U
X
M
U
X
(Clock Edge
Sync)
Up/Down Reset
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
340 Freescale Semiconductor
On the front end of the PWM timer , the clock is enabled to the PWM circuit by the PWMEx bit being high.
There is an edge-synchronizing circuit to guarantee that the clock will only be enabled or disabled at an
edge. When the channel is disabled (PWMEx = 0), the counter for the channel does not count.
9.4.2.2 PWM Polarity
Each channel has a polarity bit to allow starting a waveform cycle with a high or low signal. This is shown
on the block diagram Figure 9-16 as a mux select of either the Q output or the Q output of the PWM output
flip flop. When one of the bits in the PWMPOL register is set, the associated PWM channel output is high
at the beginning of the waveform, then goes low when the duty count is reached. Conversely , if the polarity
bit is zero, the output starts low and then goes high when the duty count is reached.
9.4.2.3 PWM Period and Duty
Dedicated period and duty registers exist for each channel and are double buffered so that if they change
while the channel is enabled, the change will NOT take effect until one of the following occurs:
The effective period ends
The counter is written (counter resets to $00)
The channel is disabled
In this way , the output of the PWM will always be either the old waveform or the new waveform, not some
variation in between. If the channel is not enabled, then writes to the period and duty registers will go
directly to the latches as well as the buffer.
A change in duty or period can be forced into effect “immediately” by writing the new value to the duty
and/or period registers and then writing to the counter. This forces the counter to reset and the new duty
and/or period values to be latched. In addition, since the counter is readable, it is possible to know where
the count is with respect to the duty value and software can be used to make adjustments
NOTE
When forcing a new period or duty into effect immediately, an irregular
PWM cycle can occur.
Depending on the polarity bit, the duty registers will contain the count of
either the high time or the low time.
9.4.2.4 PWM Timer Counters
Each channel has a dedicated 8-bit up/down counter which runs at the rate of the selected clock source (see
Section 9.4.1, “PWM Clock Select” for the available clock sources and rates). The counter compares to
two registers, a duty register and a period register as shown in Figure 9-16. When the PWM counter
matches the duty register, the output flip-flop changes state, causing the PWM waveform to also change
state. A match between the PWM counter and the period register behaves differently depending on what
output mode is selected as shown in Figure 9-16 and described in Section 9.4.2.5, “Left Aligned Outputs”
and Section 9.4.2.6, “Center Aligned Outputs”.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 341
Each channel counter can be read at anytime without affecting the count or the operation of the PWM
channel.
Any value written to the counter causes the counter to reset to $00, the counter direction to be set to up,
the immediate load of both duty and period registers with values from the buffers, and the output to change
according to the polarity bit. When the channel is disabled (PWMEx = 0), the counter stops. When a
channel becomes enabled (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM counter continues from the count in the
PWMCNTx register. This allows the waveform to continue where it left off when the channel is re-
enabled. When the channel is disabled, writing “0” to the period register will cause the counter to reset on
the next selected clock.
NOTE
If the user wants to start a new “clean” PWM waveform without any
“history” from the old waveform, the user must write to channel counter
(PWMCNTx) prior to enabling the PWM channel (PWMEx = 1).
Generally, writes to the counter are done prior to enabling a channel in order to start from a known state.
However, writing a counter can also be done while the PWM channel is enabled (counting). The effect is
similar to writing the counter when the channel is disabled, except that the new period is started
immediately with the output set according to the polarity bit.
NOTE
Writing to the counter while the channel is enabled can cause an irregular
PWM cycle to occur.
The counter is cleared at the end of the effective period (see Section 9.4.2.5, “Left Aligned Outputs” and
Section 9.4.2.6, “Center Aligned Outputs” for more details).
9.4.2.5 Left Aligned Outputs
The PWM timer provides the choice of two types of outputs, left aligned or center aligned. They are
selected with the CAEx bits in the PWMCAE register. If the CAEx bit is cleared (CAEx = 0), the
corresponding PWM output will be left aligned.
In left aligned output mode, the 8-bit counter is configured as an up counter only. It compares to two
registers, a duty register and a period register as shown in the block diagram in Figure 9-16. When the
PWM counter matches the duty register the output flip-flop changes state causing the PWM waveform to
also change state. A match between the PWM counter and the period register resets the counter and the
output flip-flop, as shown in Figure 9-16, as well as performing a load from the double buffer period and
duty register to the associated registers, as described in Section 9.4.2.3, “PWM Period and Duty”. The
counter counts from 0 to the value in the period register – 1.
Table 9-12. PWM Timer Counter Conditions
Counter Clears ($00) Counter Counts Counter Stops
When PWMCNTx register written to
any value
When PWM channel is enabled
(PWMEx = 1). Counts from last value in
PWMCNTx.
When PWM channel is disabled
(PWMEx = 0)
Effective period ends
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
342 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
Changing the PWM output mode from left aligned to center aligned output
(or vice versa) while channels are operating can cause irregularities in the
PWM output. It is recommended to program the output mode before
enabling the PWM channel.
Figure 9-17. PWM Left Aligned Output Waveform
To calculate the output frequency in left aligned output mode for a particular channel, take the selected
clock source frequency for the channel (A, B, SA, or SB) and divide it by the value in the period register
for that channel.
PWMx Frequency = Clock (A, B, SA, or SB) / PWMPERx
PWMx Duty Cycle (high time as a% of period):
Polarity = 0 (PPOLx = 0)
Duty Cycle = [(PWMPERx-PWMDTYx)/PWMPERx] * 100%
Polarity = 1 (PPOLx = 1)
Duty Cycle = [PWMDTYx / PWMPERx] * 100%
As an example of a left aligned output, consider the following case:
Clock Source = E, where E = 10 MHz (100 ns period)
PPOLx = 0
PWMPERx = 4
PWMDTYx = 1
PWMx Frequency = 10 MHz/4 = 2.5 MHz
PWMx Period = 400 ns
PWMx Duty Cycle = 3/4 *100% = 75%
The output waveform generated is shown in Figure 9-18.
PWMDTYx
Period = PWMPERx
PPOLx = 0
PPOLx = 1
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 343
Figure 9-18. PWM Left Aligned Output Example Waveform
9.4.2.6 Center Aligned Outputs
For center aligned output mode selection, set the CAEx bit (CAEx = 1) in the PWMCAE register and the
corresponding PWM output will be center aligned.
The 8-bit counter operates as an up/down counter in this mode and is set to up whenever the counter is
equal to $00. The counter compares to two registers, a duty register and a period register as shown in the
block diagram in Figure 9-16. When the PWM counter matches the duty register, the output flip-flop
changes state, causing the PWM waveform to also change state. A match between the PWM counter and
the period register changes the counter direction from an up-count to a down-count. When the PWM
counter decrements and matches the duty register again, the output flip-flop changes state causing the
PWM output to also change state. When the PWM counter decrements and reaches zero, the counter
direction changes from a down-count back to an up-count and a load from the double buffer period and
duty registers to the associated registers is performed, as described in Section 9.4.2.3, “PWM Period and
Duty”. The counter counts from 0 up to the value in the period register and then back down to 0. Thus the
effective period is PWMPERx*2.
NOTE
Changing the PWM output mode from left aligned to center aligned output
(or vice versa) while channels are operating can cause irregularities in the
PWM output. It is recommended to program the output mode before
enabling the PWM channel.
Figure 9-19. PWM Center Aligned Output Waveform
Period = 400 ns
E = 100 ns
Duty Cycle = 75%
PPOLx = 0
PPOLx = 1
PWMDTYx PWMDTYx
Period = PWMPERx*2
PWMPERx
PWMPERx
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
344 Freescale Semiconductor
To calculate the output frequency in center aligned output mode for a particular channel, take the selected
clock source frequency for the channel (A, B, SA, or SB) and divide it by twice the value in the period
register for that channel.
PWMx Frequency = Clock (A, B, SA, or SB) / (2*PWMPERx)
PWMx Duty Cycle (high time as a% of period):
Polarity = 0 (PPOLx = 0)
Duty Cycle = [(PWMPERx-PWMDTYx)/PWMPERx] * 100%
Polarity = 1 (PPOLx = 1)
Duty Cycle = [PWMDTYx / PWMPERx] * 100%
As an example of a center aligned output, consider the following case:
Clock Source = E, where E = 10 MHz (100 ns period)
PPOLx = 0
PWMPERx = 4
PWMDTYx = 1
PWMx Frequency = 10 MHz/8 = 1.25 MHz
PWMx Period = 800 ns
PWMx Duty Cycle = 3/4 *100% = 75%
Shown in Figure 9-20 is the output waveform generated.
Figure 9-20. PWM Center Aligned Output Example Waveform
9.4.2.7 PWM 16-Bit Functions
The scalable PWM timer als o has the option of generating up to 8-channels of 8-bits or 4-channels of 16-
bits for greater PWM resolution. This 16-bit channel option is achieved through the concatenation of two
8-bit channels.
The PWMCTL register contains four control bits, each of which is used to concatenate a pair of PWM
channels into one 16-bit channel. Channels 6 and 7 are concatenated with the CON67 bit, channels 4 and
5 are concatenated with the CON45 bit, channels 2 and 3 are concatenated with the CON23 bit, and
channels 0 and 1 are concatenated with the CON01 bit.
NOTE
Change these bits only when both corresponding channels are disabled.
When channels 6 and 7 are concatenated, channel 6 registers become the high order bytes of the double
byte channel, as shown in Figure 9-21. Similarly, when channels 4 and 5 are concatenated, channel 4
E = 100 ns
DUTY CYCLE = 75%
E = 100 ns
PERIOD = 800 ns
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 345
registers become the high order bytes of the double byte channel. When channels 2 and 3 are concatenated,
channel 2 registers become the high order bytes of the double byte channel. When channels 0 and 1 are
concatenated, channel 0 registers become the high order bytes of the double byte channel.
When using the 16-bit concatenated mode, the clock source is determined by the low order 8-bit channel
clock select control bits. That is channel 7 when channels 6 and 7 are concatenated, channel 5 when
channels 4 and 5 are concatenated, channel 3 when channels 2 and 3 are concatenated, and channel 1 when
channels 0 and 1 are concatenated. The resulting PWM is output to the pins of the corresponding low order
8-bit channel as also shown in Figure 9-21. The polarity of the resulting PWM output is controlled by the
PPOLx bit of the corresponding low order 8-bit channel as well.
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
346 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 9-21. PWM 16-Bit Mode
Once concatenated mode is enabled (CONxx bits set in PWMCTL register), enabling/disabling the
corresponding 16-bit PWM channel is controlled by the low order PWMEx bit. In this case, the high order
bytes PWMEx bits have no effect and their corresponding PWM output is disabled.
PWMCNT6 PWMCNT7
PWM7
Clock Source 7 High Low
Period/Duty Compare
PWMCNT4 PWMCNT5
PWM5
Clock Source 5
High Low
Period/Duty Compare
PWMCNT2 PWMCNT3
PWM3
Clock Source 3
High Low
Period/Duty Compare
PWMCNT0 PWMCNT1
PWM1
Clock Source 1
High Low
Period/Duty Compare
Maximum possible 16-bit channels
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 347
In concatenated mode, writes to the 16-bit counter by using a 16-bit access or writes to either the low or
high order byte of the counter will reset the 16-bit counter. Reads of the 16-bit counter must be made by
16-bit access to maintain data coherency.
Either left aligned or center aligned output mode can be used in concatenated mode and is controlled by
the low order CAEx bit. The high order CAEx bit has no effect.
Table 9-13 is used to summarize which channels are used to set the various control bits when in 16-bit
mode.
9.4.2.8 PWM Boundary Cases
Table 9-14 summarizes the boundary conditions for the PWM regardless of the output mode (left aligned
or center aligned) and 8-bit (normal) or 16-bit (concatenation).
9.5 Resets
The reset state of each individual bit is listed within the Section 9.3.2, “Register Descriptions” which
details the registers and their bit-fields. All special functions or modes which are initialized during or just
following reset are described within this section.
The 8-bit up/down counter is configured as an up counter out of reset.
All the channels are disabled and all the counters do not count.
Table 9-13. 16-bit Concatenation Mode Summary
Note: Bits related to available channels have functional significance.
CONxx PWMEx PPOLx PCLKx CAEx PWMx
Output
CON67 PWME7 PPOL7 PCLK7 CAE7 PWM7
CON45 PWME5 PPOL5 PCLK5 CAE5 PWM5
CON23 PWME3 PPOL3 PCLK3 CAE3 PWM3
CON01 PWME1 PPOL1 PCLK1 CAE1 PWM1
Table 9-14. PWM Boundary Cases
PWMDTYx PWMPERx PPOLx PWMx Output
$00
(indicates no duty)
>$00 1 Always low
$00
(indicates no duty)
>$00 0 Always high
XX $00(1)
(indicates no period)
1. Counter = $00 and does not count.
1 Always high
XX $001
(indicates no period)
0 Always low
>= PWMPERx XX 1 Always high
>= PWMPERx XX 0 Always low
Chapter 9 Pulse-Width Modulator (S12PWM8B8CV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
348 Freescale Semiconductor
For channels 0, 1, 4, and 5 the clock choices are clock A.
For channels 2, 3, 6, and 7 the clock choices are clock B.
9.6 Interrupts
The PWM module has no interrupt.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 349
Chapter 10
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
10.1 Introduction
The ADC12B_LBA is an n-channel multiplexed input su ccessive approximation analog-to-digital
converter. Refer to device electrical specifications for ADC parameters and accuracy.
The List Based Architecture (LBA) provides flexible conversion sequence definition as well as flexible
oversampling. The order of channels to be converted can be freely defined. Also, multiple instantiations
of the module can be triggered simultaneously (matching sampling point across multiple module
instantiations).
There are four register bits which control the conversion flow (please refer to the description of register
ADCFLWCTL).
The four conversion flow control bits of register ADCFLWCTL can be modified in two different ways:
Via data bus accesses
Via internal interface Signals (Trigger, Restart, LoadOK, and Seq_Abort; see also Figure 10-2).
Each Interface Signal is associated with one conversion flow control bit.
For information regarding internal interface connectivity related to the conversion flow control please
refer to the device overview of the reference manual.
The ADCFLWCTL register can be controlled via internal interface only or via data bus only or by both
depending on the register access configuration bits ACC_CFG[1:0].
Table 10-1. Revision History
Revision
Number Revision
Date Sections Affected Description of Changes
V1.35 06. Nov 2012 10.4.2.9/10-372 Modified bit description of flag LDOK_EIF for better understanding.
V1.36 08 Nov 2012 10.4.2.13/10-377 Updated description of bits RIDX_IMD for better understanding.
V1.37 19. Apr 2013 - Updates from review of reference manual to fix typos etc.
V1.38 30. Apr 2013 10.4.2.13/10-377
Provided more detailed information regarding captured information in
bits RIDX_IMD[5:0] for different scenarios of Sequence Abort Event
execution.
V1.39 02. Jul 2013 10.4.2.6/10-366 Update of: Timing considerations for Restart Mode
V1.40 02. Oct 2013 entire document Updated formatting and wording correction for entire document (for
technical publications).
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
350 Freescale Semiconductor
The four bits of register ADCFLWCTL reflect the captured request and status of the four internal interface
Signals (LoadOK, Trigger, Restart, and Seq_abort; see also Figure 10-2) if access configuration is set
accordingly and indicate event progress (when an event is processed and when it is finished).
Conversion flow error situations are captured by corresponding interrupt flags in the ADCEIF register.
There are two conversion flow control modes (Restart Mode, Trigger Mode). Each mode causes a certain
behavior of the conversion flow control bits which can be selected according to the application needs.
Please refer to Section 10.4.2.1, “ADC Control Register 0 (ADCCTL_0) and Section 10.5.3.2.4, “The two
conversion flow control Mode Configurations for more information regarding conversion flow control.
Because internal components of the ADC are turned on/off with bit ADC_EN, the ADC requires a
recovery time period (tREC) after ADC is enabled until the first conversion can be launched via a trigger.
When bit ADC_EN gets cleared (transition from 1’b1 to 1’b0) any ongoing conversion sequence will be
aborted and pending results, or the result of current conversion, gets discarded (not stored). The ADC
cannot be re-enabled before any pending action or action in process is finished respectively aborted, which
could take up to a maximum latency time of tDISABLE (see device reference manual for more details).
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 351
10.2 Key Features
Programmers Model with List Based Architecture for conversion command and result value
organization
Selectable resolution of 8-bit, 10-bit, or 12-bit
Channel select control for n external analog input channels
Provides up to eight device internal channels (please see the device reference manual for
connectivity information and Figure 10-2)
Programmable sample time
A sample buffer amplifier for channel sampling (improved performance in view to influence of
channel input path resistance versus conversion accuracy)
Left/right justified result data
Individual selectable VRH_0/1 and VRL_0/1 inputs on a conversion command basis (please see
Figure 10-2)
Special conversions for selected VRH_0/1, VRL_0/1, (VRL_0/1 + VRH_0/1) / 2
15 conversion interrupts with flexible interrupt or ganization per conversion result
One dedicated interrupt for “End Of List” type commands
Command Sequence List (CSL) with a maximum number of 64 command entries
Provides conversion sequence abort
Restart from top of active Command Sequence List (CSL)
The Command Sequence List and Result Value List are implemented in double buffered manner
(two lists in parallel for each function)
Conversion Command (CSL) loading possible from System RAM or NVM
Single conversion flow control register with software selectable access path
Two conversion flow control modes optimized to different application use cases
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
352 Freescale Semiconductor
10.2.1 Modes of Operation
10.2.1.1 Conversion Modes
This architecture provides single, multiple, or continuous conversion on a single channel or on multiple
channels based on the Command Sequence List.
10.2.1.2 MCU Operating Modes
MCU Stop Mode
Before issuing an MCU Stop Mode request the ADC should be idle (no conversion or conversion
sequence or Command Sequence List ongoing).
If a conversion, conversion sequence, or CSL is in progress when an MCU Stop Mode request is
issued, a Sequence Abort Event occurs automatically and any ongoing conversion finish. After the
Sequence Abort Event finishes, if the STR_SEQA bit is set (STR_SEQA=1), then the conversion
result is stored and the corresponding flags are set. If the STR_SEQA bit is cleared
(STR_SEQA=0), then the conversion result is not stored and the corresponding flags are not set.
The microcontroller then enters MCU Stop Mode without SEQAD_IF being set.
Alternatively, the Sequence Abort Event can be issued by software before an MCU Stop Mode
request. As soon as flag SEQAD_IF is set the MCU Stop Mode request can be is issued.
With the occurrence of the MCU Stop Mode Request until exit from Stop Mode all flow control
signals (RSTA, SEQA, LDOK, TRIG) are cleared.
After exiting MCU Stop Mode, the following happens in the order given with expected event(s)
depending on the conversion flow control mode:
In ADC conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode” a Restart Event is expected to
simultaneously set bits TRIG and RSTA, causing the ADC to execute the Restart Event
(CMD_IDX and RVL_IDX cleared) followed by the Trigger Event. The Restart Event can be
generated automatically after exit from MCU Stop Mode if bit AUT_RSTA is set.
In ADC conversion flow control mode “Restart Mode”, a Restart Event is expected to set bit
RSTA only (ADC already aborted at MCU Stop Mode entry hence bit SEQA must not be set
simultaneously) causing the ADC to execute the Restart Event (CDM_IDX and RVL_IDX
cleared). The Restart Event can be generate d automatically afte r exit from MCU Stop Mode if
bit AUT_RSTA is set.
The RVL buffer select (RVL_SEL) is not changed if a CSL is in process at MCU Stop Mode
request. Hence the same buffer will be used after exit from S top Mode that was used when the
Stop Mode request occurred.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 353
MCU Wait Mode
Depending on the ADC Wait Mode configuration bit SWAI, the ADC either continues conversion
in MCU W ait Mode or freezes conversion at the next conversion boundary before MCU W ait Mode
is entered.
ADC behavior for configuration SWAI =1’b0:
The ADC continues conversion during Wait Mode according to the conversion flow control
sequence. It is assumed that the conversion flow control sequence is continued (conversion flow
control bits TRIG, RSTA, SEQA, and LDOK are serviced accordingly).
ADC behavior for configuration SWAI = 1’b1:
At MCU Wait Mode request the ADC should be idle (no conversion or conversion sequence or
Command Sequence List ongoing).
If a conversion, conversion sequence, or CSL is in progress when an MCU Wait Mode request is
issued, a Sequence Abort Event occurs automatically and any ongoing conversion finish. After the
Sequence Abort Event finishes, if the STR_SEQA bit is set (STR_SEQA=1), then the conversion
result is stored and the corresponding flags are set. If the STR_SEQA bit is cleared
(STR_SEQA=0), then the conversion result is not stored and the corresponding flags are not set.
Alternatively the Sequence Abort Event can be issued by software before MCU Wait Mode
request. As soon as flag SEQAD_IF is set, the MCU Wait Mode request can be issued.
With the occurrence of the MCU Wait Mode request until exit from Wait Mode all flow control
signals (RSTA, SEQA, LDOK, TRIG) are cleared.
After exiting MCU Wait Mode, the following happens in the order given with expected event(s)
depending on the conversion flow control mode:
In ADC conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode”, a Restart Event is expected to occur.
This simultaneously sets bit TRIG and RSTA causing the ADC to execute the Restart Event
(CMD_IDX and RVL_IDX cleared) followed by the Trigger Event. The Restart Event can be
generated automatically after exit from MCU Wait Mode if bit AUT_RSTA is set.
In ADC conversion flow control mode “Restart Mode”, a Restart Event is expected to set bit
RSTA only (ADC already aborted at MCU Wait Mode entry hence bit SEQA must not be set
simultaneously) causing the ADC to execute the Restart Event (CDM_IDX and RVL_IDX
cleared). The Restart Event can be generated automatically after exit from MCU Wait Mode if
bit AUT_RSTA is set.
The RVL buffer select (RVL_SEL) is not changed if a CSL is in process at MCU Wait Mode
request. Hence the same R VL buffer will be used after exit from Wait Mode that was used when
Wait Mode request occurred.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
354 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
In principle, the MCU could stay in Wait Mode for a shorter period of time
than the ADC needs to abort an ongoing conversion (range of µµµµs).
Therefore in case a Sequence Abort Event is issued automatically due to
MCU Wait Mode request a following Restart Event after exit from MCU
Wait Mode can not be executed before ADC has finished this Sequence
Abort Event. The Restart Event is detected but it is pending.
This applies in case MCU Wait Mode is exited before ADC has finished the
Sequence Abort Event and a Restart Event is iss ued immediate ly after exit
from MCU Wait Mode. Bit READY can be used by software to detect when
the Restart Event can be issued without latency time in processing the event
(see also Figure 10-1).
Figure 10-1. Conversion Flow Control Diagram - Wait Mode (SWAI=1’b1, AUT_RSTA=1’b0)
MCU Freeze Mode
Depending on the ADC Freeze Mode configuration bit FRZ_MOD, the ADC either continues
conversion in Freeze Mode or freezes conversion at next conversion boundary before the MCU
Freeze Mode is entered. After exit from MCU Freeze Mode with previously frozen conversion
sequence the ADC continues the conversion with the next conversion command and all ADC
interrupt flags are unchanged during MCU Freeze Mode.
CSL_0 Active
AN3 AN1 AN4 IN5
AN6 AN1
Wait Mode request (SWAI=1’b1),
Automatic Sequence Abort
Event
Wait Mode
entry
Wake-up
Event
Idle Active
AN3 AN1 AN4
Abort
Sequence_n EOS
Sequence_0
AN5 AN2 AN0
Sequence_1
Trigger
Begin from top of current CSL
READY=1’b1
Restart
Event
Earliest point of time to issue
Restart Event without latenc y
t
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 355
10.2.2 Block Diagram
Figure 10-2. ADC12B_LBA Block Diagram
Successive
Approximation
Register (SAR)
and C-DAC
VSSA
ANx
ext.
MUX
Result List
Result_0
Result_1
..........
..........
Sample & Hold
VDDA
VRH_0
VRH_1
Sequence Abort Int.
+
-
Comparator
Clock
Prescaler
System Clock ADC Clock
Seq_abort
Trigger
Restart
...........
..........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
Result 63
.....
AN2
AN1
AN0
Conversion
(RAM)
DMA access
Command
Comm_0
Comm_1
..........
..........
...........
..........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
Comm 63
Sequence
(RAM/
DMA access
List
Error
handler
active
Active
Alternative-
Sequence
Command
List
Idle/
LoadOK
FlowCtrl Issue
Error/
see reference
manual for
connectivity ADC
Temperature
Sense
VREG_sense
Internal_7
Internal_6
Internal_5
Internal_4
Internal_3
Internal_2
Channel
int.
MUX
Channel
(Conversion Flow, Timing, Interrupt)
Control Unit
Conversion Int.
(RAM/
information
(EN)
Data Bus
Alternative
Result
List
(RAM)
VRL_0
VRL_1
Int.
regarding ADC
internal interface
PIM
+
-
Final
Buffer
Buffer
AMP
NVM)
NVM)
ADC12B_LBA
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
356 Freescale Semiconductor
10.3 Signal Description
This section lists all inputs to the ADC12B_LBA block.
10.3.1 Detailed Signal Descriptions
10.3.1.1 ANx (x = n,..., 2, 1, 0)
This pin serves as the analog input Channel x. The maximum input channel number is n. Please refer to
the device reference manual for the maximum number of input channels.
10.3.1.2 VRH_0, VRH _1, VRL_0, VRL_1
VRH_0/1 are the high reference voltages, VRL0/1 are the low reference voltages for a ADC conversion
selectable on a conversion command basis. Please refer to the device reference manual for availability and
connectivity of these pins.
10.3.1.3 VDDA, VSSA
These pins are the power supplies for the analog circuitry of the ADC12B_LBA block.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 357
10.4 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the ADC12B_LBA.
10.4.1 Module Memory Map
Figure 10-3 gives an overview of all ADC12B_LBA registers.
NOTE
Register Address = Base Address + Address Offset, where the Base Address
is defined at the MCU level and the Address Of fset is defined at the module
level.
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
0x0000 ADCCTL_0 RADC_EN ADC_SR FRZ_MOD SWAI ACC_CFG[1:0] STR_SEQA MOD_CFG
W
0x0001 ADCCTL_1 RCSL_BMOD RVL_BMOD SMOD_ACC AUT_RSTA 00 00
W
0x0002 ADCSTS RCSL_SEL RVL_SEL DBECC_ERR Reserved READY 0 00
W
0x0003 ADCTIM R0 PRS[6:0]
W
0x0004 ADCFMT RDJM 0000SRES[2:0]
W
0x0005 ADCFLWCTL RSEQA TRIG RSTA LDOK 00 0 0
W
0x0006 ADCEIE RIA_EIE CMD_EIE EOL_EIE Reserved TRIG_EIE RSTAR_EIE LDOK_EIE 0
W
0x0007 ADCIE RSEQAD_IE CONIF_OIE Reserved 00 0 0 0
W
0x0008 ADCEiF RIA_EIF CMD_EIF EOL_EIF Reserved TRIG_EIF RSTAR_EIF LDOK_EIF 0
W
0x0009 ADCIF RSEQAD_IF CONIF_OIF Reserved 00 0 0 0
W
0x000A ADCCONIE_0 RCON_IE[15:8]
W
0x000B ADCCONIE_1 RCON_IE[7:1] EOL_IE
W
0x000C ADCCONIF_0 RCON_IF[15:8]
W
0x000D ADCCONIF_1 RCON_IF[7:1] EOL_IF
W
0x000E ADCIMDRI_0 RCSL_IMD RVL_IMD 000000
0x000F ADCIMDRI_1 R 0 0 RIDX_IMD[5:0]
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-3. ADC12B_LBA Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3)
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
358 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0010 ADCEOLRI R CSL_EOL RVL_EOL 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0011 Reserved R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0012 Reserved R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x0013 Reserved R Reserved Reserved 0 0
W
0x0014 ADCCMD_0 RCMD_SEL 00 INTFLG_SEL[3:0]
W
0x0015 ADCCMD_1 RVRH_SEL VRL_SEL CH_SEL[5:0]
W
0x0016 ADCCMD_2 RSMP[4:0] 00
Reserved
W
0x0017 ADCCMD_3 R Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0018 Reserved R Reserved
W
0x0019 Reserved R Reserved
W
0x001A Reserved R Reserved
W
0x001B Reserved R Reserved
W
0x001C ADCCIDX R0 0 CMD_IDX[5:0]
W
0x001D ADCCBP_0 RCMD_PTR[23:16]
W
0x001E ADCCBP_1 RCMD_PTR[15:8]
W
0x001F ADCCBP_2 RCMD_PTR[7:2] 00
W
0x0020 ADCRIDX R 0 0 RES_IDX[5:0]
W
0x0021 ADCRBP_0 R0 0 0 0 RES_PTR[19:16]
W
0x0022 ADCRBP_1 RRES_PTR[15:8]
W
0x0023 ADCRBP_2 RRES_PTR[7:2] 00
W
0x0024 ADCCROFF0 R0 CMDRES_OFF0[6:0]
W
0x0025 ADCCROFF1 R0 CMDRES_OFF1[6:0]
W
0x0026 Reserved R0 0 0 0 Reserved
W
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-3. ADC12B_LBA Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3)
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 359
0x0027 Reserved R Reserved
W
0x0028 Reserved R Reserved 00
W
0x0029 Reserved R Reserved 0 Reserved
W
0x002A-
0x003F Reserved R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
Address Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-3. ADC12B_LBA Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3)
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
360 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes in address order all the ADC12B_LBA registers and their individual bits.
10.4.2.1 ADC Control Register 0 (ADCCTL_0)
Read: Anytime
Write:
Bits ADC_EN, ADC_SR, FRZ_MOD and SWAI writable anytime
Bits MOD_CFG, STR_SEQA and ACC_CFG[1:0] writable if bit ADC_EN clear or bit
SMOD_ACC set
Module Base + 0x0000
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RADC_EN ADC_SR FRZ_MOD SWAI ACC_CFG[1:0] STR_SEQA MOD_CFG
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-4. ADC Control Register 0 (ADCCTL_0)
Table 10-2. ADCCTL_0 Field Descriptions
Field Description
15
ADC_EN
ADC Enable Bit This bit enables the ADC (e.g. sample buffer amplifier etc.) and controls accessibility of ADC
register bits. When this bit gets cleared any ongoing conversion sequence will be aborted and pending results
or the result of current conversion gets discarded (not stored). The ADC cannot be re-enabled before any
pending action or action in process is finished or aborted, which could take up to a maximum latency time of
tDISABLE (see device reference manual for more details).
Because internal components of the ADC are turned on/off with this bit, the ADC requires a recovery time period
(tREC) after ADC is enabled until the first conversion can be launched via a trigger.
0 ADC disabled.
1 ADC enabled.
14
ADC_SR
ADC Soft-Reset — This bit causes an ADC Soft-Reset if set after a severe error occurred (see list of severe
errors in Section 10.4.2.9, “ADC Error Interrupt Flag Register (ADCEIF) that causes the ADC to cease
operation). It clears all overrun flags and error flags and forces the ADC state machine to its idle state. It also
clears the Command Index Register, the Result Index Register, and the CSL_SEL and RVL_SEL bits (to be
ready for a new control sequence to load new command and start execution again from top of selected CSL).
A severe error occurs if an error flag is set which cause the ADC to cease operation.
In order to make the ADC operational again an ADC Soft-Reset must be issued.
Once this bit is set it can not be cleared by writing any value. It is cleared only by ADC hardware after the Soft-
Reset has been executed.
0 No ADC Soft-Reset issued.
1 Issue ADC Soft-Reset.
13
FRZ_MOD
Freeze Mode Configuration — This bit influences conversion flow during Freeze Mode.
0 ADC continues conversion in Freeze Mode.
1 ADC freezes the conversion at next conversion boundary at Freeze Mode entry.
12
SWAI
Wait Mode Configuration — This bit influences conversion flow during Wait Mode.
0 ADC continues conversion in Wait Mode.
1 ADC halts the conversion at next conversion boundary at Wait Mode entry.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 361
NOTE
Each conversion flow control bit (SEQA, RSTA, TRIG, LDOK) must be
controlled by software or internal interface according to the requirements
described in Section 10.5.3.2.4, “The two conversion flow control Mode
Configurations and overview summary in Table 10-10.
11-10
ACC_CFG[1:0] ADCFLWCTL Register Access Configuration These bits define if the register ADCFLWCTL is controlled
via internal interface only or data bus only or both. See Table 10-3. for more details.
9
STR_SEQA
Control Of Conversion Result Storage and RSTAR_EIF flag setting at Seque nce Abort or Restart Event
— This bit controls conversion result storage and RSTAR_EIF flag setting when a Sequence Abort Event or
Restart Event occurs as follows:
If STR_SEQA = 1’b0 and if a:
Sequence Abort Event or Restart Event is issued during a conversion the data of this conversion is not stored
and the respective conversion complete flag is not set
Restart Event only is issued before the last conversion of a CSL is finished and no Sequence Abort Event is
in process (SEQA clear) causes the RSTA_EIF error flag to be asserted and bit SEQA gets set by hardware
If STR_SEQA = 1’b1 and if a:
Sequence Abort Event or Restart Event is issued during a conversion the data of this conversion is stored and
the respective conversion complete flag is set and Intermediate Result Information Register is updated.
Restart Event only occurs during the last conversion of a CSL and no Sequence Abort Event is in process
(SEQA clear) does not set the RSTA_EIF error flag
Restart Event only is issued before the CSL is finished and no Sequence Abort Event is in process (SEQA
clear) causes the RSTA_EIF error flag to be asserted and bit SEQA gets set by hardware
8
MOD_CFG
(Conversion Flow Control) Mode Configuration This bit defines the conversion flow control after a Restart
Event and after execution of the “End Of List” command type:
- Restart Mode
- Trigger Mode
(For more details please see also section Section 10.5.3.2, “Introduction of the Programmer’s Model and
following.)
0 “Restart Mode” selected.
1 “Trigger Mode” selected.
Table 10-3. ADCFLWCTL Register Access Configurations
ACC_CFG[1] ACC_CFG[0] ADC FLWCTL Access Mode
00 None of the access paths is enabled
(default / reset configuration)
01 Single Access Mode - Internal Interface
(ADCFLWCTL access via internal interface only)
10 Single Access Mode - Data Bus
(ADCFLWCTL access via data bus only)
11 Dual Access Mode
(ADCFLWCTL register access via internal interface and data bus)
Table 10-2. ADCCTL_0 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
362 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.2 ADC Control Register 1 (ADCCTL_1)
Read: Anytime
Write:
Bit CSL_BMOD and RVL_BMOD writable if bit ADC_EN clear or bit SMOD_ACC set
Bit SMOD_ACC only writable in MCU Special Mode
Bit AUT_RSTA writable anytime
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
RCSL_BMOD RVL_BMOD SMOD_ACC AUT_RSTA 0000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-5. ADC Control Register 1 (ADCCTL_1)
Table 10-4. ADCCTL_1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CSL_BMOD
CSL Buffer Mode Select Bit — This bit defines the CSL buffer mode. This bit is only writable if ADC_EN is clear.
0 CSL single buffer mode.
1 CSL double buffer mode.
6
RVL_BMOD
RVL Buffer Mode Select Bit — This bit defines the RVL buffer mode.
0 RVL single buffer mode
1 RVL double buffer mode
5
SMOD_ACC
Special Mode Access Control Bit — This bit controls register access rights in MCU Special Mode. This bit is
automatically cleared when leaving MCU Special Mode.
Note: When this bit is set also the ADCCMD register is writeable via the data bus to allow modification of the
current command for debugging purpose. But this is only possible if the current command is not already
processed (conversion not started).
Please see access details given for each register.
Care must be taken when modifying ADC registers while bit SMOD_ACC is set to not corrupt a possible ongoing
conversion.
0 Normal user access - Register write restrictions exist as specified for each bit.
1 Special access - Register write restrictions are lifted.
4
AUT_RSTA
Automatic Restart Event af ter exit from MCU Stop and Wa it Mode (SW AI set) This bit controls if a Restart
Event is automatically generated after exit from MCU Stop Mode or Wait Mode with bit SWAI set. It can be
configured for ADC conversion flow control mode
“Trigger Mode” and “Restart Mode” (anytime during application
runtime).
0 No automatic Restart Event after exit from MCU Stop Mode.
1 Automatic Restart Event occurs after exit from MCU Stop Mode.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 363
10.4.2.3 ADC Status Register (ADCSTS)
It is important to note that if flag DBECC_ERR is set the ADC ceases operation. In order to make the ADC
operational again an ADC Soft-Reset must be issued. An ADC Soft-Reset clears bits CSL_SEL and
RVL_SEL.
Read: Anytime
Write:
Bits CSL_SEL and RVL_SEL anytime if bit ADC_EN is clear or bit SMOD_ACC is set
Bits DBECC_ERR and READY not writable
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
RCSL_SEL RVL_SEL DBECC_ERR Reserved READY 0 0 0
W
Reset00001000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-6. ADC Status Register (ADCSTS)
Table 10-5. ADCSTS Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CSL_SEL Command Sequence List Select bit — This bit controls and indicates which ADC Command List is active. This
bit can only be written if ADC_EN bit is clear. This bit toggles in CSL double buffer mode when no conversion or
conversion sequence is ongoing and bit LDOK is set and bit RSTA is set. In CSL single buffer mode this bit is
forced to 1’b0 by bit CSL_BMOD.
0 ADC Command List 0 is active.
1 ADC Command List 1 is active.
6
RVL_SEL Result Value List Select Bit This bit controls and indicates which ADC Result List is active. This bit can only
be written if bit ADC_EN is clear. After storage of the initial Result Value List this bit toggles in RVL double buffer
mode whenever the conversion result of the first conversion of the current CSL is stored or a CSL got aborted.
In RVL single buffer mode this bit is forced to 1’b0 by bit RVL_BMOD.
Please see also Section 10.2.1.2, “MCU Operating Modes for information regarding Result List usage in case of
Stop or Wait Mode.
0 ADC Result List 0 is active.
1 ADC Result List 1 is active.
5
DBECC_ERR Double Bit ECC Error Flag This flag indicates that a double bit ECC error occurred during conversion
command load or result storage and ADC ceases operation.
In order to make the ADC operational again an ADC Soft-Reset must be issued.
This bit is cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear.
0 No double bit ECC error occurred.
1 A double bit ECC error occurred.
3
READY
Ready For Restart Event Flag — This flag indicates that ADC is in its idle state and ready for a Restart Event.
It can be used to verify after exit from Wait Mode if a Restart Event can be issued and processed immediately
without any latency time due to an ongoing Sequence Abort Event after exit from MCU Wait Mode (see also the
Note in Section 10.2.1.2, “MCU Operating Modes).
0 ADC not in idle state.
1 ADC is in idle state.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
364 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.4 ADC Timing Register (ADCTIM)
Read: Anytime
Write: These bits are writable if bit ADC_EN is clear or bit SMOD_ACC is set
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R0 PRS[6:0]
W
Reset00000101
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-7. ADC Timing Register (ADCTIM))
Table 10-6. ADCTIM Field Descriptions
Field Description
6-0
PRS[6:0]
ADC Clock Prescaler — These 7bits are the binary prescaler value PRS. The ADC conversion clock frequency
is calculated as follows:
Refer to Device Specification for allowed frequency range of fATDCLK.
fATDCLK
fBUS
2x PRS 1+
------------------------------------=
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 365
10.4.2.5 ADC Format Register (ADCFMT)
Read: Anytime
Write: Bits DJM and SRES[2:0] are writable if bit ADC_EN clear or bit SMOD_ACC set
Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
RDJM 0000 SRES[2:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-8. ADC Format Register (ADCFMT)
Table 10-7. ADCFMT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
DJM
Result Register Data Justification — Conversion result data format is always unsigned. This bit controls
justification of conversion result data in the conversion result list.
0 Left justified data in the conversion result list.
1 Right justified data in the conversion result list.
2-0
SRES[2:0]
ADC Resolution Select — These bits select the resolution of conversion results. See Table 10-8 for coding.
Table 10-8. Selectable Conversion Resolution
SRES[2] SRES[1] SRES[0] ADC Resolution
0 0 0 8-bit data
0 0 1 Reserved1.
0 1 0 10-bit data
0 1 1 Reserved1.
1 0 0 12-bit data
1 x x Reserved(1)
1. Reserved settings cause a severe error at ADC conversion start whereby
the CMD_EIF flag is set and ADC ceases operation
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
366 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.6 ADC Con version Flow Control Register (ADCFLWCTL)
Bit set and bit clear instructions should not be used to access this register.
When the ADC is enabled the bits of ADCFLWCTL register can be modified after a latency time of three
Bus Clock cycles.
All bits are cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear or via ADC soft-reset.
Read: Anytime
Write:
Bits SEQA, TRIG, RSTA, LDOK can only be set if bit ADC_EN is set.
Writing 1’b0 to any of these bits does not have an effect
Timing considerations (Trigger Event - channel sample start) depending on ADC mode configuration:
Restart Mode
When the Restart Event has been processed (initial command of current CSL is loaded) it takes two
Bus Clock cycles plus two ADC conversion clock cycles (pump phase) from the T rigger Event (bit
TRIG set) until the select channel starts to sample.
During a conversion sequence (back to back conversions) it takes five Bus Clock cycles plus two
ADC conversion clock cycles (pump phase) from current conversion period end until the newly
selected channel is sampled in the following conversion period.
Trigger Mode
When a Restart Event occurs a Trigger Event is issued simultaneously . The time required to process
the Restart Event is mainly defined by the internal read data bus availability and therefore can vary .
In this mode the Trigger Event is processed immediately after the Restart Event is finished and both
conversion flow control bits are cleared simultaneously . From de-assert of bit TRIG until sampling
begins five Bus Clock cycles are required. Hence from occurrence of a Restart Event until channel
sampling it takes five Bus Clock cycles plus an uncertainty of a few Bus Clock cycles.
For more details regarding the sample phase please refer to Section 10.5.2.2, “Sample and Hold Machine
with Sample Buffer Amplifier.
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
RSEQA TRIG RSTA LDOK 0000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-9. ADC Conversion Flow Control Register (ADCFLWC TL)
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 367
Table 10-9. ADCFLWCTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
SEQA
Conversion Se quence Abort Event This bit indicates that a conversion sequence abort event is in progress.
When this bit is set the ongoing conversion sequence and current CSL will be aborted at the next conversion
boundary. This bit gets cleared when the ongoing conversion sequence is aborted and ADC is idle.
This bit can only be set if bit ADC_EN is set.
This bit is cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear.
Data Bus Control:
This bit can be controlled via the data bus if access control is configured accordingly via ACC_CFG[1:0].
Writing a value of 1’b0 does not clear the flag.
Writing a one to this bit does not clear it but causes an overrun if the bit has already been set. See
Section 10.5.3.2.6, “Conversion flow control in case of conversion sequence control bit overrun scenarios for
more details.
Internal Interface Control:
This bit can be controlled via the internal interface Signal “Seq_Abort” if access control is configured accordingly
via ACC_CFG[1:0]. After being set an additional request via the internal interface Signal “Seq_Abort” causes an
overrun. See also conversion flow control in case of overrun situations.
General:
In both conversion flow control modes (Restart Mode and Trigger Mode) when bit RSTA gets set automatically
bit SEQA gets set when the ADC has not reached one of the following scenarios:
- A Sequence Abort request is about to be executed or has been executed.
- “End Of List” command type has been executed or is about to be executed
In case bit SEQA is set automatically the Restart error flag RSTA_EIF is set to indicate an unexpected Restart
Request.
0 No conversion sequence abort request.
1 Conversion sequence abort request.
6
TRIG
Conversion Sequence Trigger Bit — This bit starts a conversion sequence if set and no conversion or
conversion sequence is ongoing. This bit is cleared when the first conversion of a sequence starts to sample.
This bit can only be set if bit ADC_EN is set.
This bit is cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear.
Data Bus Control:
This bit can be controlled via the data bus if access control is configured accordingly via ACC_CFG[1:0].
Writing a value of 1’b0 does not clear the flag.
After being set this bit can not be cleared by writing a value of 1’b1 instead the error flag TRIG_EIF is set. See
also Section 10.5.3.2.6, “Conversion flow control in case of conversion sequence control bit overrun scenarios
for more details.
Internal Interface Control:
This bit can be controlled via the internal interface Signal “Trigger” if access control is configured accordingly via
ACC_CFG[1:0]. After being set an additional request via internal interface Signal “Trigger“ causes the flag
TRIG_EIF to be set.
0 No conversion sequence trigger.
1 Trigger to start conversion sequence.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
368 Freescale Semiconductor
5
RSTA
Restart Event (Restart from Top of Command Sequence List) — This bit indicates that a Restart Event is
executed. The ADC loads the conversion command from top of the active Sequence Command List when no
conversion or conversion sequence is ongoing. This bit is cleared when the first conversion command of the
sequence from top of active Sequence Command List has been loaded into the ADCCMD register.
This bit can only be set if bit ADC_EN is set.
This bit is cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear.
Data Bus Control:
This bit can be controlled via the data bus if access control is configured accordingly via ACC_CFG[1:0].
Writing a value of 1’b0 does not clear the flag.
Writing a one to this bit does not clear it but causes an overrun if the bit has already been set. See also
Section 10.5.3.2.6, “Conversion flow control in case of conversion sequence control bit overrun scenarios for
more details.
Internal Interface Control:
This bit can be controlled via the internal interface Signal “Restart” if access control is configured accordingly via
ACC_CFG[1:0]. After being set an additional request via internal interface Signal “Restart“ causes an overrun.
See conversion flow control in case of overrun situations for more details.
General:
In conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode” when bit RSTA gets set bit TRIG is set simultaneously if one of
the following has been executed:
- “End Of List” command type has been executed or is about to be executed
- Sequence Abort Event
0 Continue with commands from active Sequence Command List.
1 Restart from top of active Sequence Command List.
4
LDOK
Load OK for alter n ative Comman d Sequence List This bit indicates if the preparation of the alternative
Sequence Command List is done and Command Sequence List must be swapped with the Restart Event. This
bit is cleared when bit RSTA is set (Restart Event executed) and the Command Sequence List got swapped.
This bit can only be set if bit ADC_EN is set.
This bit is cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear.
This bit is forced to zero if bit CSL_BMOD is clear.
Data Bus Control:
This bit can be controlled via the data bus if access control is configured accordingly via ACC_CFG[1:0].
Writing a value of 1’b0 does not clear the flag.
To set bit LDOK the bits LDOK and RSTA must be written simultaneously.
After being set this bit can not be cleared by writing a value of 1’b1. See also Section 10.5.3.2.6, “Conversion
flow control in case of conversion sequence control bit overrun scenarios for more details.
Internal Interface Control:
This bit can be controlled via the internal interface Signal “LoadOK” and “Restart” if access control is configured
accordingly via ACC_CFG[1:0]. With the assertion of Interface Signal “Restart” the interface Signal “LoadOK” is
evaluated and bit LDOK set accordingly (bit LDOK set if Interface Signal “LoadOK” asserted when Interface
Signal “Restart” asserts).
General:
Only in “Restart Mode” if a Restart Event occurs without bit LDOK being set the error flag LDOK_EIF is set except
when the respective Restart Request occurred after or simultaneously with a Sequence Abort Request.
The LDOK_EIF error flag is also not set in “Restart Mode” if the first Restart Event occurs after:
- ADC got enabled
- Exit from Stop Mode
- ADC Soft-Reset
0 Load of alternative list done.
1 Load alternative list.
Table 10-9. ADCFLWCTL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 369
For a detailed description of all conversion flow control bit scenarios please see also Section 10.5.3.2.4,
“The two conversion flow control Mode Configurations, Section 10.5.3.2.5, “The four ADC conversion
flow control bits and Section 10.5.3.2.6, “Conversion flow control in case of conversion sequence control
bit overrun scenarios
Table 10-10. Summary of Conversion Flow Control Bit Scenarios
RSTA TRIG SEQA LDOK C onversion Flow
Control Mode Conversion Flow Control
Scenario
0 0 0 0 Both Modes Valid
0 0 0 1 Both Modes Can Not Occur
0 0 1 0 Both Modes Valid5.
0 0 1 1 Both Modes Can Not Occur
0 1 0 0 Both Modes Valid2.
0 1 0 1 Both Modes Can Not Occur
0 1 1 0 Both Modes Can Not Occur
0 1 1 1 Both Modes Can Not Occur
1 0 0 0 Both Modes Valid4.
1 0 0 1 Both Modes Valid1. 4.
1 0 1 0 Both Modes Valid3. 4. 5.
1 0 1 1 Both Modes Valid1. 3. 4. 5.
1100
“Restart Mode” Error flag TRIG_EIF set
“Trigger Mode” Valid2. 4. 6.
1101
“Restart Mode” Error flag TRIG_EIF set
“Trigger Mode” Valid1. 2. 4. 6.
1110
“Restart Mode” Error flag TRIG_EIF set
“Trigger Mode” Valid2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
1111
“Restart Mode” Error flag TRIG_EIF set
“Trigger Mode” Valid(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
1. Swap CSL buffer
2. Start conversion sequence
3. Prevent RSTA_EIF and LDOK_EIF
4. Load conversion command from top of CSL
5. Abort any ongoing conversion, conversion sequence and CSL
6. Bit TRIG set automatically in Trigger Mode
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
370 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.7 ADC Error Interrupt Enable Register (ADCEIE)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0006
76543210
RIA_EIE CMD_EIE EOL_EIE Reserved TRIG_EIE RSTAR_EIE LDOK_EIE 0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-10. ADC Error Interrupt Enable Register (ADCEIE)
Table 10-11. ADCEIE Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
IA_EIE
Illegal Access Error Interrupt Enable Bit — This bit enables the illegal access error interrupt.
0 Illegal access error interrupt disabled.
1 Illegal access error interrupt enabled.
6
CMD_EIE
Command Value Error Interrupt Enable Bit — This bit enables the command value error interrupt.
0 Command value interrupt disabled.
1 Command value interrupt enabled.
5
EOL_EIE
”End Of List” Error Interrupt Enable Bit This bit enables the “End Of List” error interrupt.
0 “End Of List” error interrupt disabled.
1 “End Of List” error interrupt enabled.
3
TRIG_EIE
Conversion Sequence T rigger Error Interrupt Enable Bit This bit enables the conversion sequence trigger
error interrupt.
0 Conversion sequence trigger error interrupt disabled.
1 Conversion sequence trigger error interrupt enabled.
2
RSTAR_EIE
Restart Request Error Interrupt Enable Bit— This bit enables the restart request error interrupt.
0 Restart Request error interrupt disabled.
1 Restart Request error interrupt enabled.
1
LDOK_EIE
Load OK Error Interrupt Enable Bit — This bit enables the Load OK error interrupt.
0 Load OK error interrupt disabled.
1 Load OK error interrupt enabled.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 371
10.4.2.8 ADC Interrupt Enable Register (ADCIE)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0007
76543210
RSEQAD_IE CONIF_OIE Reserved 00000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-11. ADC Interrupt Enable Register (ADCIE)
Table 10-12. ADCIE Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
SEQAD_IE
Conversion Sequence Abort Done Interrupt Enable Bit — This bit enables the conversion sequence abort
event done interrupt.
0 Conversion sequence abort event done interrupt disabled.
1 Conversion sequence abort event done interrupt enabled.
6
CONIF_OIE ADCCONIF Register Flags Overrun Interrupt Enable — This bit enables the flag which indicates if an overrun
situation occurred for one of the CON_IF[15:1] flags or for the EOL_IF flag.
0 No ADCCONIF Register Flag overrun occurred.
1 ADCCONIF Register Flag overrun occurred.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
372 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.9 ADC Error Interrupt Flag Register (ADCEIF)
If one of the following error flags is set the ADC ceases operation:
•IA_EIF
•CMD_EIF
•EOL_EIF
•TRIG_EIF
In order to make the ADC operational again an ADC Soft-Reset must be issued which clears above listed
error interrupt flags.
The error interrupt flags RSTAR_EIF and LDOK_EIF do not cause the ADC to cease operation. If set the
ADC continues operation. Each of the two bits can be cleared by writing a value of 1’b1. Both bits are also
cleared if an ADC Soft-Reset is issued.
All bits are cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear. W riting any flag with value 1’b0 does not clear a flag. W riting
any flag with value 1’b1 does not set the flag.
Read: Anytime
Write:
Bits RSTAR_EIF and LDOK_EIF are writable anytime
Bits IA_EIF, CMD_EIF, EOL_EIF and TRIG_EIF are not writable
Module Base + 0x0008
76543210
RIA_EIF CMD_EIF EOL_EIF Reserved TRIG_EIF RSTAR_EIF LDOK_EIF 0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-12. ADC Error Interrupt Flag Register (ADCEIF)
Table 10-13. ADCEIF Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
IA_EIF
Illegal Access Error Interrupt Flag — This flag indicates that storing the conversion result caused an illegal
access error or conversion command loading from outside system RAM or NVM area occurred.
The ADC ceases operation if this error flag is set (issue of type severe).
0 No illegal access error occurred.
1 An illegal access error occurred.
6
CMD_EIF
Command Value Error Interrupt Flag This flag indicates that an invalid command is loaded (Any command
that contains reserved bit settings) or illegal format setting selected (reserved SRES[2:0] bit settings).
The ADC ceases operation if this error flag is set (issue of type severe).
0 Valid conversion command loaded.
1 Invalid conversion command loaded.
5
EOL_EIF
“End Of List” Error Interrupt Flag — This flag indicates a missing “End Of List” command type in current
executed CSL.
The ADC ceases operation if this error flag is set (issue of type severe).
0 No “End Of List” error.
1 “End Of List” command type missing in current executed CSL.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 373
3
TRIG_EIF
Trigger Error Interrupt Flag — This flag indicates that a trigger error occurred.
This flag is set in “Restart” Mode when a conversion sequence got aborted and no Restart Event occurred before
the Trigger Event or if the Trigger Event occurred before the Restart Event was finished (conversion command
has been loaded).
This flag is set in “Trigger” Mode when a Trigger Event occurs before the Restart Event is issued to start
conversion of the initial Command Sequence List. In “Trigger” Mode only a Restart Event is required to start
conversion of the initial Command Sequence List.
This flag is set when a Trigger Event occurs before a conversion sequence got finished.
This flag is also set if a Trigger occurs while a Trigger Event is just processed - first conversion command of a
sequence is beginning to sample (see also Section 10.5.3.2.6, “Conversion flow control in case of conversion
sequence control bit overrun scenarios).
This flag is also set if the Trigger Event occurs automatically generated by hardware in “Trigger Mode” due to a
Restart Event and simultaneously a Trigger Event is generated via data bus or internal interface.
The ADC ceases operation if this error flag is set (issue of type severe).
0 No trigger error occurred.
1 A trigger error occurred.
2
RSTAR_EIF
Restart Request Error Interrupt Flag This flag indicates a flow control issue. It is set when a Restart Request
occurs after a Trigger Event and before one of the following conditions was reached:
- The “End Of List” command type has been executed
- Depending on bit STR_SEQA if the “End Of List” command type is about to be executed
- The current CSL has been aborted or is about to be aborted due to a Sequence Abort Request.
The ADC continues operation if this error flag is set.
This flag is not set for Restart Request overrun scenarios (see also Section 10.5.3.2.6, “Conversion flow control
in case of conversion sequence control bit overrun scenarios).
0 No Restart request error situation occurred.
1 Restart request error situation occurred.
1
LDOK_EIF
Load OK Error Interrupt FlagThis flag can only be set in “Restart Mode”. It indicates that a Restart Request
occurred without LDOK. This flag is not set if a Sequence Abort Event is already in process (bit SEQA set) when
the Restart Request occurs or a Sequence Abort Request occurs simultaneously with the Restart Request.
The LDOK_EIF error flag is also not set in “Restart Mode” if the first Restart Event occurs after:
- ADC got enabled
- Exit from Stop Mode
- ADC Soft-Reset
- ADC used in CSL single buffer mode
The ADC continues operation if this error flag is set.
0 No Load OK error situation occurred.
1 Load OK error situation occurred.
Table 10-13. ADCEIF Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
374 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.10 ADC Interrupt Flag Register (ADCIF)
After being set any of these bits can be cleared by writing a value of 1’b1 or via ADC soft-reset (bit
ADC_SR). All bits are cleared if bit ADC_EN is clear . W r iting any flag with value 1’b0 does not clear the
flag. Writing any flag with value 1’b1 does not set the flag.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
In RVL double buffer mode a conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) or
End Of List interrupt flag (EOL_IF) overrun is detected if one of these bits
is set when it should be set again due to conversion command execution.
In RVL single buffer mode a conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1])
overrun is detected only. The overrun is detected if any of the conversion
interrupt flags (CON_IF[15:1]) is set while the first conversion result of a
CSL is stored (result of first conversion from top of CSL is stored).
Module Base + 0x0009
76543210
RSEQAD_IF CONIF_OIF Reserved 00000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-13. ADC Interrupt Flag Register (ADCIF)
Table 10-14. ADCIF Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
SEQAD_IF
Conversion Sequence Abort Done Interrupt Flag This flag is set when the Sequence Abort Event has been
executed except the Sequence Abort Event occurred by hardware in order to be able to enter MCU Stop Mode
or Wait Mode with bit SWAI set.This flag is also not set if the Sequence Abort request occurs during execution
of the last conversion command of a CSL and bit STR_SEQA being set.
0 No conversion sequence abort request occurred.
1 A conversion sequence abort request occurred.
6
CONIF_OIF ADCCONIF Register Flags Overrun Interrupt Flag — This flag indicates if an overrun situation occurred for
one of the CON_IF[15:1] flags or for the EOL_IF flag. In RVL single buffer mode (RVL_BMOD clear) an overrun
of the EOL_IF flag is not indicated (For more information please see Note below).
0 No ADCCONIF Register Flag overrun occurred.
1 ADCCONIF Register Flag overrun occurred.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 375
10.4.2.11 ADC Conversion Interrupt Enable Register (ADCCONIE)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x000A
151413121110987654321 0
RCON_IE[15:1] EOL_IE
W
Reset000000000000000 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-14. ADC Conversion Interrupt Enable Register (ADCCONIE)
Table 10-15. ADCCONIE Field Descriptions
Field Description
15-1
CON_IE[15:1] Conversion Interrupt Enable Bits — These bits enable the individual interrupts which can be triggered via
interrupt flags CON_IF[15:1].
0 ADC conversion interrupt disabled.
1 ADC conversion interrupt enabled.
0
EOL_IE
End Of List Interrupt Enable Bit — This bit enables the end of conversion sequence list interrupt.
0 End of list interrupt disabled.
1 End of list interrupt enabled.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
376 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.12 ADC Conversion Interrupt Flag Register (ADCCONIF)
After being set any of these bits can be cleared by writing a value of 1’b1. All bits are cleared if bit
ADC_EN is clear or via ADC soft-reset (bit ADC_SR set). W riting any flag with value 1’b0 does not clear
the flag. Writing any flag with value 1’b1 does not set the flag.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
These bits can be used to indicate if a certain packet of conversion results is
available. Clearing a flag indicates that conversion results have been
retrieved by software and the flag can be used again (see also
Section 10.8.6, “RVL swapping in RVL double buffer mode and related
registers ADCIMDRI and ADCEOLRI.
NOTE
Overrun situation of a flag CON_IF[15:1] and EOL_IF are indicated by flag
CONIF_OIF.
Module Base + 0x000C
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RCON_IF[15:1] EOL_IF
W
Reset000000000000000 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-15. ADC Conversion Interrupt Flag Register (ADCCONIF)
Table 10-16. ADCCONIF Field Descriptions
Field Description
15-1
CON_IF[15:1] Conversion Interrupt Flags — These bits could be set by the binary coded interrupt select bits
INTFLG_SEL[3:0] when the corresponding conversion command has been processed and related data has been
stored to RAM.
See also notes below.
0
EOL_IF
End Of List Interrupt Flag — This bit is set by the binary coded conversion command type select bits
CMD_SEL[1:0] for “end of list” type of commands and after such a command has been processed and the related
data has been stored RAM.
See also second note below
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 377
10.4.2.13 ADC Intermediate Result Information Register (ADCIMDRI)
This register is cleared when bit ADC_SR is set or bit ADC_EN is clear.
Read: Anytime
Write: Never
NOTE
The register ADCIMDRI is updated and simultaneously a conversion
interrupt flag CON_IF[15:1] occurs when the corresponding conversion
command (conversion command with INTFLG_SEL[3:0] set) has been
processed and related data has been stored to RAM.
Module Base + 0x000E
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RCSL_IMD RVL_IMD 0000000 0 RIDX_IMD[5:0]
W
Reset0 0 0000000000000 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-16. ADC Interme di at e Re sult Information Register (ADCIMDRI)
Table 10-17. ADCIMDRI Field Descriptions
Field Description
15
CSL_IMD
Active CSL At Intermediate Event This bit indicates the active (used) CSL at the occurrence of a conversion
interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) (occurrence of an intermediate result buffer fill event) or when a Sequence Abort
Event gets executed.
0 CSL_0 active (used) when a conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) got set.
1 CSL_1 active (used) when a conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) got set.
14
RVL_IMD
Active RVL At Intermediate Event — This bit indicates the active (used) RVL buffer at the occurrence of a
conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) (occurrence of an intermediate result buffer fill event) or when a
Sequence Abort Event gets executed.
0 RVL_0 active (used) when a conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) got set.
1 RVL_1 active (used) when a conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) got set.
5-0
RIDX_IMD[5:0] RES_IDX Va lu e At Intermedi at e Event These bits indicate the result index (RES_IDX) value at the
occurrence of a conversion interrupt flag (CON_IF[15:1]) (occurrence of an intermediate result buffer fill event)
or occurrence of EOL_IF flag or when a Sequence Abort Event gets executed to abort an ongoing conversion
(the result index RES_IDX is captured at the occurrence of a result data store).
When a Sequence Abort Event has been processed flag SEQAD_IF is set and the RES_IDX value of the last
stored result is provided. Hence in case an ongoing conversion is aborted the RES_IDX value captured in
RIDX_IMD bits depends on bit STORE_SEQA:
- STORE_SEQA =1: The result index of the aborted conversion is provided
- STORE_SEQA =0: The result index of the last stored result at abort execution time is provided
In case a CSL is aborted while no conversion is ongoing (ADC waiting for a Trigger Event) the last captured result
index is provided.
In case a Sequence Abort Event was initiated by hardware due to MCU entering Stop Mode or Wait Mode with
bit SWAI set, the result index of the last stored result is captured by bits RIDX_IMD but flag SEQAD_IF is not set.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
378 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.14 ADC End Of List Result Information Register (ADCEOLRI)
This register is cleared when bit ADC_SR is set or bit ADC_EN is clear.
Read: Anytime
Write: Never
NOTE
The conversion interrupt EOL_IF occurs and simultaneously the register
ADCEOLRI is updated when the “End Of List” conversion command type
has been processed and related data has been stored to RAM.
Module Base + 0x0010
76543210
RCSL_EOL RVL_EOL 000000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-17. ADC End Of List Result Information Register (ADCEOLRI)
Table 10-18. ADCEOLRI Fiel d De sc ripti on s
Field Description
7
CSL_EOL
Active CSL When “End Of List” Comma nd Type Executed — This bit indicates the active (used) CSL when
a “End Of List” command type has been executed and related data has been stored to RAM.
0 CSL_0 active when “End Of List” command type executed.
1 CSL_1 active when “End Of List” command type executed.
6
RVL_EOL
Active RVL When “E nd Of List” Command Type Executed This bit indicates the active (used) RVL when
a “End Of List” command type has been executed and related data has been stored to RAM.
0 RVL_0 active when “End Of List” command type executed.
1 RVL_1 active when “End Of List” command type executed.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 379
10.4.2.15 ADC Command Register 0 (ADCCMD_0)
Read: Anytime
Write: Only writable if bit SMOD_ACC is set
(see also Section 10.4.2.2, “ADC Control Register 1 (ADCCTL_1) bit SMOD_ACC description for more
details)
NOTE
If bit SMOD_ACC is set modifying this register must be done carefully -
only when no conversion and conversion sequence is ongoing.
Module Base + 0x0014
3 1 30 29 28 27 26 25 24
RCMD_SEL 00 INTFLG_SEL[3:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-18. ADC Command Register 0 (ADCCMD_0)
Table 10-19. ADCCMD_0 Field Descriptions
Field Description
31-30
CMD_SEL[1:0]
Conversion Command Select Bits — These bits define the type of current conversion described in Table 10-
20.
27-24
INTFLG_SEL[3:0] Conversion Interrupt Flag Select Bits These bits define which interrupt flag is set in the ADCIFH/L register
at the end of current conversion.The interrupt flags ADCIF[15:1] are selected via binary coded bits
INTFLG_SEL[3:0]. See also Table 10-21
Table 10-20. Conversion Command Type Select
CMD_SEL[1] CMD _SEL[0] Conversion Command Type Description
0 0 Normal Conversion
01 End Of Sequence
(Wait for Trigger to execute next sequence or for a Restart)
10
End Of List
(Automatic wrap to top of CSL
and Continue Conversion)
11
End Of List
(Wrap to top of CSL and:
- In “Restart Mode” wait for Restart Event followed by a Trigger
- In “Trigger Mode” wait for Trigger or Restart Event)
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
380 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 10-21. Conversion Interrupt Flag Select
CON_IF[15:1] INTFLG_SEL[3] INTFLG_SEL[2] INTFLG_SEL[1] INTFLG_SEL[0] Comment
0x0000 0 0 0 0 No flag set
0x0001 0 0 0 1
Only one flag can
be set
(one hot coding)
0x0002 0 0 1 0
0x0004 0 0 1 1
0x0008 0 1 0 0
0x0010 0 1 0 1
.... ... ... ... ...
0x0800 1 1 0 0
0x1000 1 1 0 1
0x2000 1 1 1 0
0x4000 1 1 1 1
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 381
10.4.2.16 ADC Command Register 1 (ADCCMD_1)
A command which contains reserved bit settings causes the error flag CMD_EIF being set and ADC cease
operation.
Read: Anytime
Write: Only writable if bit SMOD_ACC is set
(see also Section 10.4.2.2, “ADC Control Register 1 (ADCCTL_1) bit SMOD_ACC description for more
details)
NOTE
If bit SMOD_ACC is set modifying this register must be done carefully -
only when no conversion and conversion sequence is ongoing.
Module Base + 0x0015
2 3 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RVRH_SEL VRL_SEL CH_SEL[5:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-19. ADC Command Register 1 (ADCCMD_1)
Table 10-22. ADCCMD_1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
23
VRH_SEL
Reference High Voltage Select Bit — This bit selects the high voltage reference for current conversion.
0 VRH_0 input selected as high voltage reference.
1 VRH_1 input selected as high voltage reference.
22
VRL_SEL
Reference Low Voltage Select Bit — This bit selects the voltage reference for current conversion.
0 VRL_0 input selected as low voltage reference.
1 VRL_1 input selected as low voltage reference.
21-16
CH_SEL[5:0]
ADC Input Channel Select Bits These bits select the input channel for the current conversion. See Table 10-
23 for channel coding information.
Table 10-23. Analog Input Channel Select
CH_SEL[5] CH_SEL[4] CH_SEL[3] CH_SEL[2] CH_SEL[1] CH_SEL[0] Analog Input Channel
000000 VRL_0/1
000001 VRH_0/1
0 0 0 0 1 0 (VRH_0/1 + VRL_0/1) / 2
000011 Reserved
000100 Reserved
000101 Reserved
000110 Reserved
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
382 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
ANx in Table 10-23 is the maximum number of implemented analog input
channels on the device. Please refer to the device overview of the reference
manual for details regarding number of analog input channels.
000111 Reserved
001000 Internal_0
(ADC temperature sense)
001001 Internal_1
(Vreg_3v3 sense)
001010 Internal_2
001011 Internal_3
001100 Internal_4
001101 Internal_5
001110 Internal_6
001111 Internal_7
010000 AN0
010001 AN1
010010 AN2
010011 AN3
010100 AN4
01xxxx ANx
1xxxxx Reserved
Table 10-23. Analog Input Channel Select
CH_SEL[5] CH_SEL[4] CH_SEL[3] CH_SEL[2] CH_SEL[1] CH_SEL[0] Analog Input Channel
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 383
10.4.2.17 ADC Command Register 2 (ADCCMD_2)
A command which contains reserved bit settings causes the error flag CMD_EIF being set and ADC cease
operation.
Read: Anytime
Write: Only writable if bit SMOD_ACC is set
(see also Section 10.4.2.2, “ADC Control Register 1 (ADCCTL_1) bit SMOD_ACC description for more
details)
NOTE
If bit SMOD_ACC is set modifying this register must be done carefully -
only when no conversion and conversion sequence is ongoing.
Module Base + 0x0016
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RSMP[4:0] 00
Reserved
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-20. ADC Command Register 2 (ADCCMD_2)
Table 10-24. ADCCMD_2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
15-11
SMP[4:0]
Sample Time Select Bits — These four bits select the length of the sample time in units of ADC conversion
clock cycles. Note that the ADC conversion clock period is itself a function of the prescaler value (bits PRS[6:0]).
Table 10-25 lists the available sample time lengths.
Table 10-25. Sample Time Select
SMP[4] SMP[3] SMP[2] SMP[1] SMP[0] Sample Time
in Number of
ADC Clock Cycles
00000 4
00001 5
00010 6
00011 7
00100 8
00101 9
00110 10
00111 11
01000 12
01001 13
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
384 Freescale Semiconductor
01010 14
01011 15
01100 16
01101 17
01110 18
01111 19
10000 20
10001 21
10010 22
10011 23
10100 24
10101 Reserved
10110 Reserved
10111 Reserved
11xxx Reserved
Table 10-25. Sample Time Select
SMP[4] SMP[3] SMP[2] SMP[1] SMP[0] Sample Time
in Number of
ADC Clock Cycles
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 385
10.4.2.18 ADC Command Register 3 (ADCCMD_3)
Module Base + 0x0017
76543210
R Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-21. ADC Command Register 3 (ADCCMD_3)
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
386 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.19 ADC Command Index Register (ADCCIDX)
It is important to note that these bits do not represent absolute addresses instead it is a sample index (object
size 32bit).
Read: Anytime
Write: NA
Module Base + 0x001C
76543210
R 0 0 CMD_IDX[5:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-22. ADC Command Index Register (ADCCIDX)
Table 10-26. ADCCIDX Field Descriptions
Field Description
5-0
CMD_IDX
[5:0]
ADC Command Index Bits — These bits represent the command index value for the conversion commands
relative to the two CSL start addresses in the memory map. These bits do not represent absolute addresses
instead it is a sample index (object size 32bit). See also Section 10.5.3.2.2, “Introduction of the two Command
Sequence Lists (CSLs) for more details.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 387
10.4.2.20 ADC Command Base Pointer Register (ADCCBP)
Read: Anytime
Write: Bits CMD_PTR[23:2] writable if bit ADC_EN clear or bit SMOD_ACC set
Module Base + 0x001D
2 3 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
R
CMD_PTR[23:16]
W
Reset00000000
Module Base + 0x001E
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
R
CMD_PTR[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Module Base + 0x001F
76543210
RCMD_PTR[7:2] 00
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-23. ADC Command Base Pointer Registers (ADCCBP_0, ADCCBP_1, ADCCBP_2))
Table 10-27. ADCCBP Field Descriptions
Field Description
23-2
CMD_PTR [23:2] ADC Command Base Pointer Address — These bits define the base address of the two CSL areas inside the
system RAM or NVM of the memory map. They are used to calculate the final address from which the conversion
commands will be loaded depending on which list is active. For more details see Section 10.5.3.2.2, “Introduction
of the two Command Sequence Lists (CSLs).
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
388 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.21 ADC Result Index Register (ADCRIDX)
It is important to note that these bits do not represent absolute addresses instead it is a sample index (object
size 16bit).
Read: Anytime
Write: NA
Module Base + 0x0020
76543210
R 0 0 RES_IDX[5:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-24. ADC Result Index Register (ADCRIDX)
Table 10-28. ADCRIDX Field Descriptions
Field Description
5-0
RES_IDX[5:0] ADC Result Index Bits — These read only bits represent the index value for the conversion results relative to
the two RVL start addresses in the memory map. These bits do not represent absolute addresses instead it is a
sample index (object size 16bit). See also Section 10.5.3.2.3, “Introduction of the two Result Value Lists (RVLs)
for more details.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 389
10.4.2.22 ADC Result Base Pointer Register (ADCRBP)
Read: Anytime
Write: Bits RES_PTR[19:2] writeable if bit ADC_EN clear or bit SMOD_ACC set
Module Base + 0x0021
2 3 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
R0 0 0 0
RES_PTR[19:16]
W
Reset00000000
Module Base + 0x0022
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
R
RES_PTR[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Module Base + 0x0023
76543210
RRES_PTR[7:2] 00
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-25. ADC Result Base Pointer Registers (ADCRBP_0, ADCRBP_1, ADCRBP_2))
Table 10-29. ADCRBP Field Descriptions
Field Description
19-2
RES_PTR[19:2]
ADC Result Base Pointer Address — These bits define the base address of the list areas inside the system
RAM of the memory map to which conversion results will be stored to at the end of a conversion. These bits can
only be written if bit ADC_EN is clear. See also Section 10.5.3.2.3, “Introduction of the two Result Value Lists
(RVLs).
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
390 Freescale Semiconductor
10.4.2.23 ADC Command and Result Offset Register 0 (ADCCROFF0)
Read: Anytime
Write: NA
Module Base + 0x0024
76543210
R 0 CMDRES_OFF0[6:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-26. ADC Command and Result Offset Register 0 (ADCCROFF0)
Table 10-30. ADCCROFF0 Field Descriptions
Field Description
6-0
CMDRES_OFF0
[6:0]
ADC Command and Result Offset Value These read only bits represent the conversion command and result
offset value relative to the conversion command base pointer address and result base pointer address in the
memory map to refer to CSL_0 and RVL_0. It is used to calculate the address inside the system RAM to which
the result at the end of the current conversion is stored to and the area (RAM or NVM) from which the conversion
commands are loaded from. This is a zero offset (null offset) which can not be modified. These bits do not
represent absolute addresses instead it is a sample offset (object size 16bit for RVL, object size 32bit for CSL).
See also Section 10.5.3.2.2, “Introduction of the two Command Sequence Lists (CSLs) and Section 10.5.3.2.3,
“Introduction of the two Result Value Lists (RVLs) for more details.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 391
10.4.2.24 ADC Command and Result Offset Register 1 (ADCCROFF1)
It is important to note that these bits do not represent absolute addresses instead it is an sample offset
(object size 16bit for RVL, object size 32bit for CSL).
Read: Anytime
Write: These bits are writable if bit ADC_EN clear or bit SMOD_ACC set
Module Base + 0x0025
76543210
R0 CMDRES_OFF1[6:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-27. ADC Command and Result Offset Register 1 (ADCCROFF1)
Table 10-31. ADCCROFF1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
6-0
CMDRES_OFF1
[6:0]
ADC Result Address Offset Value — These bits represent the conversion command and result offset value
relative to the conversion command base pointer address and result base pointer address in the memory map
to refer to CSL_1 and RVL_1. It is used to calculate the address inside the system RAM to which the result at
the end of the current conversion is stored to and the area (RAM or NVM) from which the conversion commands
are loaded from. These bits do not represent absolute addresses instead it is an sample offset (object size 16bit
for RVL, object size 32bit for CSL).,These bits can only be modified if bit ADC_EN is clear. See also
Section 10.5.3.2.2, “Introduction of the two Command Sequence Lists (CSLs) and Section 10.5.3.2.3,
“Introduction of the two Result Value Lists (RVLs) for more details.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
392 Freescale Semiconductor
10.5 Functional Description
10.5.1 Overview
The ADC12B_LBA consists of an analog sub-block and a digital sub-block. It is a successive
approximation analog-to-digital converter including a sample-and-hold mechanism and an internal charge
scaled C-DAC (switched capacitor scaled digital-to-analog converter) with a comparator to realize the
successive approximation algorithm.
10.5.2 Analog Sub-Block
The analog sub-block contains all analog circuits (sample and hold, C-DAC, analog Comparator, and so
on) required to perform a single conversion. Separate power supplies VDDA and VSSA allow noise from
the MCU circuitry to be isolated from the analog sub-block for improved accuracy.
10.5.2.1 Analog Input Multiplexer
The analog input multiplexers connect one of the external or internal analog input channels to the sample
and hold storage node.
10.5.2.2 Sample and Hold Machine with Sample Buffer Amplifier
The Sample and Hold Machine controls the storage and charge of the storage node (sample capacitor) to
the voltage level of the analog signal at the selected ADC input channel. This architecture employs the
advantage of reduced crosstalk between channels.
The sample buffer amplifier is used to raise the effective input impedance of the A/D machine, so that
external components (higher bandwidth or higher impedance connected as specified) are less significant
to accuracy degradation.
During the sample phase, the analog input connects first via a sample buffer amplifier with the storage
node always for two ADC clock cycles (“Buffer” sample time). For the remaining sample time (“Final”
sample time) the storage node is directly connected to the analog input source. Please see also Figure 10-
28 for illustration and the Appendix of the device reference manual for more details.
The input analog signals are unipolar and must be within the potential range of VSSA to VDDA.
During the hold process, the analog input is disconnected from the storage node.
Figure 10-28. Sampling and Conversion Timing Example (8-bit Resolution , 4 Cycle Sampling)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
"Buffer"
Sample Time
(2 cycles)
"Final"
Sample Time
(N - 2 cycles)
Total Sample Time
(N = SMP[4:0]) SAR Sequence
(Resolution Dependent Length: SRES[2:0])
Sample CAP hold phase
ADC_CLK
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 393
Please note that there is always a pump phase of two ADC_CLK cycles before the sample phase begins,
hence glitches during the pump phase could impact the conversion accuracy for short sample times.
10.5.3 Digital Sub-Block
The digital sub-block contains a list-based programmers model and the control logic for the analog sub-
block circuits.
10.5.3.1 Analog-to-Digital (A/D) Machine
The A/D machine performs the analog-to-digital conversion. The resolution is program selectable to be
either 8- or 10- or 12 bits. The A/D machine uses a successive approximation architecture. It functions by
comparing the sampled and stored analog voltage with a series of binary coded discrete voltages.
By following a binary search algorithm, the A/D machine identifies the discrete voltag e that is nearest to
the sampled and stored voltage.
Only analog input signals within the potential range of VRL_0/1 to VRH_0/1 (A/D reference potentials)
will result in a non-railed digital output code.
10.5.3.2 Introduction of the Programmers Model
The ADC_LBA provides a programmers model that uses a system memory list-based architecture for
definition of the conversion command sequence and conversion result handling.
The Command Sequence List (CSL) and Result Value List (RVL) are implemented in double buffered
manner and the buffer mode is user selectable for each list (bits CSL_BMOD, RVL_BMOD). The 32-bit
wide conversion command is double buffered and the currently active command is visible in the ADC
register map at ADCCMD register space.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
394 Freescale Semiconductor
10.5.3.2.1 Introduction of The Command Sequence List (CSL) Format
A Command Sequence List (CSL) contains up to 64 conversion commands. A user selectable number of
successive conversion commands in the CSL can be grouped as a command sequence. This sequence of
conversion commands is successively executed by the ADC at the occurrence of a Trigger Event. The
commands of a sequence are successively executed until an “End Of Sequence” or “End Of List”
command type identifier in a command is detected (command type is coded via bits CMD_SEL[1:0]). The
number of successive conversion commands that belong to a command sequence and the number of
command sequences inside the CSL can be freely defined by the user and is limited by the 64 conversion
commands a CSL can contain. A CSL must contain at least one conversion command and one “end of list”
command type identifier. The minimum number of command sequences inside a CSL is zero and the
maximum number of command sequences is 63. A command sequence is defined with bits
CMD_SEL[1:0] in the register ADCCMD_M by defining the end of a conversion sequence. The
Figure 10-29 and Figure 10-30 provides examples of a CSL.
Figure 10-29. Example CSL with sequences and an “End Of List” command type identifier
Command_1
Command_2
Command_3
Command_4
Command_5
Command_6
Command_7
Command_8
Command_9
Command_10
Command_11
Command_12
Command_13
CSL_0/1
End Of Sequence
normal conversion
Command Coding Informat ion
normal conversion
normal conversion
normal conversion
normal conversion
normal conversion
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 1
0 0
0 0
0 1
0 0
0 0
1 1
0 0
CMD_SEL[1:0]done by bits
End Of Sequence
normal conversion
normal conversion
End Of List
normal conversion
normal conversion
}
Sequence_1
}
Sequence_2
}
Sequence_3
Waiting for trigger
to proceed
Waiting for trigger
to proceed
Waiting for trigger
to proceed
Wait for RSTA or
LDOK+RSTA
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 395
Figure 10-30. Example CSL for continues conversion
Command_1
Command_2
Command_3
Command_4
Command_5
Command_6
Command_7
Command_8
Command_9
Command_10
Command_11
Command_12
Command_13
CSL_0
normal conversion
normal conversion
Command coding information
normal conversion
normal conversion
normal conversion
normal conversion
normal conversion
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
1 0
0 0
CMD_SEL[1:0]done by bits
normal conversion
normal conversion
normal conversion
End Of List, wrap to top, continue
normal conversion
normal conversion
continuous
conversion
Initial trigger
only
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
396 Freescale Semiconductor
10.5.3.2.2 Introduction of the two Command Sequence Lists (CSLs)
The two Command Sequence Lists (CSLs) can be referred to via the Command Base Pointer Register plus
the Command and Result Offset Registers plus the Command Index Register (ADCCBP,
ADCCROFF_0/1, ADCCIDX).
The final address for conversion command loading is calculated by the sum of these registers (e.g.:
ADCCBP+ADCCROFF_0+ADCCIDX or ADCCBP+ADCCROFF_1+ADCCIDX).
Bit CSL_BMOD selects if the CSL is used in double buffer or single buf fer mode. In double buffer mode,
the CSL can be swapped by flow control bits LDOK and RSTA. For detailed information about when and
how the CSL is swapped, please refer to Section 10.5.3.2.5, “The four ADC conversion flow control bits
- description of Restart Event + CSL Swap, Section 10.8.7.1, “Initial Start of a Command Sequence List
and Section 10.8.7.3, “Restart CSL execution with new/other CSL (alternative CSL becomes active CSL)
— CSL swapping
Which list is actively used for ADC command loading is indicated by bit CSL_SEL. The register to define
the CSL start addresses (ADCCBP) can be set to any even location of the system RAM or NVM area. It
is the users responsibility to make sure that the different ADC lists do not overlap or exceed the system
RAM or the NVM area, respectively. The error flag IA_EIF will be set for accesses to ranges outside
system RAM area and cause an error interrupt if enabled.
Figure 10-31. Command Sequence List Schema in Double Buffer Mode
Memory Map
0x00_0000 Register Space
RAM or NVM Space
RAM or NVM start address
RAM or NVM end address
CSL_0 (active)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_0)
CSL_1 (alternative)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_1)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_0+
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_1+
Scenario with: CSL_SEL = 1’b0
Memory Map
0x00_0000 Register Space
RAM or NVM Space
RAM / NVM start address
RAM or NVM end address
CSL_1 (active)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_0) CSL_0 (alternative)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_1)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_0+
ADCCMDP+(ADCCROFF_1+
Scenario with: CSL_SEL = 1’b1
ADCCIDX(max)) ADCCIDX(max))
ADCCIDX(max)) ADCCIDX(max))
Note:
Address register names in () are not absolute addresses instead they are a sample offset or sample index
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 397
Figure 10-32. Command Sequence List Schema in Single Buffer Mode
While the ADC is enabled, one CSL is active (indicated by bit CSL_SEL) and the corresponding list
should not be modified anymore. At the same time the alternative CSL can be modified to prepare the ADC
for new conversion sequences in CSL double buffered mode. When the ADC is enabled, the command
address registers (ADCCBP, ADCCROFF_0/2, ADCCIDX) are read only and register ADCCIDX is under
control of the ADC.
Memory Map
0x00_0000 Register Space
RAM or NVM Space
RAM or NVM start address
RAM or NVM end address
CSL_0 (active)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_0)
ADCCBP+(ADCCROFF_0+
CSL_SEL = 1’b0 (forced by CSL_BMOD)
ADCCIDX(max))
Note:
Address register names in () are not absolute addresses instead they are a sample offset or sample index
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
398 Freescale Semiconductor
10.5.3.2.3 Introduction of the two Result Value Lists (RVLs)
The same list-based architecture as described above for the CSL has been implemented for the Result
Value List (RVL) with corresponding address registers (ADCRBP, ADCCROFF_0/1, ADCRIDX).
The final address for conversion result storage is calculated by the sum of these registers (e.g.:
ADCRBP+ADCCROFF_0+ADCRIDX or ADCRBP+ADCCROFF_1+ADCRIDX).
The RVL_BMOD bit selects if the RVL is used in double buffer or single buffer mode. In double buffer
mode the RVL is swapped:
Each time an “End Of List” command type got executed followed by the first conversion from top
of the next CSL and related (first) result is about to be stored
A CSL got aborted (bit SEQA=1’b1) and ADC enters idle state (becomes ready for new flow
control events)
Using the RVL in double buffer mode the RVL is not swapped after exit from Stop Mode or Wait Mode
with bit SWAI set. Hence the R VL used before entry of Stop or Wait Mode with bit SWAI set is overwritten
after exit from the MCU Operating Mode (see also Section 10.2.1.2, “MCU Operating Modes).
Which list is actively used for the ADC conversion result storage is indicated by bit RVL_SEL. The
register to define the RVL start addresses (ADCRBP) can be set to any even location of the system RAM
area. It is the users responsibility to make sure that the different ADC lists do not overlap or exceed the
system RAM area. The error flag IA_EIF will be set for acc esses to ranges outside system RAM area and
cause an error interrupt if enabled.
Figure 10-33. Result Value List Schema in Double Buffer Mode
Memory Map
0x00_0000 Register Space
RAM Space
RAM start address
RAM end address
RVL_0 (active)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_0)
RVL_1 (alternative)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_1)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_0+
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_1+
Scenario with: RVL_SEL = 1’b0
Memory Map
0x00_0000 Register Space
RAM Space
RAM start address
RAM end address
RVL_1 (active)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_0) RVL_0 (alternative)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_1)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_0+
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_1+
Scenario with: RVL_SEL = 1’b1
ADCRIDX(max)) ADCRIDX(max))
ADCRIDX(max)) ADCRIDX(max))
Note:
Address register names in () are not absolute addresses instead they are a sample offset or sample index
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 399
Figure 10-34. Result Value List Schema in Single Buffer Mode
While ADC is enabled, one Result Value List is active (indicated by bit RVL_SEL). The conversion Result
Value List can be read anytime. When the ADC is enabled the conversion result address registers
(ADCRBP, ADCCROFF_0/1, ADCRIDX) are read only and register ADCRIDX is under control of the
ADC.
A conversion result is always stored as 16bit entity in unsigned data representation. Left and right
justification inside the entity is selected via the DJM control bit. Unused bits inside an entity are stored
zero.
Table 10-32. Conversion Result Justification Overview
Conversion Resolution
(SRES[1:0]) Left Justified Result
(DJM = 1’b0) Right Justified Result
(DJM = 1’b1)
8 bit {Result[7:0],8’b00000000} {8’b00000000,Result[7:0]}
10 bit {Result[9:0],6’b000000} {6’b000000,Result[9:0]}
12 bit {Result[11:0],4’b0000} {4’b0000,Result[11:0]}
Memory Map
0x00_0000 Register Space
RAM Space
RAM start address
RAM end address
RVL_0 (active)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_0)
ADCRBP+(ADCCROFF_0+
RVL_SEL = 1’b0 (forced by bit RVL_BMOD)
ADCRIDX(max))
Note:
Address register names in () are not absolute addresses instead they are a sample offset or sample index
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
400 Freescale Semiconductor
10.5.3.2.4 The two conversion flow control Mode Configurations
The ADC provides two modes (“Trigger Mode” and “Restart Mode”) which are different in the conversion
control flow. The “Restart Mode” provides precise timing control about the sample start point but is more
complex from the flow control perspective, while the “Trigger Mode” is more simple from flow control
point of view but is less controllable regarding conversion sample start.
Following are the key differences:
In “Trigger Mode” configuration, when conversion flow control bit RSTA gets set the bit TRIG gets set
automatically. Hence in “Trigger Mode” the applications should not set the bit TRIG and bit RSTA
simultaneously (via data bus or internal interface), because it is a flow control failure and the ADC will
cease operation.
In “Trigger Mode” configuration, after the execution of the initial Restart Event the current CSL can be
executed and controlled via T rigger Events only . Hence, if the “End Of List” command is reached a restart
of conversion flow from top of current CSL does not require to set bit RSTA because returning to the top
of current CSL is done automatically. Therefore the current CSL can be executed again after the “End Of
List” command type is executed by a Trigger Event only.
In “Restart Mode” configuration, the execution of a CSL is controlled via Trigger Events and Restart
Events. After execution of the “End Of List” command the conversion flow must be continued by a Restart
Event followed by a Trigger Event and the Trigger Event must not occur before the Restart Event has
finished.
For more details and examples regarding flow control and application use cases please see following
section and Section 10.8.7, “Conversion flow control application information.
10.5.3.2.5 The four ADC conversion flow control bits
There are four bits to control conversion flow (execution of a CSL and CSL exchange in double buffer
mode). Each bit is controllable via the data bus and internal interface depending on the setting of
ACC_CFG[1:0] bits (see also Figure 10-2). In the following the conversion control event to control the
conversion flow is given with the related internal interface signal and corresponding register bit name
together with information regarding:
Function of the conversion control event
How to request the event
When is the event finished
Mandatory requirements to executed the event
A summary of all event combinations is provided by Table 10-10.
Trigger Event
Internal Interface Signal: Trigger
Corresponding Bit Name: TRIG
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 401
Function:
S tart the first conversion of a conversion sequence which is defined in the active Command
Sequence List
Requested by:
- Positive edge of internal interface signal Trigger
- Write Access via data bus to set control bit TRIG
When finished:
This bit is cleared by the ADC when the first conversion of the sequence is beginning to
sample
Mandatory Requirements:
- In all ADC conversion flow control modes bit TRIG is only set (Trigger Event executed)
if the Trigger Event occurs while no conversion or conversion sequence is ongoing (ADC
idle)
- In ADC conversion flow control mode “Restart Mode” with a Restart Event in progress it
is not allowed that a Trigger Event occurs before the background command load phase has
finished (Restart Event has been executed) else the error flag TRIG_EIF is set
- In ADC conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode” a Restart Event causes bit TRIG
being set automatically. Bit TRIG is set when no conversion or conversion sequence is
ongoing (ADC idle) and the RVL done condition is reached by one of the following:
* A “End Of List” command type has been executed
* A Sequence Abort Event is in progress or has been executed
The ADC executes the Restart Event followed by the Trigger Event.
- In ADC conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode” a Restart Event and a simultaneous
T rigger Event via internal interface or data bus causes the TRIG_EIF bit being set and ADC
cease operation.
Restart Event (with current active CSL)
Internal Interface Signal: Restart
Corresponding Bit Name: RSTA
Function:
- Go to top of active CSL (clear index register for CSL)
- Load one background command register and wait for Trigger (CSL offset register is not
switched independent of bit CSL_BMOD)
- Set error flag RSTA_EIF when a Restart Request occurs before one of the following
conditions was reached:
* The "End Of List" command type has been executed
* Depending on bit STR_SEQA if the "End Of List" command type is about to be executed
* The current CSL has been aborted or is about to be aborted due to a Sequence Abort
Request.
Requested by:
- Positive edge of internal interface signal Restart
- Write Access via data bus to set control bit RSTA
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
402 Freescale Semiconductor
When finished:
This bit is cleared when the first conversion command of the sequence from top of active
Sequence Command List is loaded
Mandatory Requirement:
- In all ADC conversion flow control modes a Restart Event causes bit RSTA to be set. Bit
SEQA is set simultaneously by ADC hardware if:
* ADC not idle (a conversion or conversion sequence is ongoing and current CSL not
finished) and no Sequence Abort Event in progress (bit SEQA not already set or set
simultaneously via internal interface or data bus)
* ADC idle but RVL done condition not reached
The RVL done condition is reached by one of the following:
* A “End Of List” command type has been executed
* A Sequence Abort Event is in progress or has been executed (bit SEQA already set or set
simultaneously via internal interface or data bus)
The ADC executes the Sequence Abort Event followed by the Restart Event for the
conditions described before or only a Restart Event.
- In ADC conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode” a Restart Event causes bit TRIG
being set automatically. Bit TRIG is set when no conversion or conversion sequence is
ongoing (ADC idle) and the RVL done condition is reached by one of the following:
* A “End Of List” command type has been executed
* A Sequence Abort Event is in progress or has been executed
The ADC executes the Restart Event followed by the Trigger Event.
- In ADC conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode” a Restart Event and a simultaneous
T rigger Event via internal interface or data bus causes the TRIG_EIF bit being set and ADC
cease operation.
Restart Event + CSL Exchange (Swap)
Internal Interface Signals: Restart + LoadOK
Corresponding Bit Names: RSTA + LDOK
Function:
Go to top of active CSL (clear index register for CSL) and switch to other of fset register for
address calculation if configured for double buffer mode (exchange the CSL list)
Requested by:
- Internal interface with the assertion of Interface Signal Restart the interface Signal
LoadOK is evaluated and bit LDOK is set accordingly (bit LDOK set if Interface Signal
LoadOK asserted when Interface Signal Restart asserts).
- Write Access via data bus to set control bit RSTA simultaneously with bit LDOK.
When finished:
Bit LDOK can only be cleared if it was set as described before and both bits (LDOK, RSTA)
are cleared when the first conversion command from top of active Sequence Command List
is loaded
Mandatory Requirement:
No ongoing conversion or conversion sequence
Details if using the internal interface:
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 403
If signal Restart is asserted before signal LoadOK is set the conversion starts from top of
currently active CSL at the next Trigger Event (no exchange of CSL list).
If signal Restart is asserted after or simultaneously with signal LoadOK the conversion
starts from top of the other CSL at the next Trigger Event (CSL is switched) if CSL is
configured for double buffer mode.
Sequence Abort Event
Internal Interface Signal: Seq_Abort
Corresponding Bit Name: SEQA
Function:
Abort any possible ongoing conversion at next conversion boundary and abort current
conversion sequence and active CSL
Requested by:
- Positive edge of internal interface signal Seq_Abort
- Write Access via data bus to set control bit SEQA
When finished:
This bit gets cleared when an ongoing conversion is finished and the result is stored and/or
an ongoing conversion sequence is aborted and current active CSL is aborted (ADC idle,
RVL done)
Mandatory Requirement:
- In all ADC conversion flow control modes bit SEQA can only be set if:
* ADC not idle (a conversion or conversion sequence is ongoing)
* ADC idle but RVL done condition not reached
The RVL done condition is not reached if:
* An “End Of List” command type has not been executed
* A Sequence Abort Event has not been executed (bit SEQA not already set)
- In all ADC conversion flow control modes a Sequence Abort Event can be issued at any
time
- In ADC conversion flow control mode “Restart Mode” after a conversion sequence abort
request has been executed it is mandatory to set bit RSTA. If a T rigger Event occurs before
a Restart Event is executed (bit RSTA set and cleared by hardware), bit TRIG is set, error
flag TRIG_EIF is set, and the ADC can only be continued by a Soft-Reset. After the Restart
Event the ADC accepts new Trigger Events (bit TRIG set) and begins conv ersion from top
of the currently active CSL.
- In ADC conversion flow control mode “Restart Mode” after a Sequence Abort Event has
been executed, a Restart Event causes only the RSTA bit being set. The ADC executes a
Restart Event only.
In both conversion flow control modes (“Restart Mode” and “Trigger Mode”) when
conversion flow control bit RSTA gets set automatically bit SEQA gets set when the ADC
has not reached one of the following scenarios:
* An “End Of List” command type has been executed or is about to be executed
* A Sequence Abort request is about to be executed or has been executed.
In case bit SEQA is set automatically the Restart error flag RSTA_EIF is set to indicate an
unexpected Restart Request.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
404 Freescale Semiconductor
10.5.3.2.6 Conversion flow control in case of conversion sequence control bit overrun
scenarios
Restart Request Overrun:
If a legal Restart Request is detected and no Restart Event is in progress, the RSTA bit is set due to the
request. The set RSTA bit indicates that a Restart Request was detected and the Restart Event is in process.
In case further Restart Requests occur while the RSTA bit is set, this is defined a overrun situation. This
scenario is likely to occur when bit STR_SEQA is set or when a Restart Event causes a Sequence Abort
Event. The request overrun is captured in a background register that always stores the last detected overrun
request. Hence if the overrun situation occurs more than once while a Restart Event is in progress, only
the latest overrun request is pending. When the RSTA bit is cleared, the latest overrun request is processed
and RSTA is set again one cycle later.
LoadOK Overrun:
Simultaneously at any Restart Request overrun situation the LoadOK input is evaluated and the status is
captured in a background register which is alternated anytime a Restart Request Overrun occurs while
Load OK Request is asserted. The Load OK background register is cleared as soon as the pending Restart
Request gets processed.
Trigger Overrun:
If a T rigger occurs whilst bit TRIG is alread y set, this is defined as a T rigger overrun situation and causes
the ADC to cease conversion at the next conversion boundary and to set bit TRIG_EIF. A overrun is also
detected if the Trigger Event occurs automatically generated by hardware in “Trigger Mode” due to a
Restart Event and simultaneously a Trigger Event is generated via data bus or internal interface. In this
case the ADC ceases operation before conversion begins to sample. In “Trigger Mode” a Restart Request
Overrun does not cause a Trigger Overrun (bit TRIG_EIF not set).
Sequence Abort Request Overrun:
If a Sequence Abort Request occurs whilst bit SEQA is already set, this is defined as a Sequence Abort
Request Overrun situation and the overrun request is ignored.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 405
10.5.3.3 ADC List Usage and Conversion/Conversion Sequence Flow
Description
It is the user s responsibility to make sure that the different lists do not overlap or exceed the system RAM
area respectively the CSL does not exceed the NVM area if located in the NVM. The error flag IA_EIF
will be set for accesses done outside the system RAM area and will cause an error interrupt if enabled for
lists that are located in the system RAM.
Generic flow for ADC register load at conversion sequence start/restart:
It is mandatory that the ADC is idle (no ongoing conversion or conversion sequence).
It is mandatory to have at least one CSL with valid entries. See also Section 10.8.7.2, “Restart CSL
execution with currently active CSL or Section 10.8.7.3, “Restart CSL execution with new/other
CSL (alternative CSL becomes active CSL) — CSL swapping for more details on possible
scenarios.
A Restart Event occurs, which causes the index registers to be cleared (register ADCCIDX and
ADCRIDX are cleared) and to point to the top of the corresponding lists (top of active RVL and
CSL).
Load conversion command to background conversion command register 1.
The control bit(s) RSTA (and LDOK if set) are cleared.
Wait for Trigger Event to start conversion.
Generic flow for ADC register load during conversion:
The index registers ADCCIDX is incremented.
The inactive background command register is loaded with a new conversion command.
Generic flow for ADC result storage at end of conversion:
Index register ADCRIDX is incremented and the conversion result is stored in system RAM. As
soon as the result is successfully stored, any conversion interrupt flags are set accordingly.
At the conversion boundary the other background command register becomes active and visible in
the ADC register map.
If the last executed conversion command was of type “End Of Sequence”, the ADC waits for the
Trigger Event.
If the last executed conversion command was of type “End Of List” and the ADC is configured in
“Restart Mode”, the ADC sets all related flags a nd stays idle awaiting a Restart Event to continue.
If the last executed conversion command was of type “End Of List” and the ADC is configured in
“T rigger Mode”, the ADC sets all related flags and automatically returns to top of current CSL and
is awaiting a Trigger Event to continue.
If the last executed conversion command was of type “Normal Conversion” the ADC continues
command execution in the order of the current CSL (continues conversion).
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
406 Freescale Semiconductor
10.6 Resets
At reset the ADC12B_LBA is disabled and in a power down state. The reset state of each individual bit is
listed within Section 10.4.2, “Register Descriptions” which details the registers and their bit-fields.
10.7 Interrupts
The ADC supports three types of interrupts:
Conversion Interrupt
Sequence Abort Interrupt
Error and Conversion Flow Control Issue Interrupt
Each of the interrupt types is associated with individual interrupt enable bits and interrupt flags.
10.7.1 ADC Conversion Interrupt
The ADC provides one conversion interrupt associated to 16 interrupt enable bits with dedicated interrupt
flags. The 16 interrupt flags consist of:
15 conversion interrupt flags which can be associated to any conversion completion.
One additional interrupt flag which is fixed to the “End Of List” conversion command type within
the active CSL.
The association of the conversion number with the interrupt flag number is done in the conversion
command.
10.7.2 ADC Sequence Abort Done Interrupt
The ADC provides one sequence abort done interrupt associated with the sequence abort request for
conversion flow control. Hence, there is only one dedicated interrupt flag and interrupt enable bit for
conversion sequence abort and it occurs when the sequence abort is done.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 407
10.7.3 ADC Error and Conversion Flow Control Issue Interrupt
The ADC provides one error interrupt for four error classes related to conversion interrupt overflow,
command validness, DMA access status and Conversion Flow Control issues, and CSL failure. The
following error interrupt flags belong to the group of severe issues which cause an error interrupt if enabled
and cease ADC operation:
•IA_EIF
•CMD_EIF
•EOL_EIF
•TRIG_EIF
In order to make the ADC operational again, an ADC Soft-Reset must be issued which clears the above
listed error interrupt flags.
NOTE
It is important to note that if flag DBECC_ERR is set, the ADC ceases
operation as well, but does not cause an ADC error interrupt. Instead, a
machine exception is issued. In order to make the ADC operational again an
ADC Soft-Reset must be issued.
Remaining error interrupt flags cause an error interrupt if enabled, but ADC continues operation. The
related interrupt flags are:
•RSTAR_EIF
LDOK_EIF
CONIF_OIF
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
408 Freescale Semiconductor
10.8 Use Cases and Application Information
10.8.1 List Usage — CSL single buffer mode and RVL single buffer mode
In this use case both list types are configured for single buffer mode (CSL_BMOD=1’b0 and
R VL_BMOD=1’b0, CSL_SEL and RVL_SEL are forced to 1’b0). The index register for the CSL and R VL
are cleared to start from the top of the list with next conversion command and result storage in the
following cases:
The conversion flow reaches the command containing the “End-of-List” command type identifier
A Restart Request occurs at a sequence boundary
After an aborted conversion or conversion sequence
Figure 10-35. CSL Single Buffer Mode — RVL Single Buffer Mode Diagram
10.8.2 List Usage — CSL single buffer mode and RVL double buffer mode
In this use case the CSL is configured for single buffer mode (CSL_BMOD=1’b0) and the RVL is
configured for double buffer mode (RVL_BMOD=1’b1). In this buffer configuration only the result list
RVL is switched when the first conversion result of a CSL is stored after a CSL was successfully finished
or a CSL got aborted.
Figure 10-36. CSL Single Buffer Mode — RVL Single Buffer Mode Diagram
The last entirely filled RVL (an RVL where the corresponding CSL has been executed including the “End
Of List “ command type) is shown by register ADCEOLRI.
The CSL is used in single buffer mode and bit CSL_SEL is forced to 1’b0.
CSL_0
CSL_1
(unused)
RVL_0
RVL_1
(unused)
CSL_0
CSL_1
(unused)
RVL_0
RVL_1
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 409
10.8.3 List Usage — CSL double buffer mode and R VL double buffer mode
In this use case both list types are configured for double buffer mode (CSL_BMOD=1’b1 and
RVL_BMOD=1’b1) and whenever a Command Sequence List (CSL) is finished or aborted the command
Sequence List is swapped by the simultaneous assertion of bits LDOK and RSTA.
Figure 10-37. CSL Double Buffer Mode — RVL Double Buffer Mode Diagram
This use case can be used if the channel order or CSL length varies very frequently in an application.
10.8.4 List Usage — CSL double buffer mode and RVL single buffer mode
In this use case the CSL is configured for double buffer mode (CSL_BMOD=1’b1) and the RVL is
configured for single buffer mode (RVL_BMOD=1’b0).
The two command lists can be different sizes and the allocated result list memory area in the RAM must
be able to hold as many entries as the larger of the two command lists. Each time when the end of a
Command Sequence List is reached, if bits LDOK and RSTA are set, the commands list is swapped.
Figure 10-38. CSL Double Buffer Mode — RVL Single Buffer Mode Diagram
CSL_0
CSL_1
RVL_0
RVL_1
CSL_0
CSL_1
RVL_0
RVL_1
(unused)
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
410 Freescale Semiconductor
10.8.5 List Usage — CSL double buffer mode and R VL double buffer mode
In this use case both list types are configured for double buffer mode (CSL_BMOD=1’b1) and
RVL_BMOD=1’b1).
This setup is the same as Section 10.8.3, “List Usage — CSL double buffer mode and RVL double buffer
mode but at the end of a CSL the CSL is not always swapped (bit LDOK not always set with bit RSTA).
The Result Value List is swapped whenever a CSL is finished or a CSL got aborted.
Figure 10-39. CSL Double Buffer Mode — RVL Double Buffer Mode Diagram
10.8.6 RVL swapping in RVL double buffer mode and related registers
ADCIMDRI and ADCEOLRI
When using the RVL in double buffer mode, the registers ADCIMDRI and ADCEOLRI can be used by
the application software to identify which RVL holds relevant and latest data and which CSL is related to
this data. These registers are updated at the setting of one of the CON_IF[15:1] or the EOL_IF interrupt
flags. As described in the register description Section 10.4.2.13, “ADC Intermediate Result Information
Register (ADCIMDRI) and Section 10.4.2.14, “ADC End Of List Result Information Register
(ADCEOLRI), the register ADCIMDRI, for instance, is always updated at the occurrence of a
CON_IF[15:1] interrupt flag amongst other cases. Also each time the last conversion command of a CSL
is finished and the corresponding result is stored, the related EOL_IF flag is set and register ADCEOLRI
is updated. Hence application software can pick up conversion results, or groups of results, or an entire
result list driven fully by interrupts. A use case example diagram is shown in Figure 10-40.
CSL_0
CSL_1
RVL_0
RVL_1
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 411
Figure 10-40. RVL Swapping — Use Case Diagram
RVL Buffer RVL_0
CSL_0
Initial
Restart
Event
EOL
CSL_1
EOL
CSL_0
Stop Mode request
while conversion
RVL_1
Stop Mode
entry
Wake-up
Event with
AUT_RSTA= 1’b1
RVL_0
CSL_0
t
CSL Buffer
RVL swap
due to EOL
no RVL
swap
RVL values before Stop Mode
entry are overwritten
RVL_EOL 1’b0 1’b1
CSL_EOL 1’b0 1’b1
bits are valid
bits not valid
until first EOL
EOL_IF 1’b1
set by
hardware cleared by
software
1’b1
before next EOL should be cleared by software
before Stop Mode entry
return to execute
from top of CSL
followed by
next CSL to store
first result of
ongoing and before EOL
RVL_IMD 1’b0 1’b1
CSL_IMD 1’b0 1’b1
CON_IF[15:1] 0x0001
INT_1
0x0000 0x0000
Flag should be cleared by
software before it is set again
bits are valid
bits not valid
until first INT
EOL:
INT_x:
INT_2
0x0010
”End Of List” command type processed
One of the CON_IF interrupt flags occurs
INT_1
0x0001
1’b0
1’b0
RIDX_IMD[5:0] 0x050x00 0x0A 0x08 0x05
0x0B
tdelay
Delay can vary depending on the DMA performance, and ADC confi guratio n (conversion
flow using the Trigger to proceed through the CSL)
tdelay:
Comments:
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
412 Freescale Semiconductor
10.8.7 Conversion flow control application information
The ADC12B_LBA provides various conversion control scenarios to the user accomplished by the
following features.
The ADC conversion flow control can be realized via the data bus only, the internal interface only, or by
both access methods. The method used is software configurable via bits ACC_CFG[1:0].
The conversion flow is controlled via the four conversion flow control bits: SEQA, TRIG, RSTA, and
LDOK.
Two different conversion flow control modes can be configured: Trigger Mode or Restart Mode
Single or double buffer configuration of CSL and RVL.
10.8.7.1 Initial Start of a Command Sequence List
At the initial start of a Command Sequence List after device reset all entries for at least one of the two CSL
must have been completed and data must be valid. Depending on if the CSL_0 or the CSL_1 should be
executed at the initial start of a Command Sequence List the following conversion control sequence must
be applied:
If CSL_0 should be executed at the initial conversion start after device reset:
A Restart Event and a T rigger Event must occur (depending to the selected conversion flow control mode
the events must occur one after the other or simultaneously) which causes the ADC to start conversion with
commands loaded from CSL_0.
If CSL_1 should be executed at the initial conversion start after device reset:
Bit LDOK must be set simultaneously with the Restart Event followed by a Trigger Event (depending on
the selected conversion flow control mode the Trigger events must occur simultaneously or after the
Restart Event is finished). As soon as the Trigger Event gets executed the ADC starts conversion with
commands loaded from CSL_1.
As soon as a new valid Restart Event occurs the flow for ADC register load at conversion sequence start
as described in Section 10.5.3.3, “ADC List Usage and Conversion/Conversion Sequence Flow
Description applies.
10.8.7.2 Restart CSL execution with currently active CSL
To restart a Command Sequence List execution it is mandatory that the ADC is idle (no conversion or
conversion sequence is ongoing).
If necessary , a possible ongoing conversion sequence can be aborted by the Sequence Abort Event (setting
bit SEQA). As soon as bit SEQA is cleared by the ADC, the current conversion sequence has been aborted
and the ADC is idle (no conversion sequence or conversion ongoing).
After a conversion sequence abort is executed it is mandatory to request a Restart Event (bit RSTA set).
After the Restart Event is finished (bit RSTA is cleared), the ADC accepts a new T rigger Event (bit TRIG
can be set) and begins conversion from the top of the currently active CSL. In conversion flow control
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 413
mode “T rigger Mode” only a Restart Event is necessary if ADC is idle to restart Conversion Sequence List
execution (the Trigger Event occurs automatically).
It is possible to set bit RSTA and SEQA simultaneously, causing a Sequence Abort Event followed by a
Restart Event. In this case the error flags behave differently depending on the selected conversion flow
control mode:
Setting both flow control bits simultaneously in conversion flow control mode “Restart Mode”
prevents the error flags RSTA_EIF and LDOK_EIF from occurring.
Setting both flow control bits simultaneously in conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode”
prevents the error flag RSTA_EIF from occurring.
If only a Restart Event occurs while ADC is not idle and bit SEQA is not set already (Sequence Abort
Event in progress) a Sequence Abort Event is issued automatically and bit RSTAR_EIF is set.
Please see also the detailed conversion flow control bit mandatory requirements and execution information
for bit RSTA and SEQA described in Section 10.5.3.2.5, “The four ADC conversion flow control bits.
10.8.7.3 Restart CSL execution with new/other CSL (alternative CSL becomes
active CSL) — CSL swap ping
After all alternative conversion command list entries are finished the bit LDOK can be set simultaneously
with the next Restart Event to swap command buffers.
To start conversion command list execution it is mandatory that the ADC is idle (no conversion or
conversion sequence is ongoing).
If necessary , a possible ongoing conversion sequence can be aborted by the Sequence Abort Event (setting
bit SEQA). As soon as bit SEQA is cleared by the ADC, the current conversion sequence has been aborted
and the ADC is idle (no conversion sequence or conversion ongoing).
After a conversion sequence abort is executed it is mandatory to request a Restart Event (bit RSTA set)
and simultaneously set bit LDOK to swap the CSL buffer. After the Restart Event is finished (bit RSTA
and LDOK are cleared), the ADC accepts a new Trigger Event (bit TRIG can be set) and begins conversion
from the top of the newly selected CSL buffer. In conversion flow control mode “Trigger Mode” only a
Restart Event (simultaneously with bit LDOK being set) is necessary to restart conversion command list
execution with the newly selected CSL buffer (the Trigger Event occurs automatically).
It is possible to set bits RSTA, LDOK and SEQA simultaneously, causing a Sequence Abort Event
followed by a Restart Event. In this case the error flags behave differently depending on the selected
conversion flow control mode:
Setting these three flow control bits simultaneously in “Restart Mode” prevents the error flags
RSTA_EIF and LDOK_EIF from occurring.
Setting these three flow control bits simultaneously in “Trigger Mode” prevents the error flag
RSTA_EIF from occurring.
If only a Restart Event occurs while ADC is not idle and bit SEQA is not set already (Sequence Abort
Event in progress) a Sequence Abort Event is issued automatically and bit RSTAR_EIF is set.
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
414 Freescale Semiconductor
Please see also the detailed conversion flow control bit mandatory requirements and execution information
for bit RSTA and SEQA described in Section 10.5.3.2.5, “The four ADC conversion flow control bits.
10.8.8 Continuous Conversion
Applications that only need to continuously convert a list of channels, without the need for timing control
or the ability to perform different sequences of conversions (grouped number of different channels to
convert) can make use of the following simple setup:
“Trigger Mode” configuration
Single buffer CSL
Depending on data transfer rate either use single or double buffer RVL configuration
Define a list of conversion commands which only contains the “End Of List” command with
automatic wrap to top of CSL
After finishing the configuration and enabling the ADC an initial Restart Event is sufficient to launch the
continuous conversion until next device reset or low power mode.
In case a Low Power Mode is used:
If bit AUT_RSTA is set before Low Power Mode is entered the conversion continues automatically as
soon as a low power mode (Stop Mode or Wait Mode with bit SWAI set) is exited.
Figure 10-41. Conversion Flow Control Diagram — Continuous Conversion (with Stop Mode)
CSL_0 Active
AN3 AN1 AN4 IN5
Initial
Restart
Event
EOL
AN3 AN1 AN4 IN5
EOL
AN3 AN1
Stop Mode request,
Automatic Sequence Abort
Event
Idle
Stop Mode
entry
Wake-up
Event with
Idle
AUT_RSTA
Active
AN3 AN1 AN4
Abort
t
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 415
10.8.9 Triggered Conversion — Single CSL
Applications that require the conversion of one or more groups of different channels in a periodic and
timed manner can make use of a configuration in “Trigger Mode” with a single CSL containing a list of
sequences. This means the CSL consists of several sequences each separated by an “End of Sequence”
command. The last command of the CSL uses the “End Of List” command with wrap to top of CSL and
waiting for a T rigger (CMD_SEL[1:0] =2’b1 1). Hence after the initial Restart Event each sequence can be
launched via a Trigger Event and repetition of the CSL can be launched via a Trigger after execution of
the “End Of List” command.
Figure 10-42. Conversion Flow Control Diagram — Triggered Conversion (CSL Repetition)
Figure 10-43. Conversion Flow Control Diagram — Triggered Conversion (with Stop Mode)
In case a Low Power Mode is used:
If bit AUT_RSTA is set before Low Power Mode is entered, the conversion continues automatically as
soon as a low power mode (Stop Mode or Wait Mode with bit SWAI set) is exited.
CSL_0 Active
AN3 AN1 AN4 IN5
Initial
Restart
Event
EOS
AN2 AN0 AN4 IN3
EOS
AN3 AN1 AN4AN6 AN1 IN1
EOL
Trigger Trigger Trigger
Sequence_0 Sequence_1 Sequence_0
Sequence_2
Repetition of CSL_0
t
CSL_0 Active
AN3 AN1 AN4 IN5
initial
Restart
Event
EOS
AN21AN0 AN4 IN3
EOS
AN6 AN1
Stop Mode request,
Automatic Sequence Abort
Event
Idle
Stop Mode
entry
Wake-up
Event with
Idle
AUT_RSTA
Active
AN3 AN1 AN4
Abort
Sequence_0 Sequence_1
Trigger Trigger
EOS
Sequence_0
Sequence_2 AN5 AN2 AN0
Sequence_1
Trigger
Begin from top of current CSL
t
Chapter 10 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B_LBA_V1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
416 Freescale Semiconductor
10.8.10 Fully Timing Controlled Conversion
As described previously, in “Trigger Mode” a Restart Event automatically causes a trigger. To have full
and precise timing control of the beginning of any conversion/sequence the “Restart Mode” is available.
In “Restart Mode” a Restart Event does not cause a Trigger automatically; instead, the Trigger must be
issued separately and with correct timing, which means the T rigger is not allowed before the Restart Event
(conversion command loading) is finished (bit RSTA=1’b0 again). The time required from Trigger until
sampling phase starts is given (refer to Section 10.4.2.6, “ADC Conversion Flow Control Register
(ADCFLWCTL), Timing considerations) and hence timing is fully controllable by the application.
Additionally, if a Trigger occurs before a Restart Event is finished, this causes the TRIG_EIF flag being
set. This allows detection of false flow control sequences.
Figure 10-44. Conversion Flow Control Diagram — Fully Timing Controlled Conversion (with Stop Mode)
Unlike the Stop Mode entry shown in Figure 10-43 and Figure 10-44 it is recommended to issue the S top
Mode at sequence boundaries (when ADC is idle and no conversion/conversion sequence is ongoing).
Any of the Conversion flow control application use cases described above (Continuous, Triggered, or
Fully T iming Controlled Conversion) can be used with CSL single buffer mode or with CSL double buffer
mode. If using CSL double buffer mode, CSL swapping is performed by issuing a Restart Event with bit
LDOK set.
CSL_0 Active
AN3 AN1 AN4 IN5
any
Restart
Event
EOS
AN21AN0 AN4 IN3
EOS
AN6 AN1
Stop Mode request,
Automatic Sequence Abort
Event
Idle
Stop Mode
entry
Wake-up
Event with
Idle
AUT_RSTA
Active
AN3 AN1 AN4
Abort
Sequence_0 Sequence_1
Trigger Trigger
EOS
Sequence_0
Sequence_2 AN5 AN2 AN0
Sequence_1
Trigger
Begin from top of current CSL
Trigger
conversion command
load phase
t
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 417
Chapter 11
Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network
(S12MSCANV3)
11.1 Introduction
Freescale’s scalable controller area network (S12MSCANV3) definition is based on the MSCAN12
definition, which is the specific implementation of the MSCAN concept targeted for the S12, S12X and
S12Z microcontroller families.
The module is a communication controller implementing the CAN 2.0A/B protocol as defined in the
Bosch specification dated September 1991. For users to fully understand the MSCAN specification, it is
recommended that the Bosch specification be read first to familiarize the reader with the terms and
concepts contained within this document.
Though not exclusively intended for automotive applications, CAN protocol is designed to meet the
specific requirements of a vehicle serial data bus: real-time processing, reliable operation in the EMI
environment of a vehicle, cost-effectiveness, and required bandwidth.
MSCAN uses an advanced buffer arrangement resulting in predictable real-time behavior and simplified
application software.
Revision History
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Changes
V03.14 12 Nov 2012 Table 11-10 Corrected RxWRN and TxWRN threshold values
V03.15 12 Jan 2013 Table 11-2
Table 11-25
Figure 11-37
11.1/11-417
11.3.2.15/11-
438
Updated TIME bit description
Added register names to buffer map
Updated TSRH and TSRL read conditions
Updated introduction
Updated CANTXERR and CANRXERR register notes
V03.16 08 Aug 2013 Corrected typos
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
418 Freescale Semiconductor
11.1.1 Glossary
11.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 11-1. MSCAN Block Diagram
Table 11-1. Terminology
ACK Acknowledge of CAN message
CAN Controller Area Network
CRC Cyclic Redundancy Code
EOF End of Frame
FIFO First-In-First-Out Memory
IFS Inter-Frame Sequence
SOF Start of Frame
CPU bus CPU related read/write data bus
CAN bus CAN protocol related serial bus
oscillator clock Direct clock from external oscillator
bus clock CPU bus related clock
CAN clock CAN protocol related clock
RXCAN
TXCAN
Receive/
Transmit
Engine
Message
Filtering
and
Buffering
Control
and
Status
Wake-Up Interrupt Req.
Errors Interrupt Req.
Receive Interrupt Req.
Transmit Interrupt Req.
CANCLK
Bus Clock
Configuration
Oscillator Clock
MUX Presc.
Tq Clk
MSCAN
Low Pass Filter
Wake-Up
Registers
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 419
11.1.3 Features
The basic features of the MSCAN are as follows:
Implementation of the CAN protocol — Version 2.0A/B
Standard and extended data frames
Zero to eight bytes data length
Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbps1
Support for remote frames
Five receive buffers with FIFO storage scheme
Three transmit buffers with internal prioritization using a “local priority” concept
Flexible maskable identifier filter supports two full-size (32-bit) extended identifier filters, or four
16-bit filters, or eight 8-bit filters
Programmable wake-up functionality with integrated low-pass filter
Programmable loopback mode supports self-test operation
Programmable listen-only mode for monitoring of CAN bus
Programmable bus-off recovery functionality
Separate signalling and interrupt capabilities for all CAN receiver and transmitter error states
(warning, error passive, bus-off)
Programmable MSCAN clock source either bus clock or oscillator clock
Internal timer for time-stamping of received and transmitted messages
Three low-power modes: sleep, power down, and MSCAN enable
Global initialization of configuration registers
11.1.4 Modes of Operation
For a description of the specific MSCAN modes and the module operation related to the system operating
modes refer to Section 11.4.4, “Modes of Operation”.
1. Depending on the actual bit timing and the clock jitter of the PLL.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
420 Freescale Semiconductor
11.2 External Signal Description
The MSCAN uses two external pins.
NOTE
On MCUs with an integrated CAN physical interface (transceiver) the
MSCAN interface is connected internally to the transceiver interface. In
these cases the external availability of signals TXCAN and RXCAN is
optional.
11.2.1 RXCAN — CAN Receiver Input Pin
RXCAN is the MSCAN receiver input pin.
11.2.2 TXCAN — CAN Transmitter Output Pin
TXCAN is the MSCAN transmitter output pin. The TXCAN output pin represents the logic level on the
CAN bus:
0 = Dominant state
1 = Recessive state
11.2.3 CAN System
A typical CAN system with MSCAN is shown in Figure 11-2. Each CAN station is connected physically
to the CAN bus lines through a transceiver device. The transceiver is capable of driving the large current
needed for the CAN bus and has current protection against defective CAN or defective stations.
Figure 11-2. CAN System
CAN Bus
CAN Controller
(MSCAN)
Transceiver
CAN node 1
CAN node 2
CAN node n
CANL
CANH
MCU
TXCAN RXCAN
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 421
11.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the MSCAN.
11.3.1 Module Memory Map
Figure 11-3 gives an overview on all registers and their individual bits in the MSCAN memory map. The
register address results from the addition of base address and address offset. The base address is
determined at the MCU level and can be found in the MCU memory map description. The addr ess offset
is defined at the module level.
The MSCAN occupies 64 bytes in the memory space. The base address of the MSCAN module is
determined at the MCU level when the MCU is defined. The register decode map is fixed and begins at
the first address of the module address offset.
The detailed register descriptions follow in the order they appear in the register map.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
422 Freescale Semiconductor
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
CANCTL0
RRXFRM RXACT CSWAI SYNCH TIME WUPE SLPRQ INITRQ
W
0x0001
CANCTL1
RCANE CLKSRC LOOPB LISTEN BORM WUPM SLPAK INITAK
W
0x0002
CANBTR0
RSJW1 SJW0 BRP5 BRP4 BRP3 BRP2 BRP1 BRP0
W
0x0003
CANBTR1
RSAMP TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10
W
0x0004
CANRFLG
RWUPIF CSCIF RSTAT1 RSTAT0 TSTAT1 TSTAT0 OVRIF RXF
W
0x0005
CANRIER
RWUPIE CSCIE RSTATE1 RSTATE0 TSTATE1 TSTATE0 OVRIE RXFIE
W
0x0006
CANTFLG
R0 0000
TXE2 TXE1 TXE0
W
0x0007
CANTIER
R00000
TXEIE2 TXEIE1 TXEIE0
W
0x0008
CANTARQ
R00000
ABTRQ2 ABTRQ1 ABTRQ0
W
0x0009
CANTAAK
R00000ABTAK2 ABTAK1 ABTAK0
W
0x000A
CANTBSEL
R00000
TX2 TX1 TX0
W
0x000B
CANIDAC
R0 0 IDAM1 IDAM0 0 IDHIT2 IDHIT1 IDHIT0
W
0x000C
Reserved
R00000000
W
0x000D
CANMISC
R0000000
BOHOLD
W
0x000E
CANRXERR
R RXERR7 RXERR6 RXERR5 RXERR4 RXERR3 RXERR2 RXERR1 RXERR0
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-3. MSCAN Register Summary
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 423
11.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes in detail all the registers and register bits in the MSCAN module. Each description
includes a standard register diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field
function follow the register diagrams, in bit order. All bits of all registers in this module are completely
synchronous to internal clocks during a register read.
11.3.2.1 MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)
The CANCTL0 register provides various control bits of the MSCAN module as described below.
0x000F
CANTXERR
R TXERR7 TXERR6 TXERR5 TXERR4 TXERR3 TXERR2 TXERR1 TXERR0
W
0x0010–0x0013
CANIDAR0–3
RAC7AC6AC5AC4AC3AC2AC1AC0
W
0x0014–0x0017
CANIDMRx
RAM7 AM6 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0
W
0x0018–0x001B
CANIDAR4–7
RAC7AC6AC5AC4AC3AC2AC1AC0
W
0x001C–0x001F
CANIDMR4–7
RAM7 AM6 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0
W
0x0020–0x002F
CANRXFG
RSee Section 11.3.3, “Programmer’s Model of Message Storage
W
0x0030–0x003F
CANTXFG
RSee Section 11.3.3, “Programmer’s Model of Message Storage
W
Module Base + 0x0000 Access: User read/write(1)
76543210
R
RXFRM
RXACT
CSWAI
SYNCH
TIME WUPE SLPRQ INITRQ
W
Reset:00000001
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-4. MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-3. MSCAN Regist er Sum mary (continued)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
424 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
The CANCTL0 register, except WUPE, INITRQ, and SLPRQ, is held in the
reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and
INITAK = 1). This register is writable again as soon as the initialization
mode is exited (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime when out of initialization mode; exceptions are read-only RXACT and SYNCH, RXFRM (which is set by the
module only), and INITRQ (which is also writable in initialization mode)
Table 11-2. CANCTL0 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RXFRM
Received Frame FlagThis bit is read and clear only. It is set when a receiver has received a valid message
correctly, independently of the filter configuration. After it is set, it remains set until cleared by software or reset.
Clearing is done by writing a 1. Writing a 0 is ignored. This bit is not valid in loopback mode.
0 No valid message was received since last clearing this flag
1 A valid message was received since last clearing of this flag
6
RXACT
Receiver Active Status — This read-only flag indicates the MSCAN is receiving a message(1). The flag is
controlled by the receiver front end. This bit is not valid in loopback mode.
0 MSCAN is transmitting or idle
1 MSCAN is receiving a message (including when arbitration is lost)
5
CSWAI(2) CAN Stops in Wait ModeEnabling this bit allows for lower power consumption in wait mode by disabling all
the clocks at the CPU bus interface to the MSCAN module.
0 The module is not affected during wait mode
1 The module ceases to be clocked during wait mode
4
SYNCH
Synchronized Status — This read-only flag indicates whether the MSCAN is synchronized to the CAN bus and
able to participate in the communication process. It is set and cleared by the MSCAN.
0 MSCAN is not synchronized to the CAN bus
1 MSCAN is synchronized to the CAN bus
3
TIME
Timer Enable This bit activates an internal 16-bit wide free running timer which is clocked by the bit clock rate.
If the timer is enabled, a 16-bit time stamp will be assigned to each transmitted/received message within the
active TX/RX buffer. Right after the EOF of a valid message on the CAN bus, the time stamp is written to the
highest bytes (0x000E, 0x000F) in the appropriate buffer (see Section 11.3.3, “Programmer’s Model of Message
Storage”). In loopback mode no receive timestamp is generated. The internal timer is reset (all bits set to 0) when
disabled. This bit is held low in initialization mode.
0 Disable internal MSCAN timer
1 Enable internal MSCAN timer
2
WUPE(3) Wake-Up Enable — This configuration bit allows the MSCAN to restart from sleep mode or from power down
mode (entered from sleep) when traffic on CAN is detected (see Section 11.4.5.5, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”). This
bit must be configured before sleep mode entry for the selected function to take effect.
0 Wake-up disabled — The MSCAN ignores traffic on CAN
1 Wake-up enabled — The MSCAN is able to restart
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 425
11.3.2.2 MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)
The CANCTL1 register provides various control bits and handshake status information of the MSCAN
module as described below.
1
SLPRQ(4) Sleep Mode Request — This bit requests the MSCAN to enter sleep mode, which is an internal power saving
mode (see Section 11.4.5.5, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”). The sleep mode request is serviced when the CAN bus is
idle, i.e., the module is not receiving a message and all transmit buffers are empty. The module indicates entry
to sleep mode by setting SLPAK = 1 (see Section 11.3.2.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”). SLPRQ
cannot be set while the WUPIF flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.5, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)”).
Sleep mode will be active until SLPRQ is cleared by the CPU or, depending on the setting of WUPE, the MSCAN
detects activity on the CAN bus and clears SLPRQ itself.
0 Running — The MSCAN functions normally
1 Sleep mode request — The MSCAN enters sleep mode when CAN bus idle
0
INITRQ(5),(6) Initialization Mode Reques t — When this bit is set by the CPU, the MSCAN skips to initialization mode (see
Section 11.4.4.5, “MSCAN Initialization Mode”). Any ongoing transmission or reception is aborted and
synchronization to the CAN bus is lost. The module indicates entry to initialization mode by setting INITAK = 1
(Section 11.3.2.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”).
The following registers enter their hard reset state and restore their default values: CANCTL0(7), CANRFLG(8),
CANRIER(9), CANTFLG, CANTIER, CANTARQ, CANTAAK, and CANTBSEL.
The registers CANCTL1, CANBTR0, CANBTR1, CANIDAC, CANIDAR0-7, and CANIDMR0-7 can only be
written by the CPU when the MSCAN is in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). The values of the
error counters are not affected by initialization mode.
When this bit is cleared by the CPU, the MSCAN restarts and then tries to synchronize to the CAN bus. If the
MSCAN is not in bus-off state, it synchronizes after 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus; if the MSCAN
is in bus-off state, it continues to wait for 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits.
Writing to other bits in CANCTL0, CANRFLG, CANRIER, CANTFLG, or CANTIER must be done only after
initialization mode is exited, which is INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0.
0 Normal operation
1 MSCAN in initialization mode
1. See the Bosch CAN 2.0A/B specification for a detailed definition of transmitter and receiver states.
2. In order to protect from accidentally violating the CAN protocol, TXCAN is immediately forced to a recessive state when the
CPU enters wait (CSWAI = 1) or stop mode (see Section 11.4.5.2, “Operation in Wait Modeand Section 11.4.5.3, “Operation
in Stop Mode”).
3. The CPU has to make sure that the WUPE register and the WUPIE wake-up interrupt enable register (see Section 11.3.2.6,
“MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)) is enabled, if the recovery mechanism from stop or wait is required.
4. The CPU cannot clear SLPRQ before the MSCAN has entered sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1).
5. The CPU cannot clear INITRQ before the MSCAN has entered initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1).
6. In order to protect from accidentally violating the CAN protocol, TXCAN is immediately forced to a recessive state when the
initialization mode is requested by the CPU. Thus, the recommended procedure is to bring the MSCAN into sleep mode
(SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before requesting initialization mode.
7. Not including WUPE, INITRQ, and SLPRQ.
8. TSTAT1 and TSTAT0 are not affected by initialization mode.
9. RSTAT1 and RSTAT0 are not affected by initialization mode.
Table 11-2. CANCTL0 Register Field Descriptions (cont inued)
Field Description
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
426 Freescale Semiconductor
Module Base + 0x0001 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1), except CANE which is write once in normal and anytime in
special system operation modes when the MSCAN is in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
76543210
R
CANE CLKSRC LOOPB LISTEN BORM WUPM
SLPAK INITAK
W
Reset:00010001
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-5. MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)
Table 11-3. CANCTL1 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CANE
MSCAN Enable
0 MSCAN module is disabled
1 MSCAN module is enabled
6
CLKSRC
MSCAN Clock SourceThis bit defines the clock source for the MSCAN module (only for systems with a clock
generation module; Section 11.4.3.2, “Clock System,” and Section Figure 11-43., “MSCAN Clocking Scheme,”).
0 MSCAN clock source is the oscillator clock
1 MSCAN clock source is the bus clock
5
LOOPB
Loopback Self T est Mode When this bit is set, the MSCAN performs an internal loopback which can be used
for self test operation. The bit stream output of the transmitter is fed back to the receiver internally. The RXCAN
input is ignored and the TXCAN output goes to the recessive state (logic 1). The MSCAN behaves as it does
normally when transmitting and treats its own transmitted message as a message received from a remote node.
In this state, the MSCAN ignores the bit sent during the ACK slot in the CAN frame acknowledge field to ensure
proper reception of its own message. Both transmit and receive interrupts are generated.
0 Loopback self test disabled
1 Loopback self test enabled
4
LISTEN
Listen Only Mode This bit configures the MSCAN as a CAN bus monitor. When LISTEN is set, all valid CAN
messages with matching ID are received, but no acknowledgement or error frames are sent out (see
Section 11.4.4.4, “Listen-Only Mode”). In addition, the error counters are frozen. Listen only mode supports
applications which require “hot plugging” or throughput analysis. The MSCAN is unable to transmit any
messages when listen only mode is active.
0 Normal operation
1 Listen only mode activated
3
BORM
Bus-Off Recovery Mode — This bit configures the bus-off state recovery mode of the MSCAN. Refer to
Section 11.5.2, “Bus-Off Recovery,” for details.
0 Automatic bus-off recovery (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification)
1 Bus-off recovery upon user request
2
WUPM
Wake-Up Mode — If WUPE in CANCTL0 is enabled, this bit defines whether the integrated low-pass filter is
applied to protect the MSCAN from spurious wake-up (see Section 11.4.5.5, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”).
0 MSCAN wakes up on any dominant level on the CAN bus
1 MSCAN wakes up only in case of a dominant pulse on the CAN bus that has a length of Twup
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 427
11.3.2.3 MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)
The CANBTR0 register configures various CAN bus timing parameters of the MSCAN module.
1
SLPAK
Sleep Mode Acknowledge — This flag indicates whether the MSCAN module has entered sleep mode (see
Section 11.4.5.5, “MSCAN Sleep Mode”). It is used as a handshake flag for the SLPRQ sleep mode request.
Sleep mode is active when SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1. Depending on the setting of WUPE, the MSCAN will
clear the flag if it detects activity on the CAN bus while in sleep mode.
0 Running — The MSCAN operates normally
1 Sleep mode active — The MSCAN has entered sleep mode
0
INITAK
Initializati on Mo de Ackn ow le dge — This flag indicates whether the MSCAN module is in initialization mode
(see Section 11.4.4.5, “MSCAN Initialization Mode”). It is used as a handshake flag for the INITRQ initialization
mode request. Initialization mode is active when INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1. The registers CANCTL1,
CANBTR0, CANBTR1, CANIDAC, CANIDAR0–CANIDAR7, and CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7 can be written only by
the CPU when the MSCAN is in initialization mode.
0 Running — The MSCAN operates normally
1 Initialization mode active — The MSCAN has entered initialization mode
Module Base + 0x0002 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
76543210
R
SJW1 SJW0 BRP5 BRP4 BRP3 BRP2 BRP1 BRP0
W
Reset:00000000
Figure 11-6. MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)
Table 11-4. CANBTR0 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-6
SJW[1:0]
Synchronization Jump WidthThe synchronization jump width defines the maximum number of time quanta
(Tq) clock cycles a bit can be shortened or lengthened to achieve resynchronization to data transitions on the
CAN bus (see Table 11-5).
5-0
BRP[5:0]
Baud Rate Prescaler These bits determine the time quanta (Tq) clock which is used to build up the bit timing
(see Table 11-6).
Table 11-5. Synchronization Jump W idth
SJW1 SJW0 Synchronization Jump Width
0 0 1 Tq clock cycle
0 1 2 Tq clock cycles
1 0 3 Tq clock cycles
1 1 4 Tq clock cycles
Table 11-3. CANCTL1 Register Field Descriptions (cont inued)
Field Description
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
428 Freescale Semiconductor
11.3.2.4 MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)
The CANBTR1 register configures various CAN bus timing parameters of the MSCAN module.
Table 11-6. Baud Rate Prescaler
BRP5 BRP4 BRP3 BRP2 BRP1 BRP0 Prescaler value (P)
000000 1
000001 2
000010 3
000011 4
:::::: :
111111 64
Module Base + 0x0003 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
76543210
R
SAMP TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10
W
Reset:00000000
Figure 11-7. MSCAN Bus T iming Register 1 (CANBTR1)
Table 11-7. CANBTR1 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
SAMP
Sampling — This bit determines the number of CAN bus samples taken per bit time.
0 One sample per bit.
1 Three samples per bit(1).
If SAMP = 0, the resulting bit value is equal to the value of the single bit positioned at the sample point. If
SAMP = 1, the resulting bit value is determined by using majority rule on the three total samples. For higher bit
rates, it is recommended that only one sample is taken per bit time (SAMP = 0).
1. In this case, PHASE_SEG1 must be at least 2 time quanta (Tq).
6-4
TSEG2[2:0]
Time Segment 2 Time segments within the bit time fix the number of clock cycles per bit time and the location
of the sample point (see Figure 11-44). Time segment 2 (TSEG2) values are programmable as shown in
Table 11-8.
3-0
TSEG1[3:0]
Time Segment 1 Time segments within the bit time fix the number of clock cycles per bit time and the location
of the sample point (see Figure 11-44). Time segment 1 (TSEG1) values are programmable as shown in
Table 11-9.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 429
The bit time is determined by the oscillator frequency, the baud rate prescaler, and the number of time
quanta (Tq) clock cycles per bit (as shown in Table 11-8 and Table 11-9).
Eqn. 11-1
11.3.2.5 MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)
A flag can be cleared only by software (writing a 1 to the corresponding bit position) when the condition
which caused the setting is no longer valid. Every flag has an associated interrupt enable bit in the
CANRIER register.
Table 11-8. Time Segment 2 Values
TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 Time Segment 2
0 0 0 1 Tq clock cycle(1)
1. This setting is not valid. Please refer to Table 11-36 for valid settings.
0 0 1 2 Tq clock cycles
::: :
1 1 0 7 Tq clock cycles
1 1 1 8 Tq clock cycles
Table 11-9. Time Segment 1 Values
TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10 Time segment 1
0 0 0 0 1 Tq clock cycle(1)
1. This setting is not valid. Please refer to Table 11-36 for valid settings.
0 0 0 1 2 Tq clock cycles1
0 0 1 0 3 Tq clock cycles1
0 0 1 1 4 Tq clock cycles
:::: :
1 1 1 0 15 Tq clock cycles
1 1 1 1 16 Tq clock cycles
Module Base + 0x0004 Access: User read/write(1)
76543210
R
WUPIF CSCIF
RSTAT1 RSTAT0 TSTAT1 TSTAT0
OVRIF RXF
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-8. MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)
Bit Time Prescaler valueÞ
fCANCLK
---------------------------------------------------------- 1 TimeSegment1 TimeSegment2++=Þ
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
430 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
The CANRFLG register is held in the reset state1 when the initialization
mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable
again as soon as the initialization mode is exited (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK
= 0).
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode, except RSTAT[1:0] and TSTAT[1:0] flags which are read-only; write of 1 clears
flag; write of 0 is ignored
1. The RSTAT[1:0], TSTAT[1:0] bits are not affected by initialization mode.
Table 11-10. CANRFLG Register Fie ld Descriptions
Field Description
7
WUPIF
Wake-Up Interrupt Flag — If the MSCAN detects CAN bus activity while in sleep mode (see Section 11.4.5.5,
“MSCAN Sleep Mode,”) and WUPE = 1 in CANTCTL0 (see Section 11.3.2.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0
(CANCTL0)”), the module will set WUPIF. If not masked, a wake-up interrupt is pending while this flag is set.
0 No wake-up activity observed while in sleep mode
1 MSCAN detected activity on the CAN bus and requested wake-up
6
CSCIF
CAN Status Change Interrupt Flag — This flag is set when the MSCAN changes its current CAN bus status
due to the actual value of the transmit error counter (TEC) and the receive error counter (REC). An additional 4-
bit (RSTAT[1:0], TSTAT[1:0]) status register, which is split into separate sections for TEC/REC, informs the
system on the actual CAN bus status (see Section 11.3.2.6, “MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register
(CANRIER)”). If not masked, an error interrupt is pending while this flag is set. CSCIF provides a blocking
interrupt. That guarantees that the receiver/transmitter status bits (RSTAT/TSTAT) are only updated when no
CAN status change interrupt is pending. If the TECs/RECs change their current value after the CSCIF is
asserted, which would cause an additional state change in the RSTAT/TSTAT bits, these bits keep their status
until the current CSCIF interrupt is cleared again.
0 No change in CAN bus status occurred since last interrupt
1 MSCAN changed current CAN bus status
5-4
RSTAT[1:0]
Receive r Status Bits — The values of the error counters control the actual CAN bus status of the MSCAN. As
soon as the status change interrupt flag (CSCIF) is set, these bits indicate the appropriate receiver related CAN
bus status of the MSCAN. The coding for the bits RSTAT1, RSTAT0 is:
00 RxOK: 0 receive error counter 96
01 RxWRN: 96 receive error counter 128
10 RxERR: 1 28 receive error counter
11 Bus-off(1): 256transmit error counter
3-2
TSTAT[1:0]
Transmitter Status Bits — The values of the error counters control the actual CAN bus status of the MSCAN.
As soon as the status change interrupt flag (CSCIF) is set, these bits indicate the appropriate transmitter related
CAN bus status of the MSCAN. The coding for the bits TSTAT1, TSTAT0 is:
00 TxOK: 0 transmit error counter 96
01 TxWRN: 96 transmit error counter 128
10 TxERR: 1 28 transmit error counter 256
11 Bus-Off: 256 transmit error counter
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 431
11.3.2.6 MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)
This register contains the interrupt enable bits for the interrupt flags described in the CANRFLG register.
NOTE
The CANRIER register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode
is active (INITRQ=1 and INITAK=1). This register is writable when not in
initialization mode (INITRQ=0 and INITAK=0).
The RSTATE[1:0], TSTATE[1:0] bits are not affected by initialization
mode.
1
OVRIF
Overrun Interrupt Flag This flag is set when a data overrun condition occurs. If not masked, an error interrupt
is pending while this flag is set.
0 No data overrun condition
1 A data overrun detected
0
RXF(2) Receive Buffer Full Flag — RXF is set by the MSCAN when a new message is shifted in the receiver FIFO.
This flag indicates whether the shifted buffer is loaded with a correctly received message (matching identifier,
matching cyclic redundancy code (CRC) and no other errors detected). After the CPU has read that message
from the RxFG buffer in the receiver FIFO, the RXF flag must be cleared to release the buffer. A set RXF flag
prohibits the shifting of the next FIFO entry into the foreground buffer (RxFG). If not masked, a receive interrupt
is pending while this flag is set.
0 No new message available within the RxFG
1 The receiver FIFO is not empty. A new message is available in the RxFG
1. Redundant Information for the most critical CAN bus status which is “bus-off”. This only occurs if the Tx error counter exceeds
a number of 255 errors. Bus-off affects the receiver state. As soon as the transmitter leaves its bus-off state the receiver state
skips to RxOK too. Refer also to TSTAT[1:0] coding in this register.
2. To ensure data integrity, do not read the receive buffer registers while the RXF flag is cleared. For MCUs with dual CPUs,
reading the receive buffer registers while the RXF flag is cleared may result in a CPU fault condition.
Module Base + 0x0005 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
76543210
R
WUPIE CSCIE RSTATE1 RSTATE0 TSTATE1 TSTATE0 OVRIE RXFIE
W
Reset:00000000
Figure 11-9. MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)
Table 11-10. CANRFLG Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
432 Freescale Semiconductor
11.3.2.7 MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)
The transmit buffer empty flags each have an associated interrupt enable bit in the CANTIER register.
Table 11-11. CANRIER Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
WUPIE(1)
1. WUPIE and WUPE (see Section 11.3.2.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”) must both be enabled if the recovery
mechanism from stop or wait is required.
Wake-Up Interrup t Enable
0 No interrupt request is generated from this event.
1 A wake-up event causes a Wake-Up interrupt request.
6
CSCIE
CAN Status Change Interrupt Enable
0 No interrupt request is generated from this event.
1 A CAN Status Change event causes an error interrupt request.
5-4
RSTATE[1:0
]
Receiver St atus Change Enable These RSTAT enable bits control the sensitivity level in which receiver state
changes are causing CSCIF interrupts. Independent of the chosen sensitivity level the RSTAT flags continue to
indicate the actual receiver state and are only updated if no CSCIF interrupt is pending.
00 Do not generate any CSCIF interrupt caused by receiver state changes.
01 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the receiver enters or leaves “bus-off” state. Discard other receiver state
changes for generating CSCIF interrupt.
10 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the receiver enters or leaves “RxErr” or “bus-off”(2) state. Discard other
receiver state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt.
11 Generate CSCIF interrupt on all state changes.
2. Bus-off state is only defined for transmitters by the CAN standard (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification). Because the
only possible state change for the transmitter from bus-off to TxOK also forces the receiver to skip its current state to RxOK,
the coding of the RXSTAT[1:0] flags define an additional bus-off state for the receiver (see Section 11.3.2.5, “MSCAN Receiver
Flag Register (CANRFLG)”).
3-2
TSTATE[1:0]
T ransmitter S tatus Change Enable These TSTAT enable bits control the sensitivity level in which transmitter
state changes are causing CSCIF interrupts. Independent of the chosen sensitivity level, the TSTAT flags
continue to indicate the actual transmitter state and are only updated if no CSCIF interrupt is pending.
00 Do not generate any CSCIF interrupt caused by transmitter state changes.
01 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the transmitter enters or leaves “bus-off” state. Discard other transmitter
state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt.
10 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the transmitter enters or leaves “TxErr” or “bus-off” state. Discard other
transmitter state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt.
11 Generate CSCIF interrupt on all state changes.
1
OVRIE
Overrun Interrupt Enable
0 No interrupt request is generated from this event.
1 An overrun event causes an error interrupt request.
0
RXFIE
Receiver Full Interrupt Enable
0 No interrupt request is generated from this event.
1 A receive buffer full (successful message reception) event causes a receiver interrupt request.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 433
NOTE
The CANTFLG register is held in the reset state when the initialization
mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable
when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
11.3.2.8 MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)
This register contains the interrupt enable bits for the transmit buffer empty interrupt flags.
Module Base + 0x0006 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode; write of 1 clears flag, write of 0 is ignored
76543210
R0 0000
TXE2 TXE1 TXE0
W
Reset:00000111
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-10. MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)
Table 11-12. CANTFLG Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2-0
TXE[2:0]
T ransmitter Buffer EmptyThis flag indicates that the associated transmit message buffer is empty, and thus
not scheduled for transmission. The CPU must clear the flag after a message is set up in the transmit buffer and
is due for transmission. The MSCAN sets the flag after the message is sent successfully. The flag is also set by
the MSCAN when the transmission request is successfully aborted due to a pending abort request (see
Section 11.3.2.9, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)”). If not masked, a
transmit interrupt is pending while this flag is set.
Clearing a TXEx flag also clears the corresponding ABTAKx (see Section 11.3.2.10, “MSCAN Transmitter
Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)”). When a TXEx flag is set, the corresponding ABTRQx bit
is cleared (see Section 11.3.2.9, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)”).
When listen-mode is active (see Section 11.3.2.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”) the TXEx flags
cannot be cleared and no transmission is started.
Read and write accesses to the transmit buffer will be blocked, if the corresponding TXEx bit is cleared
(TXEx = 0) and the buffer is scheduled for transmission.
0 The associated message buffer is full (loaded with a message due for transmission)
1 The associated message buffer is empty (not scheduled)
Module Base + 0x0007 Access: User read/write(1)
76543210
R00000
TXEIE2 TXEIE1 TXEIE0
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-11. MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
434 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
The CANTIER register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode
is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable when not
in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
11.3.2.9 MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)
The CANTARQ register allows abort request of queued messages as described below.
NOTE
The CANTARQ register is held in the reset state when the initialization
mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable
when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
Table 11-13. CANTIER Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2-0
TXEIE[2:0]
Transmitter Empty Interrup t Enable
0 No interrupt request is generated from this event.
1 A transmitter empty (transmit buffer available for transmission) event causes a transmitter empty interrupt
request.
Module Base + 0x0008 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
76543210
R00000
ABTRQ2 ABTRQ1 ABTRQ0
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-12. MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)
Table 11-14. CANTARQ Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2-0
ABTRQ[2:0]
Abort Request — The CPU sets the ABTRQx bit to request that a scheduled message buffer (TXEx = 0) be
aborted. The MSCAN grants the request if the message has not already started transmission, or if the
transmission is not successful (lost arbitration or error). When a message is aborted, the associated TXE (see
Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and abort acknowledge flags (ABTAK, see
Section 11.3.2.10, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)”) are set and a
transmit interrupt occurs if enabled. The CPU cannot reset ABTRQx. ABTRQx is reset whenever the associated
TXE flag is set.
0 No abort request
1 Abort request pending
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 435
11.3.2.10 MSCAN Tran smitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)
The CANTAAK register indicates the successful abort of a queued message, if requested by the
appropriate bits in the CANTARQ register.
NOTE
The CANTAAK register is held in the reset state when the initialization
mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1).
11.3.2.11 MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)
The CANTBSEL register allows the selection of the actual transmit message buffer, which then will be
accessible in the CANTXFG register space.
Module Base + 0x0009 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Unimplemented
76543210
R00000ABTAK2 ABTAK1 ABTAK0
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-13. MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)
Table 11-15 . CANTAAK Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2-0
ABTAK[2:0]
Abort Acknowledge — This flag acknowledges that a message was aborted due to a pending abort request
from the CPU. After a particular message buffer is flagged empty, this flag can be used by the application
software to identify whether the message was aborted successfully or was sent anyway. The ABTAKx flag is
cleared whenever the corresponding TXE flag is cleared.
0 The message was not aborted.
1 The message was aborted.
Module Base + 0x000A Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Find the lowest ordered bit set to 1, all other bits will be read as 0
Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
76543210
R00000
TX2 TX1 TX0
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-14. MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
436 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
The CANTBSEL register is held in the reset state when the initialization
mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK=1). This register is writable when
not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
The following gives a short programming example of the usage of the CANTBSEL register:
To get the next available transmit buf fer , application software must read the CANTFLG register and write
this value back into the CANTBSEL register. In this example Tx buf fers TX1 and TX2 are available. The
value read from CANTFLG is therefore 0b0000_01 10. When writing this value back to CANTBSEL, the
Tx buffer TX1 is selected in the CANTXFG because the lowest numbered bit set to 1 is at bit position 1.
Reading back this value out of CANTBSEL results in 0b0000_0010, because only the lowest numbered
bit position set to 1 is presented. This mechanism eases the application software’s selection of the next
available Tx buffer.
LDAA CANTFLG; value read is 0b0000_0110
STAA CANTBSEL; value written is 0b0000_0110
LDAA CANTBSEL; value read is 0b0000_0010
If all transmit message buffers are deselected, no accesses are allowed to the CANTXFG registers.
11.3.2.12 MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)
The CANIDAC register is used for identifier acceptance control as described below.
Table 11-16. CANTBSEL Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2-0
TX[2:0]
Transmit Buffer Select — The lowest numbered bit places the respective transmit buffer in the CANTXFG
register space (e.g., TX1 = 1 and TX0 = 1 selects transmit buffer TX0; TX1 = 1 and TX0 = 0 selects transmit buffer
TX1). Read and write accesses to the selected transmit buffer will be blocked, if the corresponding TXEx bit is
cleared and the buffer is scheduled for transmission (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register
(CANTFLG)”).
0 The associated message buffer is deselected
1 The associated message buffer is selected, if lowest numbered bit
Module Base + 0x000B Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1), except bits IDHITx, which are read-only
76543210
R0 0
IDAM1 IDAM0
0 IDHIT2 IDHIT1 IDHIT0
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-15. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 437
The IDHITx indicators are always related to the message in the foreground buffer (RxFG). When a
message gets shifted into the foreground buffer of the receiver FIFO the indicators are updated as well.
11.3.2.13 MSCAN Reserved Register
This register is reserved for factory testing of the MSCAN module and is not available in normal system
operating modes.
Ta ble 11-17. CANIDAC Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
5-4
IDAM[1:0]
Identifier Acceptance Mode — The CPU sets these flags to define the identifier acceptance filter organization
(see Section 11.4.3, “Identifier Acceptance Filter”). Table 11-18 summarizes the different settings. In filter closed
mode, no message is accepted such that the foreground buffer is never reloaded.
2-0
IDHIT[2:0]
Identifier Acceptance Hit Indicator — The MSCAN sets these flags to indicate an identifier acceptance hit (see
Section 11.4.3, “Identifier Acceptance Filter”). Table 11-19 summarizes the different settings.
Table 11-18. Identifier Acceptance Mode Settings
IDAM1 IDAM0 Identifier Acceptance Mode
0 0 Two 32-bit acceptance filters
0 1 Four 16-bit acceptance filters
1 0 Eight 8-bit acceptance filters
1 1 Filter closed
Table 11-19. Identifier Acceptance Hit Indication
IDHIT2 IDHIT1 IDHIT0 Identifier Acceptance Hit
0 0 0 Filter 0 hit
0 0 1 Filter 1 hit
0 1 0 Filter 2 hit
0 1 1 Filter 3 hit
1 0 0 Filter 4 hit
1 0 1 Filter 5 hit
1 1 0 Filter 6 hit
1 1 1 Filter 7 hit
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
438 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
Writing to this register when in special system operating modes can alter the
MSCAN functionality.
11.3.2.14 MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC)
This register provides additional features.
11.3.2.15 MSCAN Receive Error Counter (CANRXERR)
This register reflects the status of the MSCAN receive error counter.
Module Base + 0x000C Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Always reads zero in normal system operation modes
Write: Unimplemented in normal system operation modes
76543210
R00000000
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-16. MSCAN Reserved Register
Module Base + 0x000D Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; write of ‘1’ clears flag; write of ‘0’ ignored
76543210
R0000000
BOHOLD
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-17. MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC)
Table 11-20. CANMISC Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
0
BOHOLD
Bus-off State Hold Until User Request — If BORM is set in MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1), this bit
indicates whether the module has entered the bus-off state. Clearing this bit requests the recovery from bus-off.
Refer to Section 11.5.2, “Bus-Off Recovery,” for details.
0 Module is not bus-off or recovery has been requested by user in bus-off state
1 Module is bus-off and holds this state until user request
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 439
NOTE
Reading this register when in any other mode other than sleep or
initialization mode may return an incorrect value. For MCUs with dual
CPUs, this may result in a CPU fault condition.
11.3.2.16 MSCAN Transmit Error Counter (CANTXERR)
This register reflects the status of the MSCAN transmit error counter.
NOTE
Reading this register when in any other mode other than sleep or
initialization mode, may return an incorrect value. For MCUs with dual
CPUs, this may result in a CPU fault condition.
Module Base + 0x000E Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Only when in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) or initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Write: Unimplemented
76543210
R RXERR7 RXERR6 RXERR5 RXERR4 RXERR3 RXERR2 RXERR1 RXERR0
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-18. MSCAN Receive Error Counter (CANRXERR)
Module Base + 0x000F Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Only when in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) or initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Write: Unimplemented
76543210
R TXERR7 TXERR6 TXERR5 TXERR4 TXERR3 TXERR2 TXERR1 TXERR0
W
Reset:00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-19. MSCAN Transmit Error Counter (CANTXERR)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
440 Freescale Semiconductor
11.3.2.17 MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (CANIDAR0-7)
On reception, each message is written into the background receive buffer. The CPU is only signalled to
read the message if it passes the criteria in the identifier acceptance and identifier mask registers
(accepted); otherwise, the message is overwritten by the next message (dropped).
The acceptance registers of the MSCAN are applied on the IDR0–IDR3 registers (see Section 11.3.3.1,
“Identifier Registers (IDR0–IDR3)”) of incoming messages in a bit by bit manner (see Section 11.4.3,
“Identifier Acceptance Filter”).
For extended identifiers, all four acceptance and mask registers are applied. For standard identifiers, only
the first two (CANIDAR0/1, CANIDMR0/1) are applied.
Module Base + 0x0010 to Module Base + 0x0013 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
76543210
R
AC7 AC6 AC5 AC4 AC3 AC2 AC1 AC0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 11-20. MS CAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (First Bank) — CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3
Table 11-21. CANIDAR 0–CAN IDAR 3 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
AC[7:0]
Acceptance Code Bits — AC[7:0] comprise a user-defined sequence of bits with which the corresponding bits
of the related identifier register (IDRn) of the receive message buffer are compared. The result of this comparison
is then masked with the corresponding identifier mask register.
Module Base + 0x0018 to Module Base + 0x001B Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
76543210
R
AC7 AC6 AC5 AC4 AC3 AC2 AC1 AC0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 11-21. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (Second Bank) — CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 441
11.3.2.18 MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7)
The identifier mask register specifies which of the corresponding bits in the identifier acceptance register
are relevant for acceptance filtering. To receive standard identifiers in 32 bit filter mode, it is required to
program the last three bits (AM[2:0]) in the mask registers CANIDMR1 and CANIDMR5 to “don’t care.”
To receive standard identifiers in 16 bit filter mode, it is required to program the last three bits (AM[2:0])
in the mask registers CANIDMR1, CANIDMR3, CANIDMR5, and CANIDMR7 to “don’t care.”
Table 11-22. CANIDAR 4–CAN IDAR 7 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
AC[7:0]
Acceptance Code Bits — AC[7:0] comprise a user-defined sequence of bits with which the corresponding bits
of the related identifier register (IDRn) of the receive message buffer are compared. The result of this comparison
is then masked with the corresponding identifier mask register.
Module Base + 0x0014 to Module Base + 0x0017 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
76543210
R
AM7 AM6 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 11-22. MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (First Bank) — CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3
Table 11-23. CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
AM[7:0]
Acceptance Mask Bit s — If a particular bit in this register is cleared, this indicates that the corresponding bit in
the identifier acceptance register must be the same as its identifier bit before a match is detected. The message
is accepted if all such bits match. If a bit is set, it indicates that the state of the corresponding bit in the identifier
acceptance register does not affect whether or not the message is accepted.
0 Match corresponding acceptance code register and identifier bits
1 Ignore corresponding acceptance code register bit
Module Base + 0x001C to Module Base + 0x001F Access: User read/write(1)
76543210
R
AM7 AM6 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 11-23. MS CAN Identifier Mask Registers (Second Bank) — CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
442 Freescale Semiconductor
11.3.3 Programmers Model of Message S torage
The following section details the organization of the receive and transmit message buffers and the
associated control registers.
To simplify the programmer interface, the receive and transmit message buffers have the same outline.
Each message buffer allocates 16 bytes in the memory map containing a 13 byte data structure.
An additional transmit buffer priority register (TBPR) is defined for the transmit buffers. Within the last
two bytes of this memory map, the MSCAN stores a special 16-bit time stamp, which is sampled from an
internal timer after successful transmission or reception of a message. This feature is only available for
transmit and receiver buffers, if the TIME bit is set (see Section 11.3.2.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0
(CANCTL0)”).
The time stamp register is written by the MSCAN. The CPU can only read these registers.
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 11-24. CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
AM[7:0]
Acceptance Mask Bit s — If a particular bit in this register is cleared, this indicates that the corresponding bit in
the identifier acceptance register must be the same as its identifier bit before a match is detected. The message
is accepted if all such bits match. If a bit is set, it indicates that the state of the corresponding bit in the identifier
acceptance register does not affect whether or not the message is accepted.
0 Match corresponding acceptance code register and identifier bits
1 Ignore corresponding acceptance code register bit
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 443
Figure 11-24 shows the common 13-byte data structure of receive and transmit buffers for extended
identifiers. The mapping of standard identifiers into the IDR registers is shown in Figure 11-25.
All bits of the receive and transmit buffers are ‘x’ out of reset because of RAM-based implementation1.
All reserved or unused bits of the receive and transmit buffers always read ‘x’.
Table 11-25. Message Buffer Organization
Offset
Address Register Access
0x00X0 IDR0 — Identifier Register 0 R/W
0x00X1 IDR1 — Identifier Register 1 R/W
0x00X2 IDR2 — Identifier Register 2 R/W
0x00X3 IDR3 — Identifier Register 3 R/W
0x00X4 DSR0 — Data Segment Register 0 R/W
0x00X5 DSR1 — Data Segment Register 1 R/W
0x00X6 DSR2 — Data Segment Register 2 R/W
0x00X7 DSR3 — Data Segment Register 3 R/W
0x00X8 DSR4 — Data Segment Register 4 R/W
0x00X9 DSR5 — Data Segment Register 5 R/W
0x00XA DSR6 — Data Segment Register 6 R/W
0x00XB DSR7 — Data Segment Register 7 R/W
0x00XC DLR — Data Length Register R/W
0x00XD TBPR — Transmit Buffer Priority Register(1)
1. Not applicable for receive buffers
R/W
0x00XE TSRH — Time Stamp Register (High Byte) R
0x00XF TSRL — Time Stamp Register (Low Byte) R
1. Exception: The transmit buffer priority registers are 0 out of reset.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
444 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 11-24. Receive/Transmit Message Buffer — Extended Identifier Mapping
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit0
0x00X0
IDR0
R
ID28 ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 ID23 ID22 ID21
W
0x00X1
IDR1
R
ID20 ID19 ID18 SRR (=1) IDE (=1) ID17 ID16 ID15
W
0x00X2
IDR2
R
ID14 ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 ID7
W
0x00X3
IDR3
R
ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 RTR
W
0x00X4
DSR0
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00X5
DSR1
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00X6
DSR2
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00X7
DSR3
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00X8
DSR4
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00X9
DSR5
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00XA
DSR6
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00XB
DSR7
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
0x00XC
DLR
R
DLC3 DLC2 DLC1 DLC0
W
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 445
Read:
For transmit buffers, anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter
Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see
Section 11.3.2.11, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”).
For receive buffers, only when RXF flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.5, “MSCAN Receiver Flag
Register (CANRFLG)”).
Write:
For transmit buffers, anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter
Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see
Section 11.3.2.11, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”).
Unimplemented for receive buffers.
Reset: Undefined because of RAM-based implementation
11.3.3.1 Identifier Registers (IDR0–IDR3)
The identifier registers for an extended format identifier consist of a total of 32 bits: ID[28:0], SRR, IDE,
and RTR. The identifier registers for a standard format identifier consist of a total of 13 bits: ID[10:0],
RTR, and IDE.
= Unused, always read ‘x’
Figure 11-25. Receiv e/Transmit Message Buffer — Standard Identifier Mapping
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
IDR0
0x00X0
R
ID10 ID9 ID8 ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3
W
IDR1
0x00X1
R
ID2 ID1 ID0 RTR IDE (=0)
W
IDR2
0x00X2
R
W
IDR3
0x00X3
R
W
= Unused, always read ‘x’
Figure 11-24. Receive/Transmit Message Buffer — Extended Identifier Mapping (continued)
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit0
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
446 Freescale Semiconductor
11.3.3.1.1 IDR0–IDR3 for Extended Identi fier Mapping
Module Base + 0x00X0
76543210
R
ID28 ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 ID23 ID22 ID21
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-26. Identifier Register 0 (IDR0) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 11-26. IDR0 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field Description
7-0
ID[28:21]
Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the
most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an
identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
Module Base + 0x00X1
76543210
R
ID20 ID19 ID18 SRR (=1) IDE (=1) ID17 ID16 ID15
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-27. Identifier Register 1 (IDR1) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 11-27. IDR1 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field Description
7-5
ID[20:18]
Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the
most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an
identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
4
SRR
Substitute Remote Request — This fixed recessive bit is used only in extended format. It must be set to 1 by
the user for transmission buffers and is stored as received on the CAN bus for receive buffers.
3
IDE
ID Extended This flag indicates whether the extended or standard identifier format is applied in this buffer. In
the case of a receive buffer, the flag is set as received and indicates to the CPU how to process the buffer
identifier registers. In the case of a transmit buffer, the flag indicates to the MSCAN what type of identifier to send.
0 Standard format (11 bit)
1 Extended format (29 bit)
2-0
ID[17:15]
Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the
most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an
identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 447
Module Base + 0x00X2
76543210
R
ID14 ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 ID7
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-28. Identifier Register 2 (IDR2) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 11-28. IDR2 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field Description
7-0
ID[14:7]
Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the
most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an
identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
Module Base + 0x00X3
76543210
R
ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 RTR
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-29. Identifier Register 3 (IDR3) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 11-29. IDR3 Register Field Descriptions — Extended
Field Description
7-1
ID[6:0]
Extended Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the
most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an
identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
0
RTR
Remote Transmission Request This flag reflects the status of the remote transmission request bit in the CAN
frame. In the case of a receive buffer, it indicates the status of the received frame and supports the transmission
of an answering frame in software. In the case of a transmit buffer, this flag defines the setting of the RTR bit to
be sent.
0 Data frame
1 Remote frame
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
448 Freescale Semiconductor
11.3.3.1.2 IDR0–IDR3 for Standard Identifier Mapping
Module Base + 0x00X0
76543210
R
ID10ID9ID8ID7ID6ID5ID4ID3
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-30. Ident ifier Register 0 — Standard Mapping
Table 11-30. IDR0 Register Field Descriptions Standard
Field Description
7-0
ID[10:3]
Standard Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 11 bits (ID[10:0]) for the standard format. ID10 is the
most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an
identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. See also ID bits in Table 11-31.
Module Base + 0x00X1
76543210
R
ID2 ID1 ID0 RTR IDE (=0)
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
= Unused; always read ‘x’
Figure 11-31. Ident ifier Register 1 — Standard Mapping
Table 11-31. IDR 1 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-5
ID[2:0]
Standard Format Identifier — The identifiers consist of 11 bits (ID[10:0]) for the standard format. ID10 is the
most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an
identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. See also ID bits in Table 11-30.
4
RTR
Remote Transmission RequestThis flag reflects the status of the Remote Transmission Request bit in the
CAN frame. In the case of a receive buffer, it indicates the status of the received frame and supports the
transmission of an answering frame in software. In the case of a transmit buffer, this flag defines the setting of
the RTR bit to be sent.
0 Data frame
1 Remote frame
3
IDE
ID Extended This flag indicates whether the extended or standard identifier format is applied in this buffer. In
the case of a receive buffer, the flag is set as received and indicates to the CPU how to process the buffer
identifier registers. In the case of a transmit buffer, the flag indicates to the MSCAN what type of identifier to send.
0 Standard format (11 bit)
1 Extended format (29 bit)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 449
11.3.3.2 Data Segment Registers (DSR0-7)
The eight data segment registers, each with bits DB[7:0], contain the data to be transmitted or received.
The number of bytes to be transmitted or received is determined by the data length code in the
corresponding DLR register.
Module Base + 0x00X2
76543210
R
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
= Unused; always read ‘x’
Figure 11-32. Ident ifier Register 2 — Standard Mapping
Module Base + 0x00X3
76543210
R
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
= Unused; always read ‘x’
Figure 11-33. Ident ifier Register 3 — Standard Mapping
Module Base + 0x00X4 to Module Base + 0x00XB
76543210
R
DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-34. Data Segment Registers (DSR0–DSR7) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 11-32. DSR0–DSR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0
DB[7:0]
Data bits 7-0
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
450 Freescale Semiconductor
11.3.3.3 Data Length Register (DLR)
This register keeps the data length field of the CAN frame.
11.3.3.4 Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)
This register defines the local priority of the associated message buffer. The local priority is used for the
internal prioritization process of the MSCAN and is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
The MSCAN implements the following internal prioritization mechanisms:
All transmission buffers with a cleared TXEx flag participate in the prioritization immediately
before the SOF (start of frame) is sent.
Module Base + 0x00XC
76543210
R
DLC3 DLC2 DLC1 DLC0
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
= Unused; always read “x”
Figure 11-35. Dat a Length Register (DLR) — Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 11-33. DLR Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
3-0
DLC[3:0]
Data Length Code Bits The data length code contains the number of bytes (data byte count) of the respective
message. During the transmission of a remote frame, the data length code is transmitted as programmed while
the number of transmitted data bytes is always 0. The data byte count ranges from 0 to 8 for a data frame.
Table 11-34 shows the effect of setting the DLC bits.
Table 11-34. Data Length Codes
Data Length Code Data Byte
Count
DLC3 DLC2 DLC1 DLC0
00000
00011
00102
00113
01004
01015
01106
01117
10008
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 451
The transmission buffer with the lowest local priority field wins the prioritization.
In cases of more than one buffer having the same lowe st priority, the message buf fer with the lower index
number wins.
11.3.3.5 Time Stamp Register (TSRH–TSRL)
If the TIME bit is enabled, the MSCAN will write a time stamp to the respective registers in the active
transmit or receive buffer right after the EOF of a valid message on the CAN bus (see Section 11.3.2.1,
“MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)”). In case of a transmission, the CPU can only read the time
stamp after the respective transmit buffer has been flagged empty.
The timer value, which is used for stamping, is taken from a free running internal CAN bit clock. A timer
overrun is not indicated by the MSCAN. The timer is reset (all bits set to 0) during initialization mode. The
CPU can only read the time stamp registers.
Module Base + 0x00XD Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the
corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 11.3.2.11, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register
(CANTBSEL)”)
Write: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)”) and the
corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 11.3.2.11, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register
(CANTBSEL)”)
76543210
R
PRIO7 PRIO6 PRIO5 PRIO4 PRIO3 PRIO2 PRIO1 PRIO0
W
Reset:00000000
Figure 11-36. Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)
Module Base + 0x00XE Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: For transmit buffers: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register
(CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 11.3.2.11, “MSCAN Transmit
Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”). For receive buffers: Anytime when RXF is set.
Write: Unimplemented
76543210
R TSR15 TSR14 TSR13 TSR12 TSR11 TSR10 TSR9 TSR8
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-37. Time Stamp Register — High Byte (TSRH)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
452 Freescale Semiconductor
Module Base + 0x00XF Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: or transmit buffers: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register
(CANTFLG)”) and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 11.3.2.11, “MSCAN Transmit
Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)”). For receive buffers: Anytime when RXF is set.
Write: Unimplemented
76543210
R TSR7 TSR6 TSR5 TSR4 TSR3 TSR2 TSR1 TSR0
W
Reset:xxxxxxxx
Figure 11-38. Time Stamp Register — Low Byte (TSRL)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 453
11.4 Functional Description
11.4.1 General
This section provides a complete functional description of the MSCAN.
11.4.2 Message Storage
Figure 11-39. User Model for Mes sage Buffer Organization
MSCAN
Rx0
Rx1
CAN Receive / Transmit Engine Memory Mapped I/O
CPU bus
MSCAN
Tx2
TXE2
PRIO
Receiver
Transmitter
RxBG
TxBG
Tx0
TXE0
PRIO
TxBG
Tx1
PRIO
TXE1
TxFG
CPU bus
Rx2
Rx3
Rx4
RXF
RxFG
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
454 Freescale Semiconductor
The MSCAN facilitates a sophisticated message storage system which addresses the requirements of a
broad range of network applications.
11.4.2.1 Message Transmit Background
Modern application layer software is built upon two fundamental assumptions:
Any CAN node is able to send out a stream of scheduled messages without releasing the CAN bus
between the two messages. Such nodes arbitrate for the CAN bus immediately after sending the
previous message and only release the CAN bus in case of lost arbitration.
The internal message queue within any CAN node is organized such that the highest priority
message is sent out first, if more than one message is ready to be sent.
The behavior described in the bullets above cannot be achieved with a single transmit buffer. That buf fer
must be reloaded immediately after the previous message is sent. This loading process lasts a finite amount
of time and must be completed within the inter-frame sequence (IFS) to be able to send an uninterrupted
stream of messages. Even if this is feasible for limited CAN bus speeds, it requires that the CPU reacts
with short latencies to the transmit interrupt.
A double buffer scheme de-couples the reloading of the transmit buffer from the actual message sending
and, therefore, reduces the reactiveness requirements of the CPU. Problems can arise if the sending of a
message is finished while the CPU re-loads the second buffer. No buffer would then be ready for
transmission, and the CAN bus would be released.
At least three transmit buffers are required to meet the first of the above requirements under all
circumstances. The MSCAN has three transmit buffers.
The second requirement calls for some sort of internal prioritization which the MSCAN implements with
the “local priority” concept described in Section 11.4.2.2, “Transmit Structures.”
11.4.2.2 Transmit Structures
The MSCAN triple transmit buffer scheme optimizes real-time performance by allowing multiple
messages to be set up in advance. The three buffers are arranged as shown in Figure 11-39.
All three buffers have a 13-byte data structure similar to the outline of the receive buffers (see
Section 11.3.3, “Programmers Model of Message Storage”). An additional Transmit Buffer Priority
Register (TBPR) contains an 8-bit local priority field (PRIO) (see Section 11.3.3.4, “Transmit Buffer
Priority Register (TBPR)”). The remaining two bytes are used for time stamping of a message, if required
(see Section 11.3.3.5, “Time Stamp Register (TSRH–TSRL)”).
To transmit a message, the CPU must identify an available transmit buffer, which is indicated by a set
transmitter buffer empty (TXEx) flag (see Section 11.3.2.7, “MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register
(CANTFLG)”). If a transmit buffer is available, the CPU must set a pointer to this buf fer by writing to the
CANTBSEL register (see Section 11.3.2.11, “MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register
(CANTBSEL)”). This makes the respective buffer accessible within the CANTXFG address space (see
Section 1 1.3.3, “Programmers Model of Message Storage ”). The algorithmic feature associated with the
CANTBSEL register simplifies the transmit buffer selection. In addition, this scheme makes the handler
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 455
software simpler because only one address area is applicable for the transmit process, and the required
address space is minimized.
The CPU then stores the identifier, the control bits, and the data content into one of the transmit buffers.
Finally, the buffer is flagged as ready for transmission by clearing the associated TXE flag.
The MSCAN then schedules the message for transmission and signals the successful transmission of the
buffer by setting the associated TXE flag. A transmit interrupt (see Section 11.4.7.2, “T ransmit Interrupt”)
is generated1 when TXEx is set and can be used to drive the application software to re-load the buffer.
If more than one buffer is scheduled for transmission when the CAN bus becomes available for arbitration,
the MSCAN uses the local priority setting of the three buffers to determine the prioritization. For this
purpose, every transmit buffer has an 8-bit local priority field (PRIO). The application software programs
this field when the message is set up. The local priority reflects the priority of this particular message
relative to the set of messages being transmitted from this node. The lowest binary value of the PRIO field
is defined to be the highest priority. The internal scheduling process takes place whenever the MSCAN
arbitrates for the CAN bus. This is also the case after the occurrence of a transmission error.
When a high priority message is scheduled by the application software, it may become n ecessary to abort
a lower priority message in one of the three transmit buffers. Because messages that are already in
transmission cannot be aborted, the user must request the abort by setting the corresponding abort request
bit (ABTRQ) (see Section 11.3.2.9, “MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register
(CANTARQ)”.) The MSCAN then grants the request, if possible, by:
1. Setting the corresponding abort acknowledge flag (ABTAK) in the CANTAAK register.
2. Setting the associated TXE flag to release the buffer.
3. Generating a transmit interrupt. The transmit interrupt handler software can determine from the
setting of the ABTAK flag whether the message was aborted (ABTAK = 1) or sent (ABTAK = 0).
11.4.2.3 Receive Structures
The received messages are stored in a five stage input FIFO. The five message buffers are alternately
mapped into a single memory area (see Figure 11-39). The background receive buffer (RxBG) is
exclusively associated with the MSCAN, but the foreground receive buffer (RxFG) is addressable by the
CPU (see Figure 11-39). This scheme simplifies the handler software because only one address area is
applicable for the receive process.
All receive buffers have a size of 15 bytes to store the CAN control bits, the identifier (standard or
extended), the data contents, and a time stamp, if enabled (see Section 11.3.3, “Programmers Model of
Message Storage”).
The receiver full flag (RXF) (see Section 11.3.2.5, “MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)”)
signals the status of the foreground receive buf fer. When the buffer contains a correctly received message
with a matching identifier, this flag is set.
On reception, each message is checked to see whether it passes the filter (see Section 11.4.3, “Identifier
Acceptance Filter”) and simultaneously is written into the active RxBG. After successful reception of a
valid message, the MSCAN shifts the content of RxBG into the receiver FIFO, sets the RXF flag, and
1. The transmit interrupt occurs only if not masked. A polling scheme can be applied on TXEx also.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
456 Freescale Semiconductor
generates a receive interrupt1 (see Section 11.4.7.3, “Receive Interrupt”) to the CPU. The users receive
handler must read the received message from the RxFG and then reset the RXF flag to acknowledge the
interrupt and to release the foreground buffer. A new message, which can follow immediately after the IFS
field of the CAN frame, is received into the next available RxBG. If the MSCAN receives an invalid
message in its RxBG (wrong identifier, transmission errors, etc.) the actual contents of the buffer will be
over-written by the next message. The buffer will then not be shifted into the FIFO.
When the MSCAN module is transmitting, the MSCAN receives its own transmitted messages into the
background receive buffer , RxBG, but does not shift it into the receiver FIFO, generate a receive interrupt,
or acknowledge its own messages on the CAN bus. The exception to this rule is in loopback mode (see
Section 11.3.2.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”) where the MSCAN treats its own messages
exactly like all other incoming messages. The MSCAN receives its own transmitted messages in the event
that it loses arbitration. If arbitration is lost, the MSCAN must be prepared to become a receiver.
An overrun condition occurs when all receive message buffers in the FIFO are filled with correctly
received messages with accepted identifiers and another mess age is correctly received from the CAN bus
with an accepted identifier. The latter message is discarded and an er ror interrupt with overrun indication
is generated if enabled (see Section 11.4.7.5, “Error Interrupt”). The MSCAN remains able to transmit
messages while the receiver FIFO is being filled, but all incoming messages are discarded. As soon as a
receive buffer in the FIFO is available again, new valid messages will be accepted.
11.4.3 Identifier Acceptance Filter
The MSCAN identifier acceptance registers (see Section 11.3.2.12, “MSCAN Identifier Acceptance
Control Register (CANIDAC)”) define the acceptable patterns of the standard or extended identifier
(ID[10:0] or ID[28:0]). Any of these bits can be marked ‘don’t care’ in the MSCAN identifier mask
registers (see Section 11.3.2.18, “MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7)”).
A filter hit is indicated to the applica tion software by a set receive buffe r full flag (RXF = 1) and three bits
in the CANIDAC register (see Section 11.3.2.12, “MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register
(CANIDAC)”). These identifier hit flags (IDHIT[2:0]) clearly identify the filter section that caused the
acceptance. They simplify the application software’s task to identify the cause of the receiver interrupt. If
more than one hit occurs (two or more filters match), the lower hit has priority.
A very flexible programmable generic identifier acceptance filter has been introduced to reduce the CPU
interrupt loading. The filter is programmable to operate in four different modes:
Two identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to:
The full 29 bits of the extended identifier and to the following bits of the CAN 2.0B frame:
Remote transmission request (RTR)
Identifier extension (IDE)
Substitute remote request (SRR)
The 1 1 bits of the standard identifier plus the RTR and IDE bits of the CAN 2.0A/B messages.
This mode implements two filters for a full length CAN 2.0B compliant extended identifier.
Although this mode can be used for standard identifiers, it is recommended to use the four or
eight identifier acceptance filters.
1. The receive interrupt occurs only if not masked. A polling scheme can be applied on RXF also.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 457
Figure 11-40 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3,
CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3) produces a filter 0 hit. Similarly, the second filter bank
(CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7) produces a filter 1 hit.
Four identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to:
The 14 most significant bits of the extended identifier plus the SRR and IDE bits of CAN 2.0B
messages.
The 11 bits of the standard identifier, the RTR and IDE bits of CAN 2.0A/B messages.
Figure 11-41 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3,
CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3) produces filter 0 and 1 hits. Similarly, the second filter bank
(CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7) produces filter 2 and 3 hits.
Eight identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to the first 8 bits of the identifier. This mode
implements eight independent filters for the first 8 bits of a CAN 2.0A/B compliant standard
identifier or a CAN 2.0B compliant extended identifier.
Figure 11-42 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0–CANIDAR3,
CANIDMR0–CANIDMR3) produces filter 0 to 3 hits. Similarly, the second filter bank
(CANIDAR4–CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4–CANIDMR7) produces filter 4 to 7 hits.
Closed filter. No CAN message is copied into the foreground buffer RxFG, and the RXF flag is
never set.
Figure 11-40. 32-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filter
ID28 ID21IDR0
ID10 ID3IDR0
ID20 ID15IDR1
ID2 IDEIDR1
ID14 ID7IDR2
ID10 ID3IDR2
ID6 RTRIDR3
ID10 ID3IDR3
AC7 AC0CANIDAR0
AM7 AM0CANIDMR0
AC7 AC0CANIDAR1
AM7 AM0CANIDMR1
AC7 AC0CANIDAR2
AM7 AM0CANIDMR2
AC7 AC0CANIDAR3
AM7 AM0CANIDMR3
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
CAN 2.0B
Extended Identifier
CAN 2.0A/B
Standard Identifier
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
458 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 11-41. 16-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filters
ID28 ID21IDR0
ID10 ID3IDR0
ID20 ID15IDR1
ID2 IDEIDR1
ID14 ID7IDR2
ID10 ID3IDR2
ID6 RTRIDR3
ID10 ID3IDR3
AC7 AC0CANIDAR0
AM7 AM0CANIDMR0
AC7 AC0CANIDAR1
AM7 AM0CANIDMR1
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
AC7 AC0CANIDAR2
AM7 AM0CANIDMR2
AC7 AC0CANIDAR3
AM7 AM0CANIDMR3
ID Accepted (Filter 1 Hit)
CAN 2.0B
Extended Identifier
CAN 2.0A/B
Standard Identifier
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 459
Figure 11-42. 8-bit Ma skable Identifier Acceptance Filters
CAN 2.0B
Extended Identifier
CAN 2.0A/B
Standard Identifier
AC7 AC0CIDAR3
AM7 AM0CIDMR3
ID Accepted (Filter 3 Hit)
AC7 AC0CIDAR2
AM7 AM0CIDMR2
ID Accepted (Filter 2 Hit)
AC7 AC0CIDAR1
AM7 AM0CIDMR1
ID Accepted (Filter 1 Hit)
ID28 ID21IDR0
ID10 ID3IDR0
ID20 ID15IDR1
ID2 IDEIDR1
ID14 ID7IDR2
ID10 ID3IDR2
ID6 RTRIDR3
ID10 ID3IDR3
AC7 AC0CIDAR0
AM7 AM0CIDMR0
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
460 Freescale Semiconductor
11.4.3.1 Protocol Violation Protection
The MSCAN protects the user from accidentally violating the CAN protocol through programming errors.
The protection logic implements the following features:
The receive and transmit error counters cannot be written or otherwise manipulated.
All registers which control the configuration of the MSCAN cannot be modified while the MSCAN
is on-line. The MSCAN has to be in Initialization Mode. The corresponding INITRQ/INITAK
handshake bits in the CANCTL0/CANCTL1 registers (see Section 11.3.2.1, “MSCAN Control
Register 0 (CANCTL0)”) serve as a lock to protect the following registers:
MSCAN control 1 register (CANCTL1)
MSCAN bus timing registers 0 and 1 (CANBTR0, CANBTR1)
MSCAN identifier acceptance control register (CANIDAC)
MSCAN identifier acceptance registers (CANIDAR0–CANIDAR7)
MSCAN identifier mask registers (CANIDMR0–CANIDMR7)
The TXCAN is immediately forced to a recessive state when the MSCAN goes into the power
down mode or initialization mode (see Section 11.4.5.6, “MSCAN Power Down Mode,” and
Section 11.4.4.5, “MSCAN Initialization Mode”).
The MSCAN enable bit (CANE) is writable only once in normal system operation modes, which
provides further protection against inadvertently disabling the MSCAN.
11.4.3.2 Clock System
Figure 11-43 shows the structure of the MSCAN clock generation circuitry.
Figure 11-43. MSCAN Clocking Scheme
The clock source bit (CLKSRC) in the CANCTL1 register (11.3.2.2/11-425) defines whether the internal
CANCLK is connected to the output of a crystal oscillator (oscillator clock) or to the bus clock.
The clock source has to be chosen such that the tight oscillator tolerance requirements (up to 0.4%) of the
CAN protocol are met. Additionally, for high CAN bus rates (1 Mbps), a 45% to 55% duty cycle of the
clock is required.
If the bus clock is generated from a PLL, it is recommended to select the oscillator clock rather than the
bus clock due to jitter considerations, especially at the faster CAN bus rates.
Bus Clock
Oscillator Clock
MSCAN
CANCLK
CLKSRC
CLKSRC
Prescaler
(1 .. 64)
Time quanta clock (Tq)
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 461
For microcontrollers without a clock and reset generator (CRG), CANCLK is driven from the crystal
oscillator (oscillator clock).
A programmable prescaler generates the time quanta (Tq) clock from CANCLK. A time quantum is the
atomic unit of time handled by the MSCAN.
Eqn. 11-2
A bit time is subdivided into three segments as described in the Bosch CAN 2.0A/B specification. (see
Figure 11-44):
SYNC_SEG: This segment has a fixed length of one time quantum. Signal edges are expected to
happen within this section.
Time Segment 1: This segment includes the PROP_SEG and the PHASE_SEG1 of the CAN
standard. It can be programmed by setting the parameter TSEG1 to consist of 4 to 16 time quanta.
Time Segment 2: This segment represents the PHASE_SEG2 of the CAN standard. It can be
programmed by setting the TSEG2 parameter to be 2 to 8 time quanta long.
Eqn. 11-3
Figure 11-44. Segments within the Bit Time
Tq fCANCLK
Prescaler valueÞ
--------------------------------------------------------=
Bit Rate fTq
number of Time QuantaÞÞ Þ
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------=Þ
SYNC_SEG Time Segment 1 Time Segment 2
1 4 ... 16 2 ... 8
8 ... 25 Time Quanta
= 1 Bit Time
NRZ Signal
Sample Point
(single or triple sampling)
(PROP_SEG + PHASE_SEG1) (PHASE_SEG2)
Transmit Point
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
462 Freescale Semiconductor
The synchronization jump width (see the Bosch CAN 2.0A/B specification for details) can be programmed
in a range of 1 to 4 time quanta by setting the SJW parameter.
The SYNC_SEG, TSEG1, TSEG2, and SJW parameters are set by programming the MSCAN bus timing
registers (CANBTR0, CANBTR1) (see Section 1 1.3.2.3, “MSCAN Bus T iming Register 0 (CANBTR0)
and Section 11.3.2.4, “MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)”).
Table 11-36 gives an overview of the Bosch CAN 2.0A/B specification compliant segment settings and
the related parameter values.
NOTE
It is the users responsibility to ensure the bit time settings are in compliance
with the CAN standard.
11.4.4 Modes of Operation
11.4.4.1 Normal System Operating Modes
The MSCAN module behaves as described within this specification in all normal system operating modes.
Write restrictions exist for some registers.
Table 11-35. Time Segment Syntax
Syntax Description
SYNC_SEG System expects transitions to occur on the CAN bus during this
period.
Transmit Point A node in transmit mode transfers a new value to the CAN bus at
this point.
Sample Point
A node in receive mode samples the CAN bus at this point. If the
three samples per bit option is selected, then this point marks the
position of the third sample.
Table 11-36. Bosch CAN 2.0A/B Compliant Bit Time Segment Settings
Time Segment 1 TSEG1 Time Segment 2 TSEG2 Synchronization
Jump Width SJW
5 .. 10 4 .. 9 2 1 1 .. 2 0 .. 1
4 .. 11 3 .. 10 3 2 1 .. 3 0 .. 2
5 .. 12 4 .. 11 4 3 1 .. 4 0 .. 3
6 .. 13 5 .. 12 5 4 1 .. 4 0 .. 3
7 .. 14 6 .. 13 6 5 1 .. 4 0 .. 3
8 .. 15 7 .. 14 7 6 1 .. 4 0 .. 3
9 .. 16 8 .. 15 8 7 1 .. 4 0 .. 3
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 463
11.4.4.2 Special System Operating Modes
The MSCAN module behaves as described within this specification in all special system operating modes.
Write restrictions which exist on specific registers in normal modes are lifted for test purposes in special
modes.
11.4.4.3 Emulation Modes
In all emulation modes, the MSCAN module behaves just like in normal system operating modes as
described within this specification.
11.4.4.4 Listen-Only Mode
In an optional CAN bus monitoring mode (listen-only), the CAN node is able to receive valid data frames
and valid remote frames, but it sends only “recessive” bits on the CAN bus. In addition, it cannot start a
transmission.
If the MAC sub-layer is required to send a “dominant” bit (ACK bit, overload flag, or active error flag),
the bit is rerouted internally so that the MAC sub-layer monitors this “dominant” bit, although the CAN
bus may remain in recessive state externally.
11.4.4.5 MSCAN Initialization Mode
The MSCAN enters initialization mode when it is enabled (CANE=1).
When entering initialization mode during operation, any on-going transmission or reception is
immediately aborted and synchronization to the CAN bus is lost, potentially causing CAN protocol
violations. To protect the CAN bus system from fatal consequences of violations, the MSCAN
immediately drives TXCAN into a recessive state.
NOTE
The user is responsible for ensuring that the MSCAN is not active when
initialization mode is entered. The recommended procedure is to bring the
MSCAN into sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before setting the
INITRQ bit in the CANCTL0 register. Otherwise, the abort of an on-going
message can cause an error condition and can impact other CAN bus
devices.
In initialization mode, the MSCAN is stopped. However , interface registers remain accessible. This mode
is used to reset the CANCTL0, CANRFLG, CANRIER, CANTFLG, CANTIER, CANT ARQ, CANT AAK,
and CANTBSEL registers to their default values. In addition, the MSCAN enables the configuration of the
CANBTR0, CANBTR1 bit timing registers; CANIDAC; and the CANIDAR, CANIDMR message filters.
See Section 11.3.2.1, “MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0),” for a detailed description of the
initialization mode.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
464 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 11-45. Initialization Request/Acknowledge Cycle
Due to independent clock domains within the MSCAN, INITRQ must be synchronized to all domains by
using a special handshake mechanism. This handshake causes additional synchronization delay (see
Figure 11-45).
If there is no message transfer ongoing on the CAN bus, the minimum delay will be two additional bus
clocks and three additional CAN clocks. When all parts of the MSCAN are in initialization mode, the
INITAK flag is set. The application software must use INITAK as a handshake indication for the request
(INITRQ) to go into initialization mode.
NOTE
The CPU cannot clear INITRQ before initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and
INITAK = 1) is active.
11.4.5 Low-Power Options
If the MSCAN is disabled (CANE = 0), the MSCAN clocks are stopped for power saving.
If the MSCAN is enabled (CANE = 1), the MSCAN has two additional modes with reduced power
consumption, compared to normal mode: sleep and power down mode. In sleep mode, power consumption
is reduced by stopping all clocks except those to access the registers from the CPU side. In power down
mode, all clocks are stopped and no power is consumed.
Table 11-37 summarizes the combinations of MSCAN and CPU modes. A particular combination of
modes is entered by the given settings on the CSWAI and SLPRQ/SLPAK bits.
SYNC
SYNC
Bus Clock Domain CAN Clock Domain
CPU
Init Request
INIT
Flag
INITAK
Flag
INITRQ
sync.
INITAK
sync.
INITRQ
INITAK
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 465
11.4.5.1 Operation in Run Mode
As shown in Table 11-37, only MSCAN sleep mode is available as low power option when the CPU is in
run mode.
11.4.5.2 Operation in Wait Mode
The WAI instruction puts the MCU in a low power consumption stand-by mode. If the CSWAI bit is set,
additional power can be saved in power down mode because the CPU clocks are stopped. After leaving
this power down mode, the MSCAN restarts and enters normal mode again.
While the CPU is in wait mode, the MSCAN can be operated in normal mode and generate interrupts
(registers can be accessed via background debug mode).
11.4.5.3 Operation in Stop Mode
The STOP instruction puts the MCU in a low power consumption stand-by mode. In stop mode, the
MSCAN is set in power down mode regardless of the value of the SLPRQ/SLPAK and CSWAI bits
(Table 11-37).
11.4.5.4 MSCAN Normal Mode
This is a non-power-saving mode. Enabling the MSCAN puts the module from disabled mode into normal
mode. In this mode the module can either be in initialization mode or out of initialization mode. See
Section 11.4.4.5, “MSCAN Initialization Mode”.
Table 11-37. CPU vs. MSCAN Operating Modes
CPU Mode
MSCAN Mode
Normal
Reduced Power Consumption
Sleep Power Down Disabled
(CANE=0)
RUN CSWAI = X(1)
SLPRQ = 0
SLPAK = 0
1. ‘X’ means don’t care.
CSWAI = X
SLPRQ = 1
SLPAK = 1
CSWAI = X
SLPRQ = X
SLPAK = X
WAIT CSWAI = 0
SLPRQ = 0
SLPAK = 0
CSWAI = 0
SLPRQ = 1
SLPAK = 1
CSWAI = 1
SLPRQ = X
SLPAK = X
CSWAI = X
SLPRQ = X
SLPAK = X
STOP CSWAI = X
SLPRQ = X
SLPAK = X
CSWAI = X
SLPRQ = X
SLPAK = X
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
466 Freescale Semiconductor
11.4.5.5 MSCAN Sleep Mode
The CPU can request the MSCAN to enter this low power mode by asserting the SLPRQ bit in the
CANCTL0 register. The time when the MSCAN enters sleep mode depends on a fixed synchronization
delay and its current activity:
If there are one or more message buf fers scheduled for transmission (TXEx = 0), the MSCAN will
continue to transmit until all transmit message buffers are empty (TXEx = 1, transmitted
successfully or aborted) and then goes into sleep mode.
•If the MSCAN is receiving, it continues to receive and goes into sleep mode as soon as the CAN
bus next becomes idle.
If the MSCAN is neither transmitting nor receiving, it immediately goes into sleep mode.
Figure 11-46. Sleep Request / Acknowledge Cycle
NOTE
The application software must avoid setting up a transmission (by clearing
one or more TXEx flag(s)) and immediately request sleep mode (by setting
SLPRQ). Whether the MSCAN starts transmitting or goes into sleep mode
directly depends on the exact sequence of operations.
If sleep mode is active, the SLPRQ and SLPAK bits are set (Figure 11-46). The application software must
use SLPAK as a handshake indication for the request (SLPRQ) to go into sleep mode.
When in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1), the MSCAN stops its internal clocks. However, clocks
that allow register accesses from the CPU side continue to run.
If the MSCAN is in bus-off state, it stops counting the 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits
due to the stopped clocks. TXCAN remains in a recessive state. If RXF = 1, the message can be read and
RXF can be cleared. Shifting a new message into the foreground buf fer of the receiver FIFO (RxFG) does
not take place while in sleep mode.
It is possible to access the transmit buffers and to clear the associated TXE flags. No message abort takes
place while in sleep mode.
SYNC
SYNC
Bus Clock Domain CAN Clock Domain
MSCAN
in Sleep Mode
CPU
Sleep Request
SLPRQ
Flag
SLPAK
Flag
SLPRQ
sync.
SLPAK
sync.
SLPRQ
SLPAK
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 467
If the WUPE bit in CANCTL0 is not asserted, the MSCAN will mask any activity it detects on CAN.
RXCAN is therefore held internally in a recessive state. This locks the MSCAN in sleep mode. WUPE
must be set before entering sleep mode to take effect.
The MSCAN is able to leave sleep mode (wake up) only when:
CAN bus activity occurs and WUPE = 1
or
the CPU clears the SLPRQ bit
NOTE
The CPU cannot clear the SLPRQ bit before sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and
SLPAK = 1) is active.
After wake-up, the MSCAN waits for 11 consecutive recessive bits to synchronize to the CAN bus. As a
consequence, if the MSCAN is woken-up by a CAN frame, this frame is not received.
The receive message buffers (RxFG and RxBG) contain messages if they were received before sleep mode
was entered. All pending actions will be executed upon wake-up; copying of RxBG into RxFG, message
aborts and message transmis sions. If the MSCAN remains in bus-of f state after sleep mod e was exited, it
continues counting the 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits.
11.4.5.6 MSCAN Power Down Mode
The MSCAN is in power down mode (Table 11-37) when
CPU is in stop mode
or
CPU is in wait mode and the CSWAI bit is set
When entering the power down mode, the MSCAN immediately stops all ongoing transmissions and
receptions, potentially causing CAN protocol violations. To protect the CAN bus system from fatal
consequences of violations to the above rule, the MSCAN immediately drives TXCAN into a recessive
state.
NOTE
The user is responsible for ensuring that the MSCAN is not active when
power down mode is entered. The recommended procedure is to bring the
MSCAN into Sleep mode before the STOP or WAI instruction (if CSWAI
is set) is executed. Otherwise, the abort of an ongoing message can cause an
error condition and impact other CAN bus devices.
In power down mode, all clocks are stopped and no registers can be accessed. If the MSCAN was not in
sleep mode before power down mode became active, the module performs an internal recovery cycle after
powering up. This causes some fixed delay before the module enters normal mode again.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
468 Freescale Semiconductor
11.4.5.7 Disabled Mode
The MSCAN is in disabled mode out of reset (CANE=0). All module clocks are stopped for power saving,
however the register map can still be accessed as specified.
11.4.5.8 Programmable Wake-Up Function
The MSCAN can be programmed to wake up from sleep or power down mode as soon as CAN bus activity
is detected (see control bit WUPE in MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0). The sensitivity to existing
CAN bus action can be modified by applying a low-pass filter function to the RXCAN input line (see
control bit WUPM in Section 11.3.2.2, “MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)”).
This feature can be used to protect the MSCAN from wake-up due to short glitches on the CAN bus lines.
Such glitches can result from—for example—electromagnetic interference within noisy environments.
11.4.6 Reset Initialization
The reset state of each individual bit is listed in Section 1 1.3.2, “Register Descriptions,” which details all
the registers and their bit-fields.
11.4.7 Interrupts
This section describes all interrupts originated by the MSCAN. It documents the enable bits and generated
flags. Each interrupt is listed and described separately.
11.4.7.1 Description of Interrupt Operation
The MSCAN supports four interrupt vectors (see Table 11-38), any of which can be individually masked
(for details see Section 11.3.2.6, “MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)” to
Section 11.3.2.8, “MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)”).
Refer to the device overview section to determine the dedicated interrupt vector addresses.
11.4.7.2 Transmit Interrupt
At least one of the three transmit buffers is empty (not scheduled) and can be loaded to schedule a message
for transmission. The TXEx flag of the empty message buffer is set.
Table 11-38. Interrupt Vectors
Interrupt Source CCR Mask Local Enab le
Wake-Up Interrupt (WUPIF) I bit CANRIER (WUPIE)
Error Interrupts Interrupt (CSCIF, OVRIF) I bit CANRIER (CSCIE, OVRIE)
Receive Interrupt (RXF) I bit CANRIER (RXFIE)
Transmit Interrupts (TXE[2:0]) I bit CANTIER (TXEIE[2:0])
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 469
11.4.7.3 Receive Interrupt
A message is successfully received and shifted into the foreground buffer (RxFG) of the receiver FIFO.
This interrupt is generated immediately after receiving the EOF symbol. The RXF flag is set. If there are
multiple messages in the receiver FIFO, the RXF flag is set as soon as the next message is shifted to the
foreground buffer.
11.4.7.4 Wake-Up Interrupt
A wake-up interrupt is generated if activity on the CAN bus occurs during MSCAN sleep or power-down
mode.
NOTE
This interrupt can only occur if the MSCAN was in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1
and SLPAK = 1) before entering power down mode, the wake-up option is
enabled (WUPE = 1), and the wake-up interrupt is enabled (WUPIE = 1).
11.4.7.5 Error Interrupt
An error interrupt is generated if an overrun of the receiver FIFO, error, warning, or bus-off condition
occurs. MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG) indicates one of the following conditions:
Overrun — An overrun condition of the receiver FIFO as described in Section 1 1.4.2.3, “Receive
Structures,” occurred.
CAN Status Change — The actual value of the transmit and receive error counters control the
CAN bus state of the MSCAN. As soon as the error counters skip into a critical range (Tx/Rx-
warning, Tx/Rx-error, bus-off) the MSCAN flags an error condition. The status change, which
caused the error condition, is indicated by the TSTAT and RSTAT flags (see Section 11.3.2.5,
“MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)” and Section 11.3.2.6, “MSCAN Receiver
Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)”).
11.4.7.6 Interrupt Acknowledge
Interrupts are directly associated with one or more status flags in either the MSCAN Receiver Flag
Register (CANRFLG) or the MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG). Interrupts are pending as
long as one of the corresponding flags is set. The flags in CANRFLG and CANTFLG must be reset within
the interrupt handler to handshake the interrupt. The flags are reset by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit
position. A flag cannot be cleared if the respective condition prevails.
NOTE
It must be guaranteed that the CPU clears only the bit causing the current
interrupt. For this reason, bit manipulation instructions (BSET) must not be
used to clear interrupt flags. These instructions may cause accidental
clearing of interrupt flags which are set after entering the current interrupt
service routine.
Chapter 11 Freescale’s Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
470 Freescale Semiconductor
11.5 Initialization/Application Information
11.5.1 MSCAN initialization
The procedure to initially start up the MSCAN module out of reset is as follows:
1. Assert CANE
2. Write to the configuration registers in initialization mode
3. Clear INITRQ to leave initialization mode
If the configuration of registers which are only writable in initialization mode shall be changed:
1. Bring the module into sleep mode by setting SLPRQ and awaiting SLPAK to assert after the CAN
bus becomes idle.
2. Enter initialization mode: assert INITRQ and await INITAK
3. Write to the configuration registers in initialization mode
4. Clear INITRQ to leave initialization mode and continue
11.5.2 Bus-Off Recovery
The bus-off recovery is user configurable. The bus-off state can either be left automatically or on user
request.
For reasons of backwards compatibility, the MSCAN defaults to automatic recovery after reset. In this
case, the MSCAN will become error active again after counting 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive
recessive bits on the CAN bus (see the Bosch CAN 2.0 A/B specification for details).
If the MSCAN is configured for user request (BORM set in MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)), the
recovery from bus-off starts after both independent events have become true:
128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus have been monitored
BOHOLD in MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC) has been cleared by the user
These two events may occur in any order.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 471
Chapter 12
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.1 Introduction
The SPI module allows a duplex, synchronous, serial communication between the MCU and peripheral
devices. Software can poll the SPI status flags or the SPI operation can be interrupt driven.
12.1.1 Glossary of Terms
12.1.2 Features
The SPI includes these distinctive features:
Master mode and slave mode
Selectable 8 or 16-bit transfer width
Bidirectional mode
Slave select output
Mode fault error flag with CPU interrupt capability
Double-buffered data register
Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase
Control of SPI operation during wait mode
12.1.3 Modes of Operation
The SPI functions in three modes: run, wait, and stop.
Table 12-1. Revision History
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Changes
V05.00 24 Mar 2005 12.3.2/12-475 - Added 16-bit transfer width feature.
SPI Serial Peripheral Interface
SS Slave Select
SCK Serial Clock
MOSI Master Output, Slave Input
MISO Master Input, Slave Output
MOMI Master Output, Master Input
SISO Slave Input, Slave Output
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
472 Freescale Semiconductor
Run mode
This is the basic mode of operation.
Wait mode
SPI operation in wait mode is a configurable low power mode, controlled by the SPISWAI bit
located in the SPICR2 register. In wait mode, if the SPISWAI bit is clear, the SPI operates like in
run mode. If the SPISWAI bit is set, the SPI goes into a power conservative state, with the SPI clock
generation turned off. If the SPI is configured as a master, any transmission in progress stops, but
is resumed after CPU goes into run mode. If the SPI is configured as a slave, reception and
transmission of data continues, so that the slave stays synchronized to the master.
Stop mode
The SPI is inactive in stop mode for reduced power consumption. If the SPI is configured as a
master , any transmission in progress stops, but is resumed after CPU goes into run mode. If the SPI
is configured as a slave, reception and transmission of data continues, so that the slave stays
synchronized to the master.
For a detailed description of operating modes, please refer to Section 12.4.7, “Low Power Mode Options”.
12.1.4 Block Diagram
Figure 12-1 gives an overview on the SPI architecture. The main parts of the SPI are status, control and
data registers, shifter logic, baud rate generator, master/slave control logic, and port control logic.
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 473
Figure 12-1. SPI Block Diagram
12.2 External Signal Description
This section lists the name and description of all ports including inputs and outputs that do, or may , connect
off chip. The SPI module has a total of four external pins.
12.2.1 MOSI — Master Out/Slave In Pin
This pin is used to transmit data out of the SPI module when it is configured as a master and receive data
when it is configured as slave.
12.2.2 MISO — Master In/Slave Out Pin
This pin is used to transmit data out of the SPI module when it is configured as a slave and receive data
when it is configured as master.
SPI Control Register 1
SPI Control Register 2
SPI Baud Rate Register
SPI Status Register
SPI Data Register
Shifter
Port
Control
Logic
MOSI
SCK
Interrupt Control
SPI
MSB LSB
LSBFE=1 LSBFE=0
LSBFE=0 LSBFE=1
Data In
LSBFE=1
LSBFE=0
Data Out
Baud Rate Generator
Prescaler
Bus Clock
Counter
Clock Select
SPPR 33
SPR
Baud Rate
Phase +
Polarity
Control
Master
Slave
SCK In
SCK Out
Master Baud Rate
Slave Baud Rate
Phase +
Polarity
Control
Control
Control CPOL CPHA
2
BIDIROE
SPC0
2
Shift Sample
ClockClock
MODF
SPIF SPTEF
SPI
Request
Interrupt
SS
MISO
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
474 Freescale Semiconductor
12.2.3 SS — Slave Select Pin
This pin is used to output the select signal from the SPI module to another peripheral with which a data
transfer is to take place when it is configured as a master and it is used as an input to receive the slave select
signal when the SPI is configured as slave.
12.2.4 SCK — Serial Clock Pin
In master mode, this is the synchronous output clock. In slave mode, this is the synchronous input clock.
12.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of address space and registers used by the SPI.
12.3.1 Module Memory Map
The memory map for the SPI is given in Figure 12-2. The address listed for each register is the sum of a
base address and an address offset. The base address is defined at the SoC level and the address offset is
defined at the module level. Reads from the reserved bits return zeros and writes to the reserved bits have
no effect.
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
SPICR1
RSPIE SPE SPTIE MSTR CPOL CPHA SSOE LSBFE
W
0x0001
SPICR2
R0 XFRW 0MODFEN BIDIROE 0SPISWAI SPC0
W
0x0002
SPIBR
R0 SPPR2 SPPR1 SPPR0 0SPR2 SPR1 SPR0
W
0x0003
SPISR
R SPIF 0 SPTEF MODF 0 0 0 0
W
0x0004
SPIDRH
R R15 R14 R13 R12 R11 R10 R9 R8
T15 T14 T13 T12 T11 T10 T9 T8W
0x0005
SPIDRL
RR7R6R5R4R3R2R1R0
T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0W
0x0006
Reserved
R
W
0x0007
Reserved
R
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 12-2. SPI Register Summary
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 475
12.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order. Each description includes a standard register
diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register
diagrams, in bit order.
12.3.2.1 SPI Control Register 1 (SPICR 1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base +0x0000
76543210
RSPIE SPE SPTIE MSTR CPOL CPHA SSOE LSBFE
W
Reset00000100
Figure 12-3. SPI Control Register 1 (SPICR1)
Table 12-2. SPICR1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
SPIE
SPI Interrupt Enable Bit — This bit enables SPI interrupt requests, if SPIF or MODF status flag is set.
0 SPI interrupts disabled.
1 SPI interrupts enabled.
6
SPE
SPI System Enable Bit — This bit enables the SPI system and dedicates the SPI port pins to SPI system
functions. If SPE is cleared, SPI is disabled and forced into idle state, status bits in SPISR register are reset.
0 SPI disabled (lower power consumption).
1 SPI enabled, port pins are dedicated to SPI functions.
5
SPTIE
SPI Transmit Interrupt Enable — This bit enables SPI interrupt requests, if SPTEF flag is set.
0 SPTEF interrupt disabled.
1 SPTEF interrupt enabled.
4
MSTR
SPI Master/Slave Mode Select Bit — This bit selects whether the SPI operates in master or slave mode.
Switching the SPI from master to slave or vice versa forces the SPI system into idle state.
0 SPI is in slave mode.
1 SPI is in master mode.
3
CPOL
SPI Clock Polarity Bit — This bit selects an inverted or non-inverted SPI clock. To transmit data between SPI
modules, the SPI modules must have identical CPOL values. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a
transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
0 Active-high clocks selected. In idle state SCK is low.
1 Active-low clocks selected. In idle state SCK is high.
2
CPHA
SPI Clock Phase Bit — This bit is used to select the SPI clock format. In master mode, a change of this bit will
abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
0 Sampling of data occurs at odd edges (1,3,5,...) of the SCK clock.
1 Sampling of data occurs at even edges (2,4,6,...) of the SCK clock.
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
476 Freescale Semiconductor
12.3.2.2 SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR 2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writes to the reserved bits have no effect
1
SSOE
Slave Select Output Enable — The SS output feature is enabled only in master mode, if MODFEN is set, by
asserting the SSOE as shown in Tabl e 1 2-3 . In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in
progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
0
LSBFE
LSB-First Enable — This bit does not affect the position of the MSB and LSB in the data register. Reads and
writes of the data register always have the MSB in the highest bit position. In master mode, a change of this bit
will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
0 Data is transferred most significant bit first.
1 Data is transferred least significant bit first.
Table 12-3. SS Input / Output Selection
MODFEN SSOE Master Mode Slave Mode
00 SS not used by SPI SS input
01 SS
not used by SPI SS input
10SS
input with MODF feature SS input
11 SS is slave select output SS input
Module Base +0x0001
76543210
R0 XFRW 0MODFEN BIDIROE 0SPISWAI SPC0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 12-4. SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
Table 12-2. SPICR1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 477
Table 12-4. SPICR2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
6
XFRW
T ransfer Width — This bit is used for selecting the data transfer width. If 8-bit transfer width is selected, SPIDRL
becomes the dedicated data register and SPIDRH is unused. If 16-bit transfer width is selected, SPIDRH and
SPIDRL form a 16-bit data register. Please refer to Section 12.3.2.4, “SPI Status Register (SPISR) for
information about transmit/receive data handling and the interrupt flag clearing mechanism. In master mode, a
change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
0 8-bit Transfer Width (n = 8)(1)
1 16-bit Transfer Width (n = 16)1
1. n is used later in this document as a placeholder for the selected transfer width.
4
MODFEN
Mode Fault Enable BitThis bit allows the MODF failure to be detected. If the SPI is in master mode and
MODFEN is cleared, then the SS port pin is not used by the SPI. In slave mode, the SS is available only as an
input regardless of the value of MODFEN. For an overview on the impact of the MODFEN bit on the SS port pin
configuration, refer to Tab le 12 - 3. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and
force the SPI system into idle state.
0SS
port pin is not used by the SPI.
1SS port pin with MODF feature.
3
BIDIROE
Output Enable in the Bidirectional Mode of Operation — This bit controls the MOSI and MISO output buffer
of the SPI, when in bidirectional mode of operation (SPC0 is set). In master mode, this bit controls the output
buffer of the MOSI port, in slave mode it controls the output buffer of the MISO port. In master mode, with SPC0
set, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI into idle state.
0 Output buffer disabled.
1 Output buffer enabled.
1
SPISWAI
SPI Stop in Wait Mode Bit — This bit is used for power conservation while in wait mode.
0 SPI clock operates normally in wait mode.
1 Stop SPI clock generation when in wait mode.
0
SPC0
Serial Pin Control Bit 0 — This bit enables bidirectional pin configurations as shown in Table 12-5. In master
mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
Table 12-5. Bidirectional Pin Configurations
Pin Mode SPC0 BIDIROE MISO MOSI
Master Mode of Operation
Normal 0 X Master In Master Out
Bidirectional 1 0 MISO not used by SPI Master In
1Master I/O
Slave Mode of Operation
Normal 0 X Slave Out Slave In
Bidirectional 1 0 Slave In MOSI not used by SPI
1 Slave I/O
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
478 Freescale Semiconductor
12.3.2.3 SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIBR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writes to the reserved bits have no effect
The baud rate divisor equation is as follows:
BaudRateDivisor = (SPPR + 1 ) 2(SPR + 1) Eqn. 12-1
The baud rate can be calculated with the following equation:
Baud Rate = BusClock / BaudRateDivisor Eqn. 12-2
NOTE
For maximum allowed baud rates, please refer to the SPI Electrical
Specification in the Electricals chapter of this data sheet.
Module Base +0x0002
76543210
R0 SPPR2 SPPR1 SPPR0 0SPR2 SPR1 SPR0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 12-5. SPI Bau d Rate Re gi st er (SPIB R)
Table 12-6. SPIBR Field Descriptions
Field Description
6–4
SPPR[2:0]
SPI Baud Rate Preselection Bits These bits specify the SPI baud rates as shown in Table 12-7. In master
mode, a change of these bits will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
2–0
SPR[2:0]
SPI Baud Rate Selection BitsThese bits specify the SPI baud rates as shown in Table 12-7. In master mode,
a change of these bits will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
Table 12-7. Example SPI Baud Rate Selection (25 MHz Bus Clock) (Sheet 1 of 3)
SPPR2 SPPR1 SPPR0 SPR2 SPR1 SPR0 Baud Rate
Divisor Baud Rate
000000 2 12.5 Mbit/s
000001 4 6.25 Mbit/s
0 0 0 0 1 0 8 3.125 Mbit/s
0 0 0 0 1 1 16 1.5625 Mbit/s
0 0 0 1 0 0 32 781.25 kbit/s
0 0 0 1 0 1 64 390.63 kbit/s
0 0 0 1 1 0 128 195.31 kbit/s
0 0 0 1 1 1 256 97.66 kbit/s
001000 4 6.25 Mbit/s
0 0 1 0 0 1 8 3.125 Mbit/s
0 0 1 0 1 0 16 1.5625 Mbit/s
0 0 1 0 1 1 32 781.25 kbit/s
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 479
0 0 1 1 0 0 64 390.63 kbit/s
0 0 1 1 0 1 128 195.31 kbit/s
0 0 1 1 1 0 256 97.66 kbit/s
0 0 1 1 1 1 512 48.83 kbit/s
0 1 0 0 0 0 6 4.16667 Mbit/s
0 1 0 0 0 1 12 2.08333 Mbit/s
0 1 0 0 1 0 24 1.04167 Mbit/s
0 1 0 0 1 1 48 520.83 kbit/s
0 1 0 1 0 0 96 260.42 kbit/s
0 1 0 1 0 1 192 130.21 kbit/s
0 1 0 1 1 0 384 65.10 kbit/s
0 1 0 1 1 1 768 32.55 kbit/s
0 1 1 0 0 0 8 3.125 Mbit/s
0 1 1 0 0 1 16 1.5625 Mbit/s
0 1 1 0 1 0 32 781.25 kbit/s
0 1 1 0 1 1 64 390.63 kbit/s
0 1 1 1 0 0 128 195.31 kbit/s
0 1 1 1 0 1 256 97.66 kbit/s
0 1 1 1 1 0 512 48.83 kbit/s
0 1 1 1 1 1 1024 24.41 kbit/s
1 0 0 0 0 0 10 2.5 Mbit/s
1 0 0 0 0 1 20 1.25 Mbit/s
1 0 0 0 1 0 40 625 kbit/s
1 0 0 0 1 1 80 312.5 kbit/s
1 0 0 1 0 0 160 156.25 kbit/s
1 0 0 1 0 1 320 78.13 kbit/s
1 0 0 1 1 0 640 39.06 kbit/s
1 0 0 1 1 1 1280 19.53 kbit/s
1 0 1 0 0 0 12 2.08333 Mbit/s
1 0 1 0 0 1 24 1.04167 Mbit/s
1 0 1 0 1 0 48 520.83 kbit/s
1 0 1 0 1 1 96 260.42 kbit/s
1 0 1 1 0 0 192 130.21 kbit/s
1 0 1 1 0 1 384 65.10 kbit/s
1 0 1 1 1 0 768 32.55 kbit/s
1 0 1 1 1 1 1536 16.28 kbit/s
1 1 0 0 0 0 14 1.78571 Mbit/s
1 1 0 0 0 1 28 892.86 kbit/s
1 1 0 0 1 0 56 446.43 kbit/s
1 1 0 0 1 1 112 223.21 kbit/s
1 1 0 1 0 0 224 111.61 kbit/s
1 1 0 1 0 1 448 55.80 kbit/s
Table 12-7. Example SPI Baud Rate Selection (25 MHz Bus Clock) (Sheet 2 of 3)
SPPR2 SPPR1 SPPR0 SPR2 SPR1 SPR0 Baud Rate
Divisor Baud Rate
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
480 Freescale Semiconductor
12.3.2.4 SPI Status Register (SPISR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Has no effect
1 1 0 1 1 0 896 27.90 kbit/s
1 1 0 1 1 1 1792 13.95 kbit/s
1 1 1 0 0 0 16 1.5625 Mbit/s
1 1 1 0 0 1 32 781.25 kbit/s
1 1 1 0 1 0 64 390.63 kbit/s
1 1 1 0 1 1 128 195.31 kbit/s
1 1 1 1 0 0 256 97.66 kbit/s
1 1 1 1 0 1 512 48.83 kbit/s
1 1 1 1 1 0 1024 24.41 kbit/s
1 1 1 1 1 1 2048 12.21 kbit/s
Module Base +0x0003
76543210
R SPIF 0 SPTEF MODF 0 0 0 0
W
Reset00100000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 12-6. SPI Status Register (SPISR)
Table 12-8. SPISR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
SPIF
SPIF Interrupt Flag — This bit is set after received data has been transferred into the SPI data register. For
information about clearing SPIF Flag, please refer to Table 12-9.
0 Transfer not yet complete.
1 New data copied to SPIDR.
5
SPTEF
SPI Transmit Empty Interrupt Flag — If set, this bit indicates that the transmit data register is empty. For
information about clearing this bit and placing data into the transmit data register, please refer to Table 12-10.
0 SPI data register not empty.
1 SPI data register empty.
4
MODF
Mode Fault Flag This bit is set if the SS input becomes low while the SPI is configured as a master and mode
fault detection is enabled, MODFEN bit of SPICR2 register is set. Refer to MODFEN bit description in
Section 12.3.2.2, “SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)”. The flag is cleared automatically by a read of the SPI status
register (with MODF set) followed by a write to the SPI control register 1.
0 Mode fault has not occurred.
1 Mode fault has occurred.
Table 12-7. Example SPI Baud Rate Selection (25 MHz Bus Clock) (Sheet 3 of 3)
SPPR2 SPPR1 SPPR0 SPR2 SPR1 SPR0 Baud Rate
Divisor Baud Rate
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 481
Table 12-9. SPIF Interrupt Flag Clearing Sequence
Table 12-10. SPTEF Interrupt Flag Clearing Sequence
XFRW Bit SPIF Interrupt Flag Clearing Seque nce
0 Read SPISR with SPIF == 1 then Read SPIDRL
1 Read SPISR with SPIF == 1
then
Byte Read SPIDRL (1)
1. Data in SPIDRH is lost in this case.
or
Byte Read SPIDRH (2)
2. SPIDRH can be read repeatedly without any effect on SPIF. SPIF Flag is cleared only by the read
of SPIDRL after reading SPISR with SPIF == 1.
Byte Read SPIDRL
or
Word Read (SPIDRH:SPIDRL)
XFRW Bit SPTEF Interrupt Flag Clearing Sequence
0 Read SPISR with SPTEF == 1 then Write to SPIDRL (1)
1. Any write to SPIDRH or SPIDRL with SPTEF == 0 is effectively ignored.
1 Read SPISR with SPTEF == 1
then
Byte Write to SPIDRL 1(2)
2. Data in SPIDRH is undefined in this case.
or
Byte Write to SPIDRH 1(3)
3. SPIDRH can be written repeatedly without any effect on SPTEF. SPTEF Flag is cleared only by
writing to SPIDRL after reading SPISR with SPTEF == 1.
Byte Write to SPIDRL 1
or
Word Write to (SPIDRH:SPIDRL) 1
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
482 Freescale Semiconductor
12.3.2.5 SPI Data Register (SPIDR = SPIDRH:SPIDRL)
Read: Anytime; read data only valid when SPIF is set
Write: Anytime
The SPI data register is both the input and output register for SPI data. A write to this register
allows data to be queued and transmitted. For an SPI configured as a master, queued data is
transmitted immediately after the previous transmission has completed. The SPI transmitter empty
flag SPTEF in the SPISR register indicates when the SPI data register is ready to accept new data.
Received data in the SPIDR is valid when SPIF is set.
If SPIF is cleared and data has been received, the received data is transferred from the receive shift
register to the SPIDR and SPIF is set.
If SPIF is set and not serviced, and a second data value has been received, the second received data
is kept as valid data in the receive shift register until the start of another transmission. The data in
the SPIDR does not change.
If SPIF is set and valid data is in the rec eive shif t r egis ter, and SPIF is serviced before the sta rt of
a third transmission, the data in the receive shift register is transferred into the SPIDR and SPIF
remains set (see Figure 12-9).
If SPIF is set and valid data is in the receive shif t register, and SPIF is ser vic ed after the start of a
third transmission, the data in the receive shift register has become invalid and is not transferred
into the SPIDR (see Figure 12-10).
Module Base +0x0004
76543210
RR15 R14 R13 R12 R11 R10 R9 R8
WT15 T14 T13 T12 T11 T10 T9 T8
Reset00000000
Figure 12-7. SPI Data Register High (SPIDRH)
Module Base +0x0005
76543210
RR7 R6 R5 R4 R3 R2 R1 R0
WT7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0
Reset00000000
Figure 12-8. SPI Data Register Low (SPIDRL)
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 483
Figure 12-9. Reception with SPIF serviced in Time
Figure 12-10. Reception with SPIF serviced too late
12.4 Functional Description
The SPI module allows a duplex, synchronous, serial communication between the MCU and peripheral
devices. Software can poll the SPI status flags or SPI operation can be interrupt driven.
The SPI system is enabled by setting the SPI enable (SPE) bit in SPI control register 1. While SPE is set,
the four associated SPI port pins are dedicated to the SPI function as:
Slave select (SS)
Serial clock (SCK)
Master out/slave in (MOSI)
Master in/slave out (MISO)
Receive Shift Register
SPIF
SPI Data Register
Data A Data B
Data A
Data A Received Data B Received
Data C
Data C
SPIF Serviced
Data C Received
Data B
= Unspecified = Reception in progress
Receive Shift Register
SPIF
SPI Data Register
Data A Data B
Data A
Data A Received Data B Received
Data C
Data C
SPIF Serviced
Data C Received
Data B Lost
= Unspecified = Reception in progress
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
484 Freescale Semiconductor
The main element of the SPI system is the SPI data register. The n-bit1 data register in the master and the
n-bit1 data register in the slave are linked by the MOSI and MISO pins to form a distributed 2n-bit1
register. When a data transfer operation is performed, this 2n-bit1 register is serially shifted n1 bit positions
by the S-clock from the master , so data is exchanged between the master and the slave. Data written to the
master SPI data register becomes the output data for the slave, and data read from the master SPI data
register after a transfer operation is the input data from the slave.
A read of SPISR with SPTEF = 1 followed by a write to SPIDR puts data into the transmit data register.
When a transfer is complete and SPIF is cleared, received data is moved into the receive data register. This
data register acts as the SPI receive data register for reads and as the SPI transmit data register for writes.
A common SPI data register address is shared for reading data from the read data buffer and for writing
data to the transmit data register.
The clock phase control bit (CPHA) and a clock polarity control bit (CPOL) in the SPI control register 1
(SPICR1) select one of four possible clock formats to be used by the SPI system. The CPOL bit simply
selects a non-inverted or inverted clock. The CPHA bit is used to accommodate two fundamentally
different protocols by sampling data on odd numbered SCK edges or on even numbered SCK edges (see
Section 12.4.3, “Transmission Formats”).
The SPI can be configured to operate as a master or as a slave. When the MSTR bit in SPI control register1
is set, master mode is selected, when the MSTR bit is clear, slave mode is selected.
NOTE
A change of CPOL or MSTR bit while there is a received byte pending in
the receive shift register will destroy the received byte and must be avoided.
12.4.1 Master Mode
The SPI operates in master mode when the MSTR bit is set. Only a master SPI module can initiate
transmissions. A transmission begins by writing to the master SPI data register. If the shift register is
empty, data immediately transfers to the shift register. Data begins shifting out on the MOSI pin under the
control of the serial clock.
Serial clock
The SPR2, SPR1, and SPR0 baud rate selection bits, in conjunction with the SPPR2, SPPR1, and
SPPR0 baud rate preselection bits in the SPI baud rate register , control the baud rate generator and
determine the speed of the transmission. The SCK pin is the SPI clock output. Through the SCK
pin, the baud rate generator of the master controls the shift register of the slave peripheral.
MOSI, MISO pin
In master mode, the function of the serial data output pin (MOSI) and the serial data input pin
(MISO) is determined by the SPC0 and BIDIROE control bits.
•SS pin
If MODFEN and SSOE are set, the SS pin is configured as slave select output. The SS output
becomes low during each transmission and is high when the SPI is in idle state.
If MODFEN is set and SSOE is cleared, the SS pin is configured as input for detecting mode fault
error. If the SS input becomes low this indicates a mode fault error where another master tries to
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, “SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 485
drive the MOSI and SCK lines. In this case, the SPI immediately switches to slave mode, by
clearing the MSTR bit and also disables the slave output buffer MISO (or SISO in bidirectional
mode). So the result is that all outputs are disabled and SCK, MOSI, and MISO are inputs. If a
transmission is in progress when the mode fault occurs, the transmission is aborted and the SPI is
forced into idle state.
This mode fault error also sets the mode fault (MODF) flag in the SPI status register (SPISR). If
the SPI interrupt enable bit (SPIE) is set when the MODF flag becomes set, then an SPI interrupt
sequence is also requested.
When a write to the SPI data register in the master occurs, there is a half SCK-cycle delay. After
the delay, SCK is started within the master. The rest of the transfer operation differs slightly,
depending on the clock format specified by the SPI clock phase bit, CPHA, in SPI control register 1
(see Section 12.4.3, “Transmission Formats”).
NOTE
A change of the bits CPOL, CPHA, SSOE, LSBFE, XFRW, MODFEN,
SPC0, or BIDIROE with SPC0 set, SPPR2-SPPR0 and SPR2-SPR0 in
master mode will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI into idle
state. The remote slave cannot detect this, therefore the master must ensure
that the remote slave is returned to idle state.
12.4.2 Slave Mode
The SPI operates in slave mode when the MSTR bit in SPI control register 1 is clear.
Serial clock
In slave mode, SCK is the SPI clock input from the master.
MISO, MOSI pin
In slave mode, the function of the serial data output pin (MISO) and serial data input pin (MOSI)
is determined by the SPC0 bit and BIDIROE bit in SPI control register 2.
•SS pin
The SS pin is the slave select input. Before a data transmission occurs, the SS pin of the slave SPI
must be low. SS must remain low until the transmission is complete. If SS goes high, the SPI is
forced into idle state.
The SS input also controls the serial data output pin, if SS is high (not selected), the serial data
output pin is high impedance, and, if SS is low, the first bit in the SPI data register is driven out of
the serial data output pin. Also, if the slave is not selected (SS is high), then the SCK input is
ignored and no internal shifting of the SPI shift register occurs.
Although the SPI is capable of duplex operation, some SPI peripherals are capable of only
receiving SPI data in a slave mode. For these simpler devices, there is no serial data out pin.
NOTE
When peripherals with duplex capability are used, take care not to
simultaneously enable two receivers whose serial outputs drive the same
system slave’s serial data output line.
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
486 Freescale Semiconductor
As long as no more than one slave device drives the system slave’ s serial data output line, it is possible for
several slaves to receive the same transmission from a master, although the master would not receive return
information from all of the receiving slaves.
If the CPHA bit in SPI control register 1 is clear, odd numbered edges on the SCK input cause the data at
the serial data input pin to be latched. Even numbered edges cause the value previously latched from the
serial data input pin to shift into the LSB or MSB of the SPI shift register, depending on the LSBFE bit.
If the CPHA bit is set, even numbered edges on the SCK input cause the data at the serial data input pin to
be latched. Odd numbered edges cause the value previously latched from the serial data input pin to shift
into the LSB or MSB of the SPI shift register, depending on the LSBFE bit.
When CPHA is set, the first edge is used to get the first data bit onto the serial data output pin. When CPHA
is clear and the SS input is low (slave selected), the first bit of the SPI data is driven out of the serial data
output pin. After the nth1 shift, the transfer is considered complete and the received data is transferred into
the SPI data register. To indicate transfer is complete, the SPIF flag in the SPI status register is set.
NOTE
A change of the bits CPOL, CPHA, SSOE, LSBFE, MODFEN, SPC0, or
BIDIROE with SPC0 set in slave mode will corrupt a transmission in
progress and must be avoided.
12.4.3 Transmission Formats
During an SPI transmission, data is transmitted (shifted out serially) and received (shifted in serially)
simultaneously. The serial clock (SCK) synchronizes shifting and sampling of the information on the two
serial data lines. A slave select line allows selection of an individual slave SPI device; slave devices that
are not selected do not interfere with SPI bus activities. Optionally, on a master SPI device, the slave select
line can be used to indicate multiple-master bus contention.
Figure 12-11. Master/Slave Transfer Block Diagram
12.4.3.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls
Using two bits in the SPI control register 1, software selects one of four combinations of serial clock phase
and polarity.
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, “SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
SHIFT REGISTER
SHIFT REGISTER
BAUD RATE
GENERATOR
MASTER SPI SLAVE SPI
MOSI MOSI
MISO MISO
SCK SCK
SS SS
VDD
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 487
The CPOL clock polarity control bit specifies an active high or low clock and has no significant ef fect on
the transmission format.
The CPHA clock phase control bit selects one of two fundamentally different transmission formats.
Clock phase and polarity should be identical for the master SPI device and the communicating slave
device. In some cases, the phase and polarity are changed between transmissions to allow a master device
to communicate with peripheral slaves having different requirements.
12.4.3.2 CPHA = 0 Transfer Format
The first edge on the SCK line is used to clock the first data bit of the slave into the master and the first
data bit of the master into the slave. In some peripherals, the first bit of the slave’s data is available at the
slave’s data out pin as soon as the slave is selected. In this format, the first SCK edge is issued a half cycle
after SS has become low.
A half SCK cycle later , the second edge appears on the SCK line. When this second edge occurs, the value
previously latched from the serial data input pin is shifted into the LSB or MSB of the shift register,
depending on LSBFE bit.
After this second edge, the next bit of the SPI ma ster data is transmitted out of the serial data output pin of
the master to the serial input pin on the slave. This process continues for a total of 16 edges on the SCK
line, with data being latched on odd numbered edges and shifted on even numbered edges.
Data reception is double buffered. Data is shifted serially into the SPI shift register during the transfer and
is transferred to the parallel SPI data register after the last bit is shifted in.
After 2n1 (last) SCK edges:
Data that was previously in the master SPI data register should now be in the slave data register
and the data that was in the slave data register should be in the master.
The SPIF flag in the SPI status register is set, indicating that the transfer is complete.
Figure 12-12 is a timing diagram of an SPI transfer where CPHA = 0. SCK waveforms are shown for
CPOL = 0 and CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram because
the SCK, MISO, and MOSI pins are connected directly between the master and the slave. The MISO signal
is the output from the slave and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS pin of the master
must be either high or reconfigured as a general-purpose output not affecting the SPI.
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, “SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
488 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 12-12. SPI Clock Format 0 (CPHA = 0), with 8-bit Transfer Width selected (XFRW = 0)
tL
Begin End
SCK (CPOL = 0)
SAMPLE I
CHANGE O
SEL SS (O)
Transfer
SCK (CPOL = 1)
MSB first (LSBFE = 0):
LSB first (LSBFE = 1):
MSB
LSB
LSB
MSB
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 6
Bit 1
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 2
Bit 5
Bit 1
Bit 6
CHANGE O
SEL SS (I)
MOSI pin
MISO pin
Master only
MOSI/MISO
tT
If next transfer begins here
for tT
, tl, tL
Minimum 1/2 SCK
tItL
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge
tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge
tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time)
tL, tT
, and tI are guaranteed for the master mode and required for the slave mode.
1 234 56 78910111213141516
SCK Edge Number
End of Idle State Begin of Idle State
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 489
Figure 12-13. SPI Clock Format 0 (CPHA = 0), with 16-Bit Transfer Width selected (XFRW = 1)
In slave mode, if the SS line is not deasserted between the successive transmis sions then the content of the
SPI data register is not transmitted; instead the last received data is transmitted. If the SS line is deas serted
for at least minimum idle time (half SCK cycle) between successive transmissions, then the content of the
SPI data register is transmitted.
In master mode, with slave select output enabled the SS line is always deasserted and reasserted between
successive transfers for at least minimum idle time.
12.4.3.3 CPHA = 1 Transfer Format
Some peripherals require the first SCK edge before the first data bit becomes available at the data out pin,
the second edge clocks data into the system. In this format, the first SCK edge is issued by setting the
CPHA bit at the beginning of the n1-cycle transfer operation.
The first edge of SCK occurs immediately after the half SCK clock cycle synchronizati on delay. This first
edge commands the slave to transfer its first data bit to the serial data input pin of the master.
A half SCK cycle later, the second edge appears on the SCK pin. This is the latching edge for both the
master and slave.
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, “SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
tL
Begin End
SCK (CPOL = 0)
SAMPLE I
CHANGE O
SEL SS (O)
Transfer
SCK (CPOL = 1)
MSB first (LSBFE = 0)
LSB first (LSBFE = 1)
MSB
LSB
LSB
MSB
Bit 13
Bit 2
Bit 14
Bit 1
Bit 12
Bit 3
Bit 11
Bit 4
Bit 5
CHANGE O
SEL SS (I)
MOSI pin
MISO pin
Master only
MOSI/MISO
tT
If next transfer begins here
for tT
, tl, tL
Minimum 1/2 SCK
tItL
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge
tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge
tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time)
tL, tT
, and tI are guaranteed for the master mode and required for the slave mode.
12345678910111213141516
SCK Edge Number
End of Idle State Begin of Idle State
17181920212223242526272829303132
Bit 10Bit 9Bit 8Bit 7Bit 6 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1
Bit 6Bit 5 Bit 7 Bit 8 Bit 9 Bit 10Bit 11 Bit 12Bit 13Bit 14
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
490 Freescale Semiconductor
When the third edge occurs, the value previously latched from the serial data input pin is shifted into the
LSB or MSB of the SPI shift register , depending on LSBFE bit. After this edge, the next bit of the master
data is coupled out of the serial data output pin of the master to the serial input pin on the slave.
This process continues for a total of n1 edges on the SCK line with data being latched on even numbered
edges and shifting taking place on odd numbered edges.
Data reception is double buffered, data is serially shifted into the SPI shift register during the transfer and
is transferred to the parallel SPI data register after the last bit is shifted in.
After 2n1 SCK edges:
Data that was previously in the SPI data register of the master is now in the data register of the
slave, and data that was in the data register of the slave is in the master.
The SPIF flag bit in SPISR is set indic ating that the transfer is complete.
Figure 12-14 shows two clocking variations for CPHA = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master
or slave timing diagram because the SCK, MISO, and MOSI pins are connected directly between the
master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from
the master. The SS line is the slave select input to the slave. The SS pin of the master must be either high
or reconfigured as a general-purpose output not affecting the SPI.
Figure 12-14. SPI Clock Format 1 (CPHA = 1), with 8-Bit Transfer Width selec ted (XFRW = 0)
tLtT
for tT
, tl, tL
Minimum 1/2 SCK
tItL
If next transfer begins here
Begin End
SCK (CPOL = 0)
SAMPLE I
CHANGE O
SEL SS (O)
Transfer
SCK (CPOL = 1)
MSB first (LSBFE = 0):
LSB first (LSBFE = 1):
MSB
LSB
LSB
MSB
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 6
Bit 1
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 2
Bit 5
Bit 1
Bit 6
CHANGE O
SEL SS (I)
MOSI pin
MISO pin
Master only
MOSI/MISO
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge, not required for back-to-back transfers
tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge
tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time), not required for back-to-back transfers
1 234 56 78910111213141516SCK Edge Number
End of Idle State Begin of Idle State
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 491
Figure 12-15. SPI Clock Format 1 (CPHA = 1), with 16-Bit Transfer Width selected (XFRW = 1)
The SS line can remain active low between successive transfers (can be tied low at all times). This format
is sometimes preferred in systems having a single fixed master and a single slave that drive the MISO data
line.
Back-to-back transfers in master mode
In master mode, if a transmission has completed and new data is available in the SPI data register ,
this data is sent out immediately without a trailing and minimum idle time.
The SPI interrupt request flag (SPIF) is common to both the master and slave modes. SPIF gets set one
half SCK cycle after the last SCK edge.
12.4.4 SPI Baud Rate Generation
Baud rate generation consists of a series of divider stages. Six bits in the SPI baud rate register (SPPR2,
SPPR1, SPPR0, SPR2, SPR1, and SPR0) determine the divisor to the SPI module clock which results in
the SPI baud rate.
The SPI clock rate is determined by the product of the value in the baud rate preselection bits
(SPPR2–SPPR0) and the value in the baud rate selection bits (SPR2–SPR0). The module clock divisor
equation is shown in Equation 12-3.
BaudRateDivisor = (SPPR + 1 ) 2(SPR + 1) Eqn. 12-3
tL
Begin End
SCK (CPOL = 0)
SAMPLE I
CHANGE O
SEL SS (O)
Transfer
SCK (CPOL = 1)
MSB first (LSBFE = 0)
LSB first (LSBFE = 1)
MSB
LSB
LSB
MSB
Bit 13
Bit 2
Bit 14
Bit 1
Bit 12
Bit 3
Bit 11
Bit 4
Bit 5
CHANGE O
SEL SS (I)
MOSI pin
MISO pin
Master only
MOSI/MISO
tT
If next transfer begins here
for tT
, tl, tL
Minimum 1/2 SCK
tItL
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge, not required for back-to-back transfers
tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge
tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time), not required for back-to-back transfers
12345678910111213141516
SCK Edge Number
End of Idle State Begin of Idle State
17181920212223242526272829303132
Bit 10Bit 9Bit 8Bit 7Bit 6 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1
Bit 6Bit 5 Bit 7 Bit 8 Bit 9 Bit 10Bit 11 Bit 12Bit 13Bit 14
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
492 Freescale Semiconductor
When all bits are clear (the default condition), the SPI module clock is divided by 2. When the selection
bits (SPR2–SPR0) are 001 and the preselection bits (SPPR2–SPPR0) are 000, the module clock divisor
becomes 4. When the selection bits are 010, the module clock divisor becomes 8, etc.
When the preselection bits are 001, the divisor determined by the selection bits is multiplied by 2. When
the preselection bits are 010, the divisor is multiplied by 3, etc. See Table 12-7 for baud rate calculations
for all bit conditions, based on a 25 MHz bus clock. The two sets of selects allows the clock to be divided
by a non-power of two to achieve other baud rates such as divide by 6, divide by 10, etc.
The baud rate generator is activated only when the SPI is in master mode and a serial transfer is taking
place. In the other cases, the divider is disabled to decrease IDD current.
NOTE
For maximum allowed baud rates, please refer to the SPI Electrical
Specification in the Electricals chapter of this data sheet.
12.4.5 S pecial Features
12.4.5.1 SS Output
The SS output feature automatically drives the SS pin low during transmission to select external devices
and drives it high during idle to deselect external devices. When SS output is selected, the SS output pin
is connected to the SS input pin of the external device.
The SS output is available only in master mode during normal SPI operation by asserting SSOE and
MODFEN bit as shown in Table 12-3.
The mode fault feature is disabled while SS output is enabled.
NOTE
Care must be taken when using the SS output feature in a multimaster
system because the mode fault feature is not ava ilable for detecting system
errors between masters.
12.4.5.2 Bidirectional Mode (MOMI or SISO)
The bidirectional mode is selected when the SPC0 bit is set in SPI control register 2 (see Table 12-11). In
this mode, the SPI uses only one serial data pin for the interface with external device(s). The MSTR bit
decides which pin to use. The MOSI pin becomes the serial data I/O (MOMI) pin for the master mode, and
the MISO pin becomes serial data I/O (SISO) pin for the slave mode. The MISO pin in master mode and
MOSI pin in slave mode are not used by the SPI.
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 493
The direction of each serial I/O pin depends on the BIDIROE bit. If the pin is configured as an output,
serial data from the shift register is driven out on the pin. The same pin is also the serial input to the shift
register.
The SCK is output for the master mode and input for the slave mode.
The SS is the input or output for the master mode, and it is always the input for the slave mode.
The bidirectional mode does not affect SCK and SS functions.
NOTE
In bidirectional master mode, with mode fault enabled, both data pins MISO
and MOSI can be occupied by the SPI, though MOSI is normally used for
transmissions in bidirectional mode and MISO is not used by the SPI. If a
mode fault occurs, the SPI is automatically switched to slave mode. In this
case MISO becomes occupied by the SPI and MOSI is not used. This must
be considered, if the MISO pin is used for another purpose.
12.4.6 Error Conditions
The SPI has one error condition:
Mode fault error
12.4.6.1 Mode Fault Error
If the SS input becomes low while the SPI is configured as a master , it indicates a system error where more
than one master may be trying to drive the MOSI and SCK lines simultaneously. This condition is not
permitted in normal operation, the MODF bit in the SPI status register is set automatically, provided the
MODFEN bit is set.
In the special case where the SPI is in master mode and MODFEN bit is cleared, the SS pin is not used by
the SPI. In this special case, the mode fault error function is inhibited and MODF remains cleared. In case
Table 12-11. Normal Mode and Bidirectional Mode
When SPE = 1 Master Mode MSTR = 1 Slave Mode MSTR = 0
Normal Mode
SPC0 = 0
Bidirectional Mode
SPC0 = 1
SPI
MOSI
MISO
Serial Out
Serial In
SPI
MOSI
MISO
Serial In
Serial Out
SPI
MOMI
Serial Out
Serial In
BIDIROE
SPI
SISO
Serial In
Serial Out
BIDIROE
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
494 Freescale Semiconductor
the SPI system is configured as a slave, the SS pin is a dedicated input pin. Mode fault error doesn’ t occur
in slave mode.
If a mode fault error occurs, the SPI is switched to slave mode, with the exception that the slave output
buffer is disabled. So SCK, MISO, and MOSI pins are forced to be high impedance inputs to avoid any
possibility of conflict with another output driver. A transmission in progress is aborted and the SPI is
forced into idle state.
If the mode fault error occurs in the bidirectional mode for a SPI system configured in master mode, output
enable of the MOMI (MOSI in bidirectional mode) is cleared if it was set. No mode fault error occurs in
the bidirectional mode for SPI system configured in slave mode.
The mode fault flag is cleared automatically by a read of the SPI status register (with MODF set) followed
by a write to SPI control register 1. If the mode fault flag is cleared, the SPI becomes a normal master or
slave again.
NOTE
If a mode fault error occurs and a received data byte is pending in the receive
shift register, this data byte will be lost.
12.4.7 Low Power Mode Options
12.4.7.1 SPI in Run Mode
In run mode with the SPI system enable (SPE) bit in the SPI control register clear, the SPI system is in a
low-power, disabled state. SPI registers remain accessible, but clocks to the core of this module are
disabled.
12.4.7.2 SPI in Wait Mode
SPI operation in wait mode depends upon the state of the SPISWAI bit in SPI control register 2.
If SPISWAI is clear, the SPI operates normally when the CPU is in wait mode
If SPISWAI is set, SPI clock generation ceases and the SPI module enters a power conservation
state when the CPU is in wait mode.
If SPISWAI is set and the SPI is configured for master, any transmission and reception in
progress stops at wait mode entry. The transmission and reception resumes when the SPI exits
wait mode.
If SPISWAI is set and the SPI is configured as a slave, any transmission and reception in
progress continues if the SCK continues to be driven from the master. This keeps the slave
synchronized to the master and the SCK.
If the master transmits several byte s while the sla ve is in wait mode, the slave will continue to
send out bytes consistent with the operation mode at the start of wait mode (i.e., if the slave is
currently sending its SPIDR to the master, it will continue to send the same byte. Else if the slave
is currently sending the last received byte from the master, it will continue to send each previous
master byte).
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 495
NOTE
Care must be taken when expecting data from a master while the slave is in
wait or stop mode. Even though the shift register will continue to operate,
the rest of the SPI is shut down (i.e., a SPIF interrupt will not be generated
until exiting stop or wait mode). Also, the byte from the shift register will
not be copied into the SPIDR register until after the slave SPI has exited wait
or stop mode. In slave mode, a received byte pending in the receive shift
register will be lost when entering wait or stop mode. An SPIF flag and
SPIDR copy is generated only if wait mode is entered or exited during a
tranmission. If the slave enters wait mode in idle mode and exits wait mode
in idle mode, neither a SPIF nor a SPIDR copy will occur.
12.4.7.3 SPI in Stop Mode
S top mode is dependent on the system. The SPI enters stop mode when the module clock is disabled (held
high or low). If the SPI is in master mode and exchanging data when the CPU enters stop mode, the
transmission is frozen until the CPU exits stop mode. After stop, data to and from the external SPI is
exchanged correctly. In slave mode, the SPI will stay synchronized with the master.
The stop mode is not dependent on the SPISWAI bit.
12.4.7.4 Reset
The reset values of registers and signals are described in Section 12.3, “Memory Map and Register
Definition”, which details the registers and their bit fields.
If a data transmission occurs in slave mode after reset without a write to SPIDR, it will transmit
garbage, or the data last received from the master before the reset.
Reading from the SPIDR after reset will always read zeros.
12.4.7.5 Interrupts
The SPI only originates interrupt requests when SPI is enabled (SPE bit in SPICR1 set). The following is
a description of how the SPI makes a request and how the MCU should acknowledge that request. The
interrupt vector offset and interrupt priority are chip dependent.
The interrupt flags MODF, SPIF, and SPTEF are logically ORed to generate an interrupt request.
12.4.7.5.1 MODF
MODF occurs when the master detects an error on the SS pin. The master SPI must be configured for the
MODF feature (see Table 12-3). After MODF is set, the current transfer is aborted and the following bit is
changed:
MSTR = 0, The master bit in SPICR1 resets.
The MODF interrupt is reflected in the status register MODF flag. Clearing the flag will also clear the
interrupt. This interrupt will stay active while the MODF flag is set. MODF has an automatic clearing
process which is described in Section 12.3.2.4, “SPI Status Register (SPISR)”.
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
496 Freescale Semiconductor
12.4.7.5.2 SPIF
SPIF occurs when new data has been received and copied to the SPI data register. After SPIF is set, it does
not clear until it is serviced. SPIF has an automatic clearing process, which is described in Section 12.3.2.4,
“SPI Status Register (SPISR)”.
12.4.7.5.3 SPTEF
SPTEF occurs when the SPI data register is ready to accept new data. After SPTEF is set, it does not clear
until it is serviced. SPTEF has an automatic clearing process, which is described in Section 12.3.2.4, “SPI
Status Register (SPISR)”.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 497
Chapter 13
Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
Table 13-1. Revision History
13.1 Introduction
The inter-IC bus (IIC) is a two-wire, bidirectional serial bus that provides a simple, efficient method of
data exchange between devices. Being a two-wire device, the IIC bus minimizes the need for large
numbers of connections between devices, and eliminates the need for an address decoder.
This bus is suitable for applicat ions requiring occasional communications over a short distance between a
number of devices. It also provides flexibility, allowing additional devices to be connected to the bus for
further expansion and system development.
The interface is designed to operate up to 100 kbps with maximum bus loading and timing. The device is
capable of operating at higher baud rates, up to a maximum of clock/20, with reduced bus loading. The
maximum communication length and the number of devices that can be connected are limited by a
maximum bus capacitance of 400 pF.
13.1.1 Features
The IIC module has the following key features:
Compatible with I2C bus standard
Multi-master operation
Software programmable for one of 256 different serial clock frequencies
Software selectable acknowledge bit
Interrupt driven byte-by-byte data transfer
Arbitration lost interrupt with automatic mode switching from master to slave
Calling address identification interrupt
Start and stop signal generation/detection
Repeated start signal generation
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Changes
V01.03 28 Jul 2006 13.7.1.7/13-521 - Update flow-chart of interrupt routine for 10-bit address
V01.04 17 Nov 2006 13.3.1.2/13-501 - Revise Table1-5
V01.05 14 Aug 2007 13.3.1.1/13-501 - Backward compatible for IBAD bit name
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
498 Freescale Semiconductor
Acknowledge bit generation/detection
Bus busy detection
General Call Address detection
Compliant to ten-bit address
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 499
13.1.2 Modes of Operation
The IIC functions the same in normal, special, and emulation modes. It has two low power modes: wait
and stop modes.
13.1.3 Block Diagram
The block diagram of the IIC module is shown in Figure 13-1.
Figure 13-1. IIC Block Diagram
In/Out
Data
Shift
Register
Address
Compare
SDA
Interrupt
Clock
Control
Start
Stop
Arbitration
Control
SCL
bus_clock
IIC
Registers
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
500 Freescale Semiconductor
13.2 External Signal Description
The IICV3 module has two external pins.
13.2.1 IIC_SCL — Serial Clock Line Pin
This is the bidirectional serial clock line (SCL) of the module, compatible to the IIC bus specification.
13.2.2 IIC_SDA — Serial Data Line Pin
This is the bidirectional serial data line (SDA) of the module, compatible to the IIC bus specification.
13.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all memory and registers for the IIC module.
13.3.1 Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order . Each description includes a standard register
diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register
diagrams, in bit order.
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
IBAD
RADR7 ADR6 ADR5 ADR4 ADR3 ADR2 ADR1 0
W
0x0001
IBFD
RIBC7 IBC6 IBC5 IBC4 IBC3 IBC2 IBC1 IBC0
W
0x0002
IBCR
RIBEN IBIE MS/SL Tx/Rx TXAK 00
IBSWAI
WRSTA
0x0003
IBSR
R TCF IAAS IBB IBAL 0SRW
IBIF RXAK
W
0x0004
IBDR
RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0005
IBCR2
RGCEN ADTYPE 000
ADR10 ADR9 ADR8
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-2. IIC Register Summary
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 501
13.3.1.1 IIC Address Register (IBAD)
Read and write anytime
This register contains the address the IIC bus will respond to when addressed as a slave; note that it is not
the address sent on the bus during the address transfer.
13.3.1.2 IIC Frequency Divider Register (IBFD)
Read and write anytime
Module Base +0x0000
76543210
R
ADR7 ADR6 ADR5 ADR4 ADR3 ADR2 ADR1
0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-3. IIC Bus Address Register (IBAD)
Table 13-2. IBAD Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:1
ADR[7:1]
Slave Address — Bit 1 to bit 7 contain the specific slave address to be used by the IIC bus module.The default
mode of IIC bus is slave mode for an address match on the bus.
0
Reserved
Reserved — Bit 0 of the IBAD is reserved for future compatibility. This bit will always read 0.
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
R
IBC7 IBC6 IBC5 IBC4 IBC3 IBC2 IBC1 IBC0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-4. IIC Bus Frequency Divider Register (IBFD)
Table 13-3. IBFD Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:0
IBC[7:0]
I Bus Clock Rate 7:0 — This field is used to prescale the clock for bit rate selection. The bit clock generator is
implemented as a prescale divider — IBC7:6, prescaled shift register — IBC5:3 select the prescaler divider and
IBC2-0 select the shift register tap point. The IBC bits are decoded to give the tap and prescale values as shown
in Table 13-4.
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
502 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 13-5. Prescale Divider Encoding
The number of clocks from the falling edge of SCL to the first tap (Tap[1]) is defined by the values shown
in the scl2tap column of Table 13-4, all subsequent tap points are separated by 2IBC5-3 as shown in the
tap2tap column in Table 13-5. The SCL Tap is used to generated the SCL period and the SDA Tap is used
to determine the delay from the falling edge of SCL to SDA changing, the SDA hold time.
IBC7–6 defines the multiplier factor MUL. The values of MUL are shown in the Table 13-6.
Table 13-4. I-Bus Tap and Prescale Values
IBC2-0
(bin) SCL Tap
(clocks) SDA Tap
(clocks)
000 5 1
001 6 1
010 7 2
011 8 2
100 9 3
101 10 3
110 12 4
111 15 4
IBC5-3
(bin) scl2start
(clocks) scl2stop
(clocks) scl2tap
(clocks) tap2tap
(clocks)
0002741
0012742
0102964
0116968
10014171416
10130333032
11062656264
111 126 129 126 128
Ta ble 13-6. Multiplier Factor
IBC7-6 MUL
00 01
01 02
10 04
11 RESERVED
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 503
Figure 13-5. SCL Divider and SDA Hold
The equation used to generate the divider values from the IBFD bits is:
SCL Divider = MUL x {2 x (scl2tap + [(SCL_Tap -1) x tap2tap] + 2)}
The SDA hold delay is equal to the CPU clock period multiplied by the SDA Hold value shown in
Table 13-7. The equation used to generate the SDA Hold value from the IBFD bits is:
SDA Hold = MUL x {scl2tap + [(SDA_Tap - 1) x tap2tap] + 3}
The equation for SCL Hold values to generate the start and stop conditions from the IBFD bits is:
SCL Hold(start) = MUL x [scl2start + (SCL_Tap - 1) x tap2tap]
SCL Hold(stop) = MUL x [scl2stop + (SCL_Tap - 1) x tap2tap]
Table 13-7. IIC Divider and Hold Values (Sheet 1 of 6)
IBC[7:0]
(hex) SCL Divider
(clocks) SDA Hold
(clocks) SCL Hold
(start) SCL Hold
(stop)
MUL=1
SCL Divider
SDA Hold
SCL
SDA
SDA
SCL
START condition STOP condition
SCL Hold(start) SCL Hold(stop)
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
504 Freescale Semiconductor
00 20/22 7 6 11
01 22/24 7 7 12
02 24/26 8 8 13
03 26/28 8 9 14
04 28/30 9 10 15
05 30/32 9 11 16
06 34/36 10 13 18
07 40/42 10 16 21
08 28/32 7 10 15
09 32/36 7 12 17
0A 36/40 9 14 19
0B 40/44 9 16 21
0C 44/48 11 18 23
0D 48/52 11 20 25
0E 56/60 13 24 29
0F 68/72 13 30 35
10 48 9 18 25
11 56 9 22 29
12 64 13 26 33
13 72 13 30 37
14 80 17 34 41
15 88 17 38 45
16 104 21 46 53
17 128 21 58 65
18 80 9 38 41
19 96 9 46 49
1A 112 17 54 57
1B 128 17 62 65
1C 144 25 70 73
1D 160 25 78 81
1E 192 33 94 97
1F 240 33 118 121
20 160 17 78 81
21 192 17 94 97
22 224 33 110 113
23 256 33 126 129
24 288 49 142 145
25 320 49 158 161
26 384 65 190 193
27 480 65 238 241
28 320 33 158 161
29 384 33 190 193
2A 448 65 222 225
2B 512 65 254 257
2C 576 97 286 289
Table 13-7. IIC Divider and Hold Values (Sheet 2 of 6)
IBC[7:0]
(hex) SCL Divider
(clocks) SDA Hold
(clocks) SCL Hold
(start) SCL Hold
(stop)
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 505
2D 640 97 318 321
2E 768 129 382 385
2F 960 129 478 481
30 640 65 318 321
31 768 65 382 385
32 896 129 446 449
33 1024 129 510 513
34 1152 193 574 577
35 1280 193 638 641
36 1536 257 766 769
37 1920 257 958 961
38 1280 129 638 641
39 1536 129 766 769
3A 1792 257 894 897
3B 2048 257 1022 1025
3C 2304 385 1150 1153
3D 2560 385 1278 1281
3E 3072 513 1534 1537
3F 3840 513 1918 1921
MUL=2
40 40 14 12 22
41 44 14 14 24
42 48 16 16 26
43 52 16 18 28
44 56 18 20 30
45 60 18 22 32
46 68 20 26 36
47 80 20 32 42
48 56 14 20 30
49 64 14 24 34
4A 72 18 28 38
4B 80 18 32 42
4C 88 22 36 46
4D 96 22 40 50
4E 112 26 48 58
4F 136 26 60 70
50 96 18 36 50
51 112 18 44 58
52 128 26 52 66
53 144 26 60 74
54 160 34 68 82
55 176 34 76 90
56 208 42 92 106
57 256 42 116 130
58 160 18 76 82
Table 13-7. IIC Divider and Hold Values (Sheet 3 of 6)
IBC[7:0]
(hex) SCL Divider
(clocks) SDA Hold
(clocks) SCL Hold
(start) SCL Hold
(stop)
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
506 Freescale Semiconductor
59 192 18 92 98
5A 224 34 108 114
5B 256 34 124 130
5C 288 50 140 146
5D 320 50 156 162
5E 384 66 188 194
5F 480 66 236 242
60 320 34 156 162
61 384 34 188 194
62 448 66 220 226
63 512 66 252 258
64 576 98 284 290
65 640 98 316 322
66 768 130 380 386
67 960 130 476 482
68 640 66 316 322
69 768 66 380 386
6A 896 130 444 450
6B 1024 130 508 514
6C 1152 194 572 578
6D 1280 194 636 642
6E 1536 258 764 770
6F 1920 258 956 962
70 1280 130 636 642
71 1536 130 764 770
72 1792 258 892 898
73 2048 258 1020 1026
74 2304 386 1148 1154
75 2560 386 1276 1282
76 3072 514 1532 1538
77 3840 514 1916 1922
78 2560 258 1276 1282
79 3072 258 1532 1538
7A 3584 514 1788 1794
7B 4096 514 2044 2050
7C 4608 770 2300 2306
7D 5120 770 2556 2562
7E 6144 1026 3068 3074
7F 7680 1026 3836 3842
MUL=4
80 72 28 24 44
81 80 28 28 48
82 88 32 32 52
83 96 32 36 56
84 104 36 40 60
Table 13-7. IIC Divider and Hold Values (Sheet 4 of 6)
IBC[7:0]
(hex) SCL Divider
(clocks) SDA Hold
(clocks) SCL Hold
(start) SCL Hold
(stop)
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 507
85 112 36 44 64
86 128 40 52 72
87 152 40 64 84
88 112 28 40 60
89 128 28 48 68
8A 144 36 56 76
8B 160 36 64 84
8C 176 44 72 92
8D 192 44 80 100
8E 224 52 96 116
8F 272 52 120 140
90 192 36 72 100
91 224 36 88 116
92 256 52 104 132
93 288 52 120 148
94 320 68 136 164
95 352 68 152 180
96 416 84 184 212
97 512 84 232 260
98 320 36 152 164
99 384 36 184 196
9A 448 68 216 228
9B 512 68 248 260
9C 576 100 280 292
9D 640 100 312 324
9E 768 132 376 388
9F 960 132 472 484
A0 640 68 312 324
A1 768 68 376 388
A2 896 132 440 452
A3 1024 132 504 516
A4 1152 196 568 580
A5 1280 196 632 644
A6 1536 260 760 772
A7 1920 260 952 964
A8 1280 132 632 644
A9 1536 132 760 772
AA 1792 260 888 900
AB 2048 260 1016 1028
AC 2304 388 1144 1156
AD 2560 388 1272 1284
AE 3072 516 1528 1540
AF 3840 516 1912 1924
B0 2560 260 1272 1284
B1 3072 260 1528 1540
Table 13-7. IIC Divider and Hold Values (Sheet 5 of 6)
IBC[7:0]
(hex) SCL Divider
(clocks) SDA Hold
(clocks) SCL Hold
(start) SCL Hold
(stop)
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
508 Freescale Semiconductor
Note:Since the bus frequency is speeding up,the SCL Divider could be expanded by it.Therefore,in the
table,when IBC[7:0] is from $00 to $0F,the SCL Divider is revised by the format value1/value2.Value1 is
the divider under the low frequency.Value2 is the divider under the high frequency.How to select the
divider depends on the bus frequency.When IBC[7:0] is from $10 to $BF,the divider is not changed.
13.3.1.3 IIC Control Register (IBCR)
Read and write anytime
B2 3584 516 1784 1796
B3 4096 516 2040 2052
B4 4608 772 2296 2308
B5 5120 772 2552 2564
B6 6144 1028 3064 3076
B7 7680 1028 3832 3844
B8 5120 516 2552 2564
B9 6144 516 3064 3076
BA 7168 1028 3576 3588
BB 8192 1028 4088 4100
BC 9216 1540 4600 4612
BD 10240 1540 5112 5124
BE 12288 2052 6136 6148
BF 15360 2052 7672 7684
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
R
IBEN IBIE MS/SL Tx/Rx TXAK
00
IBSWAI
WRSTA
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-6. IIC Bus Control Register (IBCR)
Table 13-7. IIC Divider and Hold Values (Sheet 6 of 6)
IBC[7:0]
(hex) SCL Divider
(clocks) SDA Hold
(clocks) SCL Hold
(start) SCL Hold
(stop)
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 509
Wait mode is entered via execution of a CPU WAI instruction. In the event that the IBSWAI bit is set, all
clocks internal to the IIC will be stopped and any transmission currently in progress will halt.If the CPU
were woken up by a source other than the IIC module, then clocks would restart and the IIC would resume
Table 13-8. IBCR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
IBEN
I-Bus Enable — This bit controls the software reset of the entire IIC bus module.
0 The module is reset and disabled. This is the power-on reset situation. When low the interface is held in reset
but registers can be accessed
1 The IIC bus module is enabled.This bit must be set before any other IBCR bits have any effect
If the IIC bus module is enabled in the middle of a byte transfer the interface behaves as follows: slave mode
ignores the current transfer on the bus and starts operating whenever a subsequent start condition is detected.
Master mode will not be aware that the bus is busy, hence if a start cycle is initiated then the current bus cycle
may become corrupt. This would ultimately result in either the current bus master or the IIC bus module losing
arbitration, after which bus operation would return to normal.
6
IBIE
I-Bus Interrupt Enable
0 Interrupts from the IIC bus module are disabled. Note that this does not clear any currently pending interrupt
condition
1 Interrupts from the IIC bus module are enabled. An IIC bus interrupt occurs provided the IBIF bit in the status
register is also set.
5
MS/SL
Master/Slave Mode Select Bit — Upon reset, this bit is cleared. When this bit is changed from 0 to 1, a START
signal is generated on the bus, and the master mode is selected. When this bit is changed from 1 to 0, a STOP
signal is generated and the operation mode changes from master to slave.A STOP signal should only be
generated if the IBIF flag is set. MS/SL is cleared without generating a STOP signal when the master loses
arbitration.
0 Slave Mode
1 Master Mode
4
Tx/Rx
Transmit/Receive Mode Select Bit — This bit selects the direction of master and slave transfers. When
addressed as a slave this bit should be set by software according to the SRW bit in the status register. In master
mode this bit should be set according to the type of transfer required. Therefore, for address cycles, this bit will
always be high.
0 Receive
1 Transmit
3
TXAK
T ransmit Acknowledge Enable — This bit specifies the value driven onto SDA during data acknowledge cycles
for both master and slave receivers. The IIC module will always acknowledge address matches, provided it is
enabled, regardless of the value of TXAK. Note that values written to this bit are only used when the IIC bus is a
receiver, not a transmitter.
0 An acknowledge signal will be sent out to the bus at the 9th clock bit after receiving one byte data
1 No acknowledge signal response is sent (i.e., acknowledge bit = 1)
2
RSTA
Repeat Start — Writing a 1 to this bit will generate a repeated START condition on the bus, provided it is the
current bus master. This bit will always be read as a low. Attempting a repeated start at the wrong time, if the bus
is owned by another master, will result in loss of arbitration.
1 Generate repeat start cycle
1
RESERVED
Reserved — Bit 1 of the IBCR is reserved for future compatibility. This bit will always read 0.
0
IBSWAI
I Bus Interface Stop in Wait Mode
0 IIC bus module clock operates normally
1 Halt IIC bus module clock generation in wait mode
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
510 Freescale Semiconductor
from where was during the previous transmission. It is not possible for the IIC to wake up the CPU when
its internal clocks are stopped.
If it were the case that the IBSWAI bit was cleared when the WAI instruction was executed, the IIC internal
clocks and interface would remain alive, continuing the operation which was currently underway . It is also
possible to configure the IIC such that it will wake up the CPU via an interrupt at the conclusion of the
current operation. See the discussion on the IBIF and IBIE bits in the IBSR and IBCR, respectively.
13.3.1.4 IIC Status Register (IBSR)
This status register is read-only with exception of bit 1 (IBIF) and bit 4 (IBAL), which are software
clearable.
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R TCF IAAS IBB
IBAL
0SRW
IBIF
RXAK
W
Reset10000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-7. IIC Bus Status Register (IBSR)
Table 13-9. IBSR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
TCF
Data Transferring Bit — While one byte of data is being transferred, this bit is cleared. It is set by the falling
edge of the 9th clock of a byte transfer. Note that this bit is only valid during or immediately following a transfer
to the IIC module or from the IIC module.
0 Transfer in progress
1 Transfer complete
6
IAAS
Addressed as a Slave Bit When its own specific address (I-bus address register) is matched with the calling
address or it receives the general call address with GCEN== 1,this bit is set.The CPU is interrupted provided the
IBIE is set.Then the CPU needs to check the SRW bit and set its Tx/Rx mode accordingly.Writing to the I-bus
control register clears this bit.
0 Not addressed
1 Addressed as a slave
5
IBB
Bus Busy Bit
0 This bit indicates the status of the bus. When a START signal is detected, the IBB is set. If a STOP signal is
detected, IBB is cleared and the bus enters idle state.
1Bus is busy
4
IBAL
Arbitration Lost — The arbitration lost bit (IBAL) is set by hardware when the arbitration procedure is lost.
Arbitration is lost in the following circumstances:
1. SDA sampled low when the master drives a high during an address or data transmit cycle.
2. SDA sampled low when the master drives a high during the acknowledge bit of a data receive cycle.
3. A start cycle is attempted when the bus is busy.
4. A repeated start cycle is requested in slave mode.
5. A stop condition is detected when the master did not request it.
This bit must be cleared by software, by writing a one to it. A write of 0 has no effect on this bit.
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 511
13.3.1.5 IIC Data I/O Register (IBDR)
In master transmit mode, when data is wr itten to the IBDR a data transfer is initiated. The most significant
bit is sent first. In master receive mode, reading this register initiates next byte data receiving. In slave
mode, the same functions are available after an addres s match has occurred.Note that the Tx/Rx bit in the
IBCR must correctly reflect the desired direction of transfer in master and slave modes for the transmission
to begin. For instance, if the IIC is configured for master transmit but a master receive is desired, then
reading the IBDR will not initiate the receive.
Reading the IBDR will return the last byte received while the IIC is configured in either master receive or
slave receive modes. The IBDR does not reflect every byte that is transmitted on the IIC bus, nor can
software verify that a byte has been written to the IBDR correctly by reading it back.
In master transmit mode, the first byte of data written to IBDR following assertion of MS/SL is used for
the address transfer and should com.prise of the calling address (in position D7:D1) concatenated with the
required R/W bit (in position D0).
3
RESERVED
Reserved — Bit 3 of IBSR is reserved for future use. A read operation on this bit will return 0.
2
SRW
Slave Read/Write — When IAAS is set this bit indicates the value of the R/W command bit of the calling address
sent from the master
This bit is only valid when the I-bus is in slave mode, a complete address transfer has occurred with an address
match and no other transfers have been initiated.
Checking this bit, the CPU can select slave transmit/receive mode according to the command of the master.
0 Slave receive, master writing to slave
1 Slave transmit, master reading from slave
1
IBIF
I-Bus Interrupt — The IBIF bit is set when one of the following conditions occurs:
— Arbitration lost (IBAL bit set)
— Data transfer complete (TCF bit set)
— Addressed as slave (IAAS bit set)
It will cause a processor interrupt request if the IBIE bit is set. This bit must be cleared by software, writing a one
to it. A write of 0 has no effect on this bit.
0
RXAK
Received Acknowledge — The value of SDA during the acknowledge bit of a bus cycle. If the received
acknowledge bit (RXAK) is low, it indicates an acknowledge signal has been received after the completion of 8
bits data transmission on the bus. If RXAK is high, it means no acknowledge signal is detected at the 9th clock.
0 Acknowledge received
1 No acknowledge received
Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
R
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 13-8. IIC Bus Data I/O Register (IBDR)
Table 13-9. IBSR Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
512 Freescale Semiconductor
13.3.1.6 IIC Control Register 2(IBCR2)
Figure 13-9. IIC Bus Control Register 2(IBCR2)
This register contains the variables used in general call and in ten-bit address.
Read and write anytime
13.4 Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the IICV3.
13.4.1 I-Bus Protocol
The IIC bus system uses a serial data line (SDA) and a serial clock line (SCL) for data transfer. All devices
connected to it must have open drain or open collector outputs. Logic AND function is exercised on both
lines with external pull-up resistors. The value of these resistors is system dependent.
Normally , a standard communication is composed of four parts: ST AR T signal, slave address transmission,
data transfer and STOP signal. They are described briefly in the following sections and illustrated in
Figure 13-10.
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
R
GCEN ADTYPE
000
ADR10 ADR9 ADR8
W
Reset00000000
Table 13-10 . IBCR 2 Fi el d De sc rip ti on s
Field Description
7
GCEN
General Call Enable.
0 General call is disabled. The module dont receive any general call data and address.
1 enable general call. It indicates that the module can receive address and any data.
6
ADTYPE
Address T ype— This bit selects the address length. The variable must be configured correctly before IIC enters
slave mode.
0 7-bit address
1 10-bit address
5,4,3
RESERVED
Reserved — Bit 5,4 and 3 of the IBCR2 are reserved for future compatibility. These bits will always read 0.
2:0
ADR[10:8]
Slave Address [10:8] —These 3 bits represent the MSB of the 10-bit address when address type is asserted
(ADTYPE = 1).
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 513
Figure 13-10. IIC-Bus Transmission Signals
13.4.1.1 START Signal
When the bus is free, i.e. no master device is engaging the bus (both SCL and SDA lines are at logical
high), a master may initiate communication by sending a START signal.As shown in Figure 13-10, a
START signal is defined as a high-to-low transition of SDA while SCL is high. This signal denotes the
beginning of a new data transfer (each data transfer may contain several bytes of data) and brings all slaves
out of their idle states.
Figure 13-11. Start and Stop Conditions
CL
DA
Start
Signal Ack
Bit
12345678
MSB LSB 12345678
MSB LSB
No
CL
DA
12345678
MSB LSB 12 5 678
MSB LSB
Repeated
34
9 9
ADR7 ADR6ADR5ADR4ADR3 ADR2ADR1R/W XXX D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Calling Address Read/ Data Byte
ADR7 ADR6ADR5ADR4ADR3ADR2ADR1R/W ADR7 ADR6ADR5ADR4ADR3ADR2ADR1R/W
New Calling Address
99
XX
Ack
Bit
Write
Start
Signal
Start
Signal Ack
Bit
Calling Address Read/
Write No
Ack
Bit
Read/
Write
SDA
SCL
START Condition STOP Condition
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
514 Freescale Semiconductor
13.4.1.2 Slave Address Transmi ssio n
The first byte of data transfer immediately after the START signal is the slave address transmitted by the
master. This is a seven-bit calling address followed by a R/W bit. The R/W bit tells the slave the desired
direction of data transfer.
1 = Read transfer, the slave transmits data to the master.
0 = Write transfer, the master transmits data to the slave.
If the calling address is 10-bit, another byte is followed by the first byte.Only the slave with a calling
address that matches the one transmitted by the master will respond by sending back an acknowledge bit.
This is done by pulling the SDA low at the 9th clock (see Figure 13-10).
No two slaves in the system may have the same address. If the IIC bus is master, it must not transmit an
address that is equal to its own slave address. The IIC bus cannot be master and slave at the same
time.However, if arbitration is lost during an address cycle the IIC bus will revert to slave mode and
operate correctly even if it is being addressed by another master.
13.4.1.3 Data Transfer
As soon as successful slave addressing is achieved, the data transfer can proceed byte-by-byte in a
direction specified by the R/W bit sent by the calling master
All transfers that come after an address cycle are referred to as data transfers, even if they carry sub-address
information for the slave device.
Each data byte is 8 bits long. Data may be changed only while SCL is low and must be held stable while
SCL is high as shown in Figure 13-10. There is one clock pulse on SCL for each data bit, the MSB being
transferred first. Each data byte has to be followed by an acknowledge bit, which is signalled from the
receiving device by pulling the SDA low at the ninth clock. So one complete data byte transfer needs nine
clock pulses.
If the slave receiver does not acknowledge the master, the SDA line must be left high by the slave. The
master can then generate a stop signal to abort the data transfer or a start signal (repeated start) to
commence a new calling.
If the master receiver does not acknowledge the slave transmitter after a byte transmission, it means 'end
of data' to the slave, so the slave releases the SDA line for the master to generate STOP or START
signal.Note in order to release the bus correctly,after no-acknowledge to the master,the slave must be
immediately switched to receiver and a following dummy reading of the IBDR is necessary.
13.4.1.4 STOP Signal
The master can terminate the communication by generating a STOP signal to free the bus. However, the
master may generate a START signal followed by a calling command without generating a STOP signal
first. This is called repeated START. A STOP signal is defined as a low-to-high transition of SDA while
SCL at logical 1 (see Figure 13-10).
The master can generate a ST OP even if the slave has generated an acknowledge at which point the slave
must release the bus.
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 515
13.4.1.5 Repeated START Sign al
As shown in Figure 13-10, a repeated START signal is a STAR T signal generated without first generating
a STOP signal to terminate the communication. This is used by the master to communicate with another
slave or with the same slave in different mode (transmit/receive mode) without releasing the bus.
13.4.1.6 Arbitration Procedure
The Inter -IC bus is a true multi-master bus that allows more than one master to be connected on it. If two
or more masters try to control the bus at the same time, a clock synchronization procedure determines the
bus clock, for which the low period is equal to the longest clock low period and the high is equal to the
shortest one among the masters. The relative priority of the contending masters is determined by a data
arbitration procedure, a bus master loses arbitration if it transmits logic 1 while another master transmits
logic 0. The losing masters immediately switch over to slave receive mode and stop driving SDA output.
In this case the transition from master to slave mode does not generate a STOP condition. Meanwhile, a
status bit is set by hardware to indicate loss of arbitration.
13.4.1.7 Clock Synchronization
Because wire-AND logic is performed on SCL line, a high-to-low transition on SCL line affects all the
devices connected on the bus. The devices start counting their low period and as soon as a device's clock
has gone low, it holds the SCL line low until the clock high state is reached.However, the change of low
to high in this device clock may not change the state of the SCL line if another device clock is within its
low period. Therefore, synchronized clock SCL is held low by the device with the longest low period.
Devices with shorter low periods enter a high wait state during this time (see Figure 13-11). When all
devices concerned have counted off their low period, the synchronized clock SCL line is released and
pulled high. There is then no dif ference between the device clocks and the state of the SCL line and all the
devices start counting their high periods.The first device to complete its high period pulls the SCL line low
again.
Figure 13-12. IIC-Bus Clock Synchronization
SCL1
SCL2
SCL
Internal Counter Reset
WAIT Start Counting High Period
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
516 Freescale Semiconductor
13.4.1.8 Handshaking
The clock synchronization mechanism can be used as a handshake in data transfer . Slave devices may hold
the SCL low after completion of one byte transfer (9 bits). In such case, it halts the bus clock and forces
the master clock into wait states until the slave releases the SCL line.
13.4.1.9 Clock Stretching
The clock synchronization mechanism can be used by slaves to slow down the bit rate of a transf er. After
the master has driven SCL low the slave can drive SCL low for the required period and then release it.If
the slave SCL low period is greater than the master SCL low period then the resulting SCL bus signal low
period is stretched.
13.4.1.10 Ten-bit Address
A ten-bit address is indicated if the first 5 bits of the first address byte are 0x11110. The following rules
apply to the first address byte.
Figure 13-13. Definition of bits in the first byte.
The address type is identified by ADTYPE. When ADTYPE is 0, 7-bit address is applied. Reversely, the
address is 10-bit address.Generally, there are two cases of 10-bit address.See the Figure 13-14 and
Figure 13-15.
Figure 13-14. A master-transmitter addresses a slave-receiver with a 10-bit address
Figure 13-15. A master-receiver addresses a slave-transmitter with a 10-bit address.
In the Figure 13-15, the first two bytes are the similar to Figure 13-14. After the repeate d START(Sr),the
first slave address is transmitted again, but the R/W is 1, meaning that th e slave is acted as a transmitter.
SLAVE
ADDRESS R/W BIT DESCRIPTION
0000000 0 General call address
0000010 x Reserved for different bus
format
0000011 x Reserved for future purposes
11111XX x Reserved for future purposes
11110XX x 10-bit slave addressing
SSlave Add1st 7bits
11110+ADR10+ADR9
R/W
0A1 Slave Add 2nd byte
ADR[8:1] A2 Data A3
SSlave Add1st 7bits
11110+ADR10+ADR9
R/W
0A1 Slave Add 2nd byte
ADR[8:1] A2 Sr Slave Add 1st 7bits
11110+ADR10+ADR9
R/W
1A3 Data A4
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 517
13.4.1.11 General Call Address
To broadcast using a general call, a device must first generate the general call address($00), then after
receiving acknowledge, it must transmit data.
In communication, as a slave device, provided the GCEN is asserted, a device acknowledges the broadcast
and receives data until the GCEN is disabled or the master device releases the bus or generates a new
transfer. In the broadcast, slaves always act as receivers. In general call, IAAS is also used to indicate the
address match.
In order to distinguish whether the address match is the normal address match or the general call address
match, IBDR should be read after the address byte has been received. If the data is $00, the match is
general call address match. The meaning of the general call address is always specified in the first data
byte and must be dealt with by S/W, the IIC hardware does not decode and process the first data byte.
When one byte transfer is done, the received data can be read from IBDR. The user can control the
procedure by enabling or disabling GCEN.
13.4.2 Operation in Run Mode
This is the basic mode of operation.
13.4.3 Operation in Wait Mode
IIC operation in wait mode can be configured. Depending on the state of internal bits, the IIC can operate
normally when the CPU is in wait mode or the IIC clock generation can be turned of f and the IIC module
enters a power conservation state during wait mode. In the later case, any transmission or reception in
progress stops at wait mode entry.
13.4.4 Operation in Stop Mode
The IIC is inactive in stop mode for reduced power consumption. The STOP instruction does not affect
IIC register states.
13.5 Resets
The reset state of each individual bit is listed in Section 13.3, “Memory Map and Register Definition,”
which details the registers and their bit-fields.
13.6 Interrupts
IICV3 uses only one interrupt vector.
Table 13-11. Interrupt Summary
Interrupt Offset Vector Priority Source Description
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
518 Freescale Semiconductor
Internally there are three types of interrupts in IIC. The interrupt service routine can determine the interrupt
type by reading the status register.
IIC Interrupt can be generated on
1. Arbitration lost condition (IBAL bit set)
2. Byte transfer condition (TCF bit set)
3. Address detect condition (IAAS bit set)
The IIC interrupt is enabled by the IBIE bit in the IIC control register. It must be cleared by writing 0 to
the IBF bit in the interrupt service routine.
13.7 Application Information
13.7.1 IIC Programming Examples
13.7.1.1 Initialization Sequence
Reset will put the IIC bus control register to its default status. Before the interface can be used to transfer
serial data, an initialization procedure must be carried out, as follows:
1. Update the frequency divider register (IBFD) and select the required division ratio to obtain SCL
frequency from system clock.
2. Update the ADTYPE of IBCR2 to define the address length, 7 bits or 10 bits.
3. Update the IIC bus address register (IBAD) to define its slave address. If 10-bit address is applied
IBCR2 should be updated to define the rest bits of address.
4. Set the IBEN bit of the IIC bus control register (IBCR) to enable the IIC interface system.
5. Modify the bits of the IIC bus control register (IBCR) to select master/slave mode, transmit/receive
mode and interrupt enable or not.
6. If supported general call, the GCEN in IBCR2 should be asserted.
13.7.1.2 Generation of START
After completion of the initialization procedure, serial data can be transmitted by selecting the 'master
transmitter' mode. If the device is connected to a multi-master bus system, the state of the IIC bus busy bit
(IBB) must be tested to check whether the serial bus is free.
If the bus is free (IBB=0), the start condition and the first byte (the slave address) can be sent. The data
written to the data register comprises the slave calling address and the LSB set to indicate the direction of
transfer required from the slave.
The bus free time (i.e., the time between a STOP condition and the following START condition) is built
into the hardware that generates the START cycle. Depending on the relative frequencies of the system
IIC
Interrupt
IBAL, TCF, IAAS
bits in IBSR
register
When either of IBAL, TCF or IAAS bits is set
may cause an interrupt based on arbitration
lost, transfer complete or address detect
conditions
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 519
clock and the SCL period it may be necessary to wait until the IIC is busy after writing the calling address
to the IBDR before proceeding with the following instructions. This is illustrated in the following example.
An example of a program which generates the START signal and transmits the first byte of data (slave
address) is shown below:
13.7.1.3 Post-Transfer Software Response
Transmission or reception of a byte will set the data transf err ing bit (TCF) to 1, which indicates one byte
communication is finished. The IIC bus interrupt bit (IBIF) is set also; an interrupt will be generated if the
interrupt function is enabled during initialization by setting the IBIE bit. Software must clear the IBIF bit
in the interrupt routine first. The TCF bit will be cleared by reading from the IIC bus data I/O register
(IBDR) in receive mode or writing to IBDR in transmit mode.
Software may service the IIC I/O in the main program by monitoring the IBIF bit if the interrupt function
is disabled. Note that polling should monitor the IBIF bit rather than the TCF bit because their operation
is different when arbitration is lost.
Note that when an interrupt occurs at the end of the address cycle the master will always be in transmit
mode, i.e. the address is transmitted. If master receive mode is required, indicated by R/W bit in IBDR,
then the Tx/Rx bit should be toggled at this stage.
During slave mode address cycles (IAAS=1), the SRW bit in the status register is read to determine the
direction of the subsequent transfer and the Tx/Rx bit is programmed accordingly.For slave mode data
cycles (IAAS=0) the SR W bit is not valid, the Tx/Rx bit in the control register should be read to determine
the direction of the current transfer.
The following is an example of a software response by a 'master transmitter' in the interrupt routine.
13.7.1.4 Generation of STOP
A data transfer ends with a ST OP signal generated by the 'master' device. A master transmitter can simply
generate a STOP signal afte r all the data has been transmitted. The following is an example showing how
a stop condition is generated by a master transmitter.
CHFLAG BRSET IBSR,#$20,* ;WAIT FOR IBB FLAG TO CLEAR
TXSTART BSET IBCR,#$30 ;SET TRANSMIT AND MASTER MODE;i.e. GENERATE START CONDITION
MOVB CALLING,IBDR ;TRANSMIT THE CALLING ADDRESS, D0=R/W
IBFREE BRCLR IBSR,#$20,* ;WAIT FOR IBB FLAG TO SET
ISR BCLR IBSR,#$02 ;CLEAR THE IBIF FLAG
BRCLR IBCR,#$20,SLAVE ;BRANCH IF IN SLAVE MODE
BRCLR IBCR,#$10,RECEIVE ;BRANCH IF IN RECEIVE MODE
BRSET IBSR,#$01,END ;IF NO ACK, END OF TRANSMISSION
TRANSMIT MOVB DATABUF,IBDR ;TRANSMIT NEXT BYTE OF DATA
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
520 Freescale Semiconductor
If a master receiver wants to terminate a data transfer, it must inform the slave transmitter by not
acknowledging the last byte of data which can be done by setting the transmit acknowledge bit (TXAK)
before reading the 2nd last byte of data. Before reading the last byte of data, a STOP signal must be
generated first. The following is an example showing how a ST OP signal is generated by a master receiver .
13.7.1.5 Generation of Repeated START
At the end of data transfer, if the master continues to want to communicate on the bus, it can generate
another START signal followed by another slave address without first generating a STOP signal. A
program example is as shown.
13.7.1.6 Slave Mode
In the slave interrupt service routine, the module addressed as slave bit (IAAS) should be tested to check
if a calling of its own address has just been received. If IAAS is set, software should set the
transmit/receive mode select bit (Tx/Rx bit of IBCR) according to the R/W command bit (SRW). W riting
to the IBCR clears the IAAS automatically . Note that the only time IAAS is read as set is from the interrupt
at the end of the address cycle where an address match occurred, interr upts resulting from subsequent data
transfers will have IAAS cleared. A data transfer may now be initiated by writing information to IBDR,
for slave transmits, or dummy reading from IBDR, in slave receive mode. The slave will drive SCL low
in-between byte transfers, SCL is released when the IBDR is accessed in the required mode.
In slave transmitter routine, the received acknowledge bit (RXAK) must be tested before transmitting the
next byte of data. Setting RXAK means an 'end of data' signal from the master receiver , after which it must
be switched from transmitter mode to receiver mode by software. A dummy read then releases the SCL
line so that the master can generate a STOP signal.
MASTX TST TXCNT ;GET VALUE FROM THE TRANSMITING COUNTER
BEQ END ;END IF NO MORE DATA
BRSET IBSR,#$01,END ;END IF NO ACK
MOVB DATABUF,IBDR ;TRANSMIT NEXT BYTE OF DATA
DEC TXCNT ;DECREASE THE TXCNT
BRA EMASTX ;EXIT
END BCLR IBCR,#$20 ;GENERATE A STOP CONDITION
EMASTX RTI ;RETURN FROM INTERRUPT
MASR DEC RXCNT ;DECREASE THE RXCNT
BEQ ENMASR ;LAST BYTE TO BE READ
MOVB RXCNT,D1 ;CHECK SECOND LAST BYTE
DEC D1 ;TO BE READ
BNE NXMAR ;NOT LAST OR SECOND LAST
LAMAR BSET IBCR,#$08 ;SECOND LAST, DISABLE ACK
;TRANSMITTING
BRA NXMAR
ENMASR BCLR IBCR,#$20 ;LAST ONE, GENERATE ‘STOP’ SIGNAL
NXMAR MOVB IBDR,RXBUF ;READ DATA AND STORE
RTI
RESTART BSET IBCR,#$04 ;ANOTHER START (RESTART)
MOVB CALLING,IBDR ;TRANSMIT THE CALLING ADDRESS;D0=R/W
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 521
13.7.1.7 Arbitration Lost
If several masters try to engage the bus simultaneously, only one master wins and the others lose
arbitration. The devices which lost arbitration are immediately switched to slave receive mode by the
hardware. Their data output to the SDA line is stopped, but SCL continues to be generated until the end of
the byte during which arbitration was lost. An interrupt occurs at the falling edge of the ninth clock of this
transfer with IBAL=1 and MS/SL=0. If one master attempts to start transmission while the bus is being
engaged by another master, the hardware will inhibit the transmission; switch the MS/SL bit from 1 to 0
without generating STOP condition; generate an interrupt to CPU and set the IBAL to indicate that the
attempt to engage the bus is failed. When considering these cases, the slave service routine should test the
IBAL first and the software should clear the IBAL bit if it is set.
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
522 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 13-16. Flow-Chart of Typical IIC Interrupt Routine
Clear
Master
Mode
?
Tx/Rx
?
Last Byte
Transmitted
?
RXAK=0
?
End Of
Addr Cycle
(Master Rx)
?
Write Next
Byte To IBDR
Switch T o
Rx Mode
Dummy Read
From IBDR Generate
Stop Signal Read Data
From IBDR
And Store
Set TXAK =1 Generate
Stop Signal
2nd Last
Byte To Be Read
?
Last
Byte To Be Read
?
Arbitration
Lost
?
Clear IBAL
IAAS=1
?
IAAS=1
?
SRW=1
?
TX/RX
?
Set TX
Mode
Write Data
To IBDR
Set RX
Mode
Dummy Read
From IBDR
ACK From
Receiver
?
Tx Next
Byte
Read Data
From IBDR
And Store
Switch To
Rx Mode
Dummy Read
From IBDR
RTI
YN
Y
YY
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
TX RX
RX
TX
(Write)
(Read)
N
IBIF
Data Transfer
YY
10-bit
address?
NN
7-bit address transfer
Y
10-bit address transfer
Mode
set RX
Dummy Read
From IBDR
N
set TX
Mode
Write Data
To IBDR
Y
IBDR==
11110xx1?
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 523
Caution:When IIC is configured as 10-bit address,the point of the data array in interrupt routine must be
reset after it’s addressed.
Chapter 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (IICV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
524 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 525
Chapter 14
Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
Revision History
14.1 Introduction
The LCD40F4BV3 driver module has 40 frontplane drivers and 4 backplane drivers so that a maximum
of 160 LCD segments are controllable. Each segment is controlled by a corresponding bit in the LCD
RAM. Four multiplex modes (1/1, 1/2, 1/3, 1/4 duty), and three bias (1/1, 1/2, 1/3) methods are available.
The V0 voltage is the lowest level of the output waveform and V3 becomes the highest level. All frontplane
and backplane pins can be multiplexed with other port functions.
The LCD40F4BV3 driver system consists of five major sub-modules:
Timing and Control – consists of registers and control logic for frame clock generation, bias
voltage level select, frame duty select, backplane select, and frontplane select/enable to produce
the required frame frequency and voltage waveforms.
Table 14-1. LCD40F4BV3 Revision History
Version
Number Revision
Date Effective
Date Author Descriptio n of Changes
01.00 26-Jul-00 initial LCD module spec
01.08 27-Mar-08 New specification for 9S12HY family based on 9S12H family specification
01.09 25-Apr-08 Update for 9S12HY defining last registers as unimplemented
02.01 29-Jul-09 add pseudo stop feature
03.01 07-Jun-11 update lcd clock prescaler on page 14-532 and table on page 14-537Change IRC
clock to RTC clock
Add 14.4.5, “LCD Clock Inputs & Reset Behavior
03.02 20-Jun-11 update on page 14-533,LCDRSTP will control both pseudo stop and full stop
update on page 14-537,LCDRAM should be reset zero
03.03 21-Jun-11 add Section Figure 14-2., “LCD40F4BV3 Register Summary
03.04 21-Oct-11 Update Section Figure 14-2., “LCD40F4BV3 Register Summary,change name to
LCDFPENR0-4
03.05 05-Sep-12 rewording of Section 14.3.2.4, “LCD RAM (LCDRAM)
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
526 Freescale Semiconductor
LCD RAM – contains the data to be displayed on the LCD. Data can be read from or written to the
display RAM at any time.
Frontplane Drivers – consists of 40 frontplane drivers.
Backplane Drivers – consists of 4 backplane drivers.
Voltage Generator – Based on voltage applied to VLCD, it generates the voltage levels for the
timing and control logic to produce the frontplane and backplane waveforms.
14.1.1 Features
The LCD40F4BV3 includes these distinctive features:
Supports five LCD operation modes
40 frontplane drivers
4 backplane drivers
Each frontplane has an enable bit respectively
Programmable frame clock generator
Programmable bias voltage level selector
On-chip generation of 4 different output voltage levels
14.1.2 Modes of Operation
The LCD40F4BV3 module supports five operation modes with different numbers of backplanes and
different biasing levels. During wait mode the LCD operation can be suspended under software control.
Depending on the state of internal bits, the LCD can operate normally or the LCD clock generation can be
turned off and the LCD40F4BV3 module enters a power conservation state.
This is a high level description only, detailed descriptions of operating modes are contained in
Section 14.4.2, “Operation in Wait Mode”, and Section 14.4.3, “Operation in Stop Mode”.
14.1.3 Block Diagram
Figure 14-1 is a block diagram of the LCD40F4BV3 module.
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 527
Figure 14-1. LCD40F4BV3 Block Diagram
LCD
RAM
20 bytes
Timing
and
Control
Logic
Frontplane
Drivers
Voltage
Generator
Backplane
Drivers
Internal Address/Data/Clocks
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
FP[39:0] VLCD BP[3:0]
Prescaler
RTCCLK
LCD Clock
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
528 Freescale Semiconductor
14.2 External Signal Description
The LCD40F4BV3 module has a total of 45 external pins.
14.2.1 BP[3:0] — Analog Backplane Pins
This output signal vector represents the analog backplane waveforms of the LCD40F4BV3 module and is
connected directly to the corresponding pads.
14.2.2 FP[39:0] — Analog Frontplane Pins
This output signal vector represents the analog frontplane waveforms of the LCD40F4BV3 module and is
connected directly to the corresponding pads.
14.2.3 VLCD — LCD Supply Voltage Pin
Positive supply voltage for the LCD waveform generation.
14.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all memory and registers.
14.3.1 Module Memory Map
The memory map for the LCD40F4BV3 module is given in Table 14-3. The address listed for each register
is the address offset. The total address for each register is the sum of the base address for the
LCD40F4BV3 module and the address offset for each register.
Table 14-2. Signal Properties
Name Port Function Reset State
4 backplane waveforms BP[3:0] Backplane waveform signals
that connect directly to the pads
High impedance
40 frontplane waveforms FP[39:0] Frontplane waveform signals
that connect directly to the pads
High impedance
LCD voltage VLCD LCD supply voltage
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 529
Table 14-3. LCD40F4BV3 Memory Map
Address
Offset Use Access
0x0000 LCD Control Register 0 (LCDCR0) Read/Write
0x0001 LCD Control Register 1 (LCDCR1) Read/Write
0x0002 LCD Frontplane Enable Register 0 (LCDFPENR0) Read/Write
0x0003 LCD Frontplane Enable Register 1 (LCDFPENR1) Read/Write
0x0004 LCD Frontplane Enable Register 2 (LCDFPENR2) Read/Write
0x0005 LCD Frontplane Enable Register 3 (LCDFPENR3) Read/Write
0x0006 LCD Frontplane Enable Register 4 (LCDFPENR4) Read/Write
0x0007 Unimplemented
0x0008 LCDRAM (Location 0) Read/Write
0x0009 LCDRAM (Location 1) Read/Write
0x000A LCDRAM (Location 2) Read/Write
0x000B LCDRAM (Location 3) Read/Write
0x000C LCDRAM (Location 4) Read/Write
0x000D LCDRAM (Location 5) Read/Write
0x000E LCDRAM (Location 6) Read/Write
0x000F LCDRAM (Location 7) Read/Write
0x0010 LCDRAM (Location 8) Read/Write
0x0011 LCDRAM (Location 9) Read/Write
0x0012 LCDRAM (Location 10) Read/Write
0x0013 LCDRAM (Location 11) Read/Write
0x0014 LCDRAM (Location 12) Read/Write
0x0015 LCDRAM (Location 13) Read/Write
0x0016 LCDRAM (Location 14) Read/Write
0x0017 LCDRAM (Location 15) Read/Write
0x0018 LCDRAM (Location 16) Read/Write
0x0019 LCDRAM (Location 17) Read/Write
0x001A LCDRAM (Location 18) Read/Write
0x001B LCDRAM (Location 19) Read/Write
0x001C-
0x001F
Unimplemented
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
530 Freescale Semiconductor
14.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions. Each description includes a standard register diagram.
Details of register bit and field function follow the register diagrams, in bit order.
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0000 LCDCR0 RLCDEN 0 0 LCLK1 LCLK0 BIAS DUTY1 DUTY0
W
0x0001 LCDCR1 R000000LCDSWAI LCDRSTP
W
0x0002 LCDFPENR0 RFP7EN FP6EN FP5EN FP4EN FP3EN FP2EN FP1EN FP0EN
W
0x0003 LCDFPENR1 RFP15EN FP14EN FP13EN FP12EN FP11EN FP10EN FP9EN FP8EN
W
0x0004 LCDFPENR2 RFP23EN FP22EN FP21EN FP20EN FP19EN FP18EN FP17EN FP16EN
W
0x0005 LCDFPENR3 RFP31EN FP30EN FP29EN FP28EN FP27EN FP26EN FP25EN FP24EN
W
0x0006 LCDFPENR4 RFP39EN FP38EN FP37EN FP36EN FP35EN FP34EN FP33EN FP32EN
W
0x0007 Reserved R
W
0x0008 LCDRAM0 RFP1BP3 FP1BP2 FP1BP1 FP1BP0 FP0BP3 FP0BP2 FP0BP1 FP0BP0
W
0x0009 LCDRAM1 RFP3BP3 FP3BP2 FP3BP1 FP3BP0 FP2BP3 FP2BP2 FP2BP1 FP2BP0
W
0x000A LCDRAM2 RFP5BP3 FP5BP2 FP5BP1 FP5BP0 FP4BP3 FP4BP2 FP4BP1 FP4BP0
W
0x000B LCDRAM3 RFP7BP3 FP7BP2 FP7BP1 FP7BP0 FP6BP3 FP6BP2 FP6BP1 FP6BP0
W
0x000C LCDRAM4 RFP9BP3 FP9BP2 FP9BP1 FP9BP0 FP8BP3 FP8BP2 FP8BP1 FP8BP0
W
0x000D LCDRAM5 RFP11BP3 FP11BP2 FP11BP1 FP11BP0 FP10BP3 FP10BP2 FP10BP1 FP10BP0
W
0x000E LCDRAM6 RFP13BP3 FP13BP2 FP13BP1 FP13BP0 FP12BP3 FP12BP2 FP12BP1 FP12BP0
W
0x000F LCDRAM7 RFP15BP3 FP15BP2 FP15BP1 FP15BP0 FP14BP3 FP14BP2 FP14BP1 FP14BP0
W
Figure 14-2. LCD40F4BV3 Register Summary
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 531
14.3.2.1 LCD Control Register 0 (LCDCR0)
Read: anytime
0x0010 LCDRAM8 RFP17BP3 FP17BP2 FP17BP1 FP17BP0 FP16BP3 FP16BP2 FP16BP1 FP16BP0
W
0x0011 LCDRAM9 RFP19BP3 FP19BP2 FP19BP1 FP19BP0 FP18BP3 FP18BP2 FP18BP1 FP18BP0
W
0x0012 LCDRAM10 RFP21BP3 FP21BP2 FP21BP1 FP21BP0 FP20BP3 FP20BP2 FP20BP1 FP20BP0
W
0x0013 LCDRAM11 RFP23BP3 FP23BP2 FP23BP1 FP23BP0 FP22BP3 FP22BP2 FP22BP1 FP22BP0
W
0x0014 LCDRAM12 RFP25BP3 FP25BP2 FP25BP1 FP25BP0 FP24BP3 FP24BP2 FP24BP1 FP24BP0
W
0x0015 LCDRAM13 RFP27BP3 FP27BP2 FP27BP1 FP27BP0 FP26BP3 FP26BP2 FP26BP1 FP26BP0
W
0x0016 LCDRAM14 RFP29BP3 FP29BP2 FP29BP1 FP29BP0 FP28BP3 FP28BP2 FP28BP1 FP28BP0
W
0x0017 LCDRAM15 RFP31BP3 FP31BP2 FP31BP1 FP31BP0 FP30BP3 FP30BP2 FP30BP1 FP30BP0
W
0x0018 LCDRAM16 RFP33BP3 FP33BP2 FP33BP1 FP33BP0 FP32BP3 FP32BP2 FP32BP1 FP32BP0
W
0x0019 LCDRAM17 RFP35BP3 FP35BP2 FP35BP1 FP35BP0 FP34BP3 FP34BP2 FP34BP1 FP34BP0
W
0x001A LCDRAM18 RFP37BP3 FP37BP2 FP37BP1 FP37BP0 FP36BP3 FP36BP2 FP36BP1 FP36BP0
W
0x001B LCDRAM19 RFP39BP3 FP39BP2 FP39BP1 FP39BP0 FP38BP3 FP38BP2 FP38BP1 FP38BP0
W
0x001C-
0x001F Reserved R
W
Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
R
LCDEN
0 0
LCLK1 LCLK0 BIAS DUTY1 DUTY0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-3. LCD Control Register 0 (LCDCR0)
Figure 14-2. LCD40F4BV3 Register Summary
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
532 Freescale Semiconductor
Write: LCDEN anytime. To avoid segment flicker the clock prescaler bits, the bias select bit and the duty
select bits must not be changed when the LCD is enabled.
Table 14-4. LCDCR0 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
LCDEN
LCD40F4BV3 Driver System Enable — The LCDEN bit starts the LCD waveform generator.
0 All frontplane and backplane pins are disabled. In addition, the LCD40F4BV3 system is disabled
and all LCD waveform generation clocks are stopped.
1 LCD driver system is enabled. All FP[39:0] pins with FP[39:0]EN set, will output an LCD driver
waveform The BP[3:0] pins will output an LCD40F4BV3 driver waveform based on the settings of DUTY0
and DUTY1.
4:3
LCLK[1:0]
LCD Clock Prescaler The LCD clock prescaler bits determine the RTCCLK divider value to produce the LCD
clock frequency. For detailed description of the correlation between LCD clock prescaler bits and the divider
value please refer to Table 14-8.
2
BIAS
BIAS Voltage Level Select — This bit selects the bias voltage levels during various LCD operating modes, as
shown in Table 14-9.
1:0
DUTY[1:0]
LCD Duty Select — The DUTY1 and DUTY0 bits select the duty (multiplex mode) of the LCD40F4BV3 driver
system, as shown in Table 14-9.
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 533
14.3.2.2 LCD Control Register 1 (LCDCR1)
Read: anytime
Write: anytime
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
R 0 0 0 0 0 0
LCDSWAI LCDRSTP
W
Reset00000000
Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-4. LCD Control Register 1 (LCDCR1)
Table 14-5. LCDCR1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
1
LCDSWAI
LCD Stop in Wait Mode — This bit controls the LCD operation while in wait mode.
0 LCD operates normally in wait mode.
1 Stop LCD40F4BV3 driver system when in wait mode.
0
LCDRSTP
LCD Run in Stop Mode This bit controls the LCD operation while in pseudo stop mode and full stop mode.
0 Stop LCD32F4B driver system when in stop mode(pseudo stop or full stop).
1 LCD operates normally in stop mode. If lcd clock come from 32k osc clock which is not stoped during full stop
mode, LCDRSTP=1 will control LCD run in pseudo stop or full stop mode. If lcd clock come from main osc clock,
LCDRSTP=1 will control LCD run in pseudo stop mode.
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
534 Freescale Semiconductor
14.3.2.3 LCD Frontplane Enable Register 0–3 (LCDFPENR0–LCDFPENR4)
These bits enable the frontplane output waveform on the corresponding frontplane pin when LCDEN = 1.
Read: anytime
Write: anytime
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
R
FP7EN FP6EN FP5EN FP4EN FP3EN FP2EN FP1EN FP0EN
W
Reset00000000
Figure 14-5. LCD Frontplane Enable Register 0 (LCDFPENR0)
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R
FP15EN FP14EN FP13EN FP12EN FP11EN FP10EN FP9EN FP8EN
W
Reset00000000
Figure 14-6. LCD Frontplane Enable Register 1 (LCDFPENR1)
Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
R
FP23EN FP22EN FP21EN FP20EN FP19EN FP18EN FP17EN FP16EN
W
Reset00000000
Figure 14-7. LCD Frontplane Enable Register 2 (LCDFPENR2)
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
R
FP31EN FP30EN FP29EN FP28EN FP27EN FP26EN FP25EN FP24EN
W
Reset00000000
Figure 14-8. LCD Frontplane Enable Register 3 (LCDFPENR3)
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
R
FP39EN FP38EN FP37EN FP36EN FP35EN FP34EN FP33EN FP32EN
W
Reset00000000
Figure 14-9. LCD Frontplane Enable Register 4 (LCDFPENR4)
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 535
14.3.2.4 LCD RAM (LCDRAM)
The LCD RAM consists of 20 bytes. After reset the LCD RAM contents will be zero, as indicated by
Figure 14-10.
Table 14-6. LCDFPENR0–LCDFPENR4 Field Descriptions
Field Description
39:0
FP[39:0]EN
Frontplane Output Enable — The FP[39:0]EN bit enables the frontplane driver outputs. If LCDEN = 0, these
bits have no effect on the state of the I/O pins. It is recommended to set FP[39:0]EN bits before LCDEN is set.
0 Frontplane driver output disabled on FP[39:0].
1 Frontplane driver output enabled on FP[39:0].
76543210
0x0008 R FP1BP3 FP1BP2 FP1BP1 FP1BP0 FP0BP3 FP0BP2 FP0BP1 FP0BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0009 R FP3BP3 FP3BP2 FP3BP1 FP3BP0 FP2BP3 FP2BP2 FP2BP1 FP2BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x000A R FP5BP3 FP5BP2 FP5BP1 FP5BP0 FP4BP3 FP4BP2 FP4BP1 FP4BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x000B R FP7BP3 FP7BP2 FP7BP1 FP7BP0 FP6BP3 FP6BP2 FP6BP1 FP6BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x000C R FP9BP3 FP9BP2 FP9BP1 FP9BP0 FP8BP3 FP8BP2 FP8BP1 FP8BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x000D R FP11BP3 FP11BP2 FP11BP1 FP11BP0 FP10BP3 FP10BP2 FP10BP1 FP10BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x000E R FP13BP3 FP13BP2 FP13BP1 FP13BP0 FP12BP3 FP12BP2 FP12BP1 FP12BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x000F R FP15BP3 FP15BP2 FP15BP1 FP15BP0 FP14BP3 FP14BP2 FP14BP1 FP14BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0010 R FP17BP3 FP17BP2 FP17BP1 FP17BP0 FP16BP3 FP16BP2 FP16BP1 FP16BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
I = Value is indeterminate
Figure 14-10. LCD RAM (LCDRAM)
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
536 Freescale Semiconductor
Read: anytime
Write: anytime
0x0011 R FP19BP3 FP19BP2 FP19BP1 FP19BP0 FP18BP3 FP18BP2 FP18BP1 FP18BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0012 R FP21BP3 FP21BP2 FP21BP1 FP21BP0 FP20BP3 FP20BP2 FP20BP1 FP20BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0013 R FP23BP3 FP23BP2 FP23BP1 FP23BP0 FP22BP3 FP22BP2 FP22BP1 FP22BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0014 R FP25BP3 FP25BP2 FP25BP1 FP25BP0 FP24BP3 FP24BP2 FP24BP1 FP24BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0015 R FP27BP3 FP27BP2 FP27BP1 FP27BP0 FP26BP3 FP26BP2 FP26BP1 FP26BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0016 R FP29BP3 FP29BP2 FP29BP1 FP29BP0 FP28BP3 FP28BP2 FP28BP1 FP28BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0017 R FP31BP3 FP31BP2 FP31BP1 FP31BP0 FP30BP3 FP30BP2 FP30BP1 FP30BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0018 R FP33BP3 FP33BP2 FP33BP1 FP33BP0 FP32BP3 FP32BP2 FP32BP1 FP32BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x0019 R FP35BP3 FP35BP2 FP35BP1 FP35BP0 FP34BP3 FP34BP2 FP34BP1 FP34BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x001A R FP37BP3 FP37BP2 FP37BP1 FP37BP0 FP36BP3 FP36BP2 FP36BP1 FP36BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
0x001B R FP39BP3 FP39BP2 FP39BP1 FP39BP0 FP38BP3 FP38BP2 FP38BP1 FP38BP0
LCDRAM W
Reset00000000
I = Value is indeterminate
Figure 14-10. LCD RAM (LCDRAM) (continued)
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 537
14.4 Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the LCD40F4BV3 block, detailing the
operation of the design from the end user perspective in a number of subsections.
14.4.1 LCD Driver Description
14.4.1.1 Frontplane, Backplane, and LCD System During Reset
During a reset the following conditions exist:
The LCD40F4BV3 system is configured in the default mode, 1/4 duty and 1/3 bias, that means all
backplanes are used.
All frontplane enable bits, FP[39:0]EN are cleared and the ON/OFF control for the display, the
LCDEN bit is cleared, thereby forcing all frontplane and backplane driver outputs to the high
impedance state. The MCU pin state during reset is defined by the port integration module (PIM).
14.4.1.2 LCD Clock and Frame Frequency
The frequency of the source clock (RTCCLK) and divider determine the LCD clock frequency. The divider
is set by the LCD clock prescaler bits, LCLK[1:0], in the LCD control register 0 (LCDCR0). Table 14-8
shows the LCD clock and frame frequency for some multiplexed mode at RTCCLK = 32768Hz, 32000Hz,
and 64000Hz.
Table 14-7. LCD RAM Field Descriptions
Field Description
39:0
3:0
FP[39:0]
BP[3:0]
LCD Segment ON The FP[39:0]BP[3:0] bit displays (turns on) the LCD segment connected between FP[39:0]
and BP[3:0].
0 LCD segment OFF
1 LCD segment ON
Table 14-8. LCD Clock and Frame Frequency
Source clock
Frequency in
Hz
LCD Clock
Prescaler Divider LCD Clock
Frequency [Hz]
Frame Frequency [Hz]
LCLK1 LCLK0 1/1 Duty 1/2 Duty 1/3 Duty 1/4 Duty
RTCCLK = 32768
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
64
128
256
512
512
256
128
64
512
256
128
64
256
128
64
32
171
85
43
21
128
64
32
16
RTCCLK = 32000
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
64
128
256
512
500
250
125
63
500
250
125
63
250
125
63
31
167
83
42
21
125
63
31
16
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
538 Freescale Semiconductor
For other combinations of RTCCLK and divider not shown in Table 14-8, the following formula may be used
to calculate the LCD frame frequency for each multiplex mode:
The possible divider values are shown in Table 14-8.
14.4.1.3 LCD RAM
For a segment on the LCD to be displayed, data must be written to the LCD RAM which is shown in
Section 14.3, “Memory Map and Register Definition”. The 160 bits in the LCD RAM correspond to the
160 segments that are driven by the frontplane and backplane drivers. Writing a 1 to a given location will
result in the corresponding display segment being driven with a differential RMS voltage necessary to turn
the segment ON when the LCDEN bit is set and the corresponding FP[39:0]EN bit is set. Writing a 0 to a
given location will result in the corresponding display segment being driven with a differential RMS
voltage necessary to turn the segment OFF. The LCD RAM is a dual port RAM that interfaces with the
internal address and data buses of the MCU. It is possible to read from LCD RAM locations for scrolling
purposes. When LCDEN = 0, the LCD RAM can be used as on-chip RAM. Writing or reading of the
LCDEN bit does not change the contents of the LCD RAM. After a reset, the LCD RAM contents will be
indeterminate.
14.4.1.4 LCD Driver System Enable and Frontplane Enable Sequencing
If LCDEN = 0 (LCD40F4BV3 driver system disabled) and the frontplane enable bit, FP[39:0]EN, is set,
the frontplane driver waveform will not appear on the output until LCDEN is set. If LCDEN = 1
(LCD40F4BV3 driver system enabled), the frontplane driver waveform will appear on the output as soon
as the corresponding frontplane enable bit, FP[39:0]EN, in the registers LCDFPENR0–LCDFPENR4 is
set.
14.4.1.5 LCD Bias and Modes of Operation
The LCD40F4BV3 driver has five modes of operation:
1/1 duty (1 backplane), 1/1 bias (2 voltage levels)
1/2 duty (2 backplanes), 1/2 bias (3 voltage levels)
1/2 duty (2 backplanes), 1/3 bias (4 voltage levels)
RTCCLK = 64000
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
64
128
256
512
1000
500
250
125
1000
500250
125
500
250
125
63
333
167
83
42
250
125
63
31
Table 14-8. LCD Clock and Frame Frequency
Source clock
Frequency in
Hz
LCD Clock
Prescaler Divider LCD Clock
Frequency [Hz]
Frame Frequency [Hz]
LCLK1 LCLK0 1/1 Duty 1/2 Duty 1/3 Duty 1/4 Duty
LCD Frame Frequency (Hz) RTCCLK (Hz)
Divider
--------------------------------------------Duty=
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 539
1/3 duty (3 backplanes), 1/3 bias (4 voltage levels)
1/4 duty (4 backplanes), 1/3 bias (4 voltage levels)
The voltage levels required for the different operating modes are generated internally based on VLCD.
Changing VLCD alters the differential RMS voltage across the segments in the ON and OFF states,
thereby setting the display contrast.
The backplane waveforms are continuous and repetitive every frame. They are fixed within each operating
mode and are not affected by the data in the LCD RAM.
The frontplane waveforms generated are dependent on the state (ON or OFF) of the LCD segments as
defined in the LCD RAM. The LCD40F4BV3 driver hardware uses the data in the LCD RAM to construct
the frontplane waveform to create a differential RMS voltage necessary to turn the segment ON or OFF.
The LCD duty is decided by the DUTY1 and DUTY0 bits in the LCD control register 0 (LCDCR0). The
number of bias voltage levels is determined by the BIAS bit in LCDCR0. Table 14-9 summarizes the
multiplex modes (duties) and the bias voltage levels that can be selected for each multiplex mode (duty).
The backplane pins have their corresponding backplane waveform output BP[3:0] in high impedance state
when in the OFF state as indicated in Table 14-9. In the OFF state the corresponding pins BP[3:0]can be
used for other functionality, for example as general purpose I/O ports.
14.4.2 Operation in Wait Mode
The LCD40F4BV3 driver system operation during wait mode is controlled by the LCD stop in wait
(LCDSWAI) bit in the LCD control register 1 (LCDCR1). If LCDSWAI is reset, the LCD40F4BV3 driver
system continues to operate during wait mode. If LCDSWAI is set, the LCD40F4BV3 driver system is
turned off during wait mode. In this case, the LCD waveform generation clocks are stopped and the
LCD40F4BV3 drivers pull down to VSSX those frontplane and backplane pins that were enabled before
entering wait mode. The contents of the LCD RAM and the LCD registers retain the values they had prior
to entering wait mode.
14.4.3 Operation in Stop Mode
All LCD40F4BV3 driver system clocks are stopped, the LCD40F4BV3 driver system pulls down to VSSX
those frontplane and backplane pins that were enabled before entering stop mode. Also, during stop mode,
the contents of the LCD RAM and the LCD registers retain the values they had prior to entering stop mode.
As a result, after exiting from stop mode, the LCD40F4BV3 driver system clocks will run (if LCDEN =
1) and the frontplane and backplane pins retain the functionality they had prior to entering stop mode.
Table 14-9. LCD Duty and Bias
Duty LCDCR0 Register Backplanes Bias (BIAS = 0) Bias (BIAS = 1)
DUTY1 DUTY0 BP3 BP2 BP1 BP0 1/1 1/2 1/3 1/1 1/2 1/3
1/1
1/2
1/3
1/4
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
OFF
OFF
OFF
BP3
OFF
OFF
BP2
BP2
OFF
BP1
BP1
BP1
BP0
BP0
BP0
BP0
YES
NA
NA
NA
NA
YES
NA
NA
NA
NA
YES
YES
YES
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
YES
YES
YES
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
540 Freescale Semiconductor
14.4.4 LCD Waveform Examples
Figure 14-11 through Figure 14-15 show the timing examples of the LCD output waveforms for the
available modes of operation.
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 541
14.4.4.1 1/1 Duty Multiplexed with 1/1 Bias Mode
Duty = 1/1:DUTY1 = 0, DUTY0 = 1
Bias = 1/1:BIAS = 0 or BIAS = 1
V0 = V1 = VSSX, V2 = V3 = VLCD
- BP1, BP2, and BP3 are not used, a maximum of 40 segments are displayed.
Figure 14-11. 1/1 Duty and 1/1 Bias
0
0
VLCD
VSSX
BP0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPx (OFF)
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPy (ON)
VLCD
VSSX
FPx (xxx0)
VLCD
VSSX
FPy (xxx1)
1 Frame
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
542 Freescale Semiconductor
14.4.4.2 1/2 Duty Multiplexed with 1/2 Bias Mode
Duty= 1/2:DUTY1 = 1, DUTY0 = 0
Bias = 1/2:BIAS = 0
V0 = VSSX, V1 = V2 = VLCD * 1/2, V3 = VLCD
- BP2 and BP3 are not used, a maximum of 80 segments are displayed.
Figure 14-12. 1/2 Duty and 1/2 Bias
0
VLCD
VSSX
BP0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPx (OFF)
1 Frame
VLCD 1/2
VLCD
VSSX
BP1
VLCD
VSSX
FPx (xx10)
VLCD
VSSX
FPy (xx00)
VLCD
VSSX
FPz (xx11)
+VLCD 1/2
-VLCD 1/2
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP1-FPx (ON)
+VLCD 1/2
-VLCD 1/2
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPy (OFF)
+VLCD 1/2
-VLCD 1/2
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPz (ON)
+VLCD 1/2
-VLCD 1/2
VLCD 1/2
VLCD 1/2
VLCD 1/2
VLCD 1/2
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 543
14.4.4.3 1/2 Duty Multiplexed with 1/3 Bias Mode
Duty= 1/2:DUTY1 = 1, DUTY0 = 0
Bias = 1/3:BIAS = 1
V0 = VSSX, V1 = VLCD * 1/3, V2 = VLCD * 2/3, V3 = VLCD
- BP2 and BP3 are not used, a maximum of 80 segments are displayed.
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
544 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 14-13. 1/2 Duty and 1/3 Bias
-VLCD 1/3
+VLCD 1/3
-VLCD 1/3
+VLCD 1/3
-VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
0
VLCD
VSSX
BP0
-VLCD
BP0-FPx (OFF)
1 Frame
VLCD 2/3
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
BP1 VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
FPx (xx10) VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
FPy (xx00) VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
FPz (xx11) VLCD 2/3
+VLCD 1/3
-VLCD 1/3
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP1-FPx (ON)
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
+VLCD 1/3
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPy (OFF)
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPz (ON)
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
+VLCD
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 545
14.4.4.4 1/3 Duty Multiplexed with 1/3 Bias Mode
Duty= 1/3:DUTY1 = 1, DUTY0 = 1
Bias = 1/3:BIAS = 0 or BIAS = 1
V0 = VSSX, V1 = VLCD * 1/3, V2 = VLCD * 2/3, V3 = VLCD
- BP3 is not used, a maximum of 120 segments are displayed.
Figure 14-14. 1/3 Duty and 1/3 Bias
+VLCD 1/3
-VLCD 1/3
+VLCD 1/3
-VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
0
VLCD
VSSX
BP0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPx (OFF)
1 Frame
VLCD 2/3
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
BP1 VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
BP2 VLCD 2/3
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP1-FPx (ON)
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
FPx (x010) VLCD 2/3
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
546 Freescale Semiconductor
14.4.4.5 1/4 Duty Multiplexed with 1/3 Bias Mode
Duty= 1/4:DUTY1 = 0, DUTY0 = 0
Bias = 1/3:BIAS = 0 or BIAS = 1
V0 = VSSX, V1 = VLCD * 1/3, V2 = VLCD * 2/3, V3 = VLCD
- A maximum of 160 segments are displayed.
Figure 14-15. 1/4 Duty and 1/3 Bias
14.4.5 LCD Clock Inputs & Reset Behavior
The LCD clock input can from main OSC (OSCCLK) or 32 kHz OSC (OSCCLK_32K), refer to Reference
Manual for detailed information. In case the clock source is from main OSC, after reset, the main OSC will
be disabled and must be enabled by setting the OSCE in CPMU as soon as possible in order to have clock
available for the LCD. If clock source is OSCCLK_32K, software must wait the OSC startup time before
enabling the LCD. If 32K OSC is enabled, it will be always on until a power on reset happens.
+VLCD 1/3
-VLCD 1/3
+VLCD 1/3
-VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
VLCD 1/3
0
VLCD
VSSX
BP0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP0-FPx (ON)
1 Frame
VLCD 2/3
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
BP1 VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
BP2 VLCD 2/3
0
+VLCD
-VLCD
BP1-FPx (OFF)
+VLCD 2/3
-VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
FPx (1001) VLCD 2/3
VLCD
VSSX
BP3 VLCD 2/3
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 547
14.5 Resets
The reset values of registers and signals are described in Section 14.3, “Memory Map and Register
Definition”. The behavior of the LCD40F4BV3 system during reset is described in Section 14.4.1, “LCD
Driver Description”.
14.6 Interrupts
This module does not generate any interrupts.
Chapter 14 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD40F4BV3) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
548 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 549
Chapter 15
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
15.1 Introduction
This block guide provides an overview of the serial communication interface (SCI) module.
The SCI allows asynchronous serial communications with peripheral devices and other CPUs.
15.1.1 Glossary
IR: InfraRed
IrDA: Infrared Design Associate
IRQ: Interrupt Request
Table 15-1. Revision History
Version
Number Revision
Date Effective
Date Author Description of Changes
05.03 12/25/2008 remove redundancy comments in Figure1-2
05.04 08/05/2009 fix typo, SCIBDL reset value be 0x04, not 0x00
05.05 06/03/2010 fix typo, Table 15-3,SCICR1 Even parity should be PT=0
fix typo, on page 15-572,should be BKDIF,not BLDIF
06.01 05/29/2012 update register map, change BD,move IREN to SCIACR2
06.02 10/17/2012
fix typo on page 15-554 and on page 15-554;fix typo of
version V6
update fast data tolerance calculation and add notes.
06.03 10/25/2012 fix typo Table 15-2, SBR[15:4],not SBR[15:0]
06.04 12/19/2012 fix typo Table 15-6,15.4.1/15-567
06.05 02/22/2013 fix typo Figure 15-1./15-551 Figure 15-4./15-554
update Table 15-2./15-554 15.4.4/15-569 15.4.6.3/15-576
06.06 03/11/2013 fix typo of BDL reset value,Figure 15-4
fix typo of Table 15-2,Table 15-16,reword 15.4.4/15-569
06.07 09/03/2013
update Figure 15-14./15-566 Figure 15-16./15-570
Figure 15-20./15-575
update 15.4.4/15-569,more detail for two baud
add note for Table 15-16./15-569
update Figure 15-2./15-553,Figure 15-12./15-564
06.08 10/14/2013 update Figure 15-4./15-554 15.3.2.9/15-564
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
550 Freescale Semiconductor
LIN: Local Interconnect Network
LSB: Least Significant Bit
MSB: Most Significant Bit
NRZ: Non-Return-to-Zero
RZI: Return-to-Zero-Inverted
RXD: Receive Pin
SCI : Serial Communication Interface
TXD: Transmit Pin
15.1.2 Features
The SCI includes these distinctive features:
Full-duplex or single-wire operation
Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format
Selectable IrDA 1.4 return-to-zero-inverted (RZI) format with programmable pulse widths
16-bit baud rate selection
Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit data format
Separately enabled transmitter and receiver
Programmable polarity for transmitter and receiver
Programmable transmitter output parity
Two receiver wakeup methods:
Idle line wakeup
Address mark wakeup
Interrupt-driven operation with eight flags:
Transmitter empty
Transmission complete
Receiver full
Idle receiver input
Receiver overrun
Noise error
Framing error
Parity error
Receive wakeup on active edge
Transmit collision detect supporting LIN
Break Detect supporting LIN
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 551
Receiver framing error detection
Hardware parity checking
1/16 bit-time noise detection
15.1.3 Modes of Operation
The SCI functions the same in normal, special, and emulation modes. It has two low power modes, wait
and stop modes.
Run mode
Wait mode
Stop mode
15.1.4 Block Diagram
Figure 15-1 is a high level block diagram of the SCI module, showing the interaction of various function
blocks.
Figure 15-1. SCI Block Diagram
SCI Data Register
RXD Data In
Data Out TXD
Receive Shift Register
Infrared
Decoder
Receive & Wakeup
Control
Data Format Control
Transmit Control
Bus Clock
1/16
Transmit Shift Register
SCI Data Register
Receive
Interrupt
Generation
Transmit
Interrupt
Generation
Infrared
Encoder
IDLE
RDRF/OR
TC
TDRE
BRKD
BERR
RXEDG
SCI
Interrupt
Request
Baud Rate
Generator
Receive
Baud Rate
Transmit
Generator
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
552 Freescale Semiconductor
15.2 External Signal Description
The SCI module has a total of two external pins.
15.2.1 TXD — Transmit Pin
The TXD pin transmits SCI (standard or infrared) data. It will idle high in either mode and is high
impedance anytime the transmitter is disabled.
15.2.2 RXD — Receive Pin
The RXD pin receives SCI (standard or infrared) data. An idle line is detected as a line high . This input is
ignored when the receiver is disabled and should be terminated to a known voltage.
15.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all the SCI registers.
15.3.1 Module Memory Map and Register Definition
The memory map for the SCI module is given below in Figure 15-2. The address listed for each register
is the address offset. The total address for each register is the sum of the base address for the SCI module
and the address offset for each register.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 553
15.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order . Each description includes a standard register
diagram with an associated figure number. Writes to a reserved register locations do not have any effect
and reads of these locations return a zero. Details of register bit and field function follow the register
diagrams, in bit order.
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
SCIBDH1RSBR15 SBR14 SBR13 SBR12 SBR11 SBR10 SBR9 SBR8
W
0x0001
SCIBDL1RSBR7 SBR6 SBR5 SBR4 SBR3 SBR2 SBR1 SBR0
W
0x0002
SCICR11RLOOPS SCISWAI RSRC M WAKE ILT PE PT
W
0x0000
SCIASR12RRXEDGIF 0000
BERRV BERRIF BKDIF
W
0x0001
SCIACR12RRXEDGIE 00000
BERRIE BKDIE
W
0x0002
SCIACR22RIREN TNP1 TNP0 00
BERRM1 BERRM0 BKDFE
W
0x0003
SCICR2
RTIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK
W
0x0004
SCISR1
R TDRE TC RDRF IDLE OR NF FE PF
W
0x0005
SCISR2
RAMAP 00
TXPOL RXPOL BRK13 TXDIR RAF
W
0x0006
SCIDRH
RR8 T8 000
Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0007
SCIDRL
RR7R6R5R4R3R2R1R0
WT7T6T5T4T3T2T1T0
1.These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to zero.
2,These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to one.
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 15-2. SCI Register Summary
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
554 Freescale Semiconductor
15.3.2.1 SCI Baud Rate Registers (SCIBDH, SCIBDL)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 0.
Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 0.
NOTE
Those two registers are only visible in the memory map if AMAP = 0 (reset
condition).
The SCI baud rate register is used by to determine the baud rate of the SCI, and to control the infrared
modulation/demodulation submodule.
Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
RSBR15 SBR14 SBR13 SBR12 SBR11 SBR10 SBR9 SBR8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 15-3. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIBDH)
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
RSBR7 SBR6 SBR5 SBR4 SBR3 SBR2 SBR1 SBR0
W
Reset01000000
Figure 15-4. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIBDL)
Table 15-2. SCIBDH and SCIBDL Field Descriptions
Field Description
SBR[15:0] SCI Baud Rate Bits — The baud rate for the SCI is determined by the bits in this register. The baud rate is
calculated two different ways depending on the state of the IREN bit.
The formulas for calculating the baud rate are:
When IREN = 0 then,
SCI baud rate = SCI bus clock / (SBR[15:0])
When IREN = 1 then,
SCI baud rate = SCI bus clock / (2 x SBR[15:1])
Note: The baud rate generator is disabled after reset and not started until the TE bit or the RE bit is set for the
first time. The baud rate generator is disabled when (SBR[15:4] = 0 and IREN = 0) or (SBR[15:5] = 0 and
IREN = 1).
Note: . User should write SCIBD by word access. The updated SCIBD may take effect until next RT clock start,
write SCIBDH or SCIBDL separately may cause baud generator load wrong data at that time,if second
write later then RT clock.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 555
15.3.2.2 SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 0.
Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 0.
NOTE
This register is only visible in the memory map if AMAP = 0 (reset
condition).
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
RLOOPS SCISWAI RSRC M WAKE ILT PE PT
W
Reset00000000
Figure 15-5. SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1)
Table 15-3. SCICR1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
LOOPS
Loop Select Bit LOOPS enables loop operation. In loop operation, the RXD pin is disconnected from the SCI
and the transmitter output is internally connected to the receiver input. Both the transmitter and the receiver must
be enabled to use the loop function.
0 Normal operation enabled
1 Loop operation enabled
The receiver input is determined by the RSRC bit.
6
SCISWAI
SCI Stop in Wait Mode Bit — SCISWAI disables the SCI in wait mode.
0 SCI enabled in wait mode
1 SCI disabled in wait mode
5
RSRC
Receiver Source Bit — When LOOPS = 1, the RSRC bit determines the source for the receiver shift register
input. See Table 15-4.
0 Receiver input internally connected to transmitter output
1 Receiver input connected externally to transmitter
4
M
Data Format Mode Bit — MODE determines whether data characters are eight or nine bits long.
0 One start bit, eight data bits, one stop bit
1 One start bit, nine data bits, one stop bit
3
WAKE
W akeup Condition Bit WAKE determines which condition wakes up the SCI: a logic 1 (address mark) in the
most significant bit position of a received data character or an idle condition on the RXD pin.
0 Idle line wakeup
1 Address mark wakeup
2
ILT
Idle Line Type Bit — ILT determines when the receiver starts counting logic 1s as idle character bits. The
counting begins either after the start bit or after the stop bit. If the count begins after the start bit, then a string of
logic 1s preceding the stop bit may cause false recognition of an idle character. Beginning the count after the
stop bit avoids false idle character recognition, but requires properly synchronized transmissions.
0 Idle character bit count begins after start bit
1 Idle character bit count begins after stop bit
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
556 Freescale Semiconductor
1
PE
Parity Enable Bit — PE enables the parity function. When enabled, the parity function inserts a parity bit in the
most significant bit position.
0 Parity function disabled
1 Parity function enabled
0
PT
Parity T ype Bit PT determines whether the SCI generates and checks for even parity or odd parity. With even
parity, an even number of 1s clears the parity bit and an odd number of 1s sets the parity bit. With odd parity, an
odd number of 1s clears the parity bit and an even number of 1s sets the parity bit.
0 Even parity
1 Odd parity
Table 15-4. Loop Functions
LOOPS RSRC Function
0 x Normal operation
1 0 Loop mode with transmitter output internally connected to receiver input
1 1 Single-wire mode with TXD pin connected to receiver input
Table 15-3. SCICR1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 557
15.3.2.3 SCI Alternative Status Register 1 (SCIASR1)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
RRXEDGIF 0000BERRV
BERRIF BKDIF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 15-6. SCI Alternative Status Register 1 (SCIASR1)
Table 15-5. SCIASR1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RXEDGIF
Receive Input Activ e Edge Interrupt Flag — RXEDGIF is asserted, if an active edge (falling if RXPOL = 0,
rising if RXPOL = 1) on the RXD input occurs. RXEDGIF bit is cleared by writing a “1” to it.
0 No active receive on the receive input has occurred
1 An active edge on the receive input has occurred
2
BERRV
Bit Error Value — BERRV reflects the state of the RXD input when the bit error detect circuitry is enabled and
a mismatch to the expected value happened. The value is only meaningful, if BERRIF = 1.
0 A low input was sampled, when a high was expected
1 A high input reassembled, when a low was expected
1
BERRIF
Bit Error Interrupt Flag — BERRIF is asserted, when the bit error detect circuitry is enabled and if the value
sampled at the RXD input does not match the transmitted value. If the BERRIE interrupt enable bit is set an
interrupt will be generated. The BERRIF bit is cleared by writing a “1” to it.
0 No mismatch detected
1 A mismatch has occurred
0
BKDIF
Break Detect Interrupt Flag — BKDIF is asserted, if the break detect circuitry is enabled and a break signal is
received. If the BKDIE interrupt enable bit is set an interrupt will be generated. The BKDIF bit is cleared by writing
a “1” to it.
0 No break signal was received
1 A break signal was received
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
558 Freescale Semiconductor
15.3.2.4 SCI Alternative Control Register 1 (SCIACR1)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
RRXEDGIE 00000
BERRIE BKDIE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 15-7. SCI Alternative Control Register 1 (SCIACR1)
Table 15-6. SCIACR1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RXEDGIE
Receive Input Active Edge Interrupt Enable RXEDGIE enables the receive input active edge interrupt flag,
RXEDGIF, to generate interrupt requests.
0 RXEDGIF interrupt requests disabled
1 RXEDGIF interrupt requests enabled
1
BERRIE
Bit Error Interrupt Enable — BERRIE enables the bit error interrupt flag, BERRIF, to generate interrupt
requests.
0 BERRIF interrupt requests disabled
1 BERRIF interrupt requests enabled
0
BKDIE
Break Detect Interrupt Enable — BKDIE enables the break detect interrupt flag, BKDIF, to generate interrupt
requests.
0 BKDIF interrupt requests disabled
1 BKDIF interrupt requests enabled
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 559
15.3.2.5 SCI Alternative Control Register 2 (SCIACR2)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
RIREN TNP1 TNP0 00
BERRM1 BERRM0 BKDFE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 15-8. SCI Alternative Control Register 2 (SCIACR2)
Table 15-7. SCIACR2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
IREN
Infrared Enable Bit — This bit enables/disables the infrared modulation/demodulation submodule.
0 IR disabled
1 IR enabled
6:5
TNP[1:0]
T ransmitter Narrow Pulse Bits These bits enable whether the SCI transmits a 1/16, 3/16, 1/32 or 1/4 narrow
pulse. See Table 15-8.
2:1
BERRM[1:0]
Bit Error Mode — Those two bits determines the functionality of the bit error detect feature. See Table 15-9.
0
BKDFE
Break Detect Feature EnableBKDFE enables the break detect circuitry.
0 Break detect circuit disabled
1 Break detect circuit enabled
Table 15-8. IRSCI Transmit Pulse Width
TNP[1:0] Narrow Pulse Width
11 1/4
10 1/32
01 1/16
00 3/16
Table 15-9. Bit Error Mode Coding
BERRM1 BERRM0 Function
0 0 Bit error detect circuit is disabled
0 1 Receive input sampling occurs during the 9th time tick of a transmitted bit
(refer to Figure 15-19)
1 0 Receive input sampling occurs during the 13th time tick of a transmitted bit
(refer to Figure 15-19)
11Reserved
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
560 Freescale Semiconductor
15.3.2.6 SCI Control Register 2 (SCICR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
RTIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK
W
Reset00000000
Figure 15-9. SCI Control Register 2 (SCICR2)
Table 15-10. SCICR2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
TIE
Transmitter Interrupt Enable Bit — TIE enables the transmit data register empty flag, TDRE, to generate
interrupt requests.
0 TDRE interrupt requests disabled
1 TDRE interrupt requests enabled
6
TCIE
T ransmission Complete Interrupt Enable Bit — TCIE enables the transmission complete flag, TC, to generate
interrupt requests.
0 TC interrupt requests disabled
1 TC interrupt requests enabled
5
RIE
Receiver Full Interrupt Enable Bit RIE enables the receive data register full flag, RDRF, or the overrun flag,
OR, to generate interrupt requests.
0 RDRF and OR interrupt requests disabled
1 RDRF and OR interrupt requests enabled
4
ILIE
Idle Line Interrupt Enable Bit — ILIE enables the idle line flag, IDLE, to generate interrupt requests.
0 IDLE interrupt requests disabled
1 IDLE interrupt requests enabled
3
TE
Transmitter Enable Bit — TE enables the SCI transmitter and configures the TXD pin as being controlled by
the SCI. The TE bit can be used to queue an idle preamble.
0 Transmitter disabled
1 Transmitter enabled
2
RE
Receiver Enable Bit — RE enables the SCI receiver.
0 Receiver disabled
1 Receiver enabled
1
RWU
Receiver Wakeup Bit — Standby state
0 Normal operation.
1 RWU enables the wakeup function and inhibits further receiver interrupt requests. Normally, hardware wakes
the receiver by automatically clearing RWU.
0
SBK
Send Break Bit — Toggling SBK sends one break character (10 or 11 logic 0s, respectively 13 or 14 logics 0s
if BRK13 is set). Toggling implies clearing the SBK bit before the break character has finished transmitting. As
long as SBK is set, the transmitter continues to send complete break characters (10 or 11 bits, respectively 13
or 14 bits).
0 No break characters
1 Transmit break characters
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 561
15.3.2.7 SCI Status Register 1 (SCISR1)
The SCISR1 and SCISR2 registers provides inputs to the MCU for generation of SCI interrupts. Also,
these registers can be polled by the MCU to check the status of these bits. The flag-clearing procedures
require that the status register be read followed by a read or write to the SCI data register.It is permissible
to execute other instructions between the two steps as long as it does not compromise the handling of I/O,
but the order of operations is important for flag clearing.
Read: Anytime
Write: Has no meaning or effect
Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
R TDRE TC RDRF IDLE OR NF FE PF
W
Reset11000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 15-10. SCI Status Register 1 (SCISR1)
Table 15-11. SCISR1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
TDRE
Transmit Data Register Empty Flag — TDRE is set when the transmit shift register receives a byte from the
SCI data register. When TDRE is 1, the transmit data register (SCIDRH/L) is empty and can receive a new value
to transmit.Clear TDRE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1), with TDRE set and then writing to SCI data
register low (SCIDRL).
0 No byte transferred to transmit shift register
1 Byte transferred to transmit shift register; transmit data register empty
6
TC
T ransmit Complete Flag TC is set low when there is a transmission in progress or when a preamble or break
character is loaded. TC is set high when the TDRE flag is set and no data, preamble, or break character is being
transmitted.When TC is set, the TXD pin becomes idle (logic 1). Clear TC by reading SCI status register 1
(SCISR1) with TC set and then writing to SCI data register low (SCIDRL). TC is cleared automatically when data,
preamble, or break is queued and ready to be sent. TC is cleared in the event of a simultaneous set and clear of
the TC flag (transmission not complete).
0 Transmission in progress
1 No transmission in progress
5
RDRF
Receive Data Register Full FlagRDRF is set when the data in the receive shift register transfers to the SCI
data register. Clear RDRF by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with RDRF set and then reading SCI data
register low (SCIDRL).
0 Data not available in SCI data register
1 Received data available in SCI data register
4
IDLE
Idle Line Flag IDLE is set when 10 consecutive logic 1s (if M = 0) or 11 consecutive logic 1s (if M =1) appear
on the receiver input. Once the IDLE flag is cleared, a valid frame must again set the RDRF flag before an idle
condition can set the IDLE flag.Clear IDLE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with IDLE set and then
reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL).
0 Receiver input is either active now or has never become active since the IDLE flag was last cleared
1 Receiver input has become idle
Note: When the receiver wakeup bit (RWU) is set, an idle line condition does not set the IDLE flag.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
562 Freescale Semiconductor
3
OR
Overrun Flag — OR is set when software fails to read the SCI data register before the receive shift register
receives the next frame. The OR bit is set immediately after the stop bit has been completely received for the
second frame. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data already in the SCI data registers is not affected.
Clear OR by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with OR set and then reading SCI data register low
(SCIDRL).
0 No overrun
1Overrun
Note: OR flag may read back as set when RDRF flag is clear. This may happen if the following sequence of
events occurs:
1. After the first frame is received, read status register SCISR1 (returns RDRF set and OR flag clear);
2. Receive second frame without reading the first frame in the data register (the second frame is not
received and OR flag is set);
3. Read data register SCIDRL (returns first frame and clears RDRF flag in the status register);
4. Read status register SCISR1 (returns RDRF clear and OR set).
Event 3 may be at exactly the same time as event 2 or any time after. When this happens, a dummy
SCIDRL read following event 4 will be required to clear the OR flag if further frames are to be received.
2
NF
Noise Flag NF is set when the SCI detects noise on the receiver input. NF bit is set during the same cycle as
the RDRF flag but does not get set in the case of an overrun. Clear NF by reading SCI status register 1(SCISR1),
and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL).
0 No noise
1Noise
1
FE
Framing Er ro r Flag — FE is set when a logic 0 is accepted as the stop bit. FE bit is set during the same cycle
as the RDRF flag but does not get set in the case of an overrun. FE inhibits further data reception until it is
cleared. Clear FE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with FE set and then reading the SCI data register
low (SCIDRL).
0 No framing error
1 Framing error
0
PF
Parity Error FlagPF is set when the parity enable bit (PE) is set and the parity of the received data does not
match the parity type bit (PT). PF bit is set during the same cycle as the RDRF flag but does not get set in the
case of an overrun. Clear PF by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1), and then reading SCI data register low
(SCIDRL).
0 No parity error
1 Parity error
Table 15-11. SCISR1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 563
15.3.2.8 SCI Status Register 2 (SCISR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
RAMAP 00
TXPOL RXPOL BRK13 TXDIR RAF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 15-11. SCI S tatus Register 2 (SCISR2)
Table 15-12. SCISR2 Field Desc ripti on s
Field Description
7
AMAP
Alternative Map This bit controls which registers sharing the same address space are accessible. In the reset
condition the SCI behaves as previous versions. Setting AMAP=1 allows the access to another set of control and
status registers and hides the baud rate and SCI control Register 1.
0 The registers labelled SCIBDH (0x0000),SCIBDL (0x0001), SCICR1 (0x0002) are accessible
1 The registers labelled SCIASR1 (0x0000),SCIACR1 (0x0001), SCIACR2 (0x00002) are accessible
4
TXPOL
Transmit Polarity — This bit control the polarity of the transmitted data. In NRZ format, a one is represented by
a mark and a zero is represented by a space for normal polarity, and the opposite for inverted polarity. In IrDA
format, a zero is represented by short high pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle low for a one for normal
polarity, and a zero is represented by short low pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle high for a one for
inverted polarity.
0 Normal polarity
1 Inverted polarity
3
RXPOL
Receive Polarity — This bit control the polarity of the received data. In NRZ format, a one is represented by a
mark and a zero is represented by a space for normal polarity, and the opposite for inverted polarity. In IrDA
format, a zero is represented by short high pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle low for a one for normal
polarity, and a zero is represented by short low pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle high for a one for
inverted polarity.
0 Normal polarity
1 Inverted polarity
2
BRK13
Break Transmit Character Leng th — This bit determines whether the transmit break character is 10 or 11 bit
respectively 13 or 14 bits long. The detection of a framing error is not affected by this bit.
0 Break character is 10 or 11 bit long
1 Break character is 13 or 14 bit long
1
TXDIR
Transmitter Pin Data Direction in Single-Wire ModeThis bit determines whether the TXD pin is going to
be used as an input or output, in the single-wire mode of operation. This bit is only relevant in the single-wire
mode of operation.
0 TXD pin to be used as an input in single-wire mode
1 TXD pin to be used as an output in single-wire mode
0
RAF
Receiver Active Flag — RAF is set when the receiver detects a logic 0 during the RT1 time period of the start
bit search. RAF is cleared when the receiver detects an idle character.
0 No reception in progress
1 Reception in progress
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
564 Freescale Semiconductor
15.3.2.9 SCI Data Registers (SCIDRH, SCIDRL)
Read: Anytime; reading accesses SCI receive data register
Write: Anytime; writing accesses SCI transmit data register; writing to R8 has no effect
NOTE
The reserved bit SCIDRH[2:0] are designed for factory test purposes only,
and are not intended for general user access. Writing to these bit is possible
when in special mode and can alter the modules functionality.
NOTE
If the value of T8 is the same as in the previous transmission, T8 does not
have to be rewritten.The same value is transmitted until T8 is rewritten
In 8-bit data format, only SCI data register low (SCIDRL) needs to be
accessed.
Module Base + 0x0006
76543210
RR8 T8 000
Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 15-12. SCI Data Registers (SCIDRH)
Module Base + 0x0007
76543210
RR7R6R5R4R3R2R1R0
WT7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0
Reset00000000
Figure 15-13. SCI Data Registers (SCIDRL)
Table 15-13. SCIDRH and SCIDRL Field Descriptions
Field Description
SCIDRH
7
R8
Received Bit 8 — R8 is the ninth data bit received when the SCI is configured for 9-bit data format (M = 1).
SCIDRH
6
T8
Transmit Bit 8 — T8 is the ninth data bit transmitted when the SCI is configured for 9-bit data format (M = 1).
SCIDRL
7:0
R[7:0]
T[7:0]
R7:R0 — Received bits seven through zero for 9-bit or 8-bit data formats
T7:T0 — Transmit bits seven through zero for 9-bit or 8-bit formats
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 565
When transmitting in 9-bit data format and using 8-bit write instructions,
write first to SCI data register high (SCIDRH), then SCIDRL.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
566 Freescale Semiconductor
15.4 Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the SCI block, detailing the operation of the
design from the end user perspective in a number of subsections.
Figure 15-14 shows the structure of the SCI module. The SCI allows full duplex, asynchronous, serial
communication between the CPU and remote devices, including other CPUs. The SCI transmitter and
receiver operate independently, although they use the same baud rate generator. The CPU monitors the
status of the SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes received data.
Figure 15-14. Detailed SCI Block Diagram
SCI Data
Receive
Shift Register
SCI Data
Register
Transmit
Shift Register
Register
Receive
Generator
SBR15:SBR0
Bus
Transmit
Control
16
Receive
and Wakeup
Data Format
Control
Control
T8
PF
FE
NF
RDRF
IDLE
TIE
OR
TCIE
TDRE
TC
R8
RAF
LOOPS
RWU
RE
PE
ILT
PT
WAKE
M
Clock
ILIE
RIE
RXD
RSRC
SBK
LOOPS
TE
RSRC
IREN
R16XCLK
Ir_RXD
TXD
Ir_TXD
R16XCLK
R32XCLK
TNP[1:0] IREN
Transmit
Encoder
Receive
Decoder
SCRXD
SCTXD
Infrared
Infrared
TC
TDRE
RDRF/OR
IDLE
Active Edge
Detect
Break Detect
RXD
BKDFE
BERRM[1:0]
BKDIE
BKDIF
RXEDGIE
RXEDGIF
BERRIE
BERRIF
SCI
Interrupt
Request
LIN Transmit
Collision
Detect
Generator
Baud Rate
Baud Rate
Transmit
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 567
15.4.1 Infrared Interface Submodule
This module provides the capability of transmitting narrow pulses to an IR LED and receiving narrow
pulses and transforming them to serial bits, which are sent to the SCI. The IrDA physical layer
specification defines a half-duplex infrared communication link for exchange data. The full standard
includes data rates up to 16 Mbits/s. This design covers only data rates between 2.4 Kbits/s and 115.2
Kbits/s.
The infrared submodule consists of two major blocks: the transmit encoder and the receive decoder. The
SCI transmits serial bits of data which are encoded by the infrared submodule to transmit a narrow pulse
for every zero bit. No pulse is transmitted for every one bit. When receiving data, the IR pulses should be
detected using an IR photo diode and transformed to CMOS levels by the IR receive decoder (external
from the MCU). The narrow pulses are then stretched by the infrared submodule to get back to a serial bit
stream to be received by the SCI.The polarity of transmitted pulses and expected receive pulses can be
inverted so that a direct connection can be made to external IrDA transc eiver modules that use active low
pulses.
The infrared submodule receives its clock sources from the SCI. One of these two clocks are selected in
the infrared submodule in order to generate either 3/16, 1/16, 1/32 or 1/4 narrow pulses during
transmission. The infrared block receives two clock sources from the SCI, R16XCLK and R32XCLK,
which are configured to generate the narrow pulse width during transmission. The R16XCLK and
R32XCLK are internal clocks with frequencies 16 and 32 times the baud rate respectively. Both
R16XCLK and R32XCLK clocks are used for transmitting data. The receive decoder uses only the
R16XCLK clock.
15.4.1.1 Infrared Transmit Encoder
The infrared transmit encoder converts serial bits of data from transmit shift register to the TXD pin. A
narrow pulse is transmitted for a zero bit and no pulse for a one bit. The narrow pulse is sent in the middle
of the bit with a duration of 1/32, 1/16, 3/16 or 1/4 of a bit time. A narrow high pulse is transmitted for a
zero bit when TXPOL is cleared, while a narrow low pulse is transmitted for a zero bit when TXPOL is set.
15.4.1.2 Infrared Receive Decoder
The infrared receive block converts data from the RXD pin to the receive shift register. A narrow pulse is
expected for each zero received and no pulse is expected for each one received. A narrow high pulse is
expected for a zero bit when RXPOL is cleared, while a narrow low pulse is expected for a zero bit when
RXPOL is set. This receive decoder meets the edge jitter requirement as defined by the IrDA serial infrared
physical layer specification.
15.4.2 LIN Support
This module provides some basic support for the LIN protocol. At first this is a break detect circuitry
making it easier for the LIN software to distinguish a break character from an incoming data stream. As a
further addition is supports a collision detection at the bit level as well as cancelling pending transmissions.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
568 Freescale Semiconductor
15.4.3 Data Format
The SCI uses the standard NRZ mark/space data format. When Infrared is enabled, the SCI uses RZI data
format where zeroes are represented by light pulses and ones remain low. See Figure 15-15 below.
Figure 15-15. SCI Data Formats
Each data character is contained in a frame that includes a start bit, eight or nine data bits, and a stop bit.
Clearing the M bit in SCI control register 1 configures the SCI for 8-bit data characters. A frame with eight
data bits has a total of 10 bits. Setting the M bit configures the SCI for nine-bit data characters. A frame
with nine data bits has a total of 11 bits.
When the SCI is configured for 9-bit data characters, the ninth data bit is the T8 bit in SCI data register
high (SCIDRH). It remains unchanged after transmission and can be used repeatedly without rewriting it.
A frame with nine data bits has a total of 11 bits.
Table 15-14. Example of 8-Bit Data Formats
Start
Bit Data
Bits Address
Bits Parity
Bits Stop
Bit
18001
17011
17 1
(1)
1. The address bit identifies the frame as an address
character. See Section 15.4.6.6, “Receiver Wakeup”.
01
Table 15-15. Example of 9-Bit Data Formats
Start
Bit Data
Bits Address
Bits Parity
Bits Stop
Bit
19001
18011
18 1
(1) 01
Bit 5
Start
Bit Bit 0 Bit 1
Next
STOP
Bit
Start
Bit
8-Bit Data Format
(Bit M in SCICR1 Clear)
Start
Bit Bit 0
NEXT
STOP
Bit
START
Bit
9-Bit Data Format
(Bit M in SCICR1 Set)
Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7 Bit 8
Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 6 Bit 7
POSSIBLE
PARITY
Bit
Possible
Parity
Bit Standard
SCI Data
Infrared
SCI Data
Standard
SCI Data
Infrared
SCI Data
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 569
15.4.4 Baud Rate Generation
A 16-bit modulus counter in the two baud rate generator derives the baud rate for both the receiver and the
transmitter . The value from 0 to 65535 written to the SBR15:SBR0 bits determines the baud rate. The value
from 0 to 4095 written to the SBR15:SBR4 bits determines the baud rate clock with SBR3:SBR0 for fine
adjust. The SBR bits are in the SCI baud rate registers (SCIBDH and SCIBDL) for both transmit and
receive baud generator . The baud rate clock is synchronized with the bus clock and drives the receiver. The
baud rate clock divided by 16 drives the transmitter. The receiver has an acquisition rate of 16 samples per
bit time.
Baud rate generation is subject to one source of error:
Integer division of the bus clock may not give the exact target frequency.
Table 15-16 lists some examples of achieving target baud rates with a bus clock frequency of 25 MHz.
When IREN = 0 then,
SCI baud rate = SCI bus clock / (SCIBR[15:0])
1. The address bit identifies the frame as an address
character. See Section 15.4.6.6, “Receiver Wakeup”.
Table 15-16. Baud Rates (Example: Bus Clock = 25 MHz)
Bits
SBR[15:0] Receiver(1)
Clock (Hz)
1. 16x faster then baud rate
Transmitter(2)
Clock (Hz)
2. divide 1/16 form transmit baud generator
Target
Baud Rate Error
(%)
109 3669724.8 229,357.8 230,400 .452
217 1843318.0 115,207.4 115,200 .006
651 614439.3 38,402.5 38,400 .006
1302 307219.7 19,201.2 19,200 .006
2604 153,609.8 9600.6 9,600 .006
5208 76,804.9 4800.3 4,800 .006
10417 38,398.8 2399.9 2,400 .003
20833 19,200.3 1200.02 1,200 .00
41667 9599.9 600.0 600 .00
65535 6103.6 381.5
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
570 Freescale Semiconductor
15.4.5 Transmitter
Figure 15-16. Transmitter Block Diagram
15.4.5.1 Transmitter Character Length
The SCI transmitter can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data characters. The state of the M bit in SCI
control register 1 (SCICR1) determines the length of data characters. When transmitting 9-bit data, bit T8
in SCI data register high (SCIDRH) is the ninth bit (bit 8).
15.4.5.2 Character Transmission
To transmit data, the MCU writes the data bits to the SCI data registers (SCIDRH/SCIDRL), which in turn
are transferred to the transmitter shift register. The transmit shift register then shifts a frame out through
the TXD pin, after it has prefaced them with a start bit and appended them with a stop bit. The SCI data
registers (SCIDRH and SCIDRL) are the write-only buffers between the internal data bus and the transmit
shift register.
PE
PT
H876543210L
11-Bit Transmit Register
Stop
Start
T8
TIE
TDRE
TCIE
SBK
TC
Parity
Generation
MSB
SCI Data Registers
Load from SCIDR
Shift Enable
Preamble (All 1s)
Break (All 0s)
Transmitter Control
M
Internal Bus
SBR15:SBR4
Transmit baud 16
Bus
Clock
TE
SCTXD
TXPOL
LOOPS
LOOP
RSRC
CONTROL To R eceiver
Transmit
Collision Detect
TDRE IRQ
TC IRQ
SCTXD
SCRXD
(From Receiver)
TCIE
BERRIF
BER IRQ
BERRM[1:0]
generator
SBR3:SBR0
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 571
The SCI also sets a flag, the transmit data register empty flag (TDRE), every time it transfers data from
the buffer (SCIDRH/L) to the transmitter shift register .The transmit driver routine may respond to this flag
by writing another byte to the Transmitter buffer (SCIDRH/SCIDRL), while the shift register is still
shifting out the first byte.
To initiate an SCI transmission:
1. Configure the SCI:
a) Select a baud rate. Write this value to the SCI baud registers (SCIBDH/L) to begin the baud
rate generator. Remember that the baud rate generator is disabled when the baud rate is zero.
Writing to the SCIBDH has no effect without also writing to SCIBDL.
b) Write to SCICR1 to configure word length, parity, and other configuration bits
(LOOPS,RSRC,M,WAKE,ILT,PE,PT).
c) Enable the transmitter , interrupts, receive, and wake u p as required, by writing to the SCICR2
register bits (TIE,TCIE,RIE,ILIE,TE,RE,RWU,SBK). A preamble or idle character will now
be shifted out of the transmitter shift register.
2. Transmit Procedure for each byte:
a) Poll the TDRE flag by reading the SCISR1 or responding to the TDRE interrupt. Keep in mind
that the TDRE bit resets to one.
b) If the TDRE flag is set, write the data to be transmitted to SCIDRH/L, where the ninth bit is
written to the T8 bit in SCIDRH if the SCI is in 9-bit data format. A new transmission will not
result until the TDRE flag has been cleared.
3. Repeat step 2 for each subsequent transmission.
NOTE
The TDRE flag is set when the shift register is loaded with the next data to
be transmitted from SCIDRH/L, which happens, generally speaking, a little
over half-way through the stop bit of the previous frame. Specifically, this
transfer occurs 9/16ths of a bit time AFTER the start of the stop bit of the
previous frame.
W riting the TE bit from 0 to a 1 automa tically loads the transmit shift register with a preamble of 10 logic
1s (if M = 0) or 11 logic 1s (if M = 1). After the preamble shifts out, control logic transfer s the data f rom
the SCI data register into the transmit shift register. A logic 0 start bit automatically goes into the least
significant bit position of the transmit shift register. A logic 1 stop bit goes into the most significant bit
position.
Hardware supports odd or even parity. When parity is enabled, the most significant bit (MSB) of the data
character is the parity bit.
The transmit data register empty flag, TDRE, in SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) becomes set when the SCI
data register tr ansfers a byte to the transmit shift register. The TDRE flag indicates that the SCI data
register can accept new data from the internal data bus. If the transmit interrupt enable bit, TIE, in SCI
control register 2 (SCICR2) is also set, the TDRE flag generates a transmitter interrupt request.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
572 Freescale Semiconductor
When the transmit shift register is not transmitting a frame, the TXD pin goes to the idle condition, logic
1. If at any time software clears the TE bit in SCI control register 2 (SCICR2), the transmitter enable signal
goes low and the transmit signal goes idle.
If software clears TE while a transmission is in progress (TC = 0), the frame in the transmit shift register
continues to shift out. To avoid accidentally cutting off the last frame in a message, always wait for TDRE
to go high after the last frame before clearing TE.
To separate messages with preambles with minimum idle line time, use this sequence between messages:
1. Write the last byte of the first message to SCIDRH/L.
2. Wait for the TDRE flag to go high, indicating the transfer of the last frame to the transmit shift
register.
3. Queue a preamble by clearing and then setting the TE bit.
4. Write the first byte of the second message to SCIDRH/L.
15.4.5.3 Break Characters
Writing a logic 1 to the send break bit, SBK, in SCI control register 2 (SCICR2) loads the transmit shift
register with a break character. A break character contains all logic 0s and has no start, stop, or parity bit.
Break character length depends on the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). As long as SBK is at logic
1, transmitter logic continuously loads break characters into the transmit shift register. After software
clears the SBK bit, the shift register finishes transmitting the last break character and then transmits at least
one logic 1. The automatic logic 1 at the end of a break character guarantees the recognition of the start bit
of the next frame.
The SCI recognizes a break character when there are 10 or 1 1(M = 0 or M = 1) consecutive zero received.
Depending if the break detect feature is enabled or not receiving a break character has these ef fects on SCI
registers.
If the break detect feature is disabled (BKDFE = 0):
Sets the framing error flag, FE
Sets the receive data register full flag, RDRF
Clears the SCI data registers (SCIDRH/L)
May set the overrun flag, OR, noise flag, NF, parity error flag, PE, or the receiver active flag, RAF
(see 3.4.4 and 3.4.5 SCI Status Register 1 and 2)
If the break detect feature is enabled (BKDFE = 1) there are two scenarios1
The break is detected right from a start bit or is detected during a byte reception.
Sets the break detect interrupt flag, BKDIF
Does not change the data register full flag, RDRF or overrun flag OR
Does not change the framing error flag FE, parity error flag PE.
Does not clear the SCI data registers (SCIDRH/L)
May set noise flag NF, or receiver active flag RAF.
1. A Break character in this context are either 10 or 11 consecutive zero received bits
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 573
Figure 15-17 shows two cases of break detect. In trace RXD_1 the break symbol starts with the start bit,
while in RXD_2 the break starts in the middle of a transmission. If BRKDFE = 1, in RXD_1 case there
will be no byte transferred to the receive buf fer and the RDRF flag will not be modified. Also no framing
error or parity error will be flagged from this transfer. In RXD_2 case, however the break signal starts later
during the transmission. At the expected stop bit position the byte received so far will be transferred to the
receive buffer, the receive data register full flag will be set, a framing error and if enabled and appropriate
a parity error will be set. Once the break is detected the BRKDIF flag will be set.
Figure 15-17. Break Detection if BRKDFE = 1 (M = 0)
15.4.5.4 Idle Characters
An idle character (or preamble) contains all logic 1s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Idle character
length depends on the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). The preamble is a synchronizing idle
character that begins the first transmission initiated after writing the TE bit from 0 to 1.
If the TE bit is cleared during a transmission, the TXD pin becomes idle after completion of the
transmission in progress. Clearing and then setting the TE bit during a transmission queues an idle
character to be sent after the frame currently being transmitted.
NOTE
When queueing an idle character , return the TE bit to logic 1 before the stop
bit of the current frame shifts out through the TXD pin. Setting TE after the
stop bit appears on TXD causes data previously written to the SCI data
register to be lost. Toggle the TE bit for a queued idle character while the
TDRE flag is set and immediately before writing the next byte to the SCI
data register.
If the TE bit is clear and the transmission is complete, the SCI is not the
master of the TXD pin
Start Bit Position Stop Bit Position
BRKDIF = 1
FE = 1 BRKDIF = 1
RXD_1
RXD_2
123 4567 8 910
123 4567 8 910
Zero Bit Counter
Zero Bit Counter . . .
. . .
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
574 Freescale Semiconductor
15.4.5.5 LIN Transmit Collision Detecti on
This module allows to check for collisions on the LIN bus.
Figure 15-18. Collision Detect Principle
If the bit error circuit is enabled (BERRM[1:0] = 0:1 or = 1:0]), the error detect circuit will compare the
transmitted and the received data stream at a point in time and flag any mismatch. The timing checks run
when transmitter is active (not idle). As soon as a mismatch between the transmitted data and the received
data is detected the following happens:
The next bit transmitted will have a high level (TXPOL = 0) or low level (TXPOL = 1)
The transmission is aborted and the byte in transmit buffer is discarded.
the transmit data register empty and the transmission complete flag will be set
The bit error interrupt flag, BERRIF, will be set.
No further transmissions will take place until the BERRIF is cleared.
Figure 15-19. Timing Diagram Bit Error Detection
If the bit error detect feature is disabled, the bit error interrupt flag is cleared.
NOTE
The RXPOL and TXPOL bit should be set the same when transmission
collision detect feature is enabled, otherwise the bit err or interrupt flag may
be set incorrectly.
TXD Pin
RXD Pin
LIN Physical Interface
Synchronizer Stage
Bus Clock
Receive Shift
Register
Transmit Shift
Register
LIN Bus
Compare
Sample
Bit Error
Point
Output Transmit
Shift Register
01234567891011121314150
Input Receive
Shift Register
BERRM[1:0] = 0:1 BERRM[1:0] = 1:1
Compare Sample Points
Sampling Begin
Sampling Begin
Sampling End
Sampling End
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 575
15.4.6 Receiver
Figure 15-20. SCI Receiver Block Diagram
15.4.6.1 Receiver Character Length
The SCI receiver can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data characters. The state of the M bit in SCI
control register 1 (SCICR1) determines the length of data characters. When receiving 9-bit data, bit R8 in
SCI data register high (SCIDRH) is the ninth bit (bit 8).
15.4.6.2 Character Reception
During an SCI reception, the receive shift register shifts a frame in from the RXD pin. The SCI data
register is the read-only buffer between the internal data bus and the receive shift register.
After a complete frame shifts into the receive shift register, the data portion of the frame transfers to the
SCI data register. The receive data register full flag, RDRF, in SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) becomes set,
All 1s
M
WAKE
ILT
PE
PT
RE
H876543210L
11-Bit Receive Shift Register
Stop
Start
Data
Wakeup
Parity
Checking
MSB
SCI Data Register
R8
ILIE
RWU
RDRF
OR
NF
FE
PE
Internal Bus
Bus
SBR15:SBR4
Receive Baud
Clock
IDLE
RAF
Recovery
Logic
RXPOL
LOOPS
Loop
RSRC
Control
SCRXD
From TXD Pin
or Transmitter
Idle IRQ
RDRF/OR
IRQ
Break
Detect Logic
Active Edge
Detect Logic
BRKDFE
BRKDIE
BRKDIF
RXEDGIE
RXEDGIF
Break IRQ
RX Active Edge IRQ
RIE
Generator
SBR3:SBR0
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
576 Freescale Semiconductor
indicating that the received byte can be read. If the receive interrupt enable bit, RIE, in SCI control
register 2 (SCICR2) is also set, the RDRF flag generates an RDRF interrupt request.
15.4.6.3 Data Sampling
The RT clock rate. The RT clock is an internal signal with a frequency 16 times the baud rate. To adjust
for baud rate mismatch, the RT clock (see Figure 15-21) is re-synchronized immediatelly at bus clock
edge:
After every start bit
After the receiver detects a data bit change from logic 1 to logic 0 (after the majority of data bit
samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10 returns a valid logic 1 and the majority of th e next RT8, RT9, and
RT10 samples returns a valid logic 0)
T o locate the start bit, data recovery logic does an asynchronous search for a logic 0 preceded by three logic
1s.When the falling edge of a possible start bit occurs, the RT clock begins to count to 16.
Figure 15-21. Receiver Data Sampling
To verify the start bit and to detect noise, data recovery logic takes samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7.
Figure 15-17 summarizes the results of the start bit verification samples.
If start bit verification is not successful, the RT clock is reset and a new search for a start bit begins.
Table 15-17. Start Bit Verification
RT3, RT5, and RT7 Samples Start Bit Verification Noise Flag
000 Yes 0
001 Yes 1
010 Yes 1
011 No 0
100 Yes 1
101 No 0
110 No 0
111 No 0
Reset RT Clock
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT8
RT7
RT6
RT11
RT10
RT9
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT16
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
Samples
RT Clock
RT CLock Count
Start Bit
RXD
Start Bit
Qualification
Start Bit Data
Sampling
111111110000000
LSB
Verification
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 577
To determine the value of a data bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at RT8, RT9, and
RT10. Table 15-18 summarizes the results of the data bit samples.
NOTE
The RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples do not affect start bit verification. If any
or all of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 start bit samples are logic 1s following a
successful start bit verification, the noise flag (NF) is set and the receiver
assumes that the bit is a start bit (logic 0).
To verify a stop bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at R T 8, RT9, and RT10. Table 15-19
summarizes the results of the stop bit samples.
Table 15-18. Data Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples Data Bit Determination Noise Flag
000 0 0
001 0 1
010 0 1
011 1 1
100 0 1
101 1 1
110 1 1
111 1 0
Table 15-19. Stop Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples Framing Error Flag Noise Flag
000 1 0
001 1 1
010 1 1
011 0 1
100 1 1
101 0 1
110 0 1
111 0 0
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
578 Freescale Semiconductor
In Figure 15-22 the verification samples RT3 and RT5 determine that the first low detected was noise and
not the beginning of a start bit. The RT clock is reset and the start bit search begins again. The noise flag
is not set because the noise occurred before the start bit was found.
Figure 15-22. Start Bit Search Example 1
In Figure 15-23, verification sample at RT3 is high. The RT3 sample sets the noise flag. Although the
perceived bit time is misaligned, the data samples RT8, RT9, and RT10 are within the bit time and data
recovery is successful.
Figure 15-23. Start Bit Search Example 2
Reset RT Clock
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT10
RT9
RT8
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT15
RT16
RT1
RT2
RT3
Samples
RT Clock
RT Clock Count
Start Bit
RXD
110111100000
LSB
0 0
Reset RT Clock
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT6
RT7
RT8
RT11
RT10
RT9
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT2
RT1
RT16
RT15
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT6
RT7
Samples
RT Clock
RT Clock Count
Actual Start Bit
RXD
1111110000
LSB
00
Perceived Start Bit
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 579
In Figure 15-24, a large burst of noise is perc eived as the beginning of a start bit, although the test sample
at RT5 is high. The RT5 sample sets the noise flag. Although this is a worst-case misalignment of
perceived bit time, the data samples RT8, RT9, and RT10 are within the bit time and data recovery is
successful.
Figure 15-24. Start Bit Search Example 3
Figure 15-25 shows the effect of noise early in the start bit time. Although this noise does not af fect proper
synchronization with the start bit time, it does set the noise flag.
Figure 15-25. Start Bit Search Example 4
Reset RT Clock
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT6
RT7
RT8
RT9
RT10
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT5
RT6
RT7
RT8
RT9
Samples
RT Clock
RT Clock Count
Actual Start Bit
RXD
101110000
LSB
0
Perceived Start Bit
Reset RT Clock
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT10
RT9
RT8
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT15
RT16
RT1
RT2
RT3
Samples
RT Clock
RT Clock Count
Perceived and Actual Start Bit
RXD
11111001
LSB
11 1 1
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
580 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 15-26 shows a burst of noise near the beginning of the start bit that resets the RT clock. The sample
after the reset is low but is not preceded by three high samples that would qualify as a falling edge.
Depending on the timing of the start bit search and on the data, the f rame may be missed entirely or it may
set the framing error flag.
Figure 15-26. Start Bit Search Example 5
In Figure 15-27, a noise burst makes the majority of data samples RT8, R T9, and RT10 high. This sets the
noise flag but does not reset the RT clock. In start bits only, the RT8, RT9, and RT10 data samples are
ignored.
Figure 15-27. Start Bit Search Example 6
15.4.6.4 Framing Errors
If the data recovery logic does not detect a logic 1 where the stop bit should be in an incoming frame, it
sets the framing error flag, FE, in SCI status register 1 (SCISR1). A break character also sets the FE flag
because a break character has no stop bit. The FE flag is set at the same time that the RDRF flag is set.
Reset RT Clock
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
Samples
RT Clock
RT Clock Count
Start Bit
RXD
11111010
LSB
11 1 1 1 0000000 0
No Start Bit Found
Reset RT Clock
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT10
RT9
RT8
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT15
RT16
RT1
RT2
RT3
Samples
RT Clock
RT Clock Count
Start Bit
RXD
11111000
LSB
11 1 1 0 110
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 581
15.4.6.5 Baud Rate Tolerance
A transmitting device may be operating at a baud rate below or above the receiver baud rate. Accumulated
bit time misalignment can cause one of the three stop bit data samples (R T8, R T9, and R T10) to fall outside
the actual stop bit. A noise error will occur if the RT8, R T9, and RT10 samples are not all the same logical
values. A framing error will occur if the receiver clock is misaligned in such a way tha t the majority of the
RT8, RT9, and RT10 stop bit samples are a logic zero.
As the receiver samples an incoming frame, it re-synchronizes the RT clock on any valid falling edge
within the frame. Re synchronization within frames will correct a misalignment between transmitter bit
times and receiver bit times.
15.4.6.5.1 Slow Data Tolerance
Figure 15-28 shows how much a slow received frame can be misaligned without causing a noise error or
a framing error. The slow stop bit begins at RT8 instead of RT1 but arrives in time for the stop bit data
samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
Figure 15-28. Slow Data
Let’s take RTr as receiver RT clock and RTt as transmitter RT clock.
For an 8-bit data character , it takes the receiver 9 bit times x 16 R T r cycles +7 RT r cycles = 151 R T r cycles
to start data sampling of the stop bit.
W ith the misaligned character shown in Figure 15-28, the receiver counts 151 R T r cycles at the point when
the count of the transmitting device is 9 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 144 RTt cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a slow 8-bit data
character with no errors is:
((151 – 144) / 151) x 100 = 4.63%
For a 9-bit data character , it takes the receiver 10 bit times x 16 R T r cycles + 7 R T r cycles = 167 R Tr cycles
to start data sampling of the stop bit.
W ith the misaligned character shown in Figure 15-28, the receiver counts 167 R T r cycles at the point when
the count of the transmitting device is 10 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 160 RTt cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a slow 9-bit
character with no errors is:
((167 – 160) / 167) X 100 = 4.19%
MSB Stop
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT6
RT7
RT8
RT9
RT10
RT11
RT12
RT13
RT14
RT15
RT16
Data
Samples
Receiver
RT Clock
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
582 Freescale Semiconductor
15.4.6.5.2 Fast Data Tolerance
Figure 15-29 shows how much a fast received frame can be misaligned. The fast stop bit ends at RT10
instead of RT16 but is still sampled at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
Figure 15-29. Fast Data
For an 8-bit data character , it takes the receiver 9 bit times x 16 R T r cycles + 9 R T r cycles = 153 R T r cycles
to finish data sampling of the stop bit.
W ith the misaligned character shown in Figure 15-29, the receiver counts 153 R T r cycles at the point when
the count of the transmitting device is 10 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 160 RTt cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a fast 8-bit
character with no errors is:
((160 – 153) / 160) x 100 = 4.375%
For a 9-bit data character , it takes the receiver 10 bit times x 16 R T r cycles + 9 R Tr cycles = 169 R T r cycles
to finish data sampling of the stop bit.
W ith the misaligned character shown in Figure 15-29, the receiver counts 169 R T r cycles at the point when
the count of the transmitting device is 11 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 176 RTt cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a fast 9-bit
character with no errors is:
((176 – 169) /176) x 100 = 3.98%
NOTE
Due to asynchronous sample and internal logic, there is maximal 2 bus
cycles between startbit edge and 1st RT clock, and cause to additional
tolerance loss at worst case. The loss should be 2/SBR/10*100%, it is
small.For example, for highspeed baud=230400 with 25MHz bus, SBR
should be 109, and the tolerance loss is 2/109/10*100=0.18%, and fast data
tolerance is 4.375%-0.18%=4.195%.
15.4.6.6 Receiver Wakeup
To enable the SCI to ignore transmissions intended only for other receivers in multiple-receiver systems,
the receiver can be put into a standby state. Setting the receiver wakeup bit, R WU, in SCI control register 2
(SCICR2) puts the receiver into standby state during which receiver interrupts are disabled.The SCI will
still load the receive data into the SCIDRH/L registers, but it will not set the RDRF flag.
Idle or Next FrameStop
RT1
RT2
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT6
RT7
RT8
RT9
RT10
RT11
RT12
RT13
RT14
RT15
RT16
Data
Samples
Receiver
RT Clock
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 583
The transmitting device can address messages to selected receivers by including addressing information
in the initial frame or frames of each message.
The WAKE bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1) determines how the SCI is brought out of the standby
state to process an incoming message. The WAKE bit enables either idle line wakeup or address mark
wakeup.
15.4.6.6.1 Idle Input line Wakeup (WAKE = 0)
In this wakeup method, an idle condition on the RXD pin clears the RWU bit and wakes up the SCI. The
initial frame or frames of every message contain addressing information. All receivers evaluate the
addressing information, and receivers for which the message is addressed process the frames that follow.
Any receiver for which a message is not addressed can set its R WU bit and return to the standby state. The
RWU bit remains set and the receiver remains on standby until another idle character appears on the RXD
pin.
Idle line wakeup requires that messages be separated by at least one idle character and that no message
contains idle characters.
The idle character that wakes a receiver does not set the receiver idle bit, IDLE, or the receive data register
full flag, RDRF.
The idle line type bit, ILT, determines whether the receiver begins counting logic 1s as idle character bits
after the start bit or after the stop bit. ILT is in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1).
15.4.6.6.2 Address Mark Wakeup (WAKE = 1)
In this wakeup method, a logic 1 in the most significant bit (MSB) position of a frame clears the RWU bit
and wakes up the SCI. The logic 1 in the MSB position marks a frame as an address frame that contains
addressing information. All receivers evaluate the addressing information, and the receivers for which the
message is addressed process the frames that follow.Any receiver for which a message is not addressed
can set its RWU bit and return to the standby state. The RWU bit remains set and the receiver remains on
standby until another address frame appears on the RXD pin.
The logic 1 MSB of an address frame clears the receiver s RWU bit before the stop bit is received and sets
the RDRF flag.
Address mark wakeup allows messages to contain idle characters but requires that the MSB be reserved
for use in address frames.
NOTE
With the WAKE bit clear, setting the RWU bit after the RXD pin has been
idle can cause the receiver to wake up immediately.
15.4.7 Single-Wire Operation
Normally, the SCI uses two pins for transmitting and receiving. In single-wire operation, the RXD pin is
disconnected from the SCI. The SCI uses the TXD pin for both receiving and transmitting.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
584 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 15-30. Single-Wire Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 1)
Enable single-wire operation by setting the LOOPS bit and the receiver source bit, RSRC, in SCI control
register 1 (SCICR1). Setting the LOOPS bit disables the path from the RXD pin to the receiver. Setting
the RSRC bit connects the TXD pin to the receiver. Both the transmitter and receiver must be enabled
(TE = 1 and RE = 1).The TXDIR bit (SCISR2[1]) determines whether the TXD pin is going to be used as
an input (TXDIR = 0) or an output (TXDIR = 1) in this mode of operation.
NOTE
In single-wire operation data from the TXD pin is inverted if RXPOL is set.
15.4.8 Loop Operation
In loop operation the transmitter output goes to the receiver input. The RXD pin is disconnected from the
SCI.
Figure 15-31. Loop Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 0)
Enable loop operation by setting the LOOPS bit and clearing the RSRC bit in SCI control register 1
(SCICR1). Setting the LOOPS bit disables the path from the RXD pin to the receiver. Clearing the RSRC
bit connects the transmitter output to the receiver input. Both the transmitter and receiver must be enabled
(TE = 1 and RE = 1).
NOTE
In loop operation data from the transmitter is not recognized by the receiver
if RXPOL and TXPOL are not the same.
15.5 Initialization/Application Information
15.5.1 Reset Initialization
See Section 15.3.2, “Register Descriptions”.
RXD
Transmitter
Receiver
TXD
RXD
Transmitter
Receiver
TXD
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 585
15.5.2 Modes of Operation
15.5.2.1 Run Mode
Normal mode of operation.
To initialize a SCI transmission, see Section 15.4.5.2, “Character Transmission”.
15.5.2.2 Wait Mode
SCI operation in wait mode depends on the state of the SCISWAI bit in the SCI control register 1
(SCICR1).
If SCISWAI is clear, the SCI operates normally when the CPU is in wait mode.
If SCISWAI is set, SCI clock generation ceases and the SCI module enters a power-conservation
state when the CPU is in wait mode. Setting SCISWAI does not affect the state of the receiver
enable bit, RE, or the transmitter enable bit, TE.
If SCISWAI is set, any transmission or reception in progress stops at wait mode entry. The
transmission or rece ption resumes when either an internal or external interrupt brings the CPU out
of wait mode. Exiting wait mode by reset aborts any transmission or reception in progress and
resets the SCI.
15.5.2.3 Stop Mode
The SCI is inactive during stop mode for reduced power consumption. The STOP instruction does not
affect the SCI register states, but the SCI bus clock will be disabled. The SCI operation resumes from
where it left off after an external interrupt brings the CPU out of stop mode. Exiting stop mode by reset
aborts any transmission or reception in progress and resets the SCI.
The receive input active edge detect circuit is still active in stop mode. An active edge on the receive input
can be used to bring the CPU out of stop mode.
15.5.3 Interrupt Operation
This section describes the interrupt originated by the SCI block.The MCU must service the interrupt
requests. Table 15-20 lists the eight interrupt sources of the SCI.
Ta ble 15-20. SCI Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Source Local Enable Description
TDRE SCISR1[7] TIE Active high level. Indicates that a byte was transferred from SCIDRH/L to the
transmit shift register.
TC SCISR1[6] TCIE Active high level. Indicates that a transmit is complete.
RDRF SCISR1[5] RIE Active high level. The RDRF interrupt indicates that received data is available
in the SCI data register.
OR SCISR1[3] Active high level. This interrupt indicates that an overrun condition has occurred.
IDLE SCISR1[4] ILIE Active high level. Indicates that receiver input has become idle.
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
586 Freescale Semiconductor
RXEDGIF SCIASR1[7] RXEDGIE Active high level. Indicates that an active edge (falling for RXPOL = 0, rising for
RXPOL = 1) was detected.
BERRIF SCIASR1[1] BERRIE Active high level. Indicates that a mismatch between transmitted and received data
in a single wire application has happened.
BKDIF SCIASR1[0] BRKDIE Active high level. Indicates that a break character has been received.
Ta ble 15-20. SCI Interrupt Sources
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 587
15.5.3.1 Description of Interrupt Operation
The SCI only originates interrupt requests. The following is a description of how the SCI makes a request
and how the MCU should acknowledge that request. The interrupt vector offset and interrupt number are
chip dependent. The SCI only has a single interrupt line (SCI Interrupt Signal, active high operation) and
all the following interrupts, when generated, are ORed together and issued through that port.
15.5.3.1.1 TDRE Description
The TDRE interrupt is set high by the SCI when the transmit shift register receives a byte from the SCI
data register. A TDRE interrupt indicates that the transmit data register (SCIDRH/L) is empty and that a
new byte can be written to the SCIDRH/L for transmission.Clear TDRE by reading SCI status register 1
with TDRE set and then writing to SCI data register low (SCIDRL).
15.5.3.1.2 TC Description
The TC interrupt is set by the SCI when a transmission has been completed. Transmission is completed
when all bits including the stop bit (if transmitted) have been shifted out and no data is queued to be
transmitted. No stop bit is transmitted when sending a break character and the TC flag is set (providing
there is no more data queued for transmission) when the break character has been shifted out. A TC
interrupt indicates that there is no transmission in progress. TC is set high when the TDRE flag is set and
no data, preamble, or break character is being transmitted. When TC is set, the TXD pin becomes idle
(logic 1). Clear TC by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with TC set and then writing to SCI data
register low (SCIDRL).TC is cle ared automatically when data, preamble, or break is queued and ready to
be sent.
15.5.3.1.3 RDRF Description
The RDRF interrupt is set when the data in the receive shift register transfers to the SCI data register. A
RDRF interrupt indicates that the received data has been transferred to the SCI data register and that the
byte can now be read by the MCU. The RDRF interrupt is cleared by reading the SCI status register one
(SCISR1) and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL).
15.5.3.1.4 OR Description
The OR interrupt is set when software fails to read the SCI data register before the receive shift register
receives the next frame. The newly acquired data in the shift register will be lost in this case, but the data
already in the SCI data registers is not affected. The OR interrupt is cleared by reading the SCI status
register one (SCISR1) and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL).
15.5.3.1.5 IDLE Description
The IDLE interrupt is set when 10 consecutive logic 1s (if M = 0) or 11 consecutive logic 1s (if M = 1)
appear on the receiver input. Once the IDLE is cleared, a valid frame must again set the RDRF flag before
an idle condition can set the IDLE flag. Clear IDLE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with IDLE
set and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL).
Chapter 15 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV6)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
588 Freescale Semiconductor
15.5.3.1.6 RXEDGIF Description
The RXEDGIF interrupt is set when an active edge (falling if RXPOL = 0, rising if RXPOL = 1) on the
RXD pin is detected. Clear RXEDGIF by writing a “1” to the SCIASR1 SCI alternative status register 1.
15.5.3.1.7 BERRIF Description
The BERRIF interrupt is set when a mismatch between the transmitted and the received data in a single
wire application like LIN was detected. Clear BERRIF by writing a “1” to the SCIASR1 SCI alternative
status register 1. This flag is also cleared if the bit error detect feature is disabled.
15.5.3.1.8 BKDIF Description
The BKDIF interrupt is set when a break signal was received. Clear BKDIF by writing a “1” to the
SCIASR1 SCI alternative status register 1. This flag is also cleared if break detect feature is disabled.
15.5.4 Recovery from Wait Mode
The SCI interrupt request can be used to bring the CPU out of wait mode.
15.5.5 Recovery from Stop Mode
An active edge on the receive input can be used to bring the CPU out of stop mode.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 589
Chapter 16
Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
Table 16-1. Revision History
16.1 Introduction
The block MC10B8C is a PWM motor controller suitable to drive instruments in a cluster configuration
or any other loads requiring a PWM signal. The motor controller has eight PWM channels associated with
two pins each (16 pins in total).
16.1.1 Features
The MC10B8C includes the following features:
10/11-bit PWM counter
11-bit resolution with selectable PWM dithering function
7-bit resolution mode (fast mode): duty cycle can be changed by accessing only 1 byte/output
Left, right, or center aligned PWM
Output slew rate control
This module is suited for, but not limited to, driving small stepper and air core motors used in
instrumentation applications. This module can be used for other motor control or PWM
applications that match the frequency, resolution, and output drive capabilities of the module.
16.1.2 Modes of Operation
16.1.2.1 Functional Modes
16.1.2.1.1 PWM Resolution
The motor controller can be configured to either 11- or 7-bits resolution mode by clearing or setting the
FAST bit. This bit influences all PWM channels. For details, please refer to Section 16.3.2.5, “Motor
Controller Duty Cycle Registers”.
Version
Number Revision
Date Author Description of Changes
V01.01 6-OCT-2009 Table 16-12
- fixed 2nd content row : MnCyP := PWM
- fixed 4th content row : MnCyP := 0
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
590 Freescale Semiconductor
16.1.2.1.2 Dither Function
Dither function can be selected or deselected by setting or clearing the DITH bit. This bit influences all
PWM channels. For details, please refer to Section 16.4.1.3.5, “Dither Bit (DITH)”.
16.1.2.2 PWM Channel Configuration Modes
The eight PWM channels can operate in three functional modes. Those modes are, with some restrictions,
selectable for each channel independently.
16.1.2.2.1 Dual Full H-Bridge Mode
This mode is suitable to drive a stepper motor or a 360o air gauge instrument. For details, please refer to
Section 16.4.1.1.1, “Dual Full H-Bridge Mode (MCOM = 11)”. In this mode two adjacent PWM channels
are combined, and two PWM channels drive four pins.
16.1.2.2.2 Full H-Bridge Mode
This mode is suitable to drive any load requiring a PWM signal in a H-bridge configuration using two pins.
For details please refer to Section 16.4.1.1.2, “Full H-Bridge Mode (MCOM = 10)”.
16.1.2.2.3 Half H-Bridge Mode
This mode is suitable to drive a 90o instrument driven by one pin. For details, please refer to
Section 16.4.1.1.3, “Half H-Bridge Mode (MCOM = 00 or 01)”.
16.1.2.3 PWM Alignment Modes
Each PWM channel can operate independently in three different alignment modes. For details, please refer
to Section 16.4.1.3.1, “PWM Alignment Modes”.
16.1.2.4 Low-Power Modes
The behavior of the motor controller in low-power modes is programmable. For details, please refer to
Section 16.4.5, “Operation in Wait Mode” and Section 16.4.6, “Operation in Stop and Pseudo-Stop
Modes”.
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 591
16.1.3 Block Diagram
Figure 16-1. MC10B8C Block Diagram
Period Register
11-Bit Timer/Counter
Duty Register 0 Comparator M0C0M
M0C0P
Duty Register 1 Comparator M0C1M
M0C1P
Duty Register 2 Comparator M1C0M
M1C0P
Duty Register 3 Comparator M1C1M
M1C1P
Duty Register 4 Comparator M2C0M
M2C0P
Duty Register 5 Comparator M2C1M
M2C1P
Duty Register 6 Comparator M3C0M
M3C0P
Duty Register 7 Comparator M3C1M
M3C1P
Control Registers
FAST
DITH
11
PWM Channel Pair
PWM Channel
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
592 Freescale Semiconductor
16.2 External Signal Description
The motor controller is associated with 16 pins. Table 16-2 lists the relationship between the PWM
channels and signal pins as well as PWM channel pair (motor number), coils, and nodes they are supposed
to drive if all channels are set to dual full H-bridge configuration.
16.2.1 M0C0M/M0C0P/M0C1M/M0C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 0
High current PWM output pins that can be used for motor drive. These pins interface to the coils of
motor 0. PWM output on M0C0M results in a positive current flow through coil 0 when M0C0P is driven
to a logic high state. PWM output on M0C1M results in a positive current flow through coil 1 when
M0C1P is driven to a logic high state.
16.2.2 M1C0M/M1C0P/M1C1M/M1C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 1
High current PWM output pins that can be used for motor drive. These pins interface to the coils of
motor 1. PWM output on M1C0M results in a positive current flow through coil 0 when M1C0P is driven
to a logic high state. PWM output on M1C1M results in a positive current flow through coil 1 when
M1C1P is driven to a logic high state.
16.2.3 M2C0M/M2C0P/M2C1M/M2C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 2
High current PWM output pins that can be used for motor drive. These pins interface to the coils of
motor 2. PWM output on M2C0M results in a positive current flow through coil 0 when M2C0P is driven
Table 16-2. PWM Channel and Pin Assignment
Pin Name PWM Channel PWM Channel Pair(1)
1. A PWM Channel Pair always consists of PWM channel x and PWM channel x+1 (x = 2n). The term
“PWM Channel Pair” is equivalent to the term “Motor”. E.g. Channel Pair 0 is equivalent to Motor 0
Coil Node
M0C0M 0 0 0 Minus
M0C0P Plus
M0C1M 1 1 Minus
M0C1P Plus
M1C0M 2 1 0 Minus
M1C0P Plus
M1C1M 3 1 Minus
M1C1P Plus
M2C0M 4 2 0 Minus
M2C0P Plus
M2C1M 5 1 Minus
M2C1P Plus
M3C0M 6 3 0 Minus
M3C0P Plus
M3C1M 7 1 Minus
M3C1P Plus
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 593
to a logic high state. PWM output on M2C1M results in a positive current flow through coil 1 when
M2C1P is driven to a logic high state.
16.2.4 M3C0M/M3C0P/M3C1M/M3C1P — PWM Output Pins for Motor 3
High current PWM output pins that can be used for motor drive. These pins interface to the coils of
motor 3. PWM output on M3C0M results in a positive current flow through coil 0 when M3C0P is driven
to a logic high state. PWM output on M3C1M results in a positive current flow through coil 1 when
M3C1P is driven to a logic high state.
16.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers of the 10-bit 8-channel motor controller
module.
16.3.1 Module Memory Map
Figure 16-2 shows the memory map of the 10-bit 8-channel motor controller module.
Figure 16-2. MC10B8C Memory Map
Offset Register Access
0x0000 Motor Controller Control Register 0 (MCCTL0) RW
0x0001 Motor Controller Control Register 1 (MCCTL1) RW
0x0002 Motor Controller Period Register (High Byte) RW
0x0003 Motor Controller Period Register (Low Byte) RW
0x0004 Reserved(1)
0x0005 Reserved
0x0006 Reserved
0x0007 Reserved
0x0008 Reserved
0x0009 Reserved
0x000A Reserved
0x000B Reserved
0x000C Reserved
0x000D Reserved
0x000E Reserved
0x000F Reserved
0x0010 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 0 (MCCC0) RW
0x0011 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 1 (MCCC1) RW
0x0012 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 2 (MCCC2) RW
0x0013 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 3 (MCCC3) RW
0x0014 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 4 (MCCC4) RW
0x0015 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 5 (MCCC5) RW
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
594 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0016 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 6 (MCCC6) RW
0x0017 Motor Controller Channel Control Register 7 (MCCC7) RW
0x0018 Reserved
0x0019 Reserved
0x001A Reserved
0x001B Reserved
0x001C Reserved
0x001D Reserved
0x001E Reserved
0x001F Reserved
0x0020 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 0 (MCDC0) — High Byte RW
0x0021 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 0 (MCDC0) — Low Byte RW
0x0022 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 1 (MCDC1) — High Byte RW
0x0023 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 1 (MCDC1) — Low Byte RW
0x0024 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 2 (MCDC2) — High Byte RW
0x0025 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 2 (MCDC2) — Low Byte RW
0x0026 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 3 (MCDC3) — High Byte RW
0x0027 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 3 (MCDC3) — Low Byte RW
0x0028 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 4 (MCDC4) — High Byte RW
0x0029 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 4 (MCDC4) — Low Byte RW
0x002A Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 5 (MCDC5) — High Byte RW
0x002B Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 5 (MCDC5) — Low Byte RW
0x002C Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 6 (MCDC6) — High Byte RW
0x002D Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 6 (MCDC6) — Low Byte RW
0x002E Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 7 (MCDC7) — High Byte RW
0x002F Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register 7 (MCDC7) — Low Byte RW
0x0030 Reserved
0x0031 Reserved
0x0032 Reserved
0x0033 Reserved
0x0034 Reserved
0x0035 Reserved
0x0036 Reserved
0x0037 Reserved
0x0038 Reserved
0x0039 Reserved
0x003A Reserved
0x003B Reserved
0x003C Reserved
0x003D Reserved
Figure 16-2. MC10B8C Memory Map (continued)
Offset Register Access
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 595
16.3.2 Register Descriptions
16.3.2.1 Motor Controller Control Register 0
This register controls the operating mode of the motor controller module.
0x003E Reserved
0x003F Reserved
1. Write accesses to “Reserved” addresses have no effect. Read accesses to “Reserved” addresses provide
invalid data (0x0000).
Offset Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
R0
MCPRE[1:0] MCSWAI FAST DITH
0
MCTOIF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-3. Motor Controller Control Register 0 (MCCTL0)
Table 16-3. MCCTL0 Field Descriptions
Field Description
6:5
MCPRE[1:0]
Motor Controller Prescaler Select — MCPRE1 and MCPRE0 determine the prescaler value that sets the
motor controller timer counter clock frequency (fTC). The clock source for the prescaler is the peripheral bus
clock (fBUS) as shown in Figure 16-22. Writes to MCPRE1 or MCPRE0 will not affect the timer counter clock
frequency fTC until the start of the next PWM period. Table 16-4 shows the prescaler values that result from
the possible combinations of MCPRE1 and MCPRE0
4
MCSWAI
Motor Controller Module Stop in Wait Mode
0 Entering wait mode has no effect on the motor controller module and the associated port pins maintain the
functionality they had prior to entering wait mode both during wait mode and after exiting wait mode.
1 Entering wait mode will stop the clock of the module and debias the analog circuitry. The
module will release the pins.
3
FAST
Motor Controller PWM Resolution Mode
0 PWM operates in 11-bit resolution mode, duty cycle registers of all channels are switched to word mode.
1 PWM operates in 7-bit resolution (fast) mode, duty cycle registers of all channels are switched to byte mode.
2
DITH
Motor Control/Driver Dither Feature Enable (refer to Section 16.4.1.3.5, “Dither Bit (DITH)”)
0 Dither feature is disabled.
1 Dither feature is enabled.
0
MCTOIF
Motor Controller Timer Counter Overflow Interrupt Flag — This bit is set when a motor controller timer
counter overflow occurs. The bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the bit.
0 A motor controller timer counter overflow has not occurred since the last reset or since the bit was cleared.
1 A motor controller timer counter overflow has occurred.
Figure 16-2. MC10B8C Memory Map (continued)
Offset Register Access
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
596 Freescale Semiconductor
.
16.3.2.2 Motor Controller Control Register 1
This register controls the behavior of the analog section of the motor controller as well as the interrupt
enables.
Table 16-4. Prescaler Values
MCPRE[1:0] fTC
00 fBus
01 fBus/2
10 fBus/4
11 fBus/8
Offset Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
R
RECIRC
000000
MCTOIE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-4. Motor Controller Control Register 1 (MCCTL1)
Table 16-5. MCCTL1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RECIRC
Recirculation in (Dual) Full H-Bridge Mode (refer to Section 16.4.1.3.3, “RECIRC Bit”)— RECIRC only
affects the outputs in (dual) full H-bridge modes. In half H-bridge mode, the PWM output is always active low.
RECIRC = 1 will also invert the effect of the S bits (refer to Section 16.4.1.3.2, “Sign Bit (S)”) in (dual) full H-
bridge modes. RECIRC must be changed only while no PWM channel is operating in (dual) full H-bridge
mode; otherwise, erroneous output pattern may occur.
0 Recirculation on the high side transistors. Active state for PWM output is logic low, the static channel will output
logic high.
1 Recirculation on the low side transistors. Active state for PWM output is logic high, the static channel will
output logic low.
0
MCTOIE
Motor Controller Timer Counter Overflow Interrupt Enable
0 Interrupt disabled.
1 Interrupt enabled. An interrupt will be generated when the motor controller timer counter overflow interrupt flag
(MCTOIF) is set.
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 597
16.3.2.3 Motor Controller Period Register
The period register defines PER, the number of motor controller timer counter clocks a PWM period lasts.
The motor controller timer counter is clocked with the frequency fTC. If dither mode is enabled (DITH = 1,
refer to Section 16.4.1.3.5, “Dither Bit (DITH)”), P0 is ignored and reads as a 0. In this case
PER = 2 * D[10:1].
For example, programming MCPER to 0x0022 (PER = 34 decimal) will result in 34 counts for each
complete PWM period. Setting MCPER to 0 will shut of f all PWM channels as if MCAM[1:0] is set to 0
in all channel control registers after the next period timer counter overflow. In this case, the motor
controller releases all pins.
NOTE
Programming MCPER to 0x0001 and setting the DITH bit will be managed
as if MCPER is programmed to 0x0000. All PWM channels will be shut of f
after the next period timer counter overflow.
Offset Module Base + 0x0002, 0x0003
1514131211109876543210
R00000
P10P9P8P7P6P5P4P3P2P1P0
W
Reset0000000000000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-5. Motor Controller Period Register (MCPER) with DITH = 0
Offset Module Base + 0x0002, 0x0003
1514131211109876543210
R00000
P10P9P8P7P6P5P4P3P2P1
0
W
Reset0000000000000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-6. Motor Controller Period Register (MCPER) with DITH = 1
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
598 Freescale Semiconductor
16.3.2.4 Motor Controller Channel Control Registers
Each PWM channel has one associated control register to control output delay, PWM alignment, and
output mode. The registers are named MCCC0... MCCC7. In the following, MCCC0 is described as a
reference for all eight registers.
Offset Module Base + 0x0010 . . . 0x0017
76543210
R
MCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0
00
CD1 CD0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-7. Motor Controller Control Register Channel 0–7 (MCCC0–MCCC7)
Table 16-6. MCCC0–MCCC7 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:6
MCOM[1:0]
Output Mode — MCOM1, MCOM0 control the PWM channel’s output mode. See Table 16-7.
5:4
MCAM[1:0]
PWM Channel Alignment Mode — MCAM1, MCAM0 control the PWM channel’s PWM alignment mode and
operation. See Table 16-8.
MCAM[1:0] and MCOM[1:0] are double buffered. The values used for the generation of the output waveform
will be copied to the working registers either at once (if all PWM channels are disabled or MCPER is set to 0)
or if a timer counter overflow occurs. Reads of the register return the most recent written value, which are not
necessarily the currently active values.
1:0
CD[1:0]
PWM Channel Delay — Each PWM channel can be individually delayed by a programmable number of PWM
timer counter clocks. The delay will be n/fTC. See Table 16-9.
Table 16-7. Output Mode
MCOM[1:0] Output Mode
00 Half H-bridge mode, PWM on MnCxM, MnCxP is released
01 Half H-bridge mode, PWM on MnCxP, MnCxM is released
10 Full H-bridge mode
11 Dual full H-bridge mode
Table 16-8. PWM Alignment Mode
MCAM[1:0] PWM Alignment Mode
00 Channel disabled
01 Left aligned
10 Right aligned
11 Center aligned
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 599
NOTE
The PWM motor controller will release the pins after the next PWM timer
counter overflow without accommodating any channel delay if a single
channel has been disabled or if the period register has been cleared or all
channels have been disabled. Program one or more inactive PWM frames
(duty cycle = 0) before writing a configuration that disables a single channel
or the entire PWM motor controller.
16.3.2.5 Motor Controller Duty Cycle Registers
Each duty cycle register sets the sign and duty functionality for the respective PWM channel.
The contents of the duty cycle registers define DUTY, the number of motor controller timer counter clocks
the corresponding output is driven low (RECIRC = 0) or is driven high (RECIRC = 1). Setting all bits to 0
will give a static high output in case of RECIRC = 0; otherwise, a static low output. Values greater than or
equal to the contents of the period register will generate a static low output in case of RECIRC = 0, or a
static high output if RECIRC = 1. The layout of the duty cycle registers differ dependent upon the state of
the FAST bit in the control register 0.
Table 16-9. Channel Delay
CD[1:0] n [# of PWM Clocks]
00 0
01 1
10 2
11 3
Offset Module Base + 0x0020 . . . 0x002F Access: User read/write
1514131211109876543210
R
S
SSSS
D10D9D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1D0
W
Reset0000000000000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-8. Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register x (MCDCx) with FAST = 0
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
600 Freescale Semiconductor
Whenever FAST = 1, the bits D10, D9, D1, and D0 will be set to 0 if the duty cycle register is written.
For example setting MCDCx = 0x0158 with FAST = 0 gives the same output waveform as setting
MCDCx = 0x5600 with FAST = 1 (with FAST = 1, the low byte of MCDCx needs not to be written).
The state of the FAST bit has impact only during write and read operations. A change of the FAST bit (set
or clear) without writing a new value does not impact the internal interpretation of the duty cycle values.
To prevent the output from inconsistent signals, the duty cycle registers are double buffered. The motor
controller module will use working registers to generate the output signals. The working registers are
copied from the bus accessible registers at the following conditions:
MCPER is set to 0 (all channels are disabled in this case)
MCAM[1:0] of the respective channel is set to 0 (channel is disabled)
A PWM timer counter overflow occurs while in half H-bridge or full H-bridge mode
A PWM channel pair is configured to work in Dual Full H-Bridge mode and a PWM timer counter
overflow occurs after the odd1 duty cycle register of the channel pair has been written.
In this way, the output of the PWM will always be either the old PWM waveform or the new PWM
waveform, not some variation in between.
Reads of this register return the most recent value written. Reads do not necessarily return the value of the
currently active sign, duty cycle, and dither functionality due to the double buffering scheme.
Offset Module Base + 0x0020 . . . 0x002F Access: User read/write
1514131211109876543210
R
S D8D7D6D5D4D3D2
00000000
W
Reset0000000000000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 16-9. Motor Controller Duty Cycle Register x (MCDCx) with FAST = 1
Table 16-10. MCDCx Field Descriptions
Field Description
0
S
SIGN The SIGN bit is used to define which output will drive the PWM signal in (dual) full-H-bridge modes. The
SIGN bit has no effect in half-bridge modes. See Section 16.4.1.3.2, “Sign Bit (S)”, and table Table 16-12 for
detailed information about the impact of RECIRC and SIGN bit on the PWM output.
1. Odd duty cycle register: MCDCx+1, x = 2n
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 601
16.4 Functional Description
16.4.1 Modes of Operation
16.4.1.1 PWM Output Modes
The motor controller is configurable between three output modes.
Dual full H-bridge mode can be used to control either a stepper motor or a 360 air core instrument.
In this case two PWM channels are combined.
In full H-bridge mode, each PWM channel is updated independently.
In half H-bridge mode, one pin of the PWM channel can generate a PWM signal to control a 90
air core instrument (or other load requiring a PWM signal) and the other pin is unused.
The mode of operation for each PWM channel is determined by the corresponding MCOM[1:0] bits in
channel control registers. After a reset occurs, each PWM channel will be disabled, the corresponding pins
are released.
Each PWM channel consists of two pins. One output pin will generate a PWM signal. The other will
operate as logic high or low output depending on the state of the RECIRC bit (refer to Section 16.4.1.3.3,
“RECIRC Bit”), while in (dual) full H-bridge mode, or will be released, while in half H-bridge mode. The
state of the S bit in the duty cycle register determines the pin where the PWM signal is driven in full H-
bridge mode. While in half H-bridge mode, the state of the released pin is determined by other modules
associated with this pin.
Associated with each PWM channel pair n are two PWM channels, x and x + 1, where x = 2 * n and n
(0, 1, 2, 3) is the PWM channel pair number. Duty cycle register x controls the sign of the PWM signal
(which pin drives the PWM signal) and the duty cycle of the PWM signal for motor controller channel x.
The pins associated with PWM channel x are MnC0P and MnC0M. Similarly, duty cycle register x + 1
controls the sign of the PWM signal and the duty cycle of the PWM signal for channel x + 1. The pins
associated with PWM channel x + 1 are MnC1P and MnC1M. This is summarized in Table 16-11.
Table 16-11. Corresponding Registers and Pin Names for Each PWM Channel Pair
PWM
Channel
Pair Number
PWM
Channel Control
Register
Duty Cycle
Register Channel
Number Pin
Names
n MCMCx MCDCx PWM Channel x, x = 2n MnC0M
MnC0P
MCMCx + 1 MCDCx + 1 PWM Channel x + 1, x = 2n MnC1M
MnC1P
0 MCMC0 MCDC0 PWM Channel 0 M0C0M
M0C0P
MCMC1 MCDC1 PWM Channel 1 M0C1M
M0C1P
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
602 Freescale Semiconductor
16.4.1.1.1 Dual Full H-Bridge Mode (MCOM = 11)
PWM channel pairs x and x + 1 operate in dual full H-bridge mode if both channels have been enabled
(MCAM[1:0]=01, 10, or 11) and both of the corresponding output mode bits MCOM[1:0] in both PWM
channel control registers are set.
A typical configuration in dual full H-bridge mode is shown in Figure 16-10. PWM channel x drives the
PWM output signal on either MnC0P or MnC0M. If MnC0P drives the PWM signal, MnC0M will be
output either high or low depending on the RECIRC bit. If MnC0M drives the PWM signal, MnC0P will
be an output high or low. PWM channel x + 1 drives the PWM output signal on either MnC1P or MnC1M.
If MnC1P drives the PWM signal, MnC1M will be an output high or low. If MnC1M drives the PWM
signal, MnC1P will be an output high or low. This results in motor recirculation currents on the high side
drivers (RECIRC = 0) while the PWM signal is at a logic high level, or motor recirculation currents on the
low side drivers (RECIRC = 1) while the PWM signal is at a logic low level. The pin driving the PWM
signal is determined by the S (sign) bit in the corresponding duty cycle register and the state of the
RECIRC bit. The value of the PWM duty cycle is determined by the value of the D[10:0] or D[8:2] bits
respectively in the duty cycle register depending on the state of the FAST bit.
1 MCMC2 MCDC2 PWM Channel 2 M1C0M
M1C0P
MCMC3 MCDC3 PWM Channel 3 M1C1M
M1C1P
2 MCMC4 MCDC4 PWM Channel 4 M2C0M
M2C0P
MCMC5 MCDC5 PWM Channel 5 M2C1M
M2C1P
3 MCMC6 MCDC6 PWM Channel 6 M3C0M
M3C0P
MCMC7 MCDC7 PWM Channel 7 M3C1M
M3C1P
Table 16-11. Corresponding Registers and Pin Names for Each PWM Channel Pair (continued)
PWM
Channel
Pair Number
PWM
Channel Control
Register
Duty Cycle
Register Channel
Number Pin
Names
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 603
Figure 16-10. Typical Dual Full H-Bridge Mode Configuratio n
Whenever FAST = 0 only 16-bit write accesses to the duty cycle registers are allowed, 8-bit write accesses
can lead to unpredictable duty cycles.
While fast mode is enabled (FAST = 1), 8-bit write accesses to the high byte of the duty cycle registers are
allowed, because only the high byte of the duty cycle register is used to determine the duty cycle.
The following sequence should be used to update the current magnitude and direction for coil 0 and coil 1
of the motor to achieve consistent PWM output:
1. Write to duty cycle register x
2. Write to duty cycle register x + 1.
At the next timer counter overflow, the duty cycle registers will be copied to the working duty cycle
registers. Sequential writes to the duty cycle register x will result in the previous data being overwritten.
16.4.1.1.2 Full H-Bridge Mode (MCOM = 10)
In full H-bridge mode, the PWM channels x and x + 1 operate independently. The duty cycle working
registers are updated whenever a timer counter overflow occurs.
16.4.1.1.3 Half H-Bridge Mode (MCOM = 00 or 01)
In half H-bridge mode, the PWM channels x and x + 1 operate independently. In this mode, each PWM
channel can be configured such that one pin is released and the other pin is a PWM output. Figure 16-11
shows a typical configuration in half H-bridge mode.
The two pins associated with each channel are switchable between released mode and PWM output
dependent upon the state of the MCOM[1:0] bits in the MCCCx (channel control) register. See register
description in Section 16.3.2.4, “Motor Controller Channel Control Registers”. In half H-bridge mode, the
state of the S bit has no effect.
PWM Channel x
PWM Channel x + 1
MnC0P
MnC0M
MnC1P
MnC1M
Motor n, Coil 0
Motor n, Coil 1
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
604 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 16-11. Typical Quad Half H-Bridge Mode Configuration
16.4.1.2 Relationship Between PWM Mode and PWM Channel Enable
The pair of motor controller channels cannot be placed into dual full H-bridge mode unless both motor
controller channels have been enabled (MCAM[1:0] not equal to 00) and dual full H-bridge mode is
selected for both PWM channels (MCOM[1:0] = 11). If only one channel is set to dual full H-bridge mode,
this channel will operate in full H-bridge mode, the other as programmed.
16.4.1.3 Relationship Between Sign, Duty, Dither, RECIRC, Period,
and PWM Mode Functions
16.4.1.3.1 PWM Alignment Modes
Each PWM channel can be programmed individually to three different alignment modes. The mode is
determined by the MCAM[1:0] bits in the corresponding channel control register.
Left aligned (MCAM[1:0] = 01): The output will start active (low if RECIRC = 0 or high if RECIRC = 1)
and will turn inactive (high if RECIRC = 0 or low if RECIRC = 1) after the number of counts specified by
the corresponding duty cycle register.
PWM Channel x
PWM Channel x + 1
MnC0P
MnC0M
MnC1P
MnC1M
Released
PWM Output
VSSM
VDDM
VSSM
VDDM
Released
PWM Output
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 605
Right aligned (MCAM[1:0] = 10): The output will start inactive (high if RECIRC = 0 and low if
RECIRC = 1) and will turn active after the number of counts specified by the difference of the contents of
period register and the corresponding duty cycle register.
Center aligned (MCAM[1:0] = 11): Even periods will be output left aligned, odd periods will be output
right aligned. PWM operation starts with the even period after the channel has been enabled. PWM
operation in center aligned mode might start with the odd period if the channel has not been disabled before
changing the alignment mode to center aligned.
015
PWM Output
0
1 Period
100 Counts
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Clock
0
1 Period
100 Counts
15 99
99
DITH = 0, MCAM[1:0] = 01, MCDCx = 15, MCPER = 100, RECIRC = 0
085
PWM Output
0
1 Period
100 Counts
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Clock
0
1 Period
100 Counts
85 99
99
DITH = 0, MCAM[1:0] = 10, MCDCx = 15, MCPER = 100, RECIRC = 0
085
PWM Output
0
1 Period
100 Counts
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Clock
0
1 Period
100 Counts
15 99
99
DITH = 0, MCAM[1:0] = 11, MCDCx = 15, MCPER = 100, RECIRC = 0
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
606 Freescale Semiconductor
16.4.1.3.2 Sign Bit (S)
Assuming RECIRC = 0 (the active state of the PWM signal is low), when the S bit for the corresponding
channel is cleared, MnC0P (if the PWM channel number is even, n = 0, 1, 2, 3, see Table 16-11) or MnC1P
(if the PWM channel number is odd, n = 0, 1, 2, 3, see Table 16-11), outputs a logic high while in (dual)
full H-bridge mode. In half H-bridge mode the state of the S bit has no effect. The PWM output signal is
generated on MnC0M (if the PWM channel number is even, n = 0, 1, 2, 3, see Table 16-11) or MnC1M (if
the PWM channel number is odd, n = 0, 1, 2, 3).
Assuming RECIRC = 0 (the active state of the PWM signal is low), when the S bit for the corresponding
channel is set, MnC0M (if the PWM chan nel number is even, n = 0, 1, 2, 3, see Table 16-11) or MnC1M
(if the PWM channel number is odd, n = 0, 1, 2, 3, see Table 16-11), outputs a logic high while in (dual)
full H-bridge mode. In half H-bridge mode the state of the S bit has no effect. The PWM output signal is
generated on MnC0P (if the PWM channel number is even, n = 0, 1, 2, 3, see Table 16-11) or MnC1P (if
the PWM channel number is odd, n = 0, 1, 2, 3).
Setting RECIRC = 1 will also invert the effect of the S bit such that while S = 0, MnC0P or MnC1P will
generate the PWM signal and MnC0M or MnC1M will be a static low output. While S = 1, MnC0M or
MnC1M will generate the PWM signal and MnC0P or MnC1P will be a static low output. In this case the
active state of the PWM signal will be high.
See Table 16-12 for detailed information about the impact of SIGN and RECIRC bit on the PWM output.
16.4.1.3.3 RECIRC Bit
The RECIRC bit controls the flow of the recirculation current of the load. Setting RECIRC = 0 will cause
recirculation current to flow through the high side transistors, and RECIRC = 1 will cause the recirculation
current to flow through the low side transistors. The RECIRC bit is only active in (dual) full H-bridge
modes.
Effectively, RECIRC = 0 will cause a static high output on the output terminal not driven by the PWM,
RECIRC = 1 will cause a static low output on the output terminals not driven b y the PWM. To achieve the
same current direction, the S bit behavior is inverted if RECIRC = 1. Figure 16-12, Figure 16-13,
Figure 16-14, and Figure 16-15 illustrate the effect of the RECIRC bit in (dual) full H-bridge modes.
RECIRC bit must be changed only while no PWM channel is operated in (dual) full H-bridge mode.
Table 16-12. Impact of RECIRC and SIGN Bit on the PWM Output
Output Mode RECIRC SIGN MnCyM MnCyP
(Dual) Full H-Bridge 0 0 PWM(1)
1. PWM: The PWM signal is low active. e.g., the waveform starts with 0 in left aligned mode. Output M generates the PWM signal.
Output P is static high.
1
(Dual) Full H-Bridge 0 1 1 PWM
(Dual) Full H-Bridge 1 0 0 PWM(2)
2. PWM: The PWM signal is high active. e.g., the waveform starts with 1 in left aligned mode. output P generates the PWM signal.
Output M is static low.
(Dual) Full H-Bridge 1 1 PWM 0
Half H-Bridge: PWM on MnCyM Don’t care Don’t care PWM (3)
3. The state of the output transistors is not controlled by the motor controller.
Half H-Bridge: PWM on MnCyP Don’t care Don’t care PWM
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 607
Figure 16-12. PWM Active Phase, RECIRC = 0, S = 0
Figure 16-13. P W M Pass iv e Phas e, RECIRC = 0, S = 0
VDDM
VSSM
MnC0P MnC0M
Static 0 PWM 1
PWM 1Static 0
VDDM
VSSM
MnC0P MnC0M
Static 0 PWM 0
Static 0 PWM 0
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
608 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 16-14. PWM Active Phase, RECIRC = 1, S = 0
Figure 16-15. P W M Pass iv e Phas e, RECIRC = 1, S = 0
VSSM
MnC0P MnC0M
VDDM
Static 1
Static 1
PWM 0
PWM 0
VDDM
VSSM
MnC0P MnC0M
Static 1
Static 1
PWM 1
PWM 1
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 609
16.4.1.3.4 Relationship Between RECIRC Bit, S Bit, MCOM Bit s, PWM State, and Output
Transistors
Please refer to Figure 16-16 for the output transistor assignment.
Figure 16-16. Output Transistor Assignment
Table 16-13 illustrates the state of the output transistors in different states of the PWM motor controller
module. ‘—’ means that the state of the output transistor is not controlled by the motor controller.
Table 16-13. State of Output Transistors in Various Modes
Mode MCOM[1:0] PWM Duty RECIRC S T1 T2 T3 T4
Off Don’t care Don’t care Don’t care
Half H-Bridge 00 Active Don’t care Don’t care OFF ON
Half H-Bridge 00 Passive Don’t care Don’t care ON OFF
Half H-Bridge 01 Active Don’t care Don’t care OFF ON
Half H-Bridge 01 Passive Don’t care Don’t care ON OFF
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Active 0 0 ON OFF OFF ON
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Passive 0 0 ON OFF ON OFF
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Active 0 1 OFF ON ON OFF
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Passive 0 1 ON OFF ON OFF
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Active 1 0 ON OFF OFF ON
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Passive 1 0 OFF ON OFF ON
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Active 1 1 OFF ON ON OFF
(Dual) Full 10 or 11 Passive 1 1 OFF ON OFF ON
VDDM
VSSM
MnCyP MnCyM
T1
T2
T3
T4
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
610 Freescale Semiconductor
16.4.1.3.5 Dither Bit (DITH)
The purpose of the dither mode is to increase the minimum length of output pulses without decreasing the
PWM resolution, in order to limit the pulse distortion introduced by the slew rate control of the outputs. If
dither mode is selected the output pattern will repeat after two timer counter overflows. For the same
output frequency, the shortest output pulse will have twice the length while dither feature is selected. To
achieve the same output frame frequency, the prescaler of the MC10B8C module has to be set to twice the
division rate if dither mode is selected; e.g., with the same prescaler division rate the repeat rate of the
output pattern is the same as well as the shortest output pulse with or without dither mode selected.
The DITH bit in control register 0 enables or disables the dither function.
DITH = 0: dither function is disabled.
When DITH is cleared and assuming left aligned operation and RECIRC = 0, the PWM output will start
at a logic low level at the beginning of the PWM period (motor controller timer counter = 0x000). The
PWM output remains low until the motor controller timer counter matches the 11-bit PWM duty cycle
value, DUTY, contained in D[10:0] in MCDCx. When a match (output compare between motor controller
timer counter and DUTY) occurs, the PWM output will toggle to a logic high level and will remain at a
logic high level until the motor controller timer counter overflows (reach es the contents o f MCPER – 1).
After the motor controller timer counter resets to 0x000, the PWM output will return to a logic low level.
This completes one PWM period. The PWM period repeats every P counts (as defined by the bits P[10:0]
in the motor controller period register) of the motor controller timer counter. If DUTY >= P, the output
will be static low. If DUTY = 0x0000, the output will be continuously at a logic high level. The
relationship between the motor controller timer counter clock, motor controller timer counter value, and
PWM output while DITH = 0 is shown in Figure 16-17.
Figure 16-17. PWM Output: DITH = 0, MCAM[1:0] = 01, MCDC = 100,
MCPER = 200, RECIRC = 0
DITH = 1: dither function is enabled
Please note if DITH = 1, the bit P0 in the motor controller period register will be inte rnally forced to 0 and
read always as 0.
When DITH is set and assuming left aligned operation and RECIRC = 0, the PWM output will start at a
logic low level at the beginning of the PWM period (when the motor controller timer counter = 0x000).
The PWM output remains low until the motor controller timer counter matches the 10-bit PWM duty cycle
01000100 0
PWM Output
1 Period
200 Counts 200 Counts
1 Period
Motor Controller
Timer Counter Clock
Motor Controller
Timer Counter 199199
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 611
value, DUTY, contained in D[10:1] in MCDCx. When a match (output compare between motor controller
timer counter and DUTY) occurs, the PWM output will toggle to a logic high level and will remain at a
logic high level until the motor controller timer counter overflows (reaches the value defined by
P[10:1] 1 in MCPER). After the motor controller timer counter resets to 0x000, the PWM output will
return to a logic low level. This completes the first half of the PW M period. During the second half of the
PWM period, the PWM output will remain at a logic low level until either the motor controller timer
counter matches the 10-bit PWM duty cycle value, DUTY, contained in D[10:1] in MCDCx if D0 = 0, or
the motor controller timer counter matches the 10-bit PWM duty cycle value + 1 (the value of D[10:1] in
MCDCx is increment by 1 and is compared with the motor controller timer co unter value) if D0 = 1 in the
corresponding duty cycle register. When a match occurs, the PWM output will toggle to a logic high level
and will remain at a logic high level until the motor controller timer counter overflo ws (reaches the value
defined by P[10:1] – 1 in MCPER). After the motor controller timer counter resets to 0x000, the PWM
output will return to a logic low level.
This process will repeat every number of counts of the motor controller timer counter defined by the period
register contents (P[10:0]). If the output is neither set to 0% nor to 100% there will be four edges on the
PWM output per PWM period in this case. Therefore, the PWM output compare function will alternate
between DUTY and DUTY + 1 every half PWM period if D0 in the corresponding duty cycle register is
set to 1. The relationship between the motor controller timer counter clock (fTC), motor controller timer
counter value, and left aligned PWM output if DITH = 1 is shown in Figure 16-18 and Figure 16-19.
Figure 16-20 and Figure 16-21 show right aligned and center aligned PWM operation respectively, with
dither feature enabled and D0 = 1. Please note: In the following examples, the MCPER value is defined
by the bits P[10:0], which is, if DITH = 1, always an even number.
NOTE
The DITH bit must be changed only if the motor controller is disabled (all
channels disabled or period register cleared) to avoid erroneous waveforms.
Figure 16-18. PWM Output: DITH = 1, MCAM[1:0] = 01, MCDC = 31, MCPER = 200, RECIRC = 0
015
PWM Output
16 0
100 Counts
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Clock
016
1 Period
100 Counts
15 99
99
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
612 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 16-19. PWM Output: DITH = 1, MCAM[1:0] = 01, MCDC = 30, MCPER = 200, RECIRC = 0
.
Figure 16-20. PWM Output: DITH = 1, MCAM[1:0] = 10, MCDC = 31, MCPER = 200, RECIRC = 0
Figure 16-21. PWM Output: DITH = 1, MCAM[1:0] = 11, MCDC = 31, MCPER = 200, RECIRC = 0
PWM Output
1 Period
100 Counts
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Clock
100 Counts
015 16 00 16
15 9999
084
PWM Output
85 0
1 Period
100 Counts
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Clock
085
100 Counts
84 99
99
084
PWM Output
0
1 Period
100 Counts
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Clock
0
100 Counts
15 99
99
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 613
16.4.2 PWM Duty Cycle
The PWM duty cycle for the motor controller channel x can be determined by dividing the decimal
representation of bits D[10:0] in MCDCx by the decimal representation of the bits P[10:0] in MCPER and
multiplying the result by 100% as shown in the equation below:
NOTE
x = PWM Channel Number = 0, 1, 2, 3 ... 8. This equation is only valid if
DUTY <= MCPER and MCPER is not equal to 0.
Whenever D[10:0] >= P[10:0], a constant low level (RECIRC = 0) or high level (RECIRC = 1) will be
output.
16.4.3 Motor Controller Counter Clock Source
Figure 16-22 shows how the PWM motor controller timer counter clock source is selected.
Figure 16-22. Motor Controller Counter Clock Selection
The peripheral bus clock is the source for the motor controller counter prescaler. The motor controller
counter clock rate, fTC, is set by selecting the appropriate prescaler value. The prescaler is selected with
the MCPRE[1:0] bits in motor controller control register 0 (MCCTL0). The motor controller channel
frequency of operation can be calculated using the following formula if DITH = 0:
Effective PWM Channel X % Duty Cycle DUTY
MCPER
--------------------- 100%=
1
1/2
1/4
1/8
Motor Controller Timer
Counter Prescaler
Motor Controller
Timer
Counter Clock
Prescaler Select
MPPRE0, MPPRE1
11-Bit Motor Controller
Timer Counter
Peripheral
Bus
Clock fBUS
Clock
Generator
CLK
Clocks and
Reset
Generator
Module
Motor Controller Timer
Counter Clock fTC
Motor Channel Frequency (Hz) fTC
MCPER M
-------------------------------
=
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
614 Freescale Semiconductor
The motor controller channel frequency of operation can be calculated using the following formula if
DITH = 1:
NOTE
Both equations are only valid if MCPER is not equal to 0. M = 1 for left or
right aligned mode, M = 2 for center aligned mode.
Table 16-14 shows examples of the motor controller channel frequencies that can be generated based on
different peripheral bus clock frequencies and the prescaler value.
NOTE
Due to the selectable slew rate control of the outputs, clipping may occur on
short output pulses.
16.4.4 Output Switching Delay
In order to prevent large peak current draw from the motor power supply, selectable delays can be used to
stagger the high logic level to low logic level transitions on the motor controller outputs. The timing delay,
td, is determined by the CD[1:0] bits in the corresponding channel control register (MCMCx) and is
selectable between 0, 1, 2, or 3 motor controller timer counter clock cycles.
NOTE
A PWM channel gets disabled at the next timer counter overflow without
notice of the switching delay.
Table 16-14. Motor Controller Channel Frequencies (Hz),
MCPER = 256, DITH = 0, MCAM = 10, 01
Prescaler
Peripheral Bus Clock Freq uency
16 MHz 10 MHz 8 MHz 5 MHz 4 MHz
1 62500 39063 31250 19531 15625
1/2 31250 19531 15625 9766 7813
1/4 15625 9766 7813 4883 3906
1/8 7813 4883 3906 2441 1953
Motor Channel Frequency (Hz) fTC
MCPER M 2
--------------------------------------
=
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 615
16.4.5 Operation in Wait Mode
During wait mode, the operation of the motor controller pins are selectable between the following two
options:
1. MCSWAI = 1: All module clocks are stopped and the associated port pins are set to their inactive
state, which is defined by the state of the RECIRC bit during wait mode. The motor controller
module registers stay the same as they were prior to entering wait mode. Therefore, after exiting
from wait mode, the associated port pins will resume to the same functionality they had prior to
entering wait mode.
2. MCSWAI = 0: The PWM clocks continue to run and the associated port pins maintain the
functionality they had prior to entering wait mode both during wait mode and after exiting wait
mode.
16.4.6 Operation in Stop and Pseudo-Stop Modes
All module clocks are stopped and the associated port pins are set to their inactive state, which is defined
by the state of the RECIRC bit. The motor controller module registers stay the same as they were prior to
entering stop or pseudo-stop modes. Therefore, after exiting from stop or pseudo-stop modes, the
associated port pins will resume to the same functionality they had prior to entering stop or pseudo-stop
modes.
16.5 Reset
The motor controller is reset by system reset. All associated ports are released, all registers of the motor
controller module will switch to their reset state as defined in Section 16.3.2, “Register Descriptions”.
16.6 Interrupts
The motor controller has one interrupt source.
16.6.1 Timer Counter Overflow Interrupt
An interrupt will be requested when the MCTOIE bit in the motor controller control register 1 is set and
the running PWM frame is finished. The interrupt is cleared by either setting the MCTOIE bit to 0 or to
write a 1 to the MCTOIF bit in the motor controller control register 0.
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
616 Freescale Semiconductor
16.7 Initialization/Application Information
This section provides an example of how the PWM motor controller can be initialized and used by
application software. The configuration parameters (e.g., timer settings, duty cycle values, etc.) are not
guaranteed to be adequate for any real application.
The example software is implemented in assembly language.
16.7.1 Code Example
One way to use the motor controller is:
1. Perform global initialization
a) Set the motor controller control registers MCCTL0 and MCCTL1 to appropriate values.
i) Prescaler disabled (MCPRE1 = 0, MCPRE0 = 0).
ii) Fast mode and dither disabled (FAST = 0, DITH = 0).
iii) Recirculation feature in dual full H-bridge mode disabled (RECIRC = 0).
All other bits in MCCTL0 and MCCTL1 are set to 0.
b) Configure the channel control registers for the desired mode.
i) Dual full H-bridge mode (MCOM[1:0] = 11).
ii) Left aligned PWM (MCAM[1:0] = 01).
iii) No channel delay (MCCD[1:0] = 00).
2. Perform the startup phase
a) Clear the duty cycle registers MCDC0 and MCDC1
b) Initialize the period register MCPER, which is equivalent to enabling the motor controller.
c) Enable the timer which generates the timebase for the updates of the duty cycle registers.
3. Main program
a) Check if pin PB0 is set to “1” and execute the sub program if a timer interrupt is pending.
b) Initiate the shutdown procedure if pin PB0 is set to “0”.
4. Sub program
a) Update the duty cycle registers
Load the duty cycle registers MCDC0 and MCDC1 with new values from the table and clear
the timer interrupt flag.
The sub program will initiate the shutdown procedure if pin PB0 is set to “0”.
b) Shutdown procedure
The timer is disabled and the duty cycle registers are cleared to drive an inactive value on the PWM output
as long as the motor controller is enabled. The period register is cleared after a certain time, which disables
the motor controller. The table address is restored and the timer interrupt flag is cleared.
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 617
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
; Motor Controller (MC10B8C) setup example
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
; Timer defines
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
T_START EQU $0040
TSCR1 EQU T_START+$06
TFLG2 EQU T_START+$0F
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
; Motor Controller defines
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MC_START EQU $0200
MCCTL0 EQU MC_START+$00
MCCTL1 EQU MC_START+$01
MCPER_HI EQU MC_START+$02
MCPER_LO EQU MC_START+$03
MCCC0 EQU MC_START+$10
MCCC1 EQU MC_START+$11
MCCC2 EQU MC_START+$12
MCCC3 EQU MC_START+$13
MCDC0_HI EQU MC_START+$20
MCDC0_LO EQU MC_START+$21
MCDC1_HI EQU MC_START+$22
MCDC1_LO EQU MC_START+$23
MCDC2_HI EQU MC_START+$24
MCDC2_LO EQU MC_START+$25
MCDC3_HI EQU MC_START+$26
MCDC3_LO EQU MC_START+$27
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
; Port defines
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
DDRB EQU $0003
PORTB EQU $0001
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
; Flash defines
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FLASH_START EQU $0100
FCMD EQU FLASH_START+$06
FCLKDIV EQU FLASH_START+$00
FSTAT EQU FLASH_START+$05
FTSTMOD EQU FLASH_START+$02
; Variables
CODE_START EQU $1000 ; start of program code
DTYDAT EQU $1500 ; start of motor controller duty cycle data
TEMP_X EQU $1700 ; save location for IX reg in ISR
TABLESIZE EQU $1704 ; number of config entries in the table
MCPERIOD EQU $0250 ; motor controller period
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ORG CODE_START ; start of code
LDS #$1FFF ; set stack pointer
MOVW #$000A,TABLESIZE ; number of configurations in the table
MOVW TABLESIZE,TEMP_X
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
618 Freescale Semiconductor
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
;global motor controller init
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
GLB_INIT: MOVB #$0000,MCCTL0 ; fMC = fBUS, FAST=0, DITH=0
MOVB #$0000,MCCTL1 ; RECIRC=0, MCTOIE=0
MOVW #$D0D0,MCCC0 ; dual full h-bridge mode, left aligned,
; no channel delay
MOVW #$0000,MCPER_HI ; disable motor controller
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
;motor controller startup
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
STARTUP:
MOVW #$0000,MCDC0_HI ; define startup duty cycles
MOVW #$0000,MCDC1_HI
MOVW #MCPERIOD,MCPER_HI ; define PWM period
MOVB #$80,TSCR1 ; enable timer
MAIN: LDAA PORTB ; if PB=0, activate shutdown
ANDA #$01
BEQ MN0
JSR TIM_SR
MN0: TST TFLG2 ; poll for timer counter overflow flag
BEQ MAIN ; TOF set?
JSR TIM_SR ; yes, go to TIM_SR
BRA MAIN
TIM_SR: LDX TEMP_X ; restore index register X
LDAA PORTB ; if PB=0, enter shutdown routine
ANDA #$01
BNE SHUTDOWN
LDX TEMP_X ; restore index register X
BEQ NEW_SEQ ; all mc configurations done?
NEW_CFG: LDD DTYDAT,X ; load new config’s
STD MCDC0_HI
DEX
DEX
LDD DTYDAT,X
STD MCDC1_HI
BRA END_SR ; leave sub-routine
SHUTDOWN: MOVB #$00,TSCR1 ; disable timer
MOVW #$0000,MCDC0_HI ; define startup duty cycle
MOVW #$0000,MCDC1_HI ; define startup duty cycle
LDAA #$0000 ; ensure that duty cycle registers are
; cleared for some time before disabling
; the motor controller
LOOP DECA
BNE LOOP
MOVW #$0000,MCPER_HI ; define pwm period
NEW_SEQ: MOVW TABLESIZE,TEMP_X ; start new tx loop
LDX TEMP_X
END_SR: STX TEMP_X ; save byte counter
MOVB #$80,TFLG2 ; clear TOF
RTS ; wait for new timer overflow
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 619
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
; motor controller duty cycles
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
org DTYDAT
DC.B $02, $FF1; MCDC1_HI, MCDC1_LO
DC.B $02, $D0 ; MCDC0_HI, MCDC0_LO
DC.B $02, $A0 ; MCDC1_HI, MCDC1_LO
DC.B $02, $90 ; MCDC0_HI, MCDC0_LO
DC.B $02, $60 ; MCDC1_HI, MCDC1_LO
DC.B $02, $25 ; MCDC0_HI, MCDC0_LO
1. The values for the duty cycle table have to be defined for the needs of the target application.
Chapter 16 Motor Controller (MC10B8CV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
620 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 621
Chapter 17
Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
17.1 Introduction
The stepper stall detector (SSD) block provides a circuit to measure and integrate the induced voltage on
the non-driven coil of a stepper motor using full step s when the ga uge pointer is returning to zero (RTZ).
During the RTZ event, the pointer is returned to zero using full steps in either clockwise or counter
clockwise direction, where only one coil is driven at any point in time. The back electromotive force
(EMF) signal present on the non-driven coil is integrated after a blanking time, and its results stored in a
16-bit accumulator. The 16-bit modulus down counter can be used to monitor the blanking time and the
integration time. The value in the accumulator represents the change in linked flux (magnetic flux times
the number of turns in the coil) and can be compared to a stored threshold. Values above the threshold
indicate a moving motor , in which case the pointer can be advanced anothe r full step in the same direction
and integration be repeated. Values below the threshold indicate a stalled motor, thereby marking the
cessation of the RTZ event.
17.1.1 Modes of Operation
Return to zero modes
Blanking with no drive
Blanking with drive
Conversion
Integration
Low-power modes
17.1.2 Features
Programmable full step state
Programmable integration polarity
Blanking (recirculation) state
16-bit integration accumulator register
Table 17-1. SSDV2 Revision History
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Ch anges
V02.00 1st Aug 2011 -remove the SMS bit in RTZCTL register
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
622 Freescale Semiconductor
16-bit modulus down counter with interrupt
17.1.3 Block Diagram
Figure 17-1. SSD Block Diagram
Coil SIN
Coil COS
Bus Clock
VDDM
COSP COSM
T1
T2
T3
VSSM
1/2 1/2
1/2
1/8
4:1 MUX
VDDM
T4
VSSM
S1 S3
S2 S4
VDDM
SINP SINM
T5
T6
T7
VSSM
VDDM
T8
VSSM
S5 S7
S6 S8
16-bit accumulator
register
VDDM
VSSM
R2
R2
DFF
16-bit modulus
down counter
R1
C1
+
+
16-bit load
register
sigma-delta converter
P
A
D
P
A
D
P
A
D
P
A
D
integrator
reference
1/8
2:1 MUX
DAC
(analog)
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 623
17.2 External Signal Description
Each SSD signal is the output pin of a half bridge, designed to source or sink current. The H-bridge pins
drive the sine and cosine coils of a stepper motor to provide four-quadrant operation.
17.2.1 COSM/COSP — Cosine Coil Pins for Motor
These pins interface to the cosine co ils of a stepper motor to measure the back EMF for calibration of the
pointer reset position.
17.2.2 SINM/SINP — Sine Coil Pins for Motor
These pins interface to the sine coils of a stepper motor to measure the back EMF for calibration of the
pointer reset position.
Table 17-2. Pin Table
Pin Name Node Coil
COSM Minus COS
COSP Plus
SINM Minus SIN
SINP Plus
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
624 Freescale Semiconductor
17.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers of the stepper stall detector (SSD) block.
17.3.1 Module Memory Map
Table 17-3 gives an overview of all registers in the SSDV2 memory map. The SSDV2 occupies eight bytes
in the memory space. The register address results from the addition of base addr ess and addr ess offset. The
base address is determined at the MCU level and is given in the Device Overview chapter. The address
offset is defined at the block level and is given here.
17.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes in detail all the registers and register bits in the SSDV2 block. Each description
includes a standard register diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field
function follow the register diagrams, in bit order.
Table 17-3. SSDV2 Memory Map
Address
Offset Use Access
0x0000 RTZCTL R/W
0x0001 MDCCTL R/W
0x0002 SSDCTL R/W
0x0003 SSDFLG R/W
0x0004 MDCCNT (High) R/W
0x0005 MDCCNT (Low) R/W
0x0006 ITGACC (High) R
0x0007 ITGACC (Low) R
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 625
17.3.2.1 Return-to-Zero Control Register (RTZCTL)
Read: anytime
Write: anytime
Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
R
ITG DCOIL RCIR POL
00
STEP
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 17-2. Return-to-Zero Control Register (RTZCTL)
Table 17-4. RTZCTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
ITG
Integration During return to zero (RTZE = 1), one of the coils must be recirculated or non-driven determined
by the STEP field. If the ITG bit is set, the coil is non-driven, and if the ITG bit is clear, the coil is being recirculated.
Table 17-5 shows the condition state of each transistor from Figure 17-1 based on the STEP, ITG, DCOIL and
RCIR bits.
Regardless of the RTZE bit value, if the ITG bit is set, one end of the non-driven coil connects to the (non-zero)
reference input and the other end connects to the integrator input of the sigma-delta converter. Regardless of the
RTZE bit value, if the ITG bit is clear, the non-driven coil is in a blanking state, the converter is in a reset state,
and the accumulator is initialized to zero. Tabl e 1 7-6 shows the condition state of each switch from Figure 17-1
based on the ITG, STEP and POL bits.
0Blanking
1 Integration
6
DCOIL
Drive Coil — During return to zero (RTZE=1), one of the coils must be driven determined by the STEP field. If
the DCOIL bit is set, this coil is driven. If the DCOIL bit is clear, this coil is disconnected or drivers turned off.
Table 17-5 shows the condition state of each transistor from Figure 17-1 based on the STEP, ITG, DCOIL and
RCIR bits.
0 Disconnect Coil
1Drive Coil
5
RCIR
Recirculation in Blanking Mode — During return to zero (RTZE = 1), one of the coils is recirculated prior to
integration during the blanking period. This bit determines if the coil is recirculated via VDDM or via VSSM.
Table 17-5 shows the condition state of each transistor from Figure 17-1 based on the STEP, ITG, DCOIL and
RCIR bits.
0 Recirculation on the high side transistors
1 Recirculation on the low side transistors
4
POL
Polarity — This bit determines which end of the non-driven coil is routed to the sigma-delta converter during
conversion or integration mode. Table 17-6 shows the condition state of each switch from Figure 17-1 based on
the ITG, STEP and POL bits.
1:0
STEP
Full Step StateThis field indicates one of the four possible full step states. Step 0 is considered the east pole
or 0 angle, step 1 is the north Pole or 90 angle, step 2 is the west pole or 180 angle, and step 3 is the south
pole or 270 angle. For each full step state, Table 17-7 shows the current through each of the two coils, and the
coil nodes that are multiplexed to the sigma-delta converter during conversion or integration mode.
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
626 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 17-5. Transistor Condition States (RTZE = 1)
STEP ITG DCOIL RCIR T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8
xx 1 0 x OFFOFFOFFOFFOFFOFFOFFOFF
00 0 0 0 OFF OFF OFF OFF ON OFF ON OFF
00 0 0 1 OFFOFFOFFOFFOFF ON OFF ON
00 0 1 0 ON OFF OFF ON ON OFF ON OFF
00 0 1 1 ONOFFOFFONOFFONOFFON
00 1 1 x ONOFFOFFONOFFOFFOFFOFF
01 0 0 0 ON OFF ON OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF
01 0 0 1 OFF ON OFF ON OFF OFF OFF OFF
01 0 1 0 ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF OFF ON
01 0 1 1 OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF OFF ON
01 1 1 x OFF OFF OFF OFF ON OFF OFF ON
10 0 0 0 OFF OFF OFF OFF ON OFF ON OFF
10 0 0 1 OFFOFFOFFOFFOFF ON OFF ON
10 0 1 0 OFF ON ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
10 0 1 1 OFF ON ON OFF OFF ON OFF ON
10 1 1 x OFF ON ON OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF
11 0 0 0 ON OFF ON OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF
11 0 0 1 OFF ON OFF ON OFF OFF OFF OFF
11 0 1 0 ON OFF ON OFF OFF ON ON OFF
11 0 1 1 OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF
11 1 1 x OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF ON ON OFF
Table 17-6. Switch Condition States (RTZE = 1 or 0)
ITG STEP POL S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8
0 xx x Open Open Open Open Open Open Open Open
1 00 0 Open Open Open Open Close Open Open Close
1 00 1 Open Open Open Open Open Close Close Open
1 01 0 Open Close Close Open Open Open Open Open
1 01 1 Close Open Open Close Open Open Open Open
1 10 0 Open Open Open Open Open Close Close Open
1 10 1 Open Open Open Open Close Open Open Close
1 11 0 Close Open Open Close Open Open Open Open
1 11 1 Open Close Close Open Open Open Open Open
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 627
17.3.2.2 Modulus Down Counter Control Register (MDCCTL)
Read: anytime
Write: anytime.
l
Table 17-7. Full Step States
STEP Pole Angle
COSINE
Coil Current SINE
Coil Current
Coil Node to
Integrator input
(Close Switch)
Coil Node to
Reference input
(Close Switch)
DCOIL = 0 DCOIL = 1 DCOIL = 0 DCOIL = 1 ITG = 1
POL = 0 ITG = 1
POL = 1 IT G = 1
POL = 0 ITG = 1
POL = 1
0East0
0 + I max 0 0 SINM (S8) SINP (S6) SINP (S5) SINM (S7)
1 North 900 0 0 + I max COSP (S2) COSM (S4) COSM (S3) COSP (S1)
2 West 1800 – I max 0 0 SINP (S6) SINM (S8) SINM (S7) SINP (S5)
3 South 2700 0 0 – I max COSM (S4) COSP (S2) COSP (S1) COSM (S3)
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
R
MCZIE MODMC RDMCL PRE
0
MCEN
0
AOVIE
WFLMC
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 17-3. Modulus Down Counter Control Register (MDCCTL)
Table 17-8. MDCCTL Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
MCZIE
Modulus Counter Underflow Interrupt Enable
0 Interrupt disabled.
1 Interrupt enabled. An interrupt will be generated when the modulus counter underflow interrupt flag (MCZIF)
is set.
6
MODMC
Modulus Mode Enab le
0 The modulus counter counts down from the value in the counter register and will stop at 0x0000.
1 Modulus mode is enabled. When the counter reaches 0x0000, the counter is loaded with the latest value
written to the modulus counter register.
Note: For proper operation, the MCEN bit should be cleared before modifying the MODMC bit in order to reset
the modulus counter to 0xFFFF.
5
RDMCL
Read Modulus Down-Counter Load
0 Reads of the modulus count register (MDCCNT) will return the present value of the count register.
1 Reads of the modulus count register (MDCCNT) will return the contents of the load register.
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
628 Freescale Semiconductor
17.3.2.3 Stepper Stall Detector Control Register (SSDCTL)
Read: anytime
Write: anytime
l
4
PRE
Prescaler
0 The modulus down counter clock frequency is the bus frequency divided by 64.
1 The modulus down counter clock frequency is the bus frequency divided by 512.
Note: A change in the prescaler division rate will not be effective until a load of the load register into the modulus
counter count register occurs.
3
FLMC
Force Load Register into the Modulus Counter Count Register — This bit always reads zero.
0 Write zero to this bit has no effect.
1 Write one into this bit loads the load register into the modulus counter count register.
2
MCEN
Modulus Down-Counter Enable
0 Modulus down-counter is disabled. The modulus counter (MDCCNT) is preset to 0xFFFF. This will prevent an
early interrupt flag when the modulus down-counter is enabled.
1 Modulus down-counter is enabled.
0
AOVIE
Accumulator Overflow Interrupt Enable
0 Interrupt disabled.
1 Interrupt enabled. An interrupt will be generated when the accumulator overflow interrupt flag (AOVIF) is set.
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
R
RTZE SDCPU SSDWAI FTST
00
ACLKS
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 17-4. Stepper Stall Detector Control Register (SSDCTL)
Table 17-9. SSDCT L Fi el d De sc rip ti on s
Field Description
7
RTZE
Return to Zero Enable If this bit is set, the coils are controlled by the SSD and are configured into one of the
four full step states as shown in Table 17-7. If this bit is cleared, the coils are not controlled by the SSD.
0 RTZ is disabled.
1 RTZ is enabled.
6
SDCPU
Sigma-Delta Converter Power Up — This bit provides on/off control for the sigma-delta converter allowing
reduced MCU power consumption. Because the analog circuit is turned off when powered down, the sigma-delta
converter requires a recovery time after it is powered up.
0 Sigma-delta converter is powered down.
1 Sigma-delta converter is powered up.
Table 17-8. MDCCTL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 629
NOTE
A change in the accumulator sample frequency will not be effective until the
ITG bit is cleared.
17.3.2.4 Stepper Stall Detector Flag Register (SSDFLG)
Read: anytime
Write: anytime.
5
SSDWAI
SSD Disabled du ri ng W ait Mode — When entering Wait Mode, this bit provides on/off control over the SSD
allowing reduced MCU power consumption. Because the analog circuit is turned off when powered down, the
sigma-delta converter requires a recovery time after exit from Wait Mode.
0 SSD continues to run in WAIT mode.
1 Entering WAIT mode freezes the clock to the prescaler divider, powers down the sigma-delta converter, and
if RTZE bit is set, the sine and cosine coils are recirculated via VSSM.
4
FTST
Factory Test — This bit is reserved for factory test and reads zero in user mode.
1:0
ACLKS
Accumulator Sample Frequency Select — This field sets the accumulator sample frequency by pre-scaling
the bus frequency by a factor of 8, 16, 32, or 64. A faster sample frequency can provide more accurate results
but cause the accumulator to overflow. Best results are achieved with a frequency between 500 kHz and 2 MHz.
Accumulator Sample Frequency = fBUS / (8 x 2ACLKS)
Table 17-10. Accumulator Sample Frequency
ACLKS Frequency fBUS = 40
MHz fBUS = 25
MHz fBUS = 16
MHz
0f
BUS / 8 5.00 MHz 3.12 MHz 2.00 MHz
1f
BUS / 16 2.50 MHz 1.56 MHz 1.00 MHz
2f
BUS / 32 1.25 MHz 781 kHz 500 kHz
3f
BUS / 64 625 kHz 391 kHz 250 kHz
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R
MCZIF
000000
AOVIF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 17-5. Stepper Stall Detector Flag Register (SSDFLG)
Table 17-9. SSDCTL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
630 Freescale Semiconductor
l
17.3.2.5 Modulus Down-Counter Count Register (MDCCNT)
Read: anytime
Write: anytime.
NOTE
A separate read/write for high byte and low byte gives a different result than
accessing the register as a word.
If the RDMCL bit in the MDCCTL register is cleared, reads of the MDCCNT register will return the
present value of the count register. If the RDMCL bit is set, reads of the MDCCNT register will return the
contents of the load register.
With a 0x0000 write to the MDCCNT register, the modulus counter stays at zero and does not set the
MCZIF flag in the SSDFLG register.
If modulus mode is not enabled (MODMC = 0), a write to the MDCCNT register immediately updates the
load register and the counter register with the value written to it. The modulus counter will count down
from this value and will stop at 0x0000.
If modulus mode is enabled (MODMC = 1), a write to the MDCCNT register updates the load register with
the value written to it. The count register will not be updated with the new value until the next counter
Table 17-11. SSDFLG Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
MCZIF
Modulus Counter Underflow Interrupt Flag — This flag is set when the modulus down-counter reaches
0x0000. If not masked (MCZIE = 1), a modulus counter underflow interrupt is pending while this flag is set. This
flag is cleared by writing a ‘1’ to the bit. A write of ‘0’ has no effect.
0
AOVIF
Accumulator Overflow Interrupt Flag — This flag is set when the Integration Accumulator has a positive or
negative overflow. If not masked (AOVIE = 1), an accumulator overflow interrupt is pending while this flag is set.
This flag is cleared by writing a ‘1’ to the bit. A write of ‘0’ has no effect.
Module Base + 0x0004
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
R
MDCCNT
W
Reset11111111
Figure 17-6. Modulus Down-Counter Count Register High (MDCCNT)
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
R
MDCCNT
W
Reset11111111
Figure 17-7. Modulus Down-Counter Count Register Low (MDCCNT)
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 631
underflow. The FLMC bit in the MDCCTL register can be used to immediately update the count register
with the new value if an immediate load is desired.
The modulus down counter clock frequency is the bus frequency divided by 64 or 512.
17.3.2.6 Integration Accumulator Register (ITGACC)
Read: anytime.
Write: Never.
NOTE
A separate read for high byte and low byte gives a different result than
accessing the register as a word.
This 16-bit field is signed and is represented in two’s complement. It indicates the change in flux while
integrating the back EMF present in the non-driven coil during a return to zero event.
When ITG is zero, the accumulator is initialized to 0x0000 and the sigma-delta converter is in a reset state.
When ITG is one, the accumulator increments or decrements depending on the sigma-delta conversion
sample. The accumulator sample frequency is determined by the ACLKS field. The accumulator freezes
at 0x7FFF on a positive overflow and freezes at 0x8000 on a negative overflow.
17.4 Functional Description
The stepper stall detector (SSD) has a simple control block to configure the H-bridge drivers of a stepper
motor in four different full step states with four available modes during a return to zero event. The SSD
has a detect circuit using a sigma-delta converter to measure and integrate changes in flux of the de-
energized winding in the stepping motor and the conversion result is accumulated in a 16-bit signed
register. The SSD also has a 16-bit modulus down counter to monitor blanking and integration times. DC
offset compensation is implemented when using the modulus down counter to monitor integration times.
Module Base + 0x0006
1 5 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RITGACC
W
Reset00000000
Figure 17-8. Integration Accumulator Register High (ITGACC)
Module Base + 0x0007
76543210
RITGACC
W
Reset00000000
Figure 17-9. Integration Accumulator Register Low (ITGACC)
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
632 Freescale Semiconductor
17.4.1 Return to Zero Modes
There are four return to zero modes as shown in Table 17-12.
17.4.1.1 Blanking with No Drive
In blanking mode with no drive, one of the coils is masked from the sigma-delta converter , and if RTZ is
enabled (RTZE = 1), it is set up to recirculate its current. If RTZ is enabled (RTZE = 1), the other coil is
disconnected to prevent any loss of flux change that would occur when the motor starts moving before the
end of recirculation and start of integration. In blanking mode with no drive, the accumulator is initialized
to 0x0000 and the converter is in a reset state.
17.4.1.2 Blanking with Drive
In blanking mode with drive, one of the coils is masked from the sigma-delta converter, and if RTZ is
enabled (RTZE = 1), it is set up to recirculate its current. If RTZ is enabled (RTZE = 1), the other coil is
driven. In blanking mode with drive, the accumulator is initialized to 0x0000 and the converter is in a reset
state.
17.4.1.3 Conversion
In conversion mode, one of the coils is routed for integration with one end connected to the (non-zero)
reference input and the other end connected to the integrator input of the sigma-delta converter. If RTZ is
enabled (RTZE=1), both coils are disconnected. This mode is not useful for stall detection.
17.4.1.4 Integration
In integration mode, one of the coils is routed for integration with one end connected to the (non-zero)
reference input and the other end connected to the integrator input of the sigma-delta converter. If RTZ is
enabled (RTZE = 1), the other coil is driven. This mode is used to rectify and integrate the back EMF
produced by the coils to detect stepped rotary motion.
DC offset compensation is implemented when using the modulus down counter to monitor integration
time.
17.4.2 Full Step States
During a return to zero (R TZ) event, the stepper motor pointer requires a 90 full motor electrical step with
full amplitude pulses applied to each phase in turn. For counter clockwise rotation (CCW), the STEP value
is incremented 0, 1, 2, 3, 0 and so on, and for a clockwise rotation the STEP value is decremented 3, 2, 1,
Table 17-12. Return to Zero Modes
ITG DCOIL Mode
0 0 Blanking with no drive
0 1 Blanking with drive
1 0 Conversion
1 1 Integration
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 633
0 and so on. Figure 17-10 shows the current level through each coil for each full step in CCW rotation
when DCOIL is set.
Figure 17-10. Full Steps (CCW)
Figure 17-11 shows the current flow in the SIN and COS H-bridges when STEP = 0, DCOIL = 1, ITG = 0
and RCIR = 0.
Figure 17-11. Current Flow when STEP = 0, DCOIL = 1, ITG = 0, RCIR = 0
Figure 17-12 shows the current flow in the SIN and COS H-bridges when STEP = 1, DCOIL = 1, ITG = 0
and RCIR = 1.
0123
0
Imax
+
_Imax
0
Imax
+
_Imax
SINE COIL
CURRENT
COSINE COIL
CURRENT
Recirculation
VDDM
COSP COSM
T1
T2
T3
T4
VSSM
VDDM
SINP SINM
T5
T6
T7
T8
VSSM
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
634 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 17-12. Current Flow when STEP = 1, DCOIL = 1, ITG = 0, RCIR = 1
Figure 17-13 shows the current flow in the SIN and COS H-bridges when STEP = 2, DCOIL = 1 and
ITG = 1.
Figure 17-13. Current flow when STEP = 2, DCOIL = 1, ITG = 1
Figure 17-14 shows the current flow in the SIN and COS H-bridges when STEP = 3, DCOIL = 1 and
ITG = 1.
VDDM
COSP
COSM
T1
T2
T3
T4
VSSM
VDDM
SINP SINM
T5
T6
T7
T8
VSSM
VDDM
COSP COSM
T1
T2
T3
T4
VSSM
VDDM
SINP SINM
T5
T6
T7
T8
VSSM
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 635
Figure 17-14. Current flow when STEP = 3, DCOIL = 1, ITG = 1
VDDM
COSP COSM
T1
T2
T3
T4
VSSM
VDDM
SINP SINM
T5
T6
T7
T8
VSSM
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
636 Freescale Semiconductor
17.4.3 Operation in Low Power Modes
The SSD block can be configured for lower MCU power consumption in three different ways.
Stop mode powers down the sigma-delta converter and halts clock to the modulus counter. Exit
from Stop enables the sigma-delta converter and the clock to the modulus counter but due to the
converter recovery time, the integration result should be ignored.
Wait mode with SSDWAI bit set powers down the sigma-delta converter and halts the clock to the
modulus counter. Exit from Wait enables the sigma-delta converter and clock to the modulus
counter but due to the converter recovery time, the integration result should be ignored.
Clearing SDCPU bit powers down the sigma-delta converter.
17.4.4 Stall Detection Flow
Figure 17-15 shows a flowchart and software setup for stall detection of a stepper motor.
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 637
Figure 17-15. Return-to-Zero Flowchart
Advance Pointer
Initialize SSD
Start Blanking
Start Integration
Disable SSD
End of
Blanking?
End of
Integration?
Stall
Detection?
Using Motor Control module, drive pointer to within 3 full steps of
calibrated zero position.
1. Clear (or set) RCIR; clear (or set) POL;
2. Set MCZIE; clear MODMC; clear (or set) PRE; set MCEN.
3. Set RTZE; set SDCPU; write ACLKS (select sample frequency).
4. Store threshold value in RAM.
1. Clear MCZIF.
2. Write MDCCNT with blanking time value.
3. Clear ITG; clear (or set) DCOIL; increment (or decrement) STEP for
CCW (or CW) motion.
MDCCNT = 0x0000? or MCZIF = 1?
1. Clear MCZIF.
2. Write MDCCNT with integration time value.
3. Set ITG; set DCOIL.
MDCCNT = 0x0000? or MCZIF = 1?
Yes
No
Yes
No
ITGACC < Threshold (RAM value)?
1. Clear MCZIF.
2. Clear MCEN.
3. Clear ITG.
4. Clear RTZE; clear SDCPU.
Yes
No
Chapter 17 Stepper Stall Detector (SSDV2) Block Description
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
638 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 639
Chapter 18
Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
Table 18-1. Revision History
18.1 Introduction
The real-time counter (RTC) supports the calendar functions. It can also serve as a cyclical wake up from
low power modes, STOP and WAITs, without the need of external components. A frequency compensa-
tion mechanism is built into this RTC module to allow adjustments made to the RTC clock when a less
accurate crystal is used or to correct frequency shifts due to changing temperature. The 1-Hz clock that
drives the clock and calendar could make use of the built-in compensation mechanism for crystal fre-
quency error compensation so that the 1-Hz clock could be made more accurate than the frequency accu-
racy of the crystal that drive the module.
18.2 Features
Features of the RTC module include:
16-bit up-counter
Support both 4-16MHz OSC(OSCCLCK) and 32.768KHz OSC(OSCCLK_32K) input
Calendar Counter registers for:
Second
Minute
Hour
Five periodic interrupts
Built-in compensation mechanism for frequency error compensation
18.2.1 Modes of Operation
This section defines the RTC operation in stop, wait and background debug modes.
Version
Number Revision
Date Sections Affected Description of Changes
0.0 April 2011 All inital Draft
0.7 March 2011 All fix typo on 18.1,18.2,18.3.4,18.5.3,18.5.6,18.6.1.1
0.8 March 2011 All V2 spec,add clock source of IRCCLK, Figure 18-1./18-641,
18.3.3/18-642, Table 18-2./18-642, Figure 18-3./18-644,
Table 18-4./18-644
0.9 March 2011 All fix typo according review
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
640 Freescale Semiconductor
18.2.1.1 Wait Mode
The RTC continues to run in wait mode if enabled before executing the WAIT instruction. Therefore, the
RTC can be used to bring the MCU out of wait mode if the real-time interrupt is enabled. For lowest
possible current consumption, the RTC should be stopped by software if not needed as an interrupt source
during wait mode.
18.2.1.2 Stop Modes
The RTC continues to run in STOP mode if the RTC is enabled before executing the STOP instruction.
Therefore, the RTC can be used to bring the MCU out of stop modes with no external components, if the
real-time interrupt is enabled.
18.2.1.3 Freeze Mode
In freeze mode(BDM active), depend on the bit FRZ in RTCCTL3, RTC will be stop or run continue.
18.2.2 Block Diagram
The block diagram for the RTC module is shown in Figure 18-1.
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 641
Figure 18-1. Real-Time Counter with Calendar (RTC) Block Diagram
18.3 External Signal Description
18.3.1 OSCCLK
The OSCCLK is 4-16MHZ main OSC output.
16-bit counter
16-bit modulo
16-bit modulo
16-bit comparator
16-bit latch
RTCCNT
RTCMOD
Interrupt
Logic
SECF
SECIE
Second Counter Register
HRF
HRIE
Minute Counter Register
MINF
MINIE
Hour Counter Register
1 Hz
4 HZ
compensation cycle
TB0IE
TB0F
COMPIE
COMPF
Compensation Circuit
CCS Q
Comparator
COMPE
CALS
CALCLK
1/(RTCPS+1)
RTCCLK
1/32
CLKSRC
OSCCLK
IRCCLK
OSCCLK_32K
CLKSRC
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
642 Freescale Semiconductor
18.3.2 OSCCLK_32K
The OSCCLK_32K is 32.768K OSC output.
18.3.3 IRCCLK
The IRCCLK is 1MHz CPMU output.
18.3.4 RTCCLK
The RTCCLK can run from OSCCLK or OSCCLK_32K. It depends on the CLKSRC setting . If derived
from OSCCLK, it depends on the RTCPS settting also. User need to set the correct RTCPS in order to get
the right RTCCLK generated. This clock will be used as LCD clock input source also.
18.3.5 CALCLK
The CALCLK is calibration clock output. It is internal routed to the timer channel for the on chip
calibration. Refer the PIM section for detailed information. And it is also routed to the pin, refer to the
device specification for avaiablity and connectivity of signal.
18.4 Register Definition
The RTC includes status and control registers, a 16-bit counter register, and a 16-bit modulo register,
calendar function counter registers. Except the RTCCTL3, RTCCTL4, RTCS1 registers which are normal
reset, all the other RTC registers are POR reset only.
Table 18-2 is a summary of RTC registers.
Table 18-2. RTC Register Summary
Name 76543210
0x0000
RTCCTL1
R
RTCEN
00000
COMPE
0
W
0x0001
RTCCTL2
RCLKS-
RC1
CLKS-
RC0
00
RTCPS3 RTCPS2 RTCPS1 RTCPS0
W
0x0002
RTCCTL3
R00
FRZ
0
CALS
0
WRTCWE1 RT-
CWE0
0x0003
RTCCTL4
R0 0
HRIE MINIE SECIE COMPIE
0
TB0IE
W
0x0004
RTCS1
R CDLC 0
HRF MINF SECF COMPF
0
TB0F
W
0x0005
RTCCCR
R
CCS Q
W
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 643
18.4.1 RTC Control Register 1(RTCCTL1)
The RTCCTL1 contains the enable bit for RTC compensation function and RTC function enable bit. This
register is write-protected, writing this register should follows write-protect mechanism section.
0x0006
RTCMODH
R
RTCMODH
W
0x0007
RTCMODL
R
RTCMODL
W
0x0008
RTCCNTH
R RTCCNTH
W
0x0009
RTCCNTL
R RTCCNTL
W
0x000A - 0x000C
RESERVED
R0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x000D
RTCSECR
R0 0
SEC5 SEC4 SEC3 SEC2 SEC1 SEC0
W
0x000E
RTCMINR
R0 0
MIN5 MIN4 MIN3 MIN2 MIN1 MIN0
W
0x000F
RTCHRR
R0 0 0
HR4 HR3 HR2 HR1 HR0
W
76543210
R
RTCEN
00000
COMPE
0
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-2. RTC Control Register 1 (RTCCTL1)
Table 18-2. RTC Register Summary (continued)
Name 76543210
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
644 Freescale Semiconductor
18.4.2 RTC Control Register 2 (RTCCTL2)
The RTCCTL2 contains the RTC clock source selection bit and clock divider control bits. This register is
write one time only in normal mode, anytime in special mode.
18.4.3 RTC Control Register 3 (RTCCTL3)
The RTCCTL3 contains the write protection configure bits (RTCWE1, RTCW0), the compensation data
setting ready bit.
Table 18-3. RTCCTL1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
RTCEN
RTC Enable — This read/write bit enables the RTC.
0 RTC function is disabled.
1 RTC function is enabled.
1
COMPE
RTC Compensation Enable— The read/write bit enables the clock compensation mechanism for clock
frequency errors.
0 Compensation mechanism is disabled.
1 Compensation mechanism is enabled.
76543210
R
CLKSRC1 CLKSRC0
00
RTCPS3 RTCPS2 RTCPS1 RTCPS0
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-3. RTC Control Register 2(RTCCTL2)
Table 18-4. RTCCTL2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:6
CLKSRC
RTC Clock Source Selection— The read/write bit select the RTCCLK source.
00 RTCCLK is from OSCCLK
01 RTCCLK is from OSCCLK_32K
10 RTCCLK is from IRCCLK
11 reserved
3:0
RTCPS
RTC main OSC prescaler — These read/write bits define the OSCCLK prescaler value. The input OSCCLK
will be divided by (RTCPS+1) if RTCLK source is from OSCCLK. User should set the RTCPS value to let
prescaler clock frequency to be 1MHZ. The 1MHZ clock will be divide by 32 to generate 31.25KHz RTC counter
clock.
76543210
R00
FRZ
0
CALS
0
W RTCWE1 RTCWE0
Reset:00000000
Figure 18-4. RTC Control Register 3(RTCCTL3)
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 645
18.4.4 RTC Control Register 4 (RTCCTL4)
The RTCCTL4 contains the interrupt enable bits for RTC interrupt functions.
Table 18-5. RTCCTL3 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:6
RTCWE[1:0] RTC Module W rite Enable — These two write-only bits control the write-protect function of several
RTC registers and bits. After a reset, write-protect is disabled, allowing full write access to RTC registers and
bits. These two bits always read as 0.
To enable write-protect, perform the following sequence:
1. Write %10 to RTCWE[1:0] bits
2. Write %10 to RTCWE[1:0] bits
To disable write-protect, perform the following sequence:
1. Write %00 to RTCWE[1:0] bits
2. Write %01 to RTCWE[1:0] bits
3. Write %11 to RTCWE[1:0] bits
4. Write %10 to RTCWE[1:0] bits
To disable write-protect from an unsure protection state, first perform the enable write-protect sequence, fol-
lowed by the disable write protect sequence.
3
FRZ
RTC Stop in Freeze Mode— The read/write bit decide the RTC behavioral during Freeze mode.
0 RTC run during freeze mode.
1 RTC stop during freeze mode.
1
CALS
RTC Calibration Clock Selection— The read/write bit enables the clock calibration source selection.
0 RTCCLK is output to CALCLK.
1 1HZ compensation clock is output to CALCLK.
76543210
R0 0
HRIE MINIE SECIE COMPIE
0
TB0IE
W
Reset:00000000
Figure 18-5. RTC Control Register 4 (RTCCTL4)
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
646 Freescale Semiconductor
18.4.5 RTC Status Register 1 (RTCS1)
The RTCS1 status register contains six interrupt status flags. When a flag is set and the corresponding
interrupt enable bit is also set, a CPU interrupt request is generated.
Table 18-6. RTCCTL4 Field Descriptions
Field Description
5
HRIE
Hour Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables hour interrupts. If HRIE is set, then an interrupt is
generated when HRF is set.
0 Hour interrupt request is disabled.
1 Hour interrupt request is enabled.
4
MINIE
Minute Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables minute interrupts. If MINIE is set, then an interrupt is
generated when MINF is set.
0 Minute interrupt request is disabled.
1 Minute interrupt request is enabled.
3
SECIE
Second Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables second interrupts. If SECIE is set, then an interrupt is
generated when SECF is set.
0 Second interrupt request is disabled.
1 Second interrupt request is enabled.
2
COMPIE
Compensation cycle Interru pt Enable — This read/write bit enables compensation cycle interrupts. If
COMPIE is set, then an interrupt is generated when COMPF is set.
0 Compensation cycle interrupt request is disabled.
1 Compensation cycle interrupt request is enabled.
0
TB0IE
4 HZ Time Tick interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables 4 Hz time ticket interrupt. If TB0IE is set, then
an interrupt is generated when TB0IF is set.
0 4 Hz time ticket interrupt request is disabled.
1 4 Hz time ticket interrupt request is enabled.
76543210
R CDLC 0
HRF MINF SECF COMPF
0
TB0F
W
Reset:00000000
Figure 18-6. RTC Status and Control Register1 (RTCSC1 )
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 647
18.4.6 RTC Compensation Configure Register (RTCCCR)
This register includes the CCS and Q value for free run 16-bit counter match times with M and M+1
modulo value during compensation.See compensation function section for detail.
Table 18-7. RTCS1 Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CDLC
Compensation Data Load Cycle — This status bit is set automatically when compensation circuit start load
RTCMOD and RTCCCR to internal buffered register and cleared automatically when finished. If this bit is set,
write to RTCMOD and RTCCCR is blocked. Write to this bit has no effect.
0 write to RTCMOD or RTCCCR is allowed.
1 write to RTCMOD and RTCCR is blocked.
5
HRF
Hour Flag — This status bit is set on every increment of the hour counter. When the HRIE bit is set, HRF
generates a CPU interrupt request. Writing a logic 0 has no effect. Writing a logic 1 clears the bit and the hour
interrupt request. Reset clears HRF to 0.
0 No hour counter increment.
1 Hour counter increment.
4
MINF
Minute Flag This status bit is set on every increment of the minute counter. When the MINIE bit is set, MINF
generates a CPU interrupt request. Writing a logic 0 has no effect. Writing a logic 1 clears the bit and the minute
interrupt request. Reset clears MINF to 0.
0 No minute counter increment.
1 Minute counter increment.
3
SECF
Second Flag — This status bit is set on every increment of the second counter. When the SECIE bit is set,
SECF generates a CPU interrupt request. Writing a logic 0 has no effect. Writing a logic 1 clears the bit and the
second interrupt request. Reset clears SECF to 0.
0 No second counter increment.
1 Second counter increment.
2
COMPF
Compensation cycle Flag — This status bit is set on every last second of compensation cycle. When the
COMPIE bit is set, COMPF generates a CPU interrupt request. Writing a logic 0 has no effect. Writing a logic 1
clears the bit and the time base interrupt request. Reset clears COMPF to 0.
0 No Compensation cycle has occurred.
1 A compensation cycle has occurred.
0
TB0F
4 Hz time tick Flag This status bit is set on every 4 Hz time ticket. When the TB0IE bit is set, TB0F generates
a CPU interrupt request. Writing a logic 0 has no effect. Writing a logic 1 clears the bit and the time base interrupt
request. Reset clears TB0F to 0.
0 No 4 Hz time tick has occurred.
1 A 4 Hz time tick has occurred.
76543210
R
CCS Q
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-7. RTC Compensation Configure Register (RTCCCR)
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
648 Freescale Semiconductor
18.4.7 RTC Counter Register (RTCCNT)
RTCCNT is the read-only value of the current RTC count of the 16-bit counter.
Table 18-8. RTCCCR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7:6
CCS
Compensation cycle selection — When the clock compensation mechanism enabled, It will decide the
compensation cycle.
00 -- 5 second compensation cycle
01 -- 15 second compensation cycle
10 -- 30 second compensation cycle
11 -- 60 second compensation cycle
5:0
Q
16-bit Counter Matches with M+1 Modulo Value Times — When the clock compensation mechanism
enabled, the free run timer counter matches with M+1 modulo value which set in RTC modulo register
(RTCMOD) Q times first, then matches with M modulo value with reset compensation cycle time. When Q is 0,
free run timer counter matches with M+1 modulo value do not happen. Refer to Section Table 18-14., “the CCS,
precision and Q value”
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RRTCCNTH
W
POR:00000000
76543210
RRTCCNTL
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-8. RTC Counter Register (RTCCNT)
Table 18-9. RTCCNT Field Description
Field Description
15:0
RTCCNT
RTC Count— These sixteen read-only bits contain the current value of the 16-bit counter. Writes have no effect
to this register. Reset will clear the count to 0x0000. Note, the RTCCNT is not synced, so user need to read register
two times to justify if value is correct, two read data same means the correct read data.
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 649
18.4.8 RTC Modulo Register (RTCMOD)
RTCMOD is the 16-bit modulo value.
18.4.9 RTC Second Register (RTCSECR)
This read/write register contains the current value of the second counter. This register can be read at any
time without affecting the c ounter count. W riting to this register loads the value to the second counter and
the counter continues to count from this new value.Writing values other than 0 to 59 to this register has
no effect. This register is write-protected, writing this register should follow write-protect mechanism
section.
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
R
RTCMODH
W
POR:00000000
76543210
R
RTCMODL
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-9. RTC Modulo Register (RTCMOD)
Table 18-10. RTCMOD Field Descriptions
Field Description
15:0
RTCMOD
RTC Modulo — These sixteen read/write bits contain the modulo value used to reset the RTCCNT count to
0x0000. Reset sets the modulo to 0x0000.
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
650 Freescale Semiconductor
The second counter rolls over to 0 after reaching 59.
18.4.10 RTC Minute Register (RTCMINR)
This read/write register contains the current value of the minute counter. This register can be read at any
time without af fecting the counter count. W riting to this register loads the value to the minute counter and
the counter continues to count from this new value. Writing values other than 0 to 59 to this register has
no effect. This register is write-protected, writing this register should follow write-protect mechanism
section.
The second counter rolls over to 0 after reaching 59.
18.4.11 RTC Hour Register (RTCHRR)
This read/write register contains the current value of the hour counter. This register can be read at any
time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the hour counter and
the counter continues to count from this new value.Writing values other than 0 to 23 to this register has
no effect. This register is write-protected, writing this register should follow write-protect mechanism
section.
76543210
R0 0
SEC5 SEC4 SEC3 SEC2 SEC1 SEC0
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-10. Second Register (SECR)
Table 1 8-11. SECR Field Descriptions
Field Description
5:0
SEC5~SEC0
Second Counter Value — These read/write bits contains the current value of the second. 0 to 59 is valid.
Wirting the value other than 0 to 59 has no effect.
76543210
R0 0
MIN5 MIN4 MIN3 MIN2 MIN1 MIN0
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-11. Minute Register (MINR)
Table 18-12 . MI NR Fi el d De sc rip tio n s
Field Description
5:0
MIN5~MIN0
Minute Counter Value These read/write bits contains the current value of the minute. 0 to 59 is valid.Wirting
the value other than 0 to 59 has no effect.
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 651
The second counter rolls over to 0 after reaching 23.
18.5 Functional Description
The RTC module support calendar functions. It includes a main 16-bit up-counter with a 16-bit modulo
register. The module also contains software selectable interrupt logic and clock output for compensation
calibration.
The RTC module provides clock indications in seconds, minutes, hours. Reading the calendar registers
return the current time. W riting to these registers set the time, and the counters will continue to count from
the new settings.
18.5.1 RTC clock and reset behavior
Depending on the use case, the RTC clock can derived from OSCCLK or OSCCLK_32K. After power on
reset, the RTC clock is derived from OSCCLK. User should set the RTCPS and CLKSRC value before
enabling the RTCEN. If RTCCLK is from OSCCLK, the RTCPS value should be set to meet that the
prescaler clock frequency will be 1MHz. The 1MHz clock will follow by a 1/32 divider to generate a
31.25KHz clock, which will be used as R TC counter clock(R TCCNT clock input). In case the clock source
is OSCCLK, after reset, the main OSC will be disabled and must be enabled by setting the OSCE in CPMU
as soon as possible in order to have clock available for the RTC. If clock source is OSCCLK_32K,
software must wait the OSC startup time after power on reset before enabling the RTC. If 32K OSC is
enabled, it will be always on until a power on reset happens.
18.5.2 Calendar Functions
Calendar functions are provided by the second, minute and hour count registers. The second, minute and
hour counters are able to generate interrupts on every count increment, providing periodic interrupts for
the second (RTCSECF), minute (RTCMINF) and hour (RTCHRF). A CPU interrupt request is generated
if the corresponding enable bit (SECIE, MINIE and HRIE) is also set.
18.5.3 Interrupts
In addition to the second, minute and hour periodic interrupts generated by the clock functions, the
76543210
R0 0 0
HR4 HR3 HR2 HR1 HR0
W
POR:00000000
Figure 18-12. Hour Register (HRR)
Table 18-13. HRR Field Descriptions
Field Description
4:0
HR4~HR0
Hour Counter Value These read/write bits contains the current value of the hour. 0 to 23 is valid.Wirting the
value other than 0 to 23 has no effect.
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
652 Freescale Semiconductor
divider circuits generates compensation cycle periodic interrupt and 4 Hz periodic interrupt. Depend on
the CCS setting, the cycle period can be 5, 15, 30, 60 seconds. The COMPIE bit in the RTC control regis-
ter 4(RTCCTL4) can enable compensation cycle interrupt. When the compensation logic start at the last
second compensation cycle, it will generate the interrupt. And user can calculate the next compensation
value and update these registers.
When a 4 Hz time base tick happens, it indicated by TB0F flags. And a CPU interrupt request is gener-
ated if the corresponding interrupt enable is also set.
18.5.4 RTC Clock Compensation
The RTC module is built with compensation circuit. The circuit is used to compensate frequency errors of
the input RTC clock, so that a more accurate 1-Hz R TC clock output ca n be achieved. Using this method,
it is possible to use a less expensive crystal. If the crystal tempera tur e profile and the current temperature
is known, the compensation circuit can also be used to compensate crystal frequency errors due to ambi-
ent temperature change and crystal aging.
The compensation logic use the RTCMOD, CCS and Q of RTCCCR to decide the free run timer counter.
User first need to decide the CCS, which determines the compensation precision. The larger CCS value,
higher the precision, longer the compensation period. During each compensation cycle, the free run timer
counter will first count RTCMOD+1 for Q times , then count R TCMOD for the “compensation peirod-Q”
times. Note if Q >= compensation period, it means that free run timer counter will count RTCMOD+1 for
“compensation period” times
The RTCMOD is the integral portion of actual frequency. Q value can be calculated base on
Section Table 18-14., “the CCS, precision and Q value”.
First example, if the RTC clock is from OSCCLK_32K and it has 2000PPM frequence drift due to the
crystal and temperature etc factors, the RTCCLK frequency will be 32833.536HZ. We set RTCMOD
value to 32833 first. The fraction value will be 0.536, and we can get CCS=0, Q=3 or CCS=1, Q=8 or
CCS=2, Q=16 or CCS=3, Q=32.
Second example, if the RTC clock is from OSCLK and it has -2000PPM frequence drift due to the crystal
Table 18-14. the CCS, precision and Q value
CCS Compensation
period (second) Compensatio n Precisio n Q
05
1/(2 * 5 * RTCMOD)(1)
1. the RTCCLK has only two possible input frequency, 31.25KHz or 32.768KHz. If RTCMOD value is set as requirement, user
can use 31250 or 32768 to replace the RTCMOD value here to easy the compensation precision calculation.
integer of ((fraction value+1/(2*5)) * 5)
1 15 1/(2 * 15 * RTCMOD)1integer of ((fraction value+1/(2*15)) * 15)
230
1/(2 * 30 * RTCMOD)1integer of ((fraction value+1/(2*30)) * 30)
360
1/(2 * 60 * RTCMOD)1integer of ((fraction value+1/(2*60)) * 60)
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 653
and temperature etc factors, the RTCPS is set to 15, the RTCCLK frequency will be 31187.5HZ. We set
RTCMOD value to 31187 first. The fraction value will be 0.5, and we can get CCS=0, Q=3 or CCS=1,
Q=8 or CCS=2, Q=15 or CCS=3, Q=30.
18.5.5 Calendar Register and Bit Write Protection
A write-protect mechanism is implemented to prevent accid ental writes to the RTC clock registers, calen-
dar registers, and other control bits. The protected RTC registers and bits are listed in below table
The mechanism uses the RTCWE[1:0] bits in the RTC control register 3(RTCCTL3) in a state machine,
which requires a bit-write sequence to disable the write-protection. A block diagram of the state machine
is shown in below Figure.
Table 18-15. Write-Protected RTC Registers and Bits
Register Bit
RTC Control Register 1(RTCCTL1) All Bits
Second Register(RTCSECR) All Bits
Minute Register(RTCMINR) All Bits
Hour Register(RTCHRR) All Bits
Write 01 to RTCWE
Write 10 to RTCWE
Write any value other than 10 to RTCWE
Write any value other than 11 to RTCWE
Write 11 to RTCWE
Write-Protect ENABLED
Write any value other
Write 00 to RTCWE
RTCW E = 11
RTCWE = 10
RESET
Write any value
other than 00
to RTWE
RTCWE = 00
RTCWE 0 1
Write any value
other than 10
to RTWE
than 01 to RTCWE
Write-Protect
DISABLED
Write 10 to RTCWE
Note: Reading RTCWE[1:0]
always return 00.
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
654 Freescale Semiconductor
After a reset, the write-pr otect mechanism is dis abled, allowing the user set the t ime and date in the calen-
dar registers.
18.5.6 Load buffer register
Compensation circuit and modulo circiuit using buffered register, those two register are loaded from
RTCCCR and RTCMOD only when compensation completed.Write to RTCMOD and RTCCCR is
blocked when CDLC=1, to protect data is stable when load occurs.
Figure 18-13. Buffered register load sequence and CDLC
18.6 Initialization/Application Information
18.6.1 RTC Calibration
18.6.1.1 ThRev. 1.05e off chip calibration
The RTC output clock (CALCLK) can be output on the RTC_CAL pin. User can measure the clcok
frequency directly. Refer to Device spec on how to enable the CALCLK on RTC_CAL pin.
18.6.1.2 The on chip calibration
The CALCLK signal can be routed to an internal timer channel for on-chip measurement. At same time,
user need feed one high precision 1 Hz clock to the other timer input pin. The calibration software can then
take simultaneous measurements of both signals using the input capture function of the timer to calculate
RTC CLK
SECF
COMPF
RTCMOD
RTCMOD_buf
CDLC
RTCEN
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 655
the variation in the RTC clock output and determine the correct calibration point. Refer to Device spec for
more information on timer channel connection.
18.6.2 RTC compensation
To reach the high precision RTC clock, the compensation need following steps.
Characterization of the OSCCLK or OSCCLK_32K crystal, get the lookup table for the crystal
frequency versus to temperature. This step is just required one time per crystal type.
Perform the RTC calibration at production for each device, get the base frequency offset.
Perform the RTC compensation periodically after enabling the RTC.
Measure the external temperature
Lookup compensation value in lookup table
Load the compensation value into RTC
Chapter 18 Real-Time Counter With Calendar (RTCV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
656 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 657
Chapter 19
Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
19.1 Introduction
This document describes the Simple Sound Generator module.
The SSG module generates audio frequency tone with autonomous amplitude control.
Refer to Figure 19-1 for the detailed block diagram of the module.
19.1.1 Features
The SSG block includes these distinctive features:
Programmable amplitude level encoded with 11 bit resolution from zero amplitude to max
amplitude
Sound STOP function to stop sound generation immediately
Registers double-buffered synchronously reload at edge of tone to avoid distortion of output tone
Interrupt generates when SSG is ready to configure new sound data
Input clock prescaler with 11 bit resolution
Module disable for power saving when not in use
Separate or mixed frequency and amplitude outputs for flexibility in external hardware variations
Attack/decay function which can increase/decrease sound amplitude automatically without CPU
interaction, including linear, gong and exponential attack/decay operation
19.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 19-1 shows the block diagram for SSG block.
Table 19-1. Revision History
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Ch anges
V1.0 Apr. 20, 2011 All Initial revision of Sound Generator Module.
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
658 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 19-1. SSG Block Diagram
19.2 External Signal Description
19.2.1 SGT
Tone output signal of SSG, which can be a single output tone signal or a tone combined with amplitude
encoding.
SGT
SGA
prescaler
counter
SSGPS_B
SSGAMP_B
attack/decay
logic
SSGTONE_B
tone
counter
amplitude
logic
tone duration
counter
SSGDUR_B
mix
bus clock
OMS
SSGAA_B
SSGADC_B
speaker
external circuit
NOTE: XXX_B is the buffer register of relevant XXX register
SSGIF SSGE
STP
Amplifier
The external circuit diagram is just for the OMS=0 case
1
0
External amplifier is required due to the limited driving capability of SGT pad
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 659
19.2.2 SGA
Encoded amplitude output signal of SSG.
19.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
19.3.1 Module Memory Map
This section describes the content of the registers in the SSG module. The base address of the SSG module
is determined at the MCU level when the MCU is defined. The register decode map is fixed and begins at
the first address of the module address offset. The figure below shows the registers associated with the
SSG and their relative offset from the base address. The register detail description follows the order they
appear in the register map.
Reserved bits within a register will always read as 0 and the write will be unimplemented. Unimplemented
functions are indicated by shading the bit.
NOTE
Register Address = Base Address + Address Offset, where the Base Address
is defined at the MCU level and the Address Of fset is defined at the module
level.
19.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes in detail all the registers and register bits in the SSG module.
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
SSGCR
RSSGE 0000
OMS RDR STP
W
0x0001
SSGADC
RADE 0000 ADM[1:0] ADS
W
0x0002
SSGPSH
R00000
PS10 PS9 PS8
W
0x0003
SSGPSL
RPS7 PS6 PS5 PS4 PS3 PS2 PS1 PS0
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 19-2. The SSG Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3)
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
660 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0004
SSGTONEH
R000000
TONE9 TONE8
W
0x0005
SSGTONEL
RTONE7 TONE6 TONE5 TONE4 TONE3 TONE2 TONE1 TONE0
W
0x0006
SSGAMPH
R00000
AMP10 AMP9 AMP8
W
0x0007
SSGAMPL
RAMP7 AMP6 AMP5 AMP4 AMP3 AMP2 AMP1 AMP0
W
0x0008
SSGAAH
R00000
AA10 AA9 AA8
W
0x0009
SSGAAL
R AA7 AA6 AA5 AA4 AA3 AA2 AA1 AA0
W
0x000A
SSGATH
R00000
AT 10 AT 9 AT 8
W
0x000B
SSGATL
R AT 7 AT 6 AT5 AT 4 AT 3 AT2 AT 1 AT 0
W
0x000C
SSGDUR
RDUR7 DUR6 DUR5 DUR4 DUR3 DUR2 DUR1 DUR0
W
0x000D
SSGIE
R0000000
RNDIE
W
0x000E
SSGIF
R0000000
RNDI
W
0x000F
RESERVED
R00000000
W
0x0010
SSGAMPBH
R 0 0 0 0 0 AMPB10 AMPB9 AMPB8
W
0x0011
SSGAMPBL
R AMPB7 AMPB6 AMPB5 AMPB4 AMPB3 AMPB2 AMP1 AMPB0
W
0x0012
SSGDCNT
R DCNT7 DCNT6 DCNT5 DCNT4 DCNT3 DCNT2 DCNT1 DCNT0
W
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 19-2. The SSG Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3)
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 661
19.3.2.1 SSG Control Register (SSGCR)
The control register SSGCR contains bits to control module enable, SSG stop control, register data ready
status and the SGT output mode selection.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
0x0013
RESERVED
R00000000
W
0x0014
RESERVED
R00000000
W
0x0015
RESERVED
R00000000
W
0x0016
RESERVED
R00000000
W
0x0017
RESERVED
R00000000
W
Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
RSSGE 0000
OMS RDR STP
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-3. SSG Control Register (SSGCR)
Table 19-2. SSGCR Fi el d De sc ripti on s
Field Description
7
SSGE
SSG Enable
0 SSG is disabled. All counters will be reset to 0, input clock will be gated.
1 SSG is enabled.
2
OMS
SSG Output Mode Selection
0 SGT output tone mixed with amplitude.
1 SGT output tone solely.
Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 19-2. The SSG Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3)
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
662 Freescale Semiconductor
19.3.2.2 SSG attack/decay control register (SSGADC)
SSGADC control the attack/decay enable and attack/decay function selection.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
1
RDR
SSG Register Data Ready —
This bit indicates whether the registers data are ready to reload into the relative buffer registers. Writing any of
SSGPS/SSGTONE/SSGAMP/SSGDUR/SSGAA/SSGAT/SSGADC will clear this bit. User should write 1 to this
bit if registers setting has been done. Writing 0 to this bit will stop the SSG when the synchronous reload event
occurs.
0 Register data is not ready to load into buffer register.
1 Register data is ready to load into buffer register.
0
STP
SSG STOP
0 SSG runs normally.
1 Immediately stop SSG.
Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
RADE 0000 ADM[1:0] ADS
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-4. SSG attack/decay control register (SSGADC)
Table 19-3. SSGADC Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
ADE
SSG attack/decay enable
0 SSG attack/decay function disabled.
1 SSG attack/decay function enabled.
2 - 1
ADM[1:0]
SSG Linear, Gong or Exponential attack/decay Selection.
refer to Section 19.4.3, “SSG Attack and Decay function for detail.
00 Select linear attack/decay operation.
01 Select gong attack/decay operation.
10 Select exponential attack/decay operation.
11 Reserved.
0
ADS
SSG Decay or attack Selection
0 Select amplitude attack function.
1 Select amplitude decay function.
Table 19-2. SSGCR Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 663
19.3.2.3 SSG Clock Prescaler Register (SSGPS)
SSGPS is a 11 bit prescaler register. For the 32MHz input bus clock source, the frequency range of
encoding amplitude waveform is from 15.625KHz to 125KHz, so the divided clock frequency is as
Table 19-5.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
R00000
PS10 PS9 PS8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-5. SSG Clock Prescaler Register (SSGPSH)
Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
RPS7 PS6 PS5 PS4 PS3 PS2 PS1 PS0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-6. SSG Clock Prescaler Register (SSGPSL)
Table 19-4. SSGPS Field Descriptions
Field Description
10–0
PS[10:0]
SSG Clock Prescaler Register Bits —
The input clock will be divided by SSGPS+1. This divided signal will be used as tone counter clock. Also it will
decide the amplitude of the PWM cycle period.
Table 19-5. Prescaler Clock Divider
Divided Clock Frequency From
32MHz Clock Sour ce Divide Ratio SSGPS[10:0]
125KHz 256 0xFF
124.514KHz 257 0x100
124.031KHz 258 0x101
123.552KHz~15.633KHz 259~2047 0x102~0x7FE
15.625KHz 2048 0x7FF
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
664 Freescale Semiconductor
19.3.2.4 SSG Tone Register (SSGTONE)
SSGTONE is SSG tone register. The tone frequency range is between 100Hz to 8KHz. Refer to Table 19-
7 for the tone frequency divide ratio and possible tone frequency.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
R000000
TONE9 TONE8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-7. SSG Tone Register (SSGTONEH)
Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
RTONE7 TONE6 TONE5 TONE4 TONE3 TONE2 TONE1 TONE0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-8. SSG Tone Register (SSGTONEL)
Table 19-6. SSGPS Field Descriptions
Field Description
9–0
TONE[9:0]
SSG Tone Register Bits
The tone frequency is equal to prescaler clock / (2*(SSGTONE+1)).
Table 19-7. Tone Frequency configuration
Prescaler Clock
Frequency Tone Frequency
Range SSGTONE[9:0] Adjacent Tone
Frequency Ga p
Range
15KHz 100Hz~7.5KHz 0x4A~0x0 1.351Hz~3750Hz
30KHz 100Hz~7.5KHz 0x95~0x1 0.671Hz~2500Hz
60KHz 100Hz~7.5KHz 0x12B~0x3 0.334Hz~1500Hz
90KHz 100Hz~7.5KHz 0x1C1~0x5 0.223~1072Hz
125KHz 100Hz~7.813KHz 0x270~0x7 0.16Hz~1115Hz
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 665
19.3.2.5 SSG Amplitude Register (SSGAMP)
SSGAMP register contains amplitude duty.
s
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
NOTE
due to algorithm reason, in gong attack operation mode, amplitude should
not be set to 0, otherwise amplitude will always be 0 and gong attack
operation will never end.
19.3.2.6 SSG Amplitude Adjustment (SSGAA)
The SSGAA is amplitude adjustment register.
Module Base + 0x0006
76543210
R00000
AMP10 AMP9 AMP8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-9. SSG amplitude Register (SSGAMPH)
Module Base + 0x0007
76543210
RAMP7 AMP6 AMP5 AMP4 AMP3 AMP2 AMP1 AMP0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-10. SSG amplitude Register (SSGAMPL)
Table 19-8. SSGAMP Field Descriptions
Field Description
10–0
AMP[10:0]
SSG Amplitude Register Bits —
Amplitude duty cycle is SSGAMP/(SSGPS+1). When SSGAMP >= SSGPS+1, duty cycle will be 100%.
Module Base + 0x0008
76543210
R00000
AA10 AA9 AA8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-11. SSG Amplitude Adjustment (SSGAAH)
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
666 Freescale Semiconductor
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
19.3.2.7 SSG Amplitude Threshold Register (SSGAT)
SSGAT contains the amplitude threshold.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0009
76543210
RAA7 AA6 AA5 AA4 AA3 AA2 AA1 AA0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-12. SSG Amplitude Adjustment (SSGAAL)
Table 19-9. SSGAA Fi el d De sc ripti on s
Field Description
10–0
AA[10:0]
SSG Amplitude Adjustment Register Bits —
The bits define the amplitude adjustment value in each linear attack/decay operation. The register is only used
when linear attack/decay is selected.
Module Base + 0x000A
76543210
R00000
AT10 AT9 AT8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-13. SSG Amplitude Threshold (SSGATH)
Module Base + 0x000B
76543210
RAT7AT6AT5AT4AT3AT2AT1AT0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-14. SSG Amplitude Threshold (SSGATL)
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 667
19.3.2.8 SSG Tone Duration register (SSGDUR)
The SSGDUR register defines the number of tone cycle in one tone duration. The tone cycle number in
one duration is SSGDUR + 1.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
19.3.2.9 SSG Interrupt Enable (SSGIE)
The SSGIE controls the enable of the interrupt.
Table 19-10 . SSGAT Fi el d De sc rip tio n s
Field Description
10–0
AT[10:0]
SSG Amplitude Threshold Register Bits —
When the amplitude >= SSGAT (attack) or amplitude <=SSGAT (decay), an interrupt will be triggered.
Module Base + 0x000C
76543210
RDUR7 DUR6 DUR5 DUR4 DUR3 DUR2 DUR1 DUR0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-15. SSG Tone Duration Register (SSGDUR)
Table 1 9-11. SSGDUR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7–0
DUR[7:0]
SSG Tone Duration Register bits —
These bits defines the number of tone cycle. The tone number in one duration is SSGDUR + 1.
In attack/decay mode, when tone duration counter reach the SSGDUR + 1, amplitude will increase/decrease by
SSGAA.
In non-attack/decay mode, when tone duration counter reach the SSGDUR + 1, config registers will reload if
RDR of SSGCR is 1, or SSG will stop if RDR of SSGCR is 0.
Module Base + 0x000D
76543210
R0000000
RNDIE
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-16. SSG Interrupt Enable Register (SSGIE)
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
668 Freescale Semiconductor
19.3.2.10 SSG Interrupt Flag Registers (SSG IF)
The SSGIF is the Interrupt flag.
19.3.2.11 Buffer Register of SSGAMP (SSGAMPB)
The SSGAMPB is the buffer register of SSGAMP. It determines amplitude directly.
Table 19-12. SSGIE Field Descriptions
Field Description
0
RNDIE
SSG Ready for Next Sound Data Interrupt Enable —
Make the interrupt flag bit RNDI can be set when next sound data is ready to config registers.
0 The interrupt signal will not be set when SSGIF is set.
1 The interrupt signal will be set when SSGIF is set.
Module Base + 0x000E
76543210
R0000000
RNDI
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-17. SSG Interrupt Flag Register (SSGIF)
Table 19-13 . SSGIF Fiel d De sc rip ti on s
Field Description
0
RNDI
SSG Ready for Next Sound Data Interrupt —
The interrupt flag will be set in two cases: one is when the current sound configuration data is loaded into internal
buffer registers, after the flag is set, user can configure the registers for the next sound data. RNDI will get set
as well when the reload time is reached and RDR is cleared. Writing 1 to this bit will clear the flag bit, writing 0
has no effect on this bit. The details of internal registers loading refer to Section 19.4.5, “Register Reload.
0 The SSG is not ready to config the next sound data.
1 The SSG is ready to config the next sound data.
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 669
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
19.3.2.12 SSG Tone Duration Counter (SSGDCNT)
The SSGDCNT is tone duration counter which contains tone cycle number. It is triggered by the negedge
of tone signal.
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x0010
76543210
R 0 0 0 0 0 AMPB10 AMPB9 AMPB8
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-18. Buffer Register of SSGAMP (SSGAMPBH)
Module Base + 0x0011
76543210
R AMPB7 AMPB6 AMPB5 AMPB4 AMPB3 AMPB2 AMPB1 AMPB0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-19. Buffer Register of SSGAMP (SSGAMPBL)
Table 19-14. SSGAMPB Field Descriptions
Field Description
10–0
AMPB[10:0]
SSGAMPB Bits —
The register is read only. In reload time the SSGAMP will be copied to the SSGAMPB. If attack/decay function
is enabled, the SSGAMPB will do decay or attack operation automatically leaving the SSGAMP unchanged. The
SSGAMPB determines the amplitude directly and finally.
Module Base + 0x0012
76543210
R DCNT7 DCNT6 DCNT5 DCNT4 DCNT3 DCNT2 DCNT1 DCNT0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 19-20. SSG Tone Duration Counter (SSGDCNT)
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
670 Freescale Semiconductor
19.4 Functional Description
19.4.1 SSG Amplitude Generation
The SSG sound amplitude is presented as the duty cycle of PWM signal. The prescaler signal period is the
period of the PWM and the amplitude register SSGAMP contains the duty, the amplitude duty cycle is
SSGAMP/(SSGPS+1), when SSGAMP>=SSGPS+1, it will be 100%. SSGAMP has a buffer register, so
changing the SSGAMP will not disturb the amplitude PWM waveform before the synchronous reload
takes place.
Figure 19-21. SSG Amplitude Generation
Table 19-15. SSGDCNT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7–0
DCNT[7:0]
SSG Tone Duration Counter bits —
The counter register is read only, It contains the tone cycle number. The counter will be reset to 0 when it reaches
the SSGDUR value. In any SSG stop case, the counter will also be reset to 0.
SSGAMP
SSGPS + 1
(x clock period)
(x clock period)
......
......
A-1
P-1 P0 1 2 A-1 P0123
......
...... ......
...... ......
......
210
bus clock
RDR
amplitude PWM
A is value of SSGAMP buffer
where : RDR is the RDR bit of SSGCR
Pcounter is the prescaler counter
Pcounter
P is the value of SSGPS buffer
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 671
19.4.2 SSG Tone Generation
The tone is a low frequency square waveform. Tone generation logic consists of a tone counter triggered
by prescaler signal and the tone period register SSGTONE with its buffer register . The register SSGTONE
contains the coefficient value of half tone period, one tone cycle peri od = 2 x (SSGTO NE + 1) x prescaler
cycle. The tone signal is also used as one of the synchronous reload signal.
Figure 19-22. SSG Tone Generation
19.4.3 SSG Attack and Decay function
In SSG the value hold in the amplitude buffer register can be automatically increased or decreased. The
amplitude increase implements sound volume attack and the amplitude decrease implements sound
volume decay. If ADS is cleared while the ADE is set, attack function will be enabled, if the ADS is set
while ADE is set, decay function will be enabled. If ADE is cleared, attack/decay function will be disabled.
The attack/decay function implements sound volume automatic increase/decrease with a small number of
CPU interventions.
Attack/decay function includes linear operation, gong operation and exponential operation.
SSGTONE SSGTONE + 1
(x prescaler period) (x prescaler period)
+ 1
...... 012 0 12210
RDR
T is value of SSGTONE buffer
where : RDR is the RDR bit of SSGCR
Tcounter is the tone counter
T T T 0123
......
......
......
prescaler clock
Tcounter
Tone
Amplitude PWM
......
......
......
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
672 Freescale Semiconductor
In linear attack operation SSGAMPB (SSGAMP’s buffer) will be increased by SSGAA every
SSGSSGDUR + 1 tone cycle. In linear decay operation, SSGAMPB will be decreased by SSGAA
every SSGDUR + 1 tone cycle. See below linear attack/decay formula.
In gong attack operation SSGAMPB will be increased by SSGAMPB/32 every SSGDUR + 1 tone
cycle. In gong decay operation SSGAMPB will be decreased by SSGAMPB/32 every SSGDUR +
1 tone cycle. See below gong attack/decay formula.
In exponential attack operation SSGAMPB will multiply with 2 then add 1 every SSGDUR + 1
tone cycle. In exponential decay operation, SSGAMPB will be divided by 2 every SSGDUR + 1
tone cycle. See below exponential attack/decay formula.
Linear attack operation:
do{
SSGAMPB = SSGAMPB + SSGAA_buf;
} While (SSGAMPB < AT_buf)
Where : AT_buf is the internal buffer of amplitude threshold register SSGAT.
SSGAMPB = SSGAMP;
Linear decay operation:
Where : AT_buf is the internal buffer of amplitude threshold register SSGAT.
} While (SSGAMPB > AT_buf)
SSGAMPB = SSGAMPB - SSGAA_buf;
do{
SSGAMPB = SSGAMP;
SSGAA_buf is the internal buffer of SSGAA.
SSGAA_buf is the internal buffer of SSGAA.
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 673
Gong attack operation:
AMP_int = {SSGAMPB, 5’b00000};
do{ AMP_int = AMP_int + (AMP_int >> 5);
SSGAMPB = AMP_int >> 5;
} While (SSGAMPB < AT_buf)
AT_buf is the internal buffer of amplitude threshold register SSGAT.
where : AMP_int is a 16 bit internal register.
SSGAMPB = SSGAMP;
Gong decay operation:
AMP_int = {SSGAMPB, 5’b11111};
SSGAMPB = SSGAMP;
do{AMP_int = AMP_int - (AMP_int >> 5);
SSGAMPB = AMP_int >> 5;
} While (SSGAMPB > AT_buf)
AT_buf is the internal buffer of amplitude threshold register SSGAT.
where : AMP_int is a 16 bit internal register.
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
674 Freescale Semiconductor
19.4.4 SSG Start and Stop
To start SSG, user should set SSGE of SSGCR and config all registers, then set the RDR of SSGCR, the
SSG will start to work.
In run time, when the STP of SSGCR is set, the SSG will stop immediately, all counters will be cleared
(reset to 0). When STP of SSGCR is cleared, SSG will restart if RDR is set. Same for the SSGE of SSGCR,
when clear the SSGE, the SSG will stop immediately, all counters will be cleared (reset to 0). when the
SSGE is set, SSG will restart if RDR is set. Clear the SSGE will disable the SGA and SGT output, so it is
not recommend to use SSGE to stop the SSG.
The RDR of SSGCR can also stop the SSG, when reload occurs while the RDR is cleared, SSG will stop
with all counters cleared, and the interrupt flag (RNDI of SSGIF) will be set. When the RDR is set again,
the SSG will restart. Refer to Figure 19-23 and Figure 19-24.
Exponential attack operation:
SSGAMPB = SSGAMP;
do {
SSGAMPB = SSGAMPB << 1 + 1;
} while (SSGAMPB < AT_buf)
Where : AT_buf is the internal buffer of amplitude threshold register SSGAT.
SSGAMPB = SSGAMP;
do { SSGAMPB = SSGAMPB >> 1;
} while (SSGAMPB > AT_buf)
Where : AT_buf is the internal buffer of amplitude threshold register SSGAT.
Exponential decay operation:
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 675
19.4.5 Register Reload
In SSG all registers except SSGCR, SSGIE and SSGIF are double buffered. the value will be reloaded
from config registers to their buf fers in three cases: one is when SSG startup (or restart), the other two are
attack/decay mode register reload and non-attack/decay mode register reload. Details as below:
When at SSG start/restart time , if the SSGCR’s RDR is set, data in config registers will be loaded
into the internal registers buffers, and the interrupt flag (RNDI of SSGIF) will be set.
In attack/decay mode, when amplitude (in SSGAMP) reaches the SSGAT value and the SSGCR’ s
RDR is set, all register will reload to their buffer registers, and the interrupt flag (RNDI of SSGIF)
will be set. Refer to Figure 19-23.
In non-attack/decay mode, when one tone duration completes and the SSGCR’s RDR is set, all
register will reload to their buffer registers, and the interrupt flag (RNDI of SSGIF) will be set.
Refer to Figure 19-24.
Figure 19-23. Attack/decay Mode Register Reload
reload point
Tone
duration
AMPB AMPB_1 AMPB_2 AMPB_T AMPB AMPB_1 AMPB_T AMPB AMPB_1
...... ......
......
......
RDR
SSG-
AMPB
reload and restart
stop point
where : Assume one tone duration contains 2 tone cycle
AMPB is the initial value reload from SSGAMP register
AMPB_x is the interim value of SSGAMPB in attack/decay operation
AMPB_T is the value of SSGAT buffer
RDR is the RDR bit of SSGCR register
Chapter 19 Simple Sound Generator (SSGV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
676 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 19-24. Non-attack/decay mode Regis ter Reload
19.4.6 SSG Output Control
There are two output signals, SGA and SGT. SGA outputs the sound amplitude while SGT can output tone
or tone mixed with amplitude. The SGT output selection is determined by OMS of SSGCR. When OMS
is cleared, the SGA output is disable, the SGA shared pins can be used as other function.
19.5 Interrupt
When the RNDI of SSGIF and RNDIE of SSGIE are all set, interrupt will be generated. Besides normal
reload interrupt, RNDI will be set when SSG start with RDR set, so the second configuration data can be
set base on reload interrupt.
duration
Tone
RDR
reload point stop point reload and restart
where : Assume one tone duration contains 3 tone cycle
RDR is the RDR bit of SSGCR register
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 677
Chapter 20
ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
20.1 Introduction
The purpose of ECC logic is to detect and correct as much as possible memory data bit er rors. These soft
errors can occur randomly during operation, mainly generated by alpha radiation. Soft Error means, that
only the information inside the memory cell is corrupt, the memory cell itself is not damaged. A write
access with correct data solves the issue. If the ECC algorithm is able to correct the data, then the sy stem
can use this corrected data without any issues. If the ECC algorithm is able to detect, but not correct the
error, then the system is able to ignore the memory read data to avoid system malfunction.
The ECC value is calculated based on an aligned 2 byte memory data word. The ECC algorithm is able to
detect and correct single bit ECC errors. Double bit ECC errors will be detected but the system is not able
to correct these errors. This kind of ECC code is called SECDED code. This ECC code requires 6
additional parity bits for each 2 byte data word.
20.1.1 Features
The SRAM_ECC module provides the ECC logic for the system memory based on a SECDED algorithm.
Main features of the SRAM_ECC module:
SECDED ECC code
single bit error detection and correction per 2 byte data word
double bit error detection per 2 byte data word
memory initialization function
byte wide system memory write access
automatic single bit ECC error correction for read and write accesses
debug logic to read and write raw use data and ECC values
20.2 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all memory and registers for the SRAM_ECC module.
20.2.1 Register Summary
Figure 20-1 shows the summary of all implemented registers inside the SRAM_ECC module.
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
678 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
Register Address = Module Base Address + Address Offset, where the
Module Base Address is defined at the MCU level and the Address Offset
is defined at the module level.
Figure 20-1. SRAM_ECC Register Summary
Address Offset
Register Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
ECCSTAT
R0000000RDY
W
0x0001
ECCIE
R0000000
SBEEIE
W
0x0002
ECCIF
R0000000
SBEEIF
W
0x0003 - 0x0006
Reserved
R00000000
W
0x0007
ECCDPTRH
RDPTR[23:16]
W
0x0008
ECCDPTRM
RDPTR[15:8]
W
0x0009
ECCDPTRL
RDPTR[7:1] 0
W
0x000A - 0x000B
Reserved
R00000000
W
0x000C
ECCDDH
RDDATA[15:8]
W
0x000D
ECCDDL
RDDATA[7:0]
W
0x000E
ECCDE
R0 0 DECC[5:0]
W
0x000F
ECCDCMD
RECCDRR 00000
ECCDW ECCDR
W
= Unimplemented, Reserved, Read as zero
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 679
20.2.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order . Each description includes a standard register
diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field functions follow the register
diagrams, in bit order.
20.2.2.1 ECC Status Register (ECCSTAT)
Figure 20-2. ECC Status Register (ECCSTAT)
Table 20-2. ECCSTAT Field Description
20.2.2.2 ECC Interrupt Enable Register (ECCIE)
Figure 20-3. ECC Interrupt Enable Register (ECCIE)
Table 20-3. ECCIE Field Description
Module Base + 0x00000 Access: User read only(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Never
765432 1 0
R0000 0 0 0 RDY
W
Reset0000000 0
Field Description
0
RDY
ECC Ready— Shows the status of the ECC module.
0 Internal SRAM initialization is ongoing, access to the SRAM is disabled
1 Internal SRAM initialization is done, access to the SRAM is enabled
Module Base + 0x00001 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
765432 1 0
R0000000
SBEEIE
W
Reset0000000 0
Field Description
0
SBEEIE
Single bit ECC Error Interrupt Enable — Enables Single ECC Error interrupt.
0 Interrupt request is disabled
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever SBEEIF is set
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
680 Freescale Semiconductor
20.2.2.3 ECC Interrupt Flag Register (ECCIF)
Figure 20-4. ECC Interrupt Flag Register (ECCIF)
Table 20-4. ECCIF Field Description
Module Base + 0x0002 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime, write 1 to clear
765432 1 0
R0000000
SBEEIF
W
Reset0000000 0
Field Description
0
SBEEIF
Single bit ECC Error Interrupt Flag — The flag is set to 1 when a single bit ECC error occurs.
0 No occurrences of single bit ECC error since the last clearing of the flag
1 Single bit ECC error occurs since the last clearing of the flag
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 681
20.2.2.4 ECC Debug Pointer Register (ECCDPTRH, ECCDPTRM,
ECCDPTRL)
Module Base + 0x0007 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
DPTR[23:16]
W
Reset00000000
Module Base + 0x0008 Access: User read/write
76543210
R
DPTR[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Module Base + 0x0009 Access: User read/write
76543210
R
DPTR[7:1]
0
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 20-5. ECC Debug Pointer Register (ECCDPTRH, ECCDPTRM, ECCDPTRL)
Table 20-5. ECCDPTR Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
DPTR
[23:0]
ECC Debug Pointer — This register contains the system memory address which will be used for a debug
access. Address bits not relevant for SRAM address space are not writeable, so the SW should read back the
pointer value to make sure the register contains the intended memory address. Anyway it is possible to write
an address value to this register which points outside the system memory. There is no additional monitoring of
the register content, therefore the SW must make sure that the address value points to the system memory
space.
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
682 Freescale Semiconductor
20.2.2.5 ECC Debug Data (ECCDDH, ECCDDL)
20.2.2.6 ECC Debug ECC (ECCDE)
Figure 20-7. ECC Debug ECC (ECCDE)
Table 20-7. ECCDE Field Description
Module Base + 0x000C Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R
DDATA[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Module Base + 0x000D Access: User read/write
76543210
R
DDATA[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 20-6. ECC Debug Data (ECCDDH, ECCDDL)
Table 20-6. ECCDD Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
DDATA
[23:0]
ECC Debug Raw Data — This register contains the raw data which will be written into the system memory
during a debug write command or the read data from the debug read command.
Module Base + 0x000E Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R 0 0
DECC[5:0]
W
Reset00000000
Field Description
5:0
DECC[5:0]
ECC Debug ECC — This register contains the raw ECC value which will be written into the system memory
during a debug write command or the ECC read value from the debug read command.
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 683
20.2.2.7 ECC Debug Command (ECCDCMD)
Figure 20-8. ECC Debug Command (ECCDCMD)
Table 20-8. ECCDCM D Fi el d De sc rip tion
20.3 Functional Description
The bus system allows 1, 2, 3 and 4 byte write access to a 4 byte aligned memory address, but the ECC
value is generated based on an aligned 2 byte data word. Depending on the access type, the access is
separated into different access cycles. Table 20-9 shows the different access types with the expected
number of access cycles and the performed internal operations.
Module Base + 0x000F Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime, in special mode only
76543210
R
ECCDRR
0 0 000
ECCDW ECCDR
W
Reset00000000
Field Description
7
ECCDRR
ECC Disable Read Repair Function— Write one to this register bit will disable the automatic single bit ECC
error repair function during read access, see also chapter 20.3.7, “ECC Debug Behavior”.
0 Automatic single ECC error repair function is enabled
1 Automatic single ECC error repair function is disabled
1
ECCDW
ECC Debug Write CommandWrite one to this register bit will perform a debug write access to the system
memory. During this access the debug data word (DDATA) and the debug ECC value (DECC) will be written to
the system memory address defined by DPTR. If the debug write access is done this bit is cleared. Writing 0 has
no effect. It is not possible to set this bit if the previous debug access is ongoing. (ECCDW or ECCDR bit set)
0
ECCDR
ECC Debug Read Command — Write one to this register bit will perform a debug read access from the system
memory address defined by DPTR. If the debug read access is done this bit is cleared and the raw memory read
data are available in register DDATA and the raw ECC value is available in register DECC. Writing 0 has no
effect. If the ECCDW and ECCDR bit are set at the same time, then only the ECCDW bit is set and the Debug
Write Command is performed. It is not possible to set this bit if the previous debug access is ongoing. (ECCDW
or ECCDR bit set)
Table 20-9. Memory access cycles
Access type ECC
error access
cycle Internal operation Memory
content Error indication
2 and 4 byte
aligned write
access
- 1 write to memory new data -
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
684 Freescale Semiconductor
The single bit ECC errors generates an interrupt when enabled. The double bit ECC errors are reported by
the SRAM_ECC module, but are handled outside by MCU level. For more information see MMC
description.
20.3.1 Aligned 2 and 4 Byte Memory write access
During an aligned 2 or 4 byte memory write access no ECC check is performed. The internal ECC logic
generates the new ECC value based on the write data and writes the data words together with the generated
ECC values into the memory.
20.3.2 Other Memory write access
Other types of write accesses are separated into read-modify-write operation. During the first cycle, the
logic reads the data from the memory and performs an ECC check. If no ECC errors was detected then the
logic generates the new ECC value based on the read and write data and writes the new data word together
with the new ECC value into the memory. If required both 2 byte data words are updated.
If the module detects a single bit ECC error during the read cycle, then the logic generates the new ECC
value based on the corrected read and new write read. In the next cycle new data word and the new ECC
value are written into the memory. If required both 2 byte data words are updated. The SBEEIF bit is set.
Hence the single bit ECC error was corrected by the write access. Figure 20-9 shows an example of a 2
byte non-aligned memory write access.
If the module detects a double bit ECC error during the read cycle, then the write access to the memory is
blocked and the initiator module is informed about the error.
1 or 3 byte write,
non-aligned 2
byte write
no 2 read data from the memory old + new
data -
write old + new data to the memory
single
bit 2
read data from the memory corrected +
new data SBEEIF
write corrected + new data to the
memory
double
bit 2read data from the memory unchanged initiator module is
informed
ignore write data
read access
no 1 read from memory unchanged -
single
bit 1(1) read data from the memory corrected
data SBEEIF
write corrected data back to memory
double
bit 1read from memory unchanged data mark as invalid
1. the next back to back read access to the memory will be delayed by one clock cycle
Table 20-9. Memory access cycles
Access type ECC
error access
cycle Internal operation Memory
content Error indication
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 685
.
Figure 20-9. 2 byte non-aligned write access
20.3.3 Memory read access
During each memory read access an ECC check is performed. If the logic detects a single bit ECC error
then the module corrects the data, so that the access initiator module receives correct data. In parallel, the
logic writes the corrected data back to the memory, so that this read access repairs the single bit ECC error.
This automatic ECC read repair function is disabled by setting the ECCDRR bit.
If a single bit ECC error was detected then the SBEEIF flag is set.
If the logic detects a double bit ECC error, then the data word is flagged as invalid, so that the access
initiator module can ignore the data.
20.3.4 Memory initialization
Memory operation which allows a read before a first write, like the read-modify-write operation of the un-
aligned access, requires that the memory contains valid ECC values before the first read-modify-write
access is performed to avoid spurious ECC error reporting. The ECC module provides logic to initialize
the complete memory content with zero during the power up phase. During the initialization process the
access to the SRAM is disabled and the RDY status bit is cleared. If the initialization process is done, the
SRAM access is possible and the RDY status bit is set.
20.3.5 Interrupt handl ing
This sections describes the interrupts generated by the SRAM_ECC module and their individual sources,
Vector addresses and interrupt priority are defined by MCU level.
ECC
2 byte use data
correct read data
read out data
and correct if
single bit ECC
error was found
write data
ECC
correct
read data write data
ECC
2 byte use data
correct read data
read out data
and correct if
single bit ECC
error was found
write data
ECC
correct
read data
write data 4 byte write data to system memory
4 byte read data from system memory
2 byte write data
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
686 Freescale Semiconductor
20.3.6 ECC Algorithm
The table below shows the equation for each ECC bit based on the 16 bit data word.
Table 20-11. ECC Calculation
20.3.7 ECC Debug Behavior
For debug purpose it is possible to read and write the uncorrected use data and the raw ECC value direct
from the memory. For these debug accesses a register interface is available. The debug access is performed
with the lowest priority, other memory accesses must be done before the debug access starts. If a debug
access is requested during a ongoing memory initialization process then the debug access is performed if
the memory initialization process is done.
If the ECCDRR bit is set then the automatic single bit ECC error repair function for all read accesses is
disabled. In this case a read access from a system memory location with single bit ECC error will produce
correct data and the single bit ECC error is flagged by the SBEEIF, but the data inside the system memory
are unchanged.
By writing wrong ECC values into the system memory the debug access can be used to force single and
double bit ECC errors to check the SW error handling.
It is not possible to set the ECCDW or ECCDR bit if the previous debug access is ongoing. (ECCDW or
ECCDR bit active) This makes sure that the ECCDD and ECCDE registers contains consistent data. The
SW should read out the status of the ECCDW and ECCDR register bit before a new debug access is
requested.
20.3.7.1 ECC Debug Memory Write Access
Writing one to the ECCDW bit performs a debug write access to the memory address defined by register
DPTR. During this access, the raw data DDATA and the ECC value DECC are written direct into the
system memory. If the debug write access is done the ECCDW register bit is cleared. The debug write
Table 20-10. SRAM_ECC Interrupt Sources
Module Interrupt Sources Local Enable
Single bit ECC error ECCIE[SBEEIE]
ECC bit Use data
ECC[0] ~ ( ^ ( data[15:0] & 0x443F ) )
ECC[1] ~ ( ^ ( data[15:0] & 0x13C7 ) )
ECC[2] ~ ( ^ ( data[15:0] & 0xE1D1 ) )
ECC[3] ~ ( ^ ( data[15:0] & 0xEE60 ) )
ECC[4] ~ ( ^ ( data[15:0] & 0x3E8A ) )
ECC[5] ~ ( ^ ( data[15:0] & 0x993C ) )
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 687
access is always a 2 byte aligned memory access, so that no ECC check is performed and no single or
double bit ECC error indication are activated.
20.3.7.2 ECC Debug Memory Read Access
W riting one to the ECCDR bit performs a debug read access from the memory address defined by register
DPTR. If the ECCDR bit is cleared then the register DDATA contains the uncorrected read data from the
memory. The register DECC contains the ECC value read from the memory . Independent of the ECCDRR
register bit setting, the debug read access will not perform an automatic ECC repair during read access.
During the debug read access no ECC check is performed, so that no single or double bit ECC error
indication are activated.
If the ECCDW and the ECCDR bits are set at the same time, then only the debug write access is performed.
Chapter 20 ECC Generation module (SRAM_ECCV1)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
688 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 689
Chapter 21
128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
Table 21-1. Revision History
Revision
Number Revision
Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Changes
V02.06 18 Mar 2013 - Standardized nomenclature in references to memory sizes
V02.07 24 May 2013 - Revised references to NVM Resource Area to improve readability
V02.08 12 Jun 2013 - Changed MLOADU Section 21.4.7.12 and MLOADF Section 21.4.7.13
FCCOB1 to FCCOB2
V02.09 19 Aug 2013 - Updated table of valid commands regarding Secured Special Singlechip
mode (Table 21-29)
- Updated text under Section 21.5.2
V02.10 16 Dec 2013 21.3.2.9
21.3.2.10
- Updated notes regarding restrictions to change Protection in Special Single
Chip Mode (SS)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 690
21.1 Introduction
The FTMRZ128K4K module implements the following:
128 KB of P-Flash (Program Flash) memory
4 KB of EEPROM memory
The Flash memory is ideal for single-supply applications allowing for field reprogramming without
requiring external high voltage sources for program or erase operations. The Flash module includes a
memory controller that executes commands to modify Flash memory contents. The user interface to the
memory controller consists of the indexed Flash Common Command Object (FCCOB) register which is
written to with the command, global address, data, and any required command parameters. The memory
controller must complete the execution of a command before the FCCOB register can be written to with a
new command.
CAUTION
A Flash word or phrase must be in the erased state before being
programmed. Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash word or
phrase is not allowed.
The Flash memory may be read as bytes and aligned words. Read access time is one bus cycle for bytes
and aligned words. For misaligned words access, the CPU has to perform twice the byte read access
command. For Flash memory, an erased bit reads 1 and a programmed bit reads 0.
It is possible to read from P-Flash memory while some commands are executing on EEPROM memory. It
is not possible to read from EEPROM memory while a command is executing on P-Flash memory.
Simultaneous P-Flash and EEPROM operations are discussed in Section 21.4.6.
Both P-Flash and EEPROM memories are implemented with Error Correction Codes (ECC) that can
resolve single bit faults and detect double bit faults. For P-Flash memory, the ECC implementation
requires that programming be done on an aligned 8 byte basis (a Flash phrase). Since P-Flash memory is
always read by half-phrase, only one single bit fault in an aligned 4 byte half-phrase containing the byte
or word accessed will be corrected.
21.1.1 Glossary
Command Write Sequence — An MCU instruction sequence to execute built-in algorithms (including
program and erase) on the Flash memory.
EEPROM Memory — The EEPROM memory constitutes the nonvolatile memory store for data.
EEPROM Sector — The EEPROM sector is the smallest portion of the EEPROM memory that can be
erased. The EEPROM sector consists of 4 bytes.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 691
NVM Command Mode — An NVM mode using the CPU to setup the FCCOB register to pass parameters
required for Flash command execution.
Phrase — An aligned group of four 16-bit words within the P-Flash memory. Each phrase includes two
sets of aligned double words with each set including 7 ECC bits for single bit fault correction and double
bit fault detection within each double word.
P-Flash Memory — The P-Flash memory constitutes the main nonvolatile memory store for applications.
P-Flash Sector — The P-Flash sector is the smallest portion of the P-Flash memory that can be erased.
Each P-Flash sector contains 512 bytes.
Program IFR — Nonvolatile information register located in the P-Flash block that contains the Version
ID, and the Program Once field.
21.1.2 Features
21.1.2.1 P-Flash Features
128 KB of P-Flash composed of one 128 KB Flash block divided into 256 sectors of 512 bytes
Single bit fault correction and double bit fault detection within a 32-bit double word during read
operations
Automated program and erase algorithm with verify and generation of ECC parity bits
Fast sector erase and phrase program operation
Ability to read the P-Flash memory while programming a word in the EEPROM memory
Flexible protection scheme to prevent accidental program or erase of P-Flash memory
21.1.2.2 EEPROM Features
4 KB of EEPROM memory composed of one 4 KB Flash block divided into 1024 sectors of 4 bytes
Single bit fault correction and double bit fault detection within a word during read operations
Automated program and erase algorithm with verify and generation of ECC parity bits
Fast sector erase and word program operation
Protection scheme to prevent accidental program or erase of EEPROM memory
Ability to program up to four words in a burst sequence
21.1.2.3 Other Flash Module Features
No external high-voltage power supply required for Flash memory program and erase operations
Interrupt generation on Flash command completion and Flash error detection
Security mechanism to prevent unauthorized access to the Flash memory
21.1.3 Block Diagram
The block diagram of the Flash module is shown in Figure 21-1.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
692 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 21-1. FTMRZ128K4K Block Diagram
21.2 External Signal Description
The Flash module contains no signals that connect off-chip.
Bus Clock
Divider
Clock
Command
Interrupt
Request
FCLK
Protection
Security
Registers
Flash
Interface
16bit
internal
bus sector 0
sector 1
sector 255
32Kx39
P-Flash
Error
Interrupt
Request
CPU
sector 0
sector 1
sector 1023
2Kx22
EEPROM
Memory
Controller
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 693
21.3 Memory Map and Registers
This section describes the memory map and registers for the Flash module. Read data from unimplemented
memory space in the Flash module is undefined. Write access to unimplemented or reserved memory space
in the Flash module will be ignored by the Flash module.
CAUTION
Writing to the Flash registers while a Flash command is executing (that is
indicated when the value of flag CCIF reads as ’0’) is not allowed. If such
action is attempted, the result of the write operation will be unpredictable.
Writing to the Flash registers is allowed when the Flash is not busy
executing commands (CCIF = 1) and during initialization right after reset,
despite the value of flag CCIF in that case (refer to Section 21.6 for a
complete description of the reset sequence).
.
21.3.1 Module Memory Map
The S12Z architecture places the P-Flash memory between global addresses 0xFE_0000 and 0xFF_FFFF
as shown in Table 21-3
The P-Flash memory map is shown in Figure 21-2.
The FPROT register , described in Section 21.3.2.9, can be set to protect regions in the Flash memory from
accidental program or erase. Three separate memory regions, one growing upward from global address
0xFF_8000 in the Flash memory (called the lower region), one growing downward from global address
0xFF_FFFF in the Flash memory (called the higher region), and the remaining addresses in the Flash
Table 21-2. FTMRZ Memory Map
Global Address (in Bytes) Size
(Bytes) Description
0x0_0000 – 0x0_0FFF 4,096 Register Space
0x10_0000 – 0x10_0FFF 4,096 EEPROM memory
0x1F_4000 – 0x1F_FFFF 49,152 NVM Resource Area(1) (see Figure 21-3)
1. See NVM Resource area description in Section 21.4.4
0xFE_0000 – 0xFF_FFFF 131,072 P-Flash Memory
Table 21-3. P-Flash Memory Addressing
Global Address Size
(Bytes) Description
0xFE_0000 – 0xFF_FFFF 128 K
P-Flash Block
Contains Flash Configuration Field
(see Table 21-4)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
694 Freescale Semiconductor
memory, can be activated for protection. The Flash memory addresses covered by these protectable
regions are shown in the P-Flash memory map. The higher address region is mainly targeted to hold the
boot loader code since it covers the vector space. Default protection settings as well as security information
that allows the MCU to restrict access to the Flash module are stored in the Flash configuration field as
described in Table 21-4.
Table 21-4. Flash Configuration Field
Global Address Size
(Bytes) Description
0xFF_FE00-0xFF_FE07 8
Backdoor Comparison Key
Refer to Section 21.4.7.11, “Verify Backdoor Access Key Command,” and
Section 21.5.1, “Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access
0xFF_FE08-0xFF_FE0912Protection Override Comparison Key. Refer to Section 21.4.7.17, “Protection
Override Command
0xFF_FE0A-
0xFF_FE0B(1)
1. 0xFF_FE08-0xFF_FE0F form a Flash phrase and must be programmed in a single command write sequence. Each byte
in the 0xFF_FE0A - 0xFF_FE0B reserved field should be programmed to 0xFF.
2Reserved
0xFF_FE0C11P-Flash Protection byte.
Refer to Section 21.3.2.9, “P-Flash Protection Register (FPROT)”
0xFF_FE0D11EEPROM Protection byte.
Refer to Section 21.3.2.10, “EEPROM Protection Register (DFPROT)”
0xFF_FE0E11Flash Nonvolatile byte
Refer to Section 21.3.2.11, “Flash Option Register (FOPT)”
0xFF_FE0F11Flash Security byte
Refer to Section 21.3.2.2, “Flash Security Register (FSEC)”
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 695
Figure 21-2. P-Flash Memory Map
Flash Configuration Field
0xFF_C000
Flash Protected/Unprotected Lower Region
1, 2, 4, 8 KB
0xFF_8000
0xFF_9000
0xFF_8400
0xFF_8800
0xFF_A000
P-Flash END = 0xFF_FFFF
0xFF_F800
0xFF_F000
0xFF_E000 Flash Protected/Unprotected Higher Region
2, 4, 8, 16 KB
Flash Protected/Unprotected Region
8 KB (up to 29 KB)
16 bytes (0xFF_FE00 - 0xFF_FE0F)
Flash Protected/Unprotected Region
96 KB
P-Flash START = 0xFE_0000
Protection
Protection
Protection
Movable End
Fixed End
Fixed End
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
696 Freescale Semiconductor
Table 21-5. Program IFR Fields
Global Address Size
(Bytes) Field Description
0x1F_C000 – 0x1F_C007 8 Reserved
0x1F_C008 – 0x1F_C0B5 174 Reserved
0x1F_C0B6 – 0x1F_C0B7 2 Version ID(1)
1. Used to track firmware patch versions, see Section 21.4.2
0x1F_C0B8 – 0x1F_C0BF 8 Reserved
0x1F_C0C0 – 0x1F_C0FF 64 Program Once Field
Refer to Section 21.4.7.6, “Program Once Command
Table 21-6. Memory Controller Resource Fields (NVM Resource Area(1))
1. See Section 21.4.4 for NVM Resources Area description.
Global Address Size
(Bytes) Description
0x1F_4000 – 0x1F_41FF 512 Reserved
0x1F_4200 – 0x1F_7FFF 15,872 Reserved
0x1F_8000 – 0x1F_97FF 6,144 Reserved
0x1F_9800 – 0x1F_BFFF 10,240 Reserved
0x1F_C000 0x1F_C0FF 256 P-Flash IFR (see Table 21-5)
0x1F_C100 – 0x1F_C1FF 256 Reserved.
0x1F_C200 – 0x1F_FFFF 15,872 Reserved.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 697
Figure 21-3. Memory Controller Resource Memory Map (NVM Resources Area)
21.3.2 Register Descriptions
The Flash module contains a set of 24 control and status registers located between Flash module base +
0x0000 and 0x0017.
In the case of the writable registers, the write accesses are forbidden during Flash command execution (for
more detail, see Caution note in Section 21.3).
A summary of the Flash module registers is given in Figure 21-4 with detailed descriptions in the
following subsections.
Address
& Name 76543210
0x0000
FCLKDIV
RFDIVLD FDIVLCK FDIV5 FDIV4 FDIV3 FDIV2 FDIV1 FDIV0
W
0x0001
FSEC
R KEYEN1 KEYEN0 RNV5 RNV4 RNV3 RNV2 SEC1 SEC0
W
0x0002
FCCOBIX
R0 0 0 0 0 CCOBIX2 CCOBIX1 CCOBIX0
W
Figure 21-4. FTMRZ128K4K Register Summary
P-Flash IFR 256 bytes
0x1F_C000
0x1F_41FF
0x1F_4000
Reserved 6 KB
Reserved 15872 bytes
0x1F_8000
0x1F_97FF
0x1F_C100 Reserved 16,128 bytes
Reserved 512 bytes
Reserved 10 KB
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
698 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0003
FPSTAT
RFPOVRD000000WSTATACK
W
0x0004
FCNFG
RCCIE 0 ERSAREQ IGNSF WSTAT[1:0] FDFD FSFD
W
0x0005
FERCNFG
R0000000
SFDIE
W
0x0006
FSTAT
RCCIF 0ACCERR FPVIOL MGBUSY RSVD MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0
W
0x0007
FERSTAT
R000000
DFDF SFDIF
W
0x0008
FPROT
RFPOPEN RNV6 FPHDIS FPHS1 FPHS0 FPLDIS FPLS1 FPLS0
W
0x0009
DFPROT
RDPOPEN DPS6 DPS5 DPS4 DPS3 DPS2 DPS1 DPS0
W
0x000A
FOPT
R NV7 NV6 NV5 NV4 NV3 NV2 NV1 NV0
W
0x000B
FRSV1
R00000000
W
0x000C
FCCOB0HI
RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x000D
FCCOB0LO
RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x000E
FCCOB1HI
RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x000F
FCCOB1LO
RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0010
FCCOB2HI
RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
Address
& Name 76543210
Figure 21-4. FTMRZ128K4K Register Summary (continued)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 699
21.3.2.1 Flash Clock Divider Register (FCLKDIV)
The FCLKDIV register is used to control timed events in program and erase algorithms.
All bits in the FCLKDIV register are readable, bit 7 is not writable, bit 6 is write-once-hi and controls the
writability of the FDIV field in normal mode. In special mode, bits 6-0 are writable any number of times
but bit 7 remains unwritable.
0x0011
FCCOB2LO
RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0012
FCCOB3HI
RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x0013
FCCOB3LO
RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0014
FCCOB4HI
RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x0015
FCCOB4LO
RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0016
FCCOB5HI
RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x0017
FCCOB5LO
RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Offset Module Base + 0x0000
76543210
RFDIVLD FDIVLCK FDIV[5:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-5. Flash Clock Divider Register (FCLKDIV)
Address
& Name 76543210
Figure 21-4. FTMRZ128K4K Register Summary (continued)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
700 Freescale Semiconductor
CAUTION
The FCLKDIV register should never be written while a Flash command is
executing (CCIF=0).
Table 21-7. FCLKDIV Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
FDIVLD
Clock Divider Loaded
0 FCLKDIV register has not been written since the last reset
1 FCLKDIV register has been written since the last reset
6
FDIVLCK
Clock Divider Locked
0 FDIV field is open for writing
1 FDIV value is locked and cannot be changed. Once the lock bit is set high, only reset can clear this bit and
restore writability to the FDIV field in normal mode.
5–0
FDIV[5:0]
Clock Divider Bits FDIV[5:0] must be set to effectively divide BUSCLK down to 1 MHz to control timed events
during Flash program and erase algorithms. Tabl e 2 1-8 shows recommended values for FDIV[5:0] based on the
BUSCLK frequency. Please refer to Section 21.4.5, “Flash Command Operations, for more information.
Table 21-8. FDIV values for various BUSCLK Frequencies
BUSCLK Frequency
(MHz) FDIV[5:0]
BUSCLK Frequency
(MHz) FDIV[5:0]
MIN(1) MAX(2) MIN1MAX2
1.0 1.6 0x00 26.6 27.6 0x1A
1.6 2.6 0x01 27.6 28.6 0x1B
2.6 3.6 0x02 28.6 29.6 0x1C
3.6 4.6 0x03 29.6 30.6 0x1D
4.6 5.6 0x04 30.6 31.6 0x1E
5.6 6.6 0x05 31.6 32.6 0x1F
6.6 7.6 0x06 32.6 33.6 0x20
7.6 8.6 0x07 33.6 34.6 0x21
8.6 9.6 0x08 34.6 35.6 0x22
9.6 10.6 0x09 35.6 36.6 0x23
10.6 11.6 0x0A 36.6 37.6 0x24
11.6 12.6 0x0B 37.6 38.6 0x25
12.6 13.6 0x0C 38.6 39.6 0x26
13.6 14.6 0x0D 39.6 40.6 0x27
14.6 15.6 0x0E 40.6 41.6 0x28
15.6 16.6 0x0F 41.6 42.6 0x29
16.6 17.6 0x10 42.6 43.6 0x2A
17.6 18.6 0x11 43.6 44.6 0x2B
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 701
21.3.2.2 Flash Security Register (FSEC)
The FSEC register holds all bits associated with the security of the MCU and Flash module.
All bits in the FSEC register are readable but not writable.
During the reset sequence, the FSEC register is loaded with the contents of the Flash security byte in the
Flash configuration field at global address 0xFF_FE0F located in P-Flash memory (see Table 21-4) as
indicated by reset condition F in Figure 21-6. If a double bit fault is detected while reading the P-Flash
phrase containing the Flash security byte during the reset sequence, all bits in the FSEC register will be set
to leave the Flash module in a secured state with backdoor key access disabled.
18.6 19.6 0x12 44.6 45.6 0x2C
19.6 20.6 0x13 45.6 46.6 0x2D
20.6 21.6 0x14 46.6 47.6 0x2E
21.6 22.6 0x15 47.6 48.6 0x2F
22.6 23.6 0x16 48.6 49.6 0x30
23.6 24.6 0x17 49.6 50.6 0x31
24.6 25.6 0x18
25.6 26.6 0x19
1. BUSCLK is Greater Than this value.
2. BUSCLK is Less Than or Equal to this value.
Offset Module Base + 0x0001
76543210
R KEYEN[1:0] RNV[5:2] SEC[1:0]
W
Reset F(1)
1. Loaded from Flash configuration field, during reset sequence.
F1F1F1F1F1F1F1
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-6. Flash Security Register (FSEC)
Table 21-9. FSEC Fiel d De sc rip tio ns
Field Description
7–6
KEYEN[1:0]
Backdoor Key Security Enable Bits — The KEYEN[1:0] bits define the enabling of backdoor key access to the
Flash module as shown in Table 21-10.
Table 21-8. FDIV values for various BUSCLK Frequencies
BUSCLK Frequency
(MHz) FDIV[5:0]
BUSCLK Frequency
(MHz) FDIV[5:0]
MIN(1) MAX(2) MIN1MAX2
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
702 Freescale Semiconductor
The security function in the Flash module is described in Section 21.5.
21.3.2.3 Flash CCOB Index Register (FCCOBIX)
The FCCOBIX register is used to indicate the amount of parameters loaded into the FCCOB registers for
Flash memory operations.
CCOBIX bits are readable and writable while remaining bits read 0 and are not writable.
5–2
RNV[5:2]
Reserved Nonvolatile Bits — The RNV bits should remain in the erased state for future enhancements.
1–0
SEC[1:0]
Flash Security Bits — The SEC[1:0] bits define the security state of the MCU as shown in Table 21-11. If the
Flash module is unsecured using backdoor key access, the SEC bits are forced to 10.
Table 21-10. Flash KEYEN States
KEYEN[1:0] Status of Backdoor Key Access
00 DISABLED
01 DISABLED(1)
1. Preferred KEYEN state to disable backdoor key access.
10 ENABLED
11 DISABLED
Table 21-11. Flash Secu rity States
SEC[1:0] Status of Security
00 SECURED
01 SECURED(1)
1. Preferred SEC state to set MCU to secured state.
10 UNSECURED
11 SECURED
Offset Module Base + 0x0002
76543210
R00000 CCOBIX[2:0]
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-7. FCCOB Index Register (FCCOBIX)
Table 21-9. FSEC Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 703
21.3.2.4 Flash Protection Status Register (FPSTAT)
This Flash register holds the status of the Protection Override feature.
All bits in the FPSTAT register are readable but are not writable.
21.3.2.5 Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG)
The FCNFG register enables the Flash command complete interrupt, control generation of wait-states and
forces ECC faults on Flash array read access from the CPU.
Table 21-12. FCCOBIX Field De sc rip tion s
Field Description
2–0
CCOBIX[1:0]
Common Command Register Index— The CCOBIX bits are used to indicate how many words of the FCCOB
register array are being read or written to. See Section 21.3.2.13, “Flash Common Command Object Registers
(FCCOB)“,” for more details.
Offset Module Base + 0x0003
76543210
R FPOVRD 0 0 0 0 0 0 WSTATACK
W
Reset00000001
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-8. Flash Protection Status Register (FPSTAT)
Table 21-13. FPSTAT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
FPOVRD
Flash Protection Override St atus The FPOVRD bit indicates if the Protection Override feature is currently
enabled. See Section 21.4.7.17, “Protection Override Command” for more details.
0 Protection is not overridden
1 Protection is overridden, contents of registers FPROT and/or DFPROT (and effective protection limits
determined by their current contents) were determined during execution of command Protection Override
0
WSTATACK
Wait-State Switch Acknowledge — The WSTATACK bit indicates that the wait-state configuration is
effectively set according to the value configured on bits FCNFG[WSTAT] (see Section 21.3.2.5, “Flash
Configuration Register (FCNFG)”). WSTATACK bit is cleared when a change in FCNFG[WSTAT] is requested
by writing to those bits, and is set when the Flash has effectively switched to the new wait-state configuration.
The application must check the status of WSTATACK bit to make sure it reads as 1 before changing the
frequency setup (see Section 21.4.3, “Flash Block Read Access”).
0 Wait-State switch is pending, Flash reads are still happening according to the previous value of
FCNFG[WSTAT]
1 Wait-State switch is complete, Flash reads are already working according to the value set on
FCNFG[WSTAT]
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
704 Freescale Semiconductor
CCIE, IGNSF, WSTAT, FDFD, and FSFD bits are readable and writable, ERSAREQ bit is read only, and
remaining bits read 0 and are not writable.
Offset Module Base + 0x0004
76543210
RCCIE 0 ERSAREQ IGNSF WSTAT[1:0] FDFD FSFD
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-9. Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG)
Table 21-14 . FC NF G Fi el d De sc rip ti on s
Field Description
7
CCIE
Command Complete Interrupt Enable — The CCIE bit controls interrupt generation when a Flash command
has completed.
0 Command complete interrupt disabled
1 An interrupt will be requested whenever the CCIF flag in the FSTAT register is set (see Section 21.3.2.7)
5
ERSAREQ
Erase All Request — Requests the Memory Controller to execute the Erase All Blocks command and release
security. ERSAREQ is not directly writable but is under indirect user control. Refer to the Reference Manual for
assertion of the soc_erase_all_req input to the FTMRZ module.
0 No request or request complete
1 Request to:
a) run the Erase All Blocks command
b) verify the erased state
c) program the security byte in the Flash Configuration Field to the unsecure state
d) release MCU security by setting the SEC field of the FSEC register to the unsecure state as defined in
Table 21-9 of Section 21.3.2.2.
The ERSAREQ bit sets to 1 when soc_erase_all_req is asserted, CCIF=1 and the Memory Controller starts
executing the sequence. ERSAREQ will be reset to 0 by the Memory Controller when the operation is completed
(see Section 21.4.7.7.1).
4
IGNSF
Ignore Single Bit Fault — The IGNSF controls single bit fault reporting in the FERSTAT register (see
Section 21.3.2.8).
0 All single bit faults detected during array reads are reported
1 Single bit faults detected during array reads are not reported and the single bit fault interrupt will not be
generated
3–2
WSTAT[1:0]
W ait S tate control bits — The WSTAT[1:0] bits define how many wait-states are inserted on each read access
to the Flash as shown on Table 21-15.Right after reset the maximum amount of wait-states is set, to be later re-
configured by the application if needed. Depending on the system operating frequency being used the number
of wait-states can be reduced or disabled, please refer to the Data Sheet for details. For additional information
regarding the procedure to change this configuration please see Section 21.4.3. The WSTAT[1:0] bits should not
be updated while the Flash is executing a command (CCIF=0); if that happens the value of this field will not
change and no action will take place.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 705
21.3.2.6 Flash Error Configuration Register (FERCNFG)
The FERCNFG register enables the Flash error interrupts for the FERSTAT flags.
All assigned bits in the FERCNFG register are readable and writable.
1
FDFD
Force Double Bit Fault Detect The FDFD bit allows the user to simulate a double bit fault during Flash array
read operations. The FDFD bit is cleared by writing a 0 to FDFD.
0 Flash array read operations will set the DFDF flag in the FERSTAT register only if a double bit fault is detected
1 Any Flash array read operation will force the DFDF flag in the FERSTAT register to be set (see
Section 21.3.2.7)
0
FSFD
Force Single Bit Fault Detect The FSFD bit allows the user to simulate a single bit fault during Flash array
read operations and check the associated interrupt routine. The FSFD bit is cleared by writing a 0 to FSFD.
0 Flash array read operations will set the SFDIF flag in the FERSTAT register only if a single bit fault is detected
1 Flash array read operation will force the SFDIF flag in the FERSTAT register to be set (see Section 21.3.2.7)
and an interrupt will be generated as long as the SFDIE interrupt enable in the FERCNFG register is set (see
Section 21.3.2.6)
Table 21-15. Flash Wait-States control
WSTAT[1:0] Wait-State configuration
00 ENABLED, maximum number of cycles(1)
1. Reset condition. For a target of 100MHz core frequency /
50MHz bus frequency the maximum number required is 1
cycle.
01 reserved(2)
2. Value will read as 01 or 10, as written. In the current
implementation the Flash will behave the same as 00 (wait-
states enabled, maximum number of cycles).
10 reserved2
11 DISABLED
Offset Module Base + 0x0005
76543210
R0000000
SFDIE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-10. Flash Error Configuration Register (FERCNFG)
Table 21-14. FCNFG Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
706 Freescale Semiconductor
21.3.2.7 Flash Status Register (FSTAT)
The FSTAT register reports the operational status of the Flash module.
CCIF, ACCERR, and FPVIOL bits are readable and writable, MGBUSY and MGSTAT bits are readable
but not writable, while remaining bits read 0 and are not writable.
Table 21-16. FERCNFG Field Descriptions
Field Description
0
SFDIE
Single Bit Fa ult Detect Interrupt EnableThe SFDIE bit controls interrupt generation when a single bit fault
is detected during a Flash block read operation.
0 SFDIF interrupt disabled whenever the SFDIF flag is set (see Section 21.3.2.8)
1 An interrupt will be requested whenever the SFDIF flag is set (see Section 21.3.2.8)
Offset Module Base + 0x0006
76543210
RCCIF 0ACCERR FPVIOL MGBUSY RSVD MGSTAT[1:0]
W
Reset1000000
(1)
1. Reset value can deviate from the value shown if a double bit fault is detected during the reset sequence (see Section 21.6).
01
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-11. Flash Status Register (FSTAT)
Table 21-17. FSTAT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CCIF
Command Complete Interrupt Flag — The CCIF flag indicates that a Flash command has completed. The
CCIF flag is cleared by writing a 1 to CCIF to launch a command and CCIF will stay low until command
completion or command violation.
0 Flash command in progress
1 Flash command has completed
5
ACCERR
Flash Access Error Flag — The ACCERR bit indicates an illegal access has occurred to the Flash memory
caused by either a violation of the command write sequence (see Section 21.4.5.2) or issuing an illegal Flash
command. While ACCERR is set, the CCIF flag cannot be cleared to launch a command. The ACCERR bit is
cleared by writing a 1 to ACCERR. Writing a 0 to the ACCERR bit has no effect on ACCERR.
0 No access error detected
1 Access error detected
4
FPVIOL
Flash Protection Violation Fl ag —The FPVIOL bit indicates an attempt was made to program or erase an
address in a protected area of P-Flash or EEPROM memory during a command write sequence. The FPVIOL
bit is cleared by writing a 1 to FPVIOL. Writing a 0 to the FPVIOL bit has no effect on FPVIOL. While FPVIOL
is set, it is not possible to launch a command or start a command write sequence.
0 No protection violation detected
1 Protection violation detected
3
MGBUSY
Memory Controller Busy Flag — The MGBUSY flag reflects the active state of the Memory Controller.
0 Memory Controller is idle
1 Memory Controller is busy executing a Flash command (CCIF = 0)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 707
21.3.2.8 Flash Error Status R egister (FERSTAT)
The FERSTAT register reflects the error status of internal Flash operations.
All flags in the FERSTAT register are readable and only writable to clear the flag.
2
RSVD
Reserved Bit — This bit is reserved and always reads 0.
1–0
MGSTAT[1:0]
Memory Controller Command Completion Status Flag — One or more MGSTAT flag bits are set if an error
is detected during execution of a Flash command or during the Flash reset sequence. The MGSTAT bits are
cleared automatically at the start of the execution of a Flash command. See Section 21.4.7, “Flash Command
Description,” and Section 21.6, “Initialization” for details.
Offset Module Base + 0x0007
76543210
R000000
DFDF SFDIF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-12. Flash Error Status Register (FERSTAT)
Table 2 1-18. FERSTAT Field Descriptions
Field Description
1
DFDF
Double Bit Fault Detect Flag — The setting of the DFDF flag indicates that a double bit fault was detected in
the stored parity and data bits during a Flash array read operation or that a Flash array read operation returning
invalid data was attempted on a Flash block that was under a Flash command operation.(1) The DFDF flag is
cleared by writing a 1 to DFDF. Writing a 0 to DFDF has no effect on DFDF.(2)
0 No double bit fault detected
1 Double bit fault detected or a Flash array read operation returning invalid data was attempted while command
running. See Section 21.4.3, “Flash Block Read Access” for details
1. In case of ECC errors the corresponding flag must be cleared for the proper setting of any further error, i.e. any new error will
only be indicated properly when DFDF and/or SFDIF are clear at the time the error condition is detected.
2. There is a one cycle delay in storing the ECC DFDF and SFDIF fault flags in this register. At least one NOP is required after
a flash memory read before checking FERSTAT for the occurrence of ECC errors.
0
SFDIF
Single Bit Fault Detect Interrupt Flag — With the IGNSF bit in the FCNFG register clear, the SFDIF flag
indicates that a single bit fault was detected in the stored parity and data bits during a Flash array read operation
or that a Flash array read operation returning invalid data was attempted on a Flash block that was under a Flash
command operation. The SFDIF flag is cleared by writing a 1 to SFDIF. Writing a 0 to SFDIF has no effect on
SFDIF.
0 No single bit fault detected
1 Single bit fault detected and corrected or a Flash array read operation returning invalid data was attempted
while command running
Table 21-17. FSTAT Field Descripti ons (co ntinued)
Field Description
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
708 Freescale Semiconductor
21.3.2.9 P-Flash Protection Register (FPROT)
The FPROT register defines which P-Flash sectors are protected against program and erase operations.
The (unreserved) bits of the FPROT register are writable in Normal Single Chip Mode with th e restriction
that the size of the protected region can only be increased(see Section 21.3.2.9.1, “P-Flash Protection
Restrictions,” and Table 21-23). All (unreserved) bits of the FPROT register are writable without
restriction in Special Single Chip Mode.
During the reset sequence, the FPROT register is loaded with the contents of the P-Flash protection byte
in the Flash configuration field at global address 0xFF_FE0C located in P-Flash memory (see Table 21-4)
as indicated by reset condition ‘F’ in Figure 21-13. To change the P-Flash protection that will be loaded
during the reset sequence, the upper sector of the P-Flash memory must be unprotected, then the P-Flash
protection byte must be reprogrammed. If a double bit fault is detected while reading the P-Flash phrase
containing the P-Flash protection byte during the reset sequence, the FPOPEN bit will be cleared and
remaining bits in the FPROT register will be set to leave the P-Flash memory fully protected.
Trying to alter data in any protected area in the P-Flash memory will result in a protection violation error
and the FPVIOL bit will be set in the FSTAT register. The block erase of a P-Flash block is not possible
if any of the P-Flash sectors contained in the same P-Flash block are protected.
Offset Module Base + 0x0008
76543210
RFPOPEN RNV6 FPHDIS FPHS[1:0] FPLDIS FPLS[1:0]
W
Reset F(1)
1. Loaded from Flash configuration field, during reset sequence.
F1F1F1F1F1F1F1
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-13. Flash Protection Register (FPROT)
Table 21-19. FPROT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
FPOPEN
Flash Protection Operation Enable — The FPOPEN bit determines the protection function for program or
erase operations as shown in Table 21-20 for the P-Flash block.
0 When FPOPEN is clear, the FPHDIS and FPLDIS bits define unprotected address ranges as specified by the
corresponding FPHS and FPLS bits
1 When FPOPEN is set, the FPHDIS and FPLDIS bits enable protection for the address range specified by the
corresponding FPHS and FPLS bits
6
RNV[6]
Reserved Nonvolatile Bit — The RNV bit should remain in the erased state for future enhancements.
5
FPHDIS
Flash Protection Hi gher Address Rang e Disable — The FPHDIS bit determines whether there is a
protected/unprotected area in a specific region of the P-Flash memory ending with global address 0xFF_FFFF.
0 Protection/Unprotection enabled
1 Protection/Unprotection disabled
4–3
FPHS[1:0]
Flash Protection High er Address Size The FPHS bits determine the size of the protected/unprotected area
in P-Flash memory as shown inTable 21-21. The FPHS bits can only be written to while the FPHDIS bit is set.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 709
All possible P-Flash protection scenarios are shown in Figure 21-14 . Although the protection scheme is
loaded from the Flash memory at global address 0xFF_FE0C during the reset sequence, it can be changed
by the user. The P-Flash protection scheme can be used by applications requiring reprogramming in
Normal Single Chip Mode while providing as much protection as possible if reprogramming is not
required.
2
FPLDIS
Flash Protection L ow er Address Range Disabl e — The FPLDIS bit determines whether there is a
protected/unprotected area in a specific region of the P-Flash memory beginning with global address
0xFF_8000.
0 Protection/Unprotection enabled
1 Protection/Unprotection disabled
1–0
FPLS[1:0]
Flash Protection Lower Address Size — The FPLS bits determine the size of the protected/unprotected area
in P-Flash memory as shown in Table 21-22. The FPLS bits can only be written to while the FPLDIS bit is set.
Table 21-20. P-Flash Protection Function
FPOPEN FPHDIS FPLDIS Function(1)
1. For range sizes, refer to Table 21-21 and Table 21-22.
1 1 1 No P-Flash Protection
1 1 0 Protected Low Range
1 0 1 Protected High Range
1 0 0 Protected High and Low Ranges
0 1 1 Full P-Flash Memory Protected
0 1 0 Unprotected Low Range
0 0 1 Unprotected High Range
0 0 0 Unprotected High and Low Ranges
Table 21-21. P-Flash Protection Higher Address Range
FPHS[1:0] Global Address Range Protected Size
00 0xFF_F800–0xFF_FFFF 2 KB
01 0xFF_F000–0xFF_FFFF 4 KB
10 0xFF_E000–0xFF_FFFF 8 KB
11 0xFF_C000–0xFF_FFFF 16 KB
Table 21-22. P-Flash Protection Lower Address Range
FPLS[1:0] Glob al Address Range Protected Size
00 0xFF_8000–0xFF_83FF 1 KB
01 0xFF_8000–0xFF_87FF 2 KB
10 0xFF_8000–0xFF_8FFF 4 KB
11 0xFF_8000–0xFF_9FFF 8 KB
Table 21-19. FPROT Field Descriptions (continued)
Field Description
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
710 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 21-14. P-Flash Protection Scenarios
7654
FPHS[1:0] FPLS[1:0]
3210
FPHS[1:0] FPLS[1:0]
FPHDIS = 1
FPLDIS = 1
FPHDIS = 1
FPLDIS = 0
FPHDIS = 0
FPLDIS = 1
FPHDIS = 0
FPLDIS = 0
Scenario
Scenario
Unprotected region Protected region with size
Protected region Protected region with size
defined by FPLS
defined by FPHSnot defined by FPLS, FPHS
0xFF_8000
0xFF_FFFF
0xFF_8000
0xFF_FFFF
FLASH START
FLASH START
FPOPEN = 1FPOPEN = 0
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 711
21.3.2.9.1 P-Flash Protection Restrictions
In Normal Single Chip Mode the general guideline is that P-Flash protection can only be added and not
removed. Table 21-23 specifies all valid trans itions between P-Flash protection scenarios. Any attempt to
write an invalid scenario to the FPROT register will be ignored. The contents of the FPROT register reflect
the active protection scenario. See the FPHS and FPLS bit descriptions for additional restrictions.
21.3.2.10 EEPROM Protection Register (DFPROT)
The DFPROT register defines which EEPROM sectors are protected against program and erase
operations.
The (unreserved) bits of the DFPROT register are writable in Normal Single Chip Mode with the
restriction that protection can be added but not removed. Writes in Normal Single Chip Mode must
increase the DPS value and the DPOPEN bit can only be written from 1 (protection disabled) to 0
(protection enabled). If the DPOPEN bit is set, the state of the DPS bits is irrelevant.All DPOPEN/DPS bit
registers are writable without restriction in Special Single Chip Mode.
During the reset sequence, fields DPOPEN and DPS of the DFPROT register are loaded with the contents
of the EEPROM protection byte in the Flash configuration field at global address 0xFF_FE0D located in
Table 21-23. P-Flash Protection Scenario Transitions
From
Protection
Scenario
To Protection Scenario(1)
1. Allowed transitions marked with X, see Figure 21-14 for a definition of the scenarios.
01234567
0XXXX
1XX
2XX
3X
4XX
5XXXX
6XXXX
7XXXXXXXX
Offset Module Base + 0x0009
76543210
RDPOPEN DPS[6:0]
W
Reset F(1)
1. Loaded from Flash configuration field, during reset sequence.
F1F1F1F1F1F1F1
Figure 21-15 . E EPRO M Prote ct ion Regi st e r (DFPROT)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
712 Freescale Semiconductor
P-Flash memory (see Table 21-4) as indicated by reset condition F in Table 21-25. To change the
EEPROM protection that will be loaded during the reset sequence, the P-Flash sector containing the
EEPROM protection byte must be unprotected, then the EEPROM protection byte must be programmed.
If a double bit fault is detected while reading the P-Flash phrase containing the EEPROM protection byte
during the reset sequence, the DPOPEN bit will be cleared and DPS bits will be set to leave the EEPROM
memory fully protected.
Trying to alter data in any protected area in the EEPROM memory will result in a protection violation error
and the FPVIOL bit will be set in the FST AT register. Block erase of the EEPROM memory is not possible
if any of the EEPROM sectors are protected.
21.3.2.11 Flash Option Register (FOPT)
The FOPT register is the Flash option register.
Table 21-24. DFPROT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
DPOPEN
EEPROM Protection Control
0 Enables EEPROM memory protection from program and erase with protected address range defined by DPS
bits
1 Disables EEPROM memory protection from program and erase
6–0
DPS[6:0]
EEPROM Protection Size — The DPS[6:0] bits determine the size of the protected area in the EEPROM
memory, this size increase in step of 32 bytes, as shown in Table 21-25 .
Table 21-25. EEPROM Protection Address Range
DPS[6:0] Global Address Range Protected Size
0000000 0x10_0000 – 0x10_001F 32 bytes
0000001 0x10_0000 – 0x10_003F 64 bytes
0000010 0x10_0000 – 0x10_005F 96 bytes
0000011 0x10_0000 – 0x10_007F 128 bytes
0000100 0x10_0000 – 0x10_009F 160 bytes
0000101 0x10_0000 – 0x10_00BF 192 bytes
The Protection Size goes on enlarging in step of 32 bytes, for each DPS value
increasing of one. .
.
.
1111111 0x10_0000 – 0x10_0FFF 4,096 bytes
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 713
All bits in the FOPT register are readable but are not writable.
During the reset sequence, the FOPT register is loaded from the Flash nonvolatile byte in the Flash
configuration field at global address 0xFF_FE0E located in P-Flash memory (see Table 21-4) as indicated
by reset condition F in Figure 21-16. If a double bit fault is detected while reading the P-Flash phrase
containing the Flash nonvolatile byte during the reset sequence, all bits in the FOPT register will be set.
21.3.2.12 Flash Reserved1 Register (FRSV1)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
All bits in the FRSV1 register read 0 and are not writable.
21.3.2.13 Flash Common Command Object Registers (FCCOB)
The FCCOB is an array of six words. Byte wide reads and writes are allowed to the FCCOB registers.
Offset Module Base + 0x000A
76543210
R NV[7:0]
W
Reset F(1)
1. Loaded from Flash configuration field, during reset sequence.
F1F1F1F1F1F1F1
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-16. Flash Option Register (FOPT)
Table 21-26. FOPT Field Descriptions
Field Description
7–0
NV[7:0]
Nonvolatile BitsThe NV[7:0] bits are available as nonvolatile bits. Refer to the Device Overview for proper
use of the NV bits.
Offset Module Base + 0x000B
76543210
R00000000
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 21-17 . Fl as h Rese rve d 1 Re gi st er (FRSV1 )
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
714 Freescale Semiconductor
Offset Module Base + 0x000C
76543210
RCCOB[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-18. Flash Common Command Object 0 High Register (FCCOB0HI)
Offset Module Base + 0x000D
76543210
RCCOB[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-19. Flash Common Command Object 0 Low Register (FCCOB0LO)
Offset Module Base + 0x000E
76543210
RCCOB[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-20. Flash Common Command Object 1 High Register (FCCOB1HI)
Offset Module Base + 0x000F
76543210
RCCOB[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-21. Flash Common Command Object 1 Low Register (FCCOB1LO)
Offset Module Base + 0x0010
76543210
RCCOB[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-22. Flash Common Command Object 2 High Register (FCCOB2HI)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 715
Offset Module Base + 0x0011
76543210
RCCOB[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-23. Flash Common Command Object 2 Low Register (FCCOB2LO)
Offset Module Base + 0x0012
76543210
RCCOB[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-24. Flash Common Command Object 3 High Register (FCCOB3HI)
Offset Module Base + 0x0013
76543210
RCCOB[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-25. Flash Common Command Object 3 Low Register (FCCOB3LO)
Offset Module Base + 0x0014
76543210
RCCOB[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-26. Flash Common Command Object 4 High Register (FCCOB4HI)
Offset Module Base + 0x0015
76543210
RCCOB[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-27. Flash Common Command Object 4 Low Register (FCCOB4LO)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
716 Freescale Semiconductor
21.3.2.13.1 FCCOB - NVM Command Mode
NVM command mode uses the FCCOB registers to provide a command code and its relevant parameters
to the Memory Controller. The user first sets up all required FCCOB fields and then initiates the
command’s execution by writing a 1 to the CCIF bit in the FSTAT register (a 1 written by the user clears
the CCIF command completion flag to 0). When the user clears the CCIF bit in the FSTAT register all
FCCOB parameter fields are locked and cannot be changed by the user until the command completes (as
evidenced by the Memory Controller returning CCIF to 1). Some commands return information to the
FCCOB register array.
The generic format for the FCCOB parameter fields in NVM command mode is shown in Table 21-27.
The return values are available for reading after the CCIF flag in the FSTAT register has been returned to
1 by the Memory Controller. The value written to the FCCOBIX field must reflect the amount of CCOB
words loaded for command execution.
Table 21-27 shows the generic Flash command format. The high byte of the first word in the CCOB array
contains the command code, followed by the parameters for this specific Flash command. For details on
the FCCOB settings required by each command, see the Flash command descriptions in Section 21.4.7.
Offset Module Base + 0x0016
76543210
RCCOB[15:8]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-28. Flash Common Command Object 5 High Register (FCCOB5HI)
Offset Module Base + 0x0017
76543210
RCCOB[7:0]
W
Reset00000000
Figure 21-29. Flash Common Command Object 5 Low Register (FCCOB5LO)
Table 21-27. FCCOB - NVM Command Mode (Typical Usage)
CCOBIX[2:0] Register Byte F CCOB Parameter Fields (NVM Command Mode)
000 FCCOB0 HI FCMD[7:0] defining Flash command
LO Global address [23:16]
001 FCCOB1 HI Global address [15:8]
LO Global address [7:0]
010 FCCOB2 HI Data 0 [15:8]
LO Data 0 [7:0]
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 717
21.4 Functional Description
21.4.1 Modes of Operation
The FTMRZ128K4K module provides the modes of operation normal and special . The operating mode
is determined by module-level inputs and affects the FCLKDIV, FCNFG, and DFPROT registers (see
Table 21-29).
21.4.2 IFR Version ID Word
The version ID word is stored in the IFR at address 0x1F_C0B6. The contents of the word are defined in
Table 21-28.
VERNUM: Version number . The first version is number 0b_0001 with both 0b_0000 and 0b_1 1 11
meaning ‘none’.
21.4.3 Flash Block Read Access
If data read from the Flash block results in a double-bit fault ECC error (meaning that data is detected to
be in error and cannot be corrected), the read data will be tagged as invalid during that access (please look
into the Reference Manual for details). Forcing the DFDF status bit by setting FDFD (see Section 21.3.2.5)
has effect only on the DFDF status bit value and does not result in an invalid access.
011 FCCOB3 HI Data 1 [15:8]
LO Data 1 [7:0]
100 FCCOB4 HI Data 2 [15:8]
LO Data 2 [7:0]
101 FCCOB5 HI Data 3 [15:8]
LO Data 3 [7:0]
Table 21-28. IFR Version ID Fields
[15:4] [3:0]
Reserved VERNUM
Table 21-27. FCCOB - NVM Command Mode (Typical Usage)
CCOBIX[2:0] Register Byte F CCOB Parameter Fields (NVM Command Mode)
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
718 Freescale Semiconductor
To guarantee the proper read timing from the Flash array, the FTMRZ128K4K FMU will control (i.e.
pause) the S12Z core accesses, considering that the MCU can be configured to fetch data at a faster
frequency than the Flash block can support. Right after reset the FTMRZ128K4K FMU will be configured
to run with the maximum amount of wait-states enabled; if the user application is setup to run at a slower
frequency the control bits FCNFG[WSTAT] (see Section 21.3.2.5) can be configured by the user to disable
the generation of wait-states, so it does not impose a performance penalty to the system if the read timing
of the S12Z core is setup to be within the margins of the Flash block. For a definition of the frequency
values where wait-states can be disabled please look into the Reference Manual.
The following sequence must be followed when the transition from a higher frequency to a lower
frequency is going to happen:
Flash resets with wait-states enabled;
system frequency must be configured to the lower target;
user writes to FNCNF[WSTAT] to disable wait-states;
user reads the value of FPSTAT[WSTATACK], the new wait-state configuration will be effective
when it reads as 1;
user must re-write FCLKDIV to set a new value based on the lower frequency.
The following sequence must be followed on the contrary direction, going from a lower frequency to a
higher frequency:
user writes to FCNFG[WSTAT] to enable wait-states;
user reads the value of FPSTAT[WSTATACK], the new wait-state configuration will be effective
when it reads as 1;
user must re-write FCLKDIV to set a new value based on the higher frequency;
system frequency must be set to the upper target.
CAUTION
If the application is going to require the frequency setup to change, the value
to be loaded on register FCLKDIV will have to be updated according to the
new frequency value. In this scenario the application must take care to avoid
locking the value of the FCLKDIV register: bit FDIVLCK must not be set
if the value to be loaded on FDIV is going to be re-written, otherwise a reset
is going to be required. Please refer to Section 21.3.2.1, “Flash Clock
Divider Register (FCLKDIV) and Section 21.4.5.1, “Writing the FCLKDIV
Register.
21.4.4 Internal NVM resource
IFR is an internal NVM resource readable by CPU . The IFR fields are shown in Table 21-5.
The NVM Resource Area global address map is shown in Table 21-6.
21.4.5 Flash Command Operations
Flash command operations are used to modify Flash memory contents.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 719
The next sections describe:
How to write the FCLKDIV register that is used to generate a time base (FCLK) derived from
BUSCLK for Flash program and erase command operations
The command write sequence used to set Flash command parameters and launch execution
Valid Flash commands available for execution, according to MCU functional mode and MCU
security state.
21.4.5.1 Writing the FCLKDIV Register
Prior to issuing any Flash program or erase command after a reset, the user is required to write the
FCLKDIV register to divide BUSCLK down to a target FCLK of 1 MHz. Table 21-8 shows recommended
values for the FDIV field based on BUSCLK frequency.
NOTE
Programming or erasing the Flash memory cannot be performed if the bus
clock runs at less than 0.8 MHz. Setting FDIV too high can destroy the Flash
memory due to overstress. Setting FDIV too low can result in incomplete
programming or erasure of the Flash memory cells.
When the FCLKDIV register is written, the FDIVLD bit is set automatically. If the FDIVLD bit is 0, the
FCLKDIV register has not been written since the last reset. If the FCLKDIV register has not been written,
any Flash program or erase command loaded during a command write sequence will not execute and the
ACCERR bit in the FSTAT register will set.
21.4.5.2 Command Write Sequence
The Memory Controller will launch all valid Flash commands entered using a command write sequence.
Before launching a command, the ACCERR and FPVIOL bits in the FSTAT register must be clear (see
Section 21.3.2.7) and the CCIF flag should be tested to determine the status of the current command wr ite
sequence. If CCIF is 0, the previous command write sequence is still active, a new command write
sequence cannot be started, and all writes to the FCCOB register are ignored.
21.4.5.2.1 Define FCCOB Contents
The FCCOB parameter fields must be loaded with all required parameters for the Flash command being
executed. The CCOBIX bits in the FCCOBIX register must reflect the amount of words loaded into the
FCCOB registers (see Section 21.3.2.3).
The contents of the FCCOB parameter fields are transferred to the Memory Controller when the user clears
the CCIF command completion flag in the FSTAT register (writing 1 clears the CCIF to 0). The CCIF flag
will remain clear until the Flash command has completed. Upon completion, the Memory Controller will
return CCIF to 1 and the FCCOB register will be used to communicate any results. The flow for a generic
command write sequence is shown in Figure 21-30.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
720 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure 21-30. Generic Flash Command Write Sequence Flowchart
Write to FCCOBIX register
Write: FSTAT register (to launch command)
Clear CCIF 0x80
Clear ACCERR/FPVIOL 0x30
Write: FSTAT register
yes
no
Access Error and
Protection Violation
Read: FSTAT register
START
Check
FCCOB
ACCERR/
FPVIOL
Set?
EXIT
Write: FCLKDIV register
Read: FCLKDIV register
yes
no
FDIV
Correct?
no
Bit Polling for
Command Completion
Check yes
CCIF Set?
to indicate number of parameters
to be loaded.
Write to FCCOB register
to load required command parameter.
yes
no
More
Parameters?
Availability Check
Results from previous Command
Note: FCLKDIV must be
set after each reset
Read: FSTAT register
no
yes
CCIF
Set?
no
yes
CCIF
Set?
Clock Divider
Value Check
Read: FSTAT register
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 721
21.4.5.3 Valid Flash Module Commands
Table 21-29 present the valid Flash commands, as enabled by the combination of the functional MCU
mode (Normal SingleChip NS, Special Singlechip SS) with the MCU security state (Unsecured, Secured).
+Table 21-29. Flash Commands by Mode and Security State
FCMD Command
Unsecured Secured
NS
(1)
1. Unsecured Normal Single Chip mode
SS(2)
2. Unsecured Special Single Chip mode.
NS
(3)
3. Secured Normal Single Chip mode.
SS(4)
4. Secured Special Single Chip mode.Please refer to Section 21.5.2.
0x01 Erase Verify All Blocks 
0x02 Erase Verify Block 
0x03 Erase Verify P-Flash Section 
0x04 Read Once 
0x06 Program P-Flash 
0x07 Program Once 
0x08 Erase All Blocks
0x09 Erase Flash Block 
0x0A Erase P-Flash Sector 
0x0B Unsecure Flash
0x0C Verify Backdoor Access Key 
0x0D Set User Margin Level 
0x0E Set Field Margin Level
0x10 Erase Verify EEPROM Section 
0x11 Program EEPROM 
0x12 Erase EEPROM Sector 
0x13 Protection Override 
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
722 Freescale Semiconductor
21.4.5.4 P-Flash Commands
Table 21-30 summarizes the valid P-Flash commands along with the effects of the commands on the P-
Flash block and other resources within the Flash module.
21.4.5.5 EEPROM Commands
Table 21-31 summarizes the valid EEPROM commands along with the effects of the commands on the
EEPROM block.
Table 21-30. P-Flash Commands
FCMD Command Function on P-Flash Memory
0x01 Erase Verify All
Blocks
Verify that all P-Flash (and EEPROM) blocks are erased.
0x02 Erase Verify Block Verify that a P-Flash block is erased.
0x03 Erase Verify P-
Flash Section
Verify that a given number of words starting at the address provided are erased.
0x04 Read Once Read a dedicated 64 byte field in the nonvolatile information register in P-Flash block that
was previously programmed using the Program Once command.
0x06 Program P-Flash Program a phrase in a P-Flash block.
0x07 Program Once Program a dedicated 64 byte field in the nonvolatile information register in P-Flash block
that is allowed to be programmed only once.
0x08 Erase All Blocks
Erase all P-Flash (and EEPROM) blocks.
An erase of all Flash blocks is only possible when the FPLDIS, FPHDIS, and FPOPEN
bits in the FPROT register and the DPOPEN bit in the DFPROT register are set prior to
launching the command.
0x09 Erase Flash Block
Erase a P-Flash (or EEPROM) block.
An erase of the full P-Flash block is only possible when FPLDIS, FPHDIS and FPOPEN
bits in the FPROT register are set prior to launching the command.
0x0A Erase P-Flash
Sector
Erase all bytes in a P-Flash sector.
0x0B Unsecure Flash Supports a method of releasing MCU security by erasing all P-Flash (and EEPROM)
blocks and verifying that all P-Flash (and EEPROM) blocks are erased.
0x0C Verify Backdoor
Access Key
Supports a method of releasing MCU security by verifying a set of security keys.
0x0D Set User Margin
Level
Specifies a user margin read level for all P-Flash blocks.
0x0E Set Field Margin
Level
Specifies a field margin read level for all P-Flash blocks (special modes only).
0x13 Protection
Override
Supports a mode to temporarily override Protection configuration (for P-Flash and/or
EEPROM) by verifying a key.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 723
21.4.6 Allowed Simultaneous P-Flash and EEPROM Operations
Only the operations marked ‘OK’ in Table 21-32 are permitted to be run simultaneously on the Program
Flash and EEPROM blocks. Some operations cannot be executed simultaneously because certain
hardware resources are shared by the two memories. The priority has been placed on permitting Program
Flash reads while program and erase operations execute on the EEPROM, providing read (P-Flash ) while
write (EEPROM) functionality. Any attempt to access P-Flash and EEPROM simultaneously when it is
not allowed will result in an illegal access that will trigger a machine exception in the CPU (please look
into the Reference Manual for details). Please note that during the execution of each command there is a
period, before the operation in the Flash array actually starts, where reading is allowed and valid data is
returned. Even if the simultaneous operation is marked as not allowed the Flash will report an illegal access
only in the cycle the read collision actually happens, maximizing the time the array is available for reading.
Table 21-31. EEPROM Commands
FCMD Command Function on EEPROM Memory
0x01 Erase Verify All
Blocks
Verify that all EEPROM (and P-Flash) blocks are erased.
0x02 Erase Verify Block Verify that the EEPROM block is erased.
0x08 Erase All Blocks
Erase all EEPROM (and P-Flash) blocks.
An erase of all Flash blocks is only possible when the FPLDIS, FPHDIS, and FPOPEN
bits in the FPROT register and the DPOPEN bit in the DFPROT register are set prior to
launching the command.
0x09 Erase Flash Block
Erase a EEPROM (or P-Flash) block.
An erase of the full EEPROM block is only possible when DPOPEN bit in the DFPROT
register is set prior to launching the command.
0x0B Unsecure Flash Supports a method of releasing MCU security by erasing all EEPROM (and P-Flash)
blocks and verifying that all EEPROM (and P-Flash) blocks are erased.
0x0D Set User Margin
Level
Specifies a user margin read level for the EEPROM block.
0x0E Set Field Margin
Level
Specifies a field margin read level for the EEPROM block (special modes only).
0x10 Erase Verify
EEPROM Section
Verify that a given number of words starting at the address provided are erased.
0x11 Program
EEPROM
Program up to four words in the EEPROM block.
0x12 Erase EEPROM
Sector
Erase all bytes in a sector of the EEPROM block.
0x13 Protection
Override
Supports a mode to temporarily override Protection configuration (for P-Flash and/or
EEPROM) by verifying a key.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
724 Freescale Semiconductor
21.4.7 Flash Command Description
This section provides details of all available Flash commands launched by a command write sequence. The
ACCERR bit in the FSTAT register will be set during the command write sequence if any of the following
illegal steps are performed, causing the command not to be processed by the Memory Controller:
Starting any command write sequence that programs or erases Flash memory before initializing the
FCLKDIV register
Writing an invalid command as part of the command write sequence
For additional possible errors, refer to the error handling table provided for each command
If a Flash block is read during execution of an algorithm (CCIF = 0) on that same block, the read operation
may return invalid data resulting in an illegal access (as described on Section 21.4.6).
If the ACCERR or FPVIOL bits are set in the FSTAT register, the user must clear these bits before starting
any command write sequence (see Section 21.3.2.7).
CAUTION
A Flash word or phrase must be in the erased state before being
programmed. Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash word or
phrase is not allowed.
21.4.7.1 Erase Verify All Blocks Command
The Erase Verify All Blocks command will verify that all P-Flash and EEPROM blocks have been erased.
Table 21-32. Allowed P-Flash and EEPROM Simultaneous Operations
EEPROM
Program Flash Rea d Margin
Read2Program Sector
Erase Mass
Erase2
Read OK(1)
1. Strictly speaking, only one read of either the P-Flash or EEPROM can occur
at any given instant, but the memory controller will transparently arbitrate P-
Flash and EEPROM accesses giving uninterrupted read access whenever
possible.
OK OK OK
Margin Read(2)
2. A ‘Margin Read’ is any read after executing the margin setting commands ‘Set
User Margin Level’ or ‘Set Field Margin Level’ with anything but the ‘normal’
level specified. See the Note on margin settings in Section 21.4.7.12 and
Section 21.4.7.13.
Program
Sector Erase
Mass Erase(3)
3. The ‘Mass Erase’ operations are commands ‘Erase All Blocks’ and ‘Erase
Flash Block’
OK
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 725
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify All Blocks command, the Memory Controller will verify
that the entire Flash memory space is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify All Blocks
operation has completed. If all blocks are not erased, it means blank check failed, both MGSTAT bits will
be set.
21.4.7.2 Erase Verify Block Command
The Erase Verify Block command allows the user to verify that an entire P-Flash or EEPROM block has
been erased.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify Block command, the Memory Controller will verify that
the selected P-Flash or EEPROM block is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify Block
operation has completed.If the block is not erased, it means blank check failed, both MGSTAT bits will be
set.
Table 21-33. Erase Verify All Blocks Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x01 Not required
Table 21-34. Erase Verify All Blocks Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 000 at command launch
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the reador if blank check failed .
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read or if
blank check failed.
Table 21-35. Erase Verify Block Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x02 Global address [23:16] to
identify Flash block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] to identify Flash block
Table 21-36. Erase Verify Block Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied see Table 21-3)
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the read or if blank check failed.
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read or if
blank check failed.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
726 Freescale Semiconductor
21.4.7.3 Erase Verify P-Flash Section Command
The Erase Verify P-Flash Section command will verify that a section of code in the P-Flash memory is
erased. The Erase Verify P-Flash Section command defines the starting point of the code to be verified and
the number of phrases.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify P-Flash Section command, the Memory Controller will
verify the selected section of Flash memory is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify P-Flash
Section operation has completed. If the section is not erased, it means blank check failed, both MGSTAT
bits will be set.
21.4.7.4 Read Once Command
The Read Once command provides read access to a reserved 64 byte field (8 phrases) located in the
nonvolatile information register of P-Flash. The Read Once field is programmed using the Program Once
command described in Section 21.4.7.6. The Read Once command must not be executed from the Flash
block containing the Program Once reserved field to avoid code runaway.
Table 21-37. Erase Verify P-Flash Section Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x03 Global address [23:16] of
a P-Flash block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] of the first phrase to be verified
FCCOB2 Number of phrases to be verified
Table 21-38. Erase Verify P-Flash Section Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 010 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied see Table 21-3)
Set if a misaligned phrase address is supplied (global address [2:0] != 000)
Set if the requested section crosses a the P-Flash address boundary
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the read or if blank check failed.
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read or if
blank check failed.
Table 21-39. Read Once Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x04 Not Required
FCCOB1 Read Once phrase index (0x0000 - 0x0007)
FCCOB2 Read Once word 0 value
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 727
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Read Once command, a Read Once phrase is fetched and stored in the
FCCOB indexed register. The CCIF flag will set after the Read Once operation has completed. Valid
phrase index values for the Read Once command range from 0x0000 to 0x0007. During execution of the
Read Once command, any attempt to read addresses within P-Flash block will return invalid data.
8
21.4.7.5 Program P-Flash Command
The Program P-Flash operation will program a previously erased phrase in the P-Flash memory using an
embedded algorithm.
CAUTION
A P-Flash phrase must be in the erased state before being programmed.
Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash phrase is not allowed.
FCCOB3 Read Once word 1 value
FCCOB4 Read Once word 2 value
FCCOB5 Read Once word 3 value
Table 21-40. Read Once Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid phrase index is supplied
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the read
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read
Table 21-41. Program P-Flash Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x06 Global address [23:16] to
identify P-Flash block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] of phrase location to be programmed(1)
1. Global address [2:0] must be 000
FCCOB2 Word 0 program value
FCCOB3 Word 1 program value
FCCOB4 Word 2 program value
FCCOB5 Word 3 program value
Table 21-39. Read Once Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
728 Freescale Semiconductor
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Program P-Flash command, the Memory Controller will program the
data words to the supplied global address and will then proceed to verify the data words read back as
expected. The CCIF flag will set after the Program P-Flash operation has completed.
21.4.7.6 Program Once Command
The Program Once command restricts programming to a reserved 64 byte field (8 phrases) in the
nonvolatile information register located in P-Flash. The Program Once reserved field can be read using the
Read Once command as described in Section 21.4.7.4. The Program Once command must only be issued
once since the nonvolatile information register in P-Flash cannot be erased. The Program Once command
must not be executed from the Flash block containing the Program Once reserved field to avoid code
runaway.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Program Once command, the Memory Controller first verifies that the
selected phrase is erased. If erased, then the selected phrase will be programmed and then verified with
read back. The CCIF flag will remain clear, setting only after the Program Once operation has completed.
The reserved nonvolatile information register accessed by the Program Once command cannot be erased
and any attempt to program one of these phrases a second time will not be allowed. Valid phrase index
values for the Program Once command range from 0x0000 to 0x0007. During execution of the Program
Once command, any attempt to read addresses within P-Flash will return invalid data.
Table 21-42. Progra m P-Fl ash Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 101 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied see Table 21-3)
Set if a misaligned phrase address is supplied (global address [2:0] != 000)
FPVIOL Set if the global address [17:0] points to a protected area
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Table 21-43. Program Once Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x07 Not Required
FCCOB1 Program Once phrase index (0x0000 - 0x0007)
FCCOB2 Program Once word 0 value
FCCOB3 Program Once word 1 value
FCCOB4 Program Once word 2 value
FCCOB5 Program Once word 3 value
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 729
21.4.7.7 Erase All Blocks Command
The Erase All Blocks operation will erase the entire P-Flash and EEPROM memory space.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase All Blocks command, the Memory Controller will erase the entire
Flash memory space and verify that it is erased. If the Memory Controller verifies that the entire Flash
memory space was properly erased, security will be released. During the execution of this command
(CCIF=0) the user must not write to any Flash module register. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase All
Blocks operation has completed.
21.4.7.7.1 Erase All Pin
The functionality of the Erase All Blocks command is also available in an uncommanded fashion from the
soc_erase_all_req input pin on the Flash module. Refer to the Reference Manual for information on
control of soc_erase_all_req.
Table 21-44. Program Once Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 101 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid phrase index is supplied
Set if the requested phrase has already been programmed(1)
1. If a Program Once phrase is initially programmed to 0xFFFF_FFFF_FFFF_FFFF, the Program Once command will
be allowed to execute again on that same phrase.
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Table 21-45. Erase All Blocks Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x08 Not required
Table 21-46. Erase All Blocks Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 000 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
FPVIOL Set if any area of the P-Flash or EEPROM memory is protected
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
730 Freescale Semiconductor
The erase-all function requires the clock divider register FCLKDIV (see Section 21.3.2.1) to be loaded
before invoking this function using soc_erase_all_req input pin. Please refer to the Reference Manual for
information about the default value of FCLKDIV in case direct writes to register FCLKDIV are not
allowed by the time this feature is invoked. If FCLKDIV is not properly set the erase-all operation will not
execute and the ACCERR flag in FSTAT register will set. After the execution of the erase-all function the
FCLKDIV register will be reset and the value of register FCLKDIV must be loaded before launching any
other command afterwards.
Before invoking the erase-all function using the soc_erase_all_req pin, the ACCERR and FPVIOL flags
in the FSTAT register must be clear. When invoked from soc_erase_all_req the erase-all function will
erase all P-Flash memory and EEPROM memory space regardless of the protection settings. If the post-
erase verify passes, the routine will then release security by setting the SEC field of the FSEC register to
the unsecure state (see Section 21.3.2.2). The security byte in the Flash Configuration Field will be
programmed to the unsecure state (see Table 21-9). The status of the erase-all request is reflected in the
ERSAREQ bit in the FCNFG register (see Section 21.3.2.5). The ERSAREQ bit in FCNFG will be cleared
once the operation has completed and the normal FSTAT error reporting will be available as described
inTable 21-47.
At the end of the erase-all sequence Protection will remain configured as it was before executing the erase-
all function. If the application requires programming P-Flash and/or EEPROM after the erase-all function
completes, the existing protection limits must be taken into account. If protection needs to be disabled the
user may need to reset the system right after completing the erase-all function.
21.4.7.8 Erase Flash Block Command
The Erase Flash Block operation will erase all addresses in a P-Flash or EEPROM block.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Flash Block command, the Memory Controller will erase the
selected Flash block and verify that it is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Flash Block
operation has completed.
Table 21-47. Erase All Pin Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the erase verify operation, or
during the program verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the erase verify
operation, or during the program verify operation
Table 21-48. Erase Flash Block Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x09 Global address [23:16] to
identify Flash block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] in Flash block to be erased
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 731
21.4.7.9 Erase P-Flash Sector Command
The Erase P-Flash Sector operation will erase all addresses in a P-Flash sector.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase P-Flash Sector command, the Memory Controller will erase the
selected Flash sector and then verify that it is erased. The CCIF flag will be set after the Erase P-Flash
Sector operation has completed.
Table 21-49. Eras e Fl ash Bloc k Comman d Error Han d ling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied
Set if the supplied P-Flash address is not phrase-aligned or if the EEPROM
address is not word-aligned
FPVIOL Set if an area of the selected Flash block is protected
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Table 21-50. Erase P-F la s h Sect or Co mmand FCC OB Re qu i rem e nts
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x0A Global address [23:16] to identify
P-Flash block to be erased
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] anywhere within the sector to be erased.
Refer to Section 21.1.2.1 for the P-Flash sector size.
Table 21-51. Erase P-Flash Sector Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied see Table 21-3)
Set if a misaligned phrase address is supplied (global address [2:0] != 000)
FPVIOL Set if the selected P-Flash sector is protected
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
732 Freescale Semiconductor
21.4.7.10 Unsecure Flash Command
The Unsecure Flash command will erase the entire P-Flash and EEPROM memory space and, if the erase
is successful, will release security.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Unsecure Flash command, the Memory Controller will erase the entire
P-Flash and EEPROM memory space and verify that it is erased. If the Memory Controller verifies that
the entire Flash memory space was properly erased, security will be released. If the erase verify is not
successful, the Unsecure Flash operation sets MGSTAT1 and terminates without changing the security
state. During the execution of this command (CCIF=0) the user must not write to any Flash module
register. The CCIF flag is set after the Unsecure Flash operation has completed.
21.4.7.11 Verify Backdoo r Access Key Command
The Verify Backdoor Access Key command will only execute if it is enabled by the KEYEN bits in the
FSEC register (see Table 21-10). The Verify Backdoor Access Key command releases security if user-
supplied keys match those stored in the Flash security bytes of the Flash configuration field (see Table 21-
4). The Verify Backdoor Access Key command must not be executed from the Flash block containing the
backdoor comparison key to avoid code runaway.
Table 21-52. Unsecure Flash Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x0B Not required
Table 21-53. Unsecure Flash Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 000 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
FPVIOL Set if any area of the P-Flash or EEPROM memory is protected
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Table 21-54. Verify Backdoor Access Key Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x0C Not required
FCCOB1 Key 0
FCCOB2 Key 1
FCCOB3 Key 2
FCCOB4 Key 3
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 733
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Verify Backdoor Access Key command, the Memory Controller will
check the FSEC KEYEN bits to verify that this command is enabled. If not enabled, the Memory
Controller sets the ACCERR bit in the FSTAT register and terminates. If the command is enabled, the
Memory Controller compares the key provided in FCCOB to the backdoor comparison key in the Flash
configuration field with Key 0 compared to 0xFF_FE00, etc. If the backdoor keys match, security will be
released. If the backdoor keys do not match, security is not released and all future attempts to execute the
Verify Backdoor Access Key command are aborted (set ACCERR) until a reset occurs. The CCIF flag is
set after the Verify Backdoor Access Key operation has completed.
21.4.7.12 Set User Margin Level Command
The Set User Margin Level command causes the Memory Controller to set the margin level for future read
operations of the P-Flash or EEPROM block.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Set User Margin Level command, the Memory Controller will set the
user margin level for the targeted block and then set the CCIF flag.
NOTE
When the EEPROM block is targeted, the EEPROM user mar gin levels are
applied only to the EEPROM reads. However, when the P-Flash block is
targeted, the P-Flash user margin levels are applied to both P-Flash and
EEPROM reads. It is not possible to apply user margin levels to the P-Flash
block only.
Valid margin level settings for the Set User Margin Level command are defined in Table 21-57.
Table 21-55. Verify Backdoor Access Key Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 100 at command launch
Set if an incorrect backdoor key is supplied
Set if backdoor key access has not been enabled (KEYEN[1:0] != 10, see
Section 21.3.2.2)
Set if the backdoor key has mismatched since the last reset
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 None
MGSTAT0 None
Table 21-56. Set User Margin Level Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x0D Global address [23:16] to identify Flash
block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] to identify Flash block
FCCOB2 Margin level setting.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
734 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
User margin levels can be used to check that Flash memory contents have
adequate mar gin for normal leve l read operations. If unexpected results are
encountered when checking Flash memory contents at user margin levels, a
potential loss of information has been detected.
21.4.7.13 Set Field Margin Level Command
The Set Field Margin Level command, valid in special modes only, causes the Memory Controller to set
the margin level specified for future read operations of the P-Flash or EEPROM block.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Set Field Margin Level command, the Memory Controller will set the
field margin level for the targeted block and then set the CCIF flag.
Table 21-57. Valid Set User Margin Level Settings
FCCOB2 Level Description
0x0000 Return to Normal Level
0x0001 User Margin-1 Level(1)
1. Read margin to the erased state
0x0002 User Margin-0 Level(2)
2. Read margin to the programmed state
Table 21-58. Set User Margin Level Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 010 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied see Table 21-3)
Set if an invalid margin level setting is supplied
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 None
MGSTAT0 None
Table 21-59. Set Field Margin Level Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x0E Global address [23:16] to identify Flash
block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] to identify Flash block
FCCOB2 Margin level setting.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 735
NOTE
When the EEPROM block is targeted, the EEPROM field margin levels are
applied only to the EEPROM reads. However, when the P-Flash block is
targeted, the P-Flash field margin levels are applied to both P-Flash and
EEPROM reads. It is not possible to apply field margin levels to the P-Flash
block only.
Valid margin level settings for the Set Field Margin Level command are defined in Table 21-60.
CAUTION
Field margin levels must only be used during verify of the initial factory
programming.
NOTE
Field margin levels can be used to check that Flash memory contents have
adequate margin for data retention at the normal level setting. If unexpected
results are encountered when checking Flash memory contents at field
margin levels, the Flash memory contents should be erased and
reprogrammed.
Table 21-60. Valid Set Field Margin Level Settings
FCCOB2 Level Description
0x0000 Return to Normal Level
0x0001 User Margin-1 Level(1)
1. Read margin to the erased state
0x0002 User Margin-0 Level(2)
2. Read margin to the programmed state
0x0003 Field Margin-1 Level1
0x0004 Field Margin-0 Level2
Table 21-61. Set Field Margin Level Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 010 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied see Table 21-3)
Set if an invalid margin level setting is supplied
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 None
MGSTAT0 None
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
736 Freescale Semiconductor
21.4.7.14 Erase Verify EEPROM Section Command
The Erase Verify EEPROM Section command will verify that a section of code in the EEPROM is erased.
The Erase Verify EEPROM Section command defines the starting point of the data to be verified and the
number of words.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify EEPROM Section command, the Memory Controller will
verify the selected section of EEPROM memory is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify
EEPROM Section operation has completed. If the section is not erased, it means blank check failed, both
MGSTAT bits will be set.
21.4.7.15 Program EEPROM Command
The Program EEPROM operation programs one to four previously erased words in the EEPROM block.
The Program EEPROM operation will confirm that the targeted location(s) were successfully programmed
upon completion.
CAUTION
A Flash word must be in the erased state before being programmed.
Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash word is not allowed.
Table 21-62. Erase Verify EEPROM Section Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x10
Global address [23:16] to
identify the EEPROM
block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] of the first word to be verified
FCCOB2 Number of words to be verified
Table 21-63. Erase Verify EEPROM Section Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 010 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied
Set if a misaligned word address is supplied (global address [0] != 0)
Set if the requested section breaches the end of the EEPROM block
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the read or if blank check failed.
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read or if
blank check failed.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 737
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Program EEPROM command, the user-supplied words will be
transferred to the Memory Controller and be programmed if the area is unprotected. The CCOBIX index
value at Program EEPROM command launch determines how many words will be programmed in the
EEPROM block. The CCIF flag is set when the operation has completed.
21.4.7.16 Erase EEPROM Sector Command
The Erase EEPROM Sector operation will erase all addresses in a sector of the EEPROM block.
Table 21-64. Program EEPROM Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x11 Global address [23:16] to
identify the EEPROM block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] of word to be programmed
FCCOB2 Word 0 program value
FCCOB3 Word 1 program value, if desired
FCCOB4 Word 2 program value, if desired
FCCOB5 Word 3 program value, if desired
Table 21-65. Program EEPROM Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] < 010 at command launch
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] > 101 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is supplied
Set if a misaligned word address is supplied (global address [0] != 0)
Set if the requested group of words breaches the end of the EEPROM block
FPVIOL Set if the selected area of the EEPROM memory is protected
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Table 2 1-66. Erase EEPROM Sector Command FCCOB Requirements
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x12 Global address [23:16] to identify
EEPROM block
FCCOB1 Global address [15:0] anywhere within the sector to be erased.
See Section 21.1.2.2 for EEPROM sector size.
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
738 Freescale Semiconductor
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase EEPROM Sector command, the Memory Controller will erase the
selected Flash sector and verify that it is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase EEPROM Sector
operation has completed.
21.4.7.17 Protection Override Command
The Protection Override command allows the user to temporarily override the protection limits, either
decreasing, increasing or disabling protection limits, on P-Flash and/or EEPROM, if the comparison key
provided as a parameter loaded on FCCOB matches the value of the key previously programmed on the
Flash Configuration Field (see Table 21-4). The value of the Protection Override Comparison Key must
not be 16’hFFFF, that is considered invalid and if used as argument will cause the Protection Override
feature to be disabled. Any valid key value that does not match the value programmed in the Flash
Configuration Field will cause the Protection Override feature to be disabled. Current status of the
Protection Override feature can be observed on FPSTAT FPOVRD bit (see Section 21.3.2.4, “Flash
Protection Status Register (FPSTAT)).
Table 21-67. Erase EEPROM Sector Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29)
Set if an invalid global address [23:0] is suppliedsee Table 21-3
Set if a misaligned word address is supplied (global address [0] != 0)
FPVIOL Set if the selected area of the EEPROM memory is protected
MGSTAT1 Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
MGSTAT0 Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify
operation
Table 21-68. Protection Override Command FCCOB Requirement s
Register FCCOB Parameters
FCCOB0 0x13 Protection Update Selection
[1:0] See Table 21-69
FCCOB1 Comparison Key
FCCOB2 reserved New FPROT value
FCCOB3 reserved New DFPROT value
Table 21-69. Protection Override selection description
Protection Update
Selection code [1:0] Protection register se lection
bit 0
Update P-Flash protection
0 - keep unchanged (do not update)
1 - update P-Flash protection with new FPROT value loaded on FCCOB
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 739
If the comparison key successfully matches the key programmed in the Flash Configuration Field the
Protection Override command will preserve the current values of registers FPROT and DFPROT stored in
an internal area and will override these regis ters as selected by the Protection Update Selection field with
the value(s) loaded on FCCOB parameters. The new values loaded into FPROT and/or DFPROT can
reconfigure protection without any restriction (by increasing, decreasing or disabling protection limits). If
the command executes successfully the FPSTAT FPOVRD bit will set.
If the comparison key does not match the key programmed in the Flash Configuration Field, or if the key
loaded on FCCOB is 16’hFFFF, the value of registers FPROT and DFPROT will be restored to their
original contents before executing the Protection Override command and the FPSTAT FPOVRD bit will
be cleared. If the contents of the Protection Override Comparison Key in the Flash Configuration Field is
left in the erased state (i.e. 16’hFFFF) the Protection Override feature is permanently disabled. If the
command execution is flagged as an error (ACCERR being set for incorrect command launch) the values
of FPROT and DFPROT will not be modified.
The Protection Override command can be called multiple times and every time it is launched it will
preserve the current values of registers FPROT and DFPROT in a single-entry buffer to be restored later;
when the Protection Override command is launched to restore FPROT and DFPROT these registers will
assume the values they had before executing the Protection Override command on the last time. If contents
of FPROT and/or DFPROT registers were modified by direct register writes while protection is overridden
these modifications will be lost. Running Protection Override command to restore the contents of registers
FPROT and DFPROT will not force them to the reset values.
bit 1
Update EEPROM protection
0 - keep unchanged (do not update)
1 - update EEPROM protection with new DFPROT value loaded on FCCOB
Table 21-70. Protection Override Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition
FSTAT
ACCERR
Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != (001, 010 or 011) at command launch.
Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 21-29).
Set if protection is supposed to be restored (if key does not match or is invalid) and
Protection Override command was not run previously (bit FPSTAT FPOVRD is 0),
so there are no previous valid values of FPROT and DFPROT to be re-loaded.
Set if Protection Update Selection[1:0] = 00 (in case of CCOBIX[2:0] = 010 or 011)
Set if Protection Update Selection[1:0] = 00, CCOBIX[2:0] = 001 and a valid
comparison key is loaded as a command parameter.
FPVIOL None
MGSTAT1 None
MGSTAT0 None
Table 21-69. Protection Override selection description
Protection Update
Selection code [1:0] Protection register se lection
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
740 Freescale Semiconductor
21.4.8 Interrupts
The Flash module can generate an interrupt when a Flash command operation has completed or when a
Flash command operation has detected an ECC fault.
NOTE
Vector addresses and their relative interrupt priority are determined at the
MCU level.
21.4.8.1 Description of Flash Interrupt Operation
The Flash module uses the CCIF flag in combination with the CCIE interrupt enable bit to generate the
Flash command interrupt request. The Flash module uses the SFDIF flag in combination with the SFDIE
interrupt enable bits to generate the Flash error interrupt request. For a detailed description of the register
bits involved, refer to Section 21.3.2.5, “Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG)”, Section 21.3.2.6, “Flash
Error Configuration Register (FERCNFG)”, Section 21.3.2.7, “Flash Status Register (FSTAT)”, and
Section 21.3.2.8, “Flash Error Status Register (FERSTAT)”.
The logic used for generating the Flash module interrupts is shown in Figure 21-31.
Figure 21-31. Flash Module Interrupts Implementation
21.4.9 Wait Mode
The Flash module is not affected if the MCU enters wait mode. The Flash module can recover the MCU
from wait via the CCIF interrupt (see Section 21.4.8, “Interrupts”).
Table 21-71. Flash Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Source Interrupt Flag Local Enable Global (CCR)
Mask
Flash Command Complete CCIF
(FSTAT register)
CCIE
(FCNFG register)
I Bit
ECC Single Bit Fault on Flash Read SFDIF
(FERSTAT register)
SFDIE
(FERCNFG register)
I Bit
Flash Error Interrupt Request
CCIF
CCIE
SFDIF
SFDIE
Flash Command Interrupt Request
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 741
21.4.10 Stop Mode
If a Flash command is active (CCIF = 0) when the MCU requests stop mode, the current Flash operation
will be completed before the MCU is allowed to enter stop mode.
21.5 Security
The Flash module provides security information to the MCU. The Flash security state is defined by the
SEC bits of the FSEC register (see Table 21-11). During reset, the Flash module initializes the FSEC
register using data read from the security byte of the Flash configuration field at global address
0xFF_FE0F. The security state out of reset can be permanently changed by programming the security byte
assuming that the MCU is starting from a mode where the necessary P-Flash erase and program commands
are available and that the upper region of the P-Flash is unprotected. If the Flash security byte is
successfully programmed, its new value will take affect after the next MCU reset.
The following subsections describe these security-related subjects:
Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access
Unsecuring the MCU in Special Single Chip Mode using BDM
.Mode and Security Effects on Flash Command Availability
21.5.1 Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access
The MCU may be unsecured by using the backdoor key access feature which requires knowledge of the
contents of the backdoor keys (four 16-bit words programmed at addresses 0xFF_FE00-0xFF_FE07). If
the KEYEN[1:0] bits are in the enabled state (see Section 21.3.2.2), the Verify Backdoor Access Key
command (see Section 21.4.7.11) allows the user to present four prospective keys for comparison to the
keys stored in the Flash memory via the Memory Controller. If the keys presented in the Verify Backdoor
Access Key command match the backdoor keys stored in the Flash memory, the SEC bits in the FSEC
register (see Table 21-11) will be changed to unsecure the MCU. Key values of 0x0000 and 0xFFFF are
not permitted as backdoor keys. While the Verify Backdoor Access Key command is active, P-Flash
memory and EEPROM memory will not be available for read access and will return invalid data.
The user code stored in the P-Flash memory must have a method of receiving the backdoor keys from an
external stimulus. This external stimulus would typically be through one of the on-chip serial ports.
If the KEYEN[1:0] bits are in the enabled state (see Section 21.3.2.2), the MCU can be unsecured by the
backdoor key access sequence described below:
1. Follow the command sequence for the Verify Backdoor Access Key command as explained in
Section 21.4.7.11
2. If the Verify Backdoor Access Key command is successful, the MCU is unsecured and the
SEC[1:0] bits in the FSEC register are forced to the unsecure state of 10
The Verify Backdoor Access Key command is monitored by the Memory Controller and an illegal key will
prohibit future use of the Verify Backdoor Access Key command. A reset of the MCU is the only method
Chapter 21 128 KB Flash Module (S12ZFTMRZ128K4KV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
742 Freescale Semiconductor
to re-enable the Verify Backdoor Access Key command. The security as defined in the Flash security byte
(0xFF_FE0F) is not changed by using the Verify Backdoor Access Key command sequence. The backdoor
keys stored in addresses 0xFF_FE00-0xFF_FE07 are unaffected by the Verify Backdoor Access Key
command sequence. The Verify Backdoor Access Key command sequence has no effect on the program
and erase protections defined in the Flash protection register, FPROT.
After the backdoor keys have been correctly matched, the MCU will be unsecured. After the MCU is
unsecured, the sector containing the Flash security byte can be erased and the Flash security byte can be
reprogrammed to the unsecure state, if desired. In the unsecure state, the user has full control of the
contents of the backdoor keys by programming addresses 0xFF_FE00-0xFF_FE07 in the Flash
configuration field.
21.5.2 Unsecuring the MCU in Special Single Chip Mode using BDM
A secured MCU can be unsecured in special single chip mode using an automated procedure described in
Section 21.4.7.7.1, “Erase All Pin”, For a complete description about how to activate that procedure please
look into the Reference Manual.
21.5.3 .Mode and Security Effects on Flash Command Availability
The availability of Flash module commands depends on the MCU operating mode and security state as
shown in Table 21-29.
21.6 Initialization
On each system reset the flash module executes an initialization sequence which establishes initial values
for the Flash Block Configuration Parameters, the FPROT and DFPROT protection registers, and the
FOPT and FSEC registers. The initialization routine reverts to built-in default values that leave the module
in a fully protected and secured state if errors are encountered during execution of the reset sequence. If a
double bit fault is detected during the reset sequence, both MGSTAT bits in the FSTAT register will be set.
CCIF is cleared throughout the initialization sequence. The Flash module holds off all CPU access for a
portion of the initialization sequence. Flash reads are allowed once the hold is removed. Completion of the
initialization sequence is marked by setting CCIF high which enables user commands.
If a reset occurs while any Flash command is in progress, that command will be immediately aborted. The
state of the word being programmed or the sector/block being erased is not guaranteed.
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 743
Chapter 22
CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
Table 22-1. Revision History Table
NOTE
The information given in this section are preliminary and should be used as
a guide only. Values in this section cannot be guaranteed by Freescale and
are subject to change without notice.
22.1 Introduction
The CAN Physical Layer provides a physical layer for high speed CAN area network communication in
automotive applications. It serves as an integrated interface to the CAN bus lines for the internally
connected MSCAN controller through the pins CANH, CANL and SPLIT.
The CAN Physical Layer is designed to meet the CAN Physical Layer ISO 11898-2 and ISO 11898-5
standards.
22.1.1 Features
The CAN Physical Layer module includes these distinctive features:
High speed CAN interface for baud rates of up to 1 Mbit/s
ISO 11898-2 and ISO 11898-5 compliant for 12 V battery systems
SPLIT pin driver for bus recessive level stabilization
Low power mode with remote CAN wake-up handled by MSCAN module
Over-current shutdown for CANH and CANL
Voltage monitoring on CANH and CANL
CPTXD-dominant timeout feature monitoring the CPTXD signal
Fulfills the OEM “Hardware Requirements for (LIN,) CAN (and FlexRay) Interfaces in
Automotive Applications” v1.3
Revision
Number Revision Date Sections
Affected Descriptio n o f Changes
V02.00 05 Nov 2012 Added CPTXD-dominant timeout feature
V02.01 10 Jul 2013 Minor orthographical corrections
V02.02 10 Jul 2013 Removed reference to CPMU section for RPM definition
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
744 Freescale Semiconductor
22.1.2 Modes of Operation
The following modes can be taken by the CAN Physical Layer (refer to 22.5.2 for details):
1. Shutdown mode
In shutdown mode the CAN Physical Layer is fully de-biased including the wake-up receiver.
2. Normal mode
In normal mode the transceiver is fully biased and functional. The SPLIT pin drives 2.5 V if
enabled.
3. Pseudo-normal mode
Same as normal mode with CANL driver disabled.
4. Listen-only mode
Same as normal mode with transmitter de-biased.
5. Standby mode with configurable wake-up feature
In standby mode the transceiver is fully de-biased. The wake-up receiver is enabled out of reset.
22.1.3 Block Diagram
Figure 22-1 shows a block diagram of the CAN Physical Layer. The module consists of a precision
receiver, a low-power wake-up receiver, an output driver and diagnostics.
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 745
Figure 22-1. CAN Physical Layer Block Diagram
22.2 External Signal Description
Table 22-2 shows the external pins associated with the CAN Physical Layer.
Table 22-2. CAN Physical Layer Signal Properties
Name Function
CANH CAN Bus High Pin
SPLIT 2.5 V Termination Pin
CANL CAN Bus Low Pin
VDDC Supply Pin for CAN Physical Layer
VSSC Ground Pin for CAN Physical Layer
VDDC
2.5V
CPRXD
CPTXD
CHOCIF
CLOCIF
0V
CANH
SPLIT
CANL
0V
5V
0V
5V
CLVL
CLVH
CHVL
CHVH
CAN BUS
Normal/Shutdown/
SPE
VSSC
Interrupt
Standby mode
intern.
mid
point
high-z
Time
out
CPDTIF
Generation
Precision
Receiver
Wake-up
Receiver
Standby
0
1
Mode
Status
Change
Status
Change
Status
Change
Status
Change
CLVLIF
CLVHIF
CHVLIF
CHVHIF
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
746 Freescale Semiconductor
22.2.1 CANH — CAN Bus High Pin
The CANH signal either connects directly to CAN bus high line or through an optional external common
mode choke.
22.2.2 CANL — CAN Bus Low Pin
The CANL signal either connects directly to CAN bus low line or through an optional external common
mode choke.
22.2.3 SPLIT — CAN Bus Te rmination Pin
The SPLIT pin can drive a 2.5 V bias for bus termination purpose (CAN bus middle point). Usage of this
pin is optional and depends on bus termination strategy for a given bus network.
22.2.4 VDDC — Supply Pin for CAN Physical Layer
The VDDC pin is used to supply the CAN Physical Layer with 5 V from an external source.
22.2.5 VSSC — Ground Pin for CAN Physical Layer
The VSSC pin is the return path for the 5 V supply (VDDC).
22.3 Internal Signal Description
22.3.1 CPTXD — TXD Input to CAN Physical Layer
CPTXD is the input signal to the CAN Physical Layer. A logic 1 on this input is considered CAN recessive
and a logic 0 as dominant level.
Per default, CPTXD is connected device-internally to the TXCAN transmitter output of the MSCAN
module. For optional routing options consult the device level documentation.
22.3.2 CPRXD — RXD Output of CAN Physical Layer
CPRXD is the output signal of the CAN Physical Layer. A logic 1 on this output represents CAN recessive
and a logic 0 a dominant level.
In stand-by mode the wake-up receiver is routed to this output. In any other mode this signal defaults to
the precision receiver.
Per default, CPRXD is connected device-internally to the RXCAN receiver input of the MSCAN module.
For optional routing options consult the device level documentation.
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 747
22.4 Memory Map and Register Definition
22.4.1 This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the CAN Physical
Layer.Module Memory Map
A summary of the registers associated with the CAN Physical Layer sub-block is shown in Table 22-3.
Detailed descriptions of the registers and bits are given in the following sections.
NOTE
Register Address = Module Base Address + Address Offset, where the
Module Base Address is defined at the MCU level and the Address Offset
is defined at the module level.
Address
Offset Register
Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000 CPDR RCPDR700000
CPDR1 CPDR0
W
0x0001 CPCR RCPE SPE WUPE 00
SLR2 SLR1 SLR0
W
0x0002 Reserved RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0003 CPSR R CPCHVH CPCHVL CPCLVH CPCLVL CPDT 0 0 0
W
0x0004 Reserved RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0005 Reserved RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0006 CPIE R0 0 0 CPVFIE CPDTIE 00
CPOCIE
W
0x0007 CPIF RCHVHIF CHVLIF CLVHIF CLVLIF CPDTIF 0CHOCIF CLOCIF
W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Table 22-3. CAN Physical Layer Register Summary
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
748 Freescale Semiconductor
22.4.2 Register Descriptions
This section describes all CAN Physical Layer registers and their individual bits.
22.4.2.1 Port CP Data Register (CPDR)
Module Base + 0x0000 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
RCPDR700000
CPDR1 CPDR0
W
Reset10000011
Figure 22-2. Port CP Data Register (CPDR)
Table 22-4. CPDR Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CPDR7
Port CP Data Bit 7
Read-only bit. The synchronized CAN Physical Layer wake-up receiver output can be read at any time.
1
CPDR1
Port CP Data Bit 1
The CAN Physical Layer CPTXD input can be directly controlled through this register bit if routed here (see
device-level specification). In this case the register bit value is driven to the pin.
0 CPTXD is driven low (dominant)
1 CPTXD is driven high (recessive)
0
CPDR0
Port CP Data Bit 0
Read-only bit. The synchronized CAN Physical Layer CPRXD output state can be read at any time.
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 749
22.4.2.2 CAN Physical Layer Control Register (CPCR)
Module Base + 0x0001 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime except CPE which is set once
76543210
RCPE SPE WUPE 00
SLR2 SLR1 SLR0
W
Reset00100000
Figure 22-3. CAN Physical Layer Control Register (CPCR)
Table 22-5. CPCR Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CPE
CAN Physical Layer Enable
Set once. If set to 1, the CAN Physical Layer exits shutdown mode and enters normal mode.
0 CAN Physical Layer is disabled (shutdown mode)
1 CAN Physical Layer is enabled
6
SPE
Split Enable
If set to 1, the CAN Physical Layer SPLIT pin drives a 2.5 V bias in normal and listen-only mode.
0 SPLIT pin is high-impedance
1 SPLIT pin drives a 2.5 V bias
5
WUPE
Wake-Up Receiver Enable
If set to 1, the CAN Physical Layer wake-up receiver is enabled when not in shutdown mode. To save additional
power, this bit should be set to 0, if the CAN bus is not used to wake up the device.
0 Wake-up receiver is disabled
1 Wake-up receiver is enabled
2-0
SLR2-0
Slew Rate
The slew rate controls recessive to dominant and dominant to recessive transitions. This affects the delay time
from CPTXD to the bus and from the bus to CPRXD. The loop time is thus affected by the slew rate selection.
Six slew rates are available:
000 CAN Physical Layer slew rate 0
001 CAN Physical Layer slew rate 1
010 CAN Physical Layer slew rate 2
011 Reserved
100 CAN Physical Layer slew rate 4
101 CAN Physical Layer slew rate 5
110 CAN Physical Layer slew rate 6
111 R eserved
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
750 Freescale Semiconductor
22.4.2.3 Reserved Register
NOTE
This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only and is not
intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in special
modes can alter the modules functionality.
22.4.2.4 CAN Physical Layer Status Register (CPSR)
Module Base + 0x0002 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Only in special mode
76543210
RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Resetxxxxxxxx
Figure 22-4. Reserved Register
Module Base + 0x0003 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Never
76543210
R CPCHVH CPCHVL CPCLVH CPCLVL CPDT 0 0 0
W
Reset00000000
Figure 22-5. CAN Physical Layer Status Re gister (CPSR)
Table 22-6. CPSR Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CPCHVH
CANH Voltage Failure High Status Bit
This bit reflects the CANH voltage failure high monitor status.
0 Condition VCANH VH5
1 Condition VCANH VH5
6
CPCHVL
CANH Voltage Failure Low Status Bit
This bit reflects the CANH voltage failure low monitor status.
0 Condition VCANH VH0
1 Condition VCANH VH0
5
CPCLVH
CANL Voltage Failure High Status Bit
This bit reflects the CANL voltage failure high monitor status.
0 Condition VCANL VL5
1 Condition VCANL VL5
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 751
4
CPCLVL
CANL Voltage Failure Low Status Bit
This bit reflects the CANL voltage failure low monitor status.
0 Condition VCANL VL0
1 Condition VCANL VL0
3
CPDT
CPTXD-Dominant Timeout Status Bit
This bit is set to 1, if CPTXD is dominant for longer than tCPTXDDT. It signals a timeout event and remains set
until CPTXD returns to recessive level for longer than 1 s.
0 No CPTXD-timeout occurred or CPTXD has ceased to be dominant after timeout
1 CPTXD-dominant timeout occurred and CPTXD is still dominant
Table 22-6. CPSR Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
752 Freescale Semiconductor
22.4.2.5 Reserved Register
22.4.2.6 Reserved Register
22.4.2.7 CAN Physical Layer Interrupt Enable Register (CPIE)
Module Base + 0x0004 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Only in special mode
NOTE
This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only and is not
intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in special
modes can alter the modules functionality.
76543210
R
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Resetxxxxxxxx
Figure 22-6. Reserved Register
Module Base + 0x0005 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Only in special mode
NOTE
This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only and is not
intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in special
modes can alter the modules functionality.
76543210
R
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Resetxxxxxxxx
Figure 22-7. Reserved Register
Module Base + 0x0006 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R0 0 0 CPVFIE CPDTIE 00
CPOCIE
W
Reset00000000
Figure 22-8. CAN Physical Layer Interrupt Enable Register (CPIE)
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 753
22.4.2.8 CAN Physical Layer Interrupt Flag Register (CPIF)
If any of the flags is asserted an error interrupt is pending if enabled. A flag can be cleared by writing a
logic level 1 to the corresponding bit location. Writing a 0 has no effect.
Table 22-7. CPIE Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
4
CPVFIE
CAN Physical Layer Voltage-Failure Interrupt Enable
If enabled, the CAN Physical Layer generates an interrupt if any of the CAN Physical Layer voltage failure
interrupt flags assert.
0 Voltage failure interrupt is disabled
1 Voltage failure interrupt is enabled
3
CPDTIE
CPTXD-Dominant Timeout Interrupt Enable
If enabled, the CAN Physical Layer generates an interrupt if the CPTXD-dominant timeout interrupt flag asserts.
0 CPTXD-dominant timeout interrupt is disabled
1 CPTXD-dominant timeout interrupt is enabled
0
CPOCIE
CAN Physical Layer Over-current Interrupt Enable
If enabled, the CAN Physical Layer generates an interrupt if any of the CAN Physical Layer over-current interrupt
flags assert.
0 Over-current interrupt is disabled
1 Over-current interrupt is enabled
Module Base + 0x0007 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime, write 1 to clear
76543210
RCHVHIF CHVLIF CLVHIF CLVLIF CPDTIF 0CHOCIF CLOCIF
W
Reset00000000
Figure 22-9. CAN Physical Layer Interrupt Flag Register (CPIF)
Table 22-8. CPIF Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
7
CHVHIF
CANH Voltage Failure High Interrupt Flag
This flag is set to 1 when the CPCHVH bit in the CAN Physical Layer Status Register (CPSR) changes.
0 No change in CPCHVH
1 CPCHVH has changed
6
CHVLIF
CANH Voltage Failure Low Interrupt Flag
This flag is set to 1 when the CPCHVL bit in the CAN Physical Layer Status Register (CPSR) changes.
0 No change in CPCHVL
1 CPCHVL has changed
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
754 Freescale Semiconductor
5
CLVHIF
CANL Voltage Failure High Inter rupt Flag
This flag is set to 1 when the CPCLVH bit in the CAN Physical Layer Status Register (CPSR) changes.
0 No change in CPCLVH
1 CPCLVH has changed
4
CLVLIF
CANL Voltage Failure Low Interr upt Flag
This flag is set to 1 when the CPCLVL bit in the CAN Physical Layer Status Register (CPSR) changes.
0 No change in CPCLVL
1 CPCLVL has changed
3
CPDTIF
CAN CPTXD-Dominant Timeout Interrupt Flag
This flag is set to 1 when CPTXD is dominant longer than tCPTXDDT. It signals a timeout event and entry of
listen-only mode disabling the transmitter.
Exit of listen-only mode which was entered at timeout is requested by clearing CPDTIF when CPDT is clear after
setting CPTXD to recessive state. It takes 1 to 2 s to return to normal mode.
If CPTXD is dominant or dominant timeout status is still active (CPDT=1) when clearing the flag, the CAN
Physical Layer remains in listen-only mode and this flag is set again after a delay (see 22.5.3.2, “CPTXD-
Dominant Timeout Interrupt”).
0 No CPTXD-dominant timeout has occurred
1 CPTXD-dominant timeout has occurred
1
CHOCIF
CANH Over-Current Interrupt Flag
This flag is set to 1 if an over current condition was detected on CANH when driving a dominant bit to the CAN
bus. While this flag is asserted the CAN Physical Layer remains in listen-only mode.
0 Normal current level ICANH < ICANHOC
1 Error event ICANH ICANHOC occurred
0
CLOCIF
CANL Over-Current Interrupt Flag
This flag is set to 1 if an over current condition was detected on CANL when driving a dominant bit to the CAN
bus. While this flag is asserted the CAN Physical Layer remains in listen-only mode.
0 Normal current level ICANL < ICANLOC
1 Error event ICANL ICANLOC occurred
Table 22-8. CPIF Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 755
22.5 Functional Description
22.5.1 General
The CAN Physical Layer provides an interface for the SoC integrated MSCAN controller.
22.5.2 Modes
Figure 22-10 shows the possible mode transitions depending on control bit CPE, device reduced
performance mode (“RPM”; refer to “Low Power Modes” section in device overview) and bus error
conditions.
Figure 22-10. CAN Physical Layer Mode Transitions
22.5.2.1 Shutdown Mode
Shutdown mode is a low power mode and entered out of reset. The transceiver, wake-up, bus error
diagnostic, dominant timeout and interrupt functionality are disabled. CANH and CANL lines are pulled
Normal
TRM: On, REC: On, WUP: WUPE
CANH, CANL: Driver on
SPLIT: SPE
Listen-only
TRM: Off, REC: On, WUP: WUPE
CANH, CANL: Driver off
SPLIT: SPE
A
A & CPCLVL
Shutdown
Reset
TRM: Off, REC: Off, WUP: Off
CANH,CANL: 30Kterm. to VSSC
SPLIT: High-impedance
Standby
TRM: Off, REC: Off, WUP: WUPE
CANH,CANL: 30K term. to VSSC
SPLIT: High-impedance
TRM: Transmitter
REC: Receiver
WUP: Wake-up receiver
CPE = 1
RPM
RPM & A & CPCLVL
A = (CPCHVH| CPCLVH| CHOCIF | CLOCIF| CPDTIF1)
RPM RPM & A
1: A delay after clearing CPDTIF must be accounted for (see description)
Pseudo-Normal
TRM: On, REC: On, WUP: WUPE
CANH: Driver on, CANL: Driver off
SPLIT: SPE
CPCLVL CPCLVL
RPM
RPM & A & CPCLVL
A
A & CPCLVL
& CPTXD=1
& CPTXD=1
RPM: Reduced performance mode
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
756 Freescale Semiconductor
to VSSC via high-ohmic input resistors of the receiver. The SPLIT pin as well as the internal mid-point
reference are set to high-impedance.
Shutdown mode cannot be re-entered until reset.
22.5.2.2 Normal Mode
In normal mode the full transceiver functionality is available. In this mode, the CAN bus is controlled by
the CPTXD input and the CAN bus state (recessive, dominant) is reported on the CPRXD output. The
voltage failure, over-current and CPTXD-dominant timeout monitors are enabled. The SPLIT pin is
driving a 2.5 V bias if enabled. The internal mid-point reference is set to 2.5 V.
If CPTXD is high, the transmit driver is set into recessive state, and CANH and CANL lines are biased to
the voltage set at VDDC divided by 2, approx. 2.5 V.
If CPTXD is low, the transmit driver is set into dominant state, and CANH and CANL drivers are active.
CANL is pulled low and CANH is pulled high.
The receiver reports the bus state on CPRXD. If the differential voltage VCANH minus VCANL at CANH
and CANL is below the internal threshold, the bus is recessive and CPRXD is set high, otherwise a
dominant bus is detected and CPRXD is set low.
When detecting a voltage high failure, over-current or CPTXD-dominant timeout event the CAN Physical
Layer enters listen-only mode. A voltage low failure on CANL results in entering pseudo-normal mode.
A voltage low failure on CANH maintains normal mode.
NOTE
After entering normal mode from shutdown of standby mode a settling time
of tCP_set must have passed until flags can be considered as valid.
22.5.2.3 Pseudo-Normal Mode
Pseudo-normal mode is identical to normal mode except for CANL driver being disabled as a result of a
voltage low failure that has been detected on the CANL bus line (CPCLVL=1). CANH remains functional
in this mode to allow transmission. Normal mode will automatically be re-entered after the error condition
has ceased.
22.5.2.4 Listen-only Mode
Listen-only mode is entered upon detecting a CAN bus error condition (except for CPCLVL=1) or
CPTXD-dominant timeout event. The entire transmitter is forced off. All other functions of the normal
mode are maintained.
Application software action is required to re-enter normal mode by clearing the related flags if the bus error
condition was caused by an over-current (refer to 22.6.3). In case of a voltage failure, normal mode will
automatically be re-entered if the condition has passed. If the listen-only mode was caused by CPTXD-
dominant timeout event, the related flag can only be cleared after the CPTXD has returned to recessive
level.
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 757
22.5.2.5 Standby Mode with Wake-Up Feature
Standby is a reduced current consumption mode and is entered during RPM following a stop mode request.
The transceiver and bus error diagnostics are disabled. The CPTXD-dominant timeout counter is stopped.
CANH and CANL lines are pulled to VSSC via high-ohmic input resistors of the receiver. The SPLIT pin
is set to high-impedance. The internal mid-point reference is set to 0V. All voltage failure and over-current
monitors are disabled.
If not configured off, the wake-up receiver can pass wake-up events from the CAN bus to the CPRXD
output.
The wake-up glitch filtering and pulse detection is handled by the MSCAN controller. The CAN Physical
Layer provides an asynchronous path to wake-up the MSCAN from sleep mode. If the device resides in
stop mode it can be woken-up via the same path. The wake-up specification of the MSCAN applies. Refer
to MSCAN chapter.
Standby is left as soon as the device returns from RPM.
22.5.3 Interrupts
This section describes the interrupt generated by the CAN Physical Layer and its individual sources.
Vector addresses and interrupt priorities are defined at MCU level. The module inter nal interrupt sources
are combined (OR-ed) into one module interrupt output CPI with a single local enable bit each for voltage
failure and over-current errors.
22.5.3.1 Voltage Failure Interrupts
A voltage failure error is detected if voltage levels on the CAN bus lines exceed the specified limits.
The voltages on both lines CANH and CANL are monitored continuously for crossing the lower and
higher thresholds, VH0, VH5 and VL0, VL5, respectively.
A comparator output transition to error level results in setting the corresponding status bit in CAN Physical
Layer Status Register (CPSR). A change of a status bit sets the related interrupt flag in CAN Physical
Layer Interrupt Flag Register (CPIF).
Table 22-9. CAN Physical Layer Interrupt Sources
Module Interrupt Source Module Internal Interrupt Source Local Enable
CAN Physical Layer Interrupt (CPI) CANH Voltage Failure High Interrupt (CHVHIF) CPVFIE = 1
CANH Voltage Failure Low Interrupt (CHVLIF)
CANL Voltage Failure High Interrupt (CLVHIF)
CANL Voltage Failure Low Interrupt (CLVLIF)
CPTXD-Dominant Timeout Interrupt (CPDTIF) CPDTIE = 1
CANH Over-Current Interrupt (CHOCIF) CPOCIE = 1
CANL Over-Current Interrupt (CLOCIF)
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
758 Freescale Semiconductor
The flags are used as interrupt sources of which either of the four can generate a CPI interrupt if the
common enable bit CPVFIE in CAN Physical Layer Interrupt Enable Register (CPIE) is set.
22.5.3.2 CPTXD-Dominant Timeout Interrupt
For network lock-up protection of the CAN bus, the CAN physical layer features a permanent CPTXD-
dominant timeout monitor. When the CPTXD signal has been dominant for more than tCPTXDDT the
transmitter is disabled by entering lis ten-only mode and the bus is released to recessive state. The CPDT
status and CPDTIF interrupt flags are both set.
To re-enable the transmitter, the CPDTIF flag must be cleared. If the CPTXD input is dominant or
dominant timeout status is still active (CPDT=1), the CAN Physical Layer stays in listen-only mode and
CPDTIF is set again after some microseconds to indicate that the attempt has failed. If CPTXD is recessive
and CPDT=0 it takes 1 to 2 s after clearing CPDTIF for returning to normal mode.
The flag is used as an interrupt source to generate a CPI interrupt if the enable bit CPDTIE in CAN
Physical Layer Interrupt Enable Register (CPIE) is set.
22.5.3.3 Over-Current Interrupt
An over- current error is detected if current levels on the CAN bus lines exceed the specified limits while
driving a dominant bit.
The current levels on both lines CANH and CANL are monitored continuously for crossing the thresholds
ICANHOC and ICANLOC, respectively.
A comparator output transition to error level results in setting the corresponding interrupt flag in CAN
Physical Layer Interrupt Flag Register (CPIF).
The flags are the direct interrupt sources of which either of the two can generate a CPI interrupt if the
common enable bit CPOCIE in CAN Physical Layer Interrupt Enable Register (CPIE) is set.
22.6 Initialization/Application Information
22.6.1 Initialization Sequence
Setup for immediate CAN communication:
1. Enable and configure MSCAN
2. Configure CAN Physical Layer slew rate
3. Enable CAN Physical Layer interrupts
4. Optionally enable SPLIT pin
5. Optionally disable wake-up receiver in case of other wake-up sources
6. Enable CAN Physical Layer to enter normal mode
7. Start CAN communication
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 759
22.6.2 Wake-up Mechanism
In standby mode the CAN Physical Layer passes the bus state to its CPRXD output without any signal
filtering if the wake-up receiver is enabled. In order to wake-up from standby mode upon CAN bus events
the implemented MSCAN module wake-up feature with glitch filtering is used if set up accordingly.
Refer to the MSCAN chapter for details on configuring and enabling the wake-up function.
22.6.3 Bus Error Handling
Upon CAN bus error voltage high failures and over-current events listen-only is entered immediately and
the transmitter is turned off. This mode is maintained as long as voltage failure conditions persist or, in
case of over-current events, application software re-enables the transmit driver by clearing the related
flags.
All high and low voltage levels for both CAN bus lines are continuously reflected in their related voltage
failure status bits. A change in a status bit sets the corresponding flag and generates an interrupt if enabled.
As long as any of the voltage failure high status bits is set, the transmit driver remains off. It will be turned
on again automatically as soon as all voltage failure conditions have disappeared. In case of a voltage
failure low condition on CANL only the CANL driver is disabled. A voltage failure low condition on
CANH has no effect on the transmitter.
Voltage failure errors have informational purpose. If the application detects frequent CAN protocol errors
it is advisable to take the appropriate action. No software action is need to re-enable the transmit driver.
An over-current event on either CAN bus line sets the related flag and turns off the transmit driver. This
error can only be detected while driving the bus dominant. In contrast to the voltage failure the over-current
condition instantaneously disappears as soon as the transmit driver is automatically being turned of f. This
state is locked and the application software must account for re-enabling the driver.
The recommended procedure to handle an over-current related bus error is:
1. On interrupt abort any scheduled transmissions
2. Read interrupt flag register to determine over-current source(s)
3. Clear related interrupt flag(s)
4. Retry CAN transmission
5. On interrupt abort any scheduled transmissions
6. Read interrupt flag register to determine over-current source(s)
7. If the same over-current error persists do not retry and run appropriate custom diagnostics
22.6.4 CPTXD-Dominant Timeout Recovery
Recovery from a CPTXD-dominant timeout error is attempted with the following sequence:
1. On CPTXD-dominant timeout interrupt set CPTXD input to recessive state
2. Wait until CPDT clear; exit loop if waiting for longer than 3 s and report malfunction
3. Clear CPDTIF
4. Wait for min. 2 s before attempting new transmission
Chapter 22 CAN Physical Layer (S12CANPHYV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
760 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 761
Chapter 23
Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
23.1 Introduction
The BATS module provides the functionality to measure the voltage of the battery supply pin VSENSE or
of the chip supply pin VSUP.
23.1.1 Features
Either One of the voltage present on the VSENSE or VSUP pin can be routed via an internal divider to the
internal Analog to Digital Converter. Independent of the routing to the Analog to Digital Converter, it is
possible to route one of these voltages to a comparator to generate a low or a high voltage interrupt to alert
the MCU.
23.1.2 Modes of Operation
The BATS module behaves as follows in the system power modes:
1. Run mode
The activation of the VSENSE Level Sense Enable (BSESE=1) or ADC connection Enable
(BSEAE=1) closes the path from the VSENSE pin through the resistor chain to ground and enables
the associated features if selected.
The activation of the VSUP Level Sense Enable (BSUSE=1) or ADC connection Enable
(BSUAE=1) closes the path from VSUP pin through the resistor chain to ground and enables the
associated features if selected.
BSESE takes precedence over BSUSE. BSEAE takes precedence over BSUAE.
2. Stop mode
During stop mode operation the path from the VSENSE pin through the resistor chain to ground is
opened and the low voltage sense features are disabled.
Table 23-1. Revision History Table
Rev. No.
(Item No.) Data Sections
Affected Substantial Change(s)
V01.00 15 Dec 2010 all Initial Version
V02.00 16 Mar 2011 23.3.2.1
23.4.2.1
- added BVLS[1] to support four voltage level
- moved BVHS to register bit 6
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
762 Freescale Semiconductor
During stop mode operation the path from the VSUP pin through the resistor chain to ground is
opened and the low voltage sense features are disabled.
The content of the configuration register is unchanged.
23.1.3 Block Diagram
Figure 23-1 shows a block diagram of the BATS module. See device guide for connectivity to ADC
channel.
Figure 23-1. BATS Block Diagram
23.2 External Signal Description
This section lists the name and description of all external ports.
23.2.1 VSENSE — Supply (Battery) Voltage Sense Pin
This pin can be connected to the supply (Battery) line for voltage measurements. The voltage present at
this input is scaled down by an internal voltage divider, and can be routed to the internal ADC or to a
VSENSE
to ADC
...
BVLC BVHC
VSUP
...
BSEAE BSUAE
BSESE BSUSE
BVHS
BVLS[1:0] Comparator
1 automatically closed if BSESE and/or BSEAE
is active, open during Stop mode
2 automatically closed if BSUSE and/or BSUAE
is active, open during Stop mode
12
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 763
comparator via an analog multiplexer. The pin itself is protected against reverse battery connections. To
protect the pin from external fast transients an external resistor (RVSENSE_R) is needed for protection.
23.2.2 VSUP — Voltage Supply Pin
This pin is the chip supply. It can be internally connected for voltage measurement. The voltage present at
this input is scaled down by an internal voltage divider, and can be routed to the internal ADC or to a
comparator via an analog multiplexer.
23.3 Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides the detailed information of all registers for the BATS module.
23.3.1 Register Summary
Figure 23-2 shows the summary of all implemented registers inside the BATS module.
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
764 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
Register Address = Module Base Address + Address Offset, where the
Module Base Address is defined at the MCU level and the Address Offset
is defined at the module level.
23.3.2 Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order . Each description includes a standard register
diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register
diagrams, in bit order. Unused bits read back zero.
Address Offset
Register Name Bit 7654321Bit 0
0x0000
BATE
R0
BVHS BVLS[1:0] BSUAE BSUSE BSEAE BSESE
W
0x0001
BATSR
R000000BVHCBVLC
W
0x0002
BATIE
R000000
BVHIE BVLIE
W
0x0003
BATIF
R000000
BVHIF BVLIF
W
0x0004 - 0x0005
Reserved
R00000000
W
0x0006 - 0x0007
Reserved
R
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
= Unimplemented
Figure 23-2. BATS Register Summary
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 765
23.3.2.1 BATS Module Enable Register (BATE)
NOTE
Module Base + 0x0000 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R0
BVHS BVLS[1:0] BSUAE BSUSE BSEAE BSESE
W
Reset00000001
= Unimplemented
Figure 23-3. BATS Module Enable Register (BATE)
Table 23-2. BATE Field Description
Field Description
6
BVHS
BATS Voltage High Select — This bit selects the trigger level for the Voltage Level High Condition (BVHC).
0 Voltage level VHBI1 is selected
1 Voltage level VHBI2 is selected
5:4
BVLS[1:0]
BATS Voltage Low Select — This bit selects the trigger level for the Voltage Level Low Condition (BVLC).
00 Voltage level VLBI1 is selected
01 Voltage level VLBI2 is selected
10 Voltage level VLBI3 is selected
11 Voltage level VLBI4 is selected
3
BSUAE
BATS VSUP ADC Connection Enable — This bit connects the VSUP pin through the resistor chain to ground
and connects the ADC channel to the divided down voltage. This bit can be set only if the BSEAE bit is cleared.
0 ADC Channel is disconnected
1 ADC Channel is connected
2
BSUSE
BATS VSUP Level Sense Enable — This bit connects the VSUP pin through the resistor chain to ground and
enables the Voltage Level Sense features measuring BVLC and BVHC. This bit can be set only if the BSESE bit
is cleared.
0 Level Sense features disabled
1 Level Sense features enabled
1
BSEAE
BATS VSENSE ADC Connection Enable — This bit connects the VSENSE pin through the resistor chain to
ground and connects the ADC channel to divided down voltage. Setting this bit will clear bit BSUAE .
0 ADC Channel is disconnected
1 ADC Channel is connected
0
BSESE
BATS VSENSE Level Sense Enable — This bit connects the VSENSE pin through the resistor chain to ground
and enables the Voltage Level Sense features measuring BVLC and BVHC.Setting this bit will clear bit BSUSE
0 Level Sense features disabled
1 Level Sense features enabled
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
766 Freescale Semiconductor
When opening the resistors path to ground by changing BSESE, BSEAE or
BSUSE, BSUAE then for a time TEN_UNC + two bus cycles the measured
value is invalid. This is to let internal nodes be charged to correct value.
BVHIE, BVLIE might be cleared for this time period to avoid false
interrupts.
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 767
23.3.2.2 BATS Module Status Register (BATSR)
Figure 23-5. BATS Voltage Sensing
Module Base + 0x0001 Access: User read only(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Never
76543210
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 BVHC BVLC
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 23-4. BATS Module Status Register (BATSR)
Table 23-3. BATSR - Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
1
BVHC
BATS V olt age Sense High Condition Bit This status bit indicates that a high voltage at VSENSE or VSUP,
depending on selection, is present.
0 Vmeasured VHBI_A (rising edge) or Vmeasured VHBI_D (falling edge)
1 Vmeasured VHBI_A (rising edge) or Vmeasured VHBI_D (falling edge)
0
BVLC
BATS Voltage Sense Low Condition Bit — This status bit indicates that a low voltage at VSENSE or VSUP,
depending on selection, is present.
0 Vmeasured VLBI_A (falling edge) or Vmeasured VLBI_D (rising edge)
1 Vmeasured VLBI_A (falling edge) or Vmeasured VLBI_D (rising edge)
t
V
VLBI_A
VLBI_D
VHBI_A
VHBI_D
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
768 Freescale Semiconductor
23.3.2.3 BATS Interrupt Enable Register (BATIE)
23.3.2.4 BATS Interrupt Flag Register (BATIF)
Module Base + 0x0002 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
76543210
R000000
BVHIE BVLIE
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 23-6. BATS Interrupt Enable Register (BATIE)
Table 23-4. BATIE Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
1
BVHIE
BATS Interrupt Enable High — Enables High Voltage Interrupt .
0 No interrupt will be requested whenever BVHIF flag is set .
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever BVHIF flag is set
0
BVLIE
BATS Interrupt Enable Low — Enables Low Voltage Interrupt .
0 No interrupt will be requested whenever BVLIF flag is set .
1 Interrupt will be requested whenever BVLIF flag is set .
Module Base + 0x0003 Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime, write 1 to clear
76543210
R000000
BVHIF BVLIF
W
Reset00000000
= Unimplemented
Figure 23-7. BATS Interrupt Flag Register (BATIF)
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 769
23.3.2.5 Reserved Register
NOTE
These reserved registers are designed for factory test purposes only and are
not intended for general user access. Writing to these registers when in
special mode can alter the module’s functionality.
23.4 Functional Description
23.4.1 General
The BATS module allows measuring voltages on the VSENSE and VSUP pins. The VSENSE pin is
implemented to allow measurement of the supply Line (Battery) Voltage VBAT directly. By bypassing the
device supply capacitor and the external reversed battery protection diode this pin allows to detect
under/over voltage conditions without delay. A series resistor (RVSENSE_R) is required to protect the
VSENSE pin from fast transients.
The voltage at the VSENSE or VSUP pin can be routed via an internal voltage divider to an internal
Analog to Digital Converter Channel. Also the BATS module can be configured to generate a low and high
voltage interrupt based on VSENSE or VSUP. The trigger level of the high and low interrupt are selectable.
In a typical application, the module could be used as follows: The voltage at VSENSE is observed via
usage of the interrupt feature (BSESE=1, BVHIE=1), while the VSUP pin voltage is routed to the ADC to
allow regular measurement (BSUAE=1).
Table 23-5. BATIF Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
1
BVHIF
BATS Interrupt Flag High Detect — The flag is set to 1 when BVHC status bit changes.
0 No change of the BVHC status bit since the last clearing of the flag.
1 BVHC status bit has changed since the last clearing of the flag.
0
BVLIF
BATS Interrupt Flag Low Detect — The flag is set to 1 when BVLC status bit changes.
0 No change of the BVLC status bit since the last clearing of the flag.
1 BVLC status bit has changed since the last clearing of the flag.
Module Base + 0x0006
Module Base + 0x0007
Access: User read/write(1)
1. Read: Anytime
Write: Only in special mode
76543210
R
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
Resetxxxxxxxx
Figure 23-8. Reserved Register
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 770
23.4.2 Interrupts
This section describes the interrupt generated by the BATS module. The interrupt is only available in CPU
run mode. Entering and exiting CPU stop mode has no effect on the interrupt flags.
To make sure the interrupt generation works properly the bus clock frequency must be higher than the
Voltage Warning Low Pass Filter frequency (fVWLP_filter).
The comparator outputs BVLC and BVHC are forced to zero if the comparator is disabled (configuration
bits BSESE and BSUSE are cleared). If the software disables the comparator during a high or low Voltage
condition (BVHC or BVLC active), then an additional interrupt is generated. To avoid this behavior the
software must disable the interrupt generation before disabling the comparator.
The BATS interrupt vector is named in Table 23-6. Vector addresses and interrupt priorities are defined at
MCU level.
The module internal interrupt sources are combined into one module interrupt signal.
23.4.2.1 BATS Voltage Low Condition Interrupt (BVLI)
To use the Voltage Low Interrupt the Level Sensing must be enabled (BSESE =1 or BSUSE =1).
If measured when
a) VLBI1 selected with BVLS[1:0] = 0x0
at selected pin Vmeasure VLBI1_A (falling edge) or Vmeasure VLBI1_D (rising edge)
or when
b) VLBI2 selected with BVLS[1:0] = 0x1
at selected pin Vmeasure VLBI2_A (falling edge) or Vmeasure VLBI2_D (rising edge)
or when
c) VLBI3 selected with BVLS[1:0] = 0x2
at selected pin Vmeasure VLBI3_A (falling edge) or Vmeasure VLBI3_D (rising edge)
or when
d) VLBI4 selected with BVLS[1:0] = 0x3
at selected pin Vmeasure VLBI4_A (falling edge) or Vmeasure VLBI4_D (rising edge)
then BVLC is set. BVLC status bit indicates that a low voltage at the selected pin is present. The Low
Voltage Interrupt flag (BVLIF) is set to 1 when the Voltage Low Condition (BVLC) changes state . The
Table 23-6. BATS Interrupt Sources
Module Interrupt Source Module Internal Interrupt Sou rce Local Enable
BATS Interrupt (BATI) BATS Voltage Low Condition Interrupt (BVLI) BVLIE = 1
BATS Voltage High Condition Interrupt (BVHI) BVHIE = 1
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 771
Interrupt flag BVLIF can only be cleared by writing a 1. If the interrupt is enabled by bit BVLIE the
module requests an interrupt to MCU (BATI).
23.4.2.2 BATS Voltage High Condition Interrupt (BVHI)
To use the Voltage High Interrupt the Level Sensing must be enabled (BSESE =1 or BSUSE).
If measured when
a) VHBI1 selected with BVHS = 0
at selected pin Vmeasure VHBI1_A (rising edge) or Vmeasure VHBI1_D (falling edge)
or when
a) VHBI2 selected with BVHS = 1
at selected pin Vmeasure VHBI2_A (rising edge) or Vmeasure VHBI2_D (falling edge)
then BVHC is set. BVHC status bit indicates that a high voltage at the selected pin is present. The High
Voltage Interrupt flag (BVHIF) is set to 1 when a Voltage High Condition (BVHC) changes state. The
Interrupt flag BVHIF can only be cleared by writing a 1. If the interrupt is enabled by bit BVHIE the
module requests an interrupt to MCU (BATI).
Chapter 23 Supply Voltage Sensor - (BATSV2)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
772 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 773
Appendix A
MCU Electrical Specifications
A.1 General
This supplement contains the most accurate electrical information for the MC9S12ZVH-Family available
at the time of publication.
This introduction is intended to give an overview on several common topics like power supply, current
injection etc.
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
774 Freescale Semiconductor
Table A-1. Power Supplies
A.1.1 Pins
There are 4 groups of functional pins.
A.1.1.1 General Purpose I/O Pins (GPIO)
The I/O pins have a level in the range of 4.5V to 5.5V. This class of pins is comprised of all port I/O pins
(except PE0,1), BKGD and the RESET pins. Some functionality may be disabled.
A.1.1.2 High Voltage Pins
These consist of the VSENSE, VSUP, CANH, CANL, SPLIT, BCTL and BCTLC pins. These pins are
intended to interface to external components operating in the automotive battery range. They have nominal
voltages above the standard 5V I/O voltage range.
Mnemonic Nominal Voltage Description
VSS1 0V Ground pin for 2.8V core supply voltage generated by on chip voltage regulator
VDDF 2.8V 2.8V core supply voltage generated by on chip voltage regulator
VSS2 0V Ground pin for 1.8V core supply voltage generated by on chip voltage regulator
VDD18 1.8V 1.8V core supply voltage generated by on chip voltage regulator
VDDX1 5.0 V 5V power supply output for I/O drivers generated by on chip voltage regulator
VSSX1,2,3 0V Ground pin for I/O drivers
VDDX2,3 5.0 V 5V power supply for I/O drivers which should be supply from external power transistor
VDDA 5.0 V 5V Power supply for the analog-to-digital converter and for the reference circuit of the
internal voltage regulator
VSSA 0V Ground pin for VDDA analog supply
VDDM1,2(1)
1. All VDDM/VSSM pins are internally connected by metal
VDDA and VDDM1,2 are connected to VDDX pins by diodes for ESD
protection such that VDDX must not exceed VDDA and VDDM1,2 by
more than a diode voltage drop. VSSA, VSSM1,2 and VSSX are
connected by anti-parallel diodes for ESD protection. VDDC is connected
to VDDX by diodes for ESD protection such that VDDC must not exceed
VDDX by more than a diode voltage drop.
5.0 V 5V power supply for motor I/O drivers which should be supply from external power
transistor
VSSM1,2 0V Ground pin for motor I/O drivers
VSUP 12V/18V External power supply for voltage regulator
VDDC 5V Power supply input from external power transistor and feedback pin for the BCTLC
VSSC 0V Ground pin for on chip CANPHY0 supply
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 775
A.1.1.3 Main Oscillator
If the designated PE0 (EXTAL) and PE1 (XTAL) pins are configured for external oscillator operation then
these pins have a nominal voltage of 1.8V.
A.1.1.4 TEST
This pin is used for production testing only. The TEST pin must be tied to ground in all applications.
A.1.2 Current Injection
Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDDX or VDD range during instantaneous and
operating maximum current conditions. Figure A-1. shows a 5V GPIO pad driver and the on chip voltage
regulator with VDDX output. It shows also the power and ground pins VSUP, VDDX, VSSX and VSSA.
Px represents any 5V GPIO pin. Assume Px is configured as an input. The pad driver transistors P1 and
N1 are switched off (high impedance). If the voltage Vin on Px is greater than VDDX a positive injection
current Iin will flow through diode D1 into VDDX node. If this injection current Iin is greater than ILoad,
the internal power supply VDDX may go out of regulation. Ensure the external VDDX load will shunt
current greater than maximum inje ction current. This is the grea test risk when the MCU is not consuming
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
776 Freescale Semiconductor
power; e.g., if no system clock is present, or if the clock rate is very low which would reduce overall power
consumption.
Figure A-1. Current Injection on GPIO Port if Vin > VDDX
A.1.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Absolute maximum ratings are stress ratings only. A functional operation outside these ranges is not
guaranteed. Stress beyo nd these limits may af fect the reliability or cause permanent damage of the device.
This device contains circuitry protecting against damage due to high static voltage or electrical fields;
however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltages higher than
maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused
inputs are tied to an appropriate logic voltage level.
Table A-2. Absolute Maximum Ratings(1)
Num Rating Symbol Min Max Unit
1 Voltage regulator supply voltage VSUP -0.3 42 V
2 Voltage Regulator basis control VBCTL -0.3 42 V
3 the on chip CANPHY0 supply input and the BCTLC feedback pin VVDDC -0.3 6.0 V
VBG Pad Driver
VDDX
VSSX
VSSA
VSUP
Vin > VDDX
Iin
Iin
Voltage Regulator
D1
P1
N1
CLoad
ISUP
ILoad
IDDX
P2
Px
+
_
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 777
A.1.4 ESD Protection and Latch-up Immunity
All ESD testing is in conformity with CDF-AEC-Q100 stress test qualification for automotive grade
integrated circuits. During the device qualification ESD stresses were performed for the Human Body
Model (HBM) and the Charged-Device Model.
A device will be defined as a failure if after exposure to ESD pulses the device no longer meets the device
specification. Complete DC parametric and functional testing is performed per the applicable device
specification at room temperature followed by hot temperature, unless specified otherwise in the device
specification.
4 Base connection of bipolar for CANPHY0 supply VBCTLC -0.3 42 V
5 Voltage difference VDDX to VDDM and VDDA(2) VDDXM –0.1 0.1 V
6 Voltage difference VSSX to VSSM and VSSA VSSXM –0.3 0.3 V
7 Digital I/O input voltage VIN –0.3 6.0 V
8 EXTAL, XTAL (3) VILV –0.3 2.16 V
9 Core logic supply voltage VDD18 -0.3 2.16 V
10 Flash supply voltage VDDF -0.3 3.6 V
11 TEST input VTEST –0.3 10.0 V
12 Instantaneous maximum current
Single pin limit for all digital I/O pins(4) except PU/PV
ID–25 +25 mA
13 Instantaneous maximum current
Single pin limit for all PU/PV I/O pins
ID55 55 mA
14 Instantaneous maximum current on VDDM IVDDM -220 220 mA
15 Instantaneous maximum current
Single pin limit for EXTAL, XTAL
IDL –25 +25 mA
16 Storage temperature range Tstg –65 155 C
1. Beyond absolute maximum ratings device might be damaged.
2. VDDX and VDDA must be shorted
3. EXTAL, XTAL pins configured for external oscillator operation only
4. All digital I/O pins are internally clamped to VSSX and VDDX, or VSSA and VDDA.
Table A-3. ESD and Latch-up Test Conditions
Model Spec Description Symbol Value Unit
Human Body JESD22-A114
Series Resistance R 1500
Storage Capacitance C 100 pF
Number of Pulse per pin
positive
negative
-
-
3
3
Charged- Device JESD22-C101 Series Resistance R 0
Storage Capacitance C 4 pF
Table A-2. Absolute Maximum Ratings(1)
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
778 Freescale Semiconductor
A.1.5 Operating Conditions
This section describes the operating conditions of the device. Unless otherwise noted those conditions
apply to all the following data.
NOTE
Please refer to the temperature rating of the device with regards to the
ambient temperature TA and the junction temperature TJ. For power
dissipation calculations refer to Section A.1.6, “Power Dissipation and
Thermal Characteristics”.
Latch-up for 5V
GPIO’s
Minimum Input Voltage Limit -2.5 V
Maximum Input Voltage Limit +7.5 V
Latch-up for
BCTL/BCTLC/V
SENSE/CANH/
CANL/SPLIT
Minimum Input Voltage Limit -7 V
Maximum Input Voltage Limit +21 V
Table A-4. ESD Protection and Latch-up Characteristics
Num Rating Symbol Min Max Unit
1Human Body Model (HBM):
-all pins except CANH/CANL/SPLIT/VSENSE
-CANH/CANL/SPLIT/VSENSE VHBM
+/-2
+/-4
-KV
2Charged-Device Model (CDM):
Corner Pins VCDM +/-750 - V
3Charged-Device Model (CDM):
all other pins VCDM +/-500 - V
4Direct Contact Discharge IEC61000-4-2 with and
with out 220pF capacitor (R=330, C=150pF):
CANH and CANL
VESDIEC +/-8 - KV
5Latch-up Current of 5V GPIO’s at T= 27C
positive
negative
ILAT +100
-100
-mA
Table A-5. Operating Conditions
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Voltage regulator supply VSUP 5.5 12 40(1) V
2 main Oscillator fosc 4—20MHz
3 32K Oscillator fosc32k 32 40 KHz
Table A-3. ESD and Latch-up Test Conditions
Model Spec Description Symbol Value Unit
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 779
NOTE
Operation is guaranteed when powering down until low voltage reset
assertion.
A.1.6 Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics
Power dissipation and thermal characteristics are closely related. The user must assure that the maximum
operating junction temperature is not exceeded. The average chip-junction temperature (TJ) in C can be
obtained from:
4 Bus frequency fbus see
Footnote(2)
—32MHz
5 Bus frequency without flash wait states fWSTAT ——25MHz
6COperating junction temperature range
Operating ambient temperature range(3) TJ
TA
–40
–40
130
85
C
7VOperating junction temperature range
Operating ambient temperature range(4) TJ
TA
–40
–40
150
105
C
1. Normal operating range is 6V - 18V. Continuos operation at 40V is not allowed. Only Transient Conditions (Load Dump)
single pulse tmax<400ms
2. Minimum bus frequency for ADC module refer to fADCCLK and for Flash program and erase please refer to fNVMOP
3. Please refer to Section A.1.6, “Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics” for more details about the relation between
ambient temperature TA and device junction temperature TJ.
4. Please refer to Section A.1.6, “Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics” for more details about the relation between
ambient temperature TA and device junction temperature TJ.
Table A-5. Operating Conditions
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
TJTAPDJA
+=
TJJunction Temperature, [C=
TAAmbient Temperature, [C=
PDTotal Chip Power Dissipation, [W]=
JA Package Thermal Resistance, [ C/W]=
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
780 Freescale Semiconductor
The total power dissipation PD can be calculated from the equation below . T able A-6 below lists the power
dissipation components . Table A-6 gives an overview of the supply currents.
Figure A-2. Supply Currents Overview
Table A-6. Power Dissipation Components
Power Component Description
PSUP = VSUP ISUP Internal Power through VSUP pin
PBCTL = VBCTL IBCTL Internal Power through BCTL pin
PBCTLC = VBCTLC IBCTLC Internal Power through BCTLC pin
PINT = VDDX IVDDX + VDDA IVDDA + VDDM IVDDM Internal Power through VDDX/A/M pins.
PGPIO = VI/O II/O Power dissipation of external load driven by GPIO Port.
Assuming the load is connected between GPIO and
ground. This power component is included in PINT and
is subtracted from overall MCU power dissipation PD
PCANPHY0= VDDCANH ICANH + VDDCANL ICANHL Power dissipation of CANPHY0
PD = PVSUP + PBCTL + PINT + PCANPHY0 + PBCTLC - PGPIO
VSUP
CANH
CANL
VDDA
VDDM[2:1]
VDDX[3:1]
VSSX1
VSENSE
VBAT
ISUP ICAN
ICAN
GND
GPIO II/O
VI/O
RL2
MC9S12ZVH-Family
BCTL
BCTLC
VDDC
SPLIT
IBCTL
IBCTLC
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 781
Table A-7. Thermal Package Characteristics1
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
LQFP 100
1 Thermal resistance 100LQFP, single sided PCB(1)
1. Junction to ambient thermal resistance, JA was simulated to be equivalent to the JEDEC specification JESD51-2 in a
horizontal configuration in natural convection.
JA 58 C/W
2 Thermal resistance 100LQFP, double sided PCB
with 2 internal planes(2)
2. Junction to ambient thermal resistance, JA was simulated to be equivalent to the JEDEC specification JESD51-7 in a
horizontal configuration in natural convection.
JA 45 C/W
3 Junction to Board 100LQFP JB 30 C/W
4 Junction to Case 100LQFP4JC 13 C/W
144LQFP
5 Thermal resistance 144LQFP, single sided PCB(3)
3. Junction to ambient thermal resistance, JA was simulated to be equivalent to the JEDEC specification JESD51-2 in a
horizontal configuration in natural convection.
JA 50 C/W
6 Thermal resistance 144LQFP, double sided PCB
with 2 internal planes(4)
4. Junction to ambient thermal resistance, JA was simulated to be equivalent to the JEDEC specification JESD51-7 in a
horizontal configuration in natural convection.
JA 41 C/W
7 Junction to Board 144LQFP JB 29 C/W
8 Junction to Case 144LQFP4JC 11 C/W
1. The values for thermal resistance are achieved by package simulations
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
782 Freescale Semiconductor
A.1.7 I/O Characteristics
This section describes the characteristics of I/O pins
Table A-8. 5-V I/O Characteristics
Conditions are 4.5 V < VDDX< 5.5 V junction temperature from –40C to +150C, unless otherwise noted
I/O Characteristics for all GPIO pins (defined in A.1.1.1/A-774).
Nu
mRating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1a Input high voltage VIH 0.65*VDDX ——V
1b Input high voltage BKGD pin 3.13V < VDDX<5.5V VIH 0.65*VDDX ——V
2 Input high voltage VIH ——V
DDX+0.3 V
3a Input low voltage VIL 0.35*VDDX V
3b Input low voltage BKGD pin 3.13V < VDDX<5.5V VIL 0.35*VDDX V
4 Input low voltage VIL VSSX–0.3 V
5 Input hysteresis VHYS 250 mV
6 Input leakage current (pins in high impedance input
mode)(1) all except PU/PV
Vin = VDD35 or VSS35
V Temperature range -40C to 105C
Iin
-1 1 A
Input leakage current (pins in high impedance input
mode)(2) . PU/PV
Vin = VDD35 or VSS35
V Temperature range -40C to 105C
Iin
-2.5 2.5 A
6a Input leakage current (pins in high impedance input
mode) all except PU/PV
Vin = VDD35 or VSS35
25
150C
Iin
1
26
—nA
Input leakage current (pins in high impedance input
mode) PU/PV
Vin = VDD35 or VSS35
25
150C
Iin
10
1500
—nA
7 Output high voltage (pins in output mode) all except
PU/PV
Full drive IOH = -4mA
VOH VDD35 – 0.8 V
Output high voltage (pins in output mode) PU/PV
Full drive IOH = –20 mA
VOH VDDM – 0.4 V
8 Output low voltage (pins in output mode) all except
PU/PV
Full drive IOL = +4 mA
VOL ——0.8V
Output low voltage (pins in output mode) PU/PV
Full drive IOL = +20 mA
VOL ——0.4V
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 783
9 Port U, V Output Rise Time
VDD5=5V, 10% to 90% of VOH
Cload 47pF connected to GND, slew disabled
Rload=1K connected to GND, slew enabled
Rload=1K connected to VDD, slew enabled
tr
—9.9
87
107
ns
10 Port U, V Output Fall Time
VDD5=5V, 10% to 90% of VOH
Cload 47pF connected to GND, slew disabled
Rload=1Kconnected to GND, slew enabled
Rload=1Kconnected to VDD,, slew enabled
tf
—9.9
105
87
ns
11 Internal pull up current (All GPIO except RESET and
PU/PV)
VIH min > input voltage > VIL max
IPUL -10 -130 A
Internal pull up current (RESET pin)
VIH min > input voltage > VIL max
RPUL 3.8 5 10.5 K
Internal pull up device current PU/PV
VIH min > input voltage > VIL max
IPUL -10 -130 A
12 Internal pull down current (All GPIO except PU/PV)
VIH min > input voltage > VIL max
IPDH 10 130 A
Internal pull down device current PU/PV
VIH min > input voltage > VIL max
IPDH 10 130 A
13 Input capacitance Cin —7 pF
14 Injection current(3)
Single pin limit
Total device Limit, sum of all injected currents
IICS
IICP
–2.5
–25
2.5
25
mA
1. Maximum leakage current occurs at maximum operating temperature.
2. Maximum leakage current occurs at maximum operating temperature.
3. Refer to Section A.1.2, “Current Injection” for more details. For sake of ADC conversion accuracy, the application
should avoid to inject any current into the pins PAD1/PAD2.
Table A-9. 5-V I/O Timing Characteristics
Conditions are 4.5 V < VDDX< 5.5 V junction temperature from –40C to +150C, unless otherwise noted
I/O Characteristics for all GPIO pins (defined in A.1.1.1/A-774).
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Port T, S, AD interrupt input pulse filtered (STOP)(1)
1. Parameter only applies in stop or pseudo stop mode.
tP_MASK —— 3s
2 Port T, S, AD interrupt input pulse passed (STOP)1tP_PASS 10 s
3 Port T, S, AD interrupt input pulse filtered (STOP) in
number of bus clock cycles of period 1/fbus
nP_MASK —— 3
4 Port T, S, AD interrupt input pulse passed (STOP) in
number of bus clock cycles of period 1/fbus
nP_PASS 4—
5IRQ
pulse width, edge-sensitive mode (STOP) in
number of bus clock cycles of period 1/fbus
nIRQ 1—
Table A-8. 5-V I/O Characteristics
Conditions are 4.5 V < VDDX< 5.5 V junction temperature from –40C to +150C, unless otherwise noted
I/O Characteristics for all GPIO pins (defined in A.1.1.1/A-774).
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
784 Freescale Semiconductor
A.1.8 Supply Currents
This section describes the current consumption characteristics of the device as well as the conditions for
the measurements.
A.1.8.1 Measurement Conditions
Current is measured on VSUP. VDDX is connected to VDDA. It does not include the current to drive
external loads. Unless otherwise noted the currents are measured in special single chip mode and the CPU
code is executed from RAM. For Run and Wait current measurements PLL is on and the reference clock
is the IRC1M trimmed to 1MHz. The bus frequency is 32MHz and the CPU frequency is 64MHz. Table A-
10, Table A-11 and Table A-12 show the configuration of the CPMU module and the peripherals for Run,
Wait and Stop current measurement.
Table A-10. CPMU Configuration for Pseudo Stop Current Measurement
CPMU REGISTER Bit settings/Conditions
CPMUCLKS PLLSEL=0, PSTP=1, CSAD=0,
PRE=PCE=RTIOSCSEL=COPOSCSEL=1
CPMUOSC OSCE=1, External Square wave on EXTAL fEXTAL=4MHz,
VIH= 1.8V, VIL=0V
CPMURTI RTDEC=0, RTR[6:4]=111, RTR[3:0]=1111;
CPMUCOP WCOP=1, CR[2:0]=111
Table A-11. CPMU Configuration for Run/Wait and Full Stop Current Measurement
CPMU REGISTER Bit settings/Conditions
CPMUSYNR VCOFRQ[1:0]=01,SYNDIV[5:0] = 31
CPMUPOSTDIV POSTDIV[4:0]=0
CPMUCLKS PLLSEL=1, CSAD=0
CPMUOSC OSCE=0,
Reference clock for PLL is fref=firc1m trimmed to 1MHz
API settings for STOP current measurement
CPMUAPICTL APIEA=0, APIFE=1, APIE=0
CPMUAPITR trimmed to >=10Khz
CPMUAPIRH/RL set to 0xFFFF
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 785
Table A-12. Peripheral Configurations for Run & Wait Current Measurement
Peripheral Configuration
SCI0/SCI1 Continuously transmit data (0x55) at speed of 19200 baud
SPI0 Configured to master mode, continuously transmit data (0x55) at
1Mbit/s
MSCAN0 Configured to loop-back mode using a bit rate of 500Kbits/s
PWM Configured to toggle its pins at the rate of 40kHz
ADC0 The peripheral is configured to operate at its maximum specified
frequency and to continuously convert voltages on all input
channels in sequence.
IIC0 Operate in master mode and continuously transimit
data(0x55 or 0xAA) at 100Kbits/s
DBG The module is enabled and the comparators are configured to
trigger in outside range.The range covers all the code executed by
the core.
TIM0/TIM1 The peripheral is configured to output compare mode, pulse
accumulator and modulus counter enabled.
LCD Configured to 244Hz frame frequency, 1/4 Duty, 1/3 Bias
with all FP/BP enabled and all segment on
MC Configured to full H-bridge mode MCPER=0x3FF, 1/2fbus
motor controller timer counter clock, MCDC=0x20
SSD0-3 Disabled
SSG0 Configured to 1K Hz Tone with attached mode, mix mode output
RTC Enabled
COP & RTI Enabled
BATS Enabled
CANPHY0 Configured to connect with MSCAN0
Table A-13. Run and Wait Current Characteristics
Conditions are: VSUP=12V, TA=105C, see Tabl e A -11 and Tab le A- 1 2
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1Run Current I
SUPR 28 32 mA
2 Wait Current ISUPW 21 mA
Appendix A MCU Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
786 Freescale Semiconductor
A.1.9 ADC Conversion Result Reference
The reference voltage VBG is measured under the conditions shown in Table A-16. The value stored in the
IFR is the average of 8 consecutive conversions.
Table A-14. Stop Current Characteristics
Conditions are: VSUP=12V
Num Rating(1)
1. If MCU is in Stop mode long enough then TA= TJ. Die self heating due to Stop current is negligible.
Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
Stop Current all modules off
1T
A= TJ= -40CI
SUPS 14 65 A
2T
A= TJ= 25CI
SUPS 20 A
3T
A= TJ= 150CI
SUPS 200 700 A
Stop Current with CANPHY0 in standby
4T
A= TJ= 25CI
SUPS 55 A
Stop Current with 32KOSC and RTC enabled
5T
A= TJ= 25CI
SUPS 45 A
Table A-15. Pseudo Stop Current Characteristics
Conditions are: VSUP=12V, API, COP & RTI enabled
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
Pseudo Stop Current with API, COP and RTI enabled
1T
A= 25CI
SUPS 226 A
Pseudo Stop Current with RTC enabled(clock source from external main OSC)
2T
A= 25CI
SUPS 235 A
Table A-16. Measurement Conditions
Description Symbol Value Unit
Regulator supply voltage VSUP 5 V
I/O supply voltage VDDX, A,M 5V
ADC clock fADCCLK 2MHz
ADC sample time tSMP 4 ADC clock cycles
Bus frequency fbus 32 MHz
Ambient temperature TA150 C
Code execution from RAM
NVM activity none
Appendix B ADC Electricals
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 787
Appendix B
ADC Electricals
This section describes the characteristics of the analog-to-digital converter.
B.1 ADC Operating Characteristics
The Table B-1 shows conditions under which the ADC operates.
The following constraints exist to obtain full-scale, full range results:
VSSA VRLVINVRHVDDA
This constraint exists since the sample buffer ampl ifier can not drive beyond the power supply levels that
it ties to. If the input level goes outside of this range it will effectively be clipped.
Table B-1. ADC Operating Characteristics
B.1.1 Factors Influencing Accuracy
Source resistance, source capacitance and current injection have an influence on the accuracy of the ADC.
A further factor is that PortAD pins that are configured as output drivers switching.
Supply voltage 4.5V < VDDA < 5.5 V, -40oC < TJ < 150oC
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Reference potential
Low
High
VRL
VRH
VSSA
VDDA/2
VDDA/2
VDDA
V
V
2 Voltage difference VDDX to VDDA VDDX -0.1 0 0.1 V
3 Voltage difference VSSX to VSSA VSSX –0.1 0 0.1 V
4 Differential reference voltage(1)
1. The accuracy is reduced if differential reference voltage is less than 4.50 V
VRH-VRL 3.13 5.0 5.5 V
5 ADC Clock Frequency (derived from bus clock via the
prescaler bus) fADCCLk
0.25 8.0 MHz
6 Buffer amplifier turn on time (delay after module
start/recovery from Stop mode)
tREC —— 1s
7 ADC disable then re-enable require time tDISABLE —— 3Bus
Cycles
8ADC Conversion Period(2)
10 bit resolution:
8 bit resolution:
2. The minimum time assumes a sample time of 4 ADC clock cycles. The maximum time assumes a sample time of 24
ADC clock cycles.
NCONV10
NCONV8
18
16
38
36
ADC
clock
Cycles
Appendix B ADC Electricals
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
788 Freescale Semiconductor
B.1.1.1 Port AD Output Drivers Switching
PortAD output drivers switching can adversely affect the ADC accuracy whilst converting the analog
voltage on other PortAD pins because the output drivers are supplied from the VDDA/VSSA ADC supply
pins. Although internal design measures are implemented to minimize the af fect of output driver noise, it
is recommended to configure PortAD pins as outputs only for low frequency , low load outputs. The impact
on ADC accuracy is load dependent and not specified. The values specified are valid under condition that
no PortAD output drivers switch during conversion.
B.1.1.2 Source Resistance
Due to the input pin leakage current as specified in conjunction with the source resistance there will be a
voltage drop from the signal source to the ADC input. The maximum source resistance RS specifies results
in an error (10-bit resolution) of less than 1/2 LSB (2.5 mV) at the maximum leakage current.
B.1.1.3 Source Capacitance
When sampling an additional internal capacitor is switched to the input. This can cause a voltage drop due
to charge sharing with the external and the pin capacitance. For a maximum sampling error of the input
voltage 1LSB (10-bit resilution), then the external filter capacitor, Cf 1024 * (CINS–CINN).
B.1.1.4 Current Injection
There are two cases to consider.
1. A current is injected into the channel being converted. The channel being stressed has conversion
values of 0x3FF (in 10-bit mode) for analog inputs greater than VRH and 0x000 for values less than
VRL unless the current is higher than specified as disruptive condition.
2. Current is injected into pins in the neighborhood of the channel being converted. A portion of this
current is picked up by the channel (coupling ratio K), This additional current impacts the accuracy
of the conversion depending on the source resistance.
The additional input voltage error on the converted channel can be calculated as:
VERR = K * RS * IINJ
with IINJ being the sum of the currents injected into the two pins adjacent to the converted channel.
Table B-2. ADC Electrical Characteristics
Supply voltage 3.13 V < VDDA < 5.5 V, -40oC < TJ < 150oC
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Max input source resistance RS——10K
2 Total input capacitance Non sampling
Total input capacitance Sampling
CINN
CINS
10
16
pF
3Input internal Resistance RINA -515k
4 Disruptive analog input current INA -2.5 2.5 mA
5 Coupling ratio positive current injection Kp——1E-4A/A
6 Coupling ratio negative current injection Kn——5E-3A/A
Appendix B ADC Electricals
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 789
B.1.2 ADC Accuracy
Table B-3. specifies the ADC conversion performance excluding any errors due to current injection,
input capacitance and source resistance.
B.1.2.1 ADC Accuracy Definitions
For the following definitions see also <Cross Refs>Figure B-1.
Differential non-linearity (DNL) is defined as the difference between two adjacent switching steps.
The integral non-linearity (INL) is defined as the sum of all DNLs:
DNL i ViVi1
1LSB
-------------------------- 1=
INL n DNL i
i1=
n
VnV0
1LSB
---------------------n==
Appendix B ADC Electricals
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
790 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure B-1. ADC Accuracy Definitions
1
5Vin
mV
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 12065 70 75 8060
0
3
2
5
4
7
6
45
$3F7
$3F9
$3F8
$3FB
$3FA
$3FD
$3FC
$3FE
$3FF
$3F4
$3F6
$3F5
8
9
1
2
$FF
$FE
$FD
$3F3
10-Bit Resolution
8-Bit Resolution
Ideal Transfer Curve
10-Bit Transfer Curve
8-Bit Transfer Curve
55
10-Bit Absolute Error Boundary
8-Bit Absolute Error Boundary
LSB
Vi-1 Vi
DNL
5000 +
Appendix B ADC Electricals
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 791
Table B-3. ADC Conversion Performance 5V range
Supply voltage 4.5 V < VDDA < 5.5 V, 4.5V < VREF < 5.5 V. ( VREF= VRH - VRL ). fADCCLK = 8.0 MHz
The values are tested to be valid with no PortAD output drivers switching simultaneous with conversions.
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
5 Resolution (VREF = 5.12V) 10-Bit LSB 5 mV
6 Differential Nonlinearity 10-Bit DNL -1 0.5 1 counts
7 Integral Nonlinearity 10-Bit INL -2 1 2 counts
8 Absolute Error(1)
1. This includes quantization error which is inherently 1/2 count for any A/D converter.
10-Bit AE -3 2 3 counts
9 Resolution (VREF = 5.12V) 8-Bit LSB 20 mV
10 Differential Nonlinearity 8-Bit DNL -0.5 0.3 0.5 counts
11 Integral Nonlinearity 8-Bit INL -1 0.5 1 counts
12 Absolute Error (1.) 8-Bit AE -1.5 1 1.5 counts
Appendix B ADC Electricals
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
792 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 793
Appendix C
PLL Electrical Specifications
C.1 Reset, Oscillator and PLL
C.1.1 Phase Locked Loop
C.1.1.1 Jitter Information
With each transition of the feedback clock, the deviation from the reference clock is measured and the
input voltage to the VCO is adjusted accordingly.The adjustment is done continuously with no abrupt
changes in the VCOCLK frequency. Noise, voltage, temperature and other factors cause slight variations
in the control loop resulting in a clock jitter. This jitter affects the real minimum and maximum clock
periods as illustrated in Figure C-1.
Figure C-1. Jitter Definitions
The relative deviation of tnom is at its maximum for one clock period, and decreases towards zero for larger
number of clock periods (N).
Defining the jitter as:
The following equation is a good fit for the maximum jitter:
23 N-1N1
0
tnom
tmax1
tmin1
tmaxN
tminN
JN max 1
tmax N
Nt
nom
-----------------------
1
tmin N
Nt
nom
-----------------------
,



=
Appendix C PLL Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
794 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure C-2. Maximum Bus Clock Jitter Approximation (N = number of Bus Cycles)
NOTE
On timers and serial modules a prescaler will eliminate the effect of the jitter
to a large extent.
Ta ble C-1. ipll_1vdd_ll18 Characteristics
Conditions are 4.5 V < VDDX< 5.5 V junction temperature from –40C to +150C, unless otherwise noted
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1VCO frequency during system reset fVCORST 832MHz
2VCO locking range fVCO 32 64 MHz
3Reference Clock fREF 1MHz
4Lock Detection Lock|0 1.5%
(1)
1. % deviation from target frequency
5Un-Lock Detection unl|0.5 2.5%
1
7Time to lock tlock 150 +
256/fREF
s
8Jitter fit parameter 1(2)
2. fREF = 1MHz, fBUS = 32MHz
j12%
9 PLL Clock Monitor Failure assert frequency fPMFA 0.45 1.1 1.6 MHz
JN j1
NPOSTDIV 1+
--------------------------------------------------=
1 5 10 20 N
J(N)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 795
Appendix D
IRC Electrical Specifications
Table D-1. IRC electrical characteristics
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1Junction Temperature - 40 to 150 Celsius
Internal Reference Frequency, factory trimmed
fIRC1M_TRIM 0.987 1 1.013 MHz
Appendix D IRC Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
796 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 797
Appendix E
LCD Electrical Specifications
E.1 LCD DriverTable E-1. LCD40F4B Driver Electrical Characteristics
1) Outputs measured one at a time, low impedance voltage source connected to the VLCD pin.
The 1/3, 1/2 and 2/3 VLCD voltage levels are buffered internally with an asymmetric output stage, as
shown in Figure E-1.
Figure E-1. Buffer configuration (left) and buffer output stage (right )
The switching matrix applies a capacitive load (LCD elements) to th e buffer output. The charge excites
the buffer output voltage VBuf from the target output voltage which can be 1/3, 1/2 or 2/3 VLCD. After a
positive spike on VBuf a frontplane or backplane is discharged by an active load with a constant current.
After a negative spike on VBuf the output is char ged through a transistor which is switched on and which
behaves like a resistor. Simplified output voltage transients are shown in Figure E-2.. The shown
transients emphasize the spikes and the voltage recovery. They are not to scale. The buffer output
Characteristic Symbol Min. Typ. Max. Unit
LCD Output Impedance(BP[3:0],FP[39:0])
for outputs to charge to higher voltage level or to
GND 1) ZBP/FP --5.0k
LCD Output Current (BP[3:0],FP[39:0])
for outputs to discharge to lower voltage level ex-
cept GND 1) IBP/FP 50 - - A
switch
matrix
to LCD
VBuf VBuf
VLCD VDDX
output MOSFET
active load
Iout
Appendix E LCD Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
798 Freescale Semiconductor
characteristic is shown in Figure E-3.. The resistive output characteristic is also valid if an output is
forced to GND or VLCD.
Figure E-2. VBuf transients (not to scale)
Figure E-3. buffer output characte ristic
VBuf
t
2/3VLCD
1/2VLCD
1/3VLCD
constant current
resistive
IOUT
VOUT
1/3, 1/2 or
2/3 VLCD
resistive
current source
region
region
IBP/FP
ZBP/FP
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 799
Appendix F
MSCAN Electrical Specifications
F.1 MSCAN Electrical Characteristics
Table F-1. MSCAN Wake-up Pulse Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table F-1. unless otherwise noted
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 MSCAN wakeup dominant pulse filtered tWUP ——1.5s
2 MSCAN wakeup dominant pulse pass tWUP 5—s
Appendix F MSCAN Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
800 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix G NVM Electrical Parameters
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 801
Appendix G
NVM Electrical Parameters
G.1 NVM Timing Parameters
The time base for all NVM program or erase operations is derived from the bus clock using the FCLKDIV
register. The frequency of this derived clock must be set within the limits specified as f NVMOP. The NVM
module does not have any means to monitor the frequency and will not prevent program or erase operation
at frequencies above or below the specified minimum. When attempting to program or erase the NVM
module at a lower frequency, a full program or erase transition is not assured.
The device bus frequency, below which the flash wait states can be disabled, is specified in the device
operating conditions table in Section A.1.5.
The following sections provide equations which can be used to determine the time required to execute
specific flash commands. All timing parameters are a function of the bus clock frequency, fNVMBUS. All
program and erase times are also a function of the NVM operating frequency, fNVMOP. A summary of key
timing parameters can be found in Table G-1.
Appendix G NVM Electrical Parameters
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
802 Freescale Semiconductor
Table G-1. NVM Timing Characteristics
G.2 NVM Reliability Parameters
The reliability of the NVM blocks is guaranteed by stress test during qualification, constant process
monitors and burn-in to screen early life failures.
The data retention and program/erase cycling failure rates are specified at the operating conditions noted.
The program/erase cycle count on the sector is incremented every time a sector or mass erase event is
executed.
NOTE
All values shown in Table G-2 are preliminary and subject to further
characterization.
Num Rating fNVMOP
cycles fNVMBUS
cycles Symbol Min Typ(1)
1. Typical program and erase times are based on typical fNVMOP and maximum fNVMBUS
Max(2)
2. Maximum program and erase times are based on minimum fNVMOP and maximum fNVMBUS
Unit
1 Bus frequency 1 fNVMBUS 1—50MHz
2 NVM Operating frequency 1 fNVMOP 0.8 1.0 1.05 MHz
3 Erase All Blocks 100066 33968 tERSALL 96.66 101.42 159.05 ms
4 Unsecure Flash 100066 34046 tUNSECU 96.66 101.43 159.13 ms
5 Program Once 164 3054 tPGMONCE 0.28 0.29 3.26 ms
6 Read Once 0 481 tRDONCE 0.02 0.02 0.48 ms
7 Verify Backdoor Access Key 0 515 tVFYKEY 0.02 0.02 0.52 ms
8 Erase Verify All Blocks 0 33215 tRD1ALL 1.33 1.33 33.22 ms
9 Erase Verify Block (Pflash) 0 33348 tRD1BLK_P 1.33 1.33 33.35 ms
10 Erase Verify Block (Dflash) 0 858 tRD1BLK_D 0.03 0.03 0.86 ms
11 Erase Verify P-Flash Section 0 579 tRD1SEC 0.02 0.02 0.58 ms
12 Program P-Flash (4 Word) 164 3123 tPGM_4 0.28 0.29 3.33 ms
13 Erase Flash Block (Pflash) 100060 33642 tERSBLK_P 96.64 101.41 158.72 ms
14 Erase Flash Block (Dflash) 100060 1155 tERSBLK_D 95.34 100.11 126.23 ms
15 Erase P-Flash Sectorl. 20015 960 tERSPG 19.10 20.05 25.98 ms
16 Erase Verify D-Flash Section 0 635 tDRD1SEC 0.03 0.03 0.64 ms
17 Program D-Flash (1 Word) 68 1709 tDPGM_1 0.13 0.14 1.79 ms
18 Program D-Flash (2 Word) 136 2712 tDPGM_2 0.24 0.24 2.88 ms
19 Program D-Flash (3 Word) 192 3411 tDPGM_3 0.32 0.33 3.65 ms
20 Program D-Flash (4 Word) 254 4038 tDPGM_4 0.40 0.42 4.36 ms
21 Erase D-Flash Sector 5015 862 tDERSPG 4.81 5.05 7.13 ms
22 Set User Margin LevelJ 0 473 tMLOADU 0.02 0.02 0.47 ms
23 Set Factory Margin Level 0 482 tMLOADF 0.02 0.02 0.48 ms
Appendix G NVM Electrical Parameters
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 803
G.3 NVM Factory Shipping Condition
Devices are shipped from the factory with flash and EEPROM in the erased state. Data retention
specifications begin at time of this erase operation. For additional information on how Freescale defines
Typical Data Retention, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618.
Table G-2. NVM Reliability Characteristics
NUM Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C(1)
after up to 10,000 program/erase cycles
1. TJavg does not exceed 85C in a typical temperature profile over the lifetime of a consumer, industrial or automotive
application.
tNVMRET 20 100(2)
2. Typical data retention values are based on intrinsic capability of the technology measured at high temperature and de-rated
to 25C using the Arrhenius equation. For additional information on how Freescale defines Typical Data Retention, please
refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618
Years
2 Program Flash number of program/erase cycles
(-40C tj 150C
nFLPE 10K 100K(3)
3. Spec table quotes typical endurance evaluated at 25C for this product family. For additional information on how Freescale
defines Typical Endurance, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB619.
Cycles
3 Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C1
after up to 100,000 program/erase cycles
tNVMRET 5100
2 Years
4 Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C1
after up to 10,000 program/erase cycles
tNVMRET 10 1002 Years
5 Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C1
after less than 100 program/erase cycles
tNVMRET 20 1002 Years
6 EEPROM number of program/erase cycles (-40C tj 150CnFLPE 100K 500K3 Cycles
Appendix G NVM Electrical Parameters
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
804 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix H BATS Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 805
Appendix H
BATS Electrical Specifications
This section describe the electrical characteristics of the Supply Voltage Sense module.
H.1 Maximum Ratings
Table H-1. Maximum ratings of the Supply Voltage Sense - (BATS).
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V VSUP 18 V, -40°C TJ 150°C(1) unless otherwise noted. Typical
values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C(2) under nominal conditions unless otherwise
noted.
1. TJ: Junction Temperature
2. TA: Ambient Temperature
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 VSENSE Max Rating VVSENSE_M -27 42 V
Appendix H BATS Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
806 Freescale Semiconductor
H.2 Static Electrical Characteristics
Table H-2. Static Electrical Characteristics - Supply Voltage Sense - (BATS).
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V VSUP 18 V, -40°C TJ 150°C(1) unless otherwise noted. Typical
values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C(2) under nominal conditions unless otherwise
noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Low Voltage Warning (LBI 1)
Assert (Measured on selected pin, falling edge)
Deassert (Measured on selected pin, rising edge)
Hysteresis (measured on selected pin)
VLBI1_A
VLBI1_D
VLBI1_H
4.75
5.5
0.4
6
6.5
V
V
V
2 Low Voltage Warning (LBI 2)
Assert (Measured on selected pin, falling edge)
Deassert (Measured on selected pin, rising edge)
Hysteresis (measured on selected pin)
VLBI2_A
VLBI2_D
VLBI2_H
6
6.75
0.4
7
7.75
V
V
V
3 Low Voltage Warning (LBI 3)
Assert (Measured on selected pin, falling edge)
Deassert (Measured on selected pin, rising edge)
Hysteresis (measured on selected pin)
VLBI3_A
VLBI3_D
VLBI3_H
7
7.75
0.4
8.5
9
V
V
V
4 Low Voltage Warning (LBI 4)
Assert (Measured on selected pin, falling edge)
Deassert (Measured on selected pin, rising edge)
Hysteresis (measured on selected pin)
VLBI4_A
VLBI4_D
VLBI4_H
8
9
0.4
10
10.5
V
V
V
5 High Voltage Warning (HBI 1)
Assert (Measured on selected pin, rising edge)
Deassert (Measured on selected pin, falling edge)
Hysteresis (measured on selected pin)
VHBI1_A
VHBI1_D
VHBI1_H
14.5
14
16.5
1.0
18
V
V
V
6 High Voltage Warning (HBI 2)
Assert (Measured on selected pin, rising edge)
Deassert (Measured on selected pin, falling edge)
Hysteresis (measured on selected pin)
VHBI2_A
VHBI2_D
VHBI2_H
25
24
27.5
1.0
30
V
V
V
7 Pin Input Divider Ratio
RatioVSENSE = VSENSE / VADC(3)
RatioVSUP = VSUP / VADC
5.5V < VSENSE < 29 V; 5.5V < VSUP < 29 V
RatioVSENSE
RatioVSUP
9
9
8 Analog Input Matching
Absolute Error on VADC
- compared to VSENSE / RatioVSENSE
- compared to VSUP / RatioVSUP
AIMatching +-2% +-5%
Appendix H BATS Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 807
H.3 Dynamic Electrical Characteristics
NOTE
The information given in this section are preliminary and should be used as a guide only. Values in
this section cannot be guaranteed by Freescale and are subject to change without notice.
9 VSENSE Series Resistor
Required to be placed externally at VSENSE pin.
RVSENSE_R 9.5 10 10.5 k
10 VSENSE Impedance
If path to ground is enabled.
Value at VSENSE pin. RVSENSE_R is excluded.
RVSEN_IMP 350 k
1. TJ: Junction Temperature
2. TA: Ambient Temperature
3. VADC: Voltage accessible at the ATD input channel
Table H-3. Dynamic Electrical Characteristics - Supply Voltage Sense - (BATS).
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V VSUP 18 V, -40°C TJ 150°C(1) unless otherwise noted. Typical
values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C(2) under nominal conditions unless otherwise
noted.
1. TJ: Junction Temperature
2. TA: Ambient Temperature
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Enable Stabilisation Time TEN_UNC –1–s
2 Voltage Warning Low Pass Filter fVWLP_filter –0.5–MHz
Table H-2. Static Electrical Characteristics - Supply Voltage Sense - (BATS).
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V VSUP 18 V, -40°C TJ 150°C(1) unless otherwise noted. Typical
values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C(2) under nominal conditions unless otherwise
noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
Appendix H BATS Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
808 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 809
Appendix I
VREG Electrical Specifications
Table I-1. Voltage Regulator Electrical Chara cteristics
-40oC <= TJ <= 150C unless noted otherwise, VDDA, VDDM and VDDX must be shorted on the application board.
Num Characteristic Symbol Min Typical Max Unit
1 Input Voltages VSUP 3.5 40 V
2 Output Voltage VDDX
Full Performance Mode VSUP > =6V
Full Performance Mode 5.5V <= VSUP <=6V
Full Performance Mode 3.5V <= VSUP <=5.5V
Reduced Performance Mode (stopmode)
VSUP > =3.5V
VDDX 4.75
4.50
3.13
2.5
5.0
5.0
-
5.5
5.25
5.25
5.25
5.75
V
V
V
V
3 Load Current VDDX(1),(2) (3)without external PNP
Full Performance Mode VSUP > =6V
Full Performance Mode 3.5V <= VSUP <=6V
Reduced Performance Mode (stopmode)
IDDX 0
0
0
-
-
-
70
25
5
mA
mA
mA
4 Output Voltage VDDC with external PNP
Full Performance Mode VSUP > =6V
Full Performance Mode 5.5V <= VSUP <=6V
Full Performance Mode 3.5V <= VSUP <=5.5V
Reduced Performance Mode (stopmode)
VSUP > =3.5V
VDDC 4.75
4.50
3.13
2.5
5.0
5.0
-
5.5
5.25
5.25
5.25
5.75
V
V
V
V
5 Load Current VDDC
Reduced Performance Mode (stopmode)
IDDC 0—2.5mA
6 Low Voltage Interrupt Assert Level(4)
Low Voltage Interrupt Deassert Level
VLVIA
VLVID
4.04
4.19
4.23
4.38
4.40
4.49
V
V
7a VDDX Low Voltage Reset deassert(5) V
LVRXD 3.13 V
7b VDDX Low Voltage Reset assert VLVRXA 2.95 3.02 V
8 Trimmed ACLK output frequency fACLK 20 KHz
9 Trimmed ACLK internal clock f / fnominal (6) dfACLK - 5% + 5%
10 The first period after enabling the counter by APIFE
might be reduced by API start up delay
tsdel ——100s
11 Temperature Sensor Slope dVHT 5.05 5.25 5.45 mV/oC
12 Temperature Sensor Output Voltage(150C) VHT -2.4-V
13 High Temperature Interrupt Assert(7)
High Temperature Interrupt Deassert
THTIA
THTID
120
110
132
122
144
134
oC
oC
14 Bandgap output voltage VBG 1.13 1.22 1.32 V
15 Base Current For External PNP(VDDX) IBCTL 1.5 mA
Appendix I VREG Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
810 Freescale Semiconductor
NOTE
The LVR monitors the voltages VDD, VDDF and VDDX. If the voltage
drops on these supplies to a level which could prohibit the correct function
(e.g. code execution) of the microcontroller, the LVR triggers.
16 Base Current For External PNP(VDDC) IBCTLC 1.5 mA
17a Startup from Reset (normal mode) nSTARTUP 396 504 tbus
17b Startup from Reset (special mode) nSTARTUP 551 555 559 tbus
18 Recover time from STOP tSTP_REC —23—s
1. For the given maximum load currents and VSUP input voltages, the MCU will stay out of reset.
2. Load current without the use of external PNP transistor
3. Please note that the core current is derived from VDDX
4. LVI is monitored on the VDDA supply domain
5. LVRX is monitored on the VDDX supply domain only active during full performance mode. During reduced performance
mode (stopmode) voltage supervision is solely performed by the POR block monitoring core VDD.
6. The ACLK trimming must be set that the minimum period equals to 0.2ms
7. VREGHTTR=0x88
Table I-1. Voltage Regulator Electrical Chara cteristics
-40oC <= TJ <= 150C unless noted otherwise, VDDA, VDDM and VDDX must be shorted on the application board.
Num Characteristic Symbol Min Typical Max Unit
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 811
Appendix J
S12CANPHY Electrical Specifications
J.1 Maximum Ratings
J.2 Static Electrical Characteristics
Table J-1. Maximum Ratings
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V <= VSUP <= 18 V, 4.75V <= VDDC <= 5.25V , -40°C < Tj < 150°C unless
otherwise noted. Typical values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C under nominal conditions
unless otherwise noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Value Unit
1 DC voltage on CANL, CANH, SPLIT VBUS -32 to +40 V
2 Continuous current on CANH and CANL ILH 200 mA
3 ESD on CANH, CANL and SPLIT (HBM) VESDCH 2000 V
4 ESD on CANH, CANL (IEC61000-4, Czap = 150 pF,
Rzap = 330 )
VESDIEC 8000 V
Table J-2. Static Electrical Chara cteristics
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V <= VSUP <= 18 V, 4.75V <= VDDC <= 5.25V >, -40°C < Tj < 150°C> unless
otherwise noted. Typical values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C under nominal conditions
unless otherwise noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
CAN TRANSCEIVER CURRENT
1 Supply Current of canphy_ll18uhv
Normal mode, Bus Recessive State
Normal mode, Bus Dominant State without
Bus Load
Standby mode
Shutdown mode
IRES
IDOM
ISTB
ISDN
1.7
2
0.022
0
mA
PINS (CANH AND CANL)
2 Bus Pin Common Mode Voltage VCOM -12 - 12 V
3 Differential Input Voltage (after trim)
Recessive State at RXD
Dominant State at RXD
VCANH -
VCANL -1.0
0.95
-
-
0.55
5.0
V
4 Differential Input Hysteresis (RXD) VHYS 175 mV
Appendix J S12CANPHY Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
812 Freescale Semiconductor
5 Input Resistance RIN 532.550k
6 Differential Input Resistance RIND 10 65 100 k
7 Common mode input resistance matching RINM -3 0 +3 %
8 CANH Output Voltage
TXD Dominant State
TXD Recessive State
VCANH
2.75
2.0
3.5
2.5
4.5
3.0
V
9 CANL Output Voltage
TXD Dominant State
TXD Recessive State
VCANL
0.5
2.0
1.5
2.5
2.25
3.0
V
10 Differential Output Voltage
TXD Dominant State
TXD Recessive State
VOH -
VOL 1.5
-0.5
2.0
0
3.0
0.05
V
11 Output Current Capability (Dominant State)
CANH
CANL
ICANL
ICANH
55 mA
12 CANL Overcurrent Detection (after trim)
CANL
CANH
ICANLOC
ICANHOC
70
70
85
85
120
120
mA
13 CANH and CANL Input Current (Standby
Mode)
VCANH, VCANL from 0 V to 5.0 V
VCANH, VCANL = - 2.0 V
VCANH, VCANL = 7.0 V
ICAN1
20
-75
250
uA
14 CANH and CANL Input Current, Device
Unsupplied
VCANH, VCANL = 2.5 V
VCANH, VCANL = - 2.0 V
VCANH, VCANL = 7.0 V
ICAN2
20
-75
250
uA
DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION (CANH AND CANL)
15 CANL to 0 V Threshold (after trim) VL0 -0.75 -0.15 0 V
16 CANH to 0 V Threshold (after trim) VH0 -0.75 -0.15 0 V
17 CANL to 5.0 V Threshold (after trim) VL5 VDDC VDDC
+0.15
VDDC
+ 0.75
V
18 CANH to 5.0 V Threshold (after trim) VH5 VDDC VDDC
+0.15
VDDC
+0.75
V
SPLIT
Table J-2. Static Electrical Chara cteristics
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V <= VSUP <= 18 V, 4.75V <= VDDC <= 5.25V >, -40°C < Tj < 150°C> unless
otherwise noted. Typical values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C under nominal conditions
unless otherwise noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
Appendix J S12CANPHY Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 813
19 Output voltage
Loaded condition ISPLIT= +/- 500 uA
Unloaded condition Rmeasure > 1 M
VSPLIT 0.3*VDDC
0.45*VDDC
0.5*VDDC
0.5*VDDC
0.7*VDDC
0.55*VDDC
V
20 Leakage current
-12 V < VSPLIT < +12 V
-22 V < VSPLIT < +35 V
ILSPLIT
-
-
0
-
5
25
uA
Table J-2. Static Electrical Chara cteristics
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V <= VSUP <= 18 V, 4.75V <= VDDC <= 5.25V >, -40°C < Tj < 150°C> unless
otherwise noted. Typical values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C under nominal conditions
unless otherwise noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
Appendix J S12CANPHY Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
814 Freescale Semiconductor
J.3 Dynamic Electrical Characteristics
Table J-3. Dynamic Electrical Characteristics
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V <= VSUP <= 18 V, 4.75V <= VDDC <= 5.25V >, -40°C < Tj < 150°C>
unless otherwise noted. Typical values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C under nominal
conditions unless otherwise noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
SIGNAL EDGE RISE AND FALL TIMES (CANH, CANL)
1 Propagation Loop Delay TXD to RXD (Recessive
to Dominant)
Slew Rate 6
Slew Rate 5
Slew Rate 4
Slew Rate 2
Slew Rate 1
Slew Rate 0
tLRD
146
112
89
83
72
64 255
ns
2 Propagation Delay TXD to CAN (Recessive to
Dominant)
Slew Rate 6
Slew Rate 5
Slew Rate 4
Slew Rate 2
Slew Rate 1
Slew Rate 0
tTRD
98
63
43
38
28
23
ns
3 Propagation Delay CAN to RXD (Recessive to
Dominant, using slew rate 0)
tRRD 42 ns
4 Propagation Loop Delay TXD to RXD (Dominant
to Recessive)
Slew Rate 6
Slew Rate 5
Slew Rate 4
Slew Rate 2
Slew Rate 1
Slew Rate 0
tLDR
366
224
153
139
114
102 255
ns
5 Propagation Delay TXD to CAN (Dominant to
Recessive)
Slew Rate 6
Slew Rate 5
Slew Rate 4
Slew Rate 2
Slew Rate 1
Slew Rate 0
tTDR
280
152
90
81
56
46
ns
6 Propagation Delay CAN to RXD (Dominant to
Recessive, using slew rate 0)
tRDR 56 ns
Appendix J S12CANPHY Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 815
7 Non-Differential Slew Rate (CANL or CANH)
Slew Rate 6
Slew Rate 5
Slew Rate 4
Slew Rate 2
Slew Rate 1
Slew Rate 0
tSL6
tSL5
tSL4
tSL2
tSL1
tSL0
6
10
19
23
35
55
V/µs
8 Bus Communication Rate tBUS 1.0 M bps
9 Settling time after entering Normal mode tCP_set 10 s
10 CPTXD-dominant timeout tCPTXDDT 2ms
Table J-3. Dynamic Electrical Characteristics
Characteristics noted under conditions 5.5V <= VSUP <= 18 V, 4.75V <= VDDC <= 5.25V >, -40°C < Tj < 150°C>
unless otherwise noted. Typical values noted reflect the approximate parameter mean at TA = 25°C under nominal
conditions unless otherwise noted.
Num Ratings Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
Appendix J S12CANPHY Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
816 Freescale Semiconductor
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Re v . 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 817
Appendix K
Electrical Characteristics for the Oscillator (OSCLCPcr)
K.1 OSCLCP Electrical characteristics
Table K-1. XOSCLCP Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table K-1. unless otherwise noted
Num Rating Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1 Nominal crystal or resonator frequency fOSC 4.0 20 MHz
2 Startup Current iOSC 100 A
3a Oscillator start-up time (4MHz)(1)
1. These values apply for carefully designed PCB layouts with capacitors that match the crystal/resonator
requirements.
tUPOSC 210ms
3b Oscillator start-up time (8MHz)1tUPOSC 1.6 8 ms
3c Oscillator start-up time (16MHz)1tUPOSC 15ms
3d Oscillator start-up time (20MHz)1tUPOSC 14ms
4 Clock Monitor Failure Assert Frequency fCMFA 200 450 1200 KHz
5 Input Capacitance (EXTAL, XTAL pins) CIN 7pF
6 EXTAL Pin Input Hysteresis VHYS,EXT
AL
120 mV
7EXTAL Pin oscillation amplitude (loop
controlled Pierce) VPP,EXTAL
0.9 V
8EXTAL Pin oscillation amplitude (full swing
Pierce) VPP,EXTAL
1.8 V
9EXTAL Pin oscillation required
amplitude(2)
2. Needs to be measured at room temperature on the application board using a probe with very low (<=5pF)
input capacitance.
VPP,EXTAL
0.8 1.5 V
10 EXTAL Pin oscillation required
amplitude(3)
3. Needs to be measured at room temperature on the application board using a probe with very low (<=5pF)
input capacitance.
VPP,EXTAL
0.8 2.4 V
Appendix K Electrical Characteristics for the Oscillator (OSCLCPcr)
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
818 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix L OSC32K Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 819
Appendix L
OSC32K Electrical Specifications
L.1 DC Electrical Specifications
L.2 Frequency Specifications
Table L-1. OSC32K DC Electrical Specifications
Num Characteristic Symbol Min Typ Max Uni
t
1 OSC32K Supply Current VDDA=5.0 IDDOSC 40 60 A
2Allowed Impedence on 32K_EXTAL/XTAL pins Ilk_ext 10 
332K_EXTAL Load Capacitance
32K_XTAL Load Capacitance
Cx
Cy(1)
1. See crystal or resonator manufacturer’s recommendation
4External Feedback resistor RF10 M
5External Series resistor RS200 K
6Peak-to-Peak Amplitude of Oscillation Vpp 0.75*VDDX VDDX V
Table L-2. OSC32K Frequency Specifications
Num Characteristic Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
1Oscillator crystal or resonator frequency fosc_lo 32 40 kHz
2Crystal Start-up Time (1)
1. Proper PC board layout procedures must be followed to achieve specifications.
tcst 1000 4000 ms
Appendix L OSC32K Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
820 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix M SPI Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 821
Appendix M
SPI Electrical Specifications
This section provides electrical parametrics and ratings for the SPI.
In Table M-1. the measurement conditions are listed.
M.1 Master Mode
In Figure M-1. the timing diagram for master mode with transmission format CPHA=0 is
depicted.
Figure M-1. SPI Master Timing (CPHA=0)
In Figure M-2. the timing diagram for master mode with transmission format CPHA=1 is
depicted.
Table M-1. Measurement Conditions
Description Value Unit
Drive mode full drive mode
Load capacitance CLOAD(1),
on all outputs
1. Timing specified for equal load on all SPI output pins. Avoid asymmetric load.
50 pF
Thresholds for delay
measurement points (20% / 80%) VDDX V
SCK
(OUTPUT)
SCK
(OUTPUT)
MISO
(INPUT)
MOSI
(OUTPUT)
SS1
(OUTPUT)
1
9
5 6
MSB IN2
BIT 6 . . . 1
LSB IN
MSB OUT2LSB OUT
BIT 6 . . . 1
11
4
4
2
10
(CPOL 0)
(CPOL 1)
3
13
13
1. If enabled.
2. LSBFE = 0. For LSBFE = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.
12
12
Appendix M SPI Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
822 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure M-2. SPI Master Timing (CPHA=1)
In Table M-2. the timing characteristics for master mode are listed.
Table M-2. SPI Master Mode Timing Characteristics
Num Characteristic Symbol Unit
Min Typ Max
1 SCK Frequency fsck 1/2048 12(1)
1. pls. see Figure M-3.
fbus
1SCK Period tsck 21 2048 tbus
2 Enable Lead Time tlead —1/2 tsck
3 Enable Lag Time tlag —1/2 tsck
4 Clock (SCK) High or Low Time twsck —1/2 tsck
5 Data Setup Time (Inputs) tsu 8— ns
6 Data Hold Time (Inputs) thi 8— ns
9 Data Valid after SCK Edge tvsck 15 ns
10 Data Valid after SS fall (CPHA=0) tvss 15 ns
11 Data Hold Time (Outputs) tho 0— ns
12 Rise and Fall Time Inputs trfi —— 8 ns
13 Rise and Fall Time Outputs trfo —— 8 ns
SCK
(OUTPUT)
SCK
(OUTPUT)
MISO
(INPUT)
MOSI
(OUTPUT)
1
5 6
MSB IN2
BIT 6 . . . 1
LSB IN
MASTER MSB OUT2MASTER LSB OUT
BIT 6 . . . 1
4
4
9
12 13
11
(CPOL 0)
(CPOL 1)
SS1
(OUTPUT)
212 13 3
1. If enabled.
2. LSBFE = 0. For LSBFE = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.
Appendix M SPI Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 823
Figure M-3. Derating of maximum fSCK to fbus ratio in Master Mode
In Master Mode the allowed maximum f
SCK to fbus ratio (= minimum Baud Rate Divisor, pls. see
SPI Block Guide) derates with increasing fbus, please see Figure M-3..
M.2 Slave Mode
In Figure M-4. the timing diagram for slave mode with transmission format CPHA=0 is depicted.
1/2
1/4
fSCK/fbus
fbus [MHz]
10 20 30 40
15 25 355
Appendix M SPI Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
824 Freescale Semiconductor
Figure M-4. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA=0)
In Figure M-5. the timing diagram for slave mode with transmission format CPHA=1 is depicted.
Figure M-5. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA=1)
SCK
(INPUT)
SCK
(INPUT)
MOSI
(INPUT)
MISO
(OUTPUT)
SS
(INPUT)
1
9
5 6
MSB IN
BIT 6 . . . 1
LSB IN
SLAVE MSB SLAVE LSB OUT
BIT 6 . . . 1
11
4
4
2
7
(CPOL 0)
(CPOL 1)
3
13
NOTE: Not defined!
12
12
11
see
13
note
8
10
see
note
SCK
(INPUT)
SCK
(INPUT)
MOSI
(INPUT)
MISO
(OUTPUT)
1
5 6
MSB IN
BIT 6 . . . 1
LSB IN
MSB OUT SLAVE LSB OUT
BIT 6 . . . 1
4
4
9
12 13
11
(CPOL 0)
(CPOL 1)
SS
(INPUT)
212 13 3
NOTE: Not defined!
SLAVE
7
8
see
note
Appendix M SPI Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 825
In Table M-3. the timing characteristics for slave mode are listed.
Table M-3. SPI Slave Mode Timing Characteristics
Num Characteristic Symbol Unit
Min Typ Max
1 SCK Frequency fsck DC 14fbus
1SCK Period tsck 4— tbus
2 Enable Lead Time tlead 4— tbus
3 Enable Lag Time tlag 4— tbus
4 Clock (SCK) High or Low Time twsck 4— tbus
5 Data Setup Time (Inputs) tsu 8— ns
6 Data Hold Time (Inputs) thi 8— ns
7 Slave Access Time (time to data active) ta—— 20 ns
8 Slave MISO Disable Time tdis —— 22 ns
9 Data Valid after SCK Edge tvsck —— (1)
1. 0.5tbus added due to internal synchronization delay
ns
10 Data Valid after SS fall tvss —— 1ns
11 Data Hold Time (Outputs) tho 20 ns
12 Rise and Fall Time Inputs trfi —— 8 ns
13 Rise and Fall Time Outputs trfo —— 8 ns
28 0.5 tbus
+
28 0.5 tbus
+
Appendix M SPI Electrical Specifications
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
826 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix N Ordering Information
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 827
Appendix N
Ordering Information
The following figure provides an ordering partnumber example for the devices covered by this data book.
There are two options when ordering a device. Customers must choose between ordering either the mask-
specific partnumber or the generic / mask-independent partnumber. Ordering the mask-specific
partnumber enables the customer to specify which particular maskset they will receive whereas ordering
the generic maskset means that the currently preferred maskset (which may change over time) is shipped.
In either case, the marking on the device will always show the generic / mask-independent partnumber and
the mask set number.
NOTE
The mask identifier suffix and the Tape & Reel suffix are always both omitted from the
partnumber which is actually marked on the device.
For specific partnumbers to order, please contact your local sales office. The below figure illustrates the
structure of a typical mask-specific ordering number for the MC9S12ZVH128 devices
Figure N-1. Part Number
S 9 12Z VH128 F0 V LQ R
Package Option:
Temperature Option:
Device Title
Controller Family
C = -40°C to 85°C
V = -40°C to 105°C
Status / Partnumber type:
S or SC = Maskset specific partnumber
MC = Generic / mask-independent partnumber
P or PC = prototype status (pre qualification)
Main Memory Type:
9 = Flash
3 = ROM (if available)
Maskset identifier Suffix:
First digit usually references wafer fab
Second digit usually differentiates mask rev.
(This suffix is omitted in generic partnumbers)
Tape & Reel:
R = Tape & Reel
No R = No Tape & Reel
LQ = 144 LQFP
LL = 100 LQFP
Appendix N Ordering Information
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
828 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 829
Appendix O
Package Information
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
830 Freescale Semiconductor
O.1 144 LQFP
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 831
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
832 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 833
O.2 100 LQFP
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
834 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 835
Appendix O Package Information
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
836 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 837
Appendix P
Detailed Register Address Map
Table P-1. Revision History
P.1 Detailed Register Map
The following tables show the detailed register map of the MC9S12ZVH-Family.
NOTE
This is a summary of all register bits implemented on MC9S12ZVH
devices. Each member of the MC9S12ZVH-Family implements the subset
of registers, which is associated with its feature set (see Table 1-2).
Version
Number Revision
Date Description of Changes
Rev 0.01 22-June-2011 Initial Version
Rev 0.07 17-Feb-2012 Fix typos
Rev 0.08 17-Oct-2012 Update for DBG/RTC/FTMRZ/CPMU etc register for 1N65E device
correct PARTID description
Rev 0.09 21-Nov-2012 Update the SCI register for 1N65E
Update CANPHY register for 1N65E
0x0000–0x0003 PARTID registers
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0000 PARTID0 R00000001
W
0x0001 PARTID1 R00010111
W
0x0002 PARTID2 R Revision Dependent
W
0x0003 PARTID3 R00000000
W
0x0004–0x000F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0004-
0x000F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0010–0x001F Interrupt Control module(INT)
0x0010 IVBR R IVB_ADDR[15:8]
W
0x0011 R IVB_ADDR[7:1] 0
W
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
838 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0012-
0x0015
ReservedR00000000
W
0x0016INT_XGPRIOR00000 XILVL[2:0]
W
0x0017 INT_CFADDR R 0 INT_CFADDR[6:3] 000
W
0x0018 INT_CFDATA0 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x0019 INT_CFDATA1 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x001A INT_CFDATA2 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x001B INT_CFDATA3 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x001C INT_CFDATA4 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x001D INT_CFDATA5 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x001E INT_CFDATA6 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x001F INT_CFDATA7 R RQST 0000 PRIOLVL[2:0]
W
0x0020–0x006F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0020-
0x006F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0070–0x00FF Memory Map Control Module(MMC)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0070 MODE R MODC 0000000
W
0x0071-
0x007F
ReservedR00000000
W
0x0080 MMCECH R ITR[3:0] TGT[2:0]
W
0x0010–0x001F Interrupt Control module(INT)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 839
0x0081 MMCECL R ACC[3:0] ERR[3:0]
W
0x0082 MMCCCRH R CPUU 0000000
W
0x0083 MMCCCRL R 0 CPUX 0 CPUI 0 0 0 0
W
0x0084ReservedR00000000
W
0x0085 MMCPCH R CPUPC[23:16]
W
0x0086 MMCPCM R CPUPC[15:8]
W
0x0087 MMCPCL R CPUPC[7:0]
W
0x0088-
0x00FF
ReservedR00000000
W
0x0100–0x017F Debug Module (DBG V1)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0100 DBGC1 RARM 0reserved BDMBP BRKCPU reserved EEVE
WTRIG
0x0101 DBGC2 R0000 CDCM ABCM
W
0x0102 DBGTCRH Rreserved TSOURCE TRANGE TRCMOD TALIGN
W
0x0103 DBGTCRL R0000
DSTAMP PDOE PROFILE STAMP
W
0x0104 DBGTB R Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
W
0x0105 DBGTB R Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
0x0106 DBGCNT R0 CNT
W
0x0107 DBGSCR1 RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
0x0070–0x00FF Memory Map Control Module(MMC)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
840 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0108 DBGSCR2 RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
0x0109 DBGSCR3 RC3SC1 C3SC0 C2SC1 C2SC0 C1SC1 C1SC0 C0SC1 C0SC0
W
0x010A DBGEFR R PTBOVF TRIGF 0 EEVF ME3 ME2 ME1 ME0
W
0x010B DBGSR R TBF 0 0 PTACT 0 SSF2 SSF1 SSF0
W
0x010C-
0x010F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0110 DBGACTL R0 NDB INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0111-
0x0114 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0115 DBGAAH RDBGAA[23:16]
W
0x0116 DBGAAM RDBGAA[15:8]
W
0x0117 DBGAAL RDBGAA[7:0]
W
0x0118 DBGAD0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x0119 DBGAD1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x011A DBGAD2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
0x011B DBGAD3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x011C DBGADM0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x011D DBGADM1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x011E DBGADM2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
0x011F DBGADM3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x0120 DBGBCTL R0 0 INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0100–0x017F Debug Module (DBG V1)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 841
0x0121-
0x0124 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0125 DBGBAH RDBGBA[23:16]
W
0x0126 DBGBAM RDBGBA[15:8]
W
0x0127 DBGBAL RDBGBA[7:0]
W
0x0128-
0x012F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0130 DBGCCTL R0 NDB INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0131-
0x0134 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0135 DBGCAH RDBGCA[23:16]
W
0x0136 DBGCAM RDBGCA[15:8]
W
0x0137 DBGCAL RDBGCA[7:0]
W
0x0138 DBGCD0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x0139 DBGCD1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x013A DBGCD2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
0x013B DBGCD3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x013C DBGCDM0 RBit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 Bit 24
W
0x013D DBGCDM1 RBit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 Bit 16
W
0x013E DBGCDM2 RBit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8
W
0x013F DBGCDM3 RBit 7654321Bit 0
W
0x0140 DBGDCTL R0 0 INST 0RW RWE reserved COMPE
W
0x0100–0x017F Debug Module (DBG V1)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
842 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0141-
0x0144 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0145 DBGDAH RDBGDA[23:16]
W
0x0146 DBGDAM RDBGDA[15:8]
W
0x0147 DBGDAL RDBGDA[7:0]
W
0x0148-
0x017F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0180–0x01FF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0180-
0x01FF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0200 MODRR0 R0000
C0CP0RR
3
C0CP0RR
2
C0CP0RR
1
C0CP0RR
0
W
0x0201 MODRR1 R0000
PWM6RR PWM4RR PWM2RR PWM0RR
W
0x0202 MODRR2 R0 0 SCI1RR IIC0RR 00
T1IC0RR1 T1IC0RR0
W
0x0203–
0x0207 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0208 ECLKCTL RNECLK 0000000
W
0x0209 IRQCR RIRQE IRQEN 000000
W
0x020A PIMMISC R0000000
CALCLKE
N
W
0x020B–
0x020D Reserved R00000000
W
0x020E Reserved RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0100–0x017F Debug Module (DBG V1)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 843
0x020F Reserved RReserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0210–
0x021F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0220 PTA RPTA7 PTA6 PTA5 PTA4 PTA3 PTA2 PTA1 PTA0
W
0x0221 PTB R0000
PTB3 PTB2 PTB1 PTB0
W
0x0222 PTIA R PTIA7 PTIA6 PTIA5 PTIA4 PTIA3 PTIA2 PTIA1 PTIA0
W
0x0223 PTIB R0000PTIB3PTIB2PTIB1PTIB0
W
0x0224 DDRA RDDRA7 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0
W
0x0225 DDRB R0000
DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0
W
0x0226 PERA RPERA7 PERA6 PERA5 PERA4 PERA3 PERA2 PERA1 PERA0
W
0x0227 PERB R0000
PERB3 PERB2 PERB1 PERB0
W
0x0228 PPSA RPPSA7 PPSA6 PPSA5 PPSA4 PPSA3 PPSA2 PPSA1 PPSA0
W
0x0229 PPSB R0000
PPSB3 PPSB2 PPSB1 PPSB0
W
0x022A–
0x023D Reserved R00000000
W
0x023E WOMA R0000
WOMA3 WOMA2 00
W
0x023F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0240 PTC RPTC7 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1 PTC0
W
0x0241 PTD RPTD7 PTD6 PTD5 PTD4 PTD3 PTD2 PTD1 PTD0
W
0x0242 PTIC R PTIC7 PTIC6 PTIC5 PTIC4 PTIC3 PTIC2 PTIC1 PTIC0
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
844 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0243 PTID R PTID7 PTID6 PTID5 PTID4 PTID3 PTID2 PTID1 PTID0
W
0x0244 DDRC RDDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0
W
0x0245 DDRD RDDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0
W
0x0246 PERC RPERC7 PERC6 PERC5 PERC4 PERC3 PERC2 PERC1 PERC0
W
0x0247 PERD RPERD7 PERD6 PERD5 PERD4 PERD3 PERD2 PERD1 PERD0
W
0x0248 PPSC RPPSC7 PPSC6 PPSC5 PPSC4 PPSC3 PPSC2 PPSC1 PPSC0
W
0x0249 PPSD RPPSD7 PPSD6 PPSD5 PPSD4 PPSD3 PPSD2 PPSD1 PPSD0
W
0x024A–
0x025F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0260 PTE R0000
PTE3 PTE2 PTE1 PTE0
W
0x0261 PTF RPTF7 PTF6 PTF5 PTF4 PTF3 PTF2 PTF1 PTF0
W
0x0262 PTIE R0000PTIE3PTIE2PTIE1PTIE0
W
0x0263 PTIF R PTIF7 PTIF6 PTIF5 PTIF4 PTIF3 PTIF2 PTIF1 PTIF0
W
0x0264 DDRE R0000
DDRE3 DDRE2 DDRE1 DDRE0
W
0x0265 DDRF RDDRF7 DDRF6 DDRF5 DDRF4 DDRF3 DDRF2 DDRF1 DDRF0
W
0x0266 PERE R0000
PERE3 PERE2 PERE1 PERE0
W
0x0267 PERF RPERF7 PERF6 PERF5 PERF4 PERF3 PERF2 PERF1 PERF0
W
0x0268 PPSE R0000
PPSE3 PPSE2 PPSE1 PPSE0
W
0x0269 PPSF RPPSF7 PPSF6 PPSF5 PPSF4 PPSF3 PPSF2 PPSF1 PPSF0
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 845
0x026A–
0x027F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0280 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0281 PTADL RPTADL7 PTADL6 PTADL5 PTADL4 PTADL3 PTADL2 PTADL1 PTADL0
W
0x0282 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0283 PTIADL R PTIADL7 PTIADL6 PTIADL5 PTIADL4 PTIADL3 PTIADL2 PTIADL1 PTIADL0
W
0x0284 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0285 DDRADL RDDRADL7 DDRADL6 DDRADL5 DDRADL4 DDRADL3 DDRADL2 DDRADL1 DDRADL0
W
0x0286 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0287 PERADL RPERADL7 PERADL6 PERADL5 PERADL4 PERADL3 PERADL2 PERADL1 PERADL0
W
0x0288 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0289 PPSADL RPPSADL7 PPSADL6 PPSADL5 PPSADL4 PPSADL3 PPSADL2 PPSADL1 PPSADL0
W
0x028A–
0x028B Reserved R00000000
W
0x028C Reserved R00000000
W
0x028D PIEADL RPIEADL7 PIEADL6 PIEADL5 PIEADL4 PIEADL3 PIEADL2 PIEADL1 PIEADL0
W
0x028E Reserved R00000000
W
0x028F PIFADL RPIFADL7 PIFADL6 PIFADL5 PIFADL4 PIFADL3 PIFADL2 PIFADL1 PIFADL0
W
0x0290–
0x0298 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0299 DIENADL RDIENADL7 DIENADL6 DIENADL5 DIENADL4 DIENADL3 DIENADL2 DIENADL1 DIENADL0
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
846 Freescale Semiconductor
0x029A–
0x02BF Reserved R00000000
W
0x02C0 PTT R PTT7 PTT6 PTT5 PTT4 PTT3 PTT2 PTT1 PTT0
W
0x02C1 PTIT R PTIT7 PTIT6 PTIT5 PTIT4 PTIT3 PTIT2 PTIT1 PTIT0
W
0x02C2 DDRT R DDRT7 DDRT6 DDRT5 DDRT4 DDRT3 DDRT2 DDRT1 DDRT0
W
0x02C3 PERT R PERT7 PERT6 PERT5 PERT4 PERT3 PERT2 PERT1 PERT0
W
0x02C4 PPST R PPST7 PPST6 PPST5 PPST4 PPST3 PPST2 PPST1 PPST0
W
0x02C5 Reserved R00000000
W
0x02C6 PIET RPIET7 PIET6 PIET5 PIET4 PIET3 PIET2 PIET1 PIET0
W
0x02C7 PIFT RPIFT7 PIFT6 PIFT5 PIFT4 PIFT3 PIFT2 PIFT1 PIFT0
W
0x02C8–
0x02CF Reserved R00000000
W
0x02D0 PTS RPTS7 PTS6 PTS5 PTS4 PTS3 PTS2 PTS1 PTS0
W
0x02D1 PTIS R PTIS7 PTIS6 PTIS5 PTIS4 PTIS3 PTIS2 PTIS1 PTIS0
W
0x02D2 DDRS RDDRS7 DDRS6 DDRS5 DDRS4 DDRS3 DDRS2 DDRS1 DDRS0
W
0x02D3 PERS RPERS7 PERS6 PERS5 PERS4 PERS3 PERS2 PERS1 PERS0
W
0x02D4 PPSS RPPSS7 PPSS6 PPSS5 PPSS4 PPSS3 PPSS2 PPSS1 PPSS0
W
0x02D5 Reserved R00000000
W
0x02D6 PIES RPIES7 PIES6 PIES5 PIES4 PIES3 PIES2 PIES1 PIES0
W
0x02D7 PIFS RPIFS7 PIFS6 PIFS5 PIFS4 PIFS3 PIFS2 PIFS1 PIFS0
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 847
0x02D8–
0x02DE Reserved R00000000
W
0x02DF WOMS RWOMS7WOMS6WOMS5WOMS4WOMS3WOMS2WOMS1WOMS0
W
0x02E0–
0x02EF Reserved R00000000
W
0x02F0 PTP RPTP7 PTP6 PTP5 PTP4 PTP3 PTP2 PTP1 PTP0
W
0x02F1 PTIP R PTIP7 PTIP6 PTIP5 PTIP4 PTIP3 PTIP2 PTIP1 PTIP0
W
0x02F2 DDRP RDDRP7 DDRP6 DDRP5 DDRP4 DDRP3 DDRP2 DDRP1 DDRP0
W
0x02F3 PERP RPERP7 PERP6 PERP5 PERP4 PERP3 PERP2 PERP1 PERP0
W
0x02F4 PPSP RPPSP7 PPSP6 PPSP5 PPSP4 PPSP3 PPSP2 PPSP1 PPSP0
W
0x02F5–
0x02FF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0300 PTH RPTH7 PTH6 PTH5 PTH4 PTH3 PTH2 PTH1 PTH0
W
0x0301 PTIH R PTIH7 PTIH6 PTIH5 PTIH4 PTIH3 PTIH2 PTIH1 PTIH0
W
0x0302 DDRH RDDRH7 DDRH6 DDRH5 DDRH4 DDRH3 DDRH2 DDRH1 DDRH0
W
0x0303 PERH RPERH7 PERH6 PERH5 PERH4 PERH3 PERH2 PERH1 PERH0
W
0x0304 PPSH RPPSH7 PPSH6 PPSH5 PPSH4 PPSH3 PPSH2 PPSH1 PPSH0
W
0x0305–
0x030F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0310–
0x031F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0320 PTG RPTG7 PTG6 PTG5 PTG4 PTG3 PTG2 PTG1 PTG0
W
0x0321 PTIG RPTIG7 PTIG6 PTIG5 PTIG4 PTIG3 PTIG2 PTIG1 PTIG0
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
848 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0322 DDRG RDDRG7 DDRG6 DDRG5 DDRG4 DDRG3 DDRG2 DDRG1 DDRG0
W
0x0323 PERG RPERG7 PERG6 PERG5 PERG4 PERG3 PERG2 PERG1 PERG0
W
0x0324 PPSG RPPSG7 PPSG6 PPSG5 PPSG4 PPSG3 PPSG2 PPSG1 PPSG0
W
0x0325–
0x032F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0350 PTU RPTU7 PTU6 PTU5 PTU4 PTU3 PTU2 PTU1 PTU0
W
0x0351 PTIU R PTIU7 PTIU6 PTIU5 PTIU4 PTIU3 PTIU2 PTIU1 PTIU0
W
0x0352 DDRU RDDRU7 DDRU6 DDRU5 DDRU4 DDRU3 DDRU2 DDRU1 DDRU0
W
0x0353 PERU RPERU7 PERU6 PERU5 PERU4 PERU3 PERU2 PERU1 PERU0
W
0x0354 PPSU RPPSU7 PPSU6 PPSU5 PPSU4 PPSU3 PPSU2 PPSU1 PPSU0
W
0x0355–
0x035D Reserved R00000000
W
0x035E SRRU RSRRU7 SRRU6 SRRU5 SRRU4 SRRU3 SRRU2 SRRU1 SRRU0
W
0x035F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0360 PTV RPTV7 PTV6 PTV5 PTV4 PTV3 PTV2 PTV1 PTV0
W
0x0361 PTIV R PTIV7 PTIV6 PTIV5 PTIV4 PTIV3 PTIV2 PTIV1 PTIV0
W
0x0362 DDRV RDDRV7 DDRV6 DDRV5 DDRV4 DDRV3 DDRV2 DDRV1 DDRV0
W
0x0363 PERV RPERV7 PERV6 PERV5 PERV4 PERV3 PERV2 PERV1 PERV0
W
0x0364 PPSV RPPSV7 PPSV6 PPSV5 PPSV4 PPSV3 PPSV2 PPSV1 PPSV0
W
0x0365–
0x036D Reserved R00000000
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 849
0x036E SRRV RSRRV7 SRRV6 SRRV5 SRRV4 SRRV3 SRRV2 SRRV1 SRRV0
W
0x036F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0370–
0x037F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0380–0x039F Flash Module(FTMRZ)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0380 FCLKDIV RFDIVLD FDIVLCK FDIV5 FDIV4 FDIV3 FDIV2 FDIV1 FDIV0
W
0x0381 FSEC R KEYEN1 KEYEN0 RNV5 RNV4 RNV3 RNV2 SEC1 SEC0
W
0x0382 FCCOBIX R00000
CCOBIX2 CCOBIX1 CCOBIX0
W
0x0383 FPSTAT
RFPOVRD000000
WSTATAC
K
W
0x0384 FCNFG RCCIE 0 ERSAREQ IGNSF WSTAT[1:0] FDFD FSFD
W
0x0385 FERCNFG R0000000
SFDIE
W
0x0386 FSTAT RCCIF 0ACCERR FPVIOL MGBUSY RSVD MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0
W
0x0387 FERSTAT R0000000
SFDIF
W
0x0388 FPROT RFPOPEN RNV6 FPHDIS FPHS1 FPHS0 FPLDIS FPLS1 FPLS0
W
0x0389 DFPROT RDPOPEN DPS6 DPS5 DPS4 DPS3 DPS2 DPS1 DPS0
W
0x038A FOPT R NV7 NV6 NV5 NV4 NV3 NV2 NV1 NV0
W
0x038B FRSV1 R00000000
W
0x038C FCCOB0HI RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x038D FCCOB0LO RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0200–0x037F Port Integration Module(PIM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
850 Freescale Semiconductor
0x038E FCCOB1HI RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x038F FCCOB1LO RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0390 FCCOB2HI RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x0391 FCCOB2LO RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0392 FCCOB3HI RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x0393 FCCOB3LO RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0394 FCCOB4HI RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x0395 FCCOB4LO RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0396 FCCOB5HI RCCOB15 CCOB14 CCOB13 CCOB12 CCOB11 CCOB10 CCOB9 CCOB8
W
0x0397 FCCOB5LO RCCOB7 CCOB6 CCOB5 CCOB4 CCOB3 CCOB2 CCOB1 CCOB0
W
0x0398-
0x039F Reserved R00000000
W
0x03A0–0x03BF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x03A0-
0x03BF Reserved R00000000
W
0x03C0–0x03CF SRAM ECC Generator(SRAM_ECC)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x03C0 ECCSTATR0000000RDY
W
0x03C1 ECCIER0000000
SBEEIE
W
0x03C2 ECCIFR0000000
SBEEIF
W
0x0380–0x039F Flash Module(FTMRZ)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 851
0x03C3-
0x03C6
ReservedR00000000
W
0x03C7 ECCDPTRH R DPTR[23:16]
W
0x03C8 ECCDPTRM R DPTR[15:8]
W
0x03C9 ECCDPTRL R DPTR[7:1] 0
W
0x03CA-
0x3CB
ReservedR00000000
W
0x03CC ECCDDH R DDATA[15:8]
W
0x03CD ECCDDL R DDATA[7:0]
W
0x03CE ECCDE R 0 0 DECC[5:0]
W
0x03CF ECCDCMD R ECCDRR 00000
ECCDW ECCDR
W
0x03D0–0x03FF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x03D0-
0x03FF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0400–0x042F Timer Module (TIM1)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0400 TIM1TIOS RIOS7 IOS6 IOS5 IOS4 IOS3 IOS2 IOS1 IOS0
W
0x0401 TIM1CFORC R00000000
WFOC7FOC6FOC5FOC4FOC3FOC2FOC1FOC0
0x0402 TIM1OC7M ROC7M7OC7M6OC7M5OC7M4OC7M3OC7M2OC7M1OC7M0
W
0x0403 TIM1OC7D ROC7D7 OC7D6 OC7D5 OC7D4 OC7D3 OC7D2 OC7D1 OC7D0
W
0x03C0–0x03CF SRAM ECC Generator(SRAM_ECC)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
852 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0404 TIM1TCNTH RTCNT15 TCNT14 TCNT13 TCNT12 TCNT11 TCNT10 TCNT9 TCNT8
W
0x0405 TIM1TCNTL RTCNT7 TCNT6 TCNT5 TCNT4 TCNT3 TCNT2 TCNT1 TCNT0
W
0x0406 TIM1TSCR1 RTEN TSWAI TSFRZ TFFCA PRNT 000
W
0x0407 TIM1TTOV RTOV7 TOV6 TOV5 TOV4 TOV3 TOV2 TOV1 TOV0
W
0x0408 TIM1TCTL1 ROM7 OL7 OM6 OL6 OM5 OL5 OM4 OL4
W
0x0409 TIM1TCTL2 ROM3 OL3 OM2 OL2 OM1 OL1 OM0 OL0
W
0x040A TIM1TCTL3 REDG7B EDG7A EDG6B EDG6A EDG5B EDG5A EDG4B EDG4A
W
0x040B TIM1TCTL4 REDG3B EDG3A EDG2B EDG2A EDG1B EDG1A EDG0B EDG0A
W
0x040C TIM1TIE RC7I C6I C5I C4I C3I C2I C1I C0I
W
0x040D TIM1TSCR2 RTOI 000
TCRE PR2 PR1 PR0
W
0x040E TIM1TFLG1 RC7FC6FC5FC4FC3FC2FC1FC0F
W
0x040F TIM1TFLG2 RTOF 0000000
W
0x0410
0x041F
TIM1TCxH –
TIM1TCxL
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
W
RBit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
0x0420 TIM1PACTL R0 PAEN PAMOD PEDGE CLK1 CLK0 PAOVI PAI
W
0x0421 TIM1PAFLG R000000
PAOVF PAIF
W
0x0422 TIM1PACNTH RPACNT15 PACNT14 PACNT13 PACNT12 PACNT11 PACNT10 PACNT9 PACNT8
W
0x0423 TIM1PACNTL RPACNT7 PACNT6 PACNT5 PACNT4 PACNT3 PACNT2 PACNT1 PACNT0
W
0x0400–0x042F Timer Module (TIM1)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 853
0x0424-
0x042B Reserved R
W
0x042C TIM1OCPD ROCPD7 OCPD6 OCPD5 OCPD4 OCPD3 OCPD2 OCPD1 OCPD0
W
0x042D Reserved R
W
0x042E TIM1PTPSR RPTPS7 PTPS6 PTPS5 PTPS4 PTPS3 PTPS2 PTPS1 PTPS0
W
0x042F Reserved R
W
0x0430–0x047F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0430-
0x047F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0480–0x04A7 Pulse-Width-Modulator (PWM)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0480 PWME RPWME7 PWME6 PWME5 PWME4 PWME3 PWME2 PWME1 PWME0
W
0x0481 PWMPOL RPPOL7 PPOL6 PPOL5 PPOL4 PPOL3 PPOL2 PPOL1 PPOL0
W
0x0482 PWMCLK RPCLK7 PCLKL6 PCLK5 PCLK4 PCLK3 PCLK2 PCLK1 PCLK0
W
0x0483 PWMPRCLK R0 PCKB2 PCKB1 PCKB0 0PCKA2 PCKA1 PCKA0
W
0x0484 PWMCAE RCAE7 CAE6 CAE5 CAE4 CAE3 CAE2 CAE1 CAE0
W
0x0485 PWMCTL RCON67 CON45 CON23 CON01 PSWAI PFRZ 00
W
0x0486 PWMCLKAB RPCLKAB7 PCLKAB6 PCLKAB5 PCLKAB4 PCLKAB3 PCLKAB2 PCLKAB1 PCLKAB0
W
0x0487 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0488 PWMSCLA RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0400–0x042F Timer Module (TIM1)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
854 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0489 PWMSCLB RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x048A -
0x048B Reserved R00000000
W
0x048C PWMCNT0 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x048D PWMCNT1 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x048E PWMCNT2 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x048F PWMCNT3 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x0490 PWMCNT4 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x0491 PWMCNT5 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x0492 PWMCNT6 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x0493 PWMCNT7 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W00000000
0x0494 PWMPER0 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0495 PWMPER1 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0496 PWMPER2 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0497 PWMPER3 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0498 PWMPER4 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0499 PWMPER5 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x049A PWMPER6 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x049B PWMPER7 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x0480–0x04A7 Pulse-Width-Modulator (PWM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 855
0x049C PWMDTY0 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x049D PWMDTY1 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x049E PWMDTY2 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x049F PWMDTY3 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x04A0 PWMDTY4 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x04A1 PWMDTY5 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x04A2 PWMDTY6 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x04A3 PWMDTY7 RBit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
W
0x04A4-
0x04A7 Reserved R00000000
W
0x04A8–0x05BF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x04A8-
0x05BF Reserved R00000000
W
0x05C0–0x05EF Timer Module (TIM0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x05C0 TIM0TIOS RIOS7 IOS6 IOS5 IOS4 IOS3 IOS2 IOS1 IOS0
W
0x05C1 TIM0CFORC R00000000
WFOC7FOC6FOC5FOC4FOC3FOC2FOC1FOC0
0x05C2 TIM0OC7M ROC7M7OC7M6OC7M5OC7M4OC7M3OC7M2OC7M1OC7M0
W
0x05C3 TIM0OC7D ROC7D7 OC7D6 OC7D5 OC7D4 OC7D3 OC7D2 OC7D1 OC7D0
W
0x05C4 TIM0TCNTH RTCNT15 TCNT14 TCNT13 TCNT12 TCNT11 TCNT10 TCNT9 TCNT8
W
0x0480–0x04A7 Pulse-Width-Modulator (PWM)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
856 Freescale Semiconductor
0x05C5 TIM0TCNTL RTCNT7 TCNT6 TCNT5 TCNT4 TCNT3 TCNT2 TCNT1 TCNT0
W
0x05C6 TIM0TSCR1 RTEN TSWAI TSFRZ TFFCA PRNT 000
W
0x05C7 TIM0TTOV RTOV7 TOV6 TOV5 TOV4 TOV3 TOV2 TOV1 TOV0
W
0x05C8 TIM0TCTL1 ROM7 OL7 OM6 OL6 OM5 OL5 OM4 OL4
W
0x05C9 TIM0TCTL2 ROM3 OL3 OM2 OL2 OM1 OL1 OM0 OL0
W
0x05CA TIM0TCTL3 REDG7B EDG7A EDG6B EDG6A EDG5B EDG5A EDG4B EDG4A
W
0x05CB TIM0TCTL4 REDG3B EDG3A EDG2B EDG2A EDG1B EDG1A EDG0B EDG0A
W
0x05CC TIM0TIE RC7I C6I C5I C4I C3I C2I C1I C0I
W
0x05CD TIM0TSCR2 RTOI 000
TCRE PR2 PR1 PR0
W
0x05CE TIM0TFLG1 RC7FC6FC5FC4FC3FC2FC1FC0F
W
0x05CF TIM0TFLG2 RTOF 0000000
W
0x05D0
0x05DF
TIM0TCxH –
TIM0TCxL
RBit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
W
RBit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
W
0x05E0 TIM0PACTL R0 PAEN PAMOD PEDGE CLK1 CLK0 PAOVI PAI
W
0x05E1 TIM0PAFLG R000000
PAOVF PAIF
W
0x05E2 TIM0PACNTH RPACNT15 PACNT14 PACNT13 PACNT12 PACNT11 PACNT10 PACNT9 PACNT8
W
0x05E3 TIM0PACNTL RPACNT7 PACNT6 PACNT5 PACNT4 PACNT3 PACNT2 PACNT1 PACNT0
W
0x05E4-
0x05EB Reserved R
W
0x05EC TIM0OCPD ROCPD7 OCPD6 OCPD5 OCPD4 OCPD3 OCPD2 OCPD1 OCPD0
W
0x05C0–0x05EF Timer Module (TIM0)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 857
0x05ED Reserved R
W
0x05EE TIM0PTPSR RPTPS7 PTPS6 PTPS5 PTPS4 PTPS3 PTPS2 PTPS1 PTPS0
W
0x05EF Reserved R
W
0x05F0–0x05FF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x05F0-
0x05FF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0600–0x063F Analog to Digital Converter (ADC)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0600 ADC0CTL_0 RADC_EN ADC_SR FRZ_MOD SWAI ACC_CFG[1:0] STR_SEQA MOD_CFG
W
0x0601 ADC0CTL_1 RCSL_BMOD RVL_BMOD SMOD_ACC AUT_RSTA 0000
W
0x0602 ADC0STS
R
CSL_SEL RVL_SEL
DBECC_ER
RReserved READY 0 00
W
0x0603 ADC0TIM R0 PRS[6:0]
W
0x0604 ADC0FMT RDJM 0000SRES[2:0]
W
0x0605 ADC0FLWCTL RSEQA TRIG RSTA LDOK 0000
W
0x0606 ADC0EIE RIA_EIE CMD_EIE EOL_EIE Reserved TRIG_EIE RSTAR_EIE LDOK_EIE 0
W
0x0607 ADC0IE RSEQAD_I
ECONIF_OIE Reserved 00000
W
0x0608 ADC0EiF RIA_EIF CMD_EIF EOL_EIF Reserved TRIG_EIF RSTAR_EIF LDOK_EIF 0
W
0x0609 ADC0IF RSEQAD_IF CONIF_OIF Reserved 00000
W
0x060A ADC0CO-
NIE_0
RCON_IE[15:8]
W
0x05C0–0x05EF Timer Module (TIM0)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
858 Freescale Semiconductor
0x060B ADC0CO-
NIE_1
RCON_IE[7:1] EOL_IE
W
0x060C ADC0CO-
NIF_0
RCON_IF[15:8]
W
0x060D ADC0CO-
NIF_1
RCON_IF[7:1] EOL_IF
W
0x060E ADC0IMDRI_0 RCSL_IMD RVL_IMD 000000
0x060F ADC0IMDRI_1 R0RIDX_IMD
W
0x0610 ADC0EOLRI RCSL_EOLRVL_EOL000000
W
0x0611 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0612 Reserved R00000000
W
0x0613 Reserved R Reserved Reserved 0 0
W
0x0614 ADC0CMD_0 R CMD_SEL 0 0 INTFLG_SEL[3:0]
W
0x0615 ADC0CMD_1 R VRH_SEL VRL_SEL CH_SEL[5:0]
W
0x0616 ADC0CMD_2 R SMP[4:0] 0 0 Reserved
W
0x0617 ADC0CMD_3 R Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0618 Reserved R Reserved
W
0x0619 Reserved R Reserved
W
0x061A Reserved R Reserved
W
0x061B Reserved R Reserved
W
0x061C ADC0CIDX R0 0 CMD_IDX[5:0]
W
0x0600–0x063F Analog to Digital Converter (ADC)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 859
0x061D ADC0CBP_0 RCMD_PTR[23:16]
W
0x061E ADC0CBP_1 RCMD_PTR[15:8]
W
0x061F ADC0CBP_2 RCMD_PTR[7:2] 00
W
0x0620 ADC0RIDX R 0 0 RES_IDX[5:0]
W
0x0621 ADC0RBP_0 R0000 RES_PTR[19:16]
W
0x0622 ADC0RBP_1 RRES_PTR[15:8]
W
0x0623 ADC0RBP_2 RRES_PTR[7:2] 00
W
0x0624 ADC0CROFF0 R0 CMDRES_OFF0[6:0]
W
0x0625 ADC0CROFF1 R0 CMDRES_OFF1[6:0]
W
0x0626 Reserved R0000 Reserved
W
0x0627 Reserved
R Reserved
W
0x0628 Reserved
R Reserved 00
W
0x0629 Reserved R Reserved 0 Reserved
W
0x0640–0x06BF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0640-
0x06BF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0600–0x063F Analog to Digital Converter (ADC)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
860 Freescale Semiconductor
0x06C0–0x06DF Clock and Power Management (CPMU_UHV)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x06C0 CPMU
RESERVED00
R00 000000
W
0x06C1 CPMU
RESERVED01
R00 000000
W
0x06C2 CPMU
RESERVED02
R00 000000
W
0x06C3 CPMURFLG R0 PORF LVRF 0COPRF 0OMRF PMRF
W
0x06C4 CPMU
SYNR
RVCOFRQ[1:0] SYNDIV[5:0]
W
0x06C5 CPMU
REFDIV
RREFFRQ[1:0] 00 REFDIV[3:0]
W
0x06C6 CPMU
POSTDIV
R000 POSTDIV[4:0]
W
0x06C7 CPMUIFLG RRTIF 00
LOCKIF LOCK 0 OSCIF UPOSC
W
0x06C8 CPMUINT RRTIE 00
LOCKIE 00
OSCIE 0
W
0x06C9 CPMUCLKS RPLLSEL PSTP CSAD COP
OSCSEL1 PRE PCE RTI
OSCSEL
COP
OSCSEL0
W
0x06CA CPMUPLL R0 0 FM1 FM0 0000
W
0x06CB CPMURTI RRTDECRTR6RTR5RTR4RTR3RTR2RTR1RTR0
W
0x06CC CPMUCOP
R
WCOP RSBCK
000
CR2 CR1 CR0
WWRTMAS
K
0x06CD RESERVED
CPMUTEST0
R00000000
W
0x06CE RESERVED
CPMUTEST1
R00000000
W
0x06CF CPMU
ARMCOP
R00000000
W Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x06D0 CPMU
HTCTL
R0 0 VSEL 0HTE HTDS HTIE HTIF
W
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 861
0x06D1 CPMU
LVCTL
R00 000LVDS
LVIE LVIF
W
0x06D2 CPMU
APICTL
RAPICLK 00
APIES APIEA APIFE APIE APIF
W
0x06D3 CPMUACLKT
R
RACLKTR5 ACLKTR4 ACLKTR3 ACLKTR2 ACLKTR1 ACLKTR0 00
W
0x06D4 CPMUAPIRH RAPIR15 APIR14 APIR13 APIR12 APIR11 APIR10 APIR9 APIR8
W
0x06D5 CPMUAPIRL RAPIR7 APIR6 APIR5 APIR4 APIR3 APIR2 APIR1 APIR0
W
0x06D6 RESERVED
CPMUTEST3
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x06D7 CPMUHTTR RHTOE 000
HTTR3 HTTR2 HTTR1 HTTR0
W
0x06D8 CPMU
IRCTRIMH
RTCTRIM[4:0] 0IRCTRIM[9:8]
W
0x06D9 CPMU
IRCTRIML
RIRCTRIM[7:0]
W
0x06DA CPMUOSC ROSCE Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x06DB CPMUPROT R0000000
PROT
W
0x06DC RESERVED
CPMUTEST2
R000 0 0 0 0 0
W
0x06DD CPMU
VREGCTL
R00 000
EXTCON EXTXON INTXON
W
0x06DE CPMUOSC2 R00 0000
OMRE OSCMOD
W
0x06DF CPMU
RESERVED1F
R00 000000
W
0x06C0–0x06DF Clock and Power Management (CPMU_UHV)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
862 Freescale Semiconductor
0x06E0–0x06EF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x06E0-
0x06EF Reserved R00000000
W
0x06F0–0x06F7 Supply Voltage Sensor (BATS)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x06F0 BATE R 0 BVHS BVLS[1:0] BSUAE BSUSE BSEAE BSESE
W
0x06F1 BATSRR000000BVHCBVLC
W
0x06F2 BATIER000000
BVHIE BVLIE
W
0x06F3 BATIFR000000
BVHIF BVLIF
W
0x06F4-
0x06F5
ReservedR00000000
W
0x06F8–0x06FF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x06F8-
0x06FF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0700–0x0707 Serial Communication Interface (SCI0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0700 SCI0BDH1RSBR15 SBR14 SBR13 SBR12 SBR11 SBR10 SBR9 SBR8
W
0x0701 SCI0BDL1RSBR7 SBR6 SBR5 SBR4 SBR3 SBR2 SBR1 SBR0
W
0x0702 SCI0CR11RLOOPS SCISWAI RSRC M WAKE ILT PE PT
W
0x0700 SCI0ASR12RRXEDGIF 0000
BERRV BERRIF BKDIF
W
0x0701 SCI0ACR12RRXEDGIE 00000
BERRIE BKDIE
W
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 863
0x0702 SCI0ACR22RIREN TNP1 TNP0 00
BERRM1 BERRM0 BKDFE
W
0x0703 SCI0CR2 RTIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK
W
0x0704 SCI0SR1 R TDRE TC RDRF IDLE OR NF FE PF
W
0x0705 SCI0SR2 RAMAP 00
TXPOL RXPOL BRK13 TXDIR RAF
W
0x0706 SCI0DRH RR8 T8 000000
W
0x0707 SCI0DRL RR7R6R5R4R3R2R1R0
WT7T6T5T4T3T2T1T0
1 These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCI0SR2 register is set to zero.
2 These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCI0SR2 register is set to one.
0x0708–0x070F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0708-
0x070F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0710–0x0717 Serial Communication Interface (SCI1)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0710 SCI1BDH1RSBR15 SBR14 SBR13 SBR12 SBR11 SBR10 SBR9 SBR8
W
0x0711 SCI1BDL1RSBR7 SBR6 SBR5 SBR4 SBR3 SBR2 SBR1 SBR0
W
0x0712 SCI1CR11RLOOPS SCISWAI RSRC M WAKE ILT PE PT
W
0x0710 SCI1ASR12RRXEDGIF 0000
BERRV BERRIF BKDIF
W
0x0711 SCI1ACR12RRXEDGIE 00000
BERRIE BKDIE
W
0x0712 SCI1ACR22RIREN TNP1 TNP0 00
BERRM1 BERRM0 BKDFE
W
0x0713 SCI1CR2 RTIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK
W
0x0700–0x0707 Serial Communication Interface (SCI0)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
864 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0714 SCI1SR1 R TDRE TC RDRF IDLE OR NF FE PF
W
0x0715 SCI1SR2 RAMAP 00
TXPOL RXPOL BRK13 TXDIR RAF
W
0x0716 SCI1DRH RR8 T8 000000
W
0x0717 SCI1DRL RR7R6R5R4R3R2R1R0
WT7T6T5T4T3T2T1T0
1 These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCI1SR2 register is set to zero.
2 These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCI1SR2 register is set to one.
0x0718–0x077F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0718-
0x077F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0780–0x0787 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0780 SPI0CR1 RSPIE SPE SPTIE MSTR CPOL CPHA SSOE LSBFE
W
0x0781 SPI0CR2 R0 XFRW 0MODFEN BIDIROE 0SPISWAI SPC0
W
0x0782 SPI0BR R0 SPPR2 SPPR1 SPPR0 0SPR2 SPR1 SPR0
W
0x0783 SPI0SR R SPIF 0 SPTEF MODF 0 0 0 0
W
0x0784 SPI0DRH RR15 R14 R13 R12 R11 R10 R9 R8
T15 T14 T13 T12 T11 T10 T9 T8
0x0785 SPI0DRL RR7R6R5R4R3R2R1R0
WT7T6T5T4T3T2T1T0
0x0786-
0x0787 Reserved R
W
0x0710–0x0717 Serial Communication Interface (SCI1)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 865
0x0788–0x07BF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0788-
0x07BF Reserved R00000000
W
0x07C0–0x07C7 Inter IC Bus (IIC0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x07C0 IIC0IBAD RADR7 ADR6 ADR5 ADR4 ADR3 ADR2 ADR1 0
W
0x07C1 IIC0IBFD RIBC7 IBC6 IBC5 IBC4 IBC3 IBC2 IBC1 IBC0
W
0x07C2 IIC0IBCR RIBEN IBIE MS/SL TX/RX TXAK 00
IBSWAI
WRSTA
0x07C3 IIC0IBSR RTCF IAAS IBB IBAL 0SRW
IBIF RXAK
W
0x07C4 IIC0IBDR RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D 0
W
0x07C5 IIC0IBCR2 RGCEN ADTYPE 000
ADR10 ADR9 ADR8
W
0x07C6 Reserved R00000000
W
0x07C7 Reserved R00000000
W
0x07C8–0x07FF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x07C8-
0x07FF Reserved R00000000
W
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
866 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0800–0x083F CAN Controller (MSCAN0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0800 CAN0CTL0 RRXFRM RXACT CSWAI SYNCH TIME WUPE SLPRQ INITRQ
W
0x0801 CAN0CTL1 RCANE CLKSRC LOOPB LISTEN BORM WUPM SLPAK INITAK
W
0x0802 CAN0BTR0 RSJW1 SJW0 BRP5 BRP4 BRP3 BRP2 BRP1 BRP0
W
0x0803 CAN0BTR1 RSAMP TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10
W
0x0804 CAN0RFLG RWUPIF CSCIF RSTAT1 RSTAT0 TSTAT1 TSTAT0 OVRIF RXF
W
0x0805 CAN0RIER RWUPIE CSCIE RSTATE1 RSTATE0 TSTATE1 TSTATE0 OVRIE RXFIE
W
0x0806 CAN0TFLG R0 0000
TXE2 TXE1 TXE0
W
0x0807 CAN0TIER R00000
TXEIE2 TXEIE1 TXEIE0
W
0x0808 CAN0TARQ R00000
ABTRQ2 ABTRQ1 ABTRQ0
W
0x0809 CAN0TAAK R00000ABTAK2 ABTAK1 ABTAK0
W
0x080A CAN0TBSEL R00000
TX2 TX1 TX0
W
0x080B CAN0IDAC R0 0 IDAM1 IDAM0 0 IDHIT2 IDHIT1 IDHIT0
W
0x080C Reserved R00000000
W
0x080D CAN0MISC R0000000
BOHOLD
W
0x080E CAN0RXERR R RXERR7 RXERR6 RXERR5 RXERR4 RXERR3 RXERR2 RXERR1 RXERR0
W
0x080F CAN0TXERR R TXERR7 TXERR6 TXERR5 TXERR4 TXERR3 TXERR2 TXERR1 TXERR0
W
0x0810-
0x0813 CAN0IDAR0–3 RAC7 AC6 AC5 AC4 AC3 AC2 AC1 AC0
W
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 867
0x0814-
0x0817 CAN0IDMRx RAM7AM6AM5AM4AM3AM2AM1AM0
W
0x0818-
0x081B CAN0IDAR4–7 RAC7 AC6 AC5 AC4 AC3 AC2 AC1 AC0
W
0x081C-
0x081F
CAN0IDMR4–
7
RAM7AM6AM5AM4AM3AM2AM1AM0
W
0x0820-
0x082F CAN0RXFG RSee 11.3.3”
W
0x0830-
0x083F CAN0TXFG RSee 11.3.3”
W
0x0840–0x098F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0840-
0x098F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0990–0x0997 CAN Physical Layer (CANPHY0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0990 CP0DR RCPDR700000
CPDR1 CPDR0
W
0x0991 CP0CR RCPE SPE WUPE 00
SLR2 SLR1 SLR0
W
0x0992 Reserved R0000Reserved0ReservedReserved
W
0x0993 CP0SR R CPCHVH CPCHVL CPCLVH CPCLVL CPDT 0 0 0
W
0x0994 Reserved R Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0995 Reserved R Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
W
0x0996 CP0IE R000
CPVFIE CPDTIE 00
CPOCIE
W
0x0997 CP0IF RCHVHIF CHVLIF CLVHIF CLVLIF CPDTIF 0CHOCIF CLOCIF
W
0x0800–0x083F CAN Controller (MSCAN0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
868 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0998–0x9FF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0998-
0x09FF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0A00–0x0A1F Liquid Crystal Display (LCD)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0A00 LCDCR0 RLCDEN 0 0 LCLK1 LCLK0 BIAS DUTY1 DUTY0
W
0x0A01 LCDCR1 R000000LCDSWAI LCDRSTP
W
0x0A02 LCDFPENR0 RFP7EN FP6EN FP5EN FP4EN FP3EN FP2EN FP1EN FP0EN
W
0x0A03 LCDFPENR1 RFP15EN FP14EN FP13EN FP12EN FP11EN FP10EN FP9EN FP8EN
W
0x0A04 LCDFPENR2 RFP23EN FP22EN FP21EN FP20EN FP19EN FP18EN FP17EN FP16EN
W
0x0A05 LCDFPENR3 RFP31EN FP30EN FP29EN FP28EN FP27EN FP26EN FP25EN FP24EN
W
0x0A06 LCDFPENR4 RFP39EN FP38EN FP37EN FP36EN FP35EN FP34EN FP33EN FP32EN
W
0x0A07 Reserved R
W
0x0A08 LCDRAM0 RFP1BP3 FP1BP2 FP1BP1 FP1BP0 FP0BP3 FP0BP2 FP0BP1 FP0BP0
W
0x0A09 LCDRAM1 RFP3BP3 FP3BP2 FP3BP1 FP3BP0 FP2BP3 FP2BP2 FP2BP1 FP2BP0
W
0x0A0A LCDRAM2 RFP5BP3 FP5BP2 FP5BP1 FP5BP0 FP4BP3 FP4BP2 FP4BP1 FP4BP0
W
0x0A0B LCDRAM3 RFP7BP3 FP7BP2 FP7BP1 FP7BP0 FP6BP3 FP6BP2 FP6BP1 FP6BP0
W
0x0A0C LCDRAM4 RFP9BP3 FP9BP2 FP9BP1 FP9BP0 FP8BP3 FP8BP2 FP8BP1 FP8BP0
W
0x0A0D LCDRAM5 RFP11BP3 FP11BP2 FP11BP1 FP11BP0 FP10BP3 FP10BP2 FP10BP1 FP10BP0
W
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 869
0x0A0E LCDRAM6 RFP13BP3 FP13BP2 FP13BP1 FP13BP0 FP12BP3 FP12BP2 FP12BP1 FP12BP0
W
0x0A0F LCDRAM7 RFP15BP3 FP15BP2 FP15BP1 FP15BP0 FP14BP3 FP14BP2 FP14BP1 FP14BP0
W
0x0A10 LCDRAM8 RFP17BP3 FP17BP2 FP17BP1 FP17BP0 FP16BP3 FP16BP2 FP16BP1 FP16BP0
W
0x0A11 LCDRAM9 RFP19BP3 FP19BP2 FP19BP1 FP19BP0 FP18BP3 FP18BP2 FP18BP1 FP18BP0
W
0x0A12 LCDRAM10 RFP21BP3 FP21BP2 FP21BP1 FP21BP0 FP20BP3 FP20BP2 FP20BP1 FP20BP0
W
0x0A13 LCDRAM11 RFP23BP3 FP23BP2 FP23BP1 FP23BP0 FP22BP3 FP22BP2 FP22BP1 FP22BP0
W
0x0A14 LCDRAM12 RFP25BP3 FP25BP2 FP25BP1 FP25BP0 FP24BP3 FP24BP2 FP24BP1 FP24BP0
W
0x0A15 LCDRAM13 RFP27BP3 FP27BP2 FP27BP1 FP27BP0 FP26BP3 FP26BP2 FP26BP1 FP26BP0
W
0x0A16 LCDRAM14 RFP29BP3 FP29BP2 FP29BP1 FP29BP0 FP28BP3 FP28BP2 FP28BP1 FP28BP0
W
0x0A17 LCDRAM15 RFP31BP3 FP31BP2 FP31BP1 FP31BP0 FP30BP3 FP30BP2 FP30BP1 FP30BP0
W
0x0A18 LCDRAM16 RFP33BP3 FP33BP2 FP33BP1 FP33BP0 FP32BP3 FP32BP2 FP32BP1 FP32BP0
W
0x0A19 LCDRAM17 RFP35BP3 FP35BP2 FP35BP1 FP35BP0 FP34BP3 FP34BP2 FP34BP1 FP34BP0
W
0x0A1A LCDRAM18 RFP37BP3 FP37BP2 FP37BP1 FP37BP0 FP36BP3 FP36BP2 FP36BP1 FP36BP0
W
0x0A1B LCDRAM19 RFP39BP3 FP39BP2 FP39BP1 FP39BP0 FP38BP3 FP38BP2 FP38BP1 FP38BP0
W
0x0A1C-
0x0A1F Reserved R
W
0x0A20–0x0A3F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0A20-
0x0A3F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0A00–0x0A1F Liquid Crystal Display (LCD)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
870 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0A40–0x0A7F Motor Control (MC)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0A40 MCCTL0 R0 MCPRE1 MCPRE0 MCSWAI FAST DITH 0MCTOIF
W
0x0A41 MCCTL1 RRECIRC 000000
MCTOIE
W
0x0A42 MCPERH R00000
P10 P9 P8
W
0x0A43 MCPERL RP7 P6 P5 P4 P3 P2 P1 P0
W
0x0A44–
0x0A4F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0A50 MCCC0 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A51 MCCC1 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A52 MCCC2 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A53 MCCC3 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A54 MCCC4 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A55 MCCC5 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A56 MCCC6 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A57 MCCC7 RMCOM1 MCOM0 MCAM1 MCAM0 00
CD1 CD0
W
0x0A58–
0x0A5F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0A60 MCDC0H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A61 MCDC0L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0A62 MCDC1H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A63 MCDC1L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 871
0x0A64 MCDC2H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A65 MCDC2L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0A66 MCDC3H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A67 MCDC3L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0A68 MCDC4H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A69 MCDC4L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0A6A MCDC5H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A6B MCDC5L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0A6C MCDC6H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A6D MCDC6L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0A6E MCDC7H RSSSSS
D10 D9 D8
W
0x0A6F MCDC7L RD7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
W
0x0A70–
0x0A7F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0A80–0x0A87 Stepper Stall Detector (SSD0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0A80 RTZ0CTL RITG DCOIL RCIR POL 00 STEP
W
0x0A81 MDC0CTL RMCZIE MODMC RDMCL PRE 0MCEN 0AOVIE
WFLMC
0x0A82 SSD0CTL RRTZE SDCPU SSDWAI FTST 00 ACLKS
W
0x0A83 SSD0FLG RMCZIF 000000
AOVIF
W
0x0A40–0x0A7F Motor Control (MC)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
872 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0A84 MDC0CNTH RMDCCNT[15:8]
W
0x0A85 MDC0CNTL RMDCCNT[7:0]
W
0x0A86 ITG0ACCH R ITGACC[15:8]
W
0x0A87 ITG0ACCL R ITGACC[7:0]
W
0x0A88–0x0A8F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0A88-
0x0A8F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0A90–0x0A97 Stepper Stall Detector (SSD1)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0A90 RTZ1CTL RITG DCOIL RCIR POL 00 STEP
W
0x0A91 MDC1CTL RMCZIE MODMC RDMCL PRE 0MCEN 0AOVIE
WFLMC
0x0A92 SSD1CTL RRTZE SDCPU SSDWAI FTST 00 ACLKS
W
0x0A93 SSD1FLG RMCZIF 000000
AOVIF
W
0x0A94 MDC1CNTH RMDCCNT[15:8]
W
0x0A95 MDC1CNTL RMDCCNT[7:0]
W
0x0A96 ITG1ACCH R ITGACC[15:8]
W
0x0A97 ITG1ACCL R ITGACC[7:0]
W
0x0A80–0x0A87 Stepper Stall Detector (SSD0)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 873
0x0A98–0x0A9F Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0A98-
0x0A9F Reserved R00000000
W
0x0AA0–0x0AA7 Stepper Stall Detector (SSD2)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0AA0 RTZ2CTL RITG DCOIL RCIR POL 00 STEP
W
0x0AA1 MDC2CTL RMCZIE MODMC RDMCL PRE 0MCEN 0AOVIE
WFLMC
0x0AA2 SSD2CTL RRTZE SDCPU SSDWAI FTST 00 ACLKS
W
0x0AA3 SSD2FLG RMCZIF 000000
AOVIF
W
0x0AA4 MDC2CNTH RMDCCNT[15:8]
W
0x0AA5 MDC2CNTL RMDCCNT[7:0]
W
0x0AA6 ITG2ACCH R ITGACC[15:8]
W
0x0AA7 ITG2ACCL R ITGACC[7:0]
W
0x0AA8–0x0AAF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0AA8-
0x0AAF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0AB0–0x0AB7 Stepper Stall Detector (SSD3)
Addres
sName Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0AB0 RTZ3CTL RITG DCOIL RCIR POL 00 STEP
W
0x0AB1 MDC3CTL RMCZIE MODMC RDMCL PRE 0MCEN 0AOVIE
WFLMC
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
874 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0AB2 SSD3CTL RRTZE SDCPU SSDWAI FTST 00 ACLKS
W
0x0AB3 SSD3FLG RMCZIF 000000
AOVIF
W
0x0AB4 MDC3CNTH RMDCCNT[15:8]
W
0x0AB5 MDC3CNTL RMDCCNT[7:0]
W
0x0AB6 ITG3ACCH R ITGACC[15:8]
W
0x0AB7 ITG3ACCL R ITGACC[7:0]
W
0x0AB8–0x0ADF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0AB8-
0x0ADF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0AE0–0x0AEF Real Time Clock (RTC)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0AE0 RTCCTL1 RRTCEN 00000
COMPE 0
W
0x0AE1 RTCCTL2 RCLKSRC1 CLKSRC0 00
RTCPS3 RTCPS2 RTCPS1 RTCPS0
W
0x0AE2 RTCCTL3 R00
FRZ 0CALS 0
W RTCWE1 RTCWE0
0x0AE3 RTCCTL4 R0 0 HRIE MINIE SECIE COMPIE 0TB0IE
W
0x0AE4 RTCS1 R CDLC 0 HRF MINF SECF COMPF 0TB0F
W
0x0AE5 RTCCCR RCCS Q
W
0x0AE6 RTCMODH RRTCMODH
W
0x0AE7 RTCMODL RRTCMODL
W
0x0AB0–0x0AB7 Stepper Stall Detector (SSD3)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Famil y Reference Manual , Rev. 1.05
Freescale Semiconductor 875
0x0AE8 RTCCNTH R RTCCNTH
W
0x0AE9 RTCCNTL R RTCCNTL
W
0x0AEA–
0x0AEC Reserved R00000000
W
0x0AED RTCSEC R0 0 SEC5 SEC4 SEC3 SEC2 SEC1 SEC0
W
0x0AEE RTCMIN R0 0 MIN5 MIN4 MIN3 MIN2 MIN1 MIN0
W
0x0AEF RTCHR R000
HR4 HR3 HR2 HR1 HR0
W
0x0AF0–0x0AFF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0AF0-
0x0AFF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0B00–0x0B17 Simple Sound Generator(SSG0)
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0B00 SSG0CR
RSSGE 0000
OMS RDR STP
W
0x0B01 SSG0ADC
RADE 0000 ADM[1:0] ADS
W
0x0B02 SSG0PSH
R00000
PS10 PS9 PS8
W
0x0B03 SSG0PSL
RPS7 PS6 PS5 PS4 PS3 PS2 PS1 PS0
W
0x0B04 SSG0TONEH
R000000
TONE9 TONE8
W
0x0B05 SSG0TONEL
RTONE7 TONE6 TONE5 TONE4 TONE3 TONE2 TONE1 TONE0
W
0x0B06 SSG0AMPH
R00000
AMP10 AMP9 AMP8
W
0x0B07 SSG0AMPL
RAMP7 AMP6 AMP5 AMP4 AMP3 AMP2 AMP1 AMP0
W
0x0AE0–0x0AEF Real Time Clock (RTC)
Appendix P Detailed Register Address Map
S12ZVH Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.05
876 Freescale Semiconductor
0x0B08 SSG0AAH
R00000
AA10 AA9 AA8
W
0x0B09 SSG0AAL
R AA7 AA6 AA5 AA4 AA3 AA2 AA1 AA0
W
0x0B0A SSG0ATH
R00000
AT10 AT 9 AT 8
W
0x0B0B SSG0ATL
R AT 7 AT 6 AT5 AT4 AT3 AT 2 AT 1 AT 0
W
0x0B0C SSG0DUR
RDUR7 DUR6 DUR5 DUR4 DUR3 DUR2 DUR1 DUR0
W
0x0B0D SSG0IE
R0000000
RNDIE
W
0xC0E SSG0IF
R0000000
RNDI
W
0x0B0F RESERVED
R00000000
W
0x0B10 SSG0AMPBH
R00000AMPB10AMPB9AMPB8
W
0x0B11 SSG0AMPBL
R AMPB7 AMPB6 AMPB5 AMPB4 AMPB3 AMPB2 AMP1 AMPB0
W
0x0B12 SSG0DCNT
R DCNT7 DCNT6 DCNT5 DCNT4 DCNT3 DCNT2 DCNT1 DCNT0
W
0x0B13-
0x0B17 RESERVED
R00000000
W
0x0B18–0x0FFF Reserved
Address Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0x0B18-
0x0FFF Reserved R00000000
W
0x0B00–0x0B17 Simple Sound Generator(SSG0)
Document Number: MC9S12ZVHRMV1
Rev. 1.05
Mar 2015
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software
implementers to use Freescale products. There are no express or implied copyright
licenses granted hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits based on the
information in this document.
Freescale reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products
herein. Freescale makes no warranty, representation, or guarantee regarding the
suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Freescale assume any
liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically
disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental
damages. “Typical” parameters that may be provided in Freescale data sheets and/or
specifications can and do vary in different applications, and actual performance may
vary over time. All operating parameters, including “typicals,” must be validated for
each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Freescale does not convey
any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Freescale sells products
pursuant to standard terms and conditions of sale, which can be found at the following
address:freescale.com/SalesTermsandConditions.
How to Reach Us:
Home Page:
freescale.com
Web Support:
freescale.com/support
Freescale and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.,
Reg. U.S. Pat. & Tm. Off. All other product or service names are the property of their
respective owners.
© 2015 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.